summaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
path: root/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorMichele Calgaro <michele.calgaro@yahoo.it>2019-04-21 23:22:20 +0900
committerMichele Calgaro <michele.calgaro@yahoo.it>2019-04-21 23:22:20 +0900
commitdba036816b279bc1539a9f3894fbc414665d2bce (patch)
tree29e4bf00bafe515e7afdd02168d65a47a3f9fbc0 /tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite
parent6f1b4f0c7505a049d992a33f6e409b7c75732d4b (diff)
downloadexperimental-dba036816b279bc1539a9f3894fbc414665d2bce.tar.gz
experimental-dba036816b279bc1539a9f3894fbc414665d2bce.zip
Removed unnecessary and/or TDE-unrelated code.
Signed-off-by: Michele Calgaro <michele.calgaro@yahoo.it> Signed-off-by: Slávek Banko <slavek.banko@axis.cz>
Diffstat (limited to 'tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite')
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/attach.c308
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/auth.c219
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree.c3579
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree.h156
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree_rb.c1488
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/build.c2157
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/config.h23
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/copy.c110
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/date.c873
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/delete.c393
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/expr.c1656
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/func.c646
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/hash.c356
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/hash.h109
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/insert.c919
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/main.c1136
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/opcodes.c138
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/opcodes.h136
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/os.c1818
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/os.h192
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pager.c2220
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pager.h107
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/parse.c4035
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/parse.h130
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pragma.c699
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/printf.c855
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/random.c97
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/select.c2404
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/shell.c1350
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/sqlite.h834
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/sqliteInt.h1266
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/table.c203
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/tokenize.c679
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/trigger.c764
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/trolltech.patch39
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/update.c452
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/util.c1135
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vacuum.c320
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbe.c4885
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbe.h112
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbeInt.h303
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbeaux.c1061
-rw-r--r--tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/where.c1204
43 files changed, 0 insertions, 41566 deletions
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/attach.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/attach.c
deleted file mode 100644
index e8cd86e..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/attach.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,308 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2003 April 6
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains code used to implement the ATTACH and DETACH commands.
-**
-** $Id: attach.c,v 1.10 2004/02/12 18:46:39 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-/*
-** This routine is called by the parser to process an ATTACH statement:
-**
-** ATTACH DATABASE filename AS dbname
-**
-** The pFilename and pDbname arguments are the tokens that define the
-** filename and dbname in the ATTACH statement.
-*/
-void sqliteAttach(Parse *pParse, Token *pFilename, Token *pDbname, Token *pKey){
- Db *aNew;
- int rc, i;
- char *zFile, *zName;
- sqlite *db;
- Vdbe *v;
-
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Halt, 0, 0);
- if( pParse->explain ) return;
- db = pParse->db;
- if( db->file_format<4 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot attach auxiliary databases to an "
- "older format master database", 0);
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- return;
- }
- if( db->nDb>=MAX_ATTACHED+2 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "too many attached databases - max %d",
- MAX_ATTACHED);
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- return;
- }
-
- zFile = 0;
- sqliteSetNString(&zFile, pFilename->z, pFilename->n, 0);
- if( zFile==0 ) return;
- sqliteDequote(zFile);
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_ATTACH, zFile, 0, 0)!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteFree(zFile);
- return;
- }
-#endif /* STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION */
-
- zName = 0;
- sqliteSetNString(&zName, pDbname->z, pDbname->n, 0);
- if( zName==0 ) return;
- sqliteDequote(zName);
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- if( db->aDb[i].zName && sqliteStrICmp(db->aDb[i].zName, zName)==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "database %z is already in use", zName);
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- sqliteFree(zFile);
- return;
- }
- }
-
- if( db->aDb==db->aDbStatic ){
- aNew = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(db->aDb[0])*3 );
- if( aNew==0 ) return;
- memcpy(aNew, db->aDb, sizeof(db->aDb[0])*2);
- }else{
- aNew = sqliteRealloc(db->aDb, sizeof(db->aDb[0])*(db->nDb+1) );
- if( aNew==0 ) return;
- }
- db->aDb = aNew;
- aNew = &db->aDb[db->nDb++];
- memset(aNew, 0, sizeof(*aNew));
- sqliteHashInit(&aNew->tblHash, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 0);
- sqliteHashInit(&aNew->idxHash, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 0);
- sqliteHashInit(&aNew->trigHash, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 0);
- sqliteHashInit(&aNew->aFKey, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 1);
- aNew->zName = zName;
- rc = sqliteBtreeFactory(db, zFile, 0, MAX_PAGES, &aNew->pBt);
- if( rc ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "unable to open database: %s", zFile);
- }
-#if STQLITE_HAS_CODEC
- {
- extern int sqliteCodecAttach(sqlite*, int, void*, int);
- char *zKey = 0;
- int nKey;
- if( pKey && pKey->z && pKey->n ){
- sqliteSetNString(&zKey, pKey->z, pKey->n, 0);
- sqliteDequote(zKey);
- nKey = strlen(zKey);
- }else{
- zKey = 0;
- nKey = 0;
- }
- sqliteCodecAttach(db, db->nDb-1, zKey, nKey);
- }
-#endif
- sqliteFree(zFile);
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_Initialized;
- if( pParse->nErr ) return;
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqliteInit(pParse->db, &pParse->zErrMsg);
- }
- if( rc ){
- int i = db->nDb - 1;
- assert( i>=2 );
- if( db->aDb[i].pBt ){
- sqliteBtreeClose(db->aDb[i].pBt);
- db->aDb[i].pBt = 0;
- }
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, 0);
- pParse->nErr++;
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called by the parser to process a DETACH statement:
-**
-** DETACH DATABASE dbname
-**
-** The pDbname argument is the name of the database in the DETACH statement.
-*/
-void sqliteDetach(Parse *pParse, Token *pDbname){
- int i;
- sqlite *db;
- Vdbe *v;
-
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Halt, 0, 0);
- if( pParse->explain ) return;
- db = pParse->db;
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- if( db->aDb[i].pBt==0 || db->aDb[i].zName==0 ) continue;
- if( strlen(db->aDb[i].zName)!=pDbname->n ) continue;
- if( sqliteStrNICmp(db->aDb[i].zName, pDbname->z, pDbname->n)==0 ) break;
- }
- if( i>=db->nDb ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "no such database: %T", pDbname);
- return;
- }
- if( i<2 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot detach database %T", pDbname);
- return;
- }
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse,STQLITE_DETACH,db->aDb[i].zName,0,0)!=STQLITE_OK ){
- return;
- }
-#endif /* STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION */
- sqliteBtreeClose(db->aDb[i].pBt);
- db->aDb[i].pBt = 0;
- sqliteFree(db->aDb[i].zName);
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, i);
- db->nDb--;
- if( i<db->nDb ){
- db->aDb[i] = db->aDb[db->nDb];
- memset(&db->aDb[db->nDb], 0, sizeof(db->aDb[0]));
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, i);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Initialize a DbFixer structure. This routine must be called prior
-** to passing the structure to one of the sqliteFixAAAA() routines below.
-**
-** The return value indicates whether or not fixation is required. TRUE
-** means we do need to fix the database references, FALSE means we do not.
-*/
-int sqliteFixInit(
- DbFixer *pFix, /* The fixer to be initialized */
- Parse *pParse, /* Error messages will be written here */
- int iDb, /* This is the database that must must be used */
- const char *zType, /* "view", "trigger", or "index" */
- const Token *pName /* Name of the view, trigger, or index */
-){
- sqlite *db;
-
- if( iDb<0 || iDb==1 ) return 0;
- db = pParse->db;
- assert( db->nDb>iDb );
- pFix->pParse = pParse;
- pFix->zDb = db->aDb[iDb].zName;
- pFix->zType = zType;
- pFix->pName = pName;
- return 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** The following set of routines walk through the parse tree and assign
-** a specific database to all table references where the database name
-** was left unspecified in the original SQL statement. The pFix structure
-** must have been initialized by a prior call to sqliteFixInit().
-**
-** These routines are used to make sure that an index, trigger, or
-** view in one database does not refer to objects in a different database.
-** (Exception: indices, triggers, and views in the TEMP database are
-** allowed to refer to anything.) If a reference is explicitly made
-** to an object in a different database, an error message is added to
-** pParse->zErrMsg and these routines return non-zero. If everything
-** checks out, these routines return 0.
-*/
-int sqliteFixSrcList(
- DbFixer *pFix, /* Context of the fixation */
- SrcList *pList /* The Source list to check and modify */
-){
- int i;
- const char *zDb;
-
- if( pList==0 ) return 0;
- zDb = pFix->zDb;
- for(i=0; i<pList->nSrc; i++){
- if( pList->a[i].zDatabase==0 ){
- pList->a[i].zDatabase = sqliteStrDup(zDb);
- }else if( sqliteStrICmp(pList->a[i].zDatabase,zDb)!=0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pFix->pParse,
- "%s %z cannot reference objects in database %s",
- pFix->zType, sqliteStrNDup(pFix->pName->z, pFix->pName->n),
- pList->a[i].zDatabase);
- return 1;
- }
- if( sqliteFixSelect(pFix, pList->a[i].pSelect) ) return 1;
- if( sqliteFixExpr(pFix, pList->a[i].pOn) ) return 1;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-int sqliteFixSelect(
- DbFixer *pFix, /* Context of the fixation */
- Select *pSelect /* The SELECT statement to be fixed to one database */
-){
- while( pSelect ){
- if( sqliteFixExprList(pFix, pSelect->pEList) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( sqliteFixSrcList(pFix, pSelect->pSrc) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( sqliteFixExpr(pFix, pSelect->pWhere) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( sqliteFixExpr(pFix, pSelect->pHaving) ){
- return 1;
- }
- pSelect = pSelect->pPrior;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-int sqliteFixExpr(
- DbFixer *pFix, /* Context of the fixation */
- Expr *pExpr /* The expression to be fixed to one database */
-){
- while( pExpr ){
- if( sqliteFixSelect(pFix, pExpr->pSelect) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( sqliteFixExprList(pFix, pExpr->pList) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( sqliteFixExpr(pFix, pExpr->pRight) ){
- return 1;
- }
- pExpr = pExpr->pLeft;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-int sqliteFixExprList(
- DbFixer *pFix, /* Context of the fixation */
- ExprList *pList /* The expression to be fixed to one database */
-){
- int i;
- if( pList==0 ) return 0;
- for(i=0; i<pList->nExpr; i++){
- if( sqliteFixExpr(pFix, pList->a[i].pExpr) ){
- return 1;
- }
- }
- return 0;
-}
-int sqliteFixTriggerStep(
- DbFixer *pFix, /* Context of the fixation */
- TriggerStep *pStep /* The trigger step be fixed to one database */
-){
- while( pStep ){
- if( sqliteFixSelect(pFix, pStep->pSelect) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( sqliteFixExpr(pFix, pStep->pWhere) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( sqliteFixExprList(pFix, pStep->pExprList) ){
- return 1;
- }
- pStep = pStep->pNext;
- }
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/auth.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/auth.c
deleted file mode 100644
index bf07eba..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/auth.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,219 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2003 January 11
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains code used to implement the sqlite_set_authorizer()
-** API. This facility is an optional feature of the library. Embedded
-** systems that do not need this facility may omit it by recompiling
-** the library with -DSTQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION=1
-**
-** $Id: auth.c,v 1.12 2004/02/22 18:40:57 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-/*
-** All of the code in this file may be omitted by defining a single
-** macro.
-*/
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
-
-/*
-** Set or clear the access authorization function.
-**
-** The access authorization function is be called during the compilation
-** phase to verify that the user has read and/or write access permission on
-** various fields of the database. The first argument to the auth function
-** is a copy of the 3rd argument to this routine. The second argument
-** to the auth function is one of these constants:
-**
-** STQLITE_COPY
-** STQLITE_CREATE_INDEX
-** STQLITE_CREATE_TABLE
-** STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_INDEX
-** STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_TABLE
-** STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_TRIGGER
-** STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_VIEW
-** STQLITE_CREATE_TRIGGER
-** STQLITE_CREATE_VIEW
-** STQLITE_DELETE
-** STQLITE_DROP_INDEX
-** STQLITE_DROP_TABLE
-** STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_INDEX
-** STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_TABLE
-** STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_TRIGGER
-** STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_VIEW
-** STQLITE_DROP_TRIGGER
-** STQLITE_DROP_VIEW
-** STQLITE_INSERT
-** STQLITE_PRAGMA
-** STQLITE_READ
-** STQLITE_SELECT
-** STQLITE_TRANSACTION
-** STQLITE_UPDATE
-**
-** The third and fourth arguments to the auth function are the name of
-** the table and the column that are being accessed. The auth function
-** should return either STQLITE_OK, STQLITE_DENY, or STQLITE_IGNORE. If
-** STQLITE_OK is returned, it means that access is allowed. STQLITE_DENY
-** means that the SQL statement will never-run - the sqlite_exec() call
-** will return with an error. STQLITE_IGNORE means that the SQL statement
-** should run but attempts to read the specified column will return NULL
-** and attempts to write the column will be ignored.
-**
-** Setting the auth function to NULL disables this hook. The default
-** setting of the auth function is NULL.
-*/
-int sqlite_set_authorizer(
- sqlite *db,
- int (*xAuth)(void*,int,const char*,const char*,const char*,const char*),
- void *pArg
-){
- db->xAuth = xAuth;
- db->pAuthArg = pArg;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Write an error message into pParse->zErrMsg that explains that the
-** user-supplied authorization function returned an illegal value.
-*/
-static void sqliteAuthBadReturnCode(Parse *pParse, int rc){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "illegal return value (%d) from the "
- "authorization function - should be STQLITE_OK, STQLITE_IGNORE, "
- "or STQLITE_DENY", rc);
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_MISUSE;
-}
-
-/*
-** The pExpr should be a TK_COLUMN expression. The table referred to
-** is in pTabList or else it is the NEW or OLD table of a trigger.
-** Check to see if it is OK to read this particular column.
-**
-** If the auth function returns STQLITE_IGNORE, change the TK_COLUMN
-** instruction into a TK_NULL. If the auth function returns STQLITE_DENY,
-** then generate an error.
-*/
-void sqliteAuthRead(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- Expr *pExpr, /* The expression to check authorization on */
- SrcList *pTabList /* All table that pExpr might refer to */
-){
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- int rc;
- Table *pTab; /* The table being read */
- const char *zCol; /* Name of the column of the table */
- int iSrc; /* Index in pTabList->a[] of table being read */
- const char *zDBase; /* Name of database being accessed */
-
- if( db->xAuth==0 ) return;
- assert( pExpr->op==TK_COLUMN );
- for(iSrc=0; iSrc<pTabList->nSrc; iSrc++){
- if( pExpr->iTable==pTabList->a[iSrc].iCursor ) break;
- }
- if( iSrc>=0 && iSrc<pTabList->nSrc ){
- pTab = pTabList->a[iSrc].pTab;
- }else{
- /* This must be an attempt to read the NEW or OLD pseudo-tables
- ** of a trigger.
- */
- TriggerStack *pStack; /* The stack of current triggers */
- pStack = pParse->trigStack;
- assert( pStack!=0 );
- assert( pExpr->iTable==pStack->newIdx || pExpr->iTable==pStack->oldIdx );
- pTab = pStack->pTab;
- }
- if( pTab==0 ) return;
- if( pExpr->iColumn>=0 ){
- assert( pExpr->iColumn<pTab->nCol );
- zCol = pTab->aCol[pExpr->iColumn].zName;
- }else if( pTab->iPKey>=0 ){
- assert( pTab->iPKey<pTab->nCol );
- zCol = pTab->aCol[pTab->iPKey].zName;
- }else{
- zCol = "ROWID";
- }
- assert( pExpr->iDb<db->nDb );
- zDBase = db->aDb[pExpr->iDb].zName;
- rc = db->xAuth(db->pAuthArg, STQLITE_READ, pTab->zName, zCol, zDBase,
- pParse->zAuthContext);
- if( rc==STQLITE_IGNORE ){
- pExpr->op = TK_NULL;
- }else if( rc==STQLITE_DENY ){
- if( db->nDb>2 || pExpr->iDb!=0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "access to %s.%s.%s is prohibited",
- zDBase, pTab->zName, zCol);
- }else{
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "access to %s.%s is prohibited", pTab->zName,zCol);
- }
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_AUTH;
- }else if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteAuthBadReturnCode(pParse, rc);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Do an authorization check using the code and arguments given. Return
-** either STQLITE_OK (zero) or STQLITE_IGNORE or STQLITE_DENY. If STQLITE_DENY
-** is returned, then the error count and error message in pParse are
-** modified appropriately.
-*/
-int sqliteAuthCheck(
- Parse *pParse,
- int code,
- const char *zArg1,
- const char *zArg2,
- const char *zArg3
-){
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- int rc;
-
- if( db->xAuth==0 ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- rc = db->xAuth(db->pAuthArg, code, zArg1, zArg2, zArg3, pParse->zAuthContext);
- if( rc==STQLITE_DENY ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "not authorized");
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_AUTH;
- }else if( rc!=STQLITE_OK && rc!=STQLITE_IGNORE ){
- rc = STQLITE_DENY;
- sqliteAuthBadReturnCode(pParse, rc);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Push an authorization context. After this routine is called, the
-** zArg3 argument to authorization callbacks will be zContext until
-** popped. Or if pParse==0, this routine is a no-op.
-*/
-void sqliteAuthContextPush(
- Parse *pParse,
- AuthContext *pContext,
- const char *zContext
-){
- pContext->pParse = pParse;
- if( pParse ){
- pContext->zAuthContext = pParse->zAuthContext;
- pParse->zAuthContext = zContext;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Pop an authorization context that was previously pushed
-** by sqliteAuthContextPush
-*/
-void sqliteAuthContextPop(AuthContext *pContext){
- if( pContext->pParse ){
- pContext->pParse->zAuthContext = pContext->zAuthContext;
- pContext->pParse = 0;
- }
-}
-
-#endif /* STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION */
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 3ff88f6..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,3579 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** $Id: btree.c,v 1.102 2004/02/14 17:35:07 drh Exp $
-**
-** This file implements a external (disk-based) database using BTrees.
-** For a detailed discussion of BTrees, refer to
-**
-** Donald E. Knuth, THE ART OF COMPUTER PROGRAMMING, Volume 3:
-** "Sorting And Searching", pages 473-480. Addison-Wesley
-** Publishing Company, Reading, Massachusetts.
-**
-** The basic idea is that each page of the file contains N database
-** entries and N+1 pointers to subpages.
-**
-** ----------------------------------------------------------------
-** | Ptr(0) | Key(0) | Ptr(1) | Key(1) | ... | Key(N) | Ptr(N+1) |
-** ----------------------------------------------------------------
-**
-** All of the keys on the page that Ptr(0) points to have values less
-** than Key(0). All of the keys on page Ptr(1) and its subpages have
-** values greater than Key(0) and less than Key(1). All of the keys
-** on Ptr(N+1) and its subpages have values greater than Key(N). And
-** so forth.
-**
-** Finding a particular key requires reading O(log(M)) pages from the
-** disk where M is the number of entries in the tree.
-**
-** In this implementation, a single file can hold one or more separate
-** BTrees. Each BTree is identified by the index of its root page. The
-** key and data for any entry are combined to form the "payload". Up to
-** MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD bytes of payload can be carried directly on the
-** database page. If the payload is larger than MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD bytes
-** then surplus bytes are stored on overflow pages. The payload for an
-** entry and the preceding pointer are combined to form a "Cell". Each
-** page has a small header which contains the Ptr(N+1) pointer.
-**
-** The first page of the file contains a magic string used to verify that
-** the file really is a valid BTree database, a pointer to a list of unused
-** pages in the file, and some meta information. The root of the first
-** BTree begins on page 2 of the file. (Pages are numbered beginning with
-** 1, not 0.) Thus a minimum database contains 2 pages.
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include "pager.h"
-#include "btree.h"
-#include <assert.h>
-
-/* Forward declarations */
-static BtOps sqliteBtreeOps;
-static BtCursorOps sqliteBtreeCursorOps;
-
-/*
-** Macros used for byteswapping. B is a pointer to the Btree
-** structure. This is needed to access the Btree.needSwab boolean
-** in order to tell if byte swapping is needed or not.
-** X is an unsigned integer. SWAB16 byte swaps a 16-bit integer.
-** SWAB32 byteswaps a 32-bit integer.
-*/
-#define SWAB16(B,X) ((B)->needSwab? swab16((u16)X) : ((u16)X))
-#define SWAB32(B,X) ((B)->needSwab? swab32(X) : (X))
-#define SWAB_ADD(B,X,A) \
- if((B)->needSwab){ X=swab32(swab32(X)+A); }else{ X += (A); }
-
-/*
-** The following global variable - available only if STQLITE_TEST is
-** defined - is used to determine whether new databases are created in
-** native byte order or in non-native byte order. Non-native byte order
-** databases are created for testing purposes only. Under normal operation,
-** only native byte-order databases should be created, but we should be
-** able to read or write existing databases regardless of the byteorder.
-*/
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-int btree_native_byte_order = 1;
-#else
-# define btree_native_byte_order 1
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Forward declarations of structures used only in this file.
-*/
-typedef struct PageOne PageOne;
-typedef struct MemPage MemPage;
-typedef struct PageHdr PageHdr;
-typedef struct Cell Cell;
-typedef struct CellHdr CellHdr;
-typedef struct FreeBlk FreeBlk;
-typedef struct OverflowPage OverflowPage;
-typedef struct FreelistInfo FreelistInfo;
-
-/*
-** All structures on a database page are aligned to 4-byte boundries.
-** This routine rounds up a number of bytes to the next multiple of 4.
-**
-** This might need to change for computer architectures that require
-** and 8-byte tqalignment boundry for structures.
-*/
-#define ROUNDUP(X) ((X+3) & ~3)
-
-/*
-** This is a magic string that appears at the beginning of every
-** STQLite database in order to identify the file as a real database.
-*/
-static const char zMagicHeader[] =
- "** This file contains an STQLite 2.1 database **";
-#define MAGIC_SIZE (sizeof(zMagicHeader))
-
-/*
-** This is a magic integer also used to test the integrity of the database
-** file. This integer is used in addition to the string above so that
-** if the file is written on a little-endian architecture and read
-** on a big-endian architectures (or vice versa) we can detect the
-** problem.
-**
-** The number used was obtained at random and has no special
-** significance other than the fact that it represents a different
-** integer on little-endian and big-endian machines.
-*/
-#define MAGIC 0xdae37528
-
-/*
-** The first page of the database file contains a magic header string
-** to identify the file as an STQLite database file. It also contains
-** a pointer to the first free page of the file. Page 2 contains the
-** root of the principle BTree. The file might contain other BTrees
-** rooted on pages above 2.
-**
-** The first page also contains STQLITE_N_BTREE_META integers that
-** can be used by higher-level routines.
-**
-** Remember that pages are numbered beginning with 1. (See pager.c
-** for additional information.) Page 0 does not exist and a page
-** number of 0 is used to mean "no such page".
-*/
-struct PageOne {
- char zMagic[MAGIC_SIZE]; /* String that identifies the file as a database */
- int iMagic; /* Integer to verify correct byte order */
- Pgno freeList; /* First free page in a list of all free pages */
- int nFree; /* Number of pages on the free list */
- int aMeta[STQLITE_N_BTREE_META-1]; /* User defined integers */
-};
-
-/*
-** Each database page has a header that is an instance of this
-** structure.
-**
-** PageHdr.firstFree is 0 if there is no free space on this page.
-** Otherwise, PageHdr.firstFree is the index in MemPage.u.aDisk[] of a
-** FreeBlk structure that describes the first block of free space.
-** All free space is defined by a linked list of FreeBlk structures.
-**
-** Data is stored in a linked list of Cell structures. PageHdr.firstCell
-** is the index into MemPage.u.aDisk[] of the first cell on the page. The
-** Cells are kept in sorted order.
-**
-** A Cell contains all information about a database entry and a pointer
-** to a child page that contains other entries less than itself. In
-** other words, the i-th Cell contains both Ptr(i) and Key(i). The
-** right-most pointer of the page is contained in PageHdr.rightChild.
-*/
-struct PageHdr {
- Pgno rightChild; /* Child page that comes after all cells on this page */
- u16 firstCell; /* Index in MemPage.u.aDisk[] of the first cell */
- u16 firstFree; /* Index in MemPage.u.aDisk[] of the first free block */
-};
-
-/*
-** Entries on a page of the database are called "Cells". Each Cell
-** has a header and data. This structure defines the header. The
-** key and data (collectively the "payload") follow this header on
-** the database page.
-**
-** A definition of the complete Cell structure is given below. The
-** header for the cell must be defined first in order to do some
-** of the sizing #defines that follow.
-*/
-struct CellHdr {
- Pgno leftChild; /* Child page that comes before this cell */
- u16 nKey; /* Number of bytes in the key */
- u16 iNext; /* Index in MemPage.u.aDisk[] of next cell in sorted order */
- u8 nKeyHi; /* Upper 8 bits of key size for keys larger than 64K bytes */
- u8 nDataHi; /* Upper 8 bits of data size when the size is more than 64K */
- u16 nData; /* Number of bytes of data */
-};
-
-/*
-** The key and data size are split into a lower 16-bit segment and an
-** upper 8-bit segment in order to pack them together into a smaller
-** space. The following macros reassembly a key or data size back
-** into an integer.
-*/
-#define NKEY(b,h) (SWAB16(b,h.nKey) + h.nKeyHi*65536)
-#define NDATA(b,h) (SWAB16(b,h.nData) + h.nDataHi*65536)
-
-/*
-** The minimum size of a complete Cell. The Cell must contain a header
-** and at least 4 bytes of payload.
-*/
-#define MIN_CELL_SIZE (sizeof(CellHdr)+4)
-
-/*
-** The maximum number of database entries that can be held in a single
-** page of the database.
-*/
-#define MX_CELL ((STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE-sizeof(PageHdr))/MIN_CELL_SIZE)
-
-/*
-** The amount of usable space on a single page of the BTree. This is the
-** page size minus the overhead of the page header.
-*/
-#define USABLE_SPACE (STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE - sizeof(PageHdr))
-
-/*
-** The maximum amount of payload (in bytes) that can be stored locally for
-** a database entry. If the entry contains more data than this, the
-** extra goes onto overflow pages.
-**
-** This number is chosen so that at least 4 cells will fit on every page.
-*/
-#define MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD ((USABLE_SPACE/4-(sizeof(CellHdr)+sizeof(Pgno)))&~3)
-
-/*
-** Data on a database page is stored as a linked list of Cell structures.
-** Both the key and the data are stored in aPayload[]. The key always comes
-** first. The aPayload[] field grows as necessary to hold the key and data,
-** up to a maximum of MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD bytes. If the size of the key and
-** data combined exceeds MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD bytes, then Cell.ovfl is the
-** page number of the first overflow page.
-**
-** Though this structure is fixed in size, the Cell on the database
-** page varies in size. Every cell has a CellHdr and at least 4 bytes
-** of payload space. Additional payload bytes (up to the maximum of
-** MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD) and the Cell.ovfl value are allocated only as
-** needed.
-*/
-struct Cell {
- CellHdr h; /* The cell header */
- char aPayload[MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD]; /* Key and data */
- Pgno ovfl; /* The first overflow page */
-};
-
-/*
-** Free space on a page is remembered using a linked list of the FreeBlk
-** structures. Space on a database page is allocated in increments of
-** at least 4 bytes and is always aligned to a 4-byte boundry. The
-** linked list of FreeBlks is always kept in order by address.
-*/
-struct FreeBlk {
- u16 iSize; /* Number of bytes in this block of free space */
- u16 iNext; /* Index in MemPage.u.aDisk[] of the next free block */
-};
-
-/*
-** The number of bytes of payload that will fit on a single overflow page.
-*/
-#define OVERFLOW_SIZE (STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE-sizeof(Pgno))
-
-/*
-** When the key and data for a single entry in the BTree will not fit in
-** the MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD bytes of space available on the database page,
-** then all extra bytes are written to a linked list of overflow pages.
-** Each overflow page is an instance of the following structure.
-**
-** Unused pages in the database are also represented by instances of
-** the OverflowPage structure. The PageOne.freeList field is the
-** page number of the first page in a linked list of unused database
-** pages.
-*/
-struct OverflowPage {
- Pgno iNext;
- char aPayload[OVERFLOW_SIZE];
-};
-
-/*
-** The PageOne.freeList field points to a linked list of overflow pages
-** hold information about free pages. The aPayload section of each
-** overflow page contains an instance of the following structure. The
-** aFree[] array holds the page number of nFree unused pages in the disk
-** file.
-*/
-struct FreelistInfo {
- int nFree;
- Pgno aFree[(OVERFLOW_SIZE-sizeof(int))/sizeof(Pgno)];
-};
-
-/*
-** For every page in the database file, an instance of the following structure
-** is stored in memory. The u.aDisk[] array contains the raw bits read from
-** the disk. The rest is auxiliary information held in memory only. The
-** auxiliary info is only valid for regular database pages - it is not
-** used for overflow pages and pages on the freelist.
-**
-** Of particular interest in the auxiliary info is the apCell[] entry. Each
-** apCell[] entry is a pointer to a Cell structure in u.aDisk[]. The cells are
-** put in this array so that they can be accessed in constant time, rather
-** than in linear time which would be needed if we had to walk the linked
-** list on every access.
-**
-** Note that apCell[] contains enough space to hold up to two more Cells
-** than can possibly fit on one page. In the steady state, every apCell[]
-** points to memory inside u.aDisk[]. But in the middle of an insert
-** operation, some apCell[] entries may temporarily point to data space
-** outside of u.aDisk[]. This is a transient situation that is quickly
-** resolved. But while it is happening, it is possible for a database
-** page to hold as many as two more cells than it might otherwise hold.
-** The extra two entries in apCell[] are an allowance for this situation.
-**
-** The pParent field points back to the parent page. This allows us to
-** walk up the BTree from any leaf to the root. Care must be taken to
-** unref() the parent page pointer when this page is no longer referenced.
-** The pageDestructor() routine handles that chore.
-*/
-struct MemPage {
- union u_page_data {
- char aDisk[STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE]; /* Page data stored on disk */
- PageHdr hdr; /* Overlay page header */
- } u;
- u8 isInit; /* True if auxiliary data is initialized */
- u8 idxShift; /* True if apCell[] indices have changed */
- u8 isOverfull; /* Some apCell[] points outside u.aDisk[] */
- MemPage *pParent; /* The parent of this page. NULL for root */
- int idxParent; /* Index in pParent->apCell[] of this node */
- int nFree; /* Number of free bytes in u.aDisk[] */
- int nCell; /* Number of entries on this page */
- Cell *apCell[MX_CELL+2]; /* All data entires in sorted order */
-};
-
-/*
-** The in-memory image of a disk page has the auxiliary information appended
-** to the end. EXTRA_SIZE is the number of bytes of space needed to hold
-** that extra information.
-*/
-#define EXTRA_SIZE (sizeof(MemPage)-sizeof(union u_page_data))
-
-/*
-** Everything we need to know about an open database
-*/
-struct Btree {
- BtOps *pOps; /* Function table */
- Pager *pPager; /* The page cache */
- BtCursor *pCursor; /* A list of all open cursors */
- PageOne *page1; /* First page of the database */
- u8 inTrans; /* True if a transaction is in progress */
- u8 inCkpt; /* True if there is a checkpoint on the transaction */
- u8 readOnly; /* True if the underlying file is readonly */
- u8 needSwab; /* Need to byte-swapping */
-};
-typedef Btree Bt;
-
-/*
-** A cursor is a pointer to a particular entry in the BTree.
-** The entry is identified by its MemPage and the index in
-** MemPage.apCell[] of the entry.
-*/
-struct BtCursor {
- BtCursorOps *pOps; /* Function table */
- Btree *pBt; /* The Btree to which this cursor belongs */
- BtCursor *pNext, *pPrev; /* Forms a linked list of all cursors */
- BtCursor *pShared; /* Loop of cursors with the same root page */
- Pgno pgnoRoot; /* The root page of this tree */
- MemPage *pPage; /* Page that contains the entry */
- int idx; /* Index of the entry in pPage->apCell[] */
- u8 wrFlag; /* True if writable */
- u8 eSkip; /* Determines if next step operation is a no-op */
- u8 iMatch; /* compare result from last sqliteBtreeMoveto() */
-};
-
-/*
-** Legal values for BtCursor.eSkip.
-*/
-#define SKIP_NONE 0 /* Always step the cursor */
-#define SKIP_NEXT 1 /* The next sqliteBtreeNext() is a no-op */
-#define SKIP_PREV 2 /* The next sqliteBtreePrevious() is a no-op */
-#define SKIP_INVALID 3 /* Calls to Next() and Previous() are invalid */
-
-/* Forward declarations */
-static int fileBtreeCloseCursor(BtCursor *pCur);
-
-/*
-** Routines for byte swapping.
-*/
-u16 swab16(u16 x){
- return ((x & 0xff)<<8) | ((x>>8)&0xff);
-}
-u32 swab32(u32 x){
- return ((x & 0xff)<<24) | ((x & 0xff00)<<8) |
- ((x>>8) & 0xff00) | ((x>>24)&0xff);
-}
-
-/*
-** Compute the total number of bytes that a Cell needs on the main
-** database page. The number returned includes the Cell header,
-** local payload storage, and the pointer to overflow pages (if
-** applicable). Additional space allocated on overflow pages
-** is NOT included in the value returned from this routine.
-*/
-static int cellSize(Btree *pBt, Cell *pCell){
- int n = NKEY(pBt, pCell->h) + NDATA(pBt, pCell->h);
- if( n>MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD ){
- n = MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD + sizeof(Pgno);
- }else{
- n = ROUNDUP(n);
- }
- n += sizeof(CellHdr);
- return n;
-}
-
-/*
-** Defragment the page given. All Cells are moved to the
-** beginning of the page and all free space is collected
-** into one big FreeBlk at the end of the page.
-*/
-static void defragmentPage(Btree *pBt, MemPage *pPage){
- int pc, i, n;
- FreeBlk *pFBlk;
- char newPage[STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE];
-
- assert( sqlitepager_iswriteable(pPage) );
- assert( pPage->isInit );
- pc = sizeof(PageHdr);
- pPage->u.hdr.firstCell = SWAB16(pBt, pc);
- memcpy(newPage, pPage->u.aDisk, pc);
- for(i=0; i<pPage->nCell; i++){
- Cell *pCell = pPage->apCell[i];
-
- /* This routine should never be called on an overfull page. The
- ** following asserts verify that constraint. */
- assert( Addr(pCell) > Addr(pPage) );
- assert( Addr(pCell) < Addr(pPage) + STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE );
-
- n = cellSize(pBt, pCell);
- pCell->h.iNext = SWAB16(pBt, pc + n);
- memcpy(&newPage[pc], pCell, n);
- pPage->apCell[i] = (Cell*)&pPage->u.aDisk[pc];
- pc += n;
- }
- assert( pPage->nFree==STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE-pc );
- memcpy(pPage->u.aDisk, newPage, pc);
- if( pPage->nCell>0 ){
- pPage->apCell[pPage->nCell-1]->h.iNext = 0;
- }
- pFBlk = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[pc];
- pFBlk->iSize = SWAB16(pBt, STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE - pc);
- pFBlk->iNext = 0;
- pPage->u.hdr.firstFree = SWAB16(pBt, pc);
- memset(&pFBlk[1], 0, STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE - pc - sizeof(FreeBlk));
-}
-
-/*
-** Allocate nByte bytes of space on a page. nByte must be a
-** multiple of 4.
-**
-** Return the index into pPage->u.aDisk[] of the first byte of
-** the new allocation. Or return 0 if there is not enough free
-** space on the page to satisfy the allocation request.
-**
-** If the page contains nBytes of free space but does not contain
-** nBytes of contiguous free space, then this routine automatically
-** calls defragementPage() to consolidate all free space before
-** allocating the new chunk.
-*/
-static int allocateSpace(Btree *pBt, MemPage *pPage, int nByte){
- FreeBlk *p;
- u16 *pIdx;
- int start;
- int iSize;
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- int cnt = 0;
-#endif
-
- assert( sqlitepager_iswriteable(pPage) );
- assert( nByte==ROUNDUP(nByte) );
- assert( pPage->isInit );
- if( pPage->nFree<nByte || pPage->isOverfull ) return 0;
- pIdx = &pPage->u.hdr.firstFree;
- p = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[SWAB16(pBt, *pIdx)];
- while( (iSize = SWAB16(pBt, p->iSize))<nByte ){
- assert( cnt++ < STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE/4 );
- if( p->iNext==0 ){
- defragmentPage(pBt, pPage);
- pIdx = &pPage->u.hdr.firstFree;
- }else{
- pIdx = &p->iNext;
- }
- p = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[SWAB16(pBt, *pIdx)];
- }
- if( iSize==nByte ){
- start = SWAB16(pBt, *pIdx);
- *pIdx = p->iNext;
- }else{
- FreeBlk *pNew;
- start = SWAB16(pBt, *pIdx);
- pNew = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[start + nByte];
- pNew->iNext = p->iNext;
- pNew->iSize = SWAB16(pBt, iSize - nByte);
- *pIdx = SWAB16(pBt, start + nByte);
- }
- pPage->nFree -= nByte;
- return start;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return a section of the MemPage.u.aDisk[] to the freelist.
-** The first byte of the new free block is pPage->u.aDisk[start]
-** and the size of the block is "size" bytes. Size must be
-** a multiple of 4.
-**
-** Most of the effort here is involved in coalesing adjacent
-** free blocks into a single big free block.
-*/
-static void freeSpace(Btree *pBt, MemPage *pPage, int start, int size){
- int end = start + size;
- u16 *pIdx, idx;
- FreeBlk *pFBlk;
- FreeBlk *pNew;
- FreeBlk *pNext;
- int iSize;
-
- assert( sqlitepager_iswriteable(pPage) );
- assert( size == ROUNDUP(size) );
- assert( start == ROUNDUP(start) );
- assert( pPage->isInit );
- pIdx = &pPage->u.hdr.firstFree;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, *pIdx);
- while( idx!=0 && idx<start ){
- pFBlk = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx];
- iSize = SWAB16(pBt, pFBlk->iSize);
- if( idx + iSize == start ){
- pFBlk->iSize = SWAB16(pBt, iSize + size);
- if( idx + iSize + size == SWAB16(pBt, pFBlk->iNext) ){
- pNext = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx + iSize + size];
- if( pBt->needSwab ){
- pFBlk->iSize = swab16((u16)swab16(pNext->iSize)+iSize+size);
- }else{
- pFBlk->iSize += pNext->iSize;
- }
- pFBlk->iNext = pNext->iNext;
- }
- pPage->nFree += size;
- return;
- }
- pIdx = &pFBlk->iNext;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, *pIdx);
- }
- pNew = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[start];
- if( idx != end ){
- pNew->iSize = SWAB16(pBt, size);
- pNew->iNext = SWAB16(pBt, idx);
- }else{
- pNext = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx];
- pNew->iSize = SWAB16(pBt, size + SWAB16(pBt, pNext->iSize));
- pNew->iNext = pNext->iNext;
- }
- *pIdx = SWAB16(pBt, start);
- pPage->nFree += size;
-}
-
-/*
-** Initialize the auxiliary information for a disk block.
-**
-** The pParent parameter must be a pointer to the MemPage which
-** is the parent of the page being initialized. The root of the
-** BTree (usually page 2) has no parent and so for that page,
-** pParent==NULL.
-**
-** Return STQLITE_OK on success. If we see that the page does
-** not contain a well-formed database page, then return
-** STQLITE_CORRUPT. Note that a return of STQLITE_OK does not
-** guarantee that the page is well-formed. It only shows that
-** we failed to detect any corruption.
-*/
-static int initPage(Bt *pBt, MemPage *pPage, Pgno pgnoThis, MemPage *pParent){
- int idx; /* An index into pPage->u.aDisk[] */
- Cell *pCell; /* A pointer to a Cell in pPage->u.aDisk[] */
- FreeBlk *pFBlk; /* A pointer to a free block in pPage->u.aDisk[] */
- int sz; /* The size of a Cell in bytes */
- int freeSpace; /* Amount of free space on the page */
-
- if( pPage->pParent ){
- assert( pPage->pParent==pParent );
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- if( pParent ){
- pPage->pParent = pParent;
- sqlitepager_ref(pParent);
- }
- if( pPage->isInit ) return STQLITE_OK;
- pPage->isInit = 1;
- pPage->nCell = 0;
- freeSpace = USABLE_SPACE;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.firstCell);
- while( idx!=0 ){
- if( idx>STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE-MIN_CELL_SIZE ) goto page_format_error;
- if( idx<sizeof(PageHdr) ) goto page_format_error;
- if( idx!=ROUNDUP(idx) ) goto page_format_error;
- pCell = (Cell*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx];
- sz = cellSize(pBt, pCell);
- if( idx+sz > STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE ) goto page_format_error;
- freeSpace -= sz;
- pPage->apCell[pPage->nCell++] = pCell;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pCell->h.iNext);
- }
- pPage->nFree = 0;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.firstFree);
- while( idx!=0 ){
- int iNext;
- if( idx>STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE-sizeof(FreeBlk) ) goto page_format_error;
- if( idx<sizeof(PageHdr) ) goto page_format_error;
- pFBlk = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx];
- pPage->nFree += SWAB16(pBt, pFBlk->iSize);
- iNext = SWAB16(pBt, pFBlk->iNext);
- if( iNext>0 && iNext <= idx ) goto page_format_error;
- idx = iNext;
- }
- if( pPage->nCell==0 && pPage->nFree==0 ){
- /* As a special case, an uninitialized root page appears to be
- ** an empty database */
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- if( pPage->nFree!=freeSpace ) goto page_format_error;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-
-page_format_error:
- return STQLITE_CORRUPT;
-}
-
-/*
-** Set up a raw page so that it looks like a database page holding
-** no entries.
-*/
-static void zeroPage(Btree *pBt, MemPage *pPage){
- PageHdr *pHdr;
- FreeBlk *pFBlk;
- assert( sqlitepager_iswriteable(pPage) );
- memset(pPage, 0, STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE);
- pHdr = &pPage->u.hdr;
- pHdr->firstCell = 0;
- pHdr->firstFree = SWAB16(pBt, sizeof(*pHdr));
- pFBlk = (FreeBlk*)&pHdr[1];
- pFBlk->iNext = 0;
- pPage->nFree = STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE - sizeof(*pHdr);
- pFBlk->iSize = SWAB16(pBt, pPage->nFree);
- pPage->nCell = 0;
- pPage->isOverfull = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called when the reference count for a page
-** reaches zero. We need to unref the pParent pointer when that
-** happens.
-*/
-static void pageDestructor(void *pData){
- MemPage *pPage = (MemPage*)pData;
- if( pPage->pParent ){
- MemPage *pParent = pPage->pParent;
- pPage->pParent = 0;
- sqlitepager_unref(pParent);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Open a new database.
-**
-** Actually, this routine just sets up the internal data structures
-** for accessing the database. We do not open the database file
-** until the first page is loaded.
-**
-** zFilename is the name of the database file. If zFilename is NULL
-** a new database with a random name is created. This randomly named
-** database file will be deleted when sqliteBtreeClose() is called.
-*/
-int sqliteBtreeOpen(
- const char *zFilename, /* Name of the file containing the BTree database */
- int omitJournal, /* if TRUE then do not journal this file */
- int nCache, /* How many pages in the page cache */
- Btree **ppBtree /* Pointer to new Btree object written here */
-){
- Btree *pBt;
- int rc;
-
- /*
- ** The following asserts make sure that structures used by the btree are
- ** the right size. This is to guard against size changes that result
- ** when compiling on a different architecture.
- */
- assert( sizeof(u32)==4 );
- assert( sizeof(u16)==2 );
- assert( sizeof(Pgno)==4 );
- assert( sizeof(PageHdr)==8 );
- assert( sizeof(CellHdr)==12 );
- assert( sizeof(FreeBlk)==4 );
- assert( sizeof(OverflowPage)==STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE );
- assert( sizeof(FreelistInfo)==OVERFLOW_SIZE );
- assert( sizeof(ptr)==sizeof(char*) );
- assert( sizeof(uptr)==sizeof(ptr) );
-
- pBt = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(*pBt) );
- if( pBt==0 ){
- *ppBtree = 0;
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- if( nCache<10 ) nCache = 10;
- rc = sqlitepager_open(&pBt->pPager, zFilename, nCache, EXTRA_SIZE,
- !omitJournal);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- if( pBt->pPager ) sqlitepager_close(pBt->pPager);
- sqliteFree(pBt);
- *ppBtree = 0;
- return rc;
- }
- sqlitepager_set_destructor(pBt->pPager, pageDestructor);
- pBt->pCursor = 0;
- pBt->page1 = 0;
- pBt->readOnly = sqlitepager_isreadonly(pBt->pPager);
- pBt->pOps = &sqliteBtreeOps;
- *ppBtree = pBt;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Close an open database and tqinvalidate all cursors.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeClose(Btree *pBt){
- while( pBt->pCursor ){
- fileBtreeCloseCursor(pBt->pCursor);
- }
- sqlitepager_close(pBt->pPager);
- sqliteFree(pBt);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the limit on the number of pages allowed in the cache.
-**
-** The maximum number of cache pages is set to the absolute
-** value of mxPage. If mxPage is negative, the pager will
-** operate asynchronously - it will not stop to do fsync()s
-** to insure data is written to the disk surface before
-** continuing. Transactions still work if synchronous is off,
-** and the database cannot be corrupted if this program
-** crashes. But if the operating system crashes or there is
-** an abrupt power failure when synchronous is off, the database
-** could be left in an inconsistent and unrecoverable state.
-** Synchronous is on by default so database corruption is not
-** normally a worry.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeSetCacheSize(Btree *pBt, int mxPage){
- sqlitepager_set_cachesize(pBt->pPager, mxPage);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the way data is synced to disk in order to increase or decrease
-** how well the database resists damage due to OS crashes and power
-** failures. Level 1 is the same as asynchronous (no syncs() occur and
-** there is a high probability of damage) Level 2 is the default. There
-** is a very low but non-zero probability of damage. Level 3 reduces the
-** probability of damage to near zero but with a write performance reduction.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeSetSafetyLevel(Btree *pBt, int level){
- sqlitepager_set_safety_level(pBt->pPager, level);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Get a reference to page1 of the database file. This will
-** also acquire a readlock on that file.
-**
-** STQLITE_OK is returned on success. If the file is not a
-** well-formed database file, then STQLITE_CORRUPT is returned.
-** STQLITE_BUSY is returned if the database is locked. STQLITE_NOMEM
-** is returned if we run out of memory. STQLITE_PROTOCOL is returned
-** if there is a locking protocol violation.
-*/
-static int lockBtree(Btree *pBt){
- int rc;
- if( pBt->page1 ) return STQLITE_OK;
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, 1, (void**)&pBt->page1);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ) return rc;
-
- /* Do some checking to help insure the file we opened really is
- ** a valid database file.
- */
- if( sqlitepager_pagecount(pBt->pPager)>0 ){
- PageOne *pP1 = pBt->page1;
- if( strcmp(pP1->zMagic,zMagicHeader)!=0 ||
- (pP1->iMagic!=MAGIC && swab32(pP1->iMagic)!=MAGIC) ){
- rc = STQLITE_NOTADB;
- goto page1_init_failed;
- }
- pBt->needSwab = pP1->iMagic!=MAGIC;
- }
- return rc;
-
-page1_init_failed:
- sqlitepager_unref(pBt->page1);
- pBt->page1 = 0;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** If there are no outstanding cursors and we are not in the middle
-** of a transaction but there is a read lock on the database, then
-** this routine unrefs the first page of the database file which
-** has the effect of releasing the read lock.
-**
-** If there are any outstanding cursors, this routine is a no-op.
-**
-** If there is a transaction in progress, this routine is a no-op.
-*/
-static void unlockBtreeIfUnused(Btree *pBt){
- if( pBt->inTrans==0 && pBt->pCursor==0 && pBt->page1!=0 ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pBt->page1);
- pBt->page1 = 0;
- pBt->inTrans = 0;
- pBt->inCkpt = 0;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Create a new database by initializing the first two pages of the
-** file.
-*/
-static int newDatabase(Btree *pBt){
- MemPage *pRoot;
- PageOne *pP1;
- int rc;
- if( sqlitepager_pagecount(pBt->pPager)>1 ) return STQLITE_OK;
- pP1 = pBt->page1;
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pBt->page1);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, 2, (void**)&pRoot);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pRoot);
- if( rc ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pRoot);
- return rc;
- }
- strcpy(pP1->zMagic, zMagicHeader);
- if( btree_native_byte_order ){
- pP1->iMagic = MAGIC;
- pBt->needSwab = 0;
- }else{
- pP1->iMagic = swab32(MAGIC);
- pBt->needSwab = 1;
- }
- zeroPage(pBt, pRoot);
- sqlitepager_unref(pRoot);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Attempt to start a new transaction.
-**
-** A transaction must be started before attempting any changes
-** to the database. None of the following routines will work
-** unless a transaction is started first:
-**
-** sqliteBtreeCreateTable()
-** sqliteBtreeCreateIndex()
-** sqliteBtreeClearTable()
-** sqliteBtreeDropTable()
-** sqliteBtreeInsert()
-** sqliteBtreeDelete()
-** sqliteBtreeUpdateMeta()
-*/
-static int fileBtreeBeginTrans(Btree *pBt){
- int rc;
- if( pBt->inTrans ) return STQLITE_ERROR;
- if( pBt->readOnly ) return STQLITE_READONLY;
- if( pBt->page1==0 ){
- rc = lockBtree(pBt);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- return rc;
- }
- }
- rc = sqlitepager_begin(pBt->page1);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = newDatabase(pBt);
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- pBt->inTrans = 1;
- pBt->inCkpt = 0;
- }else{
- unlockBtreeIfUnused(pBt);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Commit the transaction currently in progress.
-**
-** This will release the write lock on the database file. If there
-** are no active cursors, it also releases the read lock.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeCommit(Btree *pBt){
- int rc;
- rc = pBt->readOnly ? STQLITE_OK : sqlitepager_commit(pBt->pPager);
- pBt->inTrans = 0;
- pBt->inCkpt = 0;
- unlockBtreeIfUnused(pBt);
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Rollback the transaction in progress. All cursors will be
-** invalided by this operation. Any attempt to use a cursor
-** that was open at the beginning of this operation will result
-** in an error.
-**
-** This will release the write lock on the database file. If there
-** are no active cursors, it also releases the read lock.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeRollback(Btree *pBt){
- int rc;
- BtCursor *pCur;
- if( pBt->inTrans==0 ) return STQLITE_OK;
- pBt->inTrans = 0;
- pBt->inCkpt = 0;
- rc = pBt->readOnly ? STQLITE_OK : sqlitepager_rollback(pBt->pPager);
- for(pCur=pBt->pCursor; pCur; pCur=pCur->pNext){
- if( pCur->pPage && pCur->pPage->isInit==0 ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pCur->pPage);
- pCur->pPage = 0;
- }
- }
- unlockBtreeIfUnused(pBt);
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Set the checkpoint for the current transaction. The checkpoint serves
-** as a sub-transaction that can be rolled back independently of the
-** main transaction. You must start a transaction before starting a
-** checkpoint. The checkpoint is ended automatically if the transaction
-** commits or rolls back.
-**
-** Only one checkpoint may be active at a time. It is an error to try
-** to start a new checkpoint if another checkpoint is already active.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeBeginCkpt(Btree *pBt){
- int rc;
- if( !pBt->inTrans || pBt->inCkpt ){
- return pBt->readOnly ? STQLITE_READONLY : STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- rc = pBt->readOnly ? STQLITE_OK : sqlitepager_ckpt_begin(pBt->pPager);
- pBt->inCkpt = 1;
- return rc;
-}
-
-
-/*
-** Commit a checkpoint to transaction currently in progress. If no
-** checkpoint is active, this is a no-op.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeCommitCkpt(Btree *pBt){
- int rc;
- if( pBt->inCkpt && !pBt->readOnly ){
- rc = sqlitepager_ckpt_commit(pBt->pPager);
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }
- pBt->inCkpt = 0;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Rollback the checkpoint to the current transaction. If there
-** is no active checkpoint or transaction, this routine is a no-op.
-**
-** All cursors will be invalided by this operation. Any attempt
-** to use a cursor that was open at the beginning of this operation
-** will result in an error.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeRollbackCkpt(Btree *pBt){
- int rc;
- BtCursor *pCur;
- if( pBt->inCkpt==0 || pBt->readOnly ) return STQLITE_OK;
- rc = sqlitepager_ckpt_rollback(pBt->pPager);
- for(pCur=pBt->pCursor; pCur; pCur=pCur->pNext){
- if( pCur->pPage && pCur->pPage->isInit==0 ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pCur->pPage);
- pCur->pPage = 0;
- }
- }
- pBt->inCkpt = 0;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Create a new cursor for the BTree whose root is on the page
-** iTable. The act of acquiring a cursor gets a read lock on
-** the database file.
-**
-** If wrFlag==0, then the cursor can only be used for reading.
-** If wrFlag==1, then the cursor can be used for reading or for
-** writing if other conditions for writing are also met. These
-** are the conditions that must be met in order for writing to
-** be allowed:
-**
-** 1: The cursor must have been opened with wrFlag==1
-**
-** 2: No other cursors may be open with wrFlag==0 on the same table
-**
-** 3: The database must be writable (not on read-only media)
-**
-** 4: There must be an active transaction.
-**
-** Condition 2 warrants further discussion. If any cursor is opened
-** on a table with wrFlag==0, that prevents all other cursors from
-** writing to that table. This is a kind of "read-lock". When a cursor
-** is opened with wrFlag==0 it is guaranteed that the table will not
-** change as long as the cursor is open. This allows the cursor to
-** do a sequential scan of the table without having to worry about
-** entries being inserted or deleted during the scan. Cursors should
-** be opened with wrFlag==0 only if this read-lock property is needed.
-** That is to say, cursors should be opened with wrFlag==0 only if they
-** intend to use the sqliteBtreeNext() system call. All other cursors
-** should be opened with wrFlag==1 even if they never really intend
-** to write.
-**
-** No checking is done to make sure that page iTable really is the
-** root page of a b-tree. If it is not, then the cursor acquired
-** will not work correctly.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeCursor(Btree *pBt, int iTable, int wrFlag, BtCursor **ppCur){
- int rc;
- BtCursor *pCur, *pRing;
-
- if( pBt->page1==0 ){
- rc = lockBtree(pBt);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- *ppCur = 0;
- return rc;
- }
- }
- pCur = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(*pCur) );
- if( pCur==0 ){
- rc = STQLITE_NOMEM;
- goto create_cursor_exception;
- }
- pCur->pgnoRoot = (Pgno)iTable;
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, pCur->pgnoRoot, (void**)&pCur->pPage);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- goto create_cursor_exception;
- }
- rc = initPage(pBt, pCur->pPage, pCur->pgnoRoot, 0);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- goto create_cursor_exception;
- }
- pCur->pOps = &sqliteBtreeCursorOps;
- pCur->pBt = pBt;
- pCur->wrFlag = wrFlag;
- pCur->idx = 0;
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_INVALID;
- pCur->pNext = pBt->pCursor;
- if( pCur->pNext ){
- pCur->pNext->pPrev = pCur;
- }
- pCur->pPrev = 0;
- pRing = pBt->pCursor;
- while( pRing && pRing->pgnoRoot!=pCur->pgnoRoot ){ pRing = pRing->pNext; }
- if( pRing ){
- pCur->pShared = pRing->pShared;
- pRing->pShared = pCur;
- }else{
- pCur->pShared = pCur;
- }
- pBt->pCursor = pCur;
- *ppCur = pCur;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-
-create_cursor_exception:
- *ppCur = 0;
- if( pCur ){
- if( pCur->pPage ) sqlitepager_unref(pCur->pPage);
- sqliteFree(pCur);
- }
- unlockBtreeIfUnused(pBt);
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Close a cursor. The read lock on the database file is released
-** when the last cursor is closed.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeCloseCursor(BtCursor *pCur){
- Btree *pBt = pCur->pBt;
- if( pCur->pPrev ){
- pCur->pPrev->pNext = pCur->pNext;
- }else{
- pBt->pCursor = pCur->pNext;
- }
- if( pCur->pNext ){
- pCur->pNext->pPrev = pCur->pPrev;
- }
- if( pCur->pPage ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pCur->pPage);
- }
- if( pCur->pShared!=pCur ){
- BtCursor *pRing = pCur->pShared;
- while( pRing->pShared!=pCur ){ pRing = pRing->pShared; }
- pRing->pShared = pCur->pShared;
- }
- unlockBtreeIfUnused(pBt);
- sqliteFree(pCur);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Make a temporary cursor by filling in the fields of pTempCur.
-** The temporary cursor is not on the cursor list for the Btree.
-*/
-static void getTempCursor(BtCursor *pCur, BtCursor *pTempCur){
- memcpy(pTempCur, pCur, sizeof(*pCur));
- pTempCur->pNext = 0;
- pTempCur->pPrev = 0;
- if( pTempCur->pPage ){
- sqlitepager_ref(pTempCur->pPage);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Delete a temporary cursor such as was made by the CreateTemporaryCursor()
-** function above.
-*/
-static void releaseTempCursor(BtCursor *pCur){
- if( pCur->pPage ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pCur->pPage);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Set *pSize to the number of bytes of key in the entry the
-** cursor currently points to. Always return STQLITE_OK.
-** Failure is not possible. If the cursor is not currently
-** pointing to an entry (which can happen, for example, if
-** the database is empty) then *pSize is set to 0.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeKeySize(BtCursor *pCur, int *pSize){
- Cell *pCell;
- MemPage *pPage;
-
- pPage = pCur->pPage;
- assert( pPage!=0 );
- if( pCur->idx >= pPage->nCell ){
- *pSize = 0;
- }else{
- pCell = pPage->apCell[pCur->idx];
- *pSize = NKEY(pCur->pBt, pCell->h);
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Read payload information from the entry that the pCur cursor is
-** pointing to. Begin reading the payload at "offset" and read
-** a total of "amt" bytes. Put the result in zBuf.
-**
-** This routine does not make a distinction between key and data.
-** It just reads bytes from the payload area.
-*/
-static int getPayload(BtCursor *pCur, int offset, int amt, char *zBuf){
- char *aPayload;
- Pgno nextPage;
- int rc;
- Btree *pBt = pCur->pBt;
- assert( pCur!=0 && pCur->pPage!=0 );
- assert( pCur->idx>=0 && pCur->idx<pCur->pPage->nCell );
- aPayload = pCur->pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]->aPayload;
- if( offset<MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD ){
- int a = amt;
- if( a+offset>MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD ){
- a = MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD - offset;
- }
- memcpy(zBuf, &aPayload[offset], a);
- if( a==amt ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- offset = 0;
- zBuf += a;
- amt -= a;
- }else{
- offset -= MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD;
- }
- if( amt>0 ){
- nextPage = SWAB32(pBt, pCur->pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]->ovfl);
- }
- while( amt>0 && nextPage ){
- OverflowPage *pOvfl;
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, nextPage, (void**)&pOvfl);
- if( rc!=0 ){
- return rc;
- }
- nextPage = SWAB32(pBt, pOvfl->iNext);
- if( offset<OVERFLOW_SIZE ){
- int a = amt;
- if( a + offset > OVERFLOW_SIZE ){
- a = OVERFLOW_SIZE - offset;
- }
- memcpy(zBuf, &pOvfl->aPayload[offset], a);
- offset = 0;
- amt -= a;
- zBuf += a;
- }else{
- offset -= OVERFLOW_SIZE;
- }
- sqlitepager_unref(pOvfl);
- }
- if( amt>0 ){
- return STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Read part of the key associated with cursor pCur. A maximum
-** of "amt" bytes will be transfered into zBuf[]. The transfer
-** begins at "offset". The number of bytes actually read is
-** returned.
-**
-** Change: It used to be that the amount returned will be smaller
-** than the amount requested if there are not enough bytes in the key
-** to satisfy the request. But now, it must be the case that there
-** is enough data available to satisfy the request. If not, an exception
-** is raised. The change was made in an effort to boost performance
-** by eliminating unneeded tests.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeKey(BtCursor *pCur, int offset, int amt, char *zBuf){
- MemPage *pPage;
-
- assert( amt>=0 );
- assert( offset>=0 );
- assert( pCur->pPage!=0 );
- pPage = pCur->pPage;
- if( pCur->idx >= pPage->nCell ){
- return 0;
- }
- assert( amt+offset <= NKEY(pCur->pBt, pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]->h) );
- getPayload(pCur, offset, amt, zBuf);
- return amt;
-}
-
-/*
-** Set *pSize to the number of bytes of data in the entry the
-** cursor currently points to. Always return STQLITE_OK.
-** Failure is not possible. If the cursor is not currently
-** pointing to an entry (which can happen, for example, if
-** the database is empty) then *pSize is set to 0.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeDataSize(BtCursor *pCur, int *pSize){
- Cell *pCell;
- MemPage *pPage;
-
- pPage = pCur->pPage;
- assert( pPage!=0 );
- if( pCur->idx >= pPage->nCell ){
- *pSize = 0;
- }else{
- pCell = pPage->apCell[pCur->idx];
- *pSize = NDATA(pCur->pBt, pCell->h);
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Read part of the data associated with cursor pCur. A maximum
-** of "amt" bytes will be transfered into zBuf[]. The transfer
-** begins at "offset". The number of bytes actually read is
-** returned. The amount returned will be smaller than the
-** amount requested if there are not enough bytes in the data
-** to satisfy the request.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeData(BtCursor *pCur, int offset, int amt, char *zBuf){
- Cell *pCell;
- MemPage *pPage;
-
- assert( amt>=0 );
- assert( offset>=0 );
- assert( pCur->pPage!=0 );
- pPage = pCur->pPage;
- if( pCur->idx >= pPage->nCell ){
- return 0;
- }
- pCell = pPage->apCell[pCur->idx];
- assert( amt+offset <= NDATA(pCur->pBt, pCell->h) );
- getPayload(pCur, offset + NKEY(pCur->pBt, pCell->h), amt, zBuf);
- return amt;
-}
-
-/*
-** Compare an external key against the key on the entry that pCur points to.
-**
-** The external key is pKey and is nKey bytes long. The last nIgnore bytes
-** of the key associated with pCur are ignored, as if they do not exist.
-** (The normal case is for nIgnore to be zero in which case the entire
-** internal key is used in the comparison.)
-**
-** The comparison result is written to *pRes as follows:
-**
-** *pRes<0 This means pCur<pKey
-**
-** *pRes==0 This means pCur==pKey for all nKey bytes
-**
-** *pRes>0 This means pCur>pKey
-**
-** When one key is an exact prefix of the other, the shorter key is
-** considered less than the longer one. In order to be equal the
-** keys must be exactly the same length. (The length of the pCur key
-** is the actual key length minus nIgnore bytes.)
-*/
-static int fileBtreeKeyCompare(
- BtCursor *pCur, /* Pointer to entry to compare against */
- const void *pKey, /* Key to compare against entry that pCur points to */
- int nKey, /* Number of bytes in pKey */
- int nIgnore, /* Ignore this many bytes at the end of pCur */
- int *pResult /* Write the result here */
-){
- Pgno nextPage;
- int n, c, rc, nLocal;
- Cell *pCell;
- Btree *pBt = pCur->pBt;
- const char *zKey = (const char*)pKey;
-
- assert( pCur->pPage );
- assert( pCur->idx>=0 && pCur->idx<pCur->pPage->nCell );
- pCell = pCur->pPage->apCell[pCur->idx];
- nLocal = NKEY(pBt, pCell->h) - nIgnore;
- if( nLocal<0 ) nLocal = 0;
- n = nKey<nLocal ? nKey : nLocal;
- if( n>MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD ){
- n = MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD;
- }
- c = memcmp(pCell->aPayload, zKey, n);
- if( c!=0 ){
- *pResult = c;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- zKey += n;
- nKey -= n;
- nLocal -= n;
- nextPage = SWAB32(pBt, pCell->ovfl);
- while( nKey>0 && nLocal>0 ){
- OverflowPage *pOvfl;
- if( nextPage==0 ){
- return STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- }
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, nextPage, (void**)&pOvfl);
- if( rc ){
- return rc;
- }
- nextPage = SWAB32(pBt, pOvfl->iNext);
- n = nKey<nLocal ? nKey : nLocal;
- if( n>OVERFLOW_SIZE ){
- n = OVERFLOW_SIZE;
- }
- c = memcmp(pOvfl->aPayload, zKey, n);
- sqlitepager_unref(pOvfl);
- if( c!=0 ){
- *pResult = c;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- nKey -= n;
- nLocal -= n;
- zKey += n;
- }
- if( c==0 ){
- c = nLocal - nKey;
- }
- *pResult = c;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Move the cursor down to a new child page. The newPgno argument is the
-** page number of the child page in the byte order of the disk image.
-*/
-static int moveToChild(BtCursor *pCur, int newPgno){
- int rc;
- MemPage *pNewPage;
- Btree *pBt = pCur->pBt;
-
- newPgno = SWAB32(pBt, newPgno);
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, newPgno, (void**)&pNewPage);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = initPage(pBt, pNewPage, newPgno, pCur->pPage);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- assert( pCur->idx>=pCur->pPage->nCell
- || pCur->pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]->h.leftChild==SWAB32(pBt,newPgno) );
- assert( pCur->idx<pCur->pPage->nCell
- || pCur->pPage->u.hdr.rightChild==SWAB32(pBt,newPgno) );
- pNewPage->idxParent = pCur->idx;
- pCur->pPage->idxShift = 0;
- sqlitepager_unref(pCur->pPage);
- pCur->pPage = pNewPage;
- pCur->idx = 0;
- if( pNewPage->nCell<1 ){
- return STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Move the cursor up to the parent page.
-**
-** pCur->idx is set to the cell index that contains the pointer
-** to the page we are coming from. If we are coming from the
-** right-most child page then pCur->idx is set to one more than
-** the largest cell index.
-*/
-static void moveToParent(BtCursor *pCur){
- Pgno oldPgno;
- MemPage *pParent;
- MemPage *pPage;
- int idxParent;
- pPage = pCur->pPage;
- assert( pPage!=0 );
- pParent = pPage->pParent;
- assert( pParent!=0 );
- idxParent = pPage->idxParent;
- sqlitepager_ref(pParent);
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- pCur->pPage = pParent;
- assert( pParent->idxShift==0 );
- if( pParent->idxShift==0 ){
- pCur->idx = idxParent;
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- /* Verify that pCur->idx is the correct index to point back to the child
- ** page we just came from
- */
- oldPgno = SWAB32(pCur->pBt, sqlitepager_pagenumber(pPage));
- if( pCur->idx<pParent->nCell ){
- assert( pParent->apCell[idxParent]->h.leftChild==oldPgno );
- }else{
- assert( pParent->u.hdr.rightChild==oldPgno );
- }
-#endif
- }else{
- /* The MemPage.idxShift flag indicates that cell indices might have
- ** changed since idxParent was set and hence idxParent might be out
- ** of date. So recompute the parent cell index by scanning all cells
- ** and locating the one that points to the child we just came from.
- */
- int i;
- pCur->idx = pParent->nCell;
- oldPgno = SWAB32(pCur->pBt, sqlitepager_pagenumber(pPage));
- for(i=0; i<pParent->nCell; i++){
- if( pParent->apCell[i]->h.leftChild==oldPgno ){
- pCur->idx = i;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Move the cursor to the root page
-*/
-static int moveToRoot(BtCursor *pCur){
- MemPage *pNew;
- int rc;
- Btree *pBt = pCur->pBt;
-
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, pCur->pgnoRoot, (void**)&pNew);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = initPage(pBt, pNew, pCur->pgnoRoot, 0);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- sqlitepager_unref(pCur->pPage);
- pCur->pPage = pNew;
- pCur->idx = 0;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Move the cursor down to the left-most leaf entry beneath the
-** entry to which it is currently pointing.
-*/
-static int moveToLeftmost(BtCursor *pCur){
- Pgno pgno;
- int rc;
-
- while( (pgno = pCur->pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]->h.leftChild)!=0 ){
- rc = moveToChild(pCur, pgno);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Move the cursor down to the right-most leaf entry beneath the
-** page to which it is currently pointing. Notice the difference
-** between moveToLeftmost() and moveToRightmost(). moveToLeftmost()
-** finds the left-most entry beneath the *entry* whereas moveToRightmost()
-** finds the right-most entry beneath the *page*.
-*/
-static int moveToRightmost(BtCursor *pCur){
- Pgno pgno;
- int rc;
-
- while( (pgno = pCur->pPage->u.hdr.rightChild)!=0 ){
- pCur->idx = pCur->pPage->nCell;
- rc = moveToChild(pCur, pgno);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- }
- pCur->idx = pCur->pPage->nCell - 1;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/* Move the cursor to the first entry in the table. Return STQLITE_OK
-** on success. Set *pRes to 0 if the cursor actually points to something
-** or set *pRes to 1 if the table is empty.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeFirst(BtCursor *pCur, int *pRes){
- int rc;
- if( pCur->pPage==0 ) return STQLITE_ABORT;
- rc = moveToRoot(pCur);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- if( pCur->pPage->nCell==0 ){
- *pRes = 1;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- *pRes = 0;
- rc = moveToLeftmost(pCur);
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/* Move the cursor to the last entry in the table. Return STQLITE_OK
-** on success. Set *pRes to 0 if the cursor actually points to something
-** or set *pRes to 1 if the table is empty.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeLast(BtCursor *pCur, int *pRes){
- int rc;
- if( pCur->pPage==0 ) return STQLITE_ABORT;
- rc = moveToRoot(pCur);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- assert( pCur->pPage->isInit );
- if( pCur->pPage->nCell==0 ){
- *pRes = 1;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- *pRes = 0;
- rc = moveToRightmost(pCur);
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/* Move the cursor so that it points to an entry near pKey.
-** Return a success code.
-**
-** If an exact match is not found, then the cursor is always
-** left pointing at a leaf page which would hold the entry if it
-** were present. The cursor might point to an entry that comes
-** before or after the key.
-**
-** The result of comparing the key with the entry to which the
-** cursor is left pointing is stored in pCur->iMatch. The same
-** value is also written to *pRes if pRes!=NULL. The meaning of
-** this value is as follows:
-**
-** *pRes<0 The cursor is left pointing at an entry that
-** is smaller than pKey or if the table is empty
-** and the cursor is therefore left point to nothing.
-**
-** *pRes==0 The cursor is left pointing at an entry that
-** exactly matches pKey.
-**
-** *pRes>0 The cursor is left pointing at an entry that
-** is larger than pKey.
-*/
-static
-int fileBtreeMoveto(BtCursor *pCur, const void *pKey, int nKey, int *pRes){
- int rc;
- if( pCur->pPage==0 ) return STQLITE_ABORT;
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- rc = moveToRoot(pCur);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- for(;;){
- int lwr, upr;
- Pgno chldPg;
- MemPage *pPage = pCur->pPage;
- int c = -1; /* pRes return if table is empty must be -1 */
- lwr = 0;
- upr = pPage->nCell-1;
- while( lwr<=upr ){
- pCur->idx = (lwr+upr)/2;
- rc = fileBtreeKeyCompare(pCur, pKey, nKey, 0, &c);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- if( c==0 ){
- pCur->iMatch = c;
- if( pRes ) *pRes = 0;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- if( c<0 ){
- lwr = pCur->idx+1;
- }else{
- upr = pCur->idx-1;
- }
- }
- assert( lwr==upr+1 );
- assert( pPage->isInit );
- if( lwr>=pPage->nCell ){
- chldPg = pPage->u.hdr.rightChild;
- }else{
- chldPg = pPage->apCell[lwr]->h.leftChild;
- }
- if( chldPg==0 ){
- pCur->iMatch = c;
- if( pRes ) *pRes = c;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- pCur->idx = lwr;
- rc = moveToChild(pCur, chldPg);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- }
- /* NOT REACHED */
-}
-
-/*
-** Advance the cursor to the next entry in the database. If
-** successful then set *pRes=0. If the cursor
-** was already pointing to the last entry in the database before
-** this routine was called, then set *pRes=1.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeNext(BtCursor *pCur, int *pRes){
- int rc;
- MemPage *pPage = pCur->pPage;
- assert( pRes!=0 );
- if( pPage==0 ){
- *pRes = 1;
- return STQLITE_ABORT;
- }
- assert( pPage->isInit );
- assert( pCur->eSkip!=SKIP_INVALID );
- if( pPage->nCell==0 ){
- *pRes = 1;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- assert( pCur->idx<pPage->nCell );
- if( pCur->eSkip==SKIP_NEXT ){
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- *pRes = 0;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- pCur->idx++;
- if( pCur->idx>=pPage->nCell ){
- if( pPage->u.hdr.rightChild ){
- rc = moveToChild(pCur, pPage->u.hdr.rightChild);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = moveToLeftmost(pCur);
- *pRes = 0;
- return rc;
- }
- do{
- if( pPage->pParent==0 ){
- *pRes = 1;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- moveToParent(pCur);
- pPage = pCur->pPage;
- }while( pCur->idx>=pPage->nCell );
- *pRes = 0;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- *pRes = 0;
- if( pPage->u.hdr.rightChild==0 ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- rc = moveToLeftmost(pCur);
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Step the cursor to the back to the previous entry in the database. If
-** successful then set *pRes=0. If the cursor
-** was already pointing to the first entry in the database before
-** this routine was called, then set *pRes=1.
-*/
-static int fileBtreePrevious(BtCursor *pCur, int *pRes){
- int rc;
- Pgno pgno;
- MemPage *pPage;
- pPage = pCur->pPage;
- if( pPage==0 ){
- *pRes = 1;
- return STQLITE_ABORT;
- }
- assert( pPage->isInit );
- assert( pCur->eSkip!=SKIP_INVALID );
- if( pPage->nCell==0 ){
- *pRes = 1;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- if( pCur->eSkip==SKIP_PREV ){
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- *pRes = 0;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- assert( pCur->idx>=0 );
- if( (pgno = pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]->h.leftChild)!=0 ){
- rc = moveToChild(pCur, pgno);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = moveToRightmost(pCur);
- }else{
- while( pCur->idx==0 ){
- if( pPage->pParent==0 ){
- if( pRes ) *pRes = 1;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- moveToParent(pCur);
- pPage = pCur->pPage;
- }
- pCur->idx--;
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }
- *pRes = 0;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Allocate a new page from the database file.
-**
-** The new page is marked as dirty. (In other words, sqlitepager_write()
-** has already been called on the new page.) The new page has also
-** been referenced and the calling routine is responsible for calling
-** sqlitepager_unref() on the new page when it is done.
-**
-** STQLITE_OK is returned on success. Any other return value indicates
-** an error. *ppPage and *pPgno are undefined in the event of an error.
-** Do not invoke sqlitepager_unref() on *ppPage if an error is returned.
-**
-** If the "nearby" parameter is not 0, then a (feeble) effort is made to
-** locate a page close to the page number "nearby". This can be used in an
-** attempt to keep related pages close to each other in the database file,
-** which in turn can make database access faster.
-*/
-static int allocatePage(Btree *pBt, MemPage **ppPage, Pgno *pPgno, Pgno nearby){
- PageOne *pPage1 = pBt->page1;
- int rc;
- if( pPage1->freeList ){
- OverflowPage *pOvfl;
- FreelistInfo *pInfo;
-
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pPage1);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- SWAB_ADD(pBt, pPage1->nFree, -1);
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, SWAB32(pBt, pPage1->freeList),
- (void**)&pOvfl);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pOvfl);
- if( rc ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pOvfl);
- return rc;
- }
- pInfo = (FreelistInfo*)pOvfl->aPayload;
- if( pInfo->nFree==0 ){
- *pPgno = SWAB32(pBt, pPage1->freeList);
- pPage1->freeList = pOvfl->iNext;
- *ppPage = (MemPage*)pOvfl;
- }else{
- int closest, n;
- n = SWAB32(pBt, pInfo->nFree);
- if( n>1 && nearby>0 ){
- int i, dist;
- closest = 0;
- dist = SWAB32(pBt, pInfo->aFree[0]) - nearby;
- if( dist<0 ) dist = -dist;
- for(i=1; i<n; i++){
- int d2 = SWAB32(pBt, pInfo->aFree[i]) - nearby;
- if( d2<0 ) d2 = -d2;
- if( d2<dist ) closest = i;
- }
- }else{
- closest = 0;
- }
- SWAB_ADD(pBt, pInfo->nFree, -1);
- *pPgno = SWAB32(pBt, pInfo->aFree[closest]);
- pInfo->aFree[closest] = pInfo->aFree[n-1];
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, *pPgno, (void**)ppPage);
- sqlitepager_unref(pOvfl);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- sqlitepager_dont_rollback(*ppPage);
- rc = sqlitepager_write(*ppPage);
- }
- }
- }else{
- *pPgno = sqlitepager_pagecount(pBt->pPager) + 1;
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, *pPgno, (void**)ppPage);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = sqlitepager_write(*ppPage);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Add a page of the database file to the freelist. Either pgno or
-** pPage but not both may be 0.
-**
-** sqlitepager_unref() is NOT called for pPage.
-*/
-static int freePage(Btree *pBt, void *pPage, Pgno pgno){
- PageOne *pPage1 = pBt->page1;
- OverflowPage *pOvfl = (OverflowPage*)pPage;
- int rc;
- int needUnref = 0;
- MemPage *pMemPage;
-
- if( pgno==0 ){
- assert( pOvfl!=0 );
- pgno = sqlitepager_pagenumber(pOvfl);
- }
- assert( pgno>2 );
- assert( sqlitepager_pagenumber(pOvfl)==pgno );
- pMemPage = (MemPage*)pPage;
- pMemPage->isInit = 0;
- if( pMemPage->pParent ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pMemPage->pParent);
- pMemPage->pParent = 0;
- }
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pPage1);
- if( rc ){
- return rc;
- }
- SWAB_ADD(pBt, pPage1->nFree, 1);
- if( pPage1->nFree!=0 && pPage1->freeList!=0 ){
- OverflowPage *pFreeIdx;
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, SWAB32(pBt, pPage1->freeList),
- (void**)&pFreeIdx);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- FreelistInfo *pInfo = (FreelistInfo*)pFreeIdx->aPayload;
- int n = SWAB32(pBt, pInfo->nFree);
- if( n<(sizeof(pInfo->aFree)/sizeof(pInfo->aFree[0])) ){
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pFreeIdx);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- pInfo->aFree[n] = SWAB32(pBt, pgno);
- SWAB_ADD(pBt, pInfo->nFree, 1);
- sqlitepager_unref(pFreeIdx);
- sqlitepager_dont_write(pBt->pPager, pgno);
- return rc;
- }
- }
- sqlitepager_unref(pFreeIdx);
- }
- }
- if( pOvfl==0 ){
- assert( pgno>0 );
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, pgno, (void**)&pOvfl);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- needUnref = 1;
- }
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pOvfl);
- if( rc ){
- if( needUnref ) sqlitepager_unref(pOvfl);
- return rc;
- }
- pOvfl->iNext = pPage1->freeList;
- pPage1->freeList = SWAB32(pBt, pgno);
- memset(pOvfl->aPayload, 0, OVERFLOW_SIZE);
- if( needUnref ) rc = sqlitepager_unref(pOvfl);
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Erase all the data out of a cell. This involves returning overflow
-** pages back the freelist.
-*/
-static int clearCell(Btree *pBt, Cell *pCell){
- Pager *pPager = pBt->pPager;
- OverflowPage *pOvfl;
- Pgno ovfl, nextOvfl;
- int rc;
-
- if( NKEY(pBt, pCell->h) + NDATA(pBt, pCell->h) <= MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- ovfl = SWAB32(pBt, pCell->ovfl);
- pCell->ovfl = 0;
- while( ovfl ){
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pPager, ovfl, (void**)&pOvfl);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- nextOvfl = SWAB32(pBt, pOvfl->iNext);
- rc = freePage(pBt, pOvfl, ovfl);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- sqlitepager_unref(pOvfl);
- ovfl = nextOvfl;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Create a new cell from key and data. Overflow pages are allocated as
-** necessary and linked to this cell.
-*/
-static int fillInCell(
- Btree *pBt, /* The whole Btree. Needed to allocate pages */
- Cell *pCell, /* Populate this Cell structure */
- const void *pKey, int nKey, /* The key */
- const void *pData,int nData /* The data */
-){
- OverflowPage *pOvfl, *pPrior;
- Pgno *pNext;
- int spaceLeft;
- int n, rc;
- int nPayload;
- const char *pPayload;
- char *pSpace;
- Pgno nearby = 0;
-
- pCell->h.leftChild = 0;
- pCell->h.nKey = SWAB16(pBt, nKey & 0xffff);
- pCell->h.nKeyHi = nKey >> 16;
- pCell->h.nData = SWAB16(pBt, nData & 0xffff);
- pCell->h.nDataHi = nData >> 16;
- pCell->h.iNext = 0;
-
- pNext = &pCell->ovfl;
- pSpace = pCell->aPayload;
- spaceLeft = MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD;
- pPayload = pKey;
- pKey = 0;
- nPayload = nKey;
- pPrior = 0;
- while( nPayload>0 ){
- if( spaceLeft==0 ){
- rc = allocatePage(pBt, (MemPage**)&pOvfl, pNext, nearby);
- if( rc ){
- *pNext = 0;
- }else{
- nearby = *pNext;
- }
- if( pPrior ) sqlitepager_unref(pPrior);
- if( rc ){
- clearCell(pBt, pCell);
- return rc;
- }
- if( pBt->needSwab ) *pNext = swab32(*pNext);
- pPrior = pOvfl;
- spaceLeft = OVERFLOW_SIZE;
- pSpace = pOvfl->aPayload;
- pNext = &pOvfl->iNext;
- }
- n = nPayload;
- if( n>spaceLeft ) n = spaceLeft;
- memcpy(pSpace, pPayload, n);
- nPayload -= n;
- if( nPayload==0 && pData ){
- pPayload = pData;
- nPayload = nData;
- pData = 0;
- }else{
- pPayload += n;
- }
- spaceLeft -= n;
- pSpace += n;
- }
- *pNext = 0;
- if( pPrior ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pPrior);
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the MemPage.pParent pointer on the page whose number is
-** given in the second argument so that MemPage.pParent holds the
-** pointer in the third argument.
-*/
-static void reparentPage(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno, MemPage *pNewParent,int idx){
- MemPage *pThis;
-
- if( pgno==0 ) return;
- assert( pPager!=0 );
- pThis = sqlitepager_lookup(pPager, pgno);
- if( pThis && pThis->isInit ){
- if( pThis->pParent!=pNewParent ){
- if( pThis->pParent ) sqlitepager_unref(pThis->pParent);
- pThis->pParent = pNewParent;
- if( pNewParent ) sqlitepager_ref(pNewParent);
- }
- pThis->idxParent = idx;
- sqlitepager_unref(pThis);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Reparent all tqchildren of the given page to be the given page.
-** In other words, for every child of pPage, invoke reparentPage()
-** to make sure that each child knows that pPage is its parent.
-**
-** This routine gets called after you memcpy() one page into
-** another.
-*/
-static void reparentChildPages(Btree *pBt, MemPage *pPage){
- int i;
- Pager *pPager = pBt->pPager;
- for(i=0; i<pPage->nCell; i++){
- reparentPage(pPager, SWAB32(pBt, pPage->apCell[i]->h.leftChild), pPage, i);
- }
- reparentPage(pPager, SWAB32(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.rightChild), pPage, i);
- pPage->idxShift = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Remove the i-th cell from pPage. This routine effects pPage only.
-** The cell content is not freed or deallocated. It is assumed that
-** the cell content has been copied someplace else. This routine just
-** removes the reference to the cell from pPage.
-**
-** "sz" must be the number of bytes in the cell.
-**
-** Do not bother maintaining the integrity of the linked list of Cells.
-** Only the pPage->apCell[] array is important. The relinkCellList()
-** routine will be called soon after this routine in order to rebuild
-** the linked list.
-*/
-static void dropCell(Btree *pBt, MemPage *pPage, int idx, int sz){
- int j;
- assert( idx>=0 && idx<pPage->nCell );
- assert( sz==cellSize(pBt, pPage->apCell[idx]) );
- assert( sqlitepager_iswriteable(pPage) );
- freeSpace(pBt, pPage, Addr(pPage->apCell[idx]) - Addr(pPage), sz);
- for(j=idx; j<pPage->nCell-1; j++){
- pPage->apCell[j] = pPage->apCell[j+1];
- }
- pPage->nCell--;
- pPage->idxShift = 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Insert a new cell on pPage at cell index "i". pCell points to the
-** content of the cell.
-**
-** If the cell content will fit on the page, then put it there. If it
-** will not fit, then just make pPage->apCell[i] point to the content
-** and set pPage->isOverfull.
-**
-** Do not bother maintaining the integrity of the linked list of Cells.
-** Only the pPage->apCell[] array is important. The relinkCellList()
-** routine will be called soon after this routine in order to rebuild
-** the linked list.
-*/
-static void insertCell(Btree *pBt, MemPage *pPage, int i, Cell *pCell, int sz){
- int idx, j;
- assert( i>=0 && i<=pPage->nCell );
- assert( sz==cellSize(pBt, pCell) );
- assert( sqlitepager_iswriteable(pPage) );
- idx = allocateSpace(pBt, pPage, sz);
- for(j=pPage->nCell; j>i; j--){
- pPage->apCell[j] = pPage->apCell[j-1];
- }
- pPage->nCell++;
- if( idx<=0 ){
- pPage->isOverfull = 1;
- pPage->apCell[i] = pCell;
- }else{
- memcpy(&pPage->u.aDisk[idx], pCell, sz);
- pPage->apCell[i] = (Cell*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx];
- }
- pPage->idxShift = 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Rebuild the linked list of cells on a page so that the cells
-** occur in the order specified by the pPage->apCell[] array.
-** Invoke this routine once to repair damage after one or more
-** invocations of either insertCell() or dropCell().
-*/
-static void relinkCellList(Btree *pBt, MemPage *pPage){
- int i;
- u16 *pIdx;
- assert( sqlitepager_iswriteable(pPage) );
- pIdx = &pPage->u.hdr.firstCell;
- for(i=0; i<pPage->nCell; i++){
- int idx = Addr(pPage->apCell[i]) - Addr(pPage);
- assert( idx>0 && idx<STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE );
- *pIdx = SWAB16(pBt, idx);
- pIdx = &pPage->apCell[i]->h.iNext;
- }
- *pIdx = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Make a copy of the contents of pFrom into pTo. The pFrom->apCell[]
-** pointers that point into pFrom->u.aDisk[] must be adjusted to point
-** into pTo->u.aDisk[] instead. But some pFrom->apCell[] entries might
-** not point to pFrom->u.aDisk[]. Those are unchanged.
-*/
-static void copyPage(MemPage *pTo, MemPage *pFrom){
- uptr from, to;
- int i;
- memcpy(pTo->u.aDisk, pFrom->u.aDisk, STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE);
- pTo->pParent = 0;
- pTo->isInit = 1;
- pTo->nCell = pFrom->nCell;
- pTo->nFree = pFrom->nFree;
- pTo->isOverfull = pFrom->isOverfull;
- to = Addr(pTo);
- from = Addr(pFrom);
- for(i=0; i<pTo->nCell; i++){
- uptr x = Addr(pFrom->apCell[i]);
- if( x>from && x<from+STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE ){
- *((uptr*)&pTo->apCell[i]) = x + to - from;
- }else{
- pTo->apCell[i] = pFrom->apCell[i];
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** The following parameters determine how many adjacent pages get involved
-** in a balancing operation. NN is the number of neighbors on either side
-** of the page that participate in the balancing operation. NB is the
-** total number of pages that participate, including the target page and
-** NN neighbors on either side.
-**
-** The minimum value of NN is 1 (of course). Increasing NN above 1
-** (to 2 or 3) gives a modest improvement in SELECT and DELETE performance
-** in exchange for a larger degradation in INSERT and UPDATE performance.
-** The value of NN appears to give the best results overall.
-*/
-#define NN 1 /* Number of neighbors on either side of pPage */
-#define NB (NN*2+1) /* Total pages involved in the balance */
-
-/*
-** This routine redistributes Cells on pPage and up to two siblings
-** of pPage so that all pages have about the same amount of free space.
-** Usually one sibling on either side of pPage is used in the balancing,
-** though both siblings might come from one side if pPage is the first
-** or last child of its parent. If pPage has fewer than two siblings
-** (something which can only happen if pPage is the root page or a
-** child of root) then all available siblings participate in the balancing.
-**
-** The number of siblings of pPage might be increased or decreased by
-** one in an effort to keep pages between 66% and 100% full. The root page
-** is special and is allowed to be less than 66% full. If pPage is
-** the root page, then the depth of the tree might be increased
-** or decreased by one, as necessary, to keep the root page from being
-** overfull or empty.
-**
-** This routine calls relinkCellList() on its input page regardless of
-** whether or not it does any real balancing. Client routines will typically
-** invoke insertCell() or dropCell() before calling this routine, so we
-** need to call relinkCellList() to clean up the mess that those other
-** routines left behind.
-**
-** pCur is left pointing to the same cell as when this routine was called
-** even if that cell gets moved to a different page. pCur may be NULL.
-** Set the pCur parameter to NULL if you do not care about keeping track
-** of a cell as that will save this routine the work of keeping track of it.
-**
-** Note that when this routine is called, some of the Cells on pPage
-** might not actually be stored in pPage->u.aDisk[]. This can happen
-** if the page is overfull. Part of the job of this routine is to
-** make sure all Cells for pPage once again fit in pPage->u.aDisk[].
-**
-** In the course of balancing the siblings of pPage, the parent of pPage
-** might become overfull or underfull. If that happens, then this routine
-** is called recursively on the parent.
-**
-** If this routine fails for any reason, it might leave the database
-** in a corrupted state. So if this routine fails, the database should
-** be rolled back.
-*/
-static int balance(Btree *pBt, MemPage *pPage, BtCursor *pCur){
- MemPage *pParent; /* The parent of pPage */
- int nCell; /* Number of cells in apCell[] */
- int nOld; /* Number of pages in apOld[] */
- int nNew; /* Number of pages in apNew[] */
- int nDiv; /* Number of cells in apDiv[] */
- int i, j, k; /* Loop counters */
- int idx; /* Index of pPage in pParent->apCell[] */
- int nxDiv; /* Next divider slot in pParent->apCell[] */
- int rc; /* The return code */
- int iCur; /* apCell[iCur] is the cell of the cursor */
- MemPage *pOldCurPage; /* The cursor originally points to this page */
- int subtotal; /* Subtotal of bytes in cells on one page */
- MemPage *extraUnref = 0; /* A page that needs to be unref-ed */
- MemPage *apOld[NB]; /* pPage and up to two siblings */
- Pgno pgnoOld[NB]; /* Page numbers for each page in apOld[] */
- MemPage *apNew[NB+1]; /* pPage and up to NB siblings after balancing */
- Pgno pgnoNew[NB+1]; /* Page numbers for each page in apNew[] */
- int idxDiv[NB]; /* Indices of divider cells in pParent */
- Cell *apDiv[NB]; /* Divider cells in pParent */
- Cell aTemp[NB]; /* Temporary holding area for apDiv[] */
- int cntNew[NB+1]; /* Index in apCell[] of cell after i-th page */
- int szNew[NB+1]; /* Combined size of cells place on i-th page */
- MemPage aOld[NB]; /* Temporary copies of pPage and its siblings */
- Cell *apCell[(MX_CELL+2)*NB]; /* All cells from pages being balanced */
- int szCell[(MX_CELL+2)*NB]; /* Local size of all cells */
-
- /*
- ** Return without doing any work if pPage is neither overfull nor
- ** underfull.
- */
- assert( sqlitepager_iswriteable(pPage) );
- if( !pPage->isOverfull && pPage->nFree<STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE/2
- && pPage->nCell>=2){
- relinkCellList(pBt, pPage);
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
-
- /*
- ** Find the parent of the page to be balanceed.
- ** If there is no parent, it means this page is the root page and
- ** special rules apply.
- */
- pParent = pPage->pParent;
- if( pParent==0 ){
- Pgno pgnoChild;
- MemPage *pChild;
- assert( pPage->isInit );
- if( pPage->nCell==0 ){
- if( pPage->u.hdr.rightChild ){
- /*
- ** The root page is empty. Copy the one child page
- ** into the root page and return. This reduces the depth
- ** of the BTree by one.
- */
- pgnoChild = SWAB32(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.rightChild);
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, pgnoChild, (void**)&pChild);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- memcpy(pPage, pChild, STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE);
- pPage->isInit = 0;
- rc = initPage(pBt, pPage, sqlitepager_pagenumber(pPage), 0);
- assert( rc==STQLITE_OK );
- reparentChildPages(pBt, pPage);
- if( pCur && pCur->pPage==pChild ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pChild);
- pCur->pPage = pPage;
- sqlitepager_ref(pPage);
- }
- freePage(pBt, pChild, pgnoChild);
- sqlitepager_unref(pChild);
- }else{
- relinkCellList(pBt, pPage);
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- if( !pPage->isOverfull ){
- /* It is OK for the root page to be less than half full.
- */
- relinkCellList(pBt, pPage);
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- /*
- ** If we get to here, it means the root page is overfull.
- ** When this happens, Create a new child page and copy the
- ** contents of the root into the child. Then make the root
- ** page an empty page with rightChild pointing to the new
- ** child. Then fall thru to the code below which will cause
- ** the overfull child page to be split.
- */
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pPage);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = allocatePage(pBt, &pChild, &pgnoChild, sqlitepager_pagenumber(pPage));
- if( rc ) return rc;
- assert( sqlitepager_iswriteable(pChild) );
- copyPage(pChild, pPage);
- pChild->pParent = pPage;
- pChild->idxParent = 0;
- sqlitepager_ref(pPage);
- pChild->isOverfull = 1;
- if( pCur && pCur->pPage==pPage ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- pCur->pPage = pChild;
- }else{
- extraUnref = pChild;
- }
- zeroPage(pBt, pPage);
- pPage->u.hdr.rightChild = SWAB32(pBt, pgnoChild);
- pParent = pPage;
- pPage = pChild;
- }
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pParent);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- assert( pParent->isInit );
-
- /*
- ** Find the Cell in the parent page whose h.leftChild points back
- ** to pPage. The "idx" variable is the index of that cell. If pPage
- ** is the rightmost child of pParent then set idx to pParent->nCell
- */
- if( pParent->idxShift ){
- Pgno pgno, swabPgno;
- pgno = sqlitepager_pagenumber(pPage);
- swabPgno = SWAB32(pBt, pgno);
- for(idx=0; idx<pParent->nCell; idx++){
- if( pParent->apCell[idx]->h.leftChild==swabPgno ){
- break;
- }
- }
- assert( idx<pParent->nCell || pParent->u.hdr.rightChild==swabPgno );
- }else{
- idx = pPage->idxParent;
- }
-
- /*
- ** Initialize variables so that it will be safe to jump
- ** directly to balance_cleanup at any moment.
- */
- nOld = nNew = 0;
- sqlitepager_ref(pParent);
-
- /*
- ** Find sibling pages to pPage and the Cells in pParent that divide
- ** the siblings. An attempt is made to find NN siblings on either
- ** side of pPage. More siblings are taken from one side, however, if
- ** pPage there are fewer than NN siblings on the other side. If pParent
- ** has NB or fewer tqchildren then all tqchildren of pParent are taken.
- */
- nxDiv = idx - NN;
- if( nxDiv + NB > pParent->nCell ){
- nxDiv = pParent->nCell - NB + 1;
- }
- if( nxDiv<0 ){
- nxDiv = 0;
- }
- nDiv = 0;
- for(i=0, k=nxDiv; i<NB; i++, k++){
- if( k<pParent->nCell ){
- idxDiv[i] = k;
- apDiv[i] = pParent->apCell[k];
- nDiv++;
- pgnoOld[i] = SWAB32(pBt, apDiv[i]->h.leftChild);
- }else if( k==pParent->nCell ){
- pgnoOld[i] = SWAB32(pBt, pParent->u.hdr.rightChild);
- }else{
- break;
- }
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, pgnoOld[i], (void**)&apOld[i]);
- if( rc ) goto balance_cleanup;
- rc = initPage(pBt, apOld[i], pgnoOld[i], pParent);
- if( rc ) goto balance_cleanup;
- apOld[i]->idxParent = k;
- nOld++;
- }
-
- /*
- ** Set iCur to be the index in apCell[] of the cell that the cursor
- ** is pointing to. We will need this later on in order to keep the
- ** cursor pointing at the same cell. If pCur points to a page that
- ** has no involvement with this rebalancing, then set iCur to a large
- ** number so that the iCur==j tests always fail in the main cell
- ** distribution loop below.
- */
- if( pCur ){
- iCur = 0;
- for(i=0; i<nOld; i++){
- if( pCur->pPage==apOld[i] ){
- iCur += pCur->idx;
- break;
- }
- iCur += apOld[i]->nCell;
- if( i<nOld-1 && pCur->pPage==pParent && pCur->idx==idxDiv[i] ){
- break;
- }
- iCur++;
- }
- pOldCurPage = pCur->pPage;
- }
-
- /*
- ** Make copies of the content of pPage and its siblings into aOld[].
- ** The rest of this function will use data from the copies rather
- ** that the original pages since the original pages will be in the
- ** process of being overwritten.
- */
- for(i=0; i<nOld; i++){
- copyPage(&aOld[i], apOld[i]);
- }
-
- /*
- ** Load pointers to all cells on sibling pages and the divider cells
- ** into the local apCell[] array. Make copies of the divider cells
- ** into aTemp[] and remove the the divider Cells from pParent.
- */
- nCell = 0;
- for(i=0; i<nOld; i++){
- MemPage *pOld = &aOld[i];
- for(j=0; j<pOld->nCell; j++){
- apCell[nCell] = pOld->apCell[j];
- szCell[nCell] = cellSize(pBt, apCell[nCell]);
- nCell++;
- }
- if( i<nOld-1 ){
- szCell[nCell] = cellSize(pBt, apDiv[i]);
- memcpy(&aTemp[i], apDiv[i], szCell[nCell]);
- apCell[nCell] = &aTemp[i];
- dropCell(pBt, pParent, nxDiv, szCell[nCell]);
- assert( SWAB32(pBt, apCell[nCell]->h.leftChild)==pgnoOld[i] );
- apCell[nCell]->h.leftChild = pOld->u.hdr.rightChild;
- nCell++;
- }
- }
-
- /*
- ** Figure out the number of pages needed to hold all nCell cells.
- ** Store this number in "k". Also compute szNew[] which is the total
- ** size of all cells on the i-th page and cntNew[] which is the index
- ** in apCell[] of the cell that divides path i from path i+1.
- ** cntNew[k] should equal nCell.
- **
- ** This little patch of code is critical for keeping the tree
- ** balanced.
- */
- for(subtotal=k=i=0; i<nCell; i++){
- subtotal += szCell[i];
- if( subtotal > USABLE_SPACE ){
- szNew[k] = subtotal - szCell[i];
- cntNew[k] = i;
- subtotal = 0;
- k++;
- }
- }
- szNew[k] = subtotal;
- cntNew[k] = nCell;
- k++;
- for(i=k-1; i>0; i--){
- while( szNew[i]<USABLE_SPACE/2 ){
- cntNew[i-1]--;
- assert( cntNew[i-1]>0 );
- szNew[i] += szCell[cntNew[i-1]];
- szNew[i-1] -= szCell[cntNew[i-1]-1];
- }
- }
- assert( cntNew[0]>0 );
-
- /*
- ** Allocate k new pages. Reuse old pages where possible.
- */
- for(i=0; i<k; i++){
- if( i<nOld ){
- apNew[i] = apOld[i];
- pgnoNew[i] = pgnoOld[i];
- apOld[i] = 0;
- sqlitepager_write(apNew[i]);
- }else{
- rc = allocatePage(pBt, &apNew[i], &pgnoNew[i], pgnoNew[i-1]);
- if( rc ) goto balance_cleanup;
- }
- nNew++;
- zeroPage(pBt, apNew[i]);
- apNew[i]->isInit = 1;
- }
-
- /* Free any old pages that were not reused as new pages.
- */
- while( i<nOld ){
- rc = freePage(pBt, apOld[i], pgnoOld[i]);
- if( rc ) goto balance_cleanup;
- sqlitepager_unref(apOld[i]);
- apOld[i] = 0;
- i++;
- }
-
- /*
- ** Put the new pages in accending order. This helps to
- ** keep entries in the disk file in order so that a scan
- ** of the table is a linear scan through the file. That
- ** in turn helps the operating system to deliver pages
- ** from the disk more rapidly.
- **
- ** An O(n^2) insertion sort algorithm is used, but since
- ** n is never more than NB (a small constant), that should
- ** not be a problem.
- **
- ** When NB==3, this one optimization makes the database
- ** about 25% faster for large insertions and deletions.
- */
- for(i=0; i<k-1; i++){
- int minV = pgnoNew[i];
- int minI = i;
- for(j=i+1; j<k; j++){
- if( pgnoNew[j]<(unsigned)minV ){
- minI = j;
- minV = pgnoNew[j];
- }
- }
- if( minI>i ){
- int t;
- MemPage *pT;
- t = pgnoNew[i];
- pT = apNew[i];
- pgnoNew[i] = pgnoNew[minI];
- apNew[i] = apNew[minI];
- pgnoNew[minI] = t;
- apNew[minI] = pT;
- }
- }
-
- /*
- ** Evenly distribute the data in apCell[] across the new pages.
- ** Insert divider cells into pParent as necessary.
- */
- j = 0;
- for(i=0; i<nNew; i++){
- MemPage *pNew = apNew[i];
- while( j<cntNew[i] ){
- assert( pNew->nFree>=szCell[j] );
- if( pCur && iCur==j ){ pCur->pPage = pNew; pCur->idx = pNew->nCell; }
- insertCell(pBt, pNew, pNew->nCell, apCell[j], szCell[j]);
- j++;
- }
- assert( pNew->nCell>0 );
- assert( !pNew->isOverfull );
- relinkCellList(pBt, pNew);
- if( i<nNew-1 && j<nCell ){
- pNew->u.hdr.rightChild = apCell[j]->h.leftChild;
- apCell[j]->h.leftChild = SWAB32(pBt, pgnoNew[i]);
- if( pCur && iCur==j ){ pCur->pPage = pParent; pCur->idx = nxDiv; }
- insertCell(pBt, pParent, nxDiv, apCell[j], szCell[j]);
- j++;
- nxDiv++;
- }
- }
- assert( j==nCell );
- apNew[nNew-1]->u.hdr.rightChild = aOld[nOld-1].u.hdr.rightChild;
- if( nxDiv==pParent->nCell ){
- pParent->u.hdr.rightChild = SWAB32(pBt, pgnoNew[nNew-1]);
- }else{
- pParent->apCell[nxDiv]->h.leftChild = SWAB32(pBt, pgnoNew[nNew-1]);
- }
- if( pCur ){
- if( j<=iCur && pCur->pPage==pParent && pCur->idx>idxDiv[nOld-1] ){
- assert( pCur->pPage==pOldCurPage );
- pCur->idx += nNew - nOld;
- }else{
- assert( pOldCurPage!=0 );
- sqlitepager_ref(pCur->pPage);
- sqlitepager_unref(pOldCurPage);
- }
- }
-
- /*
- ** Reparent tqchildren of all cells.
- */
- for(i=0; i<nNew; i++){
- reparentChildPages(pBt, apNew[i]);
- }
- reparentChildPages(pBt, pParent);
-
- /*
- ** balance the parent page.
- */
- rc = balance(pBt, pParent, pCur);
-
- /*
- ** Cleanup before returning.
- */
-balance_cleanup:
- if( extraUnref ){
- sqlitepager_unref(extraUnref);
- }
- for(i=0; i<nOld; i++){
- if( apOld[i]!=0 && apOld[i]!=&aOld[i] ) sqlitepager_unref(apOld[i]);
- }
- for(i=0; i<nNew; i++){
- sqlitepager_unref(apNew[i]);
- }
- if( pCur && pCur->pPage==0 ){
- pCur->pPage = pParent;
- pCur->idx = 0;
- }else{
- sqlitepager_unref(pParent);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine checks all cursors that point to the same table
-** as pCur points to. If any of those cursors were opened with
-** wrFlag==0 then this routine returns STQLITE_LOCKED. If all
-** cursors point to the same table were opened with wrFlag==1
-** then this routine returns STQLITE_OK.
-**
-** In addition to checking for read-locks (where a read-lock
-** means a cursor opened with wrFlag==0) this routine also moves
-** all cursors other than pCur so that they are pointing to the
-** first Cell on root page. This is necessary because an insert
-** or delete might change the number of cells on a page or delete
-** a page entirely and we do not want to leave any cursors
-** pointing to non-existant pages or cells.
-*/
-static int checkReadLocks(BtCursor *pCur){
- BtCursor *p;
- assert( pCur->wrFlag );
- for(p=pCur->pShared; p!=pCur; p=p->pShared){
- assert( p );
- assert( p->pgnoRoot==pCur->pgnoRoot );
- if( p->wrFlag==0 ) return STQLITE_LOCKED;
- if( sqlitepager_pagenumber(p->pPage)!=p->pgnoRoot ){
- moveToRoot(p);
- }
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Insert a new record into the BTree. The key is given by (pKey,nKey)
-** and the data is given by (pData,nData). The cursor is used only to
-** define what database the record should be inserted into. The cursor
-** is left pointing at the new record.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeInsert(
- BtCursor *pCur, /* Insert data into the table of this cursor */
- const void *pKey, int nKey, /* The key of the new record */
- const void *pData, int nData /* The data of the new record */
-){
- Cell newCell;
- int rc;
- int loc;
- int szNew;
- MemPage *pPage;
- Btree *pBt = pCur->pBt;
-
- if( pCur->pPage==0 ){
- return STQLITE_ABORT; /* A rollback destroyed this cursor */
- }
- if( !pBt->inTrans || nKey+nData==0 ){
- /* Must start a transaction before doing an insert */
- return pBt->readOnly ? STQLITE_READONLY : STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- assert( !pBt->readOnly );
- if( !pCur->wrFlag ){
- return STQLITE_PERM; /* Cursor not open for writing */
- }
- if( checkReadLocks(pCur) ){
- return STQLITE_LOCKED; /* The table pCur points to has a read lock */
- }
- rc = fileBtreeMoveto(pCur, pKey, nKey, &loc);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- pPage = pCur->pPage;
- assert( pPage->isInit );
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pPage);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = fillInCell(pBt, &newCell, pKey, nKey, pData, nData);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- szNew = cellSize(pBt, &newCell);
- if( loc==0 ){
- newCell.h.leftChild = pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]->h.leftChild;
- rc = clearCell(pBt, pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- dropCell(pBt, pPage, pCur->idx, cellSize(pBt, pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]));
- }else if( loc<0 && pPage->nCell>0 ){
- assert( pPage->u.hdr.rightChild==0 ); /* Must be a leaf page */
- pCur->idx++;
- }else{
- assert( pPage->u.hdr.rightChild==0 ); /* Must be a leaf page */
- }
- insertCell(pBt, pPage, pCur->idx, &newCell, szNew);
- rc = balance(pCur->pBt, pPage, pCur);
- /* sqliteBtreePageDump(pCur->pBt, pCur->pgnoRoot, 1); */
- /* fflush(stdout); */
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_INVALID;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Delete the entry that the cursor is pointing to.
-**
-** The cursor is left pointing at either the next or the previous
-** entry. If the cursor is left pointing to the next entry, then
-** the pCur->eSkip flag is set to SKIP_NEXT which forces the next call to
-** sqliteBtreeNext() to be a no-op. That way, you can always call
-** sqliteBtreeNext() after a delete and the cursor will be left
-** pointing to the first entry after the deleted entry. Similarly,
-** pCur->eSkip is set to SKIP_PREV is the cursor is left pointing to
-** the entry prior to the deleted entry so that a subsequent call to
-** sqliteBtreePrevious() will always leave the cursor pointing at the
-** entry immediately before the one that was deleted.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeDelete(BtCursor *pCur){
- MemPage *pPage = pCur->pPage;
- Cell *pCell;
- int rc;
- Pgno pgnoChild;
- Btree *pBt = pCur->pBt;
-
- assert( pPage->isInit );
- if( pCur->pPage==0 ){
- return STQLITE_ABORT; /* A rollback destroyed this cursor */
- }
- if( !pBt->inTrans ){
- /* Must start a transaction before doing a delete */
- return pBt->readOnly ? STQLITE_READONLY : STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- assert( !pBt->readOnly );
- if( pCur->idx >= pPage->nCell ){
- return STQLITE_ERROR; /* The cursor is not pointing to anything */
- }
- if( !pCur->wrFlag ){
- return STQLITE_PERM; /* Did not open this cursor for writing */
- }
- if( checkReadLocks(pCur) ){
- return STQLITE_LOCKED; /* The table pCur points to has a read lock */
- }
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pPage);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- pCell = pPage->apCell[pCur->idx];
- pgnoChild = SWAB32(pBt, pCell->h.leftChild);
- clearCell(pBt, pCell);
- if( pgnoChild ){
- /*
- ** The entry we are about to delete is not a leaf so if we do not
- ** do something we will leave a hole on an internal page.
- ** We have to fill the hole by moving in a cell from a leaf. The
- ** next Cell after the one to be deleted is guaranteed to exist and
- ** to be a leaf so we can use it.
- */
- BtCursor leafCur;
- Cell *pNext;
- int szNext;
- int notUsed;
- getTempCursor(pCur, &leafCur);
- rc = fileBtreeNext(&leafCur, &notUsed);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- if( rc!=STQLITE_NOMEM ) rc = STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- return rc;
- }
- rc = sqlitepager_write(leafCur.pPage);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- dropCell(pBt, pPage, pCur->idx, cellSize(pBt, pCell));
- pNext = leafCur.pPage->apCell[leafCur.idx];
- szNext = cellSize(pBt, pNext);
- pNext->h.leftChild = SWAB32(pBt, pgnoChild);
- insertCell(pBt, pPage, pCur->idx, pNext, szNext);
- rc = balance(pBt, pPage, pCur);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NEXT;
- dropCell(pBt, leafCur.pPage, leafCur.idx, szNext);
- rc = balance(pBt, leafCur.pPage, pCur);
- releaseTempCursor(&leafCur);
- }else{
- dropCell(pBt, pPage, pCur->idx, cellSize(pBt, pCell));
- if( pCur->idx>=pPage->nCell ){
- pCur->idx = pPage->nCell-1;
- if( pCur->idx<0 ){
- pCur->idx = 0;
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NEXT;
- }else{
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_PREV;
- }
- }else{
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NEXT;
- }
- rc = balance(pBt, pPage, pCur);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Create a new BTree table. Write into *piTable the page
-** number for the root page of the new table.
-**
-** In the current implementation, BTree tables and BTree indices are the
-** the same. In the future, we may change this so that BTree tables
-** are restricted to having a 4-byte integer key and arbitrary data and
-** BTree indices are restricted to having an arbitrary key and no data.
-** But for now, this routine also serves to create indices.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeCreateTable(Btree *pBt, int *piTable){
- MemPage *pRoot;
- Pgno pgnoRoot;
- int rc;
- if( !pBt->inTrans ){
- /* Must start a transaction first */
- return pBt->readOnly ? STQLITE_READONLY : STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- if( pBt->readOnly ){
- return STQLITE_READONLY;
- }
- rc = allocatePage(pBt, &pRoot, &pgnoRoot, 0);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- assert( sqlitepager_iswriteable(pRoot) );
- zeroPage(pBt, pRoot);
- sqlitepager_unref(pRoot);
- *piTable = (int)pgnoRoot;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Erase the given database page and all its tqchildren. Return
-** the page to the freelist.
-*/
-static int clearDatabasePage(Btree *pBt, Pgno pgno, int freePageFlag){
- MemPage *pPage;
- int rc;
- Cell *pCell;
- int idx;
-
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, pgno, (void**)&pPage);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pPage);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = initPage(pBt, pPage, pgno, 0);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.firstCell);
- while( idx>0 ){
- pCell = (Cell*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx];
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pCell->h.iNext);
- if( pCell->h.leftChild ){
- rc = clearDatabasePage(pBt, SWAB32(pBt, pCell->h.leftChild), 1);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- }
- rc = clearCell(pBt, pCell);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- }
- if( pPage->u.hdr.rightChild ){
- rc = clearDatabasePage(pBt, SWAB32(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.rightChild), 1);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- }
- if( freePageFlag ){
- rc = freePage(pBt, pPage, pgno);
- }else{
- zeroPage(pBt, pPage);
- }
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Delete all information from a single table in the database.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeClearTable(Btree *pBt, int iTable){
- int rc;
- BtCursor *pCur;
- if( !pBt->inTrans ){
- return pBt->readOnly ? STQLITE_READONLY : STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- for(pCur=pBt->pCursor; pCur; pCur=pCur->pNext){
- if( pCur->pgnoRoot==(Pgno)iTable ){
- if( pCur->wrFlag==0 ) return STQLITE_LOCKED;
- moveToRoot(pCur);
- }
- }
- rc = clearDatabasePage(pBt, (Pgno)iTable, 0);
- if( rc ){
- fileBtreeRollback(pBt);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Erase all information in a table and add the root of the table to
-** the freelist. Except, the root of the principle table (the one on
-** page 2) is never added to the freelist.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeDropTable(Btree *pBt, int iTable){
- int rc;
- MemPage *pPage;
- BtCursor *pCur;
- if( !pBt->inTrans ){
- return pBt->readOnly ? STQLITE_READONLY : STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- for(pCur=pBt->pCursor; pCur; pCur=pCur->pNext){
- if( pCur->pgnoRoot==(Pgno)iTable ){
- return STQLITE_LOCKED; /* Cannot drop a table that has a cursor */
- }
- }
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, (Pgno)iTable, (void**)&pPage);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = fileBtreeClearTable(pBt, iTable);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- if( iTable>2 ){
- rc = freePage(pBt, pPage, iTable);
- }else{
- zeroPage(pBt, pPage);
- }
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- return rc;
-}
-
-#if 0 /* UNTESTED */
-/*
-** Copy all cell data from one database file into another.
-** pages back the freelist.
-*/
-static int copyCell(Btree *pBtFrom, BTree *pBtTo, Cell *pCell){
- Pager *pFromPager = pBtFrom->pPager;
- OverflowPage *pOvfl;
- Pgno ovfl, nextOvfl;
- Pgno *pPrev;
- int rc = STQLITE_OK;
- MemPage *pNew, *pPrevPg;
- Pgno new;
-
- if( NKEY(pBtTo, pCell->h) + NDATA(pBtTo, pCell->h) <= MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- pPrev = &pCell->ovfl;
- pPrevPg = 0;
- ovfl = SWAB32(pBtTo, pCell->ovfl);
- while( ovfl && rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pFromPager, ovfl, (void**)&pOvfl);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- nextOvfl = SWAB32(pBtFrom, pOvfl->iNext);
- rc = allocatePage(pBtTo, &pNew, &new, 0);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pNew);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- memcpy(pNew, pOvfl, STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE);
- *pPrev = SWAB32(pBtTo, new);
- if( pPrevPg ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pPrevPg);
- }
- pPrev = &pOvfl->iNext;
- pPrevPg = pNew;
- }
- }
- sqlitepager_unref(pOvfl);
- ovfl = nextOvfl;
- }
- if( pPrevPg ){
- sqlitepager_unref(pPrevPg);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-#endif
-
-
-#if 0 /* UNTESTED */
-/*
-** Copy a page of data from one database over to another.
-*/
-static int copyDatabasePage(
- Btree *pBtFrom,
- Pgno pgnoFrom,
- Btree *pBtTo,
- Pgno *pTo
-){
- MemPage *pPageFrom, *pPage;
- Pgno to;
- int rc;
- Cell *pCell;
- int idx;
-
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBtFrom->pPager, pgno, (void**)&pPageFrom);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- rc = allocatePage(pBt, &pPage, pTo, 0);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pPage);
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- memcpy(pPage, pPageFrom, STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE);
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.firstCell);
- while( idx>0 ){
- pCell = (Cell*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx];
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pCell->h.iNext);
- if( pCell->h.leftChild ){
- Pgno newChld;
- rc = copyDatabasePage(pBtFrom, SWAB32(pBtFrom, pCell->h.leftChild),
- pBtTo, &newChld);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- pCell->h.leftChild = SWAB32(pBtFrom, newChld);
- }
- rc = copyCell(pBtFrom, pBtTo, pCell);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- }
- if( pPage->u.hdr.rightChild ){
- Pgno newChld;
- rc = copyDatabasePage(pBtFrom, SWAB32(pBtFrom, pPage->u.hdr.rightChild),
- pBtTo, &newChld);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- pPage->u.hdr.rightChild = SWAB32(pBtTo, newChild);
- }
- }
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- return rc;
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Read the meta-information out of a database file.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeGetMeta(Btree *pBt, int *aMeta){
- PageOne *pP1;
- int rc;
- int i;
-
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, 1, (void**)&pP1);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- aMeta[0] = SWAB32(pBt, pP1->nFree);
- for(i=0; i<sizeof(pP1->aMeta)/sizeof(pP1->aMeta[0]); i++){
- aMeta[i+1] = SWAB32(pBt, pP1->aMeta[i]);
- }
- sqlitepager_unref(pP1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Write meta-information back into the database.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeUpdateMeta(Btree *pBt, int *aMeta){
- PageOne *pP1;
- int rc, i;
- if( !pBt->inTrans ){
- return pBt->readOnly ? STQLITE_READONLY : STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- pP1 = pBt->page1;
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pP1);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- for(i=0; i<sizeof(pP1->aMeta)/sizeof(pP1->aMeta[0]); i++){
- pP1->aMeta[i] = SWAB32(pBt, aMeta[i+1]);
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/******************************************************************************
-** The complete implementation of the BTree subsystem is above this line.
-** All the code the follows is for testing and troubleshooting the BTree
-** subsystem. None of the code that follows is used during normal operation.
-******************************************************************************/
-
-/*
-** Print a disassembly of the given page on standard output. This routine
-** is used for debugging and testing only.
-*/
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-static int fileBtreePageDump(Btree *pBt, int pgno, int recursive){
- int rc;
- MemPage *pPage;
- int i, j;
- int nFree;
- u16 idx;
- char range[20];
- unsigned char payload[20];
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBt->pPager, (Pgno)pgno, (void**)&pPage);
- if( rc ){
- return rc;
- }
- if( recursive ) printf("PAGE %d:\n", pgno);
- i = 0;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.firstCell);
- while( idx>0 && idx<=STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE-MIN_CELL_SIZE ){
- Cell *pCell = (Cell*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx];
- int sz = cellSize(pBt, pCell);
- sprintf(range,"%d..%d", idx, idx+sz-1);
- sz = NKEY(pBt, pCell->h) + NDATA(pBt, pCell->h);
- if( sz>sizeof(payload)-1 ) sz = sizeof(payload)-1;
- memcpy(payload, pCell->aPayload, sz);
- for(j=0; j<sz; j++){
- if( payload[j]<0x20 || payload[j]>0x7f ) payload[j] = '.';
- }
- payload[sz] = 0;
- printf(
- "cell %2d: i=%-10s chld=%-4d nk=%-4d nd=%-4d payload=%s\n",
- i, range, (int)pCell->h.leftChild,
- NKEY(pBt, pCell->h), NDATA(pBt, pCell->h),
- payload
- );
- if( pPage->isInit && pPage->apCell[i]!=pCell ){
- printf("**** apCell[%d] does not match on prior entry ****\n", i);
- }
- i++;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pCell->h.iNext);
- }
- if( idx!=0 ){
- printf("ERROR: next cell index out of range: %d\n", idx);
- }
- printf("right_child: %d\n", SWAB32(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.rightChild));
- nFree = 0;
- i = 0;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.firstFree);
- while( idx>0 && idx<STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE ){
- FreeBlk *p = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx];
- sprintf(range,"%d..%d", idx, idx+p->iSize-1);
- nFree += SWAB16(pBt, p->iSize);
- printf("freeblock %2d: i=%-10s size=%-4d total=%d\n",
- i, range, SWAB16(pBt, p->iSize), nFree);
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, p->iNext);
- i++;
- }
- if( idx!=0 ){
- printf("ERROR: next freeblock index out of range: %d\n", idx);
- }
- if( recursive && pPage->u.hdr.rightChild!=0 ){
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.firstCell);
- while( idx>0 && idx<STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE-MIN_CELL_SIZE ){
- Cell *pCell = (Cell*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx];
- fileBtreePageDump(pBt, SWAB32(pBt, pCell->h.leftChild), 1);
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pCell->h.iNext);
- }
- fileBtreePageDump(pBt, SWAB32(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.rightChild), 1);
- }
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-#endif
-
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-/*
-** Fill aResult[] with information about the entry and page that the
-** cursor is pointing to.
-**
-** aResult[0] = The page number
-** aResult[1] = The entry number
-** aResult[2] = Total number of entries on this page
-** aResult[3] = Size of this entry
-** aResult[4] = Number of free bytes on this page
-** aResult[5] = Number of free blocks on the page
-** aResult[6] = Page number of the left child of this entry
-** aResult[7] = Page number of the right child for the whole page
-**
-** This routine is used for testing and debugging only.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeCursorDump(BtCursor *pCur, int *aResult){
- int cnt, idx;
- MemPage *pPage = pCur->pPage;
- Btree *pBt = pCur->pBt;
- aResult[0] = sqlitepager_pagenumber(pPage);
- aResult[1] = pCur->idx;
- aResult[2] = pPage->nCell;
- if( pCur->idx>=0 && pCur->idx<pPage->nCell ){
- aResult[3] = cellSize(pBt, pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]);
- aResult[6] = SWAB32(pBt, pPage->apCell[pCur->idx]->h.leftChild);
- }else{
- aResult[3] = 0;
- aResult[6] = 0;
- }
- aResult[4] = pPage->nFree;
- cnt = 0;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.firstFree);
- while( idx>0 && idx<STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE ){
- cnt++;
- idx = SWAB16(pBt, ((FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[idx])->iNext);
- }
- aResult[5] = cnt;
- aResult[7] = SWAB32(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.rightChild);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Return the pager associated with a BTree. This routine is used for
-** testing and debugging only.
-*/
-static Pager *fileBtreePager(Btree *pBt){
- return pBt->pPager;
-}
-
-/*
-** This structure is passed around through all the sanity checking routines
-** in order to keep track of some global state information.
-*/
-typedef struct IntegrityCk IntegrityCk;
-struct IntegrityCk {
- Btree *pBt; /* The tree being checked out */
- Pager *pPager; /* The associated pager. Also accessible by pBt->pPager */
- int nPage; /* Number of pages in the database */
- int *anRef; /* Number of times each page is referenced */
- char *zErrMsg; /* An error message. NULL of no errors seen. */
-};
-
-/*
-** Append a message to the error message string.
-*/
-static void checkAppendMsg(IntegrityCk *pCheck, char *zMsg1, char *zMsg2){
- if( pCheck->zErrMsg ){
- char *zOld = pCheck->zErrMsg;
- pCheck->zErrMsg = 0;
- sqliteSetString(&pCheck->zErrMsg, zOld, "\n", zMsg1, zMsg2, (char*)0);
- sqliteFree(zOld);
- }else{
- sqliteSetString(&pCheck->zErrMsg, zMsg1, zMsg2, (char*)0);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Add 1 to the reference count for page iPage. If this is the second
-** reference to the page, add an error message to pCheck->zErrMsg.
-** Return 1 if there are 2 ore more references to the page and 0 if
-** if this is the first reference to the page.
-**
-** Also check that the page number is in bounds.
-*/
-static int checkRef(IntegrityCk *pCheck, int iPage, char *zContext){
- if( iPage==0 ) return 1;
- if( iPage>pCheck->nPage || iPage<0 ){
- char zBuf[100];
- sprintf(zBuf, "invalid page number %d", iPage);
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zContext, zBuf);
- return 1;
- }
- if( pCheck->anRef[iPage]==1 ){
- char zBuf[100];
- sprintf(zBuf, "2nd reference to page %d", iPage);
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zContext, zBuf);
- return 1;
- }
- return (pCheck->anRef[iPage]++)>1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Check the integrity of the freelist or of an overflow page list.
-** Verify that the number of pages on the list is N.
-*/
-static void checkList(
- IntegrityCk *pCheck, /* Integrity checking context */
- int isFreeList, /* True for a freelist. False for overflow page list */
- int iPage, /* Page number for first page in the list */
- int N, /* Expected number of pages in the list */
- char *zContext /* Context for error messages */
-){
- int i;
- char zMsg[100];
- while( N-- > 0 ){
- OverflowPage *pOvfl;
- if( iPage<1 ){
- sprintf(zMsg, "%d pages missing from overflow list", N+1);
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zContext, zMsg);
- break;
- }
- if( checkRef(pCheck, iPage, zContext) ) break;
- if( sqlitepager_get(pCheck->pPager, (Pgno)iPage, (void**)&pOvfl) ){
- sprintf(zMsg, "failed to get page %d", iPage);
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zContext, zMsg);
- break;
- }
- if( isFreeList ){
- FreelistInfo *pInfo = (FreelistInfo*)pOvfl->aPayload;
- int n = SWAB32(pCheck->pBt, pInfo->nFree);
- for(i=0; i<n; i++){
- checkRef(pCheck, SWAB32(pCheck->pBt, pInfo->aFree[i]), zContext);
- }
- N -= n;
- }
- iPage = SWAB32(pCheck->pBt, pOvfl->iNext);
- sqlitepager_unref(pOvfl);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Return negative if zKey1<zKey2.
-** Return zero if zKey1==zKey2.
-** Return positive if zKey1>zKey2.
-*/
-static int keyCompare(
- const char *zKey1, int nKey1,
- const char *zKey2, int nKey2
-){
- int min = nKey1>nKey2 ? nKey2 : nKey1;
- int c = memcmp(zKey1, zKey2, min);
- if( c==0 ){
- c = nKey1 - nKey2;
- }
- return c;
-}
-
-/*
-** Do various sanity checks on a single page of a tree. Return
-** the tree depth. Root pages return 0. Parents of root pages
-** return 1, and so forth.
-**
-** These checks are done:
-**
-** 1. Make sure that cells and freeblocks do not overlap
-** but combine to completely cover the page.
-** 2. Make sure cell keys are in order.
-** 3. Make sure no key is less than or equal to zLowerBound.
-** 4. Make sure no key is greater than or equal to zUpperBound.
-** 5. Check the integrity of overflow pages.
-** 6. Recursively call checkTreePage on all tqchildren.
-** 7. Verify that the depth of all tqchildren is the same.
-** 8. Make sure this page is at least 33% full or else it is
-** the root of the tree.
-*/
-static int checkTreePage(
- IntegrityCk *pCheck, /* Context for the sanity check */
- int iPage, /* Page number of the page to check */
- MemPage *pParent, /* Parent page */
- char *zParentContext, /* Parent context */
- char *zLowerBound, /* All keys should be greater than this, if not NULL */
- int nLower, /* Number of characters in zLowerBound */
- char *zUpperBound, /* All keys should be less than this, if not NULL */
- int nUpper /* Number of characters in zUpperBound */
-){
- MemPage *pPage;
- int i, rc, depth, d2, pgno;
- char *zKey1, *zKey2;
- int nKey1, nKey2;
- BtCursor cur;
- Btree *pBt;
- char zMsg[100];
- char zContext[100];
- char hit[STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE];
-
- /* Check that the page exists
- */
- cur.pBt = pBt = pCheck->pBt;
- if( iPage==0 ) return 0;
- if( checkRef(pCheck, iPage, zParentContext) ) return 0;
- sprintf(zContext, "On tree page %d: ", iPage);
- if( (rc = sqlitepager_get(pCheck->pPager, (Pgno)iPage, (void**)&pPage))!=0 ){
- sprintf(zMsg, "unable to get the page. error code=%d", rc);
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zContext, zMsg);
- return 0;
- }
- if( (rc = initPage(pBt, pPage, (Pgno)iPage, pParent))!=0 ){
- sprintf(zMsg, "initPage() returns error code %d", rc);
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zContext, zMsg);
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- return 0;
- }
-
- /* Check out all the cells.
- */
- depth = 0;
- if( zLowerBound ){
- zKey1 = sqliteMalloc( nLower+1 );
- memcpy(zKey1, zLowerBound, nLower);
- zKey1[nLower] = 0;
- }else{
- zKey1 = 0;
- }
- nKey1 = nLower;
- cur.pPage = pPage;
- for(i=0; i<pPage->nCell; i++){
- Cell *pCell = pPage->apCell[i];
- int sz;
-
- /* Check payload overflow pages
- */
- nKey2 = NKEY(pBt, pCell->h);
- sz = nKey2 + NDATA(pBt, pCell->h);
- sprintf(zContext, "On page %d cell %d: ", iPage, i);
- if( sz>MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD ){
- int nPage = (sz - MX_LOCAL_PAYLOAD + OVERFLOW_SIZE - 1)/OVERFLOW_SIZE;
- checkList(pCheck, 0, SWAB32(pBt, pCell->ovfl), nPage, zContext);
- }
-
- /* Check that keys are in the right order
- */
- cur.idx = i;
- zKey2 = sqliteMallocRaw( nKey2+1 );
- getPayload(&cur, 0, nKey2, zKey2);
- if( zKey1 && keyCompare(zKey1, nKey1, zKey2, nKey2)>=0 ){
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zContext, "Key is out of order");
- }
-
- /* Check sanity of left child page.
- */
- pgno = SWAB32(pBt, pCell->h.leftChild);
- d2 = checkTreePage(pCheck, pgno, pPage, zContext, zKey1,nKey1,zKey2,nKey2);
- if( i>0 && d2!=depth ){
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zContext, "Child page depth differs");
- }
- depth = d2;
- sqliteFree(zKey1);
- zKey1 = zKey2;
- nKey1 = nKey2;
- }
- pgno = SWAB32(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.rightChild);
- sprintf(zContext, "On page %d at right child: ", iPage);
- checkTreePage(pCheck, pgno, pPage, zContext, zKey1,nKey1,zUpperBound,nUpper);
- sqliteFree(zKey1);
-
- /* Check for complete coverage of the page
- */
- memset(hit, 0, sizeof(hit));
- memset(hit, 1, sizeof(PageHdr));
- for(i=SWAB16(pBt, pPage->u.hdr.firstCell); i>0 && i<STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE; ){
- Cell *pCell = (Cell*)&pPage->u.aDisk[i];
- int j;
- for(j=i+cellSize(pBt, pCell)-1; j>=i; j--) hit[j]++;
- i = SWAB16(pBt, pCell->h.iNext);
- }
- for(i=SWAB16(pBt,pPage->u.hdr.firstFree); i>0 && i<STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE; ){
- FreeBlk *pFBlk = (FreeBlk*)&pPage->u.aDisk[i];
- int j;
- for(j=i+SWAB16(pBt,pFBlk->iSize)-1; j>=i; j--) hit[j]++;
- i = SWAB16(pBt,pFBlk->iNext);
- }
- for(i=0; i<STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE; i++){
- if( hit[i]==0 ){
- sprintf(zMsg, "Unused space at byte %d of page %d", i, iPage);
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zMsg, 0);
- break;
- }else if( hit[i]>1 ){
- sprintf(zMsg, "Multiple uses for byte %d of page %d", i, iPage);
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zMsg, 0);
- break;
- }
- }
-
- /* Check that free space is kept to a minimum
- */
-#if 0
- if( pParent && pParent->nCell>2 && pPage->nFree>3*STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE/4 ){
- sprintf(zMsg, "free space (%d) greater than max (%d)", pPage->nFree,
- STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE/3);
- checkAppendMsg(pCheck, zContext, zMsg);
- }
-#endif
-
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- return depth;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine does a complete check of the given BTree file. aRoot[] is
-** an array of pages numbers were each page number is the root page of
-** a table. nRoot is the number of entries in aRoot.
-**
-** If everything checks out, this routine returns NULL. If something is
-** amiss, an error message is written into memory obtained from malloc()
-** and a pointer to that error message is returned. The calling function
-** is responsible for freeing the error message when it is done.
-*/
-char *fileBtreeIntegrityCheck(Btree *pBt, int *aRoot, int nRoot){
- int i;
- int nRef;
- IntegrityCk sCheck;
-
- nRef = *sqlitepager_stats(pBt->pPager);
- if( lockBtree(pBt)!=STQLITE_OK ){
- return sqliteStrDup("Unable to acquire a read lock on the database");
- }
- sCheck.pBt = pBt;
- sCheck.pPager = pBt->pPager;
- sCheck.nPage = sqlitepager_pagecount(sCheck.pPager);
- if( sCheck.nPage==0 ){
- unlockBtreeIfUnused(pBt);
- return 0;
- }
- sCheck.anRef = sqliteMallocRaw( (sCheck.nPage+1)*sizeof(sCheck.anRef[0]) );
- sCheck.anRef[1] = 1;
- for(i=2; i<=sCheck.nPage; i++){ sCheck.anRef[i] = 0; }
- sCheck.zErrMsg = 0;
-
- /* Check the integrity of the freelist
- */
- checkList(&sCheck, 1, SWAB32(pBt, pBt->page1->freeList),
- SWAB32(pBt, pBt->page1->nFree), "Main freelist: ");
-
- /* Check all the tables.
- */
- for(i=0; i<nRoot; i++){
- if( aRoot[i]==0 ) continue;
- checkTreePage(&sCheck, aRoot[i], 0, "List of tree roots: ", 0,0,0,0);
- }
-
- /* Make sure every page in the file is referenced
- */
- for(i=1; i<=sCheck.nPage; i++){
- if( sCheck.anRef[i]==0 ){
- char zBuf[100];
- sprintf(zBuf, "Page %d is never used", i);
- checkAppendMsg(&sCheck, zBuf, 0);
- }
- }
-
- /* Make sure this analysis did not leave any unref() pages
- */
- unlockBtreeIfUnused(pBt);
- if( nRef != *sqlitepager_stats(pBt->pPager) ){
- char zBuf[100];
- sprintf(zBuf,
- "Outstanding page count goes from %d to %d during this analysis",
- nRef, *sqlitepager_stats(pBt->pPager)
- );
- checkAppendMsg(&sCheck, zBuf, 0);
- }
-
- /* Clean up and report errors.
- */
- sqliteFree(sCheck.anRef);
- return sCheck.zErrMsg;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the full pathname of the underlying database file.
-*/
-static const char *fileBtreeGetFilename(Btree *pBt){
- assert( pBt->pPager!=0 );
- return sqlitepager_filename(pBt->pPager);
-}
-
-/*
-** Copy the complete content of pBtFrom into pBtTo. A transaction
-** must be active for both files.
-**
-** The size of file pBtFrom may be reduced by this operation.
-** If anything goes wrong, the transaction on pBtFrom is rolled back.
-*/
-static int fileBtreeCopyFile(Btree *pBtTo, Btree *pBtFrom){
- int rc = STQLITE_OK;
- Pgno i, nPage, nToPage;
-
- if( !pBtTo->inTrans || !pBtFrom->inTrans ) return STQLITE_ERROR;
- if( pBtTo->needSwab!=pBtFrom->needSwab ) return STQLITE_ERROR;
- if( pBtTo->pCursor ) return STQLITE_BUSY;
- memcpy(pBtTo->page1, pBtFrom->page1, STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE);
- rc = sqlitepager_overwrite(pBtTo->pPager, 1, pBtFrom->page1);
- nToPage = sqlitepager_pagecount(pBtTo->pPager);
- nPage = sqlitepager_pagecount(pBtFrom->pPager);
- for(i=2; rc==STQLITE_OK && i<=nPage; i++){
- void *pPage;
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBtFrom->pPager, i, &pPage);
- if( rc ) break;
- rc = sqlitepager_overwrite(pBtTo->pPager, i, pPage);
- if( rc ) break;
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- }
- for(i=nPage+1; rc==STQLITE_OK && i<=nToPage; i++){
- void *pPage;
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pBtTo->pPager, i, &pPage);
- if( rc ) break;
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pPage);
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- sqlitepager_dont_write(pBtTo->pPager, i);
- }
- if( !rc && nPage<nToPage ){
- rc = sqlitepager_truncate(pBtTo->pPager, nPage);
- }
- if( rc ){
- fileBtreeRollback(pBtTo);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** The following tables contain pointers to all of the interface
-** routines for this implementation of the B*Tree backend. To
-** substitute a different implemention of the backend, one has merely
-** to provide pointers to alternative functions in similar tables.
-*/
-static BtOps sqliteBtreeOps = {
- fileBtreeClose,
- fileBtreeSetCacheSize,
- fileBtreeSetSafetyLevel,
- fileBtreeBeginTrans,
- fileBtreeCommit,
- fileBtreeRollback,
- fileBtreeBeginCkpt,
- fileBtreeCommitCkpt,
- fileBtreeRollbackCkpt,
- fileBtreeCreateTable,
- fileBtreeCreateTable, /* Really sqliteBtreeCreateIndex() */
- fileBtreeDropTable,
- fileBtreeClearTable,
- fileBtreeCursor,
- fileBtreeGetMeta,
- fileBtreeUpdateMeta,
- fileBtreeIntegrityCheck,
- fileBtreeGetFilename,
- fileBtreeCopyFile,
- fileBtreePager,
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
- fileBtreePageDump,
-#endif
-};
-static BtCursorOps sqliteBtreeCursorOps = {
- fileBtreeMoveto,
- fileBtreeDelete,
- fileBtreeInsert,
- fileBtreeFirst,
- fileBtreeLast,
- fileBtreeNext,
- fileBtreePrevious,
- fileBtreeKeySize,
- fileBtreeKey,
- fileBtreeKeyCompare,
- fileBtreeDataSize,
- fileBtreeData,
- fileBtreeCloseCursor,
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
- fileBtreeCursorDump,
-#endif
-};
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 101d02e..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,156 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This header file defines the interface that the sqlite B-Tree file
-** subsystem. See comments in the source code for a detailed description
-** of what each interface routine does.
-**
-** @(#) $Id: btree.h,v 1.36 2004/02/10 02:57:59 drh Exp $
-*/
-#ifndef _BTREE_H_
-#define _BTREE_H_
-
-/*
-** Forward declarations of structure
-*/
-typedef struct Btree Btree;
-typedef struct BtCursor BtCursor;
-typedef struct BtOps BtOps;
-typedef struct BtCursorOps BtCursorOps;
-
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure contains pointers to all
-** methods against an open BTree. Alternative BTree implementations
-** (examples: file based versus in-memory) can be created by substituting
-** different methods. Users of the BTree cannot tell the difference.
-**
-** In C++ we could do this by defining a virtual base class and then
-** creating subclasses for each different implementation. But this is
-** C not C++ so we have to be a little more explicit.
-*/
-struct BtOps {
- int (*Close)(Btree*);
- int (*SetCacheSize)(Btree*, int);
- int (*SetSafetyLevel)(Btree*, int);
- int (*BeginTrans)(Btree*);
- int (*Commit)(Btree*);
- int (*Rollback)(Btree*);
- int (*BeginCkpt)(Btree*);
- int (*CommitCkpt)(Btree*);
- int (*RollbackCkpt)(Btree*);
- int (*CreateTable)(Btree*, int*);
- int (*CreateIndex)(Btree*, int*);
- int (*DropTable)(Btree*, int);
- int (*ClearTable)(Btree*, int);
- int (*Cursor)(Btree*, int iTable, int wrFlag, BtCursor **ppCur);
- int (*GetMeta)(Btree*, int*);
- int (*UpdateMeta)(Btree*, int*);
- char *(*IntegrityCheck)(Btree*, int*, int);
- const char *(*GetFilename)(Btree*);
- int (*Copyfile)(Btree*,Btree*);
- struct Pager *(*Pager)(Btree*);
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
- int (*PageDump)(Btree*, int, int);
-#endif
-};
-
-/*
-** An instance of this structure defines all of the methods that can
-** be executed against a cursor.
-*/
-struct BtCursorOps {
- int (*Moveto)(BtCursor*, const void *pKey, int nKey, int *pRes);
- int (*Delete)(BtCursor*);
- int (*Insert)(BtCursor*, const void *pKey, int nKey,
- const void *pData, int nData);
- int (*First)(BtCursor*, int *pRes);
- int (*Last)(BtCursor*, int *pRes);
- int (*Next)(BtCursor*, int *pRes);
- int (*Previous)(BtCursor*, int *pRes);
- int (*KeySize)(BtCursor*, int *pSize);
- int (*Key)(BtCursor*, int offset, int amt, char *zBuf);
- int (*KeyCompare)(BtCursor*, const void *pKey, int nKey,
- int nIgnore, int *pRes);
- int (*DataSize)(BtCursor*, int *pSize);
- int (*Data)(BtCursor*, int offset, int amt, char *zBuf);
- int (*CloseCursor)(BtCursor*);
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
- int (*CursorDump)(BtCursor*, int*);
-#endif
-};
-
-/*
-** The number of 4-byte "meta" values contained on the first page of each
-** database file.
-*/
-#define STQLITE_N_BTREE_META 10
-
-int sqliteBtreeOpen(const char *zFilename, int mode, int nPg, Btree **ppBtree);
-int sqliteRbtreeOpen(const char *zFilename, int mode, int nPg, Btree **ppBtree);
-
-#define btOps(pBt) (*((BtOps **)(pBt)))
-#define btCOps(pCur) (*((BtCursorOps **)(pCur)))
-
-#define sqliteBtreeClose(pBt) (btOps(pBt)->Close(pBt))
-#define sqliteBtreeSetCacheSize(pBt, sz) (btOps(pBt)->SetCacheSize(pBt, sz))
-#define sqliteBtreeSetSafetyLevel(pBt, sl) (btOps(pBt)->SetSafetyLevel(pBt, sl))
-#define sqliteBtreeBeginTrans(pBt) (btOps(pBt)->BeginTrans(pBt))
-#define sqliteBtreeCommit(pBt) (btOps(pBt)->Commit(pBt))
-#define sqliteBtreeRollback(pBt) (btOps(pBt)->Rollback(pBt))
-#define sqliteBtreeBeginCkpt(pBt) (btOps(pBt)->BeginCkpt(pBt))
-#define sqliteBtreeCommitCkpt(pBt) (btOps(pBt)->CommitCkpt(pBt))
-#define sqliteBtreeRollbackCkpt(pBt) (btOps(pBt)->RollbackCkpt(pBt))
-#define sqliteBtreeCreateTable(pBt,piTable)\
- (btOps(pBt)->CreateTable(pBt,piTable))
-#define sqliteBtreeCreateIndex(pBt, piIndex)\
- (btOps(pBt)->CreateIndex(pBt, piIndex))
-#define sqliteBtreeDropTable(pBt, iTable) (btOps(pBt)->DropTable(pBt, iTable))
-#define sqliteBtreeClearTable(pBt, iTable)\
- (btOps(pBt)->ClearTable(pBt, iTable))
-#define sqliteBtreeCursor(pBt, iTable, wrFlag, ppCur)\
- (btOps(pBt)->Cursor(pBt, iTable, wrFlag, ppCur))
-#define sqliteBtreeMoveto(pCur, pKey, nKey, pRes)\
- (btCOps(pCur)->Moveto(pCur, pKey, nKey, pRes))
-#define sqliteBtreeDelete(pCur) (btCOps(pCur)->Delete(pCur))
-#define sqliteBtreeInsert(pCur, pKey, nKey, pData, nData) \
- (btCOps(pCur)->Insert(pCur, pKey, nKey, pData, nData))
-#define sqliteBtreeFirst(pCur, pRes) (btCOps(pCur)->First(pCur, pRes))
-#define sqliteBtreeLast(pCur, pRes) (btCOps(pCur)->Last(pCur, pRes))
-#define sqliteBtreeNext(pCur, pRes) (btCOps(pCur)->Next(pCur, pRes))
-#define sqliteBtreePrevious(pCur, pRes) (btCOps(pCur)->Previous(pCur, pRes))
-#define sqliteBtreeKeySize(pCur, pSize) (btCOps(pCur)->KeySize(pCur, pSize) )
-#define sqliteBtreeKey(pCur, offset, amt, zBuf)\
- (btCOps(pCur)->Key(pCur, offset, amt, zBuf))
-#define sqliteBtreeKeyCompare(pCur, pKey, nKey, nIgnore, pRes)\
- (btCOps(pCur)->KeyCompare(pCur, pKey, nKey, nIgnore, pRes))
-#define sqliteBtreeDataSize(pCur, pSize) (btCOps(pCur)->DataSize(pCur, pSize))
-#define sqliteBtreeData(pCur, offset, amt, zBuf)\
- (btCOps(pCur)->Data(pCur, offset, amt, zBuf))
-#define sqliteBtreeCloseCursor(pCur) (btCOps(pCur)->CloseCursor(pCur))
-#define sqliteBtreeGetMeta(pBt, aMeta) (btOps(pBt)->GetMeta(pBt, aMeta))
-#define sqliteBtreeUpdateMeta(pBt, aMeta) (btOps(pBt)->UpdateMeta(pBt, aMeta))
-#define sqliteBtreeIntegrityCheck(pBt, aRoot, nRoot)\
- (btOps(pBt)->IntegrityCheck(pBt, aRoot, nRoot))
-#define sqliteBtreeGetFilename(pBt) (btOps(pBt)->GetFilename(pBt))
-#define sqliteBtreeCopyFile(pBt1, pBt2) (btOps(pBt1)->Copyfile(pBt1, pBt2))
-#define sqliteBtreePager(pBt) (btOps(pBt)->Pager(pBt))
-
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-#define sqliteBtreePageDump(pBt, pgno, recursive)\
- (btOps(pBt)->PageDump(pBt, pgno, recursive))
-#define sqliteBtreeCursorDump(pCur, aResult)\
- (btCOps(pCur)->CursorDump(pCur, aResult))
-int btree_native_byte_order;
-#endif /* STQLITE_TEST */
-
-
-#endif /* _BTREE_H_ */
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree_rb.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree_rb.c
deleted file mode 100644
index e952b7a..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/btree_rb.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1488 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2003 Feb 4
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** $Id: btree_rb.c,v 1.24 2004/02/29 00:11:31 drh Exp $
-**
-** This file implements an in-core database using Red-Black balanced
-** binary trees.
-**
-** It was contributed to STQLite by anonymous on 2003-Feb-04 23:24:49 UTC.
-*/
-#include "btree.h"
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include <assert.h>
-
-/*
-** Omit this whole file if the STQLITE_OMIT_INMEMORYDB macro is
-** defined. This allows a lot of code to be omitted for installations
-** that do not need it.
-*/
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_INMEMORYDB
-
-
-typedef struct BtRbTree BtRbTree;
-typedef struct BtRbNode BtRbNode;
-typedef struct BtRollbackOp BtRollbackOp;
-typedef struct Rbtree Rbtree;
-typedef struct RbtCursor RbtCursor;
-
-/* Forward declarations */
-static BtOps sqliteRbtreeOps;
-static BtCursorOps sqliteRbtreeCursorOps;
-
-/*
- * During each transaction (or checkpoint), a linked-list of
- * "rollback-operations" is accumulated. If the transaction is rolled back,
- * then the list of operations must be executed (to restore the database to
- * it's state before the transaction started). If the transaction is to be
- * committed, just delete the list.
- *
- * Each operation is represented as follows, depending on the value of eOp:
- *
- * ROLLBACK_INSERT -> Need to insert (pKey, pData) into table iTab.
- * ROLLBACK_DELETE -> Need to delete the record (pKey) into table iTab.
- * ROLLBACK_CREATE -> Need to create table iTab.
- * ROLLBACK_DROP -> Need to drop table iTab.
- */
-struct BtRollbackOp {
- u8 eOp;
- int iTab;
- int nKey;
- void *pKey;
- int nData;
- void *pData;
- BtRollbackOp *pNext;
-};
-
-/*
-** Legal values for BtRollbackOp.eOp:
-*/
-#define ROLLBACK_INSERT 1 /* Insert a record */
-#define ROLLBACK_DELETE 2 /* Delete a record */
-#define ROLLBACK_CREATE 3 /* Create a table */
-#define ROLLBACK_DROP 4 /* Drop a table */
-
-struct Rbtree {
- BtOps *pOps; /* Function table */
- int aMetaData[STQLITE_N_BTREE_META];
-
- int next_idx; /* next available table index */
- Hash tblHash; /* All created tables, by index */
- u8 isAnonymous; /* True if this Rbtree is to be deleted when closed */
- u8 eTransState; /* State of this Rbtree wrt transactions */
-
- BtRollbackOp *pTransRollback;
- BtRollbackOp *pCheckRollback;
- BtRollbackOp *pCheckRollbackTail;
-};
-
-/*
-** Legal values for Rbtree.eTransState.
-*/
-#define TRANS_NONE 0 /* No transaction is in progress */
-#define TRANS_INTRANSACTION 1 /* A transaction is in progress */
-#define TRANS_INCHECKPOINT 2 /* A checkpoint is in progress */
-#define TRANS_ROLLBACK 3 /* We are currently rolling back a checkpoint or
- * transaction. */
-
-struct RbtCursor {
- BtCursorOps *pOps; /* Function table */
- Rbtree *pRbtree;
- BtRbTree *pTree;
- int iTree; /* Index of pTree in pRbtree */
- BtRbNode *pNode;
- RbtCursor *pShared; /* List of all cursors on the same Rbtree */
- u8 eSkip; /* Determines if next step operation is a no-op */
- u8 wrFlag; /* True if this cursor is open for writing */
-};
-
-/*
-** Legal values for RbtCursor.eSkip.
-*/
-#define SKIP_NONE 0 /* Always step the cursor */
-#define SKIP_NEXT 1 /* The next sqliteRbtreeNext() is a no-op */
-#define SKIP_PREV 2 /* The next sqliteRbtreePrevious() is a no-op */
-#define SKIP_INVALID 3 /* Calls to Next() and Previous() are invalid */
-
-struct BtRbTree {
- RbtCursor *pCursors; /* All cursors pointing to this tree */
- BtRbNode *pHead; /* Head of the tree, or NULL */
-};
-
-struct BtRbNode {
- int nKey;
- void *pKey;
- int nData;
- void *pData;
- u8 isBlack; /* true for a black node, 0 for a red node */
- BtRbNode *pParent; /* Nodes parent node, NULL for the tree head */
- BtRbNode *pLeft; /* Nodes left child, or NULL */
- BtRbNode *pRight; /* Nodes right child, or NULL */
-
- int nBlackHeight; /* Only used during the red-black integrity check */
-};
-
-/* Forward declarations */
-static int memRbtreeMoveto(
- RbtCursor* pCur,
- const void *pKey,
- int nKey,
- int *pRes
-);
-static int memRbtreeClearTable(Rbtree* tree, int n);
-static int memRbtreeNext(RbtCursor* pCur, int *pRes);
-static int memRbtreeLast(RbtCursor* pCur, int *pRes);
-static int memRbtreePrevious(RbtCursor* pCur, int *pRes);
-
-
-/*
-** This routine checks all cursors that point to the same table
-** as pCur points to. If any of those cursors were opened with
-** wrFlag==0 then this routine returns STQLITE_LOCKED. If all
-** cursors point to the same table were opened with wrFlag==1
-** then this routine returns STQLITE_OK.
-**
-** In addition to checking for read-locks (where a read-lock
-** means a cursor opened with wrFlag==0) this routine also NULLs
-** out the pNode field of all other cursors.
-** This is necessary because an insert
-** or delete might change erase the node out from under
-** another cursor.
-*/
-static int checkReadLocks(RbtCursor *pCur){
- RbtCursor *p;
- assert( pCur->wrFlag );
- for(p=pCur->pTree->pCursors; p; p=p->pShared){
- if( p!=pCur ){
- if( p->wrFlag==0 ) return STQLITE_LOCKED;
- p->pNode = 0;
- }
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
- * The key-compare function for the red-black trees. Returns as follows:
- *
- * (key1 < key2) -1
- * (key1 == key2) 0
- * (key1 > key2) 1
- *
- * Keys are compared using memcmp(). If one key is an exact prefix of the
- * other, then the shorter key is less than the longer key.
- */
-static int key_compare(void const*pKey1, int nKey1, void const*pKey2, int nKey2)
-{
- int mcmp = memcmp(pKey1, pKey2, (nKey1 <= nKey2)?nKey1:nKey2);
- if( mcmp == 0){
- if( nKey1 == nKey2 ) return 0;
- return ((nKey1 < nKey2)?-1:1);
- }
- return ((mcmp>0)?1:-1);
-}
-
-/*
- * Perform the LEFT-rotate transformation on node X of tree pTree. This
- * transform is part of the red-black balancing code.
- *
- * | |
- * X Y
- * / \ / \
- * a Y X c
- * / \ / \
- * b c a b
- *
- * BEFORE AFTER
- */
-static void leftRotate(BtRbTree *pTree, BtRbNode *pX)
-{
- BtRbNode *pY;
- BtRbNode *pb;
- pY = pX->pRight;
- pb = pY->pLeft;
-
- pY->pParent = pX->pParent;
- if( pX->pParent ){
- if( pX->pParent->pLeft == pX ) pX->pParent->pLeft = pY;
- else pX->pParent->pRight = pY;
- }
- pY->pLeft = pX;
- pX->pParent = pY;
- pX->pRight = pb;
- if( pb ) pb->pParent = pX;
- if( pTree->pHead == pX ) pTree->pHead = pY;
-}
-
-/*
- * Perform the RIGHT-rotate transformation on node X of tree pTree. This
- * transform is part of the red-black balancing code.
- *
- * | |
- * X Y
- * / \ / \
- * Y c a X
- * / \ / \
- * a b b c
- *
- * BEFORE AFTER
- */
-static void rightRotate(BtRbTree *pTree, BtRbNode *pX)
-{
- BtRbNode *pY;
- BtRbNode *pb;
- pY = pX->pLeft;
- pb = pY->pRight;
-
- pY->pParent = pX->pParent;
- if( pX->pParent ){
- if( pX->pParent->pLeft == pX ) pX->pParent->pLeft = pY;
- else pX->pParent->pRight = pY;
- }
- pY->pRight = pX;
- pX->pParent = pY;
- pX->pLeft = pb;
- if( pb ) pb->pParent = pX;
- if( pTree->pHead == pX ) pTree->pHead = pY;
-}
-
-/*
- * A string-manipulation helper function for check_redblack_tree(). If (orig ==
- * NULL) a copy of val is returned. If (orig != NULL) then a copy of the *
- * concatenation of orig and val is returned. The original orig is deleted
- * (using sqliteFree()).
- */
-static char *append_val(char * orig, char const * val){
- char *z;
- if( !orig ){
- z = sqliteStrDup( val );
- } else{
- z = 0;
- sqliteSetString(&z, orig, val, (char*)0);
- sqliteFree( orig );
- }
- return z;
-}
-
-/*
- * Append a string representation of the entire node to orig and return it.
- * This is used to produce debugging information if check_redblack_tree() finds
- * a problem with a red-black binary tree.
- */
-static char *append_node(char * orig, BtRbNode *pNode, int indent)
-{
- char buf[128];
- int i;
-
- for( i=0; i<indent; i++ ){
- orig = append_val(orig, " ");
- }
-
- sprintf(buf, "%p", pNode);
- orig = append_val(orig, buf);
-
- if( pNode ){
- indent += 3;
- if( pNode->isBlack ){
- orig = append_val(orig, " B \n");
- }else{
- orig = append_val(orig, " R \n");
- }
- orig = append_node( orig, pNode->pLeft, indent );
- orig = append_node( orig, pNode->pRight, indent );
- }else{
- orig = append_val(orig, "\n");
- }
- return orig;
-}
-
-/*
- * Print a representation of a node to stdout. This function is only included
- * so you can call it from within a debugger if things get really bad. It
- * is not called from anyplace in the code.
- */
-static void print_node(BtRbNode *pNode)
-{
- char * str = append_node(0, pNode, 0);
- printf(str);
-
- /* Suppress a warning message about print_node() being unused */
- (void)print_node;
-}
-
-/*
- * Check the following properties of the red-black tree:
- * (1) - If a node is red, both of it's tqchildren are black
- * (2) - Each path from a given node to a leaf (NULL) node passes thru the
- * same number of black nodes
- *
- * If there is a problem, append a description (using append_val() ) to *msg.
- */
-static void check_redblack_tree(BtRbTree * tree, char ** msg)
-{
- BtRbNode *pNode;
-
- /* 0 -> came from parent
- * 1 -> came from left
- * 2 -> came from right */
- int prev_step = 0;
-
- pNode = tree->pHead;
- while( pNode ){
- switch( prev_step ){
- case 0:
- if( pNode->pLeft ){
- pNode = pNode->pLeft;
- }else{
- prev_step = 1;
- }
- break;
- case 1:
- if( pNode->pRight ){
- pNode = pNode->pRight;
- prev_step = 0;
- }else{
- prev_step = 2;
- }
- break;
- case 2:
- /* Check red-black property (1) */
- if( !pNode->isBlack &&
- ( (pNode->pLeft && !pNode->pLeft->isBlack) ||
- (pNode->pRight && !pNode->pRight->isBlack) )
- ){
- char buf[128];
- sprintf(buf, "Red node with red child at %p\n", pNode);
- *msg = append_val(*msg, buf);
- *msg = append_node(*msg, tree->pHead, 0);
- *msg = append_val(*msg, "\n");
- }
-
- /* Check red-black property (2) */
- {
- int leftHeight = 0;
- int rightHeight = 0;
- if( pNode->pLeft ){
- leftHeight += pNode->pLeft->nBlackHeight;
- leftHeight += (pNode->pLeft->isBlack?1:0);
- }
- if( pNode->pRight ){
- rightHeight += pNode->pRight->nBlackHeight;
- rightHeight += (pNode->pRight->isBlack?1:0);
- }
- if( leftHeight != rightHeight ){
- char buf[128];
- sprintf(buf, "Different black-heights at %p\n", pNode);
- *msg = append_val(*msg, buf);
- *msg = append_node(*msg, tree->pHead, 0);
- *msg = append_val(*msg, "\n");
- }
- pNode->nBlackHeight = leftHeight;
- }
-
- if( pNode->pParent ){
- if( pNode == pNode->pParent->pLeft ) prev_step = 1;
- else prev_step = 2;
- }
- pNode = pNode->pParent;
- break;
- default: assert(0);
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
- * Node pX has just been inserted into pTree (by code in sqliteRbtreeInsert()).
- * It is possible that pX is a red node with a red parent, which is a violation
- * of the red-black tree properties. This function performs rotations and
- * color changes to rebalance the tree
- */
-static void do_insert_balancing(BtRbTree *pTree, BtRbNode *pX)
-{
- /* In the first iteration of this loop, pX points to the red node just
- * inserted in the tree. If the parent of pX exists (pX is not the root
- * node) and is red, then the properties of the red-black tree are
- * violated.
- *
- * At the start of any subsequent iterations, pX points to a red node
- * with a red parent. In all other respects the tree is a legal red-black
- * binary tree. */
- while( pX != pTree->pHead && !pX->pParent->isBlack ){
- BtRbNode *pUncle;
- BtRbNode *pGrandparent;
-
- /* Grandparent of pX must exist and must be black. */
- pGrandparent = pX->pParent->pParent;
- assert( pGrandparent );
- assert( pGrandparent->isBlack );
-
- /* Uncle of pX may or may not exist. */
- if( pX->pParent == pGrandparent->pLeft )
- pUncle = pGrandparent->pRight;
- else
- pUncle = pGrandparent->pLeft;
-
- /* If the uncle of pX exists and is red, we do the following:
- * | |
- * G(b) G(r)
- * / \ / \
- * U(r) P(r) U(b) P(b)
- * \ \
- * X(r) X(r)
- *
- * BEFORE AFTER
- * pX is then set to G. If the parent of G is red, then the while loop
- * will run again. */
- if( pUncle && !pUncle->isBlack ){
- pGrandparent->isBlack = 0;
- pUncle->isBlack = 1;
- pX->pParent->isBlack = 1;
- pX = pGrandparent;
- }else{
-
- if( pX->pParent == pGrandparent->pLeft ){
- if( pX == pX->pParent->pRight ){
- /* If pX is a right-child, do the following transform, essentially
- * to change pX into a left-child:
- * | |
- * G(b) G(b)
- * / \ / \
- * P(r) U(b) X(r) U(b)
- * \ /
- * X(r) P(r) <-- new X
- *
- * BEFORE AFTER
- */
- pX = pX->pParent;
- leftRotate(pTree, pX);
- }
-
- /* Do the following transform, which balances the tree :)
- * | |
- * G(b) P(b)
- * / \ / \
- * P(r) U(b) X(r) G(r)
- * / \
- * X(r) U(b)
- *
- * BEFORE AFTER
- */
- assert( pGrandparent == pX->pParent->pParent );
- pGrandparent->isBlack = 0;
- pX->pParent->isBlack = 1;
- rightRotate( pTree, pGrandparent );
-
- }else{
- /* This code is symetric to the illustrated case above. */
- if( pX == pX->pParent->pLeft ){
- pX = pX->pParent;
- rightRotate(pTree, pX);
- }
- assert( pGrandparent == pX->pParent->pParent );
- pGrandparent->isBlack = 0;
- pX->pParent->isBlack = 1;
- leftRotate( pTree, pGrandparent );
- }
- }
- }
- pTree->pHead->isBlack = 1;
-}
-
-/*
- * A child of pParent, which in turn had child pX, has just been removed from
- * pTree (the figure below depicts the operation, Z is being removed). pParent
- * or pX, or both may be NULL.
- * | |
- * P P
- * / \ / \
- * Z X
- * / \
- * X nil
- *
- * This function is only called if Z was black. In this case the red-black tree
- * properties have been violated, and pX has an "extra black". This function
- * performs rotations and color-changes to re-balance the tree.
- */
-static
-void do_delete_balancing(BtRbTree *pTree, BtRbNode *pX, BtRbNode *pParent)
-{
- BtRbNode *pSib;
-
- /* TODO: Comment this code! */
- while( pX != pTree->pHead && (!pX || pX->isBlack) ){
- if( pX == pParent->pLeft ){
- pSib = pParent->pRight;
- if( pSib && !(pSib->isBlack) ){
- pSib->isBlack = 1;
- pParent->isBlack = 0;
- leftRotate(pTree, pParent);
- pSib = pParent->pRight;
- }
- if( !pSib ){
- pX = pParent;
- }else if(
- (!pSib->pLeft || pSib->pLeft->isBlack) &&
- (!pSib->pRight || pSib->pRight->isBlack) ) {
- pSib->isBlack = 0;
- pX = pParent;
- }else{
- if( (!pSib->pRight || pSib->pRight->isBlack) ){
- if( pSib->pLeft ) pSib->pLeft->isBlack = 1;
- pSib->isBlack = 0;
- rightRotate( pTree, pSib );
- pSib = pParent->pRight;
- }
- pSib->isBlack = pParent->isBlack;
- pParent->isBlack = 1;
- if( pSib->pRight ) pSib->pRight->isBlack = 1;
- leftRotate(pTree, pParent);
- pX = pTree->pHead;
- }
- }else{
- pSib = pParent->pLeft;
- if( pSib && !(pSib->isBlack) ){
- pSib->isBlack = 1;
- pParent->isBlack = 0;
- rightRotate(pTree, pParent);
- pSib = pParent->pLeft;
- }
- if( !pSib ){
- pX = pParent;
- }else if(
- (!pSib->pLeft || pSib->pLeft->isBlack) &&
- (!pSib->pRight || pSib->pRight->isBlack) ){
- pSib->isBlack = 0;
- pX = pParent;
- }else{
- if( (!pSib->pLeft || pSib->pLeft->isBlack) ){
- if( pSib->pRight ) pSib->pRight->isBlack = 1;
- pSib->isBlack = 0;
- leftRotate( pTree, pSib );
- pSib = pParent->pLeft;
- }
- pSib->isBlack = pParent->isBlack;
- pParent->isBlack = 1;
- if( pSib->pLeft ) pSib->pLeft->isBlack = 1;
- rightRotate(pTree, pParent);
- pX = pTree->pHead;
- }
- }
- pParent = pX->pParent;
- }
- if( pX ) pX->isBlack = 1;
-}
-
-/*
- * Create table n in tree pRbtree. Table n must not exist.
- */
-static void btreeCreateTable(Rbtree* pRbtree, int n)
-{
- BtRbTree *pNewTbl = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(BtRbTree));
- sqliteHashInsert(&pRbtree->tblHash, 0, n, pNewTbl);
-}
-
-/*
- * Log a single "rollback-op" for the given Rbtree. See comments for struct
- * BtRollbackOp.
- */
-static void btreeLogRollbackOp(Rbtree* pRbtree, BtRollbackOp *pRollbackOp)
-{
- assert( pRbtree->eTransState == TRANS_INCHECKPOINT ||
- pRbtree->eTransState == TRANS_INTRANSACTION );
- if( pRbtree->eTransState == TRANS_INTRANSACTION ){
- pRollbackOp->pNext = pRbtree->pTransRollback;
- pRbtree->pTransRollback = pRollbackOp;
- }
- if( pRbtree->eTransState == TRANS_INCHECKPOINT ){
- if( !pRbtree->pCheckRollback ){
- pRbtree->pCheckRollbackTail = pRollbackOp;
- }
- pRollbackOp->pNext = pRbtree->pCheckRollback;
- pRbtree->pCheckRollback = pRollbackOp;
- }
-}
-
-int sqliteRbtreeOpen(
- const char *zFilename,
- int mode,
- int nPg,
- Btree **ppBtree
-){
- Rbtree **ppRbtree = (Rbtree**)ppBtree;
- *ppRbtree = (Rbtree *)sqliteMalloc(sizeof(Rbtree));
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto open_no_mem;
- sqliteHashInit(&(*ppRbtree)->tblHash, STQLITE_HASH_INT, 0);
-
- /* Create a binary tree for the STQLITE_MASTER table at location 2 */
- btreeCreateTable(*ppRbtree, 2);
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto open_no_mem;
- (*ppRbtree)->next_idx = 3;
- (*ppRbtree)->pOps = &sqliteRbtreeOps;
- /* Set file type to 4; this is so that "attach ':memory:' as ...." does not
- ** think that the database in uninitialised and refuse to attach
- */
- (*ppRbtree)->aMetaData[2] = 4;
-
- return STQLITE_OK;
-
-open_no_mem:
- *ppBtree = 0;
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
-}
-
-/*
- * Create a new table in the supplied Rbtree. Set *n to the new table number.
- * Return STQLITE_OK if the operation is a success.
- */
-static int memRbtreeCreateTable(Rbtree* tree, int* n)
-{
- assert( tree->eTransState != TRANS_NONE );
-
- *n = tree->next_idx++;
- btreeCreateTable(tree, *n);
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
-
- /* Set up the rollback structure (if we are not doing this as part of a
- * rollback) */
- if( tree->eTransState != TRANS_ROLLBACK ){
- BtRollbackOp *pRollbackOp = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(BtRollbackOp));
- if( pRollbackOp==0 ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- pRollbackOp->eOp = ROLLBACK_DROP;
- pRollbackOp->iTab = *n;
- btreeLogRollbackOp(tree, pRollbackOp);
- }
-
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
- * Delete table n from the supplied Rbtree.
- */
-static int memRbtreeDropTable(Rbtree* tree, int n)
-{
- BtRbTree *pTree;
- assert( tree->eTransState != TRANS_NONE );
-
- memRbtreeClearTable(tree, n);
- pTree = sqliteHashInsert(&tree->tblHash, 0, n, 0);
- assert(pTree);
- assert( pTree->pCursors==0 );
- sqliteFree(pTree);
-
- if( tree->eTransState != TRANS_ROLLBACK ){
- BtRollbackOp *pRollbackOp = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(BtRollbackOp));
- if( pRollbackOp==0 ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- pRollbackOp->eOp = ROLLBACK_CREATE;
- pRollbackOp->iTab = n;
- btreeLogRollbackOp(tree, pRollbackOp);
- }
-
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeKeyCompare(RbtCursor* pCur, const void *pKey, int nKey,
- int nIgnore, int *pRes)
-{
- assert(pCur);
-
- if( !pCur->pNode ) {
- *pRes = -1;
- } else {
- if( (pCur->pNode->nKey - nIgnore) < 0 ){
- *pRes = -1;
- }else{
- *pRes = key_compare(pCur->pNode->pKey, pCur->pNode->nKey-nIgnore,
- pKey, nKey);
- }
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
- * Get a new cursor for table iTable of the supplied Rbtree. The wrFlag
- * parameter indicates that the cursor is open for writing.
- *
- * Note that RbtCursor.eSkip and RbtCursor.pNode both initialize to 0.
- */
-static int memRbtreeCursor(
- Rbtree* tree,
- int iTable,
- int wrFlag,
- RbtCursor **ppCur
-){
- RbtCursor *pCur;
- assert(tree);
- pCur = *ppCur = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(RbtCursor));
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- pCur->pTree = sqliteHashFind(&tree->tblHash, 0, iTable);
- assert( pCur->pTree );
- pCur->pRbtree = tree;
- pCur->iTree = iTable;
- pCur->pOps = &sqliteRbtreeCursorOps;
- pCur->wrFlag = wrFlag;
- pCur->pShared = pCur->pTree->pCursors;
- pCur->pTree->pCursors = pCur;
-
- assert( (*ppCur)->pTree );
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
- * Insert a new record into the Rbtree. The key is given by (pKey,nKey)
- * and the data is given by (pData,nData). The cursor is used only to
- * define what database the record should be inserted into. The cursor
- * is left pointing at the new record.
- *
- * If the key exists already in the tree, just replace the data.
- */
-static int memRbtreeInsert(
- RbtCursor* pCur,
- const void *pKey,
- int nKey,
- const void *pDataInput,
- int nData
-){
- void * pData;
- int match;
-
- /* It is illegal to call sqliteRbtreeInsert() if we are
- ** not in a transaction */
- assert( pCur->pRbtree->eTransState != TRANS_NONE );
-
- /* Make sure some other cursor isn't trying to read this same table */
- if( checkReadLocks(pCur) ){
- return STQLITE_LOCKED; /* The table pCur points to has a read lock */
- }
-
- /* Take a copy of the input data now, in case we need it for the
- * replace case */
- pData = sqliteMallocRaw(nData);
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- memcpy(pData, pDataInput, nData);
-
- /* Move the cursor to a node near the key to be inserted. If the key already
- * exists in the table, then (match == 0). In this case we can just replace
- * the data associated with the entry, we don't need to manipulate the tree.
- *
- * If there is no exact match, then the cursor points at what would be either
- * the predecessor (match == -1) or successor (match == 1) of the
- * searched-for key, were it to be inserted. The new node becomes a child of
- * this node.
- *
- * The new node is initially red.
- */
- memRbtreeMoveto( pCur, pKey, nKey, &match);
- if( match ){
- BtRbNode *pNode = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(BtRbNode));
- if( pNode==0 ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- pNode->nKey = nKey;
- pNode->pKey = sqliteMallocRaw(nKey);
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- memcpy(pNode->pKey, pKey, nKey);
- pNode->nData = nData;
- pNode->pData = pData;
- if( pCur->pNode ){
- switch( match ){
- case -1:
- assert( !pCur->pNode->pRight );
- pNode->pParent = pCur->pNode;
- pCur->pNode->pRight = pNode;
- break;
- case 1:
- assert( !pCur->pNode->pLeft );
- pNode->pParent = pCur->pNode;
- pCur->pNode->pLeft = pNode;
- break;
- default:
- assert(0);
- }
- }else{
- pCur->pTree->pHead = pNode;
- }
-
- /* Point the cursor at the node just inserted, as per STQLite requirements */
- pCur->pNode = pNode;
-
- /* A new node has just been inserted, so run the balancing code */
- do_insert_balancing(pCur->pTree, pNode);
-
- /* Set up a rollback-op in case we have to roll this operation back */
- if( pCur->pRbtree->eTransState != TRANS_ROLLBACK ){
- BtRollbackOp *pOp = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(BtRollbackOp) );
- if( pOp==0 ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- pOp->eOp = ROLLBACK_DELETE;
- pOp->iTab = pCur->iTree;
- pOp->nKey = pNode->nKey;
- pOp->pKey = sqliteMallocRaw( pOp->nKey );
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- memcpy( pOp->pKey, pNode->pKey, pOp->nKey );
- btreeLogRollbackOp(pCur->pRbtree, pOp);
- }
-
- }else{
- /* No need to insert a new node in the tree, as the key already exists.
- * Just clobber the current nodes data. */
-
- /* Set up a rollback-op in case we have to roll this operation back */
- if( pCur->pRbtree->eTransState != TRANS_ROLLBACK ){
- BtRollbackOp *pOp = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(BtRollbackOp) );
- if( pOp==0 ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- pOp->iTab = pCur->iTree;
- pOp->nKey = pCur->pNode->nKey;
- pOp->pKey = sqliteMallocRaw( pOp->nKey );
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- memcpy( pOp->pKey, pCur->pNode->pKey, pOp->nKey );
- pOp->nData = pCur->pNode->nData;
- pOp->pData = pCur->pNode->pData;
- pOp->eOp = ROLLBACK_INSERT;
- btreeLogRollbackOp(pCur->pRbtree, pOp);
- }else{
- sqliteFree( pCur->pNode->pData );
- }
-
- /* Actually clobber the nodes data */
- pCur->pNode->pData = pData;
- pCur->pNode->nData = nData;
- }
-
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/* Move the cursor so that it points to an entry near pKey.
-** Return a success code.
-**
-** *pRes<0 The cursor is left pointing at an entry that
-** is smaller than pKey or if the table is empty
-** and the cursor is therefore left point to nothing.
-**
-** *pRes==0 The cursor is left pointing at an entry that
-** exactly matches pKey.
-**
-** *pRes>0 The cursor is left pointing at an entry that
-** is larger than pKey.
-*/
-static int memRbtreeMoveto(
- RbtCursor* pCur,
- const void *pKey,
- int nKey,
- int *pRes
-){
- BtRbNode *pTmp = 0;
-
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pTree->pHead;
- *pRes = -1;
- while( pCur->pNode && *pRes ) {
- *pRes = key_compare(pCur->pNode->pKey, pCur->pNode->nKey, pKey, nKey);
- pTmp = pCur->pNode;
- switch( *pRes ){
- case 1: /* cursor > key */
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pNode->pLeft;
- break;
- case -1: /* cursor < key */
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pNode->pRight;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- /* If (pCur->pNode == NULL), then we have failed to find a match. Set
- * pCur->pNode to pTmp, which is either NULL (if the tree is empty) or the
- * last node traversed in the search. In either case the relation ship
- * between pTmp and the searched for key is already stored in *pRes. pTmp is
- * either the successor or predecessor of the key we tried to move to. */
- if( !pCur->pNode ) pCur->pNode = pTmp;
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
-
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-
-/*
-** Delete the entry that the cursor is pointing to.
-**
-** The cursor is left pointing at either the next or the previous
-** entry. If the cursor is left pointing to the next entry, then
-** the pCur->eSkip flag is set to SKIP_NEXT which forces the next call to
-** sqliteRbtreeNext() to be a no-op. That way, you can always call
-** sqliteRbtreeNext() after a delete and the cursor will be left
-** pointing to the first entry after the deleted entry. Similarly,
-** pCur->eSkip is set to SKIP_PREV is the cursor is left pointing to
-** the entry prior to the deleted entry so that a subsequent call to
-** sqliteRbtreePrevious() will always leave the cursor pointing at the
-** entry immediately before the one that was deleted.
-*/
-static int memRbtreeDelete(RbtCursor* pCur)
-{
- BtRbNode *pZ; /* The one being deleted */
- BtRbNode *pChild; /* The child of the spliced out node */
-
- /* It is illegal to call sqliteRbtreeDelete() if we are
- ** not in a transaction */
- assert( pCur->pRbtree->eTransState != TRANS_NONE );
-
- /* Make sure some other cursor isn't trying to read this same table */
- if( checkReadLocks(pCur) ){
- return STQLITE_LOCKED; /* The table pCur points to has a read lock */
- }
-
- pZ = pCur->pNode;
- if( !pZ ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
-
- /* If we are not currently doing a rollback, set up a rollback op for this
- * deletion */
- if( pCur->pRbtree->eTransState != TRANS_ROLLBACK ){
- BtRollbackOp *pOp = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(BtRollbackOp) );
- if( pOp==0 ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- pOp->iTab = pCur->iTree;
- pOp->nKey = pZ->nKey;
- pOp->pKey = pZ->pKey;
- pOp->nData = pZ->nData;
- pOp->pData = pZ->pData;
- pOp->eOp = ROLLBACK_INSERT;
- btreeLogRollbackOp(pCur->pRbtree, pOp);
- }
-
- /* First do a standard binary-tree delete (node pZ is to be deleted). How
- * to do this depends on how many tqchildren pZ has:
- *
- * If pZ has no tqchildren or one child, then splice out pZ. If pZ has two
- * tqchildren, splice out the successor of pZ and replace the key and data of
- * pZ with the key and data of the spliced out successor. */
- if( pZ->pLeft && pZ->pRight ){
- BtRbNode *pTmp;
- int dummy;
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- memRbtreeNext(pCur, &dummy);
- assert( dummy == 0 );
- if( pCur->pRbtree->eTransState == TRANS_ROLLBACK ){
- sqliteFree(pZ->pKey);
- sqliteFree(pZ->pData);
- }
- pZ->pData = pCur->pNode->pData;
- pZ->nData = pCur->pNode->nData;
- pZ->pKey = pCur->pNode->pKey;
- pZ->nKey = pCur->pNode->nKey;
- pTmp = pZ;
- pZ = pCur->pNode;
- pCur->pNode = pTmp;
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NEXT;
- }else{
- int res;
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- memRbtreeNext(pCur, &res);
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NEXT;
- if( res ){
- memRbtreeLast(pCur, &res);
- memRbtreePrevious(pCur, &res);
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_PREV;
- }
- if( pCur->pRbtree->eTransState == TRANS_ROLLBACK ){
- sqliteFree(pZ->pKey);
- sqliteFree(pZ->pData);
- }
- }
-
- /* pZ now points at the node to be spliced out. This block does the
- * splicing. */
- {
- BtRbNode **ppParentSlot = 0;
- assert( !pZ->pLeft || !pZ->pRight ); /* pZ has at most one child */
- pChild = ((pZ->pLeft)?pZ->pLeft:pZ->pRight);
- if( pZ->pParent ){
- assert( pZ == pZ->pParent->pLeft || pZ == pZ->pParent->pRight );
- ppParentSlot = ((pZ == pZ->pParent->pLeft)
- ?&pZ->pParent->pLeft:&pZ->pParent->pRight);
- *ppParentSlot = pChild;
- }else{
- pCur->pTree->pHead = pChild;
- }
- if( pChild ) pChild->pParent = pZ->pParent;
- }
-
- /* pZ now points at the spliced out node. pChild is the only child of pZ, or
- * NULL if pZ has no tqchildren. If pZ is black, and not the tree root, then we
- * will have violated the "same number of black nodes in every path to a
- * leaf" property of the red-black tree. The code in do_delete_balancing()
- * repairs this. */
- if( pZ->isBlack ){
- do_delete_balancing(pCur->pTree, pChild, pZ->pParent);
- }
-
- sqliteFree(pZ);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
- * Empty table n of the Rbtree.
- */
-static int memRbtreeClearTable(Rbtree* tree, int n)
-{
- BtRbTree *pTree;
- BtRbNode *pNode;
-
- pTree = sqliteHashFind(&tree->tblHash, 0, n);
- assert(pTree);
-
- pNode = pTree->pHead;
- while( pNode ){
- if( pNode->pLeft ){
- pNode = pNode->pLeft;
- }
- else if( pNode->pRight ){
- pNode = pNode->pRight;
- }
- else {
- BtRbNode *pTmp = pNode->pParent;
- if( tree->eTransState == TRANS_ROLLBACK ){
- sqliteFree( pNode->pKey );
- sqliteFree( pNode->pData );
- }else{
- BtRollbackOp *pRollbackOp = sqliteMallocRaw(sizeof(BtRollbackOp));
- if( pRollbackOp==0 ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- pRollbackOp->eOp = ROLLBACK_INSERT;
- pRollbackOp->iTab = n;
- pRollbackOp->nKey = pNode->nKey;
- pRollbackOp->pKey = pNode->pKey;
- pRollbackOp->nData = pNode->nData;
- pRollbackOp->pData = pNode->pData;
- btreeLogRollbackOp(tree, pRollbackOp);
- }
- sqliteFree( pNode );
- if( pTmp ){
- if( pTmp->pLeft == pNode ) pTmp->pLeft = 0;
- else if( pTmp->pRight == pNode ) pTmp->pRight = 0;
- }
- pNode = pTmp;
- }
- }
-
- pTree->pHead = 0;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeFirst(RbtCursor* pCur, int *pRes)
-{
- if( pCur->pTree->pHead ){
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pTree->pHead;
- while( pCur->pNode->pLeft ){
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pNode->pLeft;
- }
- }
- if( pCur->pNode ){
- *pRes = 0;
- }else{
- *pRes = 1;
- }
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeLast(RbtCursor* pCur, int *pRes)
-{
- if( pCur->pTree->pHead ){
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pTree->pHead;
- while( pCur->pNode->pRight ){
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pNode->pRight;
- }
- }
- if( pCur->pNode ){
- *pRes = 0;
- }else{
- *pRes = 1;
- }
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Advance the cursor to the next entry in the database. If
-** successful then set *pRes=0. If the cursor
-** was already pointing to the last entry in the database before
-** this routine was called, then set *pRes=1.
-*/
-static int memRbtreeNext(RbtCursor* pCur, int *pRes)
-{
- if( pCur->pNode && pCur->eSkip != SKIP_NEXT ){
- if( pCur->pNode->pRight ){
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pNode->pRight;
- while( pCur->pNode->pLeft )
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pNode->pLeft;
- }else{
- BtRbNode * pX = pCur->pNode;
- pCur->pNode = pX->pParent;
- while( pCur->pNode && (pCur->pNode->pRight == pX) ){
- pX = pCur->pNode;
- pCur->pNode = pX->pParent;
- }
- }
- }
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
-
- if( !pCur->pNode ){
- *pRes = 1;
- }else{
- *pRes = 0;
- }
-
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreePrevious(RbtCursor* pCur, int *pRes)
-{
- if( pCur->pNode && pCur->eSkip != SKIP_PREV ){
- if( pCur->pNode->pLeft ){
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pNode->pLeft;
- while( pCur->pNode->pRight )
- pCur->pNode = pCur->pNode->pRight;
- }else{
- BtRbNode * pX = pCur->pNode;
- pCur->pNode = pX->pParent;
- while( pCur->pNode && (pCur->pNode->pLeft == pX) ){
- pX = pCur->pNode;
- pCur->pNode = pX->pParent;
- }
- }
- }
- pCur->eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
-
- if( !pCur->pNode ){
- *pRes = 1;
- }else{
- *pRes = 0;
- }
-
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeKeySize(RbtCursor* pCur, int *pSize)
-{
- if( pCur->pNode ){
- *pSize = pCur->pNode->nKey;
- }else{
- *pSize = 0;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeKey(RbtCursor* pCur, int offset, int amt, char *zBuf)
-{
- if( !pCur->pNode ) return 0;
- if( !pCur->pNode->pKey || ((amt + offset) <= pCur->pNode->nKey) ){
- memcpy(zBuf, ((char*)pCur->pNode->pKey)+offset, amt);
- }else{
- memcpy(zBuf, ((char*)pCur->pNode->pKey)+offset, pCur->pNode->nKey-offset);
- amt = pCur->pNode->nKey-offset;
- }
- return amt;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeDataSize(RbtCursor* pCur, int *pSize)
-{
- if( pCur->pNode ){
- *pSize = pCur->pNode->nData;
- }else{
- *pSize = 0;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeData(RbtCursor *pCur, int offset, int amt, char *zBuf)
-{
- if( !pCur->pNode ) return 0;
- if( (amt + offset) <= pCur->pNode->nData ){
- memcpy(zBuf, ((char*)pCur->pNode->pData)+offset, amt);
- }else{
- memcpy(zBuf, ((char*)pCur->pNode->pData)+offset ,pCur->pNode->nData-offset);
- amt = pCur->pNode->nData-offset;
- }
- return amt;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeCloseCursor(RbtCursor* pCur)
-{
- if( pCur->pTree->pCursors==pCur ){
- pCur->pTree->pCursors = pCur->pShared;
- }else{
- RbtCursor *p = pCur->pTree->pCursors;
- while( p && p->pShared!=pCur ){ p = p->pShared; }
- assert( p!=0 );
- if( p ){
- p->pShared = pCur->pShared;
- }
- }
- sqliteFree(pCur);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeGetMeta(Rbtree* tree, int* aMeta)
-{
- memcpy( aMeta, tree->aMetaData, sizeof(int) * STQLITE_N_BTREE_META );
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeUpdateMeta(Rbtree* tree, int* aMeta)
-{
- memcpy( tree->aMetaData, aMeta, sizeof(int) * STQLITE_N_BTREE_META );
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
- * Check that each table in the Rbtree meets the requirements for a red-black
- * binary tree. If an error is found, return an explanation of the problem in
- * memory obtained from sqliteMalloc(). Parameters aRoot and nRoot are ignored.
- */
-static char *memRbtreeIntegrityCheck(Rbtree* tree, int* aRoot, int nRoot)
-{
- char * msg = 0;
- HashElem *p;
-
- for(p=sqliteHashFirst(&tree->tblHash); p; p=sqliteHashNext(p)){
- BtRbTree *pTree = sqliteHashData(p);
- check_redblack_tree(pTree, &msg);
- }
-
- return msg;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeSetCacheSize(Rbtree* tree, int sz)
-{
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeSetSafetyLevel(Rbtree *pBt, int level){
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeBeginTrans(Rbtree* tree)
-{
- if( tree->eTransState != TRANS_NONE )
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
-
- assert( tree->pTransRollback == 0 );
- tree->eTransState = TRANS_INTRANSACTION;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Delete a linked list of BtRollbackOp structures.
-*/
-static void deleteRollbackList(BtRollbackOp *pOp){
- while( pOp ){
- BtRollbackOp *pTmp = pOp->pNext;
- sqliteFree(pOp->pData);
- sqliteFree(pOp->pKey);
- sqliteFree(pOp);
- pOp = pTmp;
- }
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeCommit(Rbtree* tree){
- /* Just delete pTransRollback and pCheckRollback */
- deleteRollbackList(tree->pCheckRollback);
- deleteRollbackList(tree->pTransRollback);
- tree->pTransRollback = 0;
- tree->pCheckRollback = 0;
- tree->pCheckRollbackTail = 0;
- tree->eTransState = TRANS_NONE;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
- * Close the supplied Rbtree. Delete everything associated with it.
- */
-static int memRbtreeClose(Rbtree* tree)
-{
- HashElem *p;
- memRbtreeCommit(tree);
- while( (p=sqliteHashFirst(&tree->tblHash))!=0 ){
- tree->eTransState = TRANS_ROLLBACK;
- memRbtreeDropTable(tree, sqliteHashKeysize(p));
- }
- sqliteHashClear(&tree->tblHash);
- sqliteFree(tree);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
- * Execute and delete the supplied rollback-list on pRbtree.
- */
-static void execute_rollback_list(Rbtree *pRbtree, BtRollbackOp *pList)
-{
- BtRollbackOp *pTmp;
- RbtCursor cur;
- int res;
-
- cur.pRbtree = pRbtree;
- cur.wrFlag = 1;
- while( pList ){
- switch( pList->eOp ){
- case ROLLBACK_INSERT:
- cur.pTree = sqliteHashFind( &pRbtree->tblHash, 0, pList->iTab );
- assert(cur.pTree);
- cur.iTree = pList->iTab;
- cur.eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- memRbtreeInsert( &cur, pList->pKey,
- pList->nKey, pList->pData, pList->nData );
- break;
- case ROLLBACK_DELETE:
- cur.pTree = sqliteHashFind( &pRbtree->tblHash, 0, pList->iTab );
- assert(cur.pTree);
- cur.iTree = pList->iTab;
- cur.eSkip = SKIP_NONE;
- memRbtreeMoveto(&cur, pList->pKey, pList->nKey, &res);
- assert(res == 0);
- memRbtreeDelete( &cur );
- break;
- case ROLLBACK_CREATE:
- btreeCreateTable(pRbtree, pList->iTab);
- break;
- case ROLLBACK_DROP:
- memRbtreeDropTable(pRbtree, pList->iTab);
- break;
- default:
- assert(0);
- }
- sqliteFree(pList->pKey);
- sqliteFree(pList->pData);
- pTmp = pList->pNext;
- sqliteFree(pList);
- pList = pTmp;
- }
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeRollback(Rbtree* tree)
-{
- tree->eTransState = TRANS_ROLLBACK;
- execute_rollback_list(tree, tree->pCheckRollback);
- execute_rollback_list(tree, tree->pTransRollback);
- tree->pTransRollback = 0;
- tree->pCheckRollback = 0;
- tree->pCheckRollbackTail = 0;
- tree->eTransState = TRANS_NONE;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeBeginCkpt(Rbtree* tree)
-{
- if( tree->eTransState != TRANS_INTRANSACTION )
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
-
- assert( tree->pCheckRollback == 0 );
- assert( tree->pCheckRollbackTail == 0 );
- tree->eTransState = TRANS_INCHECKPOINT;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeCommitCkpt(Rbtree* tree)
-{
- if( tree->eTransState == TRANS_INCHECKPOINT ){
- if( tree->pCheckRollback ){
- tree->pCheckRollbackTail->pNext = tree->pTransRollback;
- tree->pTransRollback = tree->pCheckRollback;
- tree->pCheckRollback = 0;
- tree->pCheckRollbackTail = 0;
- }
- tree->eTransState = TRANS_INTRANSACTION;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeRollbackCkpt(Rbtree* tree)
-{
- if( tree->eTransState != TRANS_INCHECKPOINT ) return STQLITE_OK;
- tree->eTransState = TRANS_ROLLBACK;
- execute_rollback_list(tree, tree->pCheckRollback);
- tree->pCheckRollback = 0;
- tree->pCheckRollbackTail = 0;
- tree->eTransState = TRANS_INTRANSACTION;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-static int memRbtreePageDump(Rbtree* tree, int pgno, int rec)
-{
- assert(!"Cannot call sqliteRbtreePageDump");
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-static int memRbtreeCursorDump(RbtCursor* pCur, int* aRes)
-{
- assert(!"Cannot call sqliteRbtreeCursorDump");
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-#endif
-
-static struct Pager *memRbtreePager(Rbtree* tree)
-{
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the full pathname of the underlying database file.
-*/
-static const char *memRbtreeGetFilename(Rbtree *pBt){
- return 0; /* A NULL return indicates there is no underlying file */
-}
-
-/*
-** The copy file function is not implemented for the in-memory database
-*/
-static int memRbtreeCopyFile(Rbtree *pBt, Rbtree *pBt2){
- return STQLITE_INTERNAL; /* Not implemented */
-}
-
-static BtOps sqliteRbtreeOps = {
- (int(*)(Btree*)) memRbtreeClose,
- (int(*)(Btree*,int)) memRbtreeSetCacheSize,
- (int(*)(Btree*,int)) memRbtreeSetSafetyLevel,
- (int(*)(Btree*)) memRbtreeBeginTrans,
- (int(*)(Btree*)) memRbtreeCommit,
- (int(*)(Btree*)) memRbtreeRollback,
- (int(*)(Btree*)) memRbtreeBeginCkpt,
- (int(*)(Btree*)) memRbtreeCommitCkpt,
- (int(*)(Btree*)) memRbtreeRollbackCkpt,
- (int(*)(Btree*,int*)) memRbtreeCreateTable,
- (int(*)(Btree*,int*)) memRbtreeCreateTable,
- (int(*)(Btree*,int)) memRbtreeDropTable,
- (int(*)(Btree*,int)) memRbtreeClearTable,
- (int(*)(Btree*,int,int,BtCursor**)) memRbtreeCursor,
- (int(*)(Btree*,int*)) memRbtreeGetMeta,
- (int(*)(Btree*,int*)) memRbtreeUpdateMeta,
- (char*(*)(Btree*,int*,int)) memRbtreeIntegrityCheck,
- (const char*(*)(Btree*)) memRbtreeGetFilename,
- (int(*)(Btree*,Btree*)) memRbtreeCopyFile,
- (struct Pager*(*)(Btree*)) memRbtreePager,
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
- (int(*)(Btree*,int,int)) memRbtreePageDump,
-#endif
-};
-
-static BtCursorOps sqliteRbtreeCursorOps = {
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,const void*,int,int*)) memRbtreeMoveto,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*)) memRbtreeDelete,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,const void*,int,const void*,int)) memRbtreeInsert,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,int*)) memRbtreeFirst,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,int*)) memRbtreeLast,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,int*)) memRbtreeNext,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,int*)) memRbtreePrevious,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,int*)) memRbtreeKeySize,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,int,int,char*)) memRbtreeKey,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,const void*,int,int,int*)) memRbtreeKeyCompare,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,int*)) memRbtreeDataSize,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,int,int,char*)) memRbtreeData,
- (int(*)(BtCursor*)) memRbtreeCloseCursor,
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
- (int(*)(BtCursor*,int*)) memRbtreeCursorDump,
-#endif
-
-};
-
-#endif /* STQLITE_OMIT_INMEMORYDB */
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/build.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/build.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 86d079d..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/build.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2157 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains C code routines that are called by the STQLite parser
-** when syntax rules are reduced. The routines in this file handle the
-** following kinds of SQL syntax:
-**
-** CREATE TABLE
-** DROP TABLE
-** CREATE INDEX
-** DROP INDEX
-** creating ID lists
-** BEGIN TRANSACTION
-** COMMIT
-** ROLLBACK
-** PRAGMA
-**
-** $Id: build.c,v 1.175 2004/02/24 01:04:12 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include <ctype.h>
-
-/*
-** This routine is called when a new SQL statement is beginning to
-** be parsed. Check to see if the schema for the database needs
-** to be read from the STQLITE_MASTER and STQLITE_TEMP_MASTER tables.
-** If it does, then read it.
-*/
-void sqliteBeginParse(Parse *pParse, int explainFlag){
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- int i;
- pParse->explain = explainFlag;
- if((db->flags & STQLITE_Initialized)==0 && db->init.busy==0 ){
- int rc = sqliteInit(db, &pParse->zErrMsg);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- pParse->rc = rc;
- pParse->nErr++;
- }
- }
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- DbClearProperty(db, i, DB_Locked);
- if( !db->aDb[i].inTrans ){
- DbClearProperty(db, i, DB_Cookie);
- }
- }
- pParse->nVar = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called after a single SQL statement has been
-** parsed and we want to execute the VDBE code to implement
-** that statement. Prior action routines should have already
-** constructed VDBE code to do the work of the SQL statement.
-** This routine just has to execute the VDBE code.
-**
-** Note that if an error occurred, it might be the case that
-** no VDBE code was generated.
-*/
-void sqliteExec(Parse *pParse){
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- Vdbe *v = pParse->pVdbe;
-
- if( v==0 && (v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse))!=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Halt, 0, 0);
- }
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) return;
- if( v && pParse->nErr==0 ){
- FILE *trace = (db->flags & STQLITE_VdbeTrace)!=0 ? stdout : 0;
- sqliteVdbeTrace(v, trace);
- sqliteVdbeMakeReady(v, pParse->nVar, pParse->explain);
- pParse->rc = pParse->nErr ? STQLITE_ERROR : STQLITE_DONE;
- pParse->colNamesSet = 0;
- }else if( pParse->rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- pParse->nTab = 0;
- pParse->nMem = 0;
- pParse->nSet = 0;
- pParse->nAgg = 0;
- pParse->nVar = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Locate the in-memory structure that describes
-** a particular database table given the name
-** of that table and (optionally) the name of the database
-** containing the table. Return NULL if not found.
-**
-** If zDatabase is 0, all databases are searched for the
-** table and the first matching table is returned. (No checking
-** for duplicate table names is done.) The search order is
-** TEMP first, then MAIN, then any auxiliary databases added
-** using the ATTACH command.
-**
-** See also sqliteLocateTable().
-*/
-Table *sqliteFindTable(sqlite *db, const char *zName, const char *zDatabase){
- Table *p = 0;
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- int j = (i<2) ? i^1 : i; /* Search TEMP before MAIN */
- if( zDatabase!=0 && sqliteStrICmp(zDatabase, db->aDb[j].zName) ) continue;
- p = sqliteHashFind(&db->aDb[j].tblHash, zName, strlen(zName)+1);
- if( p ) break;
- }
- return p;
-}
-
-/*
-** Locate the in-memory structure that describes
-** a particular database table given the name
-** of that table and (optionally) the name of the database
-** containing the table. Return NULL if not found.
-** Also leave an error message in pParse->zErrMsg.
-**
-** The difference between this routine and sqliteFindTable()
-** is that this routine leaves an error message in pParse->zErrMsg
-** where sqliteFindTable() does not.
-*/
-Table *sqliteLocateTable(Parse *pParse, const char *zName, const char *zDbase){
- Table *p;
-
- p = sqliteFindTable(pParse->db, zName, zDbase);
- if( p==0 ){
- if( zDbase ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "no such table: %s.%s", zDbase, zName);
- }else if( sqliteFindTable(pParse->db, zName, 0)!=0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "table \"%s\" is not in database \"%s\"",
- zName, zDbase);
- }else{
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "no such table: %s", zName);
- }
- }
- return p;
-}
-
-/*
-** Locate the in-memory structure that describes
-** a particular index given the name of that index
-** and the name of the database that contains the index.
-** Return NULL if not found.
-**
-** If zDatabase is 0, all databases are searched for the
-** table and the first matching index is returned. (No checking
-** for duplicate index names is done.) The search order is
-** TEMP first, then MAIN, then any auxiliary databases added
-** using the ATTACH command.
-*/
-Index *sqliteFindIndex(sqlite *db, const char *zName, const char *zDb){
- Index *p = 0;
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- int j = (i<2) ? i^1 : i; /* Search TEMP before MAIN */
- if( zDb && sqliteStrICmp(zDb, db->aDb[j].zName) ) continue;
- p = sqliteHashFind(&db->aDb[j].idxHash, zName, strlen(zName)+1);
- if( p ) break;
- }
- return p;
-}
-
-/*
-** Remove the given index from the index hash table, and free
-** its memory structures.
-**
-** The index is removed from the database hash tables but
-** it is not unlinked from the Table that it indexes.
-** Unlinking from the Table must be done by the calling function.
-*/
-static void sqliteDeleteIndex(sqlite *db, Index *p){
- Index *pOld;
-
- assert( db!=0 && p->zName!=0 );
- pOld = sqliteHashInsert(&db->aDb[p->iDb].idxHash, p->zName,
- strlen(p->zName)+1, 0);
- if( pOld!=0 && pOld!=p ){
- sqliteHashInsert(&db->aDb[p->iDb].idxHash, pOld->zName,
- strlen(pOld->zName)+1, pOld);
- }
- sqliteFree(p);
-}
-
-/*
-** Unlink the given index from its table, then remove
-** the index from the index hash table and free its memory
-** structures.
-*/
-void sqliteUnlinkAndDeleteIndex(sqlite *db, Index *pIndex){
- if( pIndex->pTable->pIndex==pIndex ){
- pIndex->pTable->pIndex = pIndex->pNext;
- }else{
- Index *p;
- for(p=pIndex->pTable->pIndex; p && p->pNext!=pIndex; p=p->pNext){}
- if( p && p->pNext==pIndex ){
- p->pNext = pIndex->pNext;
- }
- }
- sqliteDeleteIndex(db, pIndex);
-}
-
-/*
-** Erase all schema information from the in-memory hash tables of
-** database connection. This routine is called to reclaim memory
-** before the connection closes. It is also called during a rollback
-** if there were schema changes during the transaction.
-**
-** If iDb<=0 then reset the internal schema tables for all database
-** files. If iDb>=2 then reset the internal schema for only the
-** single file indicated.
-*/
-void sqliteResetInternalSchema(sqlite *db, int iDb){
- HashElem *pElem;
- Hash temp1;
- Hash temp2;
- int i, j;
-
- assert( iDb>=0 && iDb<db->nDb );
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_Initialized;
- for(i=iDb; i<db->nDb; i++){
- Db *pDb = &db->aDb[i];
- temp1 = pDb->tblHash;
- temp2 = pDb->trigHash;
- sqliteHashInit(&pDb->trigHash, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 0);
- sqliteHashClear(&pDb->aFKey);
- sqliteHashClear(&pDb->idxHash);
- for(pElem=sqliteHashFirst(&temp2); pElem; pElem=sqliteHashNext(pElem)){
- Trigger *pTrigger = sqliteHashData(pElem);
- sqliteDeleteTrigger(pTrigger);
- }
- sqliteHashClear(&temp2);
- sqliteHashInit(&pDb->tblHash, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 0);
- for(pElem=sqliteHashFirst(&temp1); pElem; pElem=sqliteHashNext(pElem)){
- Table *pTab = sqliteHashData(pElem);
- sqliteDeleteTable(db, pTab);
- }
- sqliteHashClear(&temp1);
- DbClearProperty(db, i, DB_SchemaLoaded);
- if( iDb>0 ) return;
- }
- assert( iDb==0 );
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_InternChanges;
-
- /* If one or more of the auxiliary database files has been closed,
- ** then remove then from the auxiliary database list. We take the
- ** opportunity to do this here since we have just deleted all of the
- ** schema hash tables and therefore do not have to make any changes
- ** to any of those tables.
- */
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- struct Db *pDb = &db->aDb[i];
- if( pDb->pBt==0 ){
- if( pDb->pAux && pDb->xFreeAux ) pDb->xFreeAux(pDb->pAux);
- pDb->pAux = 0;
- }
- }
- for(i=j=2; i<db->nDb; i++){
- struct Db *pDb = &db->aDb[i];
- if( pDb->pBt==0 ){
- sqliteFree(pDb->zName);
- pDb->zName = 0;
- continue;
- }
- if( j<i ){
- db->aDb[j] = db->aDb[i];
- }
- j++;
- }
- memset(&db->aDb[j], 0, (db->nDb-j)*sizeof(db->aDb[j]));
- db->nDb = j;
- if( db->nDb<=2 && db->aDb!=db->aDbStatic ){
- memcpy(db->aDbStatic, db->aDb, 2*sizeof(db->aDb[0]));
- sqliteFree(db->aDb);
- db->aDb = db->aDbStatic;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called whenever a rollback occurs. If there were
-** schema changes during the transaction, then we have to reset the
-** internal hash tables and reload them from disk.
-*/
-void sqliteRollbackInternalChanges(sqlite *db){
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_InternChanges ){
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, 0);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called when a commit occurs.
-*/
-void sqliteCommitInternalChanges(sqlite *db){
- db->aDb[0].schema_cookie = db->next_cookie;
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_InternChanges;
-}
-
-/*
-** Remove the memory data structures associated with the given
-** Table. No changes are made to disk by this routine.
-**
-** This routine just deletes the data structure. It does not unlink
-** the table data structure from the hash table. Nor does it remove
-** foreign keys from the sqlite.aFKey hash table. But it does destroy
-** memory structures of the indices and foreign keys associated with
-** the table.
-**
-** Indices associated with the table are unlinked from the "db"
-** data structure if db!=NULL. If db==NULL, indices attached to
-** the table are deleted, but it is assumed they have already been
-** unlinked.
-*/
-void sqliteDeleteTable(sqlite *db, Table *pTable){
- int i;
- Index *pIndex, *pNext;
- FKey *pFKey, *pNextFKey;
-
- if( pTable==0 ) return;
-
- /* Delete all indices associated with this table
- */
- for(pIndex = pTable->pIndex; pIndex; pIndex=pNext){
- pNext = pIndex->pNext;
- assert( pIndex->iDb==pTable->iDb || (pTable->iDb==0 && pIndex->iDb==1) );
- sqliteDeleteIndex(db, pIndex);
- }
-
- /* Delete all foreign keys associated with this table. The keys
- ** should have already been unlinked from the db->aFKey hash table
- */
- for(pFKey=pTable->pFKey; pFKey; pFKey=pNextFKey){
- pNextFKey = pFKey->pNextFrom;
- assert( pTable->iDb<db->nDb );
- assert( sqliteHashFind(&db->aDb[pTable->iDb].aFKey,
- pFKey->zTo, strlen(pFKey->zTo)+1)!=pFKey );
- sqliteFree(pFKey);
- }
-
- /* Delete the Table structure itself.
- */
- for(i=0; i<pTable->nCol; i++){
- sqliteFree(pTable->aCol[i].zName);
- sqliteFree(pTable->aCol[i].zDflt);
- sqliteFree(pTable->aCol[i].zType);
- }
- sqliteFree(pTable->zName);
- sqliteFree(pTable->aCol);
- sqliteSelectDelete(pTable->pSelect);
- sqliteFree(pTable);
-}
-
-/*
-** Unlink the given table from the hash tables and the delete the
-** table structure with all its indices and foreign keys.
-*/
-static void sqliteUnlinkAndDeleteTable(sqlite *db, Table *p){
- Table *pOld;
- FKey *pF1, *pF2;
- int i = p->iDb;
- assert( db!=0 );
- pOld = sqliteHashInsert(&db->aDb[i].tblHash, p->zName, strlen(p->zName)+1, 0);
- assert( pOld==0 || pOld==p );
- for(pF1=p->pFKey; pF1; pF1=pF1->pNextFrom){
- int nTo = strlen(pF1->zTo) + 1;
- pF2 = sqliteHashFind(&db->aDb[i].aFKey, pF1->zTo, nTo);
- if( pF2==pF1 ){
- sqliteHashInsert(&db->aDb[i].aFKey, pF1->zTo, nTo, pF1->pNextTo);
- }else{
- while( pF2 && pF2->pNextTo!=pF1 ){ pF2=pF2->pNextTo; }
- if( pF2 ){
- pF2->pNextTo = pF1->pNextTo;
- }
- }
- }
- sqliteDeleteTable(db, p);
-}
-
-/*
-** Construct the name of a user table or index from a token.
-**
-** Space to hold the name is obtained from sqliteMalloc() and must
-** be freed by the calling function.
-*/
-char *sqliteTableNameFromToken(Token *pName){
- char *zName = sqliteStrNDup(pName->z, pName->n);
- sqliteDequote(zName);
- return zName;
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code to open the appropriate master table. The table
-** opened will be STQLITE_MASTER for persistent tables and
-** STQLITE_TEMP_MASTER for temporary tables. The table is opened
-** on cursor 0.
-*/
-void sqliteOpenMasterTable(Vdbe *v, int isTemp){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, isTemp, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenWrite, 0, 2);
-}
-
-/*
-** Begin constructing a new table representation in memory. This is
-** the first of several action routines that get called in response
-** to a CREATE TABLE statement. In particular, this routine is called
-** after seeing tokens "CREATE" and "TABLE" and the table name. The
-** pStart token is the CREATE and pName is the table name. The isTemp
-** flag is true if the table should be stored in the auxiliary database
-** file instead of in the main database file. This is normally the case
-** when the "TEMP" or "TEMPORARY" keyword occurs in between
-** CREATE and TABLE.
-**
-** The new table record is initialized and put in pParse->pNewTable.
-** As more of the CREATE TABLE statement is parsed, additional action
-** routines will be called to add more information to this record.
-** At the end of the CREATE TABLE statement, the sqliteEndTable() routine
-** is called to complete the construction of the new table record.
-*/
-void sqliteStartTable(
- Parse *pParse, /* Parser context */
- Token *pStart, /* The "CREATE" token */
- Token *pName, /* Name of table or view to create */
- int isTemp, /* True if this is a TEMP table */
- int isView /* True if this is a VIEW */
-){
- Table *pTable;
- Index *pIdx;
- char *zName;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- Vdbe *v;
- int iDb;
-
- pParse->sFirstToken = *pStart;
- zName = sqliteTableNameFromToken(pName);
- if( zName==0 ) return;
- if( db->init.iDb==1 ) isTemp = 1;
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- assert( (isTemp & 1)==isTemp );
- {
- int code;
- char *zDb = isTemp ? "temp" : "main";
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_INSERT, SCHEMA_TABLE(isTemp), 0, zDb) ){
- sqliteFree(zName);
- return;
- }
- if( isView ){
- if( isTemp ){
- code = STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_VIEW;
- }else{
- code = STQLITE_CREATE_VIEW;
- }
- }else{
- if( isTemp ){
- code = STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_TABLE;
- }else{
- code = STQLITE_CREATE_TABLE;
- }
- }
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, code, zName, 0, zDb) ){
- sqliteFree(zName);
- return;
- }
- }
-#endif
-
-
- /* Before trying to create a temporary table, make sure the Btree for
- ** holding temporary tables is open.
- */
- if( isTemp && db->aDb[1].pBt==0 && !pParse->explain ){
- int rc = sqliteBtreeFactory(db, 0, 0, MAX_PAGES, &db->aDb[1].pBt);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "unable to open a temporary database "
- "file for storing temporary tables");
- pParse->nErr++;
- return;
- }
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_InTrans ){
- rc = sqliteBtreeBeginTrans(db->aDb[1].pBt);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "unable to get a write lock on "
- "the temporary database file");
- pParse->nErr++;
- return;
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* Make sure the new table name does not collide with an existing
- ** index or table name. Issue an error message if it does.
- **
- ** If we are re-reading the sqlite_master table because of a schema
- ** change and a new permanent table is found whose name collides with
- ** an existing temporary table, that is not an error.
- */
- pTable = sqliteFindTable(db, zName, 0);
- iDb = isTemp ? 1 : db->init.iDb;
- if( pTable!=0 && (pTable->iDb==iDb || !db->init.busy) ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "table %T already exists", pName);
- sqliteFree(zName);
- return;
- }
- if( (pIdx = sqliteFindIndex(db, zName, 0))!=0 &&
- (pIdx->iDb==0 || !db->init.busy) ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "there is already an index named %s", zName);
- sqliteFree(zName);
- return;
- }
- pTable = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(Table) );
- if( pTable==0 ){
- sqliteFree(zName);
- return;
- }
- pTable->zName = zName;
- pTable->nCol = 0;
- pTable->aCol = 0;
- pTable->iPKey = -1;
- pTable->pIndex = 0;
- pTable->iDb = iDb;
- if( pParse->pNewTable ) sqliteDeleteTable(db, pParse->pNewTable);
- pParse->pNewTable = pTable;
-
- /* Begin generating the code that will insert the table record into
- ** the STQLITE_MASTER table. Note in particular that we must go ahead
- ** and allocate the record number for the table entry now. Before any
- ** PRIMARY KEY or UNITQUE keywords are parsed. Those keywords will cause
- ** indices to be created and the table record must come before the
- ** indices. Hence, the record number for the table must be allocated
- ** now.
- */
- if( !db->init.busy && (v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse))!=0 ){
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 0, isTemp);
- if( !isTemp ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, db->file_format, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetCookie, 0, 1);
- }
- sqliteOpenMasterTable(v, isTemp);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NewRecno, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, 0, 0);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Add a new column to the table currently being constructed.
-**
-** The parser calls this routine once for each column declaration
-** in a CREATE TABLE statement. sqliteStartTable() gets called
-** first to get things going. Then this routine is called for each
-** column.
-*/
-void sqliteAddColumn(Parse *pParse, Token *pName){
- Table *p;
- int i;
- char *z = 0;
- Column *pCol;
- if( (p = pParse->pNewTable)==0 ) return;
- sqliteSetNString(&z, pName->z, pName->n, 0);
- if( z==0 ) return;
- sqliteDequote(z);
- for(i=0; i<p->nCol; i++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(z, p->aCol[i].zName)==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "duplicate column name: %s", z);
- sqliteFree(z);
- return;
- }
- }
- if( (p->nCol & 0x7)==0 ){
- Column *aNew;
- aNew = sqliteRealloc( p->aCol, (p->nCol+8)*sizeof(p->aCol[0]));
- if( aNew==0 ) return;
- p->aCol = aNew;
- }
- pCol = &p->aCol[p->nCol];
- memset(pCol, 0, sizeof(p->aCol[0]));
- pCol->zName = z;
- pCol->sortOrder = STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- p->nCol++;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called by the parser while in the middle of
-** parsing a CREATE TABLE statement. A "NOT NULL" constraint has
-** been seen on a column. This routine sets the notNull flag on
-** the column currently under construction.
-*/
-void sqliteAddNotNull(Parse *pParse, int onError){
- Table *p;
- int i;
- if( (p = pParse->pNewTable)==0 ) return;
- i = p->nCol-1;
- if( i>=0 ) p->aCol[i].notNull = onError;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called by the parser while in the middle of
-** parsing a CREATE TABLE statement. The pFirst token is the first
-** token in the sequence of tokens that describe the type of the
-** column currently under construction. pLast is the last token
-** in the sequence. Use this information to construct a string
-** that contains the typename of the column and store that string
-** in zType.
-*/
-void sqliteAddColumnType(Parse *pParse, Token *pFirst, Token *pLast){
- Table *p;
- int i, j;
- int n;
- char *z, **pz;
- Column *pCol;
- if( (p = pParse->pNewTable)==0 ) return;
- i = p->nCol-1;
- if( i<0 ) return;
- pCol = &p->aCol[i];
- pz = &pCol->zType;
- n = pLast->n + Addr(pLast->z) - Addr(pFirst->z);
- sqliteSetNString(pz, pFirst->z, n, 0);
- z = *pz;
- if( z==0 ) return;
- for(i=j=0; z[i]; i++){
- int c = z[i];
- if( isspace(c) ) continue;
- z[j++] = c;
- }
- z[j] = 0;
- if( pParse->db->file_format>=4 ){
- pCol->sortOrder = sqliteCollateType(z, n);
- }else{
- pCol->sortOrder = STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** The given token is the default value for the last column added to
-** the table currently under construction. If "minusFlag" is true, it
-** means the value token was preceded by a minus sign.
-**
-** This routine is called by the parser while in the middle of
-** parsing a CREATE TABLE statement.
-*/
-void sqliteAddDefaultValue(Parse *pParse, Token *pVal, int minusFlag){
- Table *p;
- int i;
- char **pz;
- if( (p = pParse->pNewTable)==0 ) return;
- i = p->nCol-1;
- if( i<0 ) return;
- pz = &p->aCol[i].zDflt;
- if( minusFlag ){
- sqliteSetNString(pz, "-", 1, pVal->z, pVal->n, 0);
- }else{
- sqliteSetNString(pz, pVal->z, pVal->n, 0);
- }
- sqliteDequote(*pz);
-}
-
-/*
-** Designate the PRIMARY KEY for the table. pList is a list of names
-** of columns that form the primary key. If pList is NULL, then the
-** most recently added column of the table is the primary key.
-**
-** A table can have at most one primary key. If the table already has
-** a primary key (and this is the second primary key) then create an
-** error.
-**
-** If the PRIMARY KEY is on a single column whose datatype is INTEGER,
-** then we will try to use that column as the row id. (Exception:
-** For backwards compatibility with older databases, do not do this
-** if the file format version number is less than 1.) Set the Table.iPKey
-** field of the table under construction to be the index of the
-** INTEGER PRIMARY KEY column. Table.iPKey is set to -1 if there is
-** no INTEGER PRIMARY KEY.
-**
-** If the key is not an INTEGER PRIMARY KEY, then create a unique
-** index for the key. No index is created for INTEGER PRIMARY KEYs.
-*/
-void sqliteAddPrimaryKey(Parse *pParse, IdList *pList, int onError){
- Table *pTab = pParse->pNewTable;
- char *zType = 0;
- int iCol = -1, i;
- if( pTab==0 ) goto primary_key_exit;
- if( pTab->hasPrimKey ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "table \"%s\" has more than one primary key", pTab->zName);
- goto primary_key_exit;
- }
- pTab->hasPrimKey = 1;
- if( pList==0 ){
- iCol = pTab->nCol - 1;
- pTab->aCol[iCol].isPrimKey = 1;
- }else{
- for(i=0; i<pList->nId; i++){
- for(iCol=0; iCol<pTab->nCol; iCol++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(pList->a[i].zName, pTab->aCol[iCol].zName)==0 ) break;
- }
- if( iCol<pTab->nCol ) pTab->aCol[iCol].isPrimKey = 1;
- }
- if( pList->nId>1 ) iCol = -1;
- }
- if( iCol>=0 && iCol<pTab->nCol ){
- zType = pTab->aCol[iCol].zType;
- }
- if( pParse->db->file_format>=1 &&
- zType && sqliteStrICmp(zType, "INTEGER")==0 ){
- pTab->iPKey = iCol;
- pTab->keyConf = onError;
- }else{
- sqliteCreateIndex(pParse, 0, 0, pList, onError, 0, 0);
- pList = 0;
- }
-
-primary_key_exit:
- sqliteIdListDelete(pList);
- return;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the appropriate collating type given a type name.
-**
-** The collation type is text (STQLITE_SO_TEXT) if the type
-** name contains the character stream "text" or "blob" or
-** "clob". Any other type name is collated as numeric
-** (STQLITE_SO_NUM).
-*/
-int sqliteCollateType(const char *zType, int nType){
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<nType-3; i++){
- int c = *(zType++) | 0x60;
- if( (c=='b' || c=='c') && sqliteStrNICmp(zType, "lob", 3)==0 ){
- return STQLITE_SO_TEXT;
- }
- if( c=='c' && sqliteStrNICmp(zType, "har", 3)==0 ){
- return STQLITE_SO_TEXT;
- }
- if( c=='t' && sqliteStrNICmp(zType, "ext", 3)==0 ){
- return STQLITE_SO_TEXT;
- }
- }
- return STQLITE_SO_NUM;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called by the parser while in the middle of
-** parsing a CREATE TABLE statement. A "COLLATE" clause has
-** been seen on a column. This routine sets the Column.sortOrder on
-** the column currently under construction.
-*/
-void sqliteAddCollateType(Parse *pParse, int collType){
- Table *p;
- int i;
- if( (p = pParse->pNewTable)==0 ) return;
- i = p->nCol-1;
- if( i>=0 ) p->aCol[i].sortOrder = collType;
-}
-
-/*
-** Come up with a new random value for the schema cookie. Make sure
-** the new value is different from the old.
-**
-** The schema cookie is used to determine when the schema for the
-** database changes. After each schema change, the cookie value
-** changes. When a process first reads the schema it records the
-** cookie. Thereafter, whenever it goes to access the database,
-** it checks the cookie to make sure the schema has not changed
-** since it was last read.
-**
-** This plan is not completely bullet-proof. It is possible for
-** the schema to change multiple times and for the cookie to be
-** set back to prior value. But schema changes are infrequent
-** and the probability of hitting the same cookie value is only
-** 1 chance in 2^32. So we're safe enough.
-*/
-void sqliteChangeCookie(sqlite *db, Vdbe *v){
- if( db->next_cookie==db->aDb[0].schema_cookie ){
- unsigned char r;
- sqliteRandomness(1, &r);
- db->next_cookie = db->aDb[0].schema_cookie + r + 1;
- db->flags |= STQLITE_InternChanges;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, db->next_cookie, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetCookie, 0, 0);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Measure the number of characters needed to output the given
-** identifier. The number returned includes any quotes used
-** but does not include the null terminator.
-*/
-static int identLength(const char *z){
- int n;
- int needQuote = 0;
- for(n=0; *z; n++, z++){
- if( *z=='\'' ){ n++; needQuote=1; }
- }
- return n + needQuote*2;
-}
-
-/*
-** Write an identifier onto the end of the given string. Add
-** quote characters as needed.
-*/
-static void identPut(char *z, int *pIdx, char *zIdent){
- int i, j, needQuote;
- i = *pIdx;
- for(j=0; zIdent[j]; j++){
- if( !isalnum(zIdent[j]) && zIdent[j]!='_' ) break;
- }
- needQuote = zIdent[j]!=0 || isdigit(zIdent[0])
- || sqliteKeywordCode(zIdent, j)!=TK_ID;
- if( needQuote ) z[i++] = '\'';
- for(j=0; zIdent[j]; j++){
- z[i++] = zIdent[j];
- if( zIdent[j]=='\'' ) z[i++] = '\'';
- }
- if( needQuote ) z[i++] = '\'';
- z[i] = 0;
- *pIdx = i;
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate a CREATE TABLE statement appropriate for the given
-** table. Memory to hold the text of the statement is obtained
-** from sqliteMalloc() and must be freed by the calling function.
-*/
-static char *createTableStmt(Table *p){
- int i, k, n;
- char *zStmt;
- char *zSep, *zSep2, *zEnd;
- n = 0;
- for(i=0; i<p->nCol; i++){
- n += identLength(p->aCol[i].zName);
- }
- n += identLength(p->zName);
- if( n<40 ){
- zSep = "";
- zSep2 = ",";
- zEnd = ")";
- }else{
- zSep = "\n ";
- zSep2 = ",\n ";
- zEnd = "\n)";
- }
- n += 35 + 6*p->nCol;
- zStmt = sqliteMallocRaw( n );
- if( zStmt==0 ) return 0;
- strcpy(zStmt, p->iDb==1 ? "CREATE TEMP TABLE " : "CREATE TABLE ");
- k = strlen(zStmt);
- identPut(zStmt, &k, p->zName);
- zStmt[k++] = '(';
- for(i=0; i<p->nCol; i++){
- strcpy(&zStmt[k], zSep);
- k += strlen(&zStmt[k]);
- zSep = zSep2;
- identPut(zStmt, &k, p->aCol[i].zName);
- }
- strcpy(&zStmt[k], zEnd);
- return zStmt;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called to report the final ")" that terminates
-** a CREATE TABLE statement.
-**
-** The table structure that other action routines have been building
-** is added to the internal hash tables, assuming no errors have
-** occurred.
-**
-** An entry for the table is made in the master table on disk, unless
-** this is a temporary table or db->init.busy==1. When db->init.busy==1
-** it means we are reading the sqlite_master table because we just
-** connected to the database or because the sqlite_master table has
-** recently changes, so the entry for this table already exists in
-** the sqlite_master table. We do not want to create it again.
-**
-** If the pSelect argument is not NULL, it means that this routine
-** was called to create a table generated from a
-** "CREATE TABLE ... AS SELECT ..." statement. The column names of
-** the new table will match the result set of the SELECT.
-*/
-void sqliteEndTable(Parse *pParse, Token *pEnd, Select *pSelect){
- Table *p;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
-
- if( (pEnd==0 && pSelect==0) || pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ) return;
- p = pParse->pNewTable;
- if( p==0 ) return;
-
- /* If the table is generated from a SELECT, then construct the
- ** list of columns and the text of the table.
- */
- if( pSelect ){
- Table *pSelTab = sqliteResultSetOfSelect(pParse, 0, pSelect);
- if( pSelTab==0 ) return;
- assert( p->aCol==0 );
- p->nCol = pSelTab->nCol;
- p->aCol = pSelTab->aCol;
- pSelTab->nCol = 0;
- pSelTab->aCol = 0;
- sqliteDeleteTable(0, pSelTab);
- }
-
- /* If the db->init.busy is 1 it means we are reading the SQL off the
- ** "sqlite_master" or "sqlite_temp_master" table on the disk.
- ** So do not write to the disk again. Extract the root page number
- ** for the table from the db->init.newTnum field. (The page number
- ** should have been put there by the sqliteOpenCb routine.)
- */
- if( db->init.busy ){
- p->tnum = db->init.newTnum;
- }
-
- /* If not initializing, then create a record for the new table
- ** in the STQLITE_MASTER table of the database. The record number
- ** for the new table entry should already be on the stack.
- **
- ** If this is a TEMPORARY table, write the entry into the auxiliary
- ** file instead of into the main database file.
- */
- if( !db->init.busy ){
- int n;
- Vdbe *v;
-
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) return;
- if( p->pSelect==0 ){
- /* A regular table */
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_CreateTable, 0, p->iDb, (char*)&p->tnum, P3_POINTER);
- }else{
- /* A view */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 0, 0);
- }
- p->tnum = 0;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pull, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, p->pSelect==0?"table":"view", P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, p->zName, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, p->zName, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 4, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- if( pSelect ){
- char *z = createTableStmt(p);
- n = z ? strlen(z) : 0;
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, -1, z, n);
- sqliteFree(z);
- }else{
- assert( pEnd!=0 );
- n = Addr(pEnd->z) - Addr(pParse->sFirstToken.z) + 1;
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, -1, pParse->sFirstToken.z, n);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeRecord, 5, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, 0, 0);
- if( !p->iDb ){
- sqliteChangeCookie(db, v);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, 0, 0);
- if( pSelect ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, p->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenWrite, 1, 0);
- pParse->nTab = 2;
- sqliteSelect(pParse, pSelect, SRT_Table, 1, 0, 0, 0);
- }
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- }
-
- /* Add the table to the in-memory representation of the database.
- */
- if( pParse->explain==0 && pParse->nErr==0 ){
- Table *pOld;
- FKey *pFKey;
- pOld = sqliteHashInsert(&db->aDb[p->iDb].tblHash,
- p->zName, strlen(p->zName)+1, p);
- if( pOld ){
- assert( p==pOld ); /* Malloc must have failed inside HashInsert() */
- return;
- }
- for(pFKey=p->pFKey; pFKey; pFKey=pFKey->pNextFrom){
- int nTo = strlen(pFKey->zTo) + 1;
- pFKey->pNextTo = sqliteHashFind(&db->aDb[p->iDb].aFKey, pFKey->zTo, nTo);
- sqliteHashInsert(&db->aDb[p->iDb].aFKey, pFKey->zTo, nTo, pFKey);
- }
- pParse->pNewTable = 0;
- db->nTable++;
- db->flags |= STQLITE_InternChanges;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** The parser calls this routine in order to create a new VIEW
-*/
-void sqliteCreateView(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parsing context */
- Token *pBegin, /* The CREATE token that begins the statement */
- Token *pName, /* The token that holds the name of the view */
- Select *pSelect, /* A SELECT statement that will become the new view */
- int isTemp /* TRUE for a TEMPORARY view */
-){
- Table *p;
- int n;
- const char *z;
- Token sEnd;
- DbFixer sFix;
-
- sqliteStartTable(pParse, pBegin, pName, isTemp, 1);
- p = pParse->pNewTable;
- if( p==0 || pParse->nErr ){
- sqliteSelectDelete(pSelect);
- return;
- }
- if( sqliteFixInit(&sFix, pParse, p->iDb, "view", pName)
- && sqliteFixSelect(&sFix, pSelect)
- ){
- sqliteSelectDelete(pSelect);
- return;
- }
-
- /* Make a copy of the entire SELECT statement that defines the view.
- ** This will force all the Expr.token.z values to be dynamically
- ** allocated rather than point to the input string - which means that
- ** they will persist after the current sqlite_exec() call returns.
- */
- p->pSelect = sqliteSelectDup(pSelect);
- sqliteSelectDelete(pSelect);
- if( !pParse->db->init.busy ){
- sqliteViewGetColumnNames(pParse, p);
- }
-
- /* Locate the end of the CREATE VIEW statement. Make sEnd point to
- ** the end.
- */
- sEnd = pParse->sLastToken;
- if( sEnd.z[0]!=0 && sEnd.z[0]!=';' ){
- sEnd.z += sEnd.n;
- }
- sEnd.n = 0;
- n = ((int)sEnd.z) - (int)pBegin->z;
- z = pBegin->z;
- while( n>0 && (z[n-1]==';' || isspace(z[n-1])) ){ n--; }
- sEnd.z = &z[n-1];
- sEnd.n = 1;
-
- /* Use sqliteEndTable() to add the view to the STQLITE_MASTER table */
- sqliteEndTable(pParse, &sEnd, 0);
- return;
-}
-
-/*
-** The Table structure pTable is really a VIEW. Fill in the names of
-** the columns of the view in the pTable structure. Return the number
-** of errors. If an error is seen leave an error message in pParse->zErrMsg.
-*/
-int sqliteViewGetColumnNames(Parse *pParse, Table *pTable){
- ExprList *pEList;
- Select *pSel;
- Table *pSelTab;
- int nErr = 0;
-
- assert( pTable );
-
- /* A positive nCol means the columns names for this view are
- ** already known.
- */
- if( pTable->nCol>0 ) return 0;
-
- /* A negative nCol is a special marker meaning that we are currently
- ** trying to compute the column names. If we enter this routine with
- ** a negative nCol, it means two or more views form a loop, like this:
- **
- ** CREATE VIEW one AS SELECT * FROM two;
- ** CREATE VIEW two AS SELECT * FROM one;
- **
- ** Actually, this error is caught previously and so the following test
- ** should always fail. But we will leave it in place just to be safe.
- */
- if( pTable->nCol<0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "view %s is circularly defined", pTable->zName);
- return 1;
- }
-
- /* If we get this far, it means we need to compute the table names.
- */
- assert( pTable->pSelect ); /* If nCol==0, then pTable must be a VIEW */
- pSel = pTable->pSelect;
-
- /* Note that the call to sqliteResultSetOfSelect() will expand any
- ** "*" elements in this list. But we will need to restore the list
- ** back to its original configuration afterwards, so we save a copy of
- ** the original in pEList.
- */
- pEList = pSel->pEList;
- pSel->pEList = sqliteExprListDup(pEList);
- if( pSel->pEList==0 ){
- pSel->pEList = pEList;
- return 1; /* Malloc failed */
- }
- pTable->nCol = -1;
- pSelTab = sqliteResultSetOfSelect(pParse, 0, pSel);
- if( pSelTab ){
- assert( pTable->aCol==0 );
- pTable->nCol = pSelTab->nCol;
- pTable->aCol = pSelTab->aCol;
- pSelTab->nCol = 0;
- pSelTab->aCol = 0;
- sqliteDeleteTable(0, pSelTab);
- DbSetProperty(pParse->db, pTable->iDb, DB_UnresetViews);
- }else{
- pTable->nCol = 0;
- nErr++;
- }
- sqliteSelectUnbind(pSel);
- sqliteExprListDelete(pSel->pEList);
- pSel->pEList = pEList;
- return nErr;
-}
-
-/*
-** Clear the column names from the VIEW pTable.
-**
-** This routine is called whenever any other table or view is modified.
-** The view passed into this routine might depend directly or indirectly
-** on the modified or deleted table so we need to clear the old column
-** names so that they will be recomputed.
-*/
-static void sqliteViewResetColumnNames(Table *pTable){
- int i;
- Column *pCol;
- assert( pTable!=0 && pTable->pSelect!=0 );
- for(i=0, pCol=pTable->aCol; i<pTable->nCol; i++, pCol++){
- sqliteFree(pCol->zName);
- sqliteFree(pCol->zDflt);
- sqliteFree(pCol->zType);
- }
- sqliteFree(pTable->aCol);
- pTable->aCol = 0;
- pTable->nCol = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Clear the column names from every VIEW in database idx.
-*/
-static void sqliteViewResetAll(sqlite *db, int idx){
- HashElem *i;
- if( !DbHasProperty(db, idx, DB_UnresetViews) ) return;
- for(i=sqliteHashFirst(&db->aDb[idx].tblHash); i; i=sqliteHashNext(i)){
- Table *pTab = sqliteHashData(i);
- if( pTab->pSelect ){
- sqliteViewResetColumnNames(pTab);
- }
- }
- DbClearProperty(db, idx, DB_UnresetViews);
-}
-
-/*
-** Given a token, look up a table with that name. If not found, leave
-** an error for the parser to find and return NULL.
-*/
-Table *sqliteTableFromToken(Parse *pParse, Token *pTok){
- char *zName;
- Table *pTab;
- zName = sqliteTableNameFromToken(pTok);
- if( zName==0 ) return 0;
- pTab = sqliteFindTable(pParse->db, zName, 0);
- sqliteFree(zName);
- if( pTab==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "no such table: %T", pTok);
- }
- return pTab;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called to do the work of a DROP TABLE statement.
-** pName is the name of the table to be dropped.
-*/
-void sqliteDropTable(Parse *pParse, Token *pName, int isView){
- Table *pTable;
- Vdbe *v;
- int base;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- int iDb;
-
- if( pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ) return;
- pTable = sqliteTableFromToken(pParse, pName);
- if( pTable==0 ) return;
- iDb = pTable->iDb;
- assert( iDb>=0 && iDb<db->nDb );
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- {
- int code;
- const char *zTab = SCHEMA_TABLE(pTable->iDb);
- const char *zDb = db->aDb[pTable->iDb].zName;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_DELETE, zTab, 0, zDb)){
- return;
- }
- if( isView ){
- if( iDb==1 ){
- code = STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_VIEW;
- }else{
- code = STQLITE_DROP_VIEW;
- }
- }else{
- if( iDb==1 ){
- code = STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_TABLE;
- }else{
- code = STQLITE_DROP_TABLE;
- }
- }
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, code, pTable->zName, 0, zDb) ){
- return;
- }
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_DELETE, pTable->zName, 0, zDb) ){
- return;
- }
- }
-#endif
- if( pTable->readOnly ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "table %s may not be dropped", pTable->zName);
- pParse->nErr++;
- return;
- }
- if( isView && pTable->pSelect==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "use DROP TABLE to delete table %s", pTable->zName);
- return;
- }
- if( !isView && pTable->pSelect ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "use DROP VIEW to delete view %s", pTable->zName);
- return;
- }
-
- /* Generate code to remove the table from the master table
- ** on disk.
- */
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v ){
- static VdbeOpList dropTable[] = {
- { OP_Rewind, 0, ADDR(8), 0},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, 0}, /* 1 */
- { OP_MemStore, 1, 1, 0},
- { OP_MemLoad, 1, 0, 0}, /* 3 */
- { OP_Column, 0, 2, 0},
- { OP_Ne, 0, ADDR(7), 0},
- { OP_Delete, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_Next, 0, ADDR(3), 0}, /* 7 */
- };
- Index *pIdx;
- Trigger *pTrigger;
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 0, pTable->iDb);
-
- /* Drop all triggers associated with the table being dropped */
- pTrigger = pTable->pTrigger;
- while( pTrigger ){
- assert( pTrigger->iDb==pTable->iDb || pTrigger->iDb==1 );
- sqliteDropTriggerPtr(pParse, pTrigger, 1);
- if( pParse->explain ){
- pTrigger = pTrigger->pNext;
- }else{
- pTrigger = pTable->pTrigger;
- }
- }
-
- /* Drop all STQLITE_MASTER entries that refer to the table */
- sqliteOpenMasterTable(v, pTable->iDb);
- base = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(dropTable), dropTable);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, base+1, pTable->zName, 0);
-
- /* Drop all STQLITE_TEMP_MASTER entries that refer to the table */
- if( pTable->iDb!=1 ){
- sqliteOpenMasterTable(v, 1);
- base = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(dropTable), dropTable);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, base+1, pTable->zName, 0);
- }
-
- if( pTable->iDb==0 ){
- sqliteChangeCookie(db, v);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, 0, 0);
- if( !isView ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Destroy, pTable->tnum, pTable->iDb);
- for(pIdx=pTable->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Destroy, pIdx->tnum, pIdx->iDb);
- }
- }
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- }
-
- /* Delete the in-memory description of the table.
- **
- ** Exception: if the SQL statement began with the EXPLAIN keyword,
- ** then no changes should be made.
- */
- if( !pParse->explain ){
- sqliteUnlinkAndDeleteTable(db, pTable);
- db->flags |= STQLITE_InternChanges;
- }
- sqliteViewResetAll(db, iDb);
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine constructs a P3 string suitable for an OP_MakeIdxKey
-** opcode and adds that P3 string to the most recently inserted instruction
-** in the virtual machine. The P3 string consists of a single character
-** for each column in the index pIdx of table pTab. If the column uses
-** a numeric sort order, then the P3 string character corresponding to
-** that column is 'n'. If the column uses a text sort order, then the
-** P3 string is 't'. See the OP_MakeIdxKey opcode documentation for
-** additional information. See also the sqliteAddKeyType() routine.
-*/
-void sqliteAddIdxKeyType(Vdbe *v, Index *pIdx){
- char *zType;
- Table *pTab;
- int i, n;
- assert( pIdx!=0 && pIdx->pTable!=0 );
- pTab = pIdx->pTable;
- n = pIdx->nColumn;
- zType = sqliteMallocRaw( n+1 );
- if( zType==0 ) return;
- for(i=0; i<n; i++){
- int iCol = pIdx->aiColumn[i];
- assert( iCol>=0 && iCol<pTab->nCol );
- if( (pTab->aCol[iCol].sortOrder & STQLITE_SO_TYPEMASK)==STQLITE_SO_TEXT ){
- zType[i] = 't';
- }else{
- zType[i] = 'n';
- }
- }
- zType[n] = 0;
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, -1, zType, n);
- sqliteFree(zType);
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called to create a new foreign key on the table
-** currently under construction. pFromCol determines which columns
-** in the current table point to the foreign key. If pFromCol==0 then
-** connect the key to the last column inserted. pTo is the name of
-** the table referred to. pToCol is a list of tables in the other
-** pTo table that the foreign key points to. flags contains all
-** information about the conflict resolution algorithms specified
-** in the ON DELETE, ON UPDATE and ON INSERT clauses.
-**
-** An FKey structure is created and added to the table currently
-** under construction in the pParse->pNewTable field. The new FKey
-** is not linked into db->aFKey at this point - that does not happen
-** until sqliteEndTable().
-**
-** The foreign key is set for IMMEDIATE processing. A subsequent call
-** to sqliteDeferForeignKey() might change this to DEFERRED.
-*/
-void sqliteCreateForeignKey(
- Parse *pParse, /* Parsing context */
- IdList *pFromCol, /* Columns in this table that point to other table */
- Token *pTo, /* Name of the other table */
- IdList *pToCol, /* Columns in the other table */
- int flags /* Conflict resolution algorithms. */
-){
- Table *p = pParse->pNewTable;
- int nByte;
- int i;
- int nCol;
- char *z;
- FKey *pFKey = 0;
-
- assert( pTo!=0 );
- if( p==0 || pParse->nErr ) goto fk_end;
- if( pFromCol==0 ){
- int iCol = p->nCol-1;
- if( iCol<0 ) goto fk_end;
- if( pToCol && pToCol->nId!=1 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "foreign key on %s"
- " should reference only one column of table %T",
- p->aCol[iCol].zName, pTo);
- goto fk_end;
- }
- nCol = 1;
- }else if( pToCol && pToCol->nId!=pFromCol->nId ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "number of columns in foreign key does not match the number of "
- "columns in the referenced table");
- goto fk_end;
- }else{
- nCol = pFromCol->nId;
- }
- nByte = sizeof(*pFKey) + nCol*sizeof(pFKey->aCol[0]) + pTo->n + 1;
- if( pToCol ){
- for(i=0; i<pToCol->nId; i++){
- nByte += strlen(pToCol->a[i].zName) + 1;
- }
- }
- pFKey = sqliteMalloc( nByte );
- if( pFKey==0 ) goto fk_end;
- pFKey->pFrom = p;
- pFKey->pNextFrom = p->pFKey;
- z = (char*)&pFKey[1];
- pFKey->aCol = (struct sColMap*)z;
- z += sizeof(struct sColMap)*nCol;
- pFKey->zTo = z;
- memcpy(z, pTo->z, pTo->n);
- z[pTo->n] = 0;
- z += pTo->n+1;
- pFKey->pNextTo = 0;
- pFKey->nCol = nCol;
- if( pFromCol==0 ){
- pFKey->aCol[0].iFrom = p->nCol-1;
- }else{
- for(i=0; i<nCol; i++){
- int j;
- for(j=0; j<p->nCol; j++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(p->aCol[j].zName, pFromCol->a[i].zName)==0 ){
- pFKey->aCol[i].iFrom = j;
- break;
- }
- }
- if( j>=p->nCol ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "unknown column \"%s\" in foreign key definition",
- pFromCol->a[i].zName);
- goto fk_end;
- }
- }
- }
- if( pToCol ){
- for(i=0; i<nCol; i++){
- int n = strlen(pToCol->a[i].zName);
- pFKey->aCol[i].zCol = z;
- memcpy(z, pToCol->a[i].zName, n);
- z[n] = 0;
- z += n+1;
- }
- }
- pFKey->isDeferred = 0;
- pFKey->deleteConf = flags & 0xff;
- pFKey->updateConf = (flags >> 8 ) & 0xff;
- pFKey->insertConf = (flags >> 16 ) & 0xff;
-
- /* Link the foreign key to the table as the last step.
- */
- p->pFKey = pFKey;
- pFKey = 0;
-
-fk_end:
- sqliteFree(pFKey);
- sqliteIdListDelete(pFromCol);
- sqliteIdListDelete(pToCol);
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called when an INITIALLY IMMEDIATE or INITIALLY DEFERRED
-** clause is seen as part of a foreign key definition. The isDeferred
-** parameter is 1 for INITIALLY DEFERRED and 0 for INITIALLY IMMEDIATE.
-** The behavior of the most recently created foreign key is adjusted
-** accordingly.
-*/
-void sqliteDeferForeignKey(Parse *pParse, int isDeferred){
- Table *pTab;
- FKey *pFKey;
- if( (pTab = pParse->pNewTable)==0 || (pFKey = pTab->pFKey)==0 ) return;
- pFKey->isDeferred = isDeferred;
-}
-
-/*
-** Create a new index for an SQL table. pIndex is the name of the index
-** and pTable is the name of the table that is to be indexed. Both will
-** be NULL for a primary key or an index that is created to satisfy a
-** UNITQUE constraint. If pTable and pIndex are NULL, use pParse->pNewTable
-** as the table to be indexed. pParse->pNewTable is a table that is
-** currently being constructed by a CREATE TABLE statement.
-**
-** pList is a list of columns to be indexed. pList will be NULL if this
-** is a primary key or unique-constraint on the most recent column added
-** to the table currently under construction.
-*/
-void sqliteCreateIndex(
- Parse *pParse, /* All information about this parse */
- Token *pName, /* Name of the index. May be NULL */
- SrcList *pTable, /* Name of the table to index. Use pParse->pNewTable if 0 */
- IdList *pList, /* A list of columns to be indexed */
- int onError, /* OE_Abort, OE_Ignore, OE_Replace, or OE_None */
- Token *pStart, /* The CREATE token that begins a CREATE TABLE statement */
- Token *pEnd /* The ")" that closes the CREATE INDEX statement */
-){
- Table *pTab; /* Table to be indexed */
- Index *pIndex; /* The index to be created */
- char *zName = 0;
- int i, j;
- Token nullId; /* Fake token for an empty ID list */
- DbFixer sFix; /* For assigning database names to pTable */
- int isTemp; /* True for a temporary index */
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
-
- if( pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto exit_create_index;
- if( db->init.busy
- && sqliteFixInit(&sFix, pParse, db->init.iDb, "index", pName)
- && sqliteFixSrcList(&sFix, pTable)
- ){
- goto exit_create_index;
- }
-
- /*
- ** Find the table that is to be indexed. Return early if not found.
- */
- if( pTable!=0 ){
- assert( pName!=0 );
- assert( pTable->nSrc==1 );
- pTab = sqliteSrcListLookup(pParse, pTable);
- }else{
- assert( pName==0 );
- pTab = pParse->pNewTable;
- }
- if( pTab==0 || pParse->nErr ) goto exit_create_index;
- if( pTab->readOnly ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "table %s may not be indexed", pTab->zName);
- goto exit_create_index;
- }
- if( pTab->iDb>=2 && db->init.busy==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "table %s may not have indices added", pTab->zName);
- goto exit_create_index;
- }
- if( pTab->pSelect ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "views may not be indexed");
- goto exit_create_index;
- }
- isTemp = pTab->iDb==1;
-
- /*
- ** Find the name of the index. Make sure there is not already another
- ** index or table with the same name.
- **
- ** Exception: If we are reading the names of permanent indices from the
- ** sqlite_master table (because some other process changed the schema) and
- ** one of the index names collides with the name of a temporary table or
- ** index, then we will continue to process this index.
- **
- ** If pName==0 it means that we are
- ** dealing with a primary key or UNITQUE constraint. We have to invent our
- ** own name.
- */
- if( pName && !db->init.busy ){
- Index *pISameName; /* Another index with the same name */
- Table *pTSameName; /* A table with same name as the index */
- zName = sqliteStrNDup(pName->z, pName->n);
- if( zName==0 ) goto exit_create_index;
- if( (pISameName = sqliteFindIndex(db, zName, 0))!=0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "index %s already exists", zName);
- goto exit_create_index;
- }
- if( (pTSameName = sqliteFindTable(db, zName, 0))!=0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "there is already a table named %s", zName);
- goto exit_create_index;
- }
- }else if( pName==0 ){
- char zBuf[30];
- int n;
- Index *pLoop;
- for(pLoop=pTab->pIndex, n=1; pLoop; pLoop=pLoop->pNext, n++){}
- sprintf(zBuf,"%d)",n);
- zName = 0;
- sqliteSetString(&zName, "(", pTab->zName, " autoindex ", zBuf, (char*)0);
- if( zName==0 ) goto exit_create_index;
- }else{
- zName = sqliteStrNDup(pName->z, pName->n);
- }
-
- /* Check for authorization to create an index.
- */
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- {
- const char *zDb = db->aDb[pTab->iDb].zName;
-
- assert( pTab->iDb==db->init.iDb || isTemp );
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_INSERT, SCHEMA_TABLE(isTemp), 0, zDb) ){
- goto exit_create_index;
- }
- i = STQLITE_CREATE_INDEX;
- if( isTemp ) i = STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_INDEX;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, i, zName, pTab->zName, zDb) ){
- goto exit_create_index;
- }
- }
-#endif
-
- /* If pList==0, it means this routine was called to make a primary
- ** key out of the last column added to the table under construction.
- ** So create a fake list to simulate this.
- */
- if( pList==0 ){
- nullId.z = pTab->aCol[pTab->nCol-1].zName;
- nullId.n = strlen(nullId.z);
- pList = sqliteIdListAppend(0, &nullId);
- if( pList==0 ) goto exit_create_index;
- }
-
- /*
- ** Allocate the index structure.
- */
- pIndex = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(Index) + strlen(zName) + 1 +
- sizeof(int)*pList->nId );
- if( pIndex==0 ) goto exit_create_index;
- pIndex->aiColumn = (int*)&pIndex[1];
- pIndex->zName = (char*)&pIndex->aiColumn[pList->nId];
- strcpy(pIndex->zName, zName);
- pIndex->pTable = pTab;
- pIndex->nColumn = pList->nId;
- pIndex->onError = onError;
- pIndex->autoIndex = pName==0;
- pIndex->iDb = isTemp ? 1 : db->init.iDb;
-
- /* Scan the names of the columns of the table to be indexed and
- ** load the column indices into the Index structure. Report an error
- ** if any column is not found.
- */
- for(i=0; i<pList->nId; i++){
- for(j=0; j<pTab->nCol; j++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(pList->a[i].zName, pTab->aCol[j].zName)==0 ) break;
- }
- if( j>=pTab->nCol ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "table %s has no column named %s",
- pTab->zName, pList->a[i].zName);
- sqliteFree(pIndex);
- goto exit_create_index;
- }
- pIndex->aiColumn[i] = j;
- }
-
- /* Link the new Index structure to its table and to the other
- ** in-memory database structures.
- */
- if( !pParse->explain ){
- Index *p;
- p = sqliteHashInsert(&db->aDb[pIndex->iDb].idxHash,
- pIndex->zName, strlen(pIndex->zName)+1, pIndex);
- if( p ){
- assert( p==pIndex ); /* Malloc must have failed */
- sqliteFree(pIndex);
- goto exit_create_index;
- }
- db->flags |= STQLITE_InternChanges;
- }
-
- /* When adding an index to the list of indices for a table, make
- ** sure all indices labeled OE_Replace come after all those labeled
- ** OE_Ignore. This is necessary for the correct operation of UPDATE
- ** and INSERT.
- */
- if( onError!=OE_Replace || pTab->pIndex==0
- || pTab->pIndex->onError==OE_Replace){
- pIndex->pNext = pTab->pIndex;
- pTab->pIndex = pIndex;
- }else{
- Index *pOther = pTab->pIndex;
- while( pOther->pNext && pOther->pNext->onError!=OE_Replace ){
- pOther = pOther->pNext;
- }
- pIndex->pNext = pOther->pNext;
- pOther->pNext = pIndex;
- }
-
- /* If the db->init.busy is 1 it means we are reading the SQL off the
- ** "sqlite_master" table on the disk. So do not write to the disk
- ** again. Extract the table number from the db->init.newTnum field.
- */
- if( db->init.busy && pTable!=0 ){
- pIndex->tnum = db->init.newTnum;
- }
-
- /* If the db->init.busy is 0 then create the index on disk. This
- ** involves writing the index into the master table and filling in the
- ** index with the current table contents.
- **
- ** The db->init.busy is 0 when the user first enters a CREATE INDEX
- ** command. db->init.busy is 1 when a database is opened and
- ** CREATE INDEX statements are read out of the master table. In
- ** the latter case the index already exists on disk, which is why
- ** we don't want to recreate it.
- **
- ** If pTable==0 it means this index is generated as a primary key
- ** or UNITQUE constraint of a CREATE TABLE statement. Since the table
- ** has just been created, it contains no data and the index initialization
- ** step can be skipped.
- */
- else if( db->init.busy==0 ){
- int n;
- Vdbe *v;
- int lbl1, lbl2;
- int i;
- int addr;
-
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) goto exit_create_index;
- if( pTable!=0 ){
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 0, isTemp);
- sqliteOpenMasterTable(v, isTemp);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NewRecno, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, "index", P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, pIndex->zName, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, pTab->zName, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_CreateIndex, 0, isTemp,(char*)&pIndex->tnum,P3_POINTER);
- pIndex->tnum = 0;
- if( pTable ){
- sqliteVdbeCode(v,
- OP_Dup, 0, 0,
- OP_Integer, isTemp, 0,
- OP_OpenWrite, 1, 0,
- 0);
- }
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- if( pStart && pEnd ){
- n = Addr(pEnd->z) - Addr(pStart->z) + 1;
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, addr, pStart->z, n);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeRecord, 5, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, 0, 0);
- if( pTable ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pTab->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_OpenRead, 2, pTab->tnum, pTab->zName, 0);
- lbl2 = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, 2, lbl2);
- lbl1 = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Recno, 2, 0);
- for(i=0; i<pIndex->nColumn; i++){
- int iCol = pIndex->aiColumn[i];
- if( pTab->iPKey==iCol ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, i, 0);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, 2, iCol);
- }
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeIdxKey, pIndex->nColumn, 0);
- if( db->file_format>=4 ) sqliteAddIdxKeyType(v, pIndex);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_IdxPut, 1, pIndex->onError!=OE_None,
- "indexed columns are not unique", P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Next, 2, lbl1);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, lbl2);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, 2, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, 1, 0);
- }
- if( pTable!=0 ){
- if( !isTemp ){
- sqliteChangeCookie(db, v);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, 0, 0);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- }
- }
-
- /* Clean up before exiting */
-exit_create_index:
- sqliteIdListDelete(pList);
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pTable);
- sqliteFree(zName);
- return;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine will drop an existing named index. This routine
-** implements the DROP INDEX statement.
-*/
-void sqliteDropIndex(Parse *pParse, SrcList *pName){
- Index *pIndex;
- Vdbe *v;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
-
- if( pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ) return;
- assert( pName->nSrc==1 );
- pIndex = sqliteFindIndex(db, pName->a[0].zName, pName->a[0].zDatabase);
- if( pIndex==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "no such index: %S", pName, 0);
- goto exit_drop_index;
- }
- if( pIndex->autoIndex ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "index associated with UNITQUE "
- "or PRIMARY KEY constraint cannot be dropped", 0);
- goto exit_drop_index;
- }
- if( pIndex->iDb>1 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot alter schema of attached "
- "databases", 0);
- goto exit_drop_index;
- }
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- {
- int code = STQLITE_DROP_INDEX;
- Table *pTab = pIndex->pTable;
- const char *zDb = db->aDb[pIndex->iDb].zName;
- const char *zTab = SCHEMA_TABLE(pIndex->iDb);
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_DELETE, zTab, 0, zDb) ){
- goto exit_drop_index;
- }
- if( pIndex->iDb ) code = STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_INDEX;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, code, pIndex->zName, pTab->zName, zDb) ){
- goto exit_drop_index;
- }
- }
-#endif
-
- /* Generate code to remove the index and from the master table */
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v ){
- static VdbeOpList dropIndex[] = {
- { OP_Rewind, 0, ADDR(9), 0},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, 0}, /* 1 */
- { OP_MemStore, 1, 1, 0},
- { OP_MemLoad, 1, 0, 0}, /* 3 */
- { OP_Column, 0, 1, 0},
- { OP_Eq, 0, ADDR(8), 0},
- { OP_Next, 0, ADDR(3), 0},
- { OP_Goto, 0, ADDR(9), 0},
- { OP_Delete, 0, 0, 0}, /* 8 */
- };
- int base;
-
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 0, pIndex->iDb);
- sqliteOpenMasterTable(v, pIndex->iDb);
- base = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(dropIndex), dropIndex);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, base+1, pIndex->zName, 0);
- if( pIndex->iDb==0 ){
- sqliteChangeCookie(db, v);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Destroy, pIndex->tnum, pIndex->iDb);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- }
-
- /* Delete the in-memory description of this index.
- */
- if( !pParse->explain ){
- sqliteUnlinkAndDeleteIndex(db, pIndex);
- db->flags |= STQLITE_InternChanges;
- }
-
-exit_drop_index:
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pName);
-}
-
-/*
-** Append a new element to the given IdList. Create a new IdList if
-** need be.
-**
-** A new IdList is returned, or NULL if malloc() fails.
-*/
-IdList *sqliteIdListAppend(IdList *pList, Token *pToken){
- if( pList==0 ){
- pList = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(IdList) );
- if( pList==0 ) return 0;
- pList->nAlloc = 0;
- }
- if( pList->nId>=pList->nAlloc ){
- struct IdList_item *a;
- pList->nAlloc = pList->nAlloc*2 + 5;
- a = sqliteRealloc(pList->a, pList->nAlloc*sizeof(pList->a[0]) );
- if( a==0 ){
- sqliteIdListDelete(pList);
- return 0;
- }
- pList->a = a;
- }
- memset(&pList->a[pList->nId], 0, sizeof(pList->a[0]));
- if( pToken ){
- char **pz = &pList->a[pList->nId].zName;
- sqliteSetNString(pz, pToken->z, pToken->n, 0);
- if( *pz==0 ){
- sqliteIdListDelete(pList);
- return 0;
- }else{
- sqliteDequote(*pz);
- }
- }
- pList->nId++;
- return pList;
-}
-
-/*
-** Append a new table name to the given SrcList. Create a new SrcList if
-** need be. A new entry is created in the SrcList even if pToken is NULL.
-**
-** A new SrcList is returned, or NULL if malloc() fails.
-**
-** If pDatabase is not null, it means that the table has an optional
-** database name prefix. Like this: "database.table". The pDatabase
-** points to the table name and the pTable points to the database name.
-** The SrcList.a[].zName field is filled with the table name which might
-** come from pTable (if pDatabase is NULL) or from pDatabase.
-** SrcList.a[].zDatabase is filled with the database name from pTable,
-** or with NULL if no database is specified.
-**
-** In other words, if call like this:
-**
-** sqliteSrcListAppend(A,B,0);
-**
-** Then B is a table name and the database name is unspecified. If called
-** like this:
-**
-** sqliteSrcListAppend(A,B,C);
-**
-** Then C is the table name and B is the database name.
-*/
-SrcList *sqliteSrcListAppend(SrcList *pList, Token *pTable, Token *pDatabase){
- if( pList==0 ){
- pList = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(SrcList) );
- if( pList==0 ) return 0;
- pList->nAlloc = 1;
- }
- if( pList->nSrc>=pList->nAlloc ){
- SrcList *pNew;
- pList->nAlloc *= 2;
- pNew = sqliteRealloc(pList,
- sizeof(*pList) + (pList->nAlloc-1)*sizeof(pList->a[0]) );
- if( pNew==0 ){
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pList);
- return 0;
- }
- pList = pNew;
- }
- memset(&pList->a[pList->nSrc], 0, sizeof(pList->a[0]));
- if( pDatabase && pDatabase->z==0 ){
- pDatabase = 0;
- }
- if( pDatabase && pTable ){
- Token *pTemp = pDatabase;
- pDatabase = pTable;
- pTable = pTemp;
- }
- if( pTable ){
- char **pz = &pList->a[pList->nSrc].zName;
- sqliteSetNString(pz, pTable->z, pTable->n, 0);
- if( *pz==0 ){
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pList);
- return 0;
- }else{
- sqliteDequote(*pz);
- }
- }
- if( pDatabase ){
- char **pz = &pList->a[pList->nSrc].zDatabase;
- sqliteSetNString(pz, pDatabase->z, pDatabase->n, 0);
- if( *pz==0 ){
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pList);
- return 0;
- }else{
- sqliteDequote(*pz);
- }
- }
- pList->a[pList->nSrc].iCursor = -1;
- pList->nSrc++;
- return pList;
-}
-
-/*
-** Assign cursors to all tables in a SrcList
-*/
-void sqliteSrcListAssignCursors(Parse *pParse, SrcList *pList){
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<pList->nSrc; i++){
- if( pList->a[i].iCursor<0 ){
- pList->a[i].iCursor = pParse->nTab++;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Add an alias to the last identifier on the given identifier list.
-*/
-void sqliteSrcListAddAlias(SrcList *pList, Token *pToken){
- if( pList && pList->nSrc>0 ){
- int i = pList->nSrc - 1;
- sqliteSetNString(&pList->a[i].zAlias, pToken->z, pToken->n, 0);
- sqliteDequote(pList->a[i].zAlias);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Delete an IdList.
-*/
-void sqliteIdListDelete(IdList *pList){
- int i;
- if( pList==0 ) return;
- for(i=0; i<pList->nId; i++){
- sqliteFree(pList->a[i].zName);
- }
- sqliteFree(pList->a);
- sqliteFree(pList);
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the index in pList of the identifier named zId. Return -1
-** if not found.
-*/
-int sqliteIdListIndex(IdList *pList, const char *zName){
- int i;
- if( pList==0 ) return -1;
- for(i=0; i<pList->nId; i++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(pList->a[i].zName, zName)==0 ) return i;
- }
- return -1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Delete an entire SrcList including all its substructure.
-*/
-void sqliteSrcListDelete(SrcList *pList){
- int i;
- if( pList==0 ) return;
- for(i=0; i<pList->nSrc; i++){
- sqliteFree(pList->a[i].zDatabase);
- sqliteFree(pList->a[i].zName);
- sqliteFree(pList->a[i].zAlias);
- if( pList->a[i].pTab && pList->a[i].pTab->isTransient ){
- sqliteDeleteTable(0, pList->a[i].pTab);
- }
- sqliteSelectDelete(pList->a[i].pSelect);
- sqliteExprDelete(pList->a[i].pOn);
- sqliteIdListDelete(pList->a[i].pUsing);
- }
- sqliteFree(pList);
-}
-
-/*
-** Begin a transaction
-*/
-void sqliteBeginTransaction(Parse *pParse, int onError){
- sqlite *db;
-
- if( pParse==0 || (db=pParse->db)==0 || db->aDb[0].pBt==0 ) return;
- if( pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ) return;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_TRANSACTION, "BEGIN", 0, 0) ) return;
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_InTrans ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot start a transaction within a transaction");
- return;
- }
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 0, 0);
- if( !pParse->explain ){
- db->flags |= STQLITE_InTrans;
- db->onError = onError;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Commit a transaction
-*/
-void sqliteCommitTransaction(Parse *pParse){
- sqlite *db;
-
- if( pParse==0 || (db=pParse->db)==0 || db->aDb[0].pBt==0 ) return;
- if( pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ) return;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_TRANSACTION, "COMMIT", 0, 0) ) return;
- if( (db->flags & STQLITE_InTrans)==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot commit - no transaction is active");
- return;
- }
- if( !pParse->explain ){
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_InTrans;
- }
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- if( !pParse->explain ){
- db->onError = OE_Default;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Rollback a transaction
-*/
-void sqliteRollbackTransaction(Parse *pParse){
- sqlite *db;
- Vdbe *v;
-
- if( pParse==0 || (db=pParse->db)==0 || db->aDb[0].pBt==0 ) return;
- if( pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ) return;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_TRANSACTION, "ROLLBACK", 0, 0) ) return;
- if( (db->flags & STQLITE_InTrans)==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot rollback - no transaction is active");
- return;
- }
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rollback, 0, 0);
- }
- if( !pParse->explain ){
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_InTrans;
- db->onError = OE_Default;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate VDBE code that will verify the schema cookie for all
-** named database files.
-*/
-void sqliteCodeVerifySchema(Parse *pParse, int iDb){
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- Vdbe *v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- assert( iDb>=0 && iDb<db->nDb );
- assert( db->aDb[iDb].pBt!=0 );
- if( iDb!=1 && !DbHasProperty(db, iDb, DB_Cookie) ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_VerifyCookie, iDb, db->aDb[iDb].schema_cookie);
- DbSetProperty(db, iDb, DB_Cookie);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate VDBE code that prepares for doing an operation that
-** might change the database.
-**
-** This routine starts a new transaction if we are not already within
-** a transaction. If we are already within a transaction, then a checkpoint
-** is set if the setCheckpoint parameter is true. A checkpoint should
-** be set for operations that might fail (due to a constraint) part of
-** the way through and which will need to undo some writes without having to
-** rollback the whole transaction. For operations where all constraints
-** can be checked before any changes are made to the database, it is never
-** necessary to undo a write and the checkpoint should not be set.
-**
-** Only database iDb and the temp database are made writable by this call.
-** If iDb==0, then the main and temp databases are made writable. If
-** iDb==1 then only the temp database is made writable. If iDb>1 then the
-** specified auxiliary database and the temp database are made writable.
-*/
-void sqliteBeginWriteOperation(Parse *pParse, int setCheckpoint, int iDb){
- Vdbe *v;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- if( DbHasProperty(db, iDb, DB_Locked) ) return;
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) return;
- if( !db->aDb[iDb].inTrans ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Transaction, iDb, 0);
- DbSetProperty(db, iDb, DB_Locked);
- sqliteCodeVerifySchema(pParse, iDb);
- if( iDb!=1 ){
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, setCheckpoint, 1);
- }
- }else if( setCheckpoint ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Checkpoint, iDb, 0);
- DbSetProperty(db, iDb, DB_Locked);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code that concludes an operation that may have changed
-** the database. If a statement transaction was started, then emit
-** an OP_Commit that will cause the changes to be committed to disk.
-**
-** Note that checkpoints are automatically committed at the end of
-** a statement. Note also that there can be multiple calls to
-** sqliteBeginWriteOperation() but there should only be a single
-** call to sqliteEndWriteOperation() at the conclusion of the statement.
-*/
-void sqliteEndWriteOperation(Parse *pParse){
- Vdbe *v;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- if( pParse->trigStack ) return; /* if this is in a trigger */
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) return;
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_InTrans ){
- /* A BEGIN has executed. Do not commit until we see an explicit
- ** COMMIT statement. */
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Commit, 0, 0);
- }
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/config.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/config.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 0cf0524..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/config.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,23 +0,0 @@
-#include <tqglobal.h>
-#include <tqconfig.h>
-
-#ifndef TQT_POINTER_SIZE
-# ifdef TQ_OS_WIN32
-# define TQT_POINTER_SIZE 4
-# elif TQ_OS_WIN64
-# define TQT_POINTER_SIZE 8
-# else
-# error This platform is unsupported
-# endif
-#endif /* TQT_POINTER_SIZE */
-
-#define STQLITE_PTR_SZ TQT_POINTER_SIZE
-
-#ifdef UNICODE
-# undef UNICODE
-#endif
-
-#ifdef TQ_CC_MSVC
-# pragma warning(disable: 4018)
-# pragma warning(disable: 4761)
-#endif
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/copy.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/copy.c
deleted file mode 100644
index dbd3b3c..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/copy.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,110 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2003 April 6
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains code used to implement the COPY command.
-**
-** $Id: copy.c,v 1.9 2004/02/25 13:47:31 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-/*
-** The COPY command is for compatibility with PostgreSQL and specificially
-** for the ability to read the output of pg_dump. The format is as
-** follows:
-**
-** COPY table FROM file [USING DELIMITERS string]
-**
-** "table" is an existing table name. We will read lines of code from
-** file to fill this table with data. File might be "stdin". The optional
-** delimiter string identifies the field separators. The default is a tab.
-*/
-void sqliteCopy(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- SrcList *pTableName, /* The name of the table into which we will insert */
- Token *pFilename, /* The file from which to obtain information */
- Token *pDelimiter, /* Use this as the field delimiter */
- int onError /* What to do if a constraint fails */
-){
- Table *pTab;
- int i;
- Vdbe *v;
- int addr, end;
- char *zFile = 0;
- const char *zDb;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
-
-
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto copy_cleanup;
- assert( pTableName->nSrc==1 );
- pTab = sqliteSrcListLookup(pParse, pTableName);
- if( pTab==0 || sqliteIsReadOnly(pParse, pTab, 0) ) goto copy_cleanup;
- zFile = sqliteStrNDup(pFilename->z, pFilename->n);
- sqliteDequote(zFile);
- assert( pTab->iDb<db->nDb );
- zDb = db->aDb[pTab->iDb].zName;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_INSERT, pTab->zName, 0, zDb)
- || sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_COPY, pTab->zName, zFile, zDb) ){
- goto copy_cleanup;
- }
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v ){
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 1, pTab->iDb);
- addr = sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_FileOpen, 0, 0, pFilename->z, pFilename->n);
- sqliteVdbeDequoteP3(v, addr);
- sqliteOpenTableAndIndices(pParse, pTab, 0);
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 0, 0); /* Initialize the row count */
- }
- end = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_FileRead, pTab->nCol, end);
- if( pDelimiter ){
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, addr, pDelimiter->z, pDelimiter->n);
- sqliteVdbeDequoteP3(v, addr);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, addr, "\t", 1);
- }
- if( pTab->iPKey>=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_FileColumn, pTab->iPKey, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MustBeInt, 0, 0);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NewRecno, 0, 0);
- }
- for(i=0; i<pTab->nCol; i++){
- if( i==pTab->iPKey ){
- /* The integer primary key column is filled with NULL since its
- ** value is always pulled from the record number */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_FileColumn, i, 0);
- }
- }
- sqliteGenerateConstraintChecks(pParse, pTab, 0, 0, pTab->iPKey>=0,
- 0, onError, addr);
- sqliteCompleteInsertion(pParse, pTab, 0, 0, 0, 0, -1);
- if( (db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows)!=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AddImm, 1, 0); /* Increment row count */
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, addr);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, end);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Noop, 0, 0);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ColumnName, 0, 1);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, -1, "rows inserted", P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Callback, 1, 0);
- }
- }
-
-copy_cleanup:
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pTableName);
- sqliteFree(zFile);
- return;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/date.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/date.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 5ca2b81..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/date.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,873 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2003 October 31
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains the C functions that implement date and time
-** functions for STQLite.
-**
-** There is only one exported symbol in this file - the function
-** sqliteRegisterDateTimeFunctions() found at the bottom of the file.
-** All other code has file scope.
-**
-** $Id: date.c,v 1.16 2004/02/29 01:08:18 drh Exp $
-**
-** NOTES:
-**
-** STQLite processes all times and dates as Julian Day numbers. The
-** dates and times are stored as the number of days since noon
-** in Greenwich on November 24, 4714 B.C. according to the Gregorian
-** calendar system.
-**
-** 1970-01-01 00:00:00 is JD 2440587.5
-** 2000-01-01 00:00:00 is JD 2451544.5
-**
-** This implemention requires years to be expressed as a 4-digit number
-** which means that only dates between 0000-01-01 and 9999-12-31 can
-** be represented, even though julian day numbers allow a much wider
-** range of dates.
-**
-** The Gregorian calendar system is used for all dates and times,
-** even those that predate the Gregorian calendar. Historians usually
-** use the Julian calendar for dates prior to 1582-10-15 and for some
-** dates afterwards, depending on locale. Beware of this difference.
-**
-** The conversion algorithms are implemented based on descriptions
-** in the following text:
-**
-** Jean Meeus
-** Astronomical Algorithms, 2nd Edition, 1998
-** ISBM 0-943396-61-1
-** Willmann-Bell, Inc
-** Richmond, Virginia (USA)
-*/
-#include "os.h"
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <assert.h>
-#include <time.h>
-
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS
-
-/*
-** A structure for holding a single date and time.
-*/
-typedef struct DateTime DateTime;
-struct DateTime {
- double rJD; /* The julian day number */
- int Y, M, D; /* Year, month, and day */
- int h, m; /* Hour and minutes */
- int tz; /* Timezone offset in minutes */
- double s; /* Seconds */
- char validYMD; /* True if Y,M,D are valid */
- char validHMS; /* True if h,m,s are valid */
- char validJD; /* True if rJD is valid */
- char validTZ; /* True if tz is valid */
-};
-
-
-/*
-** Convert zDate into one or more integers. Additional arguments
-** come in groups of 5 as follows:
-**
-** N number of digits in the integer
-** min minimum allowed value of the integer
-** max maximum allowed value of the integer
-** nextC first character after the integer
-** pVal where to write the integers value.
-**
-** Conversions continue until one with nextC==0 is encountered.
-** The function returns the number of successful conversions.
-*/
-static int getDigits(const char *zDate, ...){
- va_list ap;
- int val;
- int N;
- int min;
- int max;
- int nextC;
- int *pVal;
- int cnt = 0;
- va_start(ap, zDate);
- do{
- N = va_arg(ap, int);
- min = va_arg(ap, int);
- max = va_arg(ap, int);
- nextC = va_arg(ap, int);
- pVal = va_arg(ap, int*);
- val = 0;
- while( N-- ){
- if( !isdigit(*zDate) ){
- return cnt;
- }
- val = val*10 + *zDate - '0';
- zDate++;
- }
- if( val<min || val>max || (nextC!=0 && nextC!=*zDate) ){
- return cnt;
- }
- *pVal = val;
- zDate++;
- cnt++;
- }while( nextC );
- return cnt;
-}
-
-/*
-** Read text from z[] and convert into a floating point number. Return
-** the number of digits converted.
-*/
-static int getValue(const char *z, double *pR){
- const char *zEnd;
- *pR = sqliteAtoF(z, &zEnd);
- return zEnd - z;
-}
-
-/*
-** Parse a timezone extension on the end of a date-time.
-** The extension is of the form:
-**
-** (+/-)HH:MM
-**
-** If the parse is successful, write the number of minutes
-** of change in *pnMin and return 0. If a parser error occurs,
-** return 0.
-**
-** A missing specifier is not considered an error.
-*/
-static int parseTimezone(const char *zDate, DateTime *p){
- int sgn = 0;
- int nHr, nMn;
- while( isspace(*zDate) ){ zDate++; }
- p->tz = 0;
- if( *zDate=='-' ){
- sgn = -1;
- }else if( *zDate=='+' ){
- sgn = +1;
- }else{
- return *zDate!=0;
- }
- zDate++;
- if( getDigits(zDate, 2, 0, 14, ':', &nHr, 2, 0, 59, 0, &nMn)!=2 ){
- return 1;
- }
- zDate += 5;
- p->tz = sgn*(nMn + nHr*60);
- while( isspace(*zDate) ){ zDate++; }
- return *zDate!=0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Parse times of the form HH:MM or HH:MM:SS or HH:MM:SS.FFFF.
-** The HH, MM, and SS must each be exactly 2 digits. The
-** fractional seconds FFFF can be one or more digits.
-**
-** Return 1 if there is a parsing error and 0 on success.
-*/
-static int parseHhMmSs(const char *zDate, DateTime *p){
- int h, m, s;
- double ms = 0.0;
- if( getDigits(zDate, 2, 0, 24, ':', &h, 2, 0, 59, 0, &m)!=2 ){
- return 1;
- }
- zDate += 5;
- if( *zDate==':' ){
- zDate++;
- if( getDigits(zDate, 2, 0, 59, 0, &s)!=1 ){
- return 1;
- }
- zDate += 2;
- if( *zDate=='.' && isdigit(zDate[1]) ){
- double rScale = 1.0;
- zDate++;
- while( isdigit(*zDate) ){
- ms = ms*10.0 + *zDate - '0';
- rScale *= 10.0;
- zDate++;
- }
- ms /= rScale;
- }
- }else{
- s = 0;
- }
- p->validJD = 0;
- p->validHMS = 1;
- p->h = h;
- p->m = m;
- p->s = s + ms;
- if( parseTimezone(zDate, p) ) return 1;
- p->validTZ = p->tz!=0;
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Convert from YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS to julian day. We always assume
-** that the YYYY-MM-DD is according to the Gregorian calendar.
-**
-** Reference: Meeus page 61
-*/
-static void computeJD(DateTime *p){
- int Y, M, D, A, B, X1, X2;
-
- if( p->validJD ) return;
- if( p->validYMD ){
- Y = p->Y;
- M = p->M;
- D = p->D;
- }else{
- Y = 2000; /* If no YMD specified, assume 2000-Jan-01 */
- M = 1;
- D = 1;
- }
- if( M<=2 ){
- Y--;
- M += 12;
- }
- A = Y/100;
- B = 2 - A + (A/4);
- X1 = 365.25*(Y+4716);
- X2 = 30.6001*(M+1);
- p->rJD = X1 + X2 + D + B - 1524.5;
- p->validJD = 1;
- p->validYMD = 0;
- if( p->validHMS ){
- p->rJD += (p->h*3600.0 + p->m*60.0 + p->s)/86400.0;
- if( p->validTZ ){
- p->rJD += p->tz*60/86400.0;
- p->validHMS = 0;
- p->validTZ = 0;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Parse dates of the form
-**
-** YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS.FFF
-** YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS
-** YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM
-** YYYY-MM-DD
-**
-** Write the result into the DateTime structure and return 0
-** on success and 1 if the input string is not a well-formed
-** date.
-*/
-static int parseYyyyMmDd(const char *zDate, DateTime *p){
- int Y, M, D, neg;
-
- if( zDate[0]=='-' ){
- zDate++;
- neg = 1;
- }else{
- neg = 0;
- }
- if( getDigits(zDate,4,0,9999,'-',&Y,2,1,12,'-',&M,2,1,31,0,&D)!=3 ){
- return 1;
- }
- zDate += 10;
- while( isspace(*zDate) ){ zDate++; }
- if( parseHhMmSs(zDate, p)==0 ){
- /* We got the time */
- }else if( *zDate==0 ){
- p->validHMS = 0;
- }else{
- return 1;
- }
- p->validJD = 0;
- p->validYMD = 1;
- p->Y = neg ? -Y : Y;
- p->M = M;
- p->D = D;
- if( p->validTZ ){
- computeJD(p);
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Attempt to parse the given string into a Julian Day Number. Return
-** the number of errors.
-**
-** The following are acceptable forms for the input string:
-**
-** YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS.FFF +/-HH:MM
-** DDDD.DD
-** now
-**
-** In the first form, the +/-HH:MM is always optional. The fractional
-** seconds extension (the ".FFF") is optional. The seconds portion
-** (":SS.FFF") is option. The year and date can be omitted as long
-** as there is a time string. The time string can be omitted as long
-** as there is a year and date.
-*/
-static int parseDateOrTime(const char *zDate, DateTime *p){
- memset(p, 0, sizeof(*p));
- if( parseYyyyMmDd(zDate,p)==0 ){
- return 0;
- }else if( parseHhMmSs(zDate, p)==0 ){
- return 0;
- }else if( sqliteStrICmp(zDate,"now")==0){
- double r;
- if( sqliteOsCurrentTime(&r)==0 ){
- p->rJD = r;
- p->validJD = 1;
- return 0;
- }
- return 1;
- }else if( sqliteIsNumber(zDate) ){
- p->rJD = sqliteAtoF(zDate, 0);
- p->validJD = 1;
- return 0;
- }
- return 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Compute the Year, Month, and Day from the julian day number.
-*/
-static void computeYMD(DateTime *p){
- int Z, A, B, C, D, E, X1;
- if( p->validYMD ) return;
- if( !p->validJD ){
- p->Y = 2000;
- p->M = 1;
- p->D = 1;
- }else{
- Z = p->rJD + 0.5;
- A = (Z - 1867216.25)/36524.25;
- A = Z + 1 + A - (A/4);
- B = A + 1524;
- C = (B - 122.1)/365.25;
- D = 365.25*C;
- E = (B-D)/30.6001;
- X1 = 30.6001*E;
- p->D = B - D - X1;
- p->M = E<14 ? E-1 : E-13;
- p->Y = p->M>2 ? C - 4716 : C - 4715;
- }
- p->validYMD = 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Compute the Hour, Minute, and Seconds from the julian day number.
-*/
-static void computeHMS(DateTime *p){
- int Z, s;
- if( p->validHMS ) return;
- Z = p->rJD + 0.5;
- s = (p->rJD + 0.5 - Z)*86400000.0 + 0.5;
- p->s = 0.001*s;
- s = p->s;
- p->s -= s;
- p->h = s/3600;
- s -= p->h*3600;
- p->m = s/60;
- p->s += s - p->m*60;
- p->validHMS = 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Compute both YMD and HMS
-*/
-static void computeYMD_HMS(DateTime *p){
- computeYMD(p);
- computeHMS(p);
-}
-
-/*
-** Clear the YMD and HMS and the TZ
-*/
-static void clearYMD_HMS_TZ(DateTime *p){
- p->validYMD = 0;
- p->validHMS = 0;
- p->validTZ = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Compute the difference (in days) between localtime and UTC (a.k.a. GMT)
-** for the time value p where p is in UTC.
-*/
-static double localtimeOffset(DateTime *p){
- DateTime x, y;
- time_t t;
- struct tm *pTm;
- x = *p;
- computeYMD_HMS(&x);
- if( x.Y<1971 || x.Y>=2038 ){
- x.Y = 2000;
- x.M = 1;
- x.D = 1;
- x.h = 0;
- x.m = 0;
- x.s = 0.0;
- } else {
- int s = x.s + 0.5;
- x.s = s;
- }
- x.tz = 0;
- x.validJD = 0;
- computeJD(&x);
- t = (x.rJD-2440587.5)*86400.0 + 0.5;
- sqliteOsEnterMutex();
- pTm = localtime(&t);
- y.Y = pTm->tm_year + 1900;
- y.M = pTm->tm_mon + 1;
- y.D = pTm->tm_mday;
- y.h = pTm->tm_hour;
- y.m = pTm->tm_min;
- y.s = pTm->tm_sec;
- sqliteOsLeaveMutex();
- y.validYMD = 1;
- y.validHMS = 1;
- y.validJD = 0;
- y.validTZ = 0;
- computeJD(&y);
- return y.rJD - x.rJD;
-}
-
-/*
-** Process a modifier to a date-time stamp. The modifiers are
-** as follows:
-**
-** NNN days
-** NNN hours
-** NNN minutes
-** NNN.NNNN seconds
-** NNN months
-** NNN years
-** start of month
-** start of year
-** start of week
-** start of day
-** weekday N
-** unixepoch
-** localtime
-** utc
-**
-** Return 0 on success and 1 if there is any kind of error.
-*/
-static int parseModifier(const char *zMod, DateTime *p){
- int rc = 1;
- int n;
- double r;
- char *z, zBuf[30];
- z = zBuf;
- for(n=0; n<sizeof(zBuf)-1 && zMod[n]; n++){
- z[n] = tolower(zMod[n]);
- }
- z[n] = 0;
- switch( z[0] ){
- case 'l': {
- /* localtime
- **
- ** Assuming the current time value is UTC (a.k.a. GMT), shift it to
- ** show local time.
- */
- if( strcmp(z, "localtime")==0 ){
- computeJD(p);
- p->rJD += localtimeOffset(p);
- clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
- rc = 0;
- }
- break;
- }
- case 'u': {
- /*
- ** unixepoch
- **
- ** Treat the current value of p->rJD as the number of
- ** seconds since 1970. Convert to a real julian day number.
- */
- if( strcmp(z, "unixepoch")==0 && p->validJD ){
- p->rJD = p->rJD/86400.0 + 2440587.5;
- clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
- rc = 0;
- }else if( strcmp(z, "utc")==0 ){
- double c1;
- computeJD(p);
- c1 = localtimeOffset(p);
- p->rJD -= c1;
- clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
- p->rJD += c1 - localtimeOffset(p);
- rc = 0;
- }
- break;
- }
- case 'w': {
- /*
- ** weekday N
- **
- ** Move the date to the same time on the next occurrance of
- ** weekday N where 0==Sunday, 1==Monday, and so forth. If the
- ** date is already on the appropriate weekday, this is a no-op.
- */
- if( strncmp(z, "weekday ", 8)==0 && getValue(&z[8],&r)>0
- && (n=r)==r && n>=0 && r<7 ){
- int Z;
- computeYMD_HMS(p);
- p->validTZ = 0;
- p->validJD = 0;
- computeJD(p);
- Z = p->rJD + 1.5;
- Z %= 7;
- if( Z>n ) Z -= 7;
- p->rJD += n - Z;
- clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
- rc = 0;
- }
- break;
- }
- case 's': {
- /*
- ** start of TTTTT
- **
- ** Move the date backwards to the beginning of the current day,
- ** or month or year.
- */
- if( strncmp(z, "start of ", 9)!=0 ) break;
- z += 9;
- computeYMD(p);
- p->validHMS = 1;
- p->h = p->m = 0;
- p->s = 0.0;
- p->validTZ = 0;
- p->validJD = 0;
- if( strcmp(z,"month")==0 ){
- p->D = 1;
- rc = 0;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"year")==0 ){
- computeYMD(p);
- p->M = 1;
- p->D = 1;
- rc = 0;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"day")==0 ){
- rc = 0;
- }
- break;
- }
- case '+':
- case '-':
- case '0':
- case '1':
- case '2':
- case '3':
- case '4':
- case '5':
- case '6':
- case '7':
- case '8':
- case '9': {
- n = getValue(z, &r);
- if( n<=0 ) break;
- if( z[n]==':' ){
- /* A modifier of the form (+|-)HH:MM:SS.FFF adds (or subtracts) the
- ** specified number of hours, minutes, seconds, and fractional seconds
- ** to the time. The ".FFF" may be omitted. The ":SS.FFF" may be
- ** omitted.
- */
- const char *z2 = z;
- DateTime tx;
- int day;
- if( !isdigit(*z2) ) z2++;
- memset(&tx, 0, sizeof(tx));
- if( parseHhMmSs(z2, &tx) ) break;
- computeJD(&tx);
- tx.rJD -= 0.5;
- day = (int)tx.rJD;
- tx.rJD -= day;
- if( z[0]=='-' ) tx.rJD = -tx.rJD;
- computeJD(p);
- clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
- p->rJD += tx.rJD;
- rc = 0;
- break;
- }
- z += n;
- while( isspace(z[0]) ) z++;
- n = strlen(z);
- if( n>10 || n<3 ) break;
- if( z[n-1]=='s' ){ z[n-1] = 0; n--; }
- computeJD(p);
- rc = 0;
- if( n==3 && strcmp(z,"day")==0 ){
- p->rJD += r;
- }else if( n==4 && strcmp(z,"hour")==0 ){
- p->rJD += r/24.0;
- }else if( n==6 && strcmp(z,"minute")==0 ){
- p->rJD += r/(24.0*60.0);
- }else if( n==6 && strcmp(z,"second")==0 ){
- p->rJD += r/(24.0*60.0*60.0);
- }else if( n==5 && strcmp(z,"month")==0 ){
- int x, y;
- computeYMD_HMS(p);
- p->M += r;
- x = p->M>0 ? (p->M-1)/12 : (p->M-12)/12;
- p->Y += x;
- p->M -= x*12;
- p->validJD = 0;
- computeJD(p);
- y = r;
- if( y!=r ){
- p->rJD += (r - y)*30.0;
- }
- }else if( n==4 && strcmp(z,"year")==0 ){
- computeYMD_HMS(p);
- p->Y += r;
- p->validJD = 0;
- computeJD(p);
- }else{
- rc = 1;
- }
- clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
- break;
- }
- default: {
- break;
- }
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Process time function arguments. argv[0] is a date-time stamp.
-** argv[1] and following are modifiers. Parse them all and write
-** the resulting time into the DateTime structure p. Return 0
-** on success and 1 if there are any errors.
-*/
-static int isDate(int argc, const char **argv, DateTime *p){
- int i;
- if( argc==0 ) return 1;
- if( argv[0]==0 || parseDateOrTime(argv[0], p) ) return 1;
- for(i=1; i<argc; i++){
- if( argv[i]==0 || parseModifier(argv[i], p) ) return 1;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-
-/*
-** The following routines implement the various date and time functions
-** of STQLite.
-*/
-
-/*
-** julianday( TIMESTRING, MOD, MOD, ...)
-**
-** Return the julian day number of the date specified in the arguments
-*/
-static void juliandayFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- DateTime x;
- if( isDate(argc, argv, &x)==0 ){
- computeJD(&x);
- sqlite_set_result_double(context, x.rJD);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** datetime( TIMESTRING, MOD, MOD, ...)
-**
-** Return YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS
-*/
-static void datetimeFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- DateTime x;
- if( isDate(argc, argv, &x)==0 ){
- char zBuf[100];
- computeYMD_HMS(&x);
- sprintf(zBuf, "%04d-%02d-%02d %02d:%02d:%02d",x.Y, x.M, x.D, x.h, x.m,
- (int)(x.s));
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, zBuf, -1);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** time( TIMESTRING, MOD, MOD, ...)
-**
-** Return HH:MM:SS
-*/
-static void timeFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- DateTime x;
- if( isDate(argc, argv, &x)==0 ){
- char zBuf[100];
- computeHMS(&x);
- sprintf(zBuf, "%02d:%02d:%02d", x.h, x.m, (int)x.s);
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, zBuf, -1);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** date( TIMESTRING, MOD, MOD, ...)
-**
-** Return YYYY-MM-DD
-*/
-static void dateFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- DateTime x;
- if( isDate(argc, argv, &x)==0 ){
- char zBuf[100];
- computeYMD(&x);
- sprintf(zBuf, "%04d-%02d-%02d", x.Y, x.M, x.D);
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, zBuf, -1);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** strftime( FORMAT, TIMESTRING, MOD, MOD, ...)
-**
-** Return a string described by FORMAT. Conversions as follows:
-**
-** %d day of month
-** %f ** fractional seconds SS.SSS
-** %H hour 00-24
-** %j day of year 000-366
-** %J ** Julian day number
-** %m month 01-12
-** %M minute 00-59
-** %s seconds since 1970-01-01
-** %S seconds 00-59
-** %w day of week 0-6 sunday==0
-** %W week of year 00-53
-** %Y year 0000-9999
-** %% %
-*/
-static void strftimeFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- DateTime x;
- int n, i, j;
- char *z;
- const char *zFmt = argv[0];
- char zBuf[100];
- if( argv[0]==0 || isDate(argc-1, argv+1, &x) ) return;
- for(i=0, n=1; zFmt[i]; i++, n++){
- if( zFmt[i]=='%' ){
- switch( zFmt[i+1] ){
- case 'd':
- case 'H':
- case 'm':
- case 'M':
- case 'S':
- case 'W':
- n++;
- /* fall thru */
- case 'w':
- case '%':
- break;
- case 'f':
- n += 8;
- break;
- case 'j':
- n += 3;
- break;
- case 'Y':
- n += 8;
- break;
- case 's':
- case 'J':
- n += 50;
- break;
- default:
- return; /* ERROR. return a NULL */
- }
- i++;
- }
- }
- if( n<sizeof(zBuf) ){
- z = zBuf;
- }else{
- z = sqliteMalloc( n );
- if( z==0 ) return;
- }
- computeJD(&x);
- computeYMD_HMS(&x);
- for(i=j=0; zFmt[i]; i++){
- if( zFmt[i]!='%' ){
- z[j++] = zFmt[i];
- }else{
- i++;
- switch( zFmt[i] ){
- case 'd': sprintf(&z[j],"%02d",x.D); j+=2; break;
- case 'f': {
- int s = x.s;
- int ms = (x.s - s)*1000.0;
- sprintf(&z[j],"%02d.%03d",s,ms);
- j += strlen(&z[j]);
- break;
- }
- case 'H': sprintf(&z[j],"%02d",x.h); j+=2; break;
- case 'W': /* Fall thru */
- case 'j': {
- int n;
- DateTime y = x;
- y.validJD = 0;
- y.M = 1;
- y.D = 1;
- computeJD(&y);
- n = x.rJD - y.rJD + 1;
- if( zFmt[i]=='W' ){
- sprintf(&z[j],"%02d",(n+6)/7);
- j += 2;
- }else{
- sprintf(&z[j],"%03d",n);
- j += 3;
- }
- break;
- }
- case 'J': sprintf(&z[j],"%.16g",x.rJD); j+=strlen(&z[j]); break;
- case 'm': sprintf(&z[j],"%02d",x.M); j+=2; break;
- case 'M': sprintf(&z[j],"%02d",x.m); j+=2; break;
- case 's': {
- sprintf(&z[j],"%d",(int)((x.rJD-2440587.5)*86400.0 + 0.5));
- j += strlen(&z[j]);
- break;
- }
- case 'S': sprintf(&z[j],"%02d",(int)(x.s+0.5)); j+=2; break;
- case 'w': z[j++] = (((int)(x.rJD+1.5)) % 7) + '0'; break;
- case 'Y': sprintf(&z[j],"%04d",x.Y); j+=strlen(&z[j]); break;
- case '%': z[j++] = '%'; break;
- }
- }
- }
- z[j] = 0;
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, z, -1);
- if( z!=zBuf ){
- sqliteFree(z);
- }
-}
-
-
-#endif /* !defined(STQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS) */
-
-/*
-** This function registered all of the above C functions as SQL
-** functions. This should be the only routine in this file with
-** external linkage.
-*/
-void sqliteRegisterDateTimeFunctions(sqlite *db){
- static struct {
- char *zName;
- int nArg;
- int dataType;
- void (*xFunc)(sqlite_func*,int,const char**);
- } aFuncs[] = {
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS
- { "julianday", -1, STQLITE_NUMERIC, juliandayFunc },
- { "date", -1, STQLITE_TEXT, dateFunc },
- { "time", -1, STQLITE_TEXT, timeFunc },
- { "datetime", -1, STQLITE_TEXT, datetimeFunc },
- { "strftime", -1, STQLITE_TEXT, strftimeFunc },
-#endif
- };
- int i;
-
- for(i=0; i<sizeof(aFuncs)/sizeof(aFuncs[0]); i++){
- sqlite_create_function(db, aFuncs[i].zName,
- aFuncs[i].nArg, aFuncs[i].xFunc, 0);
- if( aFuncs[i].xFunc ){
- sqlite_function_type(db, aFuncs[i].zName, aFuncs[i].dataType);
- }
- }
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/delete.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/delete.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 527f070..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/delete.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,393 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains C code routines that are called by the parser
-** to handle DELETE FROM statements.
-**
-** $Id: delete.c,v 1.61 2004/02/24 01:05:32 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-/*
-** Look up every table that is named in pSrc. If any table is not found,
-** add an error message to pParse->zErrMsg and return NULL. If all tables
-** are found, return a pointer to the last table.
-*/
-Table *sqliteSrcListLookup(Parse *pParse, SrcList *pSrc){
- Table *pTab = 0;
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<pSrc->nSrc; i++){
- const char *zTab = pSrc->a[i].zName;
- const char *zDb = pSrc->a[i].zDatabase;
- pTab = sqliteLocateTable(pParse, zTab, zDb);
- pSrc->a[i].pTab = pTab;
- }
- return pTab;
-}
-
-/*
-** Check to make sure the given table is writable. If it is not
-** writable, generate an error message and return 1. If it is
-** writable return 0;
-*/
-int sqliteIsReadOnly(Parse *pParse, Table *pTab, int viewOk){
- if( pTab->readOnly ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "table %s may not be modified", pTab->zName);
- return 1;
- }
- if( !viewOk && pTab->pSelect ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot modify %s because it is a view",pTab->zName);
- return 1;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Process a DELETE FROM statement.
-*/
-void sqliteDeleteFrom(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- SrcList *pTabList, /* The table from which we should delete things */
- Expr *pWhere /* The WHERE clause. May be null */
-){
- Vdbe *v; /* The virtual database engine */
- Table *pTab; /* The table from which records will be deleted */
- const char *zDb; /* Name of database holding pTab */
- int end, addr; /* A couple addresses of generated code */
- int i; /* Loop counter */
- WhereInfo *pWInfo; /* Information about the WHERE clause */
- Index *pIdx; /* For looping over indices of the table */
- int iCur; /* VDBE Cursor number for pTab */
- sqlite *db; /* Main database structure */
- int isView; /* True if attempting to delete from a view */
- AuthContext sContext; /* Authorization context */
-
- int row_triggers_exist = 0; /* True if any triggers exist */
- int before_triggers; /* True if there are BEFORE triggers */
- int after_triggers; /* True if there are AFTER triggers */
- int oldIdx = -1; /* Cursor for the OLD table of AFTER triggers */
-
- sContext.pParse = 0;
- if( pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ){
- pTabList = 0;
- goto delete_from_cleanup;
- }
- db = pParse->db;
- assert( pTabList->nSrc==1 );
-
- /* Locate the table which we want to delete. This table has to be
- ** put in an SrcList structure because some of the subroutines we
- ** will be calling are designed to work with multiple tables and expect
- ** an SrcList* parameter instead of just a Table* parameter.
- */
- pTab = sqliteSrcListLookup(pParse, pTabList);
- if( pTab==0 ) goto delete_from_cleanup;
- before_triggers = sqliteTriggersExist(pParse, pTab->pTrigger,
- TK_DELETE, TK_BEFORE, TK_ROW, 0);
- after_triggers = sqliteTriggersExist(pParse, pTab->pTrigger,
- TK_DELETE, TK_AFTER, TK_ROW, 0);
- row_triggers_exist = before_triggers || after_triggers;
- isView = pTab->pSelect!=0;
- if( sqliteIsReadOnly(pParse, pTab, before_triggers) ){
- goto delete_from_cleanup;
- }
- assert( pTab->iDb<db->nDb );
- zDb = db->aDb[pTab->iDb].zName;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_DELETE, pTab->zName, 0, zDb) ){
- goto delete_from_cleanup;
- }
-
- /* If pTab is really a view, make sure it has been initialized.
- */
- if( isView && sqliteViewGetColumnNames(pParse, pTab) ){
- goto delete_from_cleanup;
- }
-
- /* Allocate a cursor used to store the old.* data for a trigger.
- */
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- oldIdx = pParse->nTab++;
- }
-
- /* Resolve the column names in all the expressions.
- */
- assert( pTabList->nSrc==1 );
- iCur = pTabList->a[0].iCursor = pParse->nTab++;
- if( pWhere ){
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pTabList, 0, pWhere) ){
- goto delete_from_cleanup;
- }
- if( sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pWhere, 0, 0) ){
- goto delete_from_cleanup;
- }
- }
-
- /* Start the view context
- */
- if( isView ){
- sqliteAuthContextPush(pParse, &sContext, pTab->zName);
- }
-
- /* Begin generating code.
- */
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ){
- goto delete_from_cleanup;
- }
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, row_triggers_exist, pTab->iDb);
-
- /* If we are trying to delete from a view, construct that view into
- ** a temporary table.
- */
- if( isView ){
- Select *pView = sqliteSelectDup(pTab->pSelect);
- sqliteSelect(pParse, pView, SRT_TempTable, iCur, 0, 0, 0);
- sqliteSelectDelete(pView);
- }
-
- /* Initialize the counter of the number of rows deleted, if
- ** we are counting rows.
- */
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 0, 0);
- }
-
- /* Special case: A DELETE without a WHERE clause deletes everything.
- ** It is easier just to erase the whole table. Note, however, that
- ** this means that the row change count will be incorrect.
- */
- if( pWhere==0 && !row_triggers_exist ){
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows ){
- /* If counting rows deleted, just count the total number of
- ** entries in the table. */
- int endOfLoop = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- int addr;
- if( !isView ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pTab->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenRead, iCur, pTab->tnum);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, iCur, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+2);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AddImm, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Next, iCur, addr);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, endOfLoop);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur, 0);
- }
- if( !isView ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Clear, pTab->tnum, pTab->iDb);
- for(pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Clear, pIdx->tnum, pIdx->iDb);
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* The usual case: There is a WHERE clause so we have to scan through
- ** the table and pick which records to delete.
- */
- else{
- /* Begin the database scan
- */
- pWInfo = sqliteWhereBegin(pParse, pTabList, pWhere, 1, 0);
- if( pWInfo==0 ) goto delete_from_cleanup;
-
- /* Remember the key of every item to be deleted.
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListWrite, 0, 0);
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AddImm, 1, 0);
- }
-
- /* End the database scan loop.
- */
- sqliteWhereEnd(pWInfo);
-
- /* Open the pseudo-table used to store OLD if there are triggers.
- */
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenPseudo, oldIdx, 0);
- }
-
- /* Delete every item whose key was written to the list during the
- ** database scan. We have to delete items after the scan is complete
- ** because deleting an item can change the scan order.
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListRewind, 0, 0);
- end = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
-
- /* This is the beginning of the delete loop when there are
- ** row triggers.
- */
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListRead, 0, end);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 0, 0);
- if( !isView ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pTab->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenRead, iCur, pTab->tnum);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, iCur, 0);
-
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Recno, iCur, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_RowData, iCur, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, oldIdx, 0);
- if( !isView ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur, 0);
- }
-
- sqliteCodeRowTrigger(pParse, TK_DELETE, 0, TK_BEFORE, pTab, -1,
- oldIdx, (pParse->trigStack)?pParse->trigStack->orconf:OE_Default,
- addr);
- }
-
- if( !isView ){
- /* Open cursors for the table we are deleting from and all its
- ** indices. If there are row triggers, this happens inside the
- ** OP_ListRead loop because the cursor have to all be closed
- ** before the trigger fires. If there are no row triggers, the
- ** cursors are opened only once on the outside the loop.
- */
- pParse->nTab = iCur + 1;
- sqliteOpenTableAndIndices(pParse, pTab, iCur);
-
- /* This is the beginning of the delete loop when there are no
- ** row triggers */
- if( !row_triggers_exist ){
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListRead, 0, end);
- }
-
- /* Delete the row */
- sqliteGenerateRowDelete(db, v, pTab, iCur, pParse->trigStack==0);
- }
-
- /* If there are row triggers, close all cursors then invoke
- ** the AFTER triggers
- */
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- if( !isView ){
- for(i=1, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; i++, pIdx=pIdx->pNext){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur + i, pIdx->tnum);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur, 0);
- }
- sqliteCodeRowTrigger(pParse, TK_DELETE, 0, TK_AFTER, pTab, -1,
- oldIdx, (pParse->trigStack)?pParse->trigStack->orconf:OE_Default,
- addr);
- }
-
- /* End of the delete loop */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, addr);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, end);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListReset, 0, 0);
-
- /* Close the cursors after the loop if there are no row triggers */
- if( !row_triggers_exist ){
- for(i=1, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; i++, pIdx=pIdx->pNext){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur + i, pIdx->tnum);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur, 0);
- pParse->nTab = iCur;
- }
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetCounts, 0, 0);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
-
- /*
- ** Return the number of rows that were deleted.
- */
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ColumnName, 0, 1);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, -1, "rows deleted", P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Callback, 1, 0);
- }
-
-delete_from_cleanup:
- sqliteAuthContextPop(&sContext);
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pTabList);
- sqliteExprDelete(pWhere);
- return;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine generates VDBE code that causes a single row of a
-** single table to be deleted.
-**
-** The VDBE must be in a particular state when this routine is called.
-** These are the requirements:
-**
-** 1. A read/write cursor pointing to pTab, the table containing the row
-** to be deleted, must be opened as cursor number "base".
-**
-** 2. Read/write cursors for all indices of pTab must be open as
-** cursor number base+i for the i-th index.
-**
-** 3. The record number of the row to be deleted must be on the top
-** of the stack.
-**
-** This routine pops the top of the stack to remove the record number
-** and then generates code to remove both the table record and all index
-** entries that point to that record.
-*/
-void sqliteGenerateRowDelete(
- sqlite *db, /* The database containing the index */
- Vdbe *v, /* Generate code into this VDBE */
- Table *pTab, /* Table containing the row to be deleted */
- int iCur, /* Cursor number for the table */
- int count /* Increment the row change counter */
-){
- int addr;
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotExists, iCur, 0);
- sqliteGenerateRowIndexDelete(db, v, pTab, iCur, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Delete, iCur,
- (count?OPFLAG_NCHANGE:0) | OPFLAG_CSCHANGE);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v));
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine generates VDBE code that causes the deletion of all
-** index entries associated with a single row of a single table.
-**
-** The VDBE must be in a particular state when this routine is called.
-** These are the requirements:
-**
-** 1. A read/write cursor pointing to pTab, the table containing the row
-** to be deleted, must be opened as cursor number "iCur".
-**
-** 2. Read/write cursors for all indices of pTab must be open as
-** cursor number iCur+i for the i-th index.
-**
-** 3. The "iCur" cursor must be pointing to the row that is to be
-** deleted.
-*/
-void sqliteGenerateRowIndexDelete(
- sqlite *db, /* The database containing the index */
- Vdbe *v, /* Generate code into this VDBE */
- Table *pTab, /* Table containing the row to be deleted */
- int iCur, /* Cursor number for the table */
- char *aIdxUsed /* Only delete if aIdxUsed!=0 && aIdxUsed[i]!=0 */
-){
- int i;
- Index *pIdx;
-
- for(i=1, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; i++, pIdx=pIdx->pNext){
- int j;
- if( aIdxUsed!=0 && aIdxUsed[i-1]==0 ) continue;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Recno, iCur, 0);
- for(j=0; j<pIdx->nColumn; j++){
- int idx = pIdx->aiColumn[j];
- if( idx==pTab->iPKey ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, j, 0);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, iCur, idx);
- }
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeIdxKey, pIdx->nColumn, 0);
- if( db->file_format>=4 ) sqliteAddIdxKeyType(v, pIdx);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IdxDelete, iCur+i, 0);
- }
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/expr.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/expr.c
deleted file mode 100644
index bdb8444..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/expr.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1656 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains routines used for analyzing expressions and
-** for generating VDBE code that evaluates expressions in STQLite.
-**
-** $Id: expr.c,v 1.112 2004/02/25 13:47:31 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include <ctype.h>
-
-/*
-** Construct a new expression node and return a pointer to it. Memory
-** for this node is obtained from sqliteMalloc(). The calling function
-** is responsible for making sure the node eventually gets freed.
-*/
-Expr *sqliteExpr(int op, Expr *pLeft, Expr *pRight, Token *pToken){
- Expr *pNew;
- pNew = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(Expr) );
- if( pNew==0 ){
- /* When malloc fails, we leak memory from pLeft and pRight */
- return 0;
- }
- pNew->op = op;
- pNew->pLeft = pLeft;
- pNew->pRight = pRight;
- if( pToken ){
- assert( pToken->dyn==0 );
- pNew->token = *pToken;
- pNew->span = *pToken;
- }else{
- assert( pNew->token.dyn==0 );
- assert( pNew->token.z==0 );
- assert( pNew->token.n==0 );
- if( pLeft && pRight ){
- sqliteExprSpan(pNew, &pLeft->span, &pRight->span);
- }else{
- pNew->span = pNew->token;
- }
- }
- return pNew;
-}
-
-/*
-** Set the Expr.span field of the given expression to span all
-** text between the two given tokens.
-*/
-void sqliteExprSpan(Expr *pExpr, Token *pLeft, Token *pRight){
- assert( pRight!=0 );
- assert( pLeft!=0 );
- /* Note: pExpr might be NULL due to a prior malloc failure */
- if( pExpr && pRight->z && pLeft->z ){
- if( pLeft->dyn==0 && pRight->dyn==0 ){
- pExpr->span.z = pLeft->z;
- pExpr->span.n = pRight->n + Addr(pRight->z) - Addr(pLeft->z);
- }else{
- pExpr->span.z = 0;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Construct a new expression node for a function with multiple
-** arguments.
-*/
-Expr *sqliteExprFunction(ExprList *pList, Token *pToken){
- Expr *pNew;
- pNew = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(Expr) );
- if( pNew==0 ){
- /* sqliteExprListDelete(pList); // Leak pList when malloc fails */
- return 0;
- }
- pNew->op = TK_FUNCTION;
- pNew->pList = pList;
- if( pToken ){
- assert( pToken->dyn==0 );
- pNew->token = *pToken;
- }else{
- pNew->token.z = 0;
- }
- pNew->span = pNew->token;
- return pNew;
-}
-
-/*
-** Recursively delete an expression tree.
-*/
-void sqliteExprDelete(Expr *p){
- if( p==0 ) return;
- if( p->span.dyn ) sqliteFree((char*)p->span.z);
- if( p->token.dyn ) sqliteFree((char*)p->token.z);
- sqliteExprDelete(p->pLeft);
- sqliteExprDelete(p->pRight);
- sqliteExprListDelete(p->pList);
- sqliteSelectDelete(p->pSelect);
- sqliteFree(p);
-}
-
-
-/*
-** The following group of routines make deep copies of expressions,
-** expression lists, ID lists, and select statements. The copies can
-** be deleted (by being passed to their respective ...Delete() routines)
-** without effecting the originals.
-**
-** The expression list, ID, and source lists return by sqliteExprListDup(),
-** sqliteIdListDup(), and sqliteSrcListDup() can not be further expanded
-** by subsequent calls to sqlite*ListAppend() routines.
-**
-** Any tables that the SrcList might point to are not duplicated.
-*/
-Expr *sqliteExprDup(Expr *p){
- Expr *pNew;
- if( p==0 ) return 0;
- pNew = sqliteMallocRaw( sizeof(*p) );
- if( pNew==0 ) return 0;
- memcpy(pNew, p, sizeof(*pNew));
- if( p->token.z!=0 ){
- pNew->token.z = sqliteStrDup(p->token.z);
- pNew->token.dyn = 1;
- }else{
- assert( pNew->token.z==0 );
- }
- pNew->span.z = 0;
- pNew->pLeft = sqliteExprDup(p->pLeft);
- pNew->pRight = sqliteExprDup(p->pRight);
- pNew->pList = sqliteExprListDup(p->pList);
- pNew->pSelect = sqliteSelectDup(p->pSelect);
- return pNew;
-}
-void sqliteTokenCopy(Token *pTo, Token *pFrom){
- if( pTo->dyn ) sqliteFree((char*)pTo->z);
- if( pFrom->z ){
- pTo->n = pFrom->n;
- pTo->z = sqliteStrNDup(pFrom->z, pFrom->n);
- pTo->dyn = 1;
- }else{
- pTo->z = 0;
- }
-}
-ExprList *sqliteExprListDup(ExprList *p){
- ExprList *pNew;
- struct ExprList_item *pItem;
- int i;
- if( p==0 ) return 0;
- pNew = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(*pNew) );
- if( pNew==0 ) return 0;
- pNew->nExpr = pNew->nAlloc = p->nExpr;
- pNew->a = pItem = sqliteMalloc( p->nExpr*sizeof(p->a[0]) );
- for(i=0; pItem && i<p->nExpr; i++, pItem++){
- Expr *pNewExpr, *pOldExpr;
- pItem->pExpr = pNewExpr = sqliteExprDup(pOldExpr = p->a[i].pExpr);
- if( pOldExpr->span.z!=0 && pNewExpr ){
- /* Always make a copy of the span for top-level expressions in the
- ** expression list. The logic in SELECT processing that determines
- ** the names of columns in the result set needs this information */
- sqliteTokenCopy(&pNewExpr->span, &pOldExpr->span);
- }
- assert( pNewExpr==0 || pNewExpr->span.z!=0
- || pOldExpr->span.z==0 || sqlite_malloc_failed );
- pItem->zName = sqliteStrDup(p->a[i].zName);
- pItem->sortOrder = p->a[i].sortOrder;
- pItem->isAgg = p->a[i].isAgg;
- pItem->done = 0;
- }
- return pNew;
-}
-SrcList *sqliteSrcListDup(SrcList *p){
- SrcList *pNew;
- int i;
- int nByte;
- if( p==0 ) return 0;
- nByte = sizeof(*p) + (p->nSrc>0 ? sizeof(p->a[0]) * (p->nSrc-1) : 0);
- pNew = sqliteMallocRaw( nByte );
- if( pNew==0 ) return 0;
- pNew->nSrc = pNew->nAlloc = p->nSrc;
- for(i=0; i<p->nSrc; i++){
- struct SrcList_item *pNewItem = &pNew->a[i];
- struct SrcList_item *pOldItem = &p->a[i];
- pNewItem->zDatabase = sqliteStrDup(pOldItem->zDatabase);
- pNewItem->zName = sqliteStrDup(pOldItem->zName);
- pNewItem->zAlias = sqliteStrDup(pOldItem->zAlias);
- pNewItem->jointype = pOldItem->jointype;
- pNewItem->iCursor = pOldItem->iCursor;
- pNewItem->pTab = 0;
- pNewItem->pSelect = sqliteSelectDup(pOldItem->pSelect);
- pNewItem->pOn = sqliteExprDup(pOldItem->pOn);
- pNewItem->pUsing = sqliteIdListDup(pOldItem->pUsing);
- }
- return pNew;
-}
-IdList *sqliteIdListDup(IdList *p){
- IdList *pNew;
- int i;
- if( p==0 ) return 0;
- pNew = sqliteMallocRaw( sizeof(*pNew) );
- if( pNew==0 ) return 0;
- pNew->nId = pNew->nAlloc = p->nId;
- pNew->a = sqliteMallocRaw( p->nId*sizeof(p->a[0]) );
- if( pNew->a==0 ) return 0;
- for(i=0; i<p->nId; i++){
- struct IdList_item *pNewItem = &pNew->a[i];
- struct IdList_item *pOldItem = &p->a[i];
- pNewItem->zName = sqliteStrDup(pOldItem->zName);
- pNewItem->idx = pOldItem->idx;
- }
- return pNew;
-}
-Select *sqliteSelectDup(Select *p){
- Select *pNew;
- if( p==0 ) return 0;
- pNew = sqliteMallocRaw( sizeof(*p) );
- if( pNew==0 ) return 0;
- pNew->isDistinct = p->isDistinct;
- pNew->pEList = sqliteExprListDup(p->pEList);
- pNew->pSrc = sqliteSrcListDup(p->pSrc);
- pNew->pWhere = sqliteExprDup(p->pWhere);
- pNew->pGroupBy = sqliteExprListDup(p->pGroupBy);
- pNew->pHaving = sqliteExprDup(p->pHaving);
- pNew->pOrderBy = sqliteExprListDup(p->pOrderBy);
- pNew->op = p->op;
- pNew->pPrior = sqliteSelectDup(p->pPrior);
- pNew->nLimit = p->nLimit;
- pNew->nOffset = p->nOffset;
- pNew->zSelect = 0;
- pNew->iLimit = -1;
- pNew->iOffset = -1;
- return pNew;
-}
-
-
-/*
-** Add a new element to the end of an expression list. If pList is
-** initially NULL, then create a new expression list.
-*/
-ExprList *sqliteExprListAppend(ExprList *pList, Expr *pExpr, Token *pName){
- if( pList==0 ){
- pList = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(ExprList) );
- if( pList==0 ){
- /* sqliteExprDelete(pExpr); // Leak memory if malloc fails */
- return 0;
- }
- assert( pList->nAlloc==0 );
- }
- if( pList->nAlloc<=pList->nExpr ){
- pList->nAlloc = pList->nAlloc*2 + 4;
- pList->a = sqliteRealloc(pList->a, pList->nAlloc*sizeof(pList->a[0]));
- if( pList->a==0 ){
- /* sqliteExprDelete(pExpr); // Leak memory if malloc fails */
- pList->nExpr = pList->nAlloc = 0;
- return pList;
- }
- }
- assert( pList->a!=0 );
- if( pExpr || pName ){
- struct ExprList_item *pItem = &pList->a[pList->nExpr++];
- memset(pItem, 0, sizeof(*pItem));
- pItem->pExpr = pExpr;
- if( pName ){
- sqliteSetNString(&pItem->zName, pName->z, pName->n, 0);
- sqliteDequote(pItem->zName);
- }
- }
- return pList;
-}
-
-/*
-** Delete an entire expression list.
-*/
-void sqliteExprListDelete(ExprList *pList){
- int i;
- if( pList==0 ) return;
- for(i=0; i<pList->nExpr; i++){
- sqliteExprDelete(pList->a[i].pExpr);
- sqliteFree(pList->a[i].zName);
- }
- sqliteFree(pList->a);
- sqliteFree(pList);
-}
-
-/*
-** Walk an expression tree. Return 1 if the expression is constant
-** and 0 if it involves variables.
-**
-** For the purposes of this function, a double-quoted string (ex: "abc")
-** is considered a variable but a single-quoted string (ex: 'abc') is
-** a constant.
-*/
-int sqliteExprIsConstant(Expr *p){
- switch( p->op ){
- case TK_ID:
- case TK_COLUMN:
- case TK_DOT:
- case TK_FUNCTION:
- return 0;
- case TK_NULL:
- case TK_STRING:
- case TK_INTEGER:
- case TK_FLOAT:
- case TK_VARIABLE:
- return 1;
- default: {
- if( p->pLeft && !sqliteExprIsConstant(p->pLeft) ) return 0;
- if( p->pRight && !sqliteExprIsConstant(p->pRight) ) return 0;
- if( p->pList ){
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<p->pList->nExpr; i++){
- if( !sqliteExprIsConstant(p->pList->a[i].pExpr) ) return 0;
- }
- }
- return p->pLeft!=0 || p->pRight!=0 || (p->pList && p->pList->nExpr>0);
- }
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** If the given expression codes a constant integer that is small enough
-** to fit in a 32-bit integer, return 1 and put the value of the integer
-** in *pValue. If the expression is not an integer or if it is too big
-** to fit in a signed 32-bit integer, return 0 and leave *pValue unchanged.
-*/
-int sqliteExprIsInteger(Expr *p, int *pValue){
- switch( p->op ){
- case TK_INTEGER: {
- if( sqliteFitsIn32Bits(p->token.z) ){
- *pValue = atoi(p->token.z);
- return 1;
- }
- break;
- }
- case TK_STRING: {
- const char *z = p->token.z;
- int n = p->token.n;
- if( n>0 && z[0]=='-' ){ z++; n--; }
- while( n>0 && *z && isdigit(*z) ){ z++; n--; }
- if( n==0 && sqliteFitsIn32Bits(p->token.z) ){
- *pValue = atoi(p->token.z);
- return 1;
- }
- break;
- }
- case TK_UPLUS: {
- return sqliteExprIsInteger(p->pLeft, pValue);
- }
- case TK_UMINUS: {
- int v;
- if( sqliteExprIsInteger(p->pLeft, &v) ){
- *pValue = -v;
- return 1;
- }
- break;
- }
- default: break;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return TRUE if the given string is a row-id column name.
-*/
-int sqliteIsRowid(const char *z){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(z, "_ROWID_")==0 ) return 1;
- if( sqliteStrICmp(z, "ROWID")==0 ) return 1;
- if( sqliteStrICmp(z, "OID")==0 ) return 1;
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Given the name of a column of the form X.Y.Z or Y.Z or just Z, look up
-** that name in the set of source tables in pSrcList and make the pExpr
-** expression node refer back to that source column. The following changes
-** are made to pExpr:
-**
-** pExpr->iDb Set the index in db->aDb[] of the database holding
-** the table.
-** pExpr->iTable Set to the cursor number for the table obtained
-** from pSrcList.
-** pExpr->iColumn Set to the column number within the table.
-** pExpr->dataType Set to the appropriate data type for the column.
-** pExpr->op Set to TK_COLUMN.
-** pExpr->pLeft Any expression this points to is deleted
-** pExpr->pRight Any expression this points to is deleted.
-**
-** The pDbToken is the name of the database (the "X"). This value may be
-** NULL meaning that name is of the form Y.Z or Z. Any available database
-** can be used. The pTableToken is the name of the table (the "Y"). This
-** value can be NULL if pDbToken is also NULL. If pTableToken is NULL it
-** means that the form of the name is Z and that columns from any table
-** can be used.
-**
-** If the name cannot be resolved unambiguously, leave an error message
-** in pParse and return non-zero. Return zero on success.
-*/
-static int lookupName(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parsing context */
- Token *pDbToken, /* Name of the database containing table, or NULL */
- Token *pTableToken, /* Name of table containing column, or NULL */
- Token *pColumnToken, /* Name of the column. */
- SrcList *pSrcList, /* List of tables used to resolve column names */
- ExprList *pEList, /* List of expressions used to resolve "AS" */
- Expr *pExpr /* Make this EXPR node point to the selected column */
-){
- char *zDb = 0; /* Name of the database. The "X" in X.Y.Z */
- char *zTab = 0; /* Name of the table. The "Y" in X.Y.Z or Y.Z */
- char *zCol = 0; /* Name of the column. The "Z" */
- int i, j; /* Loop counters */
- int cnt = 0; /* Number of matching column names */
- int cntTab = 0; /* Number of matching table names */
- sqlite *db = pParse->db; /* The database */
-
- assert( pColumnToken && pColumnToken->z ); /* The Z in X.Y.Z cannot be NULL */
- if( pDbToken && pDbToken->z ){
- zDb = sqliteStrNDup(pDbToken->z, pDbToken->n);
- sqliteDequote(zDb);
- }else{
- zDb = 0;
- }
- if( pTableToken && pTableToken->z ){
- zTab = sqliteStrNDup(pTableToken->z, pTableToken->n);
- sqliteDequote(zTab);
- }else{
- assert( zDb==0 );
- zTab = 0;
- }
- zCol = sqliteStrNDup(pColumnToken->z, pColumnToken->n);
- sqliteDequote(zCol);
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ){
- return 1; /* Leak memory (zDb and zTab) if malloc fails */
- }
- assert( zTab==0 || pEList==0 );
-
- pExpr->iTable = -1;
- for(i=0; i<pSrcList->nSrc; i++){
- struct SrcList_item *pItem = &pSrcList->a[i];
- Table *pTab = pItem->pTab;
- Column *pCol;
-
- if( pTab==0 ) continue;
- assert( pTab->nCol>0 );
- if( zTab ){
- if( pItem->zAlias ){
- char *zTabName = pItem->zAlias;
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zTabName, zTab)!=0 ) continue;
- }else{
- char *zTabName = pTab->zName;
- if( zTabName==0 || sqliteStrICmp(zTabName, zTab)!=0 ) continue;
- if( zDb!=0 && sqliteStrICmp(db->aDb[pTab->iDb].zName, zDb)!=0 ){
- continue;
- }
- }
- }
- if( 0==(cntTab++) ){
- pExpr->iTable = pItem->iCursor;
- pExpr->iDb = pTab->iDb;
- }
- for(j=0, pCol=pTab->aCol; j<pTab->nCol; j++, pCol++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(pCol->zName, zCol)==0 ){
- cnt++;
- pExpr->iTable = pItem->iCursor;
- pExpr->iDb = pTab->iDb;
- /* Substitute the rowid (column -1) for the INTEGER PRIMARY KEY */
- pExpr->iColumn = j==pTab->iPKey ? -1 : j;
- pExpr->dataType = pCol->sortOrder & STQLITE_SO_TYPEMASK;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* If we have not already resolved the name, then maybe
- ** it is a new.* or old.* trigger argument reference
- */
- if( zDb==0 && zTab!=0 && cnt==0 && pParse->trigStack!=0 ){
- TriggerStack *pTriggerStack = pParse->trigStack;
- Table *pTab = 0;
- if( pTriggerStack->newIdx != -1 && sqliteStrICmp("new", zTab) == 0 ){
- pExpr->iTable = pTriggerStack->newIdx;
- assert( pTriggerStack->pTab );
- pTab = pTriggerStack->pTab;
- }else if( pTriggerStack->oldIdx != -1 && sqliteStrICmp("old", zTab) == 0 ){
- pExpr->iTable = pTriggerStack->oldIdx;
- assert( pTriggerStack->pTab );
- pTab = pTriggerStack->pTab;
- }
-
- if( pTab ){
- int j;
- Column *pCol = pTab->aCol;
-
- pExpr->iDb = pTab->iDb;
- cntTab++;
- for(j=0; j < pTab->nCol; j++, pCol++) {
- if( sqliteStrICmp(pCol->zName, zCol)==0 ){
- cnt++;
- pExpr->iColumn = j==pTab->iPKey ? -1 : j;
- pExpr->dataType = pCol->sortOrder & STQLITE_SO_TYPEMASK;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- /*
- ** Perhaps the name is a reference to the ROWID
- */
- if( cnt==0 && cntTab==1 && sqliteIsRowid(zCol) ){
- cnt = 1;
- pExpr->iColumn = -1;
- pExpr->dataType = STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- }
-
- /*
- ** If the input is of the form Z (not Y.Z or X.Y.Z) then the name Z
- ** might refer to an result-set alias. This happens, for example, when
- ** we are resolving names in the WHERE clause of the following command:
- **
- ** SELECT a+b AS x FROM table WHERE x<10;
- **
- ** In cases like this, replace pExpr with a copy of the expression that
- ** forms the result set entry ("a+b" in the example) and return immediately.
- ** Note that the expression in the result set should have already been
- ** resolved by the time the WHERE clause is resolved.
- */
- if( cnt==0 && pEList!=0 ){
- for(j=0; j<pEList->nExpr; j++){
- char *zAs = pEList->a[j].zName;
- if( zAs!=0 && sqliteStrICmp(zAs, zCol)==0 ){
- assert( pExpr->pLeft==0 && pExpr->pRight==0 );
- pExpr->op = TK_AS;
- pExpr->iColumn = j;
- pExpr->pLeft = sqliteExprDup(pEList->a[j].pExpr);
- sqliteFree(zCol);
- assert( zTab==0 && zDb==0 );
- return 0;
- }
- }
- }
-
- /*
- ** If X and Y are NULL (in other words if only the column name Z is
- ** supplied) and the value of Z is enclosed in double-quotes, then
- ** Z is a string literal if it doesn't match any column names. In that
- ** case, we need to return right away and not make any changes to
- ** pExpr.
- */
- if( cnt==0 && zTab==0 && pColumnToken->z[0]=='"' ){
- sqliteFree(zCol);
- return 0;
- }
-
- /*
- ** cnt==0 means there was not match. cnt>1 means there were two or
- ** more matches. Either way, we have an error.
- */
- if( cnt!=1 ){
- char *z = 0;
- char *zErr;
- zErr = cnt==0 ? "no such column: %s" : "ambiguous column name: %s";
- if( zDb ){
- sqliteSetString(&z, zDb, ".", zTab, ".", zCol, 0);
- }else if( zTab ){
- sqliteSetString(&z, zTab, ".", zCol, 0);
- }else{
- z = sqliteStrDup(zCol);
- }
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, zErr, z);
- sqliteFree(z);
- }
-
- /* Clean up and return
- */
- sqliteFree(zDb);
- sqliteFree(zTab);
- sqliteFree(zCol);
- sqliteExprDelete(pExpr->pLeft);
- pExpr->pLeft = 0;
- sqliteExprDelete(pExpr->pRight);
- pExpr->pRight = 0;
- pExpr->op = TK_COLUMN;
- sqliteAuthRead(pParse, pExpr, pSrcList);
- return cnt!=1;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine walks an expression tree and resolves references to
-** table columns. Nodes of the form ID.ID or ID resolve into an
-** index to the table in the table list and a column offset. The
-** Expr.opcode for such nodes is changed to TK_COLUMN. The Expr.iTable
-** value is changed to the index of the referenced table in pTabList
-** plus the "base" value. The base value will ultimately become the
-** VDBE cursor number for a cursor that is pointing into the referenced
-** table. The Expr.iColumn value is changed to the index of the column
-** of the referenced table. The Expr.iColumn value for the special
-** ROWID column is -1. Any INTEGER PRIMARY KEY column is tried as an
-** alias for ROWID.
-**
-** We also check for instances of the IN operator. IN comes in two
-** forms:
-**
-** expr IN (exprlist)
-** and
-** expr IN (SELECT ...)
-**
-** The first form is handled by creating a set holding the list
-** of allowed values. The second form causes the SELECT to generate
-** a temporary table.
-**
-** This routine also looks for scalar SELECTs that are part of an expression.
-** If it finds any, it generates code to write the value of that select
-** into a memory cell.
-**
-** Unknown columns or tables provoke an error. The function returns
-** the number of errors seen and leaves an error message on pParse->zErrMsg.
-*/
-int sqliteExprResolveIds(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- SrcList *pSrcList, /* List of tables used to resolve column names */
- ExprList *pEList, /* List of expressions used to resolve "AS" */
- Expr *pExpr /* The expression to be analyzed. */
-){
- int i;
-
- if( pExpr==0 || pSrcList==0 ) return 0;
- for(i=0; i<pSrcList->nSrc; i++){
- assert( pSrcList->a[i].iCursor>=0 && pSrcList->a[i].iCursor<pParse->nTab );
- }
- switch( pExpr->op ){
- /* Double-quoted strings (ex: "abc") are used as identifiers if
- ** possible. Otherwise they remain as strings. Single-quoted
- ** strings (ex: 'abc') are always string literals.
- */
- case TK_STRING: {
- if( pExpr->token.z[0]=='\'' ) break;
- /* Fall thru into the TK_ID case if this is a double-quoted string */
- }
- /* A lone identifier is the name of a columnd.
- */
- case TK_ID: {
- if( lookupName(pParse, 0, 0, &pExpr->token, pSrcList, pEList, pExpr) ){
- return 1;
- }
- break;
- }
-
- /* A table name and column name: ID.ID
- ** Or a database, table and column: ID.ID.ID
- */
- case TK_DOT: {
- Token *pColumn;
- Token *pTable;
- Token *pDb;
- Expr *pRight;
-
- pRight = pExpr->pRight;
- if( pRight->op==TK_ID ){
- pDb = 0;
- pTable = &pExpr->pLeft->token;
- pColumn = &pRight->token;
- }else{
- assert( pRight->op==TK_DOT );
- pDb = &pExpr->pLeft->token;
- pTable = &pRight->pLeft->token;
- pColumn = &pRight->pRight->token;
- }
- if( lookupName(pParse, pDb, pTable, pColumn, pSrcList, 0, pExpr) ){
- return 1;
- }
- break;
- }
-
- case TK_IN: {
- Vdbe *v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) return 1;
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pSrcList, pEList, pExpr->pLeft) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( pExpr->pSelect ){
- /* Case 1: expr IN (SELECT ...)
- **
- ** Generate code to write the results of the select into a temporary
- ** table. The cursor number of the temporary table has already
- ** been put in iTable by sqliteExprResolveInSelect().
- */
- pExpr->iTable = pParse->nTab++;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenTemp, pExpr->iTable, 1);
- sqliteSelect(pParse, pExpr->pSelect, SRT_Set, pExpr->iTable, 0,0,0);
- }else if( pExpr->pList ){
- /* Case 2: expr IN (exprlist)
- **
- ** Create a set to put the exprlist values in. The Set id is stored
- ** in iTable.
- */
- int i, iSet;
- for(i=0; i<pExpr->pList->nExpr; i++){
- Expr *pE2 = pExpr->pList->a[i].pExpr;
- if( !sqliteExprIsConstant(pE2) ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "right-hand side of IN operator must be constant");
- return 1;
- }
- if( sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pE2, 0, 0) ){
- return 1;
- }
- }
- iSet = pExpr->iTable = pParse->nSet++;
- for(i=0; i<pExpr->pList->nExpr; i++){
- Expr *pE2 = pExpr->pList->a[i].pExpr;
- switch( pE2->op ){
- case TK_FLOAT:
- case TK_INTEGER:
- case TK_STRING: {
- int addr;
- assert( pE2->token.z );
- addr = sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_SetInsert, iSet, 0,
- pE2->token.z, pE2->token.n);
- sqliteVdbeDequoteP3(v, addr);
- break;
- }
- default: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pE2);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetInsert, iSet, 0);
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- }
- break;
- }
-
- case TK_SELECT: {
- /* This has to be a scalar SELECT. Generate code to put the
- ** value of this select in a memory cell and record the number
- ** of the memory cell in iColumn.
- */
- pExpr->iColumn = pParse->nMem++;
- if( sqliteSelect(pParse, pExpr->pSelect, SRT_Mem, pExpr->iColumn,0,0,0) ){
- return 1;
- }
- break;
- }
-
- /* For all else, just recursively walk the tree */
- default: {
- if( pExpr->pLeft
- && sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pSrcList, pEList, pExpr->pLeft) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( pExpr->pRight
- && sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pSrcList, pEList, pExpr->pRight) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( pExpr->pList ){
- int i;
- ExprList *pList = pExpr->pList;
- for(i=0; i<pList->nExpr; i++){
- Expr *pArg = pList->a[i].pExpr;
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pSrcList, pEList, pArg) ){
- return 1;
- }
- }
- }
- }
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** pExpr is a node that defines a function of some kind. It might
-** be a syntactic function like "count(x)" or it might be a function
-** that implements an operator, like "a LIKE b".
-**
-** This routine makes *pzName point to the name of the function and
-** *pnName hold the number of characters in the function name.
-*/
-static void getFunctionName(Expr *pExpr, const char **pzName, int *pnName){
- switch( pExpr->op ){
- case TK_FUNCTION: {
- *pzName = pExpr->token.z;
- *pnName = pExpr->token.n;
- break;
- }
- case TK_LIKE: {
- *pzName = "like";
- *pnName = 4;
- break;
- }
- case TK_GLOB: {
- *pzName = "glob";
- *pnName = 4;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- *pzName = "can't happen";
- *pnName = 12;
- break;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Error check the functions in an expression. Make sure all
-** function names are recognized and all functions have the correct
-** number of arguments. Leave an error message in pParse->zErrMsg
-** if anything is amiss. Return the number of errors.
-**
-** if pIsAgg is not null and this expression is an aggregate function
-** (like count(*) or max(value)) then write a 1 into *pIsAgg.
-*/
-int sqliteExprCheck(Parse *pParse, Expr *pExpr, int allowAgg, int *pIsAgg){
- int nErr = 0;
- if( pExpr==0 ) return 0;
- switch( pExpr->op ){
- case TK_GLOB:
- case TK_LIKE:
- case TK_FUNCTION: {
- int n = pExpr->pList ? pExpr->pList->nExpr : 0; /* Number of arguments */
- int no_such_func = 0; /* True if no such function exists */
- int wrong_num_args = 0; /* True if wrong number of arguments */
- int is_agg = 0; /* True if is an aggregate function */
- int i;
- int nId; /* Number of characters in function name */
- const char *zId; /* The function name. */
- FuncDef *pDef;
-
- getFunctionName(pExpr, &zId, &nId);
- pDef = sqliteFindFunction(pParse->db, zId, nId, n, 0);
- if( pDef==0 ){
- pDef = sqliteFindFunction(pParse->db, zId, nId, -1, 0);
- if( pDef==0 ){
- no_such_func = 1;
- }else{
- wrong_num_args = 1;
- }
- }else{
- is_agg = pDef->xFunc==0;
- }
- if( is_agg && !allowAgg ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "misuse of aggregate function %.*s()", nId, zId);
- nErr++;
- is_agg = 0;
- }else if( no_such_func ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "no such function: %.*s", nId, zId);
- nErr++;
- }else if( wrong_num_args ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,"wrong number of arguments to function %.*s()",
- nId, zId);
- nErr++;
- }
- if( is_agg ){
- pExpr->op = TK_AGG_FUNCTION;
- if( pIsAgg ) *pIsAgg = 1;
- }
- for(i=0; nErr==0 && i<n; i++){
- nErr = sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pExpr->pList->a[i].pExpr,
- allowAgg && !is_agg, pIsAgg);
- }
- if( pDef==0 ){
- /* Already reported an error */
- }else if( pDef->dataType>=0 ){
- if( pDef->dataType<n ){
- pExpr->dataType =
- sqliteExprType(pExpr->pList->a[pDef->dataType].pExpr);
- }else{
- pExpr->dataType = STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- }
- }else if( pDef->dataType==STQLITE_ARGS ){
- pDef->dataType = STQLITE_SO_TEXT;
- for(i=0; i<n; i++){
- if( sqliteExprType(pExpr->pList->a[i].pExpr)==STQLITE_SO_NUM ){
- pExpr->dataType = STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- break;
- }
- }
- }else if( pDef->dataType==STQLITE_NUMERIC ){
- pExpr->dataType = STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- }else{
- pExpr->dataType = STQLITE_SO_TEXT;
- }
- }
- default: {
- if( pExpr->pLeft ){
- nErr = sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pExpr->pLeft, allowAgg, pIsAgg);
- }
- if( nErr==0 && pExpr->pRight ){
- nErr = sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pExpr->pRight, allowAgg, pIsAgg);
- }
- if( nErr==0 && pExpr->pList ){
- int n = pExpr->pList->nExpr;
- int i;
- for(i=0; nErr==0 && i<n; i++){
- Expr *pE2 = pExpr->pList->a[i].pExpr;
- nErr = sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pE2, allowAgg, pIsAgg);
- }
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- return nErr;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return either STQLITE_SO_NUM or STQLITE_SO_TEXT to indicate whether the
-** given expression should sort as numeric values or as text.
-**
-** The sqliteExprResolveIds() and sqliteExprCheck() routines must have
-** both been called on the expression before it is passed to this routine.
-*/
-int sqliteExprType(Expr *p){
- if( p==0 ) return STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- while( p ) switch( p->op ){
- case TK_PLUS:
- case TK_MINUS:
- case TK_STAR:
- case TK_SLASH:
- case TK_AND:
- case TK_OR:
- case TK_ISNULL:
- case TK_NOTNULL:
- case TK_NOT:
- case TK_UMINUS:
- case TK_UPLUS:
- case TK_BITAND:
- case TK_BITOR:
- case TK_BITNOT:
- case TK_LSHIFT:
- case TK_RSHIFT:
- case TK_REM:
- case TK_INTEGER:
- case TK_FLOAT:
- case TK_IN:
- case TK_BETWEEN:
- case TK_GLOB:
- case TK_LIKE:
- return STQLITE_SO_NUM;
-
- case TK_STRING:
- case TK_NULL:
- case TK_CONCAT:
- case TK_VARIABLE:
- return STQLITE_SO_TEXT;
-
- case TK_LT:
- case TK_LE:
- case TK_GT:
- case TK_GE:
- case TK_NE:
- case TK_EQ:
- if( sqliteExprType(p->pLeft)==STQLITE_SO_NUM ){
- return STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- }
- p = p->pRight;
- break;
-
- case TK_AS:
- p = p->pLeft;
- break;
-
- case TK_COLUMN:
- case TK_FUNCTION:
- case TK_AGG_FUNCTION:
- return p->dataType;
-
- case TK_SELECT:
- assert( p->pSelect );
- assert( p->pSelect->pEList );
- assert( p->pSelect->pEList->nExpr>0 );
- p = p->pSelect->pEList->a[0].pExpr;
- break;
-
- case TK_CASE: {
- if( p->pRight && sqliteExprType(p->pRight)==STQLITE_SO_NUM ){
- return STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- }
- if( p->pList ){
- int i;
- ExprList *pList = p->pList;
- for(i=1; i<pList->nExpr; i+=2){
- if( sqliteExprType(pList->a[i].pExpr)==STQLITE_SO_NUM ){
- return STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- }
- }
- }
- return STQLITE_SO_TEXT;
- }
-
- default:
- assert( p->op==TK_ABORT ); /* Can't Happen */
- break;
- }
- return STQLITE_SO_NUM;
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code into the current Vdbe to evaluate the given
-** expression and leave the result on the top of stack.
-*/
-void sqliteExprCode(Parse *pParse, Expr *pExpr){
- Vdbe *v = pParse->pVdbe;
- int op;
- if( v==0 || pExpr==0 ) return;
- switch( pExpr->op ){
- case TK_PLUS: op = OP_Add; break;
- case TK_MINUS: op = OP_Subtract; break;
- case TK_STAR: op = OP_Multiply; break;
- case TK_SLASH: op = OP_Divide; break;
- case TK_AND: op = OP_And; break;
- case TK_OR: op = OP_Or; break;
- case TK_LT: op = OP_Lt; break;
- case TK_LE: op = OP_Le; break;
- case TK_GT: op = OP_Gt; break;
- case TK_GE: op = OP_Ge; break;
- case TK_NE: op = OP_Ne; break;
- case TK_EQ: op = OP_Eq; break;
- case TK_ISNULL: op = OP_IsNull; break;
- case TK_NOTNULL: op = OP_NotNull; break;
- case TK_NOT: op = OP_Not; break;
- case TK_UMINUS: op = OP_Negative; break;
- case TK_BITAND: op = OP_BitAnd; break;
- case TK_BITOR: op = OP_BitOr; break;
- case TK_BITNOT: op = OP_BitNot; break;
- case TK_LSHIFT: op = OP_ShiftLeft; break;
- case TK_RSHIFT: op = OP_ShiftRight; break;
- case TK_REM: op = OP_Remainder; break;
- default: break;
- }
- switch( pExpr->op ){
- case TK_COLUMN: {
- if( pParse->useAgg ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AggGet, 0, pExpr->iAgg);
- }else if( pExpr->iColumn>=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, pExpr->iTable, pExpr->iColumn);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Recno, pExpr->iTable, 0);
- }
- break;
- }
- case TK_STRING:
- case TK_FLOAT:
- case TK_INTEGER: {
- if( pExpr->op==TK_INTEGER && sqliteFitsIn32Bits(pExpr->token.z) ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, atoi(pExpr->token.z), 0);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- }
- assert( pExpr->token.z );
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, -1, pExpr->token.z, pExpr->token.n);
- sqliteVdbeDequoteP3(v, -1);
- break;
- }
- case TK_NULL: {
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_VARIABLE: {
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Variable, pExpr->iTable, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_LT:
- case TK_LE:
- case TK_GT:
- case TK_GE:
- case TK_NE:
- case TK_EQ: {
- if( pParse->db->file_format>=4 && sqliteExprType(pExpr)==STQLITE_SO_TEXT ){
- op += 6; /* Convert numeric opcodes to text opcodes */
- }
- /* Fall through into the next case */
- }
- case TK_AND:
- case TK_OR:
- case TK_PLUS:
- case TK_STAR:
- case TK_MINUS:
- case TK_REM:
- case TK_BITAND:
- case TK_BITOR:
- case TK_SLASH: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pRight);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, op, 0, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_LSHIFT:
- case TK_RSHIFT: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pRight);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, op, 0, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_CONCAT: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pRight);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Concat, 2, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_UMINUS: {
- assert( pExpr->pLeft );
- if( pExpr->pLeft->op==TK_FLOAT || pExpr->pLeft->op==TK_INTEGER ){
- Token *p = &pExpr->pLeft->token;
- char *z = sqliteMalloc( p->n + 2 );
- sprintf(z, "-%.*s", p->n, p->z);
- if( pExpr->pLeft->op==TK_INTEGER && sqliteFitsIn32Bits(z) ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, atoi(z), 0);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, -1, z, p->n+1);
- sqliteFree(z);
- break;
- }
- /* Fall through into TK_NOT */
- }
- case TK_BITNOT:
- case TK_NOT: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, op, 0, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_ISNULL:
- case TK_NOTNULL: {
- int dest;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 1, 0);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- dest = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v) + 2;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, op, 1, dest);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AddImm, -1, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_AGG_FUNCTION: {
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AggGet, 0, pExpr->iAgg);
- break;
- }
- case TK_GLOB:
- case TK_LIKE:
- case TK_FUNCTION: {
- ExprList *pList = pExpr->pList;
- int nExpr = pList ? pList->nExpr : 0;
- FuncDef *pDef;
- int nId;
- const char *zId;
- getFunctionName(pExpr, &zId, &nId);
- pDef = sqliteFindFunction(pParse->db, zId, nId, nExpr, 0);
- assert( pDef!=0 );
- nExpr = sqliteExprCodeExprList(pParse, pList, pDef->includeTypes);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_Function, nExpr, 0, (char*)pDef, P3_POINTER);
- break;
- }
- case TK_SELECT: {
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemLoad, pExpr->iColumn, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_IN: {
- int addr;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 1, 0);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- addr = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, -1, addr+4);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, addr+6);
- if( pExpr->pSelect ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Found, pExpr->iTable, addr+6);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetFound, pExpr->iTable, addr+6);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AddImm, -1, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_BETWEEN: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pList->a[0].pExpr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Ge, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pull, 1, 0);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pList->a[1].pExpr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Le, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_And, 0, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_UPLUS:
- case TK_AS: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- break;
- }
- case TK_CASE: {
- int expr_end_label;
- int jumpInst;
- int addr;
- int nExpr;
- int i;
-
- assert(pExpr->pList);
- assert((pExpr->pList->nExpr % 2) == 0);
- assert(pExpr->pList->nExpr > 0);
- nExpr = pExpr->pList->nExpr;
- expr_end_label = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- if( pExpr->pLeft ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- }
- for(i=0; i<nExpr; i=i+2){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pList->a[i].pExpr);
- if( pExpr->pLeft ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 1, 1);
- jumpInst = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Ne, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- }else{
- jumpInst = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IfNot, 1, 0);
- }
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pList->a[i+1].pExpr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, expr_end_label);
- addr = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, jumpInst, addr);
- }
- if( pExpr->pLeft ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- }
- if( pExpr->pRight ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pRight);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, expr_end_label);
- break;
- }
- case TK_RAISE: {
- if( !pParse->trigStack ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "RAISE() may only be used within a trigger-program");
- pParse->nErr++;
- return;
- }
- if( pExpr->iColumn == OE_Rollback ||
- pExpr->iColumn == OE_Abort ||
- pExpr->iColumn == OE_Fail ){
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_Halt, STQLITE_CONSTRAINT, pExpr->iColumn,
- pExpr->token.z, pExpr->token.n);
- sqliteVdbeDequoteP3(v, -1);
- } else {
- assert( pExpr->iColumn == OE_Ignore );
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_Goto, 0, pParse->trigStack->ignoreJump,
- "(IGNORE jump)", 0);
- }
- }
- break;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code that pushes the value of every element of the given
-** expression list onto the stack. If the includeTypes flag is true,
-** then also push a string that is the datatype of each element onto
-** the stack after the value.
-**
-** Return the number of elements pushed onto the stack.
-*/
-int sqliteExprCodeExprList(
- Parse *pParse, /* Parsing context */
- ExprList *pList, /* The expression list to be coded */
- int includeTypes /* TRUE to put datatypes on the stack too */
-){
- struct ExprList_item *pItem;
- int i, n;
- Vdbe *v;
- if( pList==0 ) return 0;
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- n = pList->nExpr;
- for(pItem=pList->a, i=0; i<n; i++, pItem++){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pItem->pExpr);
- if( includeTypes ){
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0,
- sqliteExprType(pItem->pExpr)==STQLITE_SO_NUM ? "numeric" : "text",
- P3_STATIC);
- }
- }
- return includeTypes ? n*2 : n;
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code for a boolean expression such that a jump is made
-** to the label "dest" if the expression is true but execution
-** continues straight thru if the expression is false.
-**
-** If the expression evaluates to NULL (neither true nor false), then
-** take the jump if the jumpIfNull flag is true.
-*/
-void sqliteExprIfTrue(Parse *pParse, Expr *pExpr, int dest, int jumpIfNull){
- Vdbe *v = pParse->pVdbe;
- int op = 0;
- if( v==0 || pExpr==0 ) return;
- switch( pExpr->op ){
- case TK_LT: op = OP_Lt; break;
- case TK_LE: op = OP_Le; break;
- case TK_GT: op = OP_Gt; break;
- case TK_GE: op = OP_Ge; break;
- case TK_NE: op = OP_Ne; break;
- case TK_EQ: op = OP_Eq; break;
- case TK_ISNULL: op = OP_IsNull; break;
- case TK_NOTNULL: op = OP_NotNull; break;
- default: break;
- }
- switch( pExpr->op ){
- case TK_AND: {
- int d2 = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteExprIfFalse(pParse, pExpr->pLeft, d2, !jumpIfNull);
- sqliteExprIfTrue(pParse, pExpr->pRight, dest, jumpIfNull);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, d2);
- break;
- }
- case TK_OR: {
- sqliteExprIfTrue(pParse, pExpr->pLeft, dest, jumpIfNull);
- sqliteExprIfTrue(pParse, pExpr->pRight, dest, jumpIfNull);
- break;
- }
- case TK_NOT: {
- sqliteExprIfFalse(pParse, pExpr->pLeft, dest, jumpIfNull);
- break;
- }
- case TK_LT:
- case TK_LE:
- case TK_GT:
- case TK_GE:
- case TK_NE:
- case TK_EQ: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pRight);
- if( pParse->db->file_format>=4 && sqliteExprType(pExpr)==STQLITE_SO_TEXT ){
- op += 6; /* Convert numeric opcodes to text opcodes */
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, op, jumpIfNull, dest);
- break;
- }
- case TK_ISNULL:
- case TK_NOTNULL: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, op, 1, dest);
- break;
- }
- case TK_IN: {
- int addr;
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- addr = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, -1, addr+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, jumpIfNull ? dest : addr+4);
- if( pExpr->pSelect ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Found, pExpr->iTable, dest);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetFound, pExpr->iTable, dest);
- }
- break;
- }
- case TK_BETWEEN: {
- int addr;
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pList->a[0].pExpr);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Lt, !jumpIfNull, 0);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pList->a[1].pExpr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Le, jumpIfNull, dest);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v));
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- break;
- }
- default: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_If, jumpIfNull, dest);
- break;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code for a boolean expression such that a jump is made
-** to the label "dest" if the expression is false but execution
-** continues straight thru if the expression is true.
-**
-** If the expression evaluates to NULL (neither true nor false) then
-** jump if jumpIfNull is true or fall through if jumpIfNull is false.
-*/
-void sqliteExprIfFalse(Parse *pParse, Expr *pExpr, int dest, int jumpIfNull){
- Vdbe *v = pParse->pVdbe;
- int op = 0;
- if( v==0 || pExpr==0 ) return;
- switch( pExpr->op ){
- case TK_LT: op = OP_Ge; break;
- case TK_LE: op = OP_Gt; break;
- case TK_GT: op = OP_Le; break;
- case TK_GE: op = OP_Lt; break;
- case TK_NE: op = OP_Eq; break;
- case TK_EQ: op = OP_Ne; break;
- case TK_ISNULL: op = OP_NotNull; break;
- case TK_NOTNULL: op = OP_IsNull; break;
- default: break;
- }
- switch( pExpr->op ){
- case TK_AND: {
- sqliteExprIfFalse(pParse, pExpr->pLeft, dest, jumpIfNull);
- sqliteExprIfFalse(pParse, pExpr->pRight, dest, jumpIfNull);
- break;
- }
- case TK_OR: {
- int d2 = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteExprIfTrue(pParse, pExpr->pLeft, d2, !jumpIfNull);
- sqliteExprIfFalse(pParse, pExpr->pRight, dest, jumpIfNull);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, d2);
- break;
- }
- case TK_NOT: {
- sqliteExprIfTrue(pParse, pExpr->pLeft, dest, jumpIfNull);
- break;
- }
- case TK_LT:
- case TK_LE:
- case TK_GT:
- case TK_GE:
- case TK_NE:
- case TK_EQ: {
- if( pParse->db->file_format>=4 && sqliteExprType(pExpr)==STQLITE_SO_TEXT ){
- /* Convert numeric comparison opcodes into text comparison opcodes.
- ** This step depends on the fact that the text comparision opcodes are
- ** always 6 greater than their corresponding numeric comparison
- ** opcodes.
- */
- assert( OP_Eq+6 == OP_StrEq );
- op += 6;
- }
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pRight);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, op, jumpIfNull, dest);
- break;
- }
- case TK_ISNULL:
- case TK_NOTNULL: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, op, 1, dest);
- break;
- }
- case TK_IN: {
- int addr;
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- addr = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, -1, addr+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, jumpIfNull ? dest : addr+4);
- if( pExpr->pSelect ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotFound, pExpr->iTable, dest);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetNotFound, pExpr->iTable, dest);
- }
- break;
- }
- case TK_BETWEEN: {
- int addr;
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pList->a[0].pExpr);
- addr = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Ge, !jumpIfNull, addr+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, dest);
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pList->a[1].pExpr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Gt, jumpIfNull, dest);
- break;
- }
- default: {
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IfNot, jumpIfNull, dest);
- break;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Do a deep comparison of two expression trees. Return TRUE (non-zero)
-** if they are identical and return FALSE if they differ in any way.
-*/
-int sqliteExprCompare(Expr *pA, Expr *pB){
- int i;
- if( pA==0 ){
- return pB==0;
- }else if( pB==0 ){
- return 0;
- }
- if( pA->op!=pB->op ) return 0;
- if( !sqliteExprCompare(pA->pLeft, pB->pLeft) ) return 0;
- if( !sqliteExprCompare(pA->pRight, pB->pRight) ) return 0;
- if( pA->pList ){
- if( pB->pList==0 ) return 0;
- if( pA->pList->nExpr!=pB->pList->nExpr ) return 0;
- for(i=0; i<pA->pList->nExpr; i++){
- if( !sqliteExprCompare(pA->pList->a[i].pExpr, pB->pList->a[i].pExpr) ){
- return 0;
- }
- }
- }else if( pB->pList ){
- return 0;
- }
- if( pA->pSelect || pB->pSelect ) return 0;
- if( pA->iTable!=pB->iTable || pA->iColumn!=pB->iColumn ) return 0;
- if( pA->token.z ){
- if( pB->token.z==0 ) return 0;
- if( pB->token.n!=pA->token.n ) return 0;
- if( sqliteStrNICmp(pA->token.z, pB->token.z, pB->token.n)!=0 ) return 0;
- }
- return 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Add a new element to the pParse->aAgg[] array and return its index.
-*/
-static int appendAggInfo(Parse *pParse){
- if( (pParse->nAgg & 0x7)==0 ){
- int amt = pParse->nAgg + 8;
- AggExpr *aAgg = sqliteRealloc(pParse->aAgg, amt*sizeof(pParse->aAgg[0]));
- if( aAgg==0 ){
- return -1;
- }
- pParse->aAgg = aAgg;
- }
- memset(&pParse->aAgg[pParse->nAgg], 0, sizeof(pParse->aAgg[0]));
- return pParse->nAgg++;
-}
-
-/*
-** Analyze the given expression looking for aggregate functions and
-** for variables that need to be added to the pParse->aAgg[] array.
-** Make additional entries to the pParse->aAgg[] array as necessary.
-**
-** This routine should only be called after the expression has been
-** analyzed by sqliteExprResolveIds() and sqliteExprCheck().
-**
-** If errors are seen, leave an error message in zErrMsg and return
-** the number of errors.
-*/
-int sqliteExprAnalyzeAggregates(Parse *pParse, Expr *pExpr){
- int i;
- AggExpr *aAgg;
- int nErr = 0;
-
- if( pExpr==0 ) return 0;
- switch( pExpr->op ){
- case TK_COLUMN: {
- aAgg = pParse->aAgg;
- for(i=0; i<pParse->nAgg; i++){
- if( aAgg[i].isAgg ) continue;
- if( aAgg[i].pExpr->iTable==pExpr->iTable
- && aAgg[i].pExpr->iColumn==pExpr->iColumn ){
- break;
- }
- }
- if( i>=pParse->nAgg ){
- i = appendAggInfo(pParse);
- if( i<0 ) return 1;
- pParse->aAgg[i].isAgg = 0;
- pParse->aAgg[i].pExpr = pExpr;
- }
- pExpr->iAgg = i;
- break;
- }
- case TK_AGG_FUNCTION: {
- aAgg = pParse->aAgg;
- for(i=0; i<pParse->nAgg; i++){
- if( !aAgg[i].isAgg ) continue;
- if( sqliteExprCompare(aAgg[i].pExpr, pExpr) ){
- break;
- }
- }
- if( i>=pParse->nAgg ){
- i = appendAggInfo(pParse);
- if( i<0 ) return 1;
- pParse->aAgg[i].isAgg = 1;
- pParse->aAgg[i].pExpr = pExpr;
- pParse->aAgg[i].pFunc = sqliteFindFunction(pParse->db,
- pExpr->token.z, pExpr->token.n,
- pExpr->pList ? pExpr->pList->nExpr : 0, 0);
- }
- pExpr->iAgg = i;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- if( pExpr->pLeft ){
- nErr = sqliteExprAnalyzeAggregates(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- }
- if( nErr==0 && pExpr->pRight ){
- nErr = sqliteExprAnalyzeAggregates(pParse, pExpr->pRight);
- }
- if( nErr==0 && pExpr->pList ){
- int n = pExpr->pList->nExpr;
- int i;
- for(i=0; nErr==0 && i<n; i++){
- nErr = sqliteExprAnalyzeAggregates(pParse, pExpr->pList->a[i].pExpr);
- }
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- return nErr;
-}
-
-/*
-** Locate a user function given a name and a number of arguments.
-** Return a pointer to the FuncDef structure that defines that
-** function, or return NULL if the function does not exist.
-**
-** If the createFlag argument is true, then a new (blank) FuncDef
-** structure is created and liked into the "db" structure if a
-** no matching function previously existed. When createFlag is true
-** and the nArg parameter is -1, then only a function that accepts
-** any number of arguments will be returned.
-**
-** If createFlag is false and nArg is -1, then the first valid
-** function found is returned. A function is valid if either xFunc
-** or xStep is non-zero.
-*/
-FuncDef *sqliteFindFunction(
- sqlite *db, /* An open database */
- const char *zName, /* Name of the function. Not null-terminated */
- int nName, /* Number of characters in the name */
- int nArg, /* Number of arguments. -1 means any number */
- int createFlag /* Create new entry if true and does not otherwise exist */
-){
- FuncDef *pFirst, *p, *pMaybe;
- pFirst = p = (FuncDef*)sqliteHashFind(&db->aFunc, zName, nName);
- if( p && !createFlag && nArg<0 ){
- while( p && p->xFunc==0 && p->xStep==0 ){ p = p->pNext; }
- return p;
- }
- pMaybe = 0;
- while( p && p->nArg!=nArg ){
- if( p->nArg<0 && !createFlag && (p->xFunc || p->xStep) ) pMaybe = p;
- p = p->pNext;
- }
- if( p && !createFlag && p->xFunc==0 && p->xStep==0 ){
- return 0;
- }
- if( p==0 && pMaybe ){
- assert( createFlag==0 );
- return pMaybe;
- }
- if( p==0 && createFlag && (p = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(*p)))!=0 ){
- p->nArg = nArg;
- p->pNext = pFirst;
- p->dataType = pFirst ? pFirst->dataType : STQLITE_NUMERIC;
- sqliteHashInsert(&db->aFunc, zName, nName, (void*)p);
- }
- return p;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/func.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/func.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 3c6c85f..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/func.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,646 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2002 February 23
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains the C functions that implement various SQL
-** functions of STQLite.
-**
-** There is only one exported symbol in this file - the function
-** sqliteRegisterBuildinFunctions() found at the bottom of the file.
-** All other code has file scope.
-**
-** $Id: func.c,v 1.43 2004/02/25 22:51:06 rdc Exp $
-*/
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include <math.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <assert.h>
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include "os.h"
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the non-aggregate min() and max() functions
-*/
-static void minmaxFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- const char *zBest;
- int i;
- int (*xCompare)(const char*, const char*);
- int mask; /* 0 for min() or 0xffffffff for max() */
-
- if( argc==0 ) return;
- mask = (int)sqlite_user_data(context);
- zBest = argv[0];
- if( zBest==0 ) return;
- if( argv[1][0]=='n' ){
- xCompare = sqliteCompare;
- }else{
- xCompare = strcmp;
- }
- for(i=2; i<argc; i+=2){
- if( argv[i]==0 ) return;
- if( (xCompare(argv[i], zBest)^mask)<0 ){
- zBest = argv[i];
- }
- }
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, zBest, -1);
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the type of the argument.
-*/
-static void typeofFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- assert( argc==2 );
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, argv[1], -1);
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the length() function
-*/
-static void lengthFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- const char *z;
- int len;
-
- assert( argc==1 );
- z = argv[0];
- if( z==0 ) return;
-#ifdef STQLITE_UTF8
- for(len=0; *z; z++){ if( (0xc0&*z)!=0x80 ) len++; }
-#else
- len = strlen(z);
-#endif
- sqlite_set_result_int(context, len);
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the abs() function
-*/
-static void absFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- const char *z;
- assert( argc==1 );
- z = argv[0];
- if( z==0 ) return;
- if( z[0]=='-' && isdigit(z[1]) ) z++;
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, z, -1);
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the substr() function
-*/
-static void substrFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- const char *z;
-#ifdef STQLITE_UTF8
- const char *z2;
- int i;
-#endif
- int p1, p2, len;
- assert( argc==3 );
- z = argv[0];
- if( z==0 ) return;
- p1 = atoi(argv[1]?argv[1]:0);
- p2 = atoi(argv[2]?argv[2]:0);
-#ifdef STQLITE_UTF8
- for(len=0, z2=z; *z2; z2++){ if( (0xc0&*z2)!=0x80 ) len++; }
-#else
- len = strlen(z);
-#endif
- if( p1<0 ){
- p1 += len;
- if( p1<0 ){
- p2 += p1;
- p1 = 0;
- }
- }else if( p1>0 ){
- p1--;
- }
- if( p1+p2>len ){
- p2 = len-p1;
- }
-#ifdef STQLITE_UTF8
- for(i=0; i<p1 && z[i]; i++){
- if( (z[i]&0xc0)==0x80 ) p1++;
- }
- while( z[i] && (z[i]&0xc0)==0x80 ){ i++; p1++; }
- for(; i<p1+p2 && z[i]; i++){
- if( (z[i]&0xc0)==0x80 ) p2++;
- }
- while( z[i] && (z[i]&0xc0)==0x80 ){ i++; p2++; }
-#endif
- if( p2<0 ) p2 = 0;
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, &z[p1], p2);
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the round() function
-*/
-static void roundFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- int n;
- double r;
- char zBuf[100];
- assert( argc==1 || argc==2 );
- if( argv[0]==0 || (argc==2 && argv[1]==0) ) return;
- n = argc==2 ? atoi(argv[1]) : 0;
- if( n>30 ) n = 30;
- if( n<0 ) n = 0;
- r = sqliteAtoF(argv[0], 0);
- sprintf(zBuf,"%.*f",n,r);
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, zBuf, -1);
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the upper() and lower() SQL functions.
-*/
-static void upperFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- char *z;
- int i;
- if( argc<1 || argv[0]==0 ) return;
- z = sqlite_set_result_string(context, argv[0], -1);
- if( z==0 ) return;
- for(i=0; z[i]; i++){
- if( islower(z[i]) ) z[i] = toupper(z[i]);
- }
-}
-static void lowerFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- char *z;
- int i;
- if( argc<1 || argv[0]==0 ) return;
- z = sqlite_set_result_string(context, argv[0], -1);
- if( z==0 ) return;
- for(i=0; z[i]; i++){
- if( isupper(z[i]) ) z[i] = tolower(z[i]);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the IFNULL(), NVL(), and COALESCE() functions.
-** All three do the same thing. They return the first non-NULL
-** argument.
-*/
-static void ifnullFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<argc; i++){
- if( argv[i] ){
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, argv[i], -1);
- break;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of random(). Return a random integer.
-*/
-static void randomFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- int r;
- sqliteRandomness(sizeof(r), &r);
- sqlite_set_result_int(context, r);
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the last_insert_rowid() SQL function. The return
-** value is the same as the sqlite_last_insert_rowid() API function.
-*/
-static void last_insert_rowid(sqlite_func *context, int arg, const char **argv){
- sqlite *db = sqlite_user_data(context);
- sqlite_set_result_int(context, sqlite_last_insert_rowid(db));
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the change_count() SQL function. The return
-** value is the same as the sqlite_changes() API function.
-*/
-static void change_count(sqlite_func *context, int arg, const char **argv){
- sqlite *db = sqlite_user_data(context);
- sqlite_set_result_int(context, sqlite_changes(db));
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the last_statement_change_count() SQL function. The
-** return value is the same as the sqlite_last_statement_changes() API function.
-*/
-static void last_statement_change_count(sqlite_func *context, int arg,
- const char **argv){
- sqlite *db = sqlite_user_data(context);
- sqlite_set_result_int(context, sqlite_last_statement_changes(db));
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the like() SQL function. This function implements
-** the build-in LIKE operator. The first argument to the function is the
-** string and the second argument is the pattern. So, the SQL statements:
-**
-** A LIKE B
-**
-** is implemented as like(A,B).
-*/
-static void likeFunc(sqlite_func *context, int arg, const char **argv){
- if( argv[0]==0 || argv[1]==0 ) return;
- sqlite_set_result_int(context,
- sqliteLikeCompare((const unsigned char*)argv[0],
- (const unsigned char*)argv[1]));
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the glob() SQL function. This function implements
-** the build-in GLOB operator. The first argument to the function is the
-** string and the second argument is the pattern. So, the SQL statements:
-**
-** A GLOB B
-**
-** is implemented as glob(A,B).
-*/
-static void globFunc(sqlite_func *context, int arg, const char **argv){
- if( argv[0]==0 || argv[1]==0 ) return;
- sqlite_set_result_int(context,
- sqliteGlobCompare((const unsigned char*)argv[0],
- (const unsigned char*)argv[1]));
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the NULLIF(x,y) function. The result is the first
-** argument if the arguments are different. The result is NULL if the
-** arguments are equal to each other.
-*/
-static void nullifFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- if( argv[0]!=0 && sqliteCompare(argv[0],argv[1])!=0 ){
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, argv[0], -1);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Implementation of the VERSION(*) function. The result is the version
-** of the STQLite library that is running.
-*/
-static void versionFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, sqlite_version, -1);
-}
-
-/*
-** EXPERIMENTAL - This is not an official function. The interface may
-** change. This function may disappear. Do not write code that depends
-** on this function.
-**
-** Implementation of the TQUOTE() function. This function takes a single
-** argument. If the argument is numeric, the return value is the same as
-** the argument. If the argument is NULL, the return value is the string
-** "NULL". Otherwise, the argument is enclosed in single quotes with
-** single-quote escapes.
-*/
-static void quoteFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- if( argc<1 ) return;
- if( argv[0]==0 ){
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, "NULL", 4);
- }else if( sqliteIsNumber(argv[0]) ){
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, argv[0], -1);
- }else{
- int i,j,n;
- char *z;
- for(i=n=0; argv[0][i]; i++){ if( argv[0][i]=='\'' ) n++; }
- z = sqliteMalloc( i+n+3 );
- if( z==0 ) return;
- z[0] = '\'';
- for(i=0, j=1; argv[0][i]; i++){
- z[j++] = argv[0][i];
- if( argv[0][i]=='\'' ){
- z[j++] = '\'';
- }
- }
- z[j++] = '\'';
- z[j] = 0;
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, z, j);
- sqliteFree(z);
- }
-}
-
-#ifdef STQLITE_SOUNDEX
-/*
-** Compute the soundex encoding of a word.
-*/
-static void soundexFunc(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- char zResult[8];
- const char *zIn;
- int i, j;
- static const unsigned char iCode[] = {
- 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
- 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
- 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
- 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
- 0, 0, 1, 2, 3, 0, 1, 2, 0, 0, 2, 2, 4, 5, 5, 0,
- 1, 2, 6, 2, 3, 0, 1, 0, 2, 0, 2, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
- 0, 0, 1, 2, 3, 0, 1, 2, 0, 0, 2, 2, 4, 5, 5, 0,
- 1, 2, 6, 2, 3, 0, 1, 0, 2, 0, 2, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
- };
- assert( argc==1 );
- zIn = argv[0];
- for(i=0; zIn[i] && !isalpha(zIn[i]); i++){}
- if( zIn[i] ){
- zResult[0] = toupper(zIn[i]);
- for(j=1; j<4 && zIn[i]; i++){
- int code = iCode[zIn[i]&0x7f];
- if( code>0 ){
- zResult[j++] = code + '0';
- }
- }
- while( j<4 ){
- zResult[j++] = '0';
- }
- zResult[j] = 0;
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, zResult, 4);
- }else{
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, "?000", 4);
- }
-}
-#endif
-
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-/*
-** This function generates a string of random characters. Used for
-** generating test data.
-*/
-static void randStr(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- static const unsigned char zSrc[] =
- "abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz"
- "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ"
- "0123456789"
- ".-!,:*^+=_|?/<> ";
- int iMin, iMax, n, r, i;
- unsigned char zBuf[1000];
- if( argc>=1 ){
- iMin = atoi(argv[0]);
- if( iMin<0 ) iMin = 0;
- if( iMin>=sizeof(zBuf) ) iMin = sizeof(zBuf)-1;
- }else{
- iMin = 1;
- }
- if( argc>=2 ){
- iMax = atoi(argv[1]);
- if( iMax<iMin ) iMax = iMin;
- if( iMax>=sizeof(zBuf) ) iMax = sizeof(zBuf)-1;
- }else{
- iMax = 50;
- }
- n = iMin;
- if( iMax>iMin ){
- sqliteRandomness(sizeof(r), &r);
- r &= 0x7fffffff;
- n += r%(iMax + 1 - iMin);
- }
- assert( n<sizeof(zBuf) );
- sqliteRandomness(n, zBuf);
- for(i=0; i<n; i++){
- zBuf[i] = zSrc[zBuf[i]%(sizeof(zSrc)-1)];
- }
- zBuf[n] = 0;
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, zBuf, n);
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure holds the context of a
-** sum() or avg() aggregate computation.
-*/
-typedef struct SumCtx SumCtx;
-struct SumCtx {
- double sum; /* Sum of terms */
- int cnt; /* Number of elements summed */
-};
-
-/*
-** Routines used to compute the sum or average.
-*/
-static void sumStep(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- SumCtx *p;
- if( argc<1 ) return;
- p = sqlite_aggregate_context(context, sizeof(*p));
- if( p && argv[0] ){
- p->sum += sqliteAtoF(argv[0], 0);
- p->cnt++;
- }
-}
-static void sumFinalize(sqlite_func *context){
- SumCtx *p;
- p = sqlite_aggregate_context(context, sizeof(*p));
- sqlite_set_result_double(context, p ? p->sum : 0.0);
-}
-static void avgFinalize(sqlite_func *context){
- SumCtx *p;
- p = sqlite_aggregate_context(context, sizeof(*p));
- if( p && p->cnt>0 ){
- sqlite_set_result_double(context, p->sum/(double)p->cnt);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure holds the context of a
-** variance or standard deviation computation.
-*/
-typedef struct StdDevCtx StdDevCtx;
-struct StdDevCtx {
- double sum; /* Sum of terms */
- double sum2; /* Sum of the squares of terms */
- int cnt; /* Number of terms counted */
-};
-
-#if 0 /* Omit because math library is required */
-/*
-** Routines used to compute the standard deviation as an aggregate.
-*/
-static void stdDevStep(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- StdDevCtx *p;
- double x;
- if( argc<1 ) return;
- p = sqlite_aggregate_context(context, sizeof(*p));
- if( p && argv[0] ){
- x = sqliteAtoF(argv[0], 0);
- p->sum += x;
- p->sum2 += x*x;
- p->cnt++;
- }
-}
-static void stdDevFinalize(sqlite_func *context){
- double rN = sqlite_aggregate_count(context);
- StdDevCtx *p = sqlite_aggregate_context(context, sizeof(*p));
- if( p && p->cnt>1 ){
- double rCnt = cnt;
- sqlite_set_result_double(context,
- sqrt((p->sum2 - p->sum*p->sum/rCnt)/(rCnt-1.0)));
- }
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-** The following structure keeps track of state information for the
-** count() aggregate function.
-*/
-typedef struct CountCtx CountCtx;
-struct CountCtx {
- int n;
-};
-
-/*
-** Routines to implement the count() aggregate function.
-*/
-static void countStep(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- CountCtx *p;
- p = sqlite_aggregate_context(context, sizeof(*p));
- if( (argc==0 || argv[0]) && p ){
- p->n++;
- }
-}
-static void countFinalize(sqlite_func *context){
- CountCtx *p;
- p = sqlite_aggregate_context(context, sizeof(*p));
- sqlite_set_result_int(context, p ? p->n : 0);
-}
-
-/*
-** This function tracks state information for the min() and max()
-** aggregate functions.
-*/
-typedef struct MinMaxCtx MinMaxCtx;
-struct MinMaxCtx {
- char *z; /* The best so far */
- char zBuf[28]; /* Space that can be used for storage */
-};
-
-/*
-** Routines to implement min() and max() aggregate functions.
-*/
-static void minmaxStep(sqlite_func *context, int argc, const char **argv){
- MinMaxCtx *p;
- int (*xCompare)(const char*, const char*);
- int mask; /* 0 for min() or 0xffffffff for max() */
-
- assert( argc==2 );
- if( argv[1][0]=='n' ){
- xCompare = sqliteCompare;
- }else{
- xCompare = strcmp;
- }
- mask = (int)sqlite_user_data(context);
- p = sqlite_aggregate_context(context, sizeof(*p));
- if( p==0 || argc<1 || argv[0]==0 ) return;
- if( p->z==0 || (xCompare(argv[0],p->z)^mask)<0 ){
- int len;
- if( !p->zBuf[0] ){
- sqliteFree(p->z);
- }
- len = strlen(argv[0]);
- if( len < sizeof(p->zBuf)-1 ){
- p->z = &p->zBuf[1];
- p->zBuf[0] = 1;
- }else{
- p->z = sqliteMalloc( len+1 );
- p->zBuf[0] = 0;
- if( p->z==0 ) return;
- }
- strcpy(p->z, argv[0]);
- }
-}
-static void minMaxFinalize(sqlite_func *context){
- MinMaxCtx *p;
- p = sqlite_aggregate_context(context, sizeof(*p));
- if( p && p->z ){
- sqlite_set_result_string(context, p->z, strlen(p->z));
- }
- if( p && !p->zBuf[0] ){
- sqliteFree(p->z);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This function registered all of the above C functions as SQL
-** functions. This should be the only routine in this file with
-** external linkage.
-*/
-void sqliteRegisterBuiltinFunctions(sqlite *db){
- static struct {
- char *zName;
- signed char nArg;
- signed char dataType;
- u8 argType; /* 0: none. 1: db 2: (-1) */
- void (*xFunc)(sqlite_func*,int,const char**);
- } aFuncs[] = {
- { "min", -1, STQLITE_ARGS, 0, minmaxFunc },
- { "min", 0, 0, 0, 0 },
- { "max", -1, STQLITE_ARGS, 2, minmaxFunc },
- { "max", 0, 0, 2, 0 },
- { "typeof", 1, STQLITE_TEXT, 0, typeofFunc },
- { "length", 1, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, lengthFunc },
- { "substr", 3, STQLITE_TEXT, 0, substrFunc },
- { "abs", 1, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, absFunc },
- { "round", 1, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, roundFunc },
- { "round", 2, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, roundFunc },
- { "upper", 1, STQLITE_TEXT, 0, upperFunc },
- { "lower", 1, STQLITE_TEXT, 0, lowerFunc },
- { "coalesce", -1, STQLITE_ARGS, 0, ifnullFunc },
- { "coalesce", 0, 0, 0, 0 },
- { "coalesce", 1, 0, 0, 0 },
- { "ifnull", 2, STQLITE_ARGS, 0, ifnullFunc },
- { "random", -1, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, randomFunc },
- { "like", 2, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, likeFunc },
- { "glob", 2, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, globFunc },
- { "nullif", 2, STQLITE_ARGS, 0, nullifFunc },
- { "sqlite_version",0,STQLITE_TEXT, 0, versionFunc},
- { "quote", 1, STQLITE_ARGS, 0, quoteFunc },
- { "last_insert_rowid", 0, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 1, last_insert_rowid },
- { "change_count", 0, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 1, change_count },
- { "last_statement_change_count",
- 0, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 1, last_statement_change_count },
-#ifdef STQLITE_SOUNDEX
- { "soundex", 1, STQLITE_TEXT, 0, soundexFunc},
-#endif
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
- { "randstr", 2, STQLITE_TEXT, 0, randStr },
-#endif
- };
- static struct {
- char *zName;
- signed char nArg;
- signed char dataType;
- u8 argType;
- void (*xStep)(sqlite_func*,int,const char**);
- void (*xFinalize)(sqlite_func*);
- } aAggs[] = {
- { "min", 1, 0, 0, minmaxStep, minMaxFinalize },
- { "max", 1, 0, 2, minmaxStep, minMaxFinalize },
- { "sum", 1, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, sumStep, sumFinalize },
- { "avg", 1, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, sumStep, avgFinalize },
- { "count", 0, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, countStep, countFinalize },
- { "count", 1, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, countStep, countFinalize },
-#if 0
- { "stddev", 1, STQLITE_NUMERIC, 0, stdDevStep, stdDevFinalize },
-#endif
- };
- static const char *azTypeFuncs[] = { "min", "max", "typeof" };
- int i;
-
- for(i=0; i<sizeof(aFuncs)/sizeof(aFuncs[0]); i++){
- void *pArg = aFuncs[i].argType==2 ? (void*)(-1) : db;
- sqlite_create_function(db, aFuncs[i].zName,
- aFuncs[i].nArg, aFuncs[i].xFunc, pArg);
- if( aFuncs[i].xFunc ){
- sqlite_function_type(db, aFuncs[i].zName, aFuncs[i].dataType);
- }
- }
- for(i=0; i<sizeof(aAggs)/sizeof(aAggs[0]); i++){
- void *pArg = aAggs[i].argType==2 ? (void*)(-1) : db;
- sqlite_create_aggregate(db, aAggs[i].zName,
- aAggs[i].nArg, aAggs[i].xStep, aAggs[i].xFinalize, pArg);
- sqlite_function_type(db, aAggs[i].zName, aAggs[i].dataType);
- }
- for(i=0; i<sizeof(azTypeFuncs)/sizeof(azTypeFuncs[0]); i++){
- int n = strlen(azTypeFuncs[i]);
- FuncDef *p = sqliteHashFind(&db->aFunc, azTypeFuncs[i], n);
- while( p ){
- p->includeTypes = 1;
- p = p->pNext;
- }
- }
- sqliteRegisterDateTimeFunctions(db);
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/hash.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/hash.c
deleted file mode 100644
index b96d40d..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/hash.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,356 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 22
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This is the implementation of generic hash-tables
-** used in STQLite.
-**
-** $Id: hash.c,v 1.11 2004/01/08 02:17:33 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include <assert.h>
-
-/* Turn bulk memory into a hash table object by initializing the
-** fields of the Hash structure.
-**
-** "new" is a pointer to the hash table that is to be initialized.
-** keyClass is one of the constants STQLITE_HASH_INT, STQLITE_HASH_POINTER,
-** STQLITE_HASH_BINARY, or STQLITE_HASH_STRING. The value of keyClass
-** determines what kind of key the hash table will use. "copyKey" is
-** true if the hash table should make its own private copy of keys and
-** false if it should just use the supplied pointer. CopyKey only makes
-** sense for STQLITE_HASH_STRING and STQLITE_HASH_BINARY and is ignored
-** for other key classes.
-*/
-void sqliteHashInit(Hash *new, int keyClass, int copyKey){
- assert( new!=0 );
- assert( keyClass>=STQLITE_HASH_INT && keyClass<=STQLITE_HASH_BINARY );
- new->keyClass = keyClass;
- new->copyKey = copyKey &&
- (keyClass==STQLITE_HASH_STRING || keyClass==STQLITE_HASH_BINARY);
- new->first = 0;
- new->count = 0;
- new->htsize = 0;
- new->ht = 0;
-}
-
-/* Remove all entries from a hash table. Reclaim all memory.
-** Call this routine to delete a hash table or to reset a hash table
-** to the empty state.
-*/
-void sqliteHashClear(Hash *pH){
- HashElem *elem; /* For looping over all elements of the table */
-
- assert( pH!=0 );
- elem = pH->first;
- pH->first = 0;
- if( pH->ht ) sqliteFree(pH->ht);
- pH->ht = 0;
- pH->htsize = 0;
- while( elem ){
- HashElem *next_elem = elem->next;
- if( pH->copyKey && elem->pKey ){
- sqliteFree(elem->pKey);
- }
- sqliteFree(elem);
- elem = next_elem;
- }
- pH->count = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Hash and comparison functions when the mode is STQLITE_HASH_INT
-*/
-static int intHash(const void *pKey, int nKey){
- return nKey ^ (nKey<<8) ^ (nKey>>8);
-}
-static int intCompare(const void *pKey1, int n1, const void *pKey2, int n2){
- return n2 - n1;
-}
-
-#if 0 /* NOT USED */
-/*
-** Hash and comparison functions when the mode is STQLITE_HASH_POINTER
-*/
-static int ptrHash(const void *pKey, int nKey){
- uptr x = Addr(pKey);
- return x ^ (x<<8) ^ (x>>8);
-}
-static int ptrCompare(const void *pKey1, int n1, const void *pKey2, int n2){
- if( pKey1==pKey2 ) return 0;
- if( pKey1<pKey2 ) return -1;
- return 1;
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Hash and comparison functions when the mode is STQLITE_HASH_STRING
-*/
-static int strHash(const void *pKey, int nKey){
- return sqliteHashNoCase((const char*)pKey, nKey);
-}
-static int strCompare(const void *pKey1, int n1, const void *pKey2, int n2){
- if( n1!=n2 ) return n2-n1;
- return sqliteStrNICmp((const char*)pKey1,(const char*)pKey2,n1);
-}
-
-/*
-** Hash and comparison functions when the mode is STQLITE_HASH_BINARY
-*/
-static int binHash(const void *pKey, int nKey){
- int h = 0;
- const char *z = (const char *)pKey;
- while( nKey-- > 0 ){
- h = (h<<3) ^ h ^ *(z++);
- }
- return h & 0x7fffffff;
-}
-static int binCompare(const void *pKey1, int n1, const void *pKey2, int n2){
- if( n1!=n2 ) return n2-n1;
- return memcmp(pKey1,pKey2,n1);
-}
-
-/*
-** Return a pointer to the appropriate hash function given the key class.
-**
-** The C syntax in this function definition may be unfamilar to some
-** programmers, so we provide the following additional explanation:
-**
-** The name of the function is "hashFunction". The function takes a
-** single parameter "keyClass". The return value of hashFunction()
-** is a pointer to another function. Specifically, the return value
-** of hashFunction() is a pointer to a function that takes two parameters
-** with types "const void*" and "int" and returns an "int".
-*/
-static int (*hashFunction(int keyClass))(const void*,int){
- switch( keyClass ){
- case STQLITE_HASH_INT: return &intHash;
- /* case STQLITE_HASH_POINTER: return &ptrHash; // NOT USED */
- case STQLITE_HASH_STRING: return &strHash;
- case STQLITE_HASH_BINARY: return &binHash;;
- default: break;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return a pointer to the appropriate hash function given the key class.
-**
-** For help in interpreted the obscure C code in the function definition,
-** see the header comment on the previous function.
-*/
-static int (*compareFunction(int keyClass))(const void*,int,const void*,int){
- switch( keyClass ){
- case STQLITE_HASH_INT: return &intCompare;
- /* case STQLITE_HASH_POINTER: return &ptrCompare; // NOT USED */
- case STQLITE_HASH_STRING: return &strCompare;
- case STQLITE_HASH_BINARY: return &binCompare;
- default: break;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-
-/* Resize the hash table so that it cantains "new_size" buckets.
-** "new_size" must be a power of 2. The hash table might fail
-** to resize if sqliteMalloc() fails.
-*/
-static void rehash(Hash *pH, int new_size){
- struct _ht *new_ht; /* The new hash table */
- HashElem *elem, *next_elem; /* For looping over existing elements */
- HashElem *x; /* Element being copied to new hash table */
- int (*xHash)(const void*,int); /* The hash function */
-
- assert( (new_size & (new_size-1))==0 );
- new_ht = (struct _ht *)sqliteMalloc( new_size*sizeof(struct _ht) );
- if( new_ht==0 ) return;
- if( pH->ht ) sqliteFree(pH->ht);
- pH->ht = new_ht;
- pH->htsize = new_size;
- xHash = hashFunction(pH->keyClass);
- for(elem=pH->first, pH->first=0; elem; elem = next_elem){
- int h = (*xHash)(elem->pKey, elem->nKey) & (new_size-1);
- next_elem = elem->next;
- x = new_ht[h].chain;
- if( x ){
- elem->next = x;
- elem->prev = x->prev;
- if( x->prev ) x->prev->next = elem;
- else pH->first = elem;
- x->prev = elem;
- }else{
- elem->next = pH->first;
- if( pH->first ) pH->first->prev = elem;
- elem->prev = 0;
- pH->first = elem;
- }
- new_ht[h].chain = elem;
- new_ht[h].count++;
- }
-}
-
-/* This function (for internal use only) locates an element in an
-** hash table that matches the given key. The hash for this key has
-** already been computed and is passed as the 4th parameter.
-*/
-static HashElem *findElementGivenHash(
- const Hash *pH, /* The pH to be searched */
- const void *pKey, /* The key we are searching for */
- int nKey,
- int h /* The hash for this key. */
-){
- HashElem *elem; /* Used to loop thru the element list */
- int count; /* Number of elements left to test */
- int (*xCompare)(const void*,int,const void*,int); /* comparison function */
-
- if( pH->ht ){
- elem = pH->ht[h].chain;
- count = pH->ht[h].count;
- xCompare = compareFunction(pH->keyClass);
- while( count-- && elem ){
- if( (*xCompare)(elem->pKey,elem->nKey,pKey,nKey)==0 ){
- return elem;
- }
- elem = elem->next;
- }
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/* Remove a single entry from the hash table given a pointer to that
-** element and a hash on the element's key.
-*/
-static void removeElementGivenHash(
- Hash *pH, /* The pH containing "elem" */
- HashElem* elem, /* The element to be removed from the pH */
- int h /* Hash value for the element */
-){
- if( elem->prev ){
- elem->prev->next = elem->next;
- }else{
- pH->first = elem->next;
- }
- if( elem->next ){
- elem->next->prev = elem->prev;
- }
- if( pH->ht[h].chain==elem ){
- pH->ht[h].chain = elem->next;
- }
- pH->ht[h].count--;
- if( pH->ht[h].count<=0 ){
- pH->ht[h].chain = 0;
- }
- if( pH->copyKey && elem->pKey ){
- sqliteFree(elem->pKey);
- }
- sqliteFree( elem );
- pH->count--;
-}
-
-/* Attempt to locate an element of the hash table pH with a key
-** that matches pKey,nKey. Return the data for this element if it is
-** found, or NULL if there is no match.
-*/
-void *sqliteHashFind(const Hash *pH, const void *pKey, int nKey){
- int h; /* A hash on key */
- HashElem *elem; /* The element that matches key */
- int (*xHash)(const void*,int); /* The hash function */
-
- if( pH==0 || pH->ht==0 ) return 0;
- xHash = hashFunction(pH->keyClass);
- assert( xHash!=0 );
- h = (*xHash)(pKey,nKey);
- assert( (pH->htsize & (pH->htsize-1))==0 );
- elem = findElementGivenHash(pH,pKey,nKey, h & (pH->htsize-1));
- return elem ? elem->data : 0;
-}
-
-/* Insert an element into the hash table pH. The key is pKey,nKey
-** and the data is "data".
-**
-** If no element exists with a matching key, then a new
-** element is created. A copy of the key is made if the copyKey
-** flag is set. NULL is returned.
-**
-** If another element already exists with the same key, then the
-** new data replaces the old data and the old data is returned.
-** The key is not copied in this instance. If a malloc fails, then
-** the new data is returned and the hash table is unchanged.
-**
-** If the "data" parameter to this function is NULL, then the
-** element corresponding to "key" is removed from the hash table.
-*/
-void *sqliteHashInsert(Hash *pH, const void *pKey, int nKey, void *data){
- int hraw; /* Raw hash value of the key */
- int h; /* the hash of the key modulo hash table size */
- HashElem *elem; /* Used to loop thru the element list */
- HashElem *new_elem; /* New element added to the pH */
- int (*xHash)(const void*,int); /* The hash function */
-
- assert( pH!=0 );
- xHash = hashFunction(pH->keyClass);
- assert( xHash!=0 );
- hraw = (*xHash)(pKey, nKey);
- assert( (pH->htsize & (pH->htsize-1))==0 );
- h = hraw & (pH->htsize-1);
- elem = findElementGivenHash(pH,pKey,nKey,h);
- if( elem ){
- void *old_data = elem->data;
- if( data==0 ){
- removeElementGivenHash(pH,elem,h);
- }else{
- elem->data = data;
- }
- return old_data;
- }
- if( data==0 ) return 0;
- new_elem = (HashElem*)sqliteMalloc( sizeof(HashElem) );
- if( new_elem==0 ) return data;
- if( pH->copyKey && pKey!=0 ){
- new_elem->pKey = sqliteMallocRaw( nKey );
- if( new_elem->pKey==0 ){
- sqliteFree(new_elem);
- return data;
- }
- memcpy((void*)new_elem->pKey, pKey, nKey);
- }else{
- new_elem->pKey = (void*)pKey;
- }
- new_elem->nKey = nKey;
- pH->count++;
- if( pH->htsize==0 ) rehash(pH,8);
- if( pH->htsize==0 ){
- pH->count = 0;
- sqliteFree(new_elem);
- return data;
- }
- if( pH->count > pH->htsize ){
- rehash(pH,pH->htsize*2);
- }
- assert( (pH->htsize & (pH->htsize-1))==0 );
- h = hraw & (pH->htsize-1);
- elem = pH->ht[h].chain;
- if( elem ){
- new_elem->next = elem;
- new_elem->prev = elem->prev;
- if( elem->prev ){ elem->prev->next = new_elem; }
- else { pH->first = new_elem; }
- elem->prev = new_elem;
- }else{
- new_elem->next = pH->first;
- new_elem->prev = 0;
- if( pH->first ){ pH->first->prev = new_elem; }
- pH->first = new_elem;
- }
- pH->ht[h].count++;
- pH->ht[h].chain = new_elem;
- new_elem->data = data;
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/hash.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/hash.h
deleted file mode 100644
index d4f0037..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/hash.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,109 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 22
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This is the header file for the generic hash-table implemenation
-** used in STQLite.
-**
-** $Id: hash.h,v 1.6 2004/01/08 02:17:33 drh Exp $
-*/
-#ifndef _STQLITE_HASH_H_
-#define _STQLITE_HASH_H_
-
-/* Forward declarations of structures. */
-typedef struct Hash Hash;
-typedef struct HashElem HashElem;
-
-/* A complete hash table is an instance of the following structure.
-** The internals of this structure are intended to be opaque -- client
-** code should not attempt to access or modify the fields of this structure
-** directly. Change this structure only by using the routines below.
-** However, many of the "procedures" and "functions" for modifying and
-** accessing this structure are really macros, so we can't really make
-** this structure opaque.
-*/
-struct Hash {
- char keyClass; /* STQLITE_HASH_INT, _POINTER, _STRING, _BINARY */
- char copyKey; /* True if copy of key made on insert */
- int count; /* Number of entries in this table */
- HashElem *first; /* The first element of the array */
- int htsize; /* Number of buckets in the hash table */
- struct _ht { /* the hash table */
- int count; /* Number of entries with this hash */
- HashElem *chain; /* Pointer to first entry with this hash */
- } *ht;
-};
-
-/* Each element in the hash table is an instance of the following
-** structure. All elements are stored on a single doubly-linked list.
-**
-** Again, this structure is intended to be opaque, but it can't really
-** be opaque because it is used by macros.
-*/
-struct HashElem {
- HashElem *next, *prev; /* Next and previous elements in the table */
- void *data; /* Data associated with this element */
- void *pKey; int nKey; /* Key associated with this element */
-};
-
-/*
-** There are 4 different modes of operation for a hash table:
-**
-** STQLITE_HASH_INT nKey is used as the key and pKey is ignored.
-**
-** STQLITE_HASH_POINTER pKey is used as the key and nKey is ignored.
-**
-** STQLITE_HASH_STRING pKey points to a string that is nKey bytes long
-** (including the null-terminator, if any). Case
-** is ignored in comparisons.
-**
-** STQLITE_HASH_BINARY pKey points to binary data nKey bytes long.
-** memcmp() is used to compare keys.
-**
-** A copy of the key is made for STQLITE_HASH_STRING and STQLITE_HASH_BINARY
-** if the copyKey parameter to HashInit is 1.
-*/
-#define STQLITE_HASH_INT 1
-/* #define STQLITE_HASH_POINTER 2 // NOT USED */
-#define STQLITE_HASH_STRING 3
-#define STQLITE_HASH_BINARY 4
-
-/*
-** Access routines. To delete, insert a NULL pointer.
-*/
-void sqliteHashInit(Hash*, int keytype, int copyKey);
-void *sqliteHashInsert(Hash*, const void *pKey, int nKey, void *pData);
-void *sqliteHashFind(const Hash*, const void *pKey, int nKey);
-void sqliteHashClear(Hash*);
-
-/*
-** Macros for looping over all elements of a hash table. The idiom is
-** like this:
-**
-** Hash h;
-** HashElem *p;
-** ...
-** for(p=sqliteHashFirst(&h); p; p=sqliteHashNext(p)){
-** SomeStructure *pData = sqliteHashData(p);
-** // do something with pData
-** }
-*/
-#define sqliteHashFirst(H) ((H)->first)
-#define sqliteHashNext(E) ((E)->next)
-#define sqliteHashData(E) ((E)->data)
-#define sqliteHashKey(E) ((E)->pKey)
-#define sqliteHashKeysize(E) ((E)->nKey)
-
-/*
-** Number of entries in a hash table
-*/
-#define sqliteHashCount(H) ((H)->count)
-
-#endif /* _STQLITE_HASH_H_ */
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/insert.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/insert.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 0d61239..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/insert.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,919 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains C code routines that are called by the parser
-** to handle INSERT statements in STQLite.
-**
-** $Id: insert.c,v 1.94 2004/02/24 01:05:33 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-/*
-** This routine is call to handle SQL of the following forms:
-**
-** insert into TABLE (IDLIST) values(EXPRLIST)
-** insert into TABLE (IDLIST) select
-**
-** The IDLIST following the table name is always optional. If omitted,
-** then a list of all columns for the table is substituted. The IDLIST
-** appears in the pColumn parameter. pColumn is NULL if IDLIST is omitted.
-**
-** The pList parameter holds EXPRLIST in the first form of the INSERT
-** statement above, and pSelect is NULL. For the second form, pList is
-** NULL and pSelect is a pointer to the select statement used to generate
-** data for the insert.
-**
-** The code generated follows one of three templates. For a simple
-** select with data coming from a VALUES clause, the code executes
-** once straight down through. The template looks like this:
-**
-** open write cursor to <table> and its indices
-** puts VALUES clause expressions onto the stack
-** write the resulting record into <table>
-** cleanup
-**
-** If the statement is of the form
-**
-** INSERT INTO <table> SELECT ...
-**
-** And the SELECT clause does not read from <table> at any time, then
-** the generated code follows this template:
-**
-** goto B
-** A: setup for the SELECT
-** loop over the tables in the SELECT
-** gosub C
-** end loop
-** cleanup after the SELECT
-** goto D
-** B: open write cursor to <table> and its indices
-** goto A
-** C: insert the select result into <table>
-** return
-** D: cleanup
-**
-** The third template is used if the insert statement takes its
-** values from a SELECT but the data is being inserted into a table
-** that is also read as part of the SELECT. In the third form,
-** we have to use a intermediate table to store the results of
-** the select. The template is like this:
-**
-** goto B
-** A: setup for the SELECT
-** loop over the tables in the SELECT
-** gosub C
-** end loop
-** cleanup after the SELECT
-** goto D
-** C: insert the select result into the intermediate table
-** return
-** B: open a cursor to an intermediate table
-** goto A
-** D: open write cursor to <table> and its indices
-** loop over the intermediate table
-** transfer values form intermediate table into <table>
-** end the loop
-** cleanup
-*/
-void sqliteInsert(
- Parse *pParse, /* Parser context */
- SrcList *pTabList, /* Name of table into which we are inserting */
- ExprList *pList, /* List of values to be inserted */
- Select *pSelect, /* A SELECT statement to use as the data source */
- IdList *pColumn, /* Column names corresponding to IDLIST. */
- int onError /* How to handle constraint errors */
-){
- Table *pTab; /* The table to insert into */
- char *zTab; /* Name of the table into which we are inserting */
- const char *zDb; /* Name of the database holding this table */
- int i, j, idx; /* Loop counters */
- Vdbe *v; /* Generate code into this virtual machine */
- Index *pIdx; /* For looping over indices of the table */
- int nColumn; /* Number of columns in the data */
- int base; /* VDBE Cursor number for pTab */
- int iCont, iBreak; /* Beginning and end of the loop over srcTab */
- sqlite *db; /* The main database structure */
- int keyColumn = -1; /* Column that is the INTEGER PRIMARY KEY */
- int endOfLoop; /* Label for the end of the insertion loop */
- int useTempTable; /* Store SELECT results in intermediate table */
- int srcTab; /* Data comes from this temporary cursor if >=0 */
- int iSelectLoop; /* Address of code that implements the SELECT */
- int iCleanup; /* Address of the cleanup code */
- int iInsertBlock; /* Address of the subroutine used to insert data */
- int iCntMem; /* Memory cell used for the row counter */
- int isView; /* True if attempting to insert into a view */
-
- int row_triggers_exist = 0; /* True if there are FOR EACH ROW triggers */
- int before_triggers; /* True if there are BEFORE triggers */
- int after_triggers; /* True if there are AFTER triggers */
- int newIdx = -1; /* Cursor for the NEW table */
-
- if( pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto insert_cleanup;
- db = pParse->db;
-
- /* Locate the table into which we will be inserting new information.
- */
- assert( pTabList->nSrc==1 );
- zTab = pTabList->a[0].zName;
- if( zTab==0 ) goto insert_cleanup;
- pTab = sqliteSrcListLookup(pParse, pTabList);
- if( pTab==0 ){
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
- assert( pTab->iDb<db->nDb );
- zDb = db->aDb[pTab->iDb].zName;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_INSERT, pTab->zName, 0, zDb) ){
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
-
- /* Ensure that:
- * (a) the table is not read-only,
- * (b) that if it is a view then ON INSERT triggers exist
- */
- before_triggers = sqliteTriggersExist(pParse, pTab->pTrigger, TK_INSERT,
- TK_BEFORE, TK_ROW, 0);
- after_triggers = sqliteTriggersExist(pParse, pTab->pTrigger, TK_INSERT,
- TK_AFTER, TK_ROW, 0);
- row_triggers_exist = before_triggers || after_triggers;
- isView = pTab->pSelect!=0;
- if( sqliteIsReadOnly(pParse, pTab, before_triggers) ){
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
- if( pTab==0 ) goto insert_cleanup;
-
- /* If pTab is really a view, make sure it has been initialized.
- */
- if( isView && sqliteViewGetColumnNames(pParse, pTab) ){
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
-
- /* Allocate a VDBE
- */
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) goto insert_cleanup;
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, pSelect || row_triggers_exist, pTab->iDb);
-
- /* if there are row triggers, allocate a temp table for new.* references. */
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- newIdx = pParse->nTab++;
- }
-
- /* Figure out how many columns of data are supplied. If the data
- ** is coming from a SELECT statement, then this step also generates
- ** all the code to implement the SELECT statement and invoke a subroutine
- ** to process each row of the result. (Template 2.) If the SELECT
- ** statement uses the the table that is being inserted into, then the
- ** subroutine is also coded here. That subroutine stores the SELECT
- ** results in a temporary table. (Template 3.)
- */
- if( pSelect ){
- /* Data is coming from a SELECT. Generate code to implement that SELECT
- */
- int rc, iInitCode;
- iInitCode = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, 0);
- iSelectLoop = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- iInsertBlock = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- rc = sqliteSelect(pParse, pSelect, SRT_Subroutine, iInsertBlock, 0,0,0);
- if( rc || pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto insert_cleanup;
- iCleanup = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, iCleanup);
- assert( pSelect->pEList );
- nColumn = pSelect->pEList->nExpr;
-
- /* Set useTempTable to TRUE if the result of the SELECT statement
- ** should be written into a temporary table. Set to FALSE if each
- ** row of the SELECT can be written directly into the result table.
- **
- ** A temp table must be used if the table being updated is also one
- ** of the tables being read by the SELECT statement. Also use a
- ** temp table in the case of row triggers.
- */
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- useTempTable = 1;
- }else{
- int addr = sqliteVdbeFindOp(v, OP_OpenRead, pTab->tnum);
- useTempTable = 0;
- if( addr>0 ){
- VdbeOp *pOp = sqliteVdbeGetOp(v, addr-2);
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_Integer && pOp->p1==pTab->iDb ){
- useTempTable = 1;
- }
- }
- }
-
- if( useTempTable ){
- /* Generate the subroutine that SELECT calls to process each row of
- ** the result. Store the result in a temporary table
- */
- srcTab = pParse->nTab++;
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, iInsertBlock);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeRecord, nColumn, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NewRecno, srcTab, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pull, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, srcTab, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Return, 0, 0);
-
- /* The following code runs first because the GOTO at the very top
- ** of the program jumps to it. Create the temporary table, then jump
- ** back up and execute the SELECT code above.
- */
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, iInitCode, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v));
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenTemp, srcTab, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, iSelectLoop);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, iCleanup);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, iInitCode, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v));
- }
- }else{
- /* This is the case if the data for the INSERT is coming from a VALUES
- ** clause
- */
- SrcList dummy;
- assert( pList!=0 );
- srcTab = -1;
- useTempTable = 0;
- assert( pList );
- nColumn = pList->nExpr;
- dummy.nSrc = 0;
- for(i=0; i<nColumn; i++){
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, &dummy, 0, pList->a[i].pExpr) ){
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
- if( sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pList->a[i].pExpr, 0, 0) ){
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* Make sure the number of columns in the source data matches the number
- ** of columns to be inserted into the table.
- */
- if( pColumn==0 && nColumn!=pTab->nCol ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "table %S has %d columns but %d values were supplied",
- pTabList, 0, pTab->nCol, nColumn);
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
- if( pColumn!=0 && nColumn!=pColumn->nId ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "%d values for %d columns", nColumn, pColumn->nId);
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
-
- /* If the INSERT statement included an IDLIST term, then make sure
- ** all elements of the IDLIST really are columns of the table and
- ** remember the column indices.
- **
- ** If the table has an INTEGER PRIMARY KEY column and that column
- ** is named in the IDLIST, then record in the keyColumn variable
- ** the index into IDLIST of the primary key column. keyColumn is
- ** the index of the primary key as it appears in IDLIST, not as
- ** is appears in the original table. (The index of the primary
- ** key in the original table is pTab->iPKey.)
- */
- if( pColumn ){
- for(i=0; i<pColumn->nId; i++){
- pColumn->a[i].idx = -1;
- }
- for(i=0; i<pColumn->nId; i++){
- for(j=0; j<pTab->nCol; j++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(pColumn->a[i].zName, pTab->aCol[j].zName)==0 ){
- pColumn->a[i].idx = j;
- if( j==pTab->iPKey ){
- keyColumn = i;
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- if( j>=pTab->nCol ){
- if( sqliteIsRowid(pColumn->a[i].zName) ){
- keyColumn = i;
- }else{
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "table %S has no column named %s",
- pTabList, 0, pColumn->a[i].zName);
- pParse->nErr++;
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* If there is no IDLIST term but the table has an integer primary
- ** key, the set the keyColumn variable to the primary key column index
- ** in the original table definition.
- */
- if( pColumn==0 ){
- keyColumn = pTab->iPKey;
- }
-
- /* Open the temp table for FOR EACH ROW triggers
- */
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenPseudo, newIdx, 0);
- }
-
- /* Initialize the count of rows to be inserted
- */
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows ){
- iCntMem = pParse->nMem++;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, iCntMem, 1);
- }
-
- /* Open tables and indices if there are no row triggers */
- if( !row_triggers_exist ){
- base = pParse->nTab;
- idx = sqliteOpenTableAndIndices(pParse, pTab, base);
- pParse->nTab += idx;
- }
-
- /* If the data source is a temporary table, then we have to create
- ** a loop because there might be multiple rows of data. If the data
- ** source is a subroutine call from the SELECT statement, then we need
- ** to launch the SELECT statement processing.
- */
- if( useTempTable ){
- iBreak = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, srcTab, iBreak);
- iCont = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- }else if( pSelect ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, iSelectLoop);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, iInsertBlock);
- }
-
- /* Run the BEFORE and INSTEAD OF triggers, if there are any
- */
- endOfLoop = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- if( before_triggers ){
-
- /* build the NEW.* reference row. Note that if there is an INTEGER
- ** PRIMARY KEY into which a NULL is being inserted, that NULL will be
- ** translated into a unique ID for the row. But on a BEFORE trigger,
- ** we do not know what the unique ID will be (because the insert has
- ** not happened yet) so we substitute a rowid of -1
- */
- if( keyColumn<0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, -1, 0);
- }else if( useTempTable ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, srcTab, keyColumn);
- }else if( pSelect ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nColumn - keyColumn - 1, 1);
- }else{
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pList->a[keyColumn].pExpr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, -1, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, -1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MustBeInt, 0, 0);
- }
-
- /* Create the new column data
- */
- for(i=0; i<pTab->nCol; i++){
- if( pColumn==0 ){
- j = i;
- }else{
- for(j=0; j<pColumn->nId; j++){
- if( pColumn->a[j].idx==i ) break;
- }
- }
- if( pColumn && j>=pColumn->nId ){
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, pTab->aCol[i].zDflt, P3_STATIC);
- }else if( useTempTable ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, srcTab, j);
- }else if( pSelect ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nColumn-j-1, 1);
- }else{
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pList->a[j].pExpr);
- }
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeRecord, pTab->nCol, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, newIdx, 0);
-
- /* Fire BEFORE or INSTEAD OF triggers */
- if( sqliteCodeRowTrigger(pParse, TK_INSERT, 0, TK_BEFORE, pTab,
- newIdx, -1, onError, endOfLoop) ){
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
- }
-
- /* If any triggers exists, the opening of tables and indices is deferred
- ** until now.
- */
- if( row_triggers_exist && !isView ){
- base = pParse->nTab;
- idx = sqliteOpenTableAndIndices(pParse, pTab, base);
- pParse->nTab += idx;
- }
-
- /* Push the record number for the new entry onto the stack. The
- ** record number is a randomly generate integer created by NewRecno
- ** except when the table has an INTEGER PRIMARY KEY column, in which
- ** case the record number is the same as that column.
- */
- if( !isView ){
- if( keyColumn>=0 ){
- if( useTempTable ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, srcTab, keyColumn);
- }else if( pSelect ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nColumn - keyColumn - 1, 1);
- }else{
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pList->a[keyColumn].pExpr);
- }
- /* If the PRIMARY KEY expression is NULL, then use OP_NewRecno
- ** to generate a unique primary key value.
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, -1, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NewRecno, base, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MustBeInt, 0, 0);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NewRecno, base, 0);
- }
-
- /* Push onto the stack, data for all columns of the new entry, beginning
- ** with the first column.
- */
- for(i=0; i<pTab->nCol; i++){
- if( i==pTab->iPKey ){
- /* The value of the INTEGER PRIMARY KEY column is always a NULL.
- ** Whenever this column is read, the record number will be substituted
- ** in its place. So will fill this column with a NULL to avoid
- ** taking up data space with information that will never be used. */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- continue;
- }
- if( pColumn==0 ){
- j = i;
- }else{
- for(j=0; j<pColumn->nId; j++){
- if( pColumn->a[j].idx==i ) break;
- }
- }
- if( pColumn && j>=pColumn->nId ){
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, pTab->aCol[i].zDflt, P3_STATIC);
- }else if( useTempTable ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, srcTab, j);
- }else if( pSelect ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, i+nColumn-j, 1);
- }else{
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pList->a[j].pExpr);
- }
- }
-
- /* Generate code to check constraints and generate index keys and
- ** do the insertion.
- */
- sqliteGenerateConstraintChecks(pParse, pTab, base, 0, keyColumn>=0,
- 0, onError, endOfLoop);
- sqliteCompleteInsertion(pParse, pTab, base, 0,0,0,
- after_triggers ? newIdx : -1);
- }
-
- /* Update the count of rows that are inserted
- */
- if( (db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows)!=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemIncr, iCntMem, 0);
- }
-
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- /* Close all tables opened */
- if( !isView ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, base, 0);
- for(idx=1, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, idx++){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, idx+base, 0);
- }
- }
-
- /* Code AFTER triggers */
- if( sqliteCodeRowTrigger(pParse, TK_INSERT, 0, TK_AFTER, pTab, newIdx, -1,
- onError, endOfLoop) ){
- goto insert_cleanup;
- }
- }
-
- /* The bottom of the loop, if the data source is a SELECT statement
- */
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, endOfLoop);
- if( useTempTable ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Next, srcTab, iCont);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, iBreak);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, srcTab, 0);
- }else if( pSelect ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, nColumn, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Return, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, iCleanup);
- }
-
- if( !row_triggers_exist ){
- /* Close all tables opened */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, base, 0);
- for(idx=1, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, idx++){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, idx+base, 0);
- }
- }
-
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetCounts, 0, 0);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
-
- /*
- ** Return the number of rows inserted.
- */
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows ){
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_ColumnName, 0, 1, "rows inserted", P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemLoad, iCntMem, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Callback, 1, 0);
- }
-
-insert_cleanup:
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pTabList);
- if( pList ) sqliteExprListDelete(pList);
- if( pSelect ) sqliteSelectDelete(pSelect);
- sqliteIdListDelete(pColumn);
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code to do a constraint check prior to an INSERT or an UPDATE.
-**
-** When this routine is called, the stack contains (from bottom to top)
-** the following values:
-**
-** 1. The recno of the row to be updated before the update. This
-** value is omitted unless we are doing an UPDATE that involves a
-** change to the record number.
-**
-** 2. The recno of the row after the update.
-**
-** 3. The data in the first column of the entry after the update.
-**
-** i. Data from middle columns...
-**
-** N. The data in the last column of the entry after the update.
-**
-** The old recno shown as entry (1) above is omitted unless both isUpdate
-** and recnoChng are 1. isUpdate is true for UPDATEs and false for
-** INSERTs and recnoChng is true if the record number is being changed.
-**
-** The code generated by this routine pushes additional entries onto
-** the stack which are the keys for new index entries for the new record.
-** The order of index keys is the same as the order of the indices on
-** the pTable->pIndex list. A key is only created for index i if
-** aIdxUsed!=0 and aIdxUsed[i]!=0.
-**
-** This routine also generates code to check constraints. NOT NULL,
-** CHECK, and UNITQUE constraints are all checked. If a constraint fails,
-** then the appropriate action is performed. There are five possible
-** actions: ROLLBACK, ABORT, FAIL, REPLACE, and IGNORE.
-**
-** Constraint type Action What Happens
-** --------------- ---------- ----------------------------------------
-** any ROLLBACK The current transaction is rolled back and
-** sqlite_exec() returns immediately with a
-** return code of STQLITE_CONSTRAINT.
-**
-** any ABORT Back out changes from the current command
-** only (do not do a complete rollback) then
-** cause sqlite_exec() to return immediately
-** with STQLITE_CONSTRAINT.
-**
-** any FAIL Sqlite_exec() returns immediately with a
-** return code of STQLITE_CONSTRAINT. The
-** transaction is not rolled back and any
-** prior changes are retained.
-**
-** any IGNORE The record number and data is popped from
-** the stack and there is an immediate jump
-** to label ignoreDest.
-**
-** NOT NULL REPLACE The NULL value is replace by the default
-** value for that column. If the default value
-** is NULL, the action is the same as ABORT.
-**
-** UNITQUE REPLACE The other row that conflicts with the row
-** being inserted is removed.
-**
-** CHECK REPLACE Illegal. The results in an exception.
-**
-** Which action to take is determined by the overrideError parameter.
-** Or if overrideError==OE_Default, then the pParse->onError parameter
-** is used. Or if pParse->onError==OE_Default then the onError value
-** for the constraint is used.
-**
-** The calling routine must open a read/write cursor for pTab with
-** cursor number "base". All indices of pTab must also have open
-** read/write cursors with cursor number base+i for the i-th cursor.
-** Except, if there is no possibility of a REPLACE action then
-** cursors do not need to be open for indices where aIdxUsed[i]==0.
-**
-** If the isUpdate flag is true, it means that the "base" cursor is
-** initially pointing to an entry that is being updated. The isUpdate
-** flag causes extra code to be generated so that the "base" cursor
-** is still pointing at the same entry after the routine returns.
-** Without the isUpdate flag, the "base" cursor might be moved.
-*/
-void sqliteGenerateConstraintChecks(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- Table *pTab, /* the table into which we are inserting */
- int base, /* Index of a read/write cursor pointing at pTab */
- char *aIdxUsed, /* Which indices are used. NULL means all are used */
- int recnoChng, /* True if the record number will change */
- int isUpdate, /* True for UPDATE, False for INSERT */
- int overrideError, /* Override onError to this if not OE_Default */
- int ignoreDest /* Jump to this label on an OE_Ignore resolution */
-){
- int i;
- Vdbe *v;
- int nCol;
- int onError;
- int addr;
- int extra;
- int iCur;
- Index *pIdx;
- int seenReplace = 0;
- int jumpInst1, jumpInst2;
- int contAddr;
- int hasTwoRecnos = (isUpdate && recnoChng);
-
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- assert( v!=0 );
- assert( pTab->pSelect==0 ); /* This table is not a VIEW */
- nCol = pTab->nCol;
-
- /* Test all NOT NULL constraints.
- */
- for(i=0; i<nCol; i++){
- if( i==pTab->iPKey ){
- continue;
- }
- onError = pTab->aCol[i].notNull;
- if( onError==OE_None ) continue;
- if( overrideError!=OE_Default ){
- onError = overrideError;
- }else if( pParse->db->onError!=OE_Default ){
- onError = pParse->db->onError;
- }else if( onError==OE_Default ){
- onError = OE_Abort;
- }
- if( onError==OE_Replace && pTab->aCol[i].zDflt==0 ){
- onError = OE_Abort;
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nCol-1-i, 1);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, 1, 0);
- switch( onError ){
- case OE_Rollback:
- case OE_Abort:
- case OE_Fail: {
- char *zMsg = 0;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Halt, STQLITE_CONSTRAINT, onError);
- sqliteSetString(&zMsg, pTab->zName, ".", pTab->aCol[i].zName,
- " may not be NULL", (char*)0);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, -1, zMsg, P3_DYNAMIC);
- break;
- }
- case OE_Ignore: {
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, nCol+1+hasTwoRecnos, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, ignoreDest);
- break;
- }
- case OE_Replace: {
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, pTab->aCol[i].zDflt, P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Push, nCol-i, 0);
- break;
- }
- default: assert(0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v));
- }
-
- /* Test all CHECK constraints
- */
- /**** TBD ****/
-
- /* If we have an INTEGER PRIMARY KEY, make sure the primary key
- ** of the new record does not previously exist. Except, if this
- ** is an UPDATE and the primary key is not changing, that is OK.
- */
- if( recnoChng ){
- onError = pTab->keyConf;
- if( overrideError!=OE_Default ){
- onError = overrideError;
- }else if( pParse->db->onError!=OE_Default ){
- onError = pParse->db->onError;
- }else if( onError==OE_Default ){
- onError = OE_Abort;
- }
-
- if( isUpdate ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nCol+1, 1);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nCol+1, 1);
- jumpInst1 = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Eq, 0, 0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nCol, 1);
- jumpInst2 = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotExists, base, 0);
- switch( onError ){
- default: {
- onError = OE_Abort;
- /* Fall thru into the next case */
- }
- case OE_Rollback:
- case OE_Abort:
- case OE_Fail: {
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_Halt, STQLITE_CONSTRAINT, onError,
- "PRIMARY KEY must be unique", P3_STATIC);
- break;
- }
- case OE_Replace: {
- sqliteGenerateRowIndexDelete(pParse->db, v, pTab, base, 0);
- if( isUpdate ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nCol+hasTwoRecnos, 1);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, base, 0);
- }
- seenReplace = 1;
- break;
- }
- case OE_Ignore: {
- assert( seenReplace==0 );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, nCol+1+hasTwoRecnos, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, ignoreDest);
- break;
- }
- }
- contAddr = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, jumpInst2, contAddr);
- if( isUpdate ){
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, jumpInst1, contAddr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nCol+1, 1);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, base, 0);
- }
- }
-
- /* Test all UNITQUE constraints by creating entries for each UNITQUE
- ** index and making sure that duplicate entries do not already exist.
- ** Add the new records to the indices as we go.
- */
- extra = -1;
- for(iCur=0, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, iCur++){
- if( aIdxUsed && aIdxUsed[iCur]==0 ) continue; /* Skip unused indices */
- extra++;
-
- /* Create a key for accessing the index entry */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nCol+extra, 1);
- for(i=0; i<pIdx->nColumn; i++){
- int idx = pIdx->aiColumn[i];
- if( idx==pTab->iPKey ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, i+extra+nCol+1, 1);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, i+extra+nCol-idx, 1);
- }
- }
- jumpInst1 = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeIdxKey, pIdx->nColumn, 0);
- if( pParse->db->file_format>=4 ) sqliteAddIdxKeyType(v, pIdx);
-
- /* Find out what action to take in case there is an indexing conflict */
- onError = pIdx->onError;
- if( onError==OE_None ) continue; /* pIdx is not a UNITQUE index */
- if( overrideError!=OE_Default ){
- onError = overrideError;
- }else if( pParse->db->onError!=OE_Default ){
- onError = pParse->db->onError;
- }else if( onError==OE_Default ){
- onError = OE_Abort;
- }
- if( seenReplace ){
- if( onError==OE_Ignore ) onError = OE_Replace;
- else if( onError==OE_Fail ) onError = OE_Abort;
- }
-
-
- /* Check to see if the new index entry will be unique */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, extra+nCol+1+hasTwoRecnos, 1);
- jumpInst2 = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IsUnique, base+iCur+1, 0);
-
- /* Generate code that executes if the new index entry is not unique */
- switch( onError ){
- case OE_Rollback:
- case OE_Abort:
- case OE_Fail: {
- int j, n1, n2;
- char zErrMsg[200];
- strcpy(zErrMsg, pIdx->nColumn>1 ? "columns " : "column ");
- n1 = strlen(zErrMsg);
- for(j=0; j<pIdx->nColumn && n1<sizeof(zErrMsg)-30; j++){
- char *zCol = pTab->aCol[pIdx->aiColumn[j]].zName;
- n2 = strlen(zCol);
- if( j>0 ){
- strcpy(&zErrMsg[n1], ", ");
- n1 += 2;
- }
- if( n1+n2>sizeof(zErrMsg)-30 ){
- strcpy(&zErrMsg[n1], "...");
- n1 += 3;
- break;
- }else{
- strcpy(&zErrMsg[n1], zCol);
- n1 += n2;
- }
- }
- strcpy(&zErrMsg[n1],
- pIdx->nColumn>1 ? " are not unique" : " is not unique");
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_Halt, STQLITE_CONSTRAINT, onError, zErrMsg, 0);
- break;
- }
- case OE_Ignore: {
- assert( seenReplace==0 );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, nCol+extra+3+hasTwoRecnos, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, ignoreDest);
- break;
- }
- case OE_Replace: {
- sqliteGenerateRowDelete(pParse->db, v, pTab, base, 0);
- if( isUpdate ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nCol+extra+1+hasTwoRecnos, 1);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, base, 0);
- }
- seenReplace = 1;
- break;
- }
- default: assert(0);
- }
- contAddr = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
-#if NULL_DISTINCT_FOR_UNITQUE
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, jumpInst1, contAddr);
-#endif
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, jumpInst2, contAddr);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine generates code to finish the INSERT or UPDATE operation
-** that was started by a prior call to sqliteGenerateConstraintChecks.
-** The stack must contain keys for all active indices followed by data
-** and the recno for the new entry. This routine creates the new
-** entries in all indices and in the main table.
-**
-** The arguments to this routine should be the same as the first six
-** arguments to sqliteGenerateConstraintChecks.
-*/
-void sqliteCompleteInsertion(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- Table *pTab, /* the table into which we are inserting */
- int base, /* Index of a read/write cursor pointing at pTab */
- char *aIdxUsed, /* Which indices are used. NULL means all are used */
- int recnoChng, /* True if the record number will change */
- int isUpdate, /* True for UPDATE, False for INSERT */
- int newIdx /* Index of NEW table for triggers. -1 if none */
-){
- int i;
- Vdbe *v;
- int nIdx;
- Index *pIdx;
-
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- assert( v!=0 );
- assert( pTab->pSelect==0 ); /* This table is not a VIEW */
- for(nIdx=0, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, nIdx++){}
- for(i=nIdx-1; i>=0; i--){
- if( aIdxUsed && aIdxUsed[i]==0 ) continue;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IdxPut, base+i+1, 0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeRecord, pTab->nCol, 0);
- if( newIdx>=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, newIdx, 0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, base,
- (pParse->trigStack?0:OPFLAG_NCHANGE) |
- (isUpdate?0:OPFLAG_LASTROWID) | OPFLAG_CSCHANGE);
- if( isUpdate && recnoChng ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code that will open write cursors for a table and for all
-** indices of that table. The "base" parameter is the cursor number used
-** for the table. Indices are opened on subsequent cursors.
-**
-** Return the total number of cursors opened. This is always at least
-** 1 (for the main table) plus more for each cursor.
-*/
-int sqliteOpenTableAndIndices(Parse *pParse, Table *pTab, int base){
- int i;
- Index *pIdx;
- Vdbe *v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- assert( v!=0 );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pTab->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_OpenWrite, base, pTab->tnum, pTab->zName, P3_STATIC);
- for(i=1, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, i++){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pIdx->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_OpenWrite, i+base, pIdx->tnum, pIdx->zName, P3_STATIC);
- }
- return i;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/main.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/main.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 66b3e27..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/main.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1136 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** Main file for the STQLite library. The routines in this file
-** implement the programmer interface to the library. Routines in
-** other files are for internal use by STQLite and should not be
-** accessed by users of the library.
-**
-** $Id: main.c,v 1.162 2004/03/04 19:09:20 rdc Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include "os.h"
-#include <ctype.h>
-
-/*
-** A pointer to this structure is used to communicate information
-** from sqliteInit into the sqliteInitCallback.
-*/
-typedef struct {
- sqlite *db; /* The database being initialized */
- char **pzErrMsg; /* Error message stored here */
-} InitData;
-
-/*
-** Fill the InitData structure with an error message that indicates
-** that the database is corrupt.
-*/
-static void corruptSchema(InitData *pData, const char *zExtra){
- sqliteSetString(pData->pzErrMsg, "malformed database schema",
- zExtra!=0 && zExtra[0]!=0 ? " - " : (char*)0, zExtra, (char*)0);
-}
-
-/*
-** This is the callback routine for the code that initializes the
-** database. See sqliteInit() below for additional information.
-**
-** Each callback contains the following information:
-**
-** argv[0] = "file-format" or "schema-cookie" or "table" or "index"
-** argv[1] = table or index name or meta statement type.
-** argv[2] = root page number for table or index. NULL for meta.
-** argv[3] = SQL text for a CREATE TABLE or CREATE INDEX statement.
-** argv[4] = "1" for temporary files, "0" for main database, "2" or more
-** for auxiliary database files.
-**
-*/
-static
-int sqliteInitCallback(void *pInit, int argc, char **argv, char **azColName){
- InitData *pData = (InitData*)pInit;
- int nErr = 0;
-
- assert( argc==5 );
- if( argv==0 ) return 0; /* Might happen if EMPTY_RESULT_CALLBACKS are on */
- if( argv[0]==0 ){
- corruptSchema(pData, 0);
- return 1;
- }
- switch( argv[0][0] ){
- case 'v':
- case 'i':
- case 't': { /* CREATE TABLE, CREATE INDEX, or CREATE VIEW statements */
- sqlite *db = pData->db;
- if( argv[2]==0 || argv[4]==0 ){
- corruptSchema(pData, 0);
- return 1;
- }
- if( argv[3] && argv[3][0] ){
- /* Call the parser to process a CREATE TABLE, INDEX or VIEW.
- ** But because db->init.busy is set to 1, no VDBE code is generated
- ** or executed. All the parser does is build the internal data
- ** structures that describe the table, index, or view.
- */
- char *zErr;
- assert( db->init.busy );
- db->init.iDb = atoi(argv[4]);
- assert( db->init.iDb>=0 && db->init.iDb<db->nDb );
- db->init.newTnum = atoi(argv[2]);
- if( sqlite_exec(db, argv[3], 0, 0, &zErr) ){
- corruptSchema(pData, zErr);
- sqlite_freemem(zErr);
- }
- db->init.iDb = 0;
- }else{
- /* If the SQL column is blank it means this is an index that
- ** was created to be the PRIMARY KEY or to fulfill a UNITQUE
- ** constraint for a CREATE TABLE. The index should have already
- ** been created when we processed the CREATE TABLE. All we have
- ** to do here is record the root page number for that index.
- */
- int iDb;
- Index *pIndex;
-
- iDb = atoi(argv[4]);
- assert( iDb>=0 && iDb<db->nDb );
- pIndex = sqliteFindIndex(db, argv[1], db->aDb[iDb].zName);
- if( pIndex==0 || pIndex->tnum!=0 ){
- /* This can occur if there exists an index on a TEMP table which
- ** has the same name as another index on a permanent index. Since
- ** the permanent table is hidden by the TEMP table, we can also
- ** safely ignore the index on the permanent table.
- */
- /* Do Nothing */;
- }else{
- pIndex->tnum = atoi(argv[2]);
- }
- }
- break;
- }
- default: {
- /* This can not happen! */
- nErr = 1;
- assert( nErr==0 );
- }
- }
- return nErr;
-}
-
-/*
-** This is a callback procedure used to reconstruct a table. The
-** name of the table to be reconstructed is passed in as argv[0].
-**
-** This routine is used to automatically upgrade a database from
-** format version 1 or 2 to version 3. The correct operation of
-** this routine relys on the fact that no indices are used when
-** copying a table out to a temporary file.
-**
-** The change from version 2 to version 3 occurred between STQLite
-** version 2.5.6 and 2.6.0 on 2002-July-18.
-*/
-static
-int upgrade_3_callback(void *pInit, int argc, char **argv, char **NotUsed){
- InitData *pData = (InitData*)pInit;
- int rc;
- Table *pTab;
- Trigger *pTrig;
- char *zErr = 0;
-
- pTab = sqliteFindTable(pData->db, argv[0], 0);
- assert( pTab!=0 );
- assert( sqliteStrICmp(pTab->zName, argv[0])==0 );
- if( pTab ){
- pTrig = pTab->pTrigger;
- pTab->pTrigger = 0; /* Disable all triggers before rebuilding the table */
- }
- rc = sqlite_exec_printf(pData->db,
- "CREATE TEMP TABLE sqlite_x AS SELECT * FROM '%q'; "
- "DELETE FROM '%q'; "
- "INSERT INTO '%q' SELECT * FROM sqlite_x; "
- "DROP TABLE sqlite_x;",
- 0, 0, &zErr, argv[0], argv[0], argv[0]);
- if( zErr ){
- if( *pData->pzErrMsg ) sqlite_freemem(*pData->pzErrMsg);
- *pData->pzErrMsg = zErr;
- }
-
- /* If an error occurred in the SQL above, then the transaction will
- ** rollback which will delete the internal symbol tables. This will
- ** cause the structure that pTab points to be deleted. In case that
- ** happened, we need to refetch pTab.
- */
- pTab = sqliteFindTable(pData->db, argv[0], 0);
- if( pTab ){
- assert( sqliteStrICmp(pTab->zName, argv[0])==0 );
- pTab->pTrigger = pTrig; /* Re-enable triggers */
- }
- return rc!=STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-
-
-/*
-** Attempt to read the database schema and initialize internal
-** data structures for a single database file. The index of the
-** database file is given by iDb. iDb==0 is used for the main
-** database. iDb==1 should never be used. iDb>=2 is used for
-** auxiliary databases. Return one of the STQLITE_ error codes to
-** indicate success or failure.
-*/
-static int sqliteInitOne(sqlite *db, int iDb, char **pzErrMsg){
- int rc;
- BtCursor *curMain;
- int size;
- Table *pTab;
- char *azArg[6];
- char zDbNum[30];
- int meta[STQLITE_N_BTREE_META];
- InitData initData;
-
- /*
- ** The master database table has a structure like this
- */
- static char master_schema[] =
- "CREATE TABLE sqlite_master(\n"
- " type text,\n"
- " name text,\n"
- " tbl_name text,\n"
- " rootpage integer,\n"
- " sql text\n"
- ")"
- ;
- static char temp_master_schema[] =
- "CREATE TEMP TABLE sqlite_temp_master(\n"
- " type text,\n"
- " name text,\n"
- " tbl_name text,\n"
- " rootpage integer,\n"
- " sql text\n"
- ")"
- ;
-
- /* The following SQL will read the schema from the master tables.
- ** The first version works with STQLite file formats 2 or greater.
- ** The second version is for format 1 files.
- **
- ** Beginning with file format 2, the rowid for new table entries
- ** (including entries in sqlite_master) is an increasing integer.
- ** So for file format 2 and later, we can play back sqlite_master
- ** and all the CREATE statements will appear in the right order.
- ** But with file format 1, table entries were random and so we
- ** have to make sure the CREATE TABLEs occur before their corresponding
- ** CREATE INDEXs. (We don't have to deal with CREATE VIEW or
- ** CREATE TRIGGER in file format 1 because those constructs did
- ** not exist then.)
- */
- static char init_script[] =
- "SELECT type, name, rootpage, sql, 1 FROM sqlite_temp_master "
- "UNION ALL "
- "SELECT type, name, rootpage, sql, 0 FROM sqlite_master";
- static char older_init_script[] =
- "SELECT type, name, rootpage, sql, 1 FROM sqlite_temp_master "
- "UNION ALL "
- "SELECT type, name, rootpage, sql, 0 FROM sqlite_master "
- "WHERE type='table' "
- "UNION ALL "
- "SELECT type, name, rootpage, sql, 0 FROM sqlite_master "
- "WHERE type='index'";
-
-
- assert( iDb>=0 && iDb!=1 && iDb<db->nDb );
-
- /* Construct the schema tables: sqlite_master and sqlite_temp_master
- */
- sqliteSafetyOff(db);
- azArg[0] = "table";
- azArg[1] = MASTER_NAME;
- azArg[2] = "2";
- azArg[3] = master_schema;
- sprintf(zDbNum, "%d", iDb);
- azArg[4] = zDbNum;
- azArg[5] = 0;
- initData.db = db;
- initData.pzErrMsg = pzErrMsg;
- sqliteInitCallback(&initData, 5, azArg, 0);
- pTab = sqliteFindTable(db, MASTER_NAME, "main");
- if( pTab ){
- pTab->readOnly = 1;
- }
- if( iDb==0 ){
- azArg[1] = TEMP_MASTER_NAME;
- azArg[3] = temp_master_schema;
- azArg[4] = "1";
- sqliteInitCallback(&initData, 5, azArg, 0);
- pTab = sqliteFindTable(db, TEMP_MASTER_NAME, "temp");
- if( pTab ){
- pTab->readOnly = 1;
- }
- }
- sqliteSafetyOn(db);
-
- /* Create a cursor to hold the database open
- */
- if( db->aDb[iDb].pBt==0 ) return STQLITE_OK;
- rc = sqliteBtreeCursor(db->aDb[iDb].pBt, 2, 0, &curMain);
- if( rc ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(rc), (char*)0);
- return rc;
- }
-
- /* Get the database meta information
- */
- rc = sqliteBtreeGetMeta(db->aDb[iDb].pBt, meta);
- if( rc ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(rc), (char*)0);
- sqliteBtreeCloseCursor(curMain);
- return rc;
- }
- db->aDb[iDb].schema_cookie = meta[1];
- if( iDb==0 ){
- db->next_cookie = meta[1];
- db->file_format = meta[2];
- size = meta[3];
- if( size==0 ){ size = MAX_PAGES; }
- db->cache_size = size;
- db->safety_level = meta[4];
- if( db->safety_level==0 ) db->safety_level = 2;
-
- /*
- ** file_format==1 Version 2.1.0.
- ** file_format==2 Version 2.2.0. Add support for INTEGER PRIMARY KEY.
- ** file_format==3 Version 2.6.0. Fix empty-string index bug.
- ** file_format==4 Version 2.7.0. Add support for separate numeric and
- ** text datatypes.
- */
- if( db->file_format==0 ){
- /* This happens if the database was initially empty */
- db->file_format = 4;
- }else if( db->file_format>4 ){
- sqliteBtreeCloseCursor(curMain);
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "unsupported file format", (char*)0);
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- }else if( db->file_format!=meta[2] || db->file_format<4 ){
- assert( db->file_format>=4 );
- if( meta[2]==0 ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "cannot attach empty database: ",
- db->aDb[iDb].zName, (char*)0);
- }else{
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "incompatible file format in auxiliary "
- "database: ", db->aDb[iDb].zName, (char*)0);
- }
- sqliteBtreeClose(db->aDb[iDb].pBt);
- db->aDb[iDb].pBt = 0;
- return STQLITE_FORMAT;
- }
- sqliteBtreeSetCacheSize(db->aDb[iDb].pBt, db->cache_size);
- sqliteBtreeSetSafetyLevel(db->aDb[iDb].pBt, meta[4]==0 ? 2 : meta[4]);
-
- /* Read the schema information out of the schema tables
- */
- assert( db->init.busy );
- sqliteSafetyOff(db);
- if( iDb==0 ){
- rc = sqlite_exec(db,
- db->file_format>=2 ? init_script : older_init_script,
- sqliteInitCallback, &initData, 0);
- }else{
- char *zSql = 0;
- sqliteSetString(&zSql,
- "SELECT type, name, rootpage, sql, ", zDbNum, " FROM \"",
- db->aDb[iDb].zName, "\".sqlite_master", (char*)0);
- rc = sqlite_exec(db, zSql, sqliteInitCallback, &initData, 0);
- sqliteFree(zSql);
- }
- sqliteSafetyOn(db);
- sqliteBtreeCloseCursor(curMain);
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "out of memory", (char*)0);
- rc = STQLITE_NOMEM;
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, 0);
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- DbSetProperty(db, iDb, DB_SchemaLoaded);
- if( iDb==0 ){
- DbSetProperty(db, 1, DB_SchemaLoaded);
- }
- }else{
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, iDb);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Initialize all database files - the main database file, the file
-** used to store temporary tables, and any additional database files
-** created using ATTACH statements. Return a success code. If an
-** error occurs, write an error message into *pzErrMsg.
-**
-** After the database is initialized, the STQLITE_Initialized
-** bit is set in the flags field of the sqlite structure. An
-** attempt is made to initialize the database as soon as it
-** is opened. If that fails (perhaps because another process
-** has the sqlite_master table locked) than another attempt
-** is made the first time the database is accessed.
-*/
-int sqliteInit(sqlite *db, char **pzErrMsg){
- int i, rc;
-
- if( db->init.busy ) return STQLITE_OK;
- assert( (db->flags & STQLITE_Initialized)==0 );
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- db->init.busy = 1;
- for(i=0; rc==STQLITE_OK && i<db->nDb; i++){
- if( DbHasProperty(db, i, DB_SchemaLoaded) ) continue;
- assert( i!=1 ); /* Should have been initialized together with 0 */
- rc = sqliteInitOne(db, i, pzErrMsg);
- if( rc ){
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, i);
- }
- }
- db->init.busy = 0;
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- db->flags |= STQLITE_Initialized;
- sqliteCommitInternalChanges(db);
- }
-
- /* If the database is in formats 1 or 2, then upgrade it to
- ** version 3. This will reconstruct all indices. If the
- ** upgrade fails for any reason (ex: out of disk space, database
- ** is read only, interrupt received, etc.) then fail the init.
- */
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK && db->file_format<3 ){
- char *zErr = 0;
- InitData initData;
- int meta[STQLITE_N_BTREE_META];
-
- db->magic = STQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN;
- initData.db = db;
- initData.pzErrMsg = &zErr;
- db->file_format = 3;
- rc = sqlite_exec(db,
- "BEGIN; SELECT name FROM sqlite_master WHERE type='table';",
- upgrade_3_callback,
- &initData,
- &zErr);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteBtreeGetMeta(db->aDb[0].pBt, meta);
- meta[2] = 4;
- sqliteBtreeUpdateMeta(db->aDb[0].pBt, meta);
- sqlite_exec(db, "COMMIT", 0, 0, 0);
- }
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg,
- "unable to upgrade database to the version 2.6 format",
- zErr ? ": " : 0, zErr, (char*)0);
- }
- sqlite_freemem(zErr);
- }
-
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_Initialized;
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** The version of the library
-*/
-const char rcsid[] = "@(#) \044Id: STQLite version " STQLITE_VERSION " $";
-const char sqlite_version[] = STQLITE_VERSION;
-
-/*
-** Does the library expect data to be encoded as UTF-8 or iso8859? The
-** following global constant always lets us know.
-*/
-#ifdef STQLITE_UTF8
-const char sqlite_encoding[] = "UTF-8";
-#else
-const char sqlite_encoding[] = "iso8859";
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Open a new STQLite database. Construct an "sqlite" structure to define
-** the state of this database and return a pointer to that structure.
-**
-** An attempt is made to initialize the in-memory data structures that
-** hold the database schema. But if this fails (because the schema file
-** is locked) then that step is deferred until the first call to
-** sqlite_exec().
-*/
-sqlite *sqlite_open(const char *zFilename, int mode, char **pzErrMsg){
- sqlite *db;
- int rc, i;
-
- /* Allocate the sqlite data structure */
- db = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(sqlite) );
- if( pzErrMsg ) *pzErrMsg = 0;
- if( db==0 ) goto no_mem_on_open;
- db->onError = OE_Default;
- db->priorNewRowid = 0;
- db->magic = STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY;
- db->nDb = 2;
- db->aDb = db->aDbStatic;
- /* db->flags |= STQLITE_ShortColNames; */
- sqliteHashInit(&db->aFunc, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 1);
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- sqliteHashInit(&db->aDb[i].tblHash, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 0);
- sqliteHashInit(&db->aDb[i].idxHash, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 0);
- sqliteHashInit(&db->aDb[i].trigHash, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 0);
- sqliteHashInit(&db->aDb[i].aFKey, STQLITE_HASH_STRING, 1);
- }
-
- /* Open the backend database driver */
- if( zFilename[0]==':' && strcmp(zFilename,":memory:")==0 ){
- db->temp_store = 2;
- }
- rc = sqliteBtreeFactory(db, zFilename, 0, MAX_PAGES, &db->aDb[0].pBt);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- switch( rc ){
- default: {
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "unable to open database: ",
- zFilename, (char*)0);
- }
- }
- sqliteFree(db);
- sqliteStrRealloc(pzErrMsg);
- return 0;
- }
- db->aDb[0].zName = "main";
- db->aDb[1].zName = "temp";
-
- /* Attempt to read the schema */
- sqliteRegisterBuiltinFunctions(db);
- rc = sqliteInit(db, pzErrMsg);
- db->magic = STQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN;
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ){
- sqlite_close(db);
- goto no_mem_on_open;
- }else if( rc!=STQLITE_OK && rc!=STQLITE_BUSY ){
- sqlite_close(db);
- sqliteStrRealloc(pzErrMsg);
- return 0;
- }else if( pzErrMsg ){
- sqliteFree(*pzErrMsg);
- *pzErrMsg = 0;
- }
-
- /* Return a pointer to the newly opened database structure */
- return db;
-
-no_mem_on_open:
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "out of memory", (char*)0);
- sqliteStrRealloc(pzErrMsg);
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the ROWID of the most recent insert
-*/
-int sqlite_last_insert_rowid(sqlite *db){
- return db->lastRowid;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the number of changes in the most recent call to sqlite_exec().
-*/
-int sqlite_changes(sqlite *db){
- return db->nChange;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the number of changes produced by the last INSERT, UPDATE, or
-** DELETE statement to complete execution. The count does not include
-** changes due to SQL statements executed in trigger programs that were
-** triggered by that statement
-*/
-int sqlite_last_statement_changes(sqlite *db){
- return db->lsChange;
-}
-
-/*
-** Close an existing STQLite database
-*/
-void sqlite_close(sqlite *db){
- HashElem *i;
- int j;
- db->want_to_close = 1;
- if( sqliteSafetyCheck(db) || sqliteSafetyOn(db) ){
- /* printf("DID NOT CLOSE\n"); fflush(stdout); */
- return;
- }
- db->magic = STQLITE_MAGIC_CLOSED;
- for(j=0; j<db->nDb; j++){
- struct Db *pDb = &db->aDb[j];
- if( pDb->pBt ){
- sqliteBtreeClose(pDb->pBt);
- pDb->pBt = 0;
- }
- }
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, 0);
- assert( db->nDb<=2 );
- assert( db->aDb==db->aDbStatic );
- for(i=sqliteHashFirst(&db->aFunc); i; i=sqliteHashNext(i)){
- FuncDef *pFunc, *pNext;
- for(pFunc = (FuncDef*)sqliteHashData(i); pFunc; pFunc=pNext){
- pNext = pFunc->pNext;
- sqliteFree(pFunc);
- }
- }
- sqliteHashClear(&db->aFunc);
- sqliteFree(db);
-}
-
-/*
-** Rollback all database files.
-*/
-void sqliteRollbackAll(sqlite *db){
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- if( db->aDb[i].pBt ){
- sqliteBtreeRollback(db->aDb[i].pBt);
- db->aDb[i].inTrans = 0;
- }
- }
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, 0);
- /* sqliteRollbackInternalChanges(db); */
-}
-
-/*
-** Execute SQL code. Return one of the STQLITE_ success/failure
-** codes. Also write an error message into memory obtained from
-** malloc() and make *pzErrMsg point to that message.
-**
-** If the SQL is a query, then for each row in the query result
-** the xCallback() function is called. pArg becomes the first
-** argument to xCallback(). If xCallback=NULL then no callback
-** is invoked, even for queries.
-*/
-int sqlite_exec(
- sqlite *db, /* The database on which the SQL executes */
- const char *zSql, /* The SQL to be executed */
- sqlite_callback xCallback, /* Invoke this callback routine */
- void *pArg, /* First argument to xCallback() */
- char **pzErrMsg /* Write error messages here */
-){
- int rc = STQLITE_OK;
- const char *zLeftover;
- sqlite_vm *pVm;
- int nRetry = 0;
- int nChange = 0;
- int nCallback;
-
- if( zSql==0 ) return STQLITE_OK;
- while( rc==STQLITE_OK && zSql[0] ){
- pVm = 0;
- rc = sqlite_compile(db, zSql, &zLeftover, &pVm, pzErrMsg);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- assert( pVm==0 || sqlite_malloc_failed );
- return rc;
- }
- if( pVm==0 ){
- /* This happens if the zSql input contained only whitespace */
- break;
- }
- db->nChange += nChange;
- nCallback = 0;
- while(1){
- int nArg;
- char **azArg, **azCol;
- rc = sqlite_step(pVm, &nArg, (const char***)&azArg,(const char***)&azCol);
- if( rc==STQLITE_ROW ){
- if( xCallback!=0 && xCallback(pArg, nArg, azArg, azCol) ){
- sqlite_finalize(pVm, 0);
- return STQLITE_ABORT;
- }
- nCallback++;
- }else{
- if( rc==STQLITE_DONE && nCallback==0
- && (db->flags & STQLITE_NullCallback)!=0 && xCallback!=0 ){
- xCallback(pArg, nArg, azArg, azCol);
- }
- rc = sqlite_finalize(pVm, pzErrMsg);
- if( rc==STQLITE_SCHEMA && nRetry<2 ){
- nRetry++;
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- break;
- }
- if( db->pVdbe==0 ){
- nChange = db->nChange;
- }
- nRetry = 0;
- zSql = zLeftover;
- while( isspace(zSql[0]) ) zSql++;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-
-/*
-** Compile a single statement of SQL into a virtual machine. Return one
-** of the STQLITE_ success/failure codes. Also write an error message into
-** memory obtained from malloc() and make *pzErrMsg point to that message.
-*/
-int sqlite_compile(
- sqlite *db, /* The database on which the SQL executes */
- const char *zSql, /* The SQL to be executed */
- const char **pzTail, /* OUT: Next statement after the first */
- sqlite_vm **ppVm, /* OUT: The virtual machine */
- char **pzErrMsg /* OUT: Write error messages here */
-){
- Parse sParse;
-
- if( pzErrMsg ) *pzErrMsg = 0;
- if( sqliteSafetyOn(db) ) goto exec_misuse;
- if( !db->init.busy ){
- if( (db->flags & STQLITE_Initialized)==0 ){
- int rc, cnt = 1;
- while( (rc = sqliteInit(db, pzErrMsg))==STQLITE_BUSY
- && db->xBusyCallback
- && db->xBusyCallback(db->pBusyArg, "", cnt++)!=0 ){}
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteStrRealloc(pzErrMsg);
- sqliteSafetyOff(db);
- return rc;
- }
- if( pzErrMsg ){
- sqliteFree(*pzErrMsg);
- *pzErrMsg = 0;
- }
- }
- if( db->file_format<3 ){
- sqliteSafetyOff(db);
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "obsolete database file format", (char*)0);
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- }
- assert( (db->flags & STQLITE_Initialized)!=0 || db->init.busy );
- if( db->pVdbe==0 ){ db->nChange = 0; }
- memset(&sParse, 0, sizeof(sParse));
- sParse.db = db;
- sqliteRunParser(&sParse, zSql, pzErrMsg);
- if( db->xTrace ){
- /* Trace only the statment that was compiled.
- ** Make a copy of that part of the SQL string since zSQL is const
- ** and we must pass a zero terminated string to the trace function
- ** The copy is unnecessary if the tail pointer is pointing at the
- ** beginnig or end of the SQL string.
- */
- if( sParse.zTail && sParse.zTail!=zSql && *sParse.zTail ){
- char *tmpSql = sqliteStrNDup(zSql, sParse.zTail - zSql);
- if( tmpSql ){
- db->xTrace(db->pTraceArg, tmpSql);
- free(tmpSql);
- }else{
- /* If a memory error occurred during the copy,
- ** trace entire SQL string and fall through to the
- ** sqlite_malloc_failed test to report the error.
- */
- db->xTrace(db->pTraceArg, zSql);
- }
- }else{
- db->xTrace(db->pTraceArg, zSql);
- }
- }
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "out of memory", (char*)0);
- sParse.rc = STQLITE_NOMEM;
- sqliteRollbackAll(db);
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, 0);
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_InTrans;
- }
- if( sParse.rc==STQLITE_DONE ) sParse.rc = STQLITE_OK;
- if( sParse.rc!=STQLITE_OK && pzErrMsg && *pzErrMsg==0 ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(sParse.rc), (char*)0);
- }
- sqliteStrRealloc(pzErrMsg);
- if( sParse.rc==STQLITE_SCHEMA ){
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, 0);
- }
- assert( ppVm );
- *ppVm = (sqlite_vm*)sParse.pVdbe;
- if( pzTail ) *pzTail = sParse.zTail;
- if( sqliteSafetyOff(db) ) goto exec_misuse;
- return sParse.rc;
-
-exec_misuse:
- if( pzErrMsg ){
- *pzErrMsg = 0;
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(STQLITE_MISUSE), (char*)0);
- sqliteStrRealloc(pzErrMsg);
- }
- return STQLITE_MISUSE;
-}
-
-
-/*
-** The following routine destroys a virtual machine that is created by
-** the sqlite_compile() routine.
-**
-** The integer returned is an STQLITE_ success/failure code that describes
-** the result of executing the virtual machine. An error message is
-** written into memory obtained from malloc and *pzErrMsg is made to
-** point to that error if pzErrMsg is not NULL. The calling routine
-** should use sqlite_freemem() to delete the message when it has finished
-** with it.
-*/
-int sqlite_finalize(
- sqlite_vm *pVm, /* The virtual machine to be destroyed */
- char **pzErrMsg /* OUT: Write error messages here */
-){
- int rc = sqliteVdbeFinalize((Vdbe*)pVm, pzErrMsg);
- sqliteStrRealloc(pzErrMsg);
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Terminate the current execution of a virtual machine then
-** reset the virtual machine back to its starting state so that it
-** can be reused. Any error message resulting from the prior execution
-** is written into *pzErrMsg. A success code from the prior execution
-** is returned.
-*/
-int sqlite_reset(
- sqlite_vm *pVm, /* The virtual machine to be destroyed */
- char **pzErrMsg /* OUT: Write error messages here */
-){
- int rc = sqliteVdbeReset((Vdbe*)pVm, pzErrMsg);
- sqliteVdbeMakeReady((Vdbe*)pVm, -1, 0);
- sqliteStrRealloc(pzErrMsg);
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return a static string that describes the kind of error specified in the
-** argument.
-*/
-const char *sqlite_error_string(int rc){
- const char *z;
- switch( rc ){
- case STQLITE_OK: z = "not an error"; break;
- case STQLITE_ERROR: z = "SQL logic error or missing database"; break;
- case STQLITE_INTERNAL: z = "internal STQLite implementation flaw"; break;
- case STQLITE_PERM: z = "access permission denied"; break;
- case STQLITE_ABORT: z = "callback requested query abort"; break;
- case STQLITE_BUSY: z = "database is locked"; break;
- case STQLITE_LOCKED: z = "database table is locked"; break;
- case STQLITE_NOMEM: z = "out of memory"; break;
- case STQLITE_READONLY: z = "attempt to write a readonly database"; break;
- case STQLITE_INTERRUPT: z = "interrupted"; break;
- case STQLITE_IOERR: z = "disk I/O error"; break;
- case STQLITE_CORRUPT: z = "database disk image is malformed"; break;
- case STQLITE_NOTFOUND: z = "table or record not found"; break;
- case STQLITE_FULL: z = "database is full"; break;
- case STQLITE_CANTOPEN: z = "unable to open database file"; break;
- case STQLITE_PROTOCOL: z = "database locking protocol failure"; break;
- case STQLITE_EMPTY: z = "table contains no data"; break;
- case STQLITE_SCHEMA: z = "database schema has changed"; break;
- case STQLITE_TOOBIG: z = "too much data for one table row"; break;
- case STQLITE_CONSTRAINT: z = "constraint failed"; break;
- case STQLITE_MISMATCH: z = "datatype mismatch"; break;
- case STQLITE_MISUSE: z = "library routine called out of sequence";break;
- case STQLITE_NOLFS: z = "kernel lacks large file support"; break;
- case STQLITE_AUTH: z = "authorization denied"; break;
- case STQLITE_FORMAT: z = "auxiliary database format error"; break;
- case STQLITE_RANGE: z = "bind index out of range"; break;
- case STQLITE_NOTADB: z = "file is encrypted or is not a database";break;
- default: z = "unknown error"; break;
- }
- return z;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine implements a busy callback that sleeps and tries
-** again until a timeout value is reached. The timeout value is
-** an integer number of milliseconds passed in as the first
-** argument.
-*/
-static int sqliteDefaultBusyCallback(
- void *Timeout, /* Maximum amount of time to wait */
- const char *NotUsed, /* The name of the table that is busy */
- int count /* Number of times table has been busy */
-){
-#if STQLITE_MIN_SLEEP_MS==1
- static const char delays[] =
- { 1, 2, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 25, 25, 50, 50, 50, 100};
- static const short int totals[] =
- { 0, 1, 3, 8, 18, 33, 53, 78, 103, 128, 178, 228, 287};
-# define NDELAY (sizeof(delays)/sizeof(delays[0]))
- int timeout = (int)Timeout;
- int delay, prior;
-
- if( count <= NDELAY ){
- delay = delays[count-1];
- prior = totals[count-1];
- }else{
- delay = delays[NDELAY-1];
- prior = totals[NDELAY-1] + delay*(count-NDELAY-1);
- }
- if( prior + delay > timeout ){
- delay = timeout - prior;
- if( delay<=0 ) return 0;
- }
- sqliteOsSleep(delay);
- return 1;
-#else
- int timeout = (int)Timeout;
- if( (count+1)*1000 > timeout ){
- return 0;
- }
- sqliteOsSleep(1000);
- return 1;
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine sets the busy callback for an Sqlite database to the
-** given callback function with the given argument.
-*/
-void sqlite_busy_handler(
- sqlite *db,
- int (*xBusy)(void*,const char*,int),
- void *pArg
-){
- db->xBusyCallback = xBusy;
- db->pBusyArg = pArg;
-}
-
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_PROGRESS_CALLBACK
-/*
-** This routine sets the progress callback for an Sqlite database to the
-** given callback function with the given argument. The progress callback will
-** be invoked every nOps opcodes.
-*/
-void sqlite_progress_handler(
- sqlite *db,
- int nOps,
- int (*xProgress)(void*),
- void *pArg
-){
- if( nOps>0 ){
- db->xProgress = xProgress;
- db->nProgressOps = nOps;
- db->pProgressArg = pArg;
- }else{
- db->xProgress = 0;
- db->nProgressOps = 0;
- db->pProgressArg = 0;
- }
-}
-#endif
-
-
-/*
-** This routine installs a default busy handler that waits for the
-** specified number of milliseconds before returning 0.
-*/
-void sqlite_busy_timeout(sqlite *db, int ms){
- if( ms>0 ){
- sqlite_busy_handler(db, sqliteDefaultBusyCallback, (void*)ms);
- }else{
- sqlite_busy_handler(db, 0, 0);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Cause any pending operation to stop at its earliest opportunity.
-*/
-void sqlite_interrupt(sqlite *db){
- db->flags |= STQLITE_Interrupt;
-}
-
-/*
-** Windows systems should call this routine to free memory that
-** is returned in the in the errmsg parameter of sqlite_open() when
-** STQLite is a DLL. For some reason, it does not work to call free()
-** directly.
-**
-** Note that we need to call free() not sqliteFree() here, since every
-** string that is exported from STQLite should have already passed through
-** sqliteStrRealloc().
-*/
-void sqlite_freemem(void *p){ free(p); }
-
-/*
-** Windows systems need functions to call to return the sqlite_version
-** and sqlite_encoding strings since they are unable to access constants
-** within DLLs.
-*/
-const char *sqlite_libversion(void){ return sqlite_version; }
-const char *sqlite_libencoding(void){ return sqlite_encoding; }
-
-/*
-** Create new user-defined functions. The sqlite_create_function()
-** routine creates a regular function and sqlite_create_aggregate()
-** creates an aggregate function.
-**
-** Passing a NULL xFunc argument or NULL xStep and xFinalize arguments
-** disables the function. Calling sqlite_create_function() with the
-** same name and number of arguments as a prior call to
-** sqlite_create_aggregate() disables the prior call to
-** sqlite_create_aggregate(), and vice versa.
-**
-** If nArg is -1 it means that this function will accept any number
-** of arguments, including 0. The maximum allowed value of nArg is 127.
-*/
-int sqlite_create_function(
- sqlite *db, /* Add the function to this database connection */
- const char *zName, /* Name of the function to add */
- int nArg, /* Number of arguments */
- void (*xFunc)(sqlite_func*,int,const char**), /* The implementation */
- void *pUserData /* User data */
-){
- FuncDef *p;
- int nName;
- if( db==0 || zName==0 || sqliteSafetyCheck(db) ) return 1;
- if( nArg<-1 || nArg>127 ) return 1;
- nName = strlen(zName);
- if( nName>255 ) return 1;
- p = sqliteFindFunction(db, zName, nName, nArg, 1);
- if( p==0 ) return 1;
- p->xFunc = xFunc;
- p->xStep = 0;
- p->xFinalize = 0;
- p->pUserData = pUserData;
- return 0;
-}
-int sqlite_create_aggregate(
- sqlite *db, /* Add the function to this database connection */
- const char *zName, /* Name of the function to add */
- int nArg, /* Number of arguments */
- void (*xStep)(sqlite_func*,int,const char**), /* The step function */
- void (*xFinalize)(sqlite_func*), /* The finalizer */
- void *pUserData /* User data */
-){
- FuncDef *p;
- int nName;
- if( db==0 || zName==0 || sqliteSafetyCheck(db) ) return 1;
- if( nArg<-1 || nArg>127 ) return 1;
- nName = strlen(zName);
- if( nName>255 ) return 1;
- p = sqliteFindFunction(db, zName, nName, nArg, 1);
- if( p==0 ) return 1;
- p->xFunc = 0;
- p->xStep = xStep;
- p->xFinalize = xFinalize;
- p->pUserData = pUserData;
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the datatype for all functions with a given name. See the
-** header comment for the prototype of this function in sqlite.h for
-** additional information.
-*/
-int sqlite_function_type(sqlite *db, const char *zName, int dataType){
- FuncDef *p = (FuncDef*)sqliteHashFind(&db->aFunc, zName, strlen(zName));
- while( p ){
- p->dataType = dataType;
- p = p->pNext;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Register a trace function. The pArg from the previously registered trace
-** is returned.
-**
-** A NULL trace function means that no tracing is executes. A non-NULL
-** trace is a pointer to a function that is invoked at the start of each
-** sqlite_exec().
-*/
-void *sqlite_trace(sqlite *db, void (*xTrace)(void*,const char*), void *pArg){
- void *pOld = db->pTraceArg;
- db->xTrace = xTrace;
- db->pTraceArg = pArg;
- return pOld;
-}
-
-/*** EXPERIMENTAL ***
-**
-** Register a function to be invoked when a transaction comments.
-** If either function returns non-zero, then the commit becomes a
-** rollback.
-*/
-void *sqlite_commit_hook(
- sqlite *db, /* Attach the hook to this database */
- int (*xCallback)(void*), /* Function to invoke on each commit */
- void *pArg /* Argument to the function */
-){
- void *pOld = db->pCommitArg;
- db->xCommitCallback = xCallback;
- db->pCommitArg = pArg;
- return pOld;
-}
-
-
-/*
-** This routine is called to create a connection to a database BTree
-** driver. If zFilename is the name of a file, then that file is
-** opened and used. If zFilename is the magic name ":memory:" then
-** the database is stored in memory (and is thus forgotten as soon as
-** the connection is closed.) If zFilename is NULL then the database
-** is for temporary use only and is deleted as soon as the connection
-** is closed.
-**
-** A temporary database can be either a disk file (that is automatically
-** deleted when the file is closed) or a set of red-black trees held in memory,
-** depending on the values of the TEMP_STORE compile-time macro and the
-** db->temp_store variable, according to the following chart:
-**
-** TEMP_STORE db->temp_store Location of temporary database
-** ---------- -------------- ------------------------------
-** 0 any file
-** 1 1 file
-** 1 2 memory
-** 1 0 file
-** 2 1 file
-** 2 2 memory
-** 2 0 memory
-** 3 any memory
-*/
-int sqliteBtreeFactory(
- const sqlite *db, /* Main database when opening aux otherwise 0 */
- const char *zFilename, /* Name of the file containing the BTree database */
- int omitJournal, /* if TRUE then do not journal this file */
- int nCache, /* How many pages in the page cache */
- Btree **ppBtree){ /* Pointer to new Btree object written here */
-
- assert( ppBtree != 0);
-
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_INMEMORYDB
- if( zFilename==0 ){
- if (TEMP_STORE == 0) {
- /* Always use file based temporary DB */
- return sqliteBtreeOpen(0, omitJournal, nCache, ppBtree);
- } else if (TEMP_STORE == 1 || TEMP_STORE == 2) {
- /* Switch depending on compile-time and/or runtime settings. */
- int location = db->temp_store==0 ? TEMP_STORE : db->temp_store;
-
- if (location == 1) {
- return sqliteBtreeOpen(zFilename, omitJournal, nCache, ppBtree);
- } else {
- return sqliteRbtreeOpen(0, 0, 0, ppBtree);
- }
- } else {
- /* Always use in-core DB */
- return sqliteRbtreeOpen(0, 0, 0, ppBtree);
- }
- }else if( zFilename[0]==':' && strcmp(zFilename,":memory:")==0 ){
- return sqliteRbtreeOpen(0, 0, 0, ppBtree);
- }else
-#endif
- {
- return sqliteBtreeOpen(zFilename, omitJournal, nCache, ppBtree);
- }
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/opcodes.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/opcodes.c
deleted file mode 100644
index df5b3c8..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/opcodes.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,138 +0,0 @@
-/* Automatically generated file. Do not edit */
-char *sqliteOpcodeNames[] = { "???",
- "Goto",
- "Gosub",
- "Return",
- "Halt",
- "Integer",
- "String",
- "Variable",
- "Pop",
- "Dup",
- "Pull",
- "Push",
- "ColumnName",
- "Callback",
- "Concat",
- "Add",
- "Subtract",
- "Multiply",
- "Divide",
- "Remainder",
- "Function",
- "BitAnd",
- "BitOr",
- "ShiftLeft",
- "ShiftRight",
- "AddImm",
- "ForceInt",
- "MustBeInt",
- "Eq",
- "Ne",
- "Lt",
- "Le",
- "Gt",
- "Ge",
- "StrEq",
- "StrNe",
- "StrLt",
- "StrLe",
- "StrGt",
- "StrGe",
- "And",
- "Or",
- "Negative",
- "AbsValue",
- "Not",
- "BitNot",
- "Noop",
- "If",
- "IfNot",
- "IsNull",
- "NotNull",
- "MakeRecord",
- "MakeIdxKey",
- "MakeKey",
- "IncrKey",
- "Checkpoint",
- "Transaction",
- "Commit",
- "Rollback",
- "ReadCookie",
- "SetCookie",
- "VerifyCookie",
- "OpenRead",
- "OpenWrite",
- "OpenTemp",
- "OpenPseudo",
- "Close",
- "MoveLt",
- "MoveTo",
- "Distinct",
- "NotFound",
- "Found",
- "IsUnique",
- "NotExists",
- "NewRecno",
- "PutIntKey",
- "PutStrKey",
- "Delete",
- "SetCounts",
- "KeyAsData",
- "RowKey",
- "RowData",
- "Column",
- "Recno",
- "FullKey",
- "NullRow",
- "Last",
- "Rewind",
- "Prev",
- "Next",
- "IdxPut",
- "IdxDelete",
- "IdxRecno",
- "IdxLT",
- "IdxGT",
- "IdxGE",
- "IdxIsNull",
- "Destroy",
- "Clear",
- "CreateIndex",
- "CreateTable",
- "IntegrityCk",
- "ListWrite",
- "ListRewind",
- "ListRead",
- "ListReset",
- "ListPush",
- "ListPop",
- "ContextPush",
- "ContextPop",
- "SortPut",
- "SortMakeRec",
- "SortMakeKey",
- "Sort",
- "SortNext",
- "SortCallback",
- "SortReset",
- "FileOpen",
- "FileRead",
- "FileColumn",
- "MemStore",
- "MemLoad",
- "MemIncr",
- "AggReset",
- "AggInit",
- "AggFunc",
- "AggFocus",
- "AggSet",
- "AggGet",
- "AggNext",
- "SetInsert",
- "SetFound",
- "SetNotFound",
- "SetFirst",
- "SetNext",
- "Vacuum",
-};
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/opcodes.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/opcodes.h
deleted file mode 100644
index a6bc6d4..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/opcodes.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,136 +0,0 @@
-/* Automatically generated file. Do not edit */
-#define OP_Goto 1
-#define OP_Gosub 2
-#define OP_Return 3
-#define OP_Halt 4
-#define OP_Integer 5
-#define OP_String 6
-#define OP_Variable 7
-#define OP_Pop 8
-#define OP_Dup 9
-#define OP_Pull 10
-#define OP_Push 11
-#define OP_ColumnName 12
-#define OP_Callback 13
-#define OP_Concat 14
-#define OP_Add 15
-#define OP_Subtract 16
-#define OP_Multiply 17
-#define OP_Divide 18
-#define OP_Remainder 19
-#define OP_Function 20
-#define OP_BitAnd 21
-#define OP_BitOr 22
-#define OP_ShiftLeft 23
-#define OP_ShiftRight 24
-#define OP_AddImm 25
-#define OP_ForceInt 26
-#define OP_MustBeInt 27
-#define OP_Eq 28
-#define OP_Ne 29
-#define OP_Lt 30
-#define OP_Le 31
-#define OP_Gt 32
-#define OP_Ge 33
-#define OP_StrEq 34
-#define OP_StrNe 35
-#define OP_StrLt 36
-#define OP_StrLe 37
-#define OP_StrGt 38
-#define OP_StrGe 39
-#define OP_And 40
-#define OP_Or 41
-#define OP_Negative 42
-#define OP_AbsValue 43
-#define OP_Not 44
-#define OP_BitNot 45
-#define OP_Noop 46
-#define OP_If 47
-#define OP_IfNot 48
-#define OP_IsNull 49
-#define OP_NotNull 50
-#define OP_MakeRecord 51
-#define OP_MakeIdxKey 52
-#define OP_MakeKey 53
-#define OP_IncrKey 54
-#define OP_Checkpoint 55
-#define OP_Transaction 56
-#define OP_Commit 57
-#define OP_Rollback 58
-#define OP_ReadCookie 59
-#define OP_SetCookie 60
-#define OP_VerifyCookie 61
-#define OP_OpenRead 62
-#define OP_OpenWrite 63
-#define OP_OpenTemp 64
-#define OP_OpenPseudo 65
-#define OP_Close 66
-#define OP_MoveLt 67
-#define OP_MoveTo 68
-#define OP_Distinct 69
-#define OP_NotFound 70
-#define OP_Found 71
-#define OP_IsUnique 72
-#define OP_NotExists 73
-#define OP_NewRecno 74
-#define OP_PutIntKey 75
-#define OP_PutStrKey 76
-#define OP_Delete 77
-#define OP_SetCounts 78
-#define OP_KeyAsData 79
-#define OP_RowKey 80
-#define OP_RowData 81
-#define OP_Column 82
-#define OP_Recno 83
-#define OP_FullKey 84
-#define OP_NullRow 85
-#define OP_Last 86
-#define OP_Rewind 87
-#define OP_Prev 88
-#define OP_Next 89
-#define OP_IdxPut 90
-#define OP_IdxDelete 91
-#define OP_IdxRecno 92
-#define OP_IdxLT 93
-#define OP_IdxGT 94
-#define OP_IdxGE 95
-#define OP_IdxIsNull 96
-#define OP_Destroy 97
-#define OP_Clear 98
-#define OP_CreateIndex 99
-#define OP_CreateTable 100
-#define OP_IntegrityCk 101
-#define OP_ListWrite 102
-#define OP_ListRewind 103
-#define OP_ListRead 104
-#define OP_ListReset 105
-#define OP_ListPush 106
-#define OP_ListPop 107
-#define OP_ContextPush 108
-#define OP_ContextPop 109
-#define OP_SortPut 110
-#define OP_SortMakeRec 111
-#define OP_SortMakeKey 112
-#define OP_Sort 113
-#define OP_SortNext 114
-#define OP_SortCallback 115
-#define OP_SortReset 116
-#define OP_FileOpen 117
-#define OP_FileRead 118
-#define OP_FileColumn 119
-#define OP_MemStore 120
-#define OP_MemLoad 121
-#define OP_MemIncr 122
-#define OP_AggReset 123
-#define OP_AggInit 124
-#define OP_AggFunc 125
-#define OP_AggFocus 126
-#define OP_AggSet 127
-#define OP_AggGet 128
-#define OP_AggNext 129
-#define OP_SetInsert 130
-#define OP_SetFound 131
-#define OP_SetNotFound 132
-#define OP_SetFirst 133
-#define OP_SetNext 134
-#define OP_Vacuum 135
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/os.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/os.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 7918f81..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/os.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1818 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 16
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-******************************************************************************
-**
-** This file contains code that is specific to particular operating
-** systems. The purpose of this file is to provide a uniform abstraction
-** on which the rest of STQLite can operate.
-*/
-#include "os.h" /* Must be first to enable large file support */
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-#if OS_UNIX
-# include <time.h>
-# include <errno.h>
-# include <unistd.h>
-# ifndef O_LARGEFILE
-# define O_LARGEFILE 0
-# endif
-# ifdef STQLITE_DISABLE_LFS
-# undef O_LARGEFILE
-# define O_LARGEFILE 0
-# endif
-# ifndef O_NOFOLLOW
-# define O_NOFOLLOW 0
-# endif
-# ifndef O_BINARY
-# define O_BINARY 0
-# endif
-#endif
-
-
-#if OS_WIN
-# include <winbase.h>
-#endif
-
-#if OS_MAC
-# include <extras.h>
-# include <path2fss.h>
-# include <TextUtils.h>
-# include <FinderRegistry.h>
-# include <Folders.h>
-# include <Timer.h>
-# include <OSUtils.h>
-#endif
-
-/*
-** The DJGPP compiler environment looks mostly like Unix, but it
-** lacks the fcntl() system call. So redefine fcntl() to be something
-** that always succeeds. This means that locking does not occur under
-** DJGPP. But its DOS - what did you expect?
-*/
-#ifdef __DJGPP__
-# define fcntl(A,B,C) 0
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Macros used to determine whether or not to use threads. The
-** STQLITE_UNIX_THREADS macro is defined if we are synchronizing for
-** Posix threads and STQLITE_W32_THREADS is defined if we are
-** synchronizing using Win32 threads.
-*/
-#if OS_UNIX && defined(THREADSAFE) && THREADSAFE
-# include <pthread.h>
-# define STQLITE_UNIX_THREADS 1
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN && defined(THREADSAFE) && THREADSAFE
-# define STQLITE_W32_THREADS 1
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC && defined(THREADSAFE) && THREADSAFE
-# include <Multiprocessing.h>
-# define STQLITE_MACOS_MULTITASKING 1
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Macros for performance tracing. Normally turned off
-*/
-#if 0
-static int last_page = 0;
-__inline__ unsigned long long int hwtime(void){
- unsigned long long int x;
- __asm__("rdtsc\n\t"
- "mov %%edx, %%ecx\n\t"
- :"=A" (x));
- return x;
-}
-static unsigned long long int g_start;
-static unsigned int elapse;
-#define TIMER_START g_start=hwtime()
-#define TIMER_END elapse=hwtime()-g_start
-#define SEEK(X) last_page=(X)
-#define TRACE1(X) fprintf(stderr,X)
-#define TRACE2(X,Y) fprintf(stderr,X,Y)
-#define TRACE3(X,Y,Z) fprintf(stderr,X,Y,Z)
-#define TRACE4(X,Y,Z,A) fprintf(stderr,X,Y,Z,A)
-#define TRACE5(X,Y,Z,A,B) fprintf(stderr,X,Y,Z,A,B)
-#else
-#define TIMER_START
-#define TIMER_END
-#define SEEK(X)
-#define TRACE1(X)
-#define TRACE2(X,Y)
-#define TRACE3(X,Y,Z)
-#define TRACE4(X,Y,Z,A)
-#define TRACE5(X,Y,Z,A,B)
-#endif
-
-
-#if OS_UNIX
-/*
-** Here is the dirt on POSIX advisory locks: ANSI STD 1003.1 (1996)
-** section 6.5.2.2 lines 483 through 490 specify that when a process
-** sets or clears a lock, that operation overrides any prior locks set
-** by the same process. It does not explicitly say so, but this implies
-** that it overrides locks set by the same process using a different
-** file descriptor. Consider this test case:
-**
-** int fd1 = open("./file1", O_RDWR|O_CREAT, 0644);
-** int fd2 = open("./file2", O_RDWR|O_CREAT, 0644);
-**
-** Suppose ./file1 and ./file2 are really the same file (because
-** one is a hard or symbolic link to the other) then if you set
-** an exclusive lock on fd1, then try to get an exclusive lock
-** on fd2, it works. I would have expected the second lock to
-** fail since there was already a lock on the file due to fd1.
-** But not so. Since both locks came from the same process, the
-** second overrides the first, even though they were on different
-** file descriptors opened on different file names.
-**
-** Bummer. If you ask me, this is broken. Badly broken. It means
-** that we cannot use POSIX locks to synchronize file access among
-** competing threads of the same process. POSIX locks will work fine
-** to synchronize access for threads in separate processes, but not
-** threads within the same process.
-**
-** To work around the problem, STQLite has to manage file locks internally
-** on its own. Whenever a new database is opened, we have to find the
-** specific inode of the database file (the inode is determined by the
-** st_dev and st_ino fields of the stat structure that fstat() fills in)
-** and check for locks already existing on that inode. When locks are
-** created or removed, we have to look at our own internal record of the
-** locks to see if another thread has previously set a lock on that same
-** inode.
-**
-** The OsFile structure for POSIX is no longer just an integer file
-** descriptor. It is now a structure that holds the integer file
-** descriptor and a pointer to a structure that describes the internal
-** locks on the corresponding inode. There is one locking structure
-** per inode, so if the same inode is opened twice, both OsFile structures
-** point to the same locking structure. The locking structure keeps
-** a reference count (so we will know when to delete it) and a "cnt"
-** field that tells us its internal lock status. cnt==0 means the
-** file is unlocked. cnt==-1 means the file has an exclusive lock.
-** cnt>0 means there are cnt shared locks on the file.
-**
-** Any attempt to lock or unlock a file first checks the locking
-** structure. The fcntl() system call is only invoked to set a
-** POSIX lock if the internal lock structure transitions between
-** a locked and an unlocked state.
-**
-** 2004-Jan-11:
-** More recent discoveries about POSIX advisory locks. (The more
-** I discover, the more I realize the a POSIX advisory locks are
-** an abomination.)
-**
-** If you close a file descriptor that points to a file that has locks,
-** all locks on that file that are owned by the current process are
-** released. To work around this problem, each OsFile structure contains
-** a pointer to an openCnt structure. There is one openCnt structure
-** per open inode, which means that multiple OsFiles can point to a single
-** openCnt. When an attempt is made to close an OsFile, if there are
-** other OsFiles open on the same inode that are holding locks, the call
-** to close() the file descriptor is deferred until all of the locks clear.
-** The openCnt structure keeps a list of file descriptors that need to
-** be closed and that list is walked (and cleared) when the last lock
-** clears.
-**
-** First, under Linux threads, because each thread has a separate
-** process ID, lock operations in one thread do not override locks
-** to the same file in other threads. Linux threads behave like
-** separate processes in this respect. But, if you close a file
-** descriptor in linux threads, all locks are cleared, even locks
-** on other threads and even though the other threads have different
-** process IDs. Linux threads is inconsistent in this respect.
-** (I'm beginning to think that linux threads is an abomination too.)
-** The consequence of this all is that the hash table for the lockInfo
-** structure has to include the process id as part of its key because
-** locks in different threads are treated as distinct. But the
-** openCnt structure should not include the process id in its
-** key because close() clears lock on all threads, not just the current
-** thread. Were it not for this goofiness in linux threads, we could
-** combine the lockInfo and openCnt structures into a single structure.
-*/
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure serves as the key used
-** to locate a particular lockInfo structure given its inode. Note
-** that we have to include the process ID as part of the key. On some
-** threading implementations (ex: linux), each thread has a separate
-** process ID.
-*/
-struct lockKey {
- dev_t dev; /* Device number */
- ino_t ino; /* Inode number */
- pid_t pid; /* Process ID */
-};
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure is allocated for each open
-** inode on each thread with a different process ID. (Threads have
-** different process IDs on linux, but not on most other unixes.)
-**
-** A single inode can have multiple file descriptors, so each OsFile
-** structure contains a pointer to an instance of this object and this
-** object keeps a count of the number of OsFiles pointing to it.
-*/
-struct lockInfo {
- struct lockKey key; /* The lookup key */
- int cnt; /* 0: unlocked. -1: write lock. 1...: read lock. */
- int nRef; /* Number of pointers to this structure */
-};
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure serves as the key used
-** to locate a particular openCnt structure given its inode. This
-** is the same as the lockKey except that the process ID is omitted.
-*/
-struct openKey {
- dev_t dev; /* Device number */
- ino_t ino; /* Inode number */
-};
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure is allocated for each open
-** inode. This structure keeps track of the number of locks on that
-** inode. If a close is attempted against an inode that is holding
-** locks, the close is deferred until all locks clear by adding the
-** file descriptor to be closed to the pending list.
-*/
-struct openCnt {
- struct openKey key; /* The lookup key */
- int nRef; /* Number of pointers to this structure */
- int nLock; /* Number of outstanding locks */
- int nPending; /* Number of pending close() operations */
- int *aPending; /* Malloced space holding fd's awaiting a close() */
-};
-
-/*
-** These hash table maps inodes and process IDs into lockInfo and openCnt
-** structures. Access to these hash tables must be protected by a mutex.
-*/
-static Hash lockHash = { STQLITE_HASH_BINARY, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 };
-static Hash openHash = { STQLITE_HASH_BINARY, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 };
-
-/*
-** Release a lockInfo structure previously allocated by findLockInfo().
-*/
-static void releaseLockInfo(struct lockInfo *pLock){
- pLock->nRef--;
- if( pLock->nRef==0 ){
- sqliteHashInsert(&lockHash, &pLock->key, sizeof(pLock->key), 0);
- sqliteFree(pLock);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Release a openCnt structure previously allocated by findLockInfo().
-*/
-static void releaseOpenCnt(struct openCnt *pOpen){
- pOpen->nRef--;
- if( pOpen->nRef==0 ){
- sqliteHashInsert(&openHash, &pOpen->key, sizeof(pOpen->key), 0);
- sqliteFree(pOpen->aPending);
- sqliteFree(pOpen);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Given a file descriptor, locate lockInfo and openCnt structures that
-** describes that file descriptor. Create a new ones if necessary. The
-** return values might be unset if an error occurs.
-**
-** Return the number of errors.
-*/
-int findLockInfo(
- int fd, /* The file descriptor used in the key */
- struct lockInfo **ppLock, /* Return the lockInfo structure here */
- struct openCnt **ppOpen /* Return the openCnt structure here */
-){
- int rc;
- struct lockKey key1;
- struct openKey key2;
- struct stat statbuf;
- struct lockInfo *pLock;
- struct openCnt *pOpen;
- rc = fstat(fd, &statbuf);
- if( rc!=0 ) return 1;
- memset(&key1, 0, sizeof(key1));
- key1.dev = statbuf.st_dev;
- key1.ino = statbuf.st_ino;
- key1.pid = getpid();
- memset(&key2, 0, sizeof(key2));
- key2.dev = statbuf.st_dev;
- key2.ino = statbuf.st_ino;
- pLock = (struct lockInfo*)sqliteHashFind(&lockHash, &key1, sizeof(key1));
- if( pLock==0 ){
- struct lockInfo *pOld;
- pLock = sqliteMallocRaw( sizeof(*pLock) );
- if( pLock==0 ) return 1;
- pLock->key = key1;
- pLock->nRef = 1;
- pLock->cnt = 0;
- pOld = sqliteHashInsert(&lockHash, &pLock->key, sizeof(key1), pLock);
- if( pOld!=0 ){
- assert( pOld==pLock );
- sqliteFree(pLock);
- return 1;
- }
- }else{
- pLock->nRef++;
- }
- *ppLock = pLock;
- pOpen = (struct openCnt*)sqliteHashFind(&openHash, &key2, sizeof(key2));
- if( pOpen==0 ){
- struct openCnt *pOld;
- pOpen = sqliteMallocRaw( sizeof(*pOpen) );
- if( pOpen==0 ){
- releaseLockInfo(pLock);
- return 1;
- }
- pOpen->key = key2;
- pOpen->nRef = 1;
- pOpen->nLock = 0;
- pOpen->nPending = 0;
- pOpen->aPending = 0;
- pOld = sqliteHashInsert(&openHash, &pOpen->key, sizeof(key2), pOpen);
- if( pOld!=0 ){
- assert( pOld==pOpen );
- sqliteFree(pOpen);
- releaseLockInfo(pLock);
- return 1;
- }
- }else{
- pOpen->nRef++;
- }
- *ppOpen = pOpen;
- return 0;
-}
-
-#endif /** POSIX advisory lock work-around **/
-
-/*
-** If we compile with the STQLITE_TEST macro set, then the following block
-** of code will give us the ability to simulate a disk I/O error. This
-** is used for testing the I/O recovery logic.
-*/
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-int sqlite_io_error_pending = 0;
-#define SimulateIOError(A) \
- if( sqlite_io_error_pending ) \
- if( sqlite_io_error_pending-- == 1 ){ local_ioerr(); return A; }
-static void local_ioerr(){
- sqlite_io_error_pending = 0; /* Really just a place to set a breakpoint */
-}
-#else
-#define SimulateIOError(A)
-#endif
-
-/*
-** When testing, keep a count of the number of open files.
-*/
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-int sqlite_open_file_count = 0;
-#define OpenCounter(X) sqlite_open_file_count+=(X)
-#else
-#define OpenCounter(X)
-#endif
-
-
-/*
-** Delete the named file
-*/
-int sqliteOsDelete(const char *zFilename){
-#if OS_UNIX
- unlink(zFilename);
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- DeleteFile(zFilename);
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- unlink(zFilename);
-#endif
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return TRUE if the named file exists.
-*/
-int sqliteOsFileExists(const char *zFilename){
-#if OS_UNIX
- return access(zFilename, 0)==0;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- return GetFileAttributes(zFilename) != 0xffffffff;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- return access(zFilename, 0)==0;
-#endif
-}
-
-
-#if 0 /* NOT USED */
-/*
-** Change the name of an existing file.
-*/
-int sqliteOsFileRename(const char *zOldName, const char *zNewName){
-#if OS_UNIX
- if( link(zOldName, zNewName) ){
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- unlink(zOldName);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- if( !MoveFile(zOldName, zNewName) ){
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- /**** FIX ME ***/
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
-#endif
-}
-#endif /* NOT USED */
-
-/*
-** Attempt to open a file for both reading and writing. If that
-** fails, try opening it read-only. If the file does not exist,
-** try to create it.
-**
-** On success, a handle for the open file is written to *id
-** and *pReadonly is set to 0 if the file was opened for reading and
-** writing or 1 if the file was opened read-only. The function returns
-** STQLITE_OK.
-**
-** On failure, the function returns STQLITE_CANTOPEN and leaves
-** *id and *pReadonly unchanged.
-*/
-int sqliteOsOpenReadWrite(
- const char *zFilename,
- OsFile *id,
- int *pReadonly
-){
-#if OS_UNIX
- int rc;
- id->dirfd = -1;
- id->fd = open(zFilename, O_RDWR|O_CREAT|O_LARGEFILE|O_BINARY, 0644);
- if( id->fd<0 ){
- id->fd = open(zFilename, O_RDONLY|O_LARGEFILE|O_BINARY);
- if( id->fd<0 ){
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- *pReadonly = 1;
- }else{
- *pReadonly = 0;
- }
- sqliteOsEnterMutex();
- rc = findLockInfo(id->fd, &id->pLock, &id->pOpen);
- sqliteOsLeaveMutex();
- if( rc ){
- close(id->fd);
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- id->locked = 0;
- TRACE3("OPEN %-3d %s\n", id->fd, zFilename);
- OpenCounter(+1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- HANDLE h = CreateFile(zFilename,
- GENERIC_READ | GENERIC_WRITE,
- FILE_SHARE_READ | FILE_SHARE_WRITE,
- NULL,
- OPEN_ALWAYS,
- FILE_ATTRIBUTE_NORMAL | FILE_FLAG_RANDOM_ACCESS,
- NULL
- );
- if( h==INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE ){
- h = CreateFile(zFilename,
- GENERIC_READ,
- FILE_SHARE_READ,
- NULL,
- OPEN_ALWAYS,
- FILE_ATTRIBUTE_NORMAL | FILE_FLAG_RANDOM_ACCESS,
- NULL
- );
- if( h==INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE ){
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- *pReadonly = 1;
- }else{
- *pReadonly = 0;
- }
- id->h = h;
- id->locked = 0;
- OpenCounter(+1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- FSSpec fsSpec;
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- HFSUniStr255 dfName;
- FSRef fsRef;
- if( __path2fss(zFilename, &fsSpec) != noErr ){
- if( HCreate(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, 'STQLI', cDocumentFile) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- if( FSpMakeFSRef(&fsSpec, &fsRef) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- FSGetDataForkName(&dfName);
- if( FSOpenFork(&fsRef, dfName.length, dfName.tqunicode,
- fsRdWrShPerm, &(id->refNum)) != noErr ){
- if( FSOpenFork(&fsRef, dfName.length, dfName.tqunicode,
- fsRdWrPerm, &(id->refNum)) != noErr ){
- if (FSOpenFork(&fsRef, dfName.length, dfName.tqunicode,
- fsRdPerm, &(id->refNum)) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- else
- *pReadonly = 1;
- } else
- *pReadonly = 0;
- } else
- *pReadonly = 0;
-# else
- __path2fss(zFilename, &fsSpec);
- if( !sqliteOsFileExists(zFilename) ){
- if( HCreate(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, 'STQLI', cDocumentFile) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- if( HOpenDF(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, fsRdWrShPerm, &(id->refNum)) != noErr ){
- if( HOpenDF(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, fsRdWrPerm, &(id->refNum)) != noErr ){
- if( HOpenDF(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, fsRdPerm, &(id->refNum)) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- else
- *pReadonly = 1;
- } else
- *pReadonly = 0;
- } else
- *pReadonly = 0;
-# endif
- if( HOpenRF(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, fsRdWrShPerm, &(id->refNumRF)) != noErr){
- id->refNumRF = -1;
- }
- id->locked = 0;
- id->delOnClose = 0;
- OpenCounter(+1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-}
-
-
-/*
-** Attempt to open a new file for exclusive access by this process.
-** The file will be opened for both reading and writing. To avoid
-** a potential security problem, we do not allow the file to have
-** previously existed. Nor do we allow the file to be a symbolic
-** link.
-**
-** If delFlag is true, then make arrangements to automatically delete
-** the file when it is closed.
-**
-** On success, write the file handle into *id and return STQLITE_OK.
-**
-** On failure, return STQLITE_CANTOPEN.
-*/
-int sqliteOsOpenExclusive(const char *zFilename, OsFile *id, int delFlag){
-#if OS_UNIX
- int rc;
- if( access(zFilename, 0)==0 ){
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- id->dirfd = -1;
- id->fd = open(zFilename,
- O_RDWR|O_CREAT|O_EXCL|O_NOFOLLOW|O_LARGEFILE|O_BINARY, 0600);
- if( id->fd<0 ){
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- sqliteOsEnterMutex();
- rc = findLockInfo(id->fd, &id->pLock, &id->pOpen);
- sqliteOsLeaveMutex();
- if( rc ){
- close(id->fd);
- unlink(zFilename);
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- id->locked = 0;
- if( delFlag ){
- unlink(zFilename);
- }
- TRACE3("OPEN-EX %-3d %s\n", id->fd, zFilename);
- OpenCounter(+1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- HANDLE h;
- int fileflags;
- if( delFlag ){
- fileflags = FILE_ATTRIBUTE_TEMPORARY | FILE_FLAG_RANDOM_ACCESS
- | FILE_FLAG_DELETE_ON_CLOSE;
- }else{
- fileflags = FILE_FLAG_RANDOM_ACCESS;
- }
- h = CreateFile(zFilename,
- GENERIC_READ | GENERIC_WRITE,
- 0,
- NULL,
- CREATE_ALWAYS,
- fileflags,
- NULL
- );
- if( h==INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE ){
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- id->h = h;
- id->locked = 0;
- OpenCounter(+1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- FSSpec fsSpec;
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- HFSUniStr255 dfName;
- FSRef fsRef;
- __path2fss(zFilename, &fsSpec);
- if( HCreate(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, 'STQLI', cDocumentFile) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- if( FSpMakeFSRef(&fsSpec, &fsRef) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- FSGetDataForkName(&dfName);
- if( FSOpenFork(&fsRef, dfName.length, dfName.tqunicode,
- fsRdWrPerm, &(id->refNum)) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
-# else
- __path2fss(zFilename, &fsSpec);
- if( HCreate(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, 'STQLI', cDocumentFile) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- if( HOpenDF(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, fsRdWrPerm, &(id->refNum)) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
-# endif
- id->refNumRF = -1;
- id->locked = 0;
- id->delOnClose = delFlag;
- if (delFlag)
- id->pathToDel = sqliteOsFullPathname(zFilename);
- OpenCounter(+1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Attempt to open a new file for read-only access.
-**
-** On success, write the file handle into *id and return STQLITE_OK.
-**
-** On failure, return STQLITE_CANTOPEN.
-*/
-int sqliteOsOpenReadOnly(const char *zFilename, OsFile *id){
-#if OS_UNIX
- int rc;
- id->dirfd = -1;
- id->fd = open(zFilename, O_RDONLY|O_LARGEFILE|O_BINARY);
- if( id->fd<0 ){
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- sqliteOsEnterMutex();
- rc = findLockInfo(id->fd, &id->pLock, &id->pOpen);
- sqliteOsLeaveMutex();
- if( rc ){
- close(id->fd);
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- id->locked = 0;
- TRACE3("OPEN-RO %-3d %s\n", id->fd, zFilename);
- OpenCounter(+1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- HANDLE h = CreateFile(zFilename,
- GENERIC_READ,
- 0,
- NULL,
- OPEN_EXISTING,
- FILE_ATTRIBUTE_NORMAL | FILE_FLAG_RANDOM_ACCESS,
- NULL
- );
- if( h==INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE ){
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- id->h = h;
- id->locked = 0;
- OpenCounter(+1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- FSSpec fsSpec;
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- HFSUniStr255 dfName;
- FSRef fsRef;
- if( __path2fss(zFilename, &fsSpec) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- if( FSpMakeFSRef(&fsSpec, &fsRef) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- FSGetDataForkName(&dfName);
- if( FSOpenFork(&fsRef, dfName.length, dfName.tqunicode,
- fsRdPerm, &(id->refNum)) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
-# else
- __path2fss(zFilename, &fsSpec);
- if( HOpenDF(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, fsRdPerm, &(id->refNum)) != noErr )
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
-# endif
- if( HOpenRF(fsSpec.vRefNum, fsSpec.parID, fsSpec.name, fsRdWrShPerm, &(id->refNumRF)) != noErr){
- id->refNumRF = -1;
- }
- id->locked = 0;
- id->delOnClose = 0;
- OpenCounter(+1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Attempt to open a file descriptor for the directory that contains a
-** file. This file descriptor can be used to fsync() the directory
-** in order to make sure the creation of a new file is actually written
-** to disk.
-**
-** This routine is only meaningful for Unix. It is a no-op under
-** windows since windows does not support hard links.
-**
-** On success, a handle for a previously open file is at *id is
-** updated with the new directory file descriptor and STQLITE_OK is
-** returned.
-**
-** On failure, the function returns STQLITE_CANTOPEN and leaves
-** *id unchanged.
-*/
-int sqliteOsOpenDirectory(
- const char *zDirname,
- OsFile *id
-){
-#if OS_UNIX
- if( id->fd<0 ){
- /* Do not open the directory if the corresponding file is not already
- ** open. */
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- assert( id->dirfd<0 );
- id->dirfd = open(zDirname, O_RDONLY|O_BINARY, 0644);
- if( id->dirfd<0 ){
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- TRACE3("OPENDIR %-3d %s\n", id->dirfd, zDirname);
-#endif
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Create a temporary file name in zBuf. zBuf must be big enough to
-** hold at least STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE characters.
-*/
-int sqliteOsTempFileName(char *zBuf){
-#if OS_UNIX
- static const char *azDirs[] = {
- "/var/tmp",
- "/usr/tmp",
- "/tmp",
- ".",
- };
- static unsigned char zChars[] =
- "abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz"
- "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ"
- "0123456789";
- int i, j;
- struct stat buf;
- const char *zDir = ".";
- for(i=0; i<sizeof(azDirs)/sizeof(azDirs[0]); i++){
- if( stat(azDirs[i], &buf) ) continue;
- if( !S_ISDIR(buf.st_mode) ) continue;
- if( access(azDirs[i], 07) ) continue;
- zDir = azDirs[i];
- break;
- }
- do{
- sprintf(zBuf, "%s/"TEMP_FILE_PREFIX, zDir);
- j = strlen(zBuf);
- sqliteRandomness(15, &zBuf[j]);
- for(i=0; i<15; i++, j++){
- zBuf[j] = (char)zChars[ ((unsigned char)zBuf[j])%(sizeof(zChars)-1) ];
- }
- zBuf[j] = 0;
- }while( access(zBuf,0)==0 );
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- static char zChars[] =
- "abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz"
- "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ"
- "0123456789";
- int i, j;
- char zTempPath[STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE];
- GetTempPath(STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE-30, zTempPath);
- for(i=strlen(zTempPath); i>0 && zTempPath[i-1]=='\\'; i--){}
- zTempPath[i] = 0;
- for(;;){
- sprintf(zBuf, "%s\\"TEMP_FILE_PREFIX, zTempPath);
- j = strlen(zBuf);
- sqliteRandomness(15, &zBuf[j]);
- for(i=0; i<15; i++, j++){
- zBuf[j] = (char)zChars[ ((unsigned char)zBuf[j])%(sizeof(zChars)-1) ];
- }
- zBuf[j] = 0;
- if( !sqliteOsFileExists(zBuf) ) break;
- }
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- static char zChars[] =
- "abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz"
- "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ"
- "0123456789";
- int i, j;
- char zTempPath[STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE];
- char zdirName[32];
- CInfoPBRec infoRec;
- Str31 dirName;
- memset(&infoRec, 0, sizeof(infoRec));
- memset(zTempPath, 0, STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE);
- if( FindFolder(kOnSystemDisk, kTemporaryFolderType, kCreateFolder,
- &(infoRec.dirInfo.ioVRefNum), &(infoRec.dirInfo.ioDrParID)) == noErr ){
- infoRec.dirInfo.ioNamePtr = dirName;
- do{
- infoRec.dirInfo.ioFDirIndex = -1;
- infoRec.dirInfo.ioDrDirID = infoRec.dirInfo.ioDrParID;
- if( PBGetCatInfoSync(&infoRec) == noErr ){
- CopyPascalStringToC(dirName, zdirName);
- i = strlen(zdirName);
- memmove(&(zTempPath[i+1]), zTempPath, strlen(zTempPath));
- strcpy(zTempPath, zdirName);
- zTempPath[i] = ':';
- }else{
- *zTempPath = 0;
- break;
- }
- } while( infoRec.dirInfo.ioDrDirID != fsRtDirID );
- }
- if( *zTempPath == 0 )
- getcwd(zTempPath, STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE-24);
- for(;;){
- sprintf(zBuf, "%s"TEMP_FILE_PREFIX, zTempPath);
- j = strlen(zBuf);
- sqliteRandomness(15, &zBuf[j]);
- for(i=0; i<15; i++, j++){
- zBuf[j] = (char)zChars[ ((unsigned char)zBuf[j])%(sizeof(zChars)-1) ];
- }
- zBuf[j] = 0;
- if( !sqliteOsFileExists(zBuf) ) break;
- }
-#endif
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Close a file.
-*/
-int sqliteOsClose(OsFile *id){
-#if OS_UNIX
- sqliteOsUnlock(id);
- if( id->dirfd>=0 ) close(id->dirfd);
- id->dirfd = -1;
- sqliteOsEnterMutex();
- if( id->pOpen->nLock ){
- /* If there are outstanding locks, do not actually close the file just
- ** yet because that would clear those locks. Instead, add the file
- ** descriptor to pOpen->aPending. It will be automatically closed when
- ** the last lock is cleared.
- */
- int *aNew;
- struct openCnt *pOpen = id->pOpen;
- pOpen->nPending++;
- aNew = sqliteRealloc( pOpen->aPending, pOpen->nPending*sizeof(int) );
- if( aNew==0 ){
- /* If a malloc fails, just leak the file descriptor */
- }else{
- pOpen->aPending = aNew;
- pOpen->aPending[pOpen->nPending-1] = id->fd;
- }
- }else{
- /* There are no outstanding locks so we can close the file immediately */
- close(id->fd);
- }
- releaseLockInfo(id->pLock);
- releaseOpenCnt(id->pOpen);
- sqliteOsLeaveMutex();
- TRACE2("CLOSE %-3d\n", id->fd);
- OpenCounter(-1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- CloseHandle(id->h);
- OpenCounter(-1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- if( id->refNumRF!=-1 )
- FSClose(id->refNumRF);
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- FSCloseFork(id->refNum);
-# else
- FSClose(id->refNum);
-# endif
- if( id->delOnClose ){
- unlink(id->pathToDel);
- sqliteFree(id->pathToDel);
- }
- OpenCounter(-1);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Read data from a file into a buffer. Return STQLITE_OK if all
-** bytes were read successfully and STQLITE_IOERR if anything goes
-** wrong.
-*/
-int sqliteOsRead(OsFile *id, void *pBuf, int amt){
-#if OS_UNIX
- int got;
- SimulateIOError(STQLITE_IOERR);
- TIMER_START;
- got = read(id->fd, pBuf, amt);
- TIMER_END;
- TRACE4("READ %-3d %7d %d\n", id->fd, last_page, elapse);
- SEEK(0);
- /* if( got<0 ) got = 0; */
- if( got==amt ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- DWORD got;
- SimulateIOError(STQLITE_IOERR);
- TRACE2("READ %d\n", last_page);
- if( !ReadFile(id->h, pBuf, amt, &got, 0) ){
- got = 0;
- }
- if( got==(DWORD)amt ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- int got;
- SimulateIOError(STQLITE_IOERR);
- TRACE2("READ %d\n", last_page);
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- FSReadFork(id->refNum, fsAtMark, 0, (ByteCount)amt, pBuf, (ByteCount*)&got);
-# else
- got = amt;
- FSRead(id->refNum, &got, pBuf);
-# endif
- if( got==amt ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Write data from a buffer into a file. Return STQLITE_OK on success
-** or some other error code on failure.
-*/
-int sqliteOsWrite(OsFile *id, const void *pBuf, int amt){
-#if OS_UNIX
- int wrote = 0;
- SimulateIOError(STQLITE_IOERR);
- TIMER_START;
- while( amt>0 && (wrote = write(id->fd, pBuf, amt))>0 ){
- amt -= wrote;
- pBuf = &((char*)pBuf)[wrote];
- }
- TIMER_END;
- TRACE4("WRITE %-3d %7d %d\n", id->fd, last_page, elapse);
- SEEK(0);
- if( amt>0 ){
- return STQLITE_FULL;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- int rc;
- DWORD wrote;
- SimulateIOError(STQLITE_IOERR);
- TRACE2("WRITE %d\n", last_page);
- while( amt>0 && (rc = WriteFile(id->h, pBuf, amt, &wrote, 0))!=0 && wrote>0 ){
- amt -= wrote;
- pBuf = &((char*)pBuf)[wrote];
- }
- if( !rc || amt>(int)wrote ){
- return STQLITE_FULL;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- OSErr oserr;
- int wrote = 0;
- SimulateIOError(STQLITE_IOERR);
- TRACE2("WRITE %d\n", last_page);
- while( amt>0 ){
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- oserr = FSWriteFork(id->refNum, fsAtMark, 0,
- (ByteCount)amt, pBuf, (ByteCount*)&wrote);
-# else
- wrote = amt;
- oserr = FSWrite(id->refNum, &wrote, pBuf);
-# endif
- if( wrote == 0 || oserr != noErr)
- break;
- amt -= wrote;
- pBuf = &((char*)pBuf)[wrote];
- }
- if( oserr != noErr || amt>wrote ){
- return STQLITE_FULL;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Move the read/write pointer in a file.
-*/
-int sqliteOsSeek(OsFile *id, off_t offset){
- SEEK(offset/1024 + 1);
-#if OS_UNIX
- lseek(id->fd, offset, SEEK_SET);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- {
- LONG upperBits = offset>>32;
- LONG lowerBits = offset & 0xffffffff;
- DWORD rc;
- rc = SetFilePointer(id->h, lowerBits, &upperBits, FILE_BEGIN);
- /* TRACE3("SEEK rc=0x%x upper=0x%x\n", rc, upperBits); */
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- {
- off_t curSize;
- if( sqliteOsFileSize(id, &curSize) != STQLITE_OK ){
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }
- if( offset >= curSize ){
- if( sqliteOsTruncate(id, offset+1) != STQLITE_OK ){
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }
- }
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- if( FSSetForkPosition(id->refNum, fsFromStart, offset) != noErr ){
-# else
- if( SetFPos(id->refNum, fsFromStart, offset) != noErr ){
-# endif
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }else{
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- }
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Make sure all writes to a particular file are committed to disk.
-**
-** Under Unix, also make sure that the directory entry for the file
-** has been created by fsync-ing the directory that contains the file.
-** If we do not do this and we encounter a power failure, the directory
-** entry for the journal might not exist after we reboot. The next
-** STQLite to access the file will not know that the journal exists (because
-** the directory entry for the journal was never created) and the transaction
-** will not roll back - possibly leading to database corruption.
-*/
-int sqliteOsSync(OsFile *id){
-#if OS_UNIX
- SimulateIOError(STQLITE_IOERR);
- TRACE2("SYNC %-3d\n", id->fd);
- if( fsync(id->fd) ){
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }else{
- if( id->dirfd>=0 ){
- TRACE2("DIRSYNC %-3d\n", id->dirfd);
- fsync(id->dirfd);
- close(id->dirfd); /* Only need to sync once, so close the directory */
- id->dirfd = -1; /* when we are done. */
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- if( FlushFileBuffers(id->h) ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- if( FSFlushFork(id->refNum) != noErr ){
-# else
- ParamBlockRec params;
- memset(&params, 0, sizeof(ParamBlockRec));
- params.ioParam.ioRefNum = id->refNum;
- if( PBFlushFileSync(&params) != noErr ){
-# endif
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }else{
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Truncate an open file to a specified size
-*/
-int sqliteOsTruncate(OsFile *id, off_t nByte){
- SimulateIOError(STQLITE_IOERR);
-#if OS_UNIX
- return ftruncate(id->fd, nByte)==0 ? STQLITE_OK : STQLITE_IOERR;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- {
- LONG upperBits = nByte>>32;
- SetFilePointer(id->h, nByte, &upperBits, FILE_BEGIN);
- SetEndOfFile(id->h);
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- if( FSSetForkSize(id->refNum, fsFromStart, nByte) != noErr){
-# else
- if( SetEOF(id->refNum, nByte) != noErr ){
-# endif
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }else{
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Determine the current size of a file in bytes
-*/
-int sqliteOsFileSize(OsFile *id, off_t *pSize){
-#if OS_UNIX
- struct stat buf;
- SimulateIOError(STQLITE_IOERR);
- if( fstat(id->fd, &buf)!=0 ){
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }
- *pSize = buf.st_size;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- DWORD upperBits, lowerBits;
- SimulateIOError(STQLITE_IOERR);
- lowerBits = GetFileSize(id->h, &upperBits);
- *pSize = (((off_t)upperBits)<<32) + lowerBits;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- if( FSGetForkSize(id->refNum, pSize) != noErr){
-# else
- if( GetEOF(id->refNum, pSize) != noErr ){
-# endif
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }else{
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
-#endif
-}
-
-#if OS_WIN
-/*
-** Return true (non-zero) if we are running under WinNT, Win2K or WinXP.
-** Return false (zero) for Win95, Win98, or WinME.
-**
-** Here is an interesting observation: Win95, Win98, and WinME lack
-** the LockFileEx() API. But we can still statically link against that
-** API as long as we don't call it win running Win95/98/ME. A call to
-** this routine is used to determine if the host is Win95/98/ME or
-** WinNT/2K/XP so that we will know whether or not we can safely call
-** the LockFileEx() API.
-*/
-int isNT(void){
- static int osType = 0; /* 0=unknown 1=win95 2=winNT */
- if( osType==0 ){
- OSVERSIONINFO sInfo;
- sInfo.dwOSVersionInfoSize = sizeof(sInfo);
- GetVersionEx(&sInfo);
- osType = sInfo.dwPlatformId==VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT ? 2 : 1;
- }
- return osType==2;
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Windows file locking notes: [similar issues apply to MacOS]
-**
-** We cannot use LockFileEx() or UnlockFileEx() on Win95/98/ME because
-** those functions are not available. So we use only LockFile() and
-** UnlockFile().
-**
-** LockFile() prevents not just writing but also reading by other processes.
-** (This is a design error on the part of Windows, but there is nothing
-** we can do about that.) So the region used for locking is at the
-** end of the file where it is unlikely to ever interfere with an
-** actual read attempt.
-**
-** A database read lock is obtained by locking a single randomly-chosen
-** byte out of a specific range of bytes. The lock byte is obtained at
-** random so two separate readers can probably access the file at the
-** same time, unless they are unlucky and choose the same lock byte.
-** A database write lock is obtained by locking all bytes in the range.
-** There can only be one writer.
-**
-** A lock is obtained on the first byte of the lock range before acquiring
-** either a read lock or a write lock. This prevents two processes from
-** attempting to get a lock at a same time. The semantics of
-** sqliteOsReadLock() require that if there is already a write lock, that
-** lock is converted into a read lock atomically. The lock on the first
-** byte allows us to drop the old write lock and get the read lock without
-** another process jumping into the middle and messing us up. The same
-** argument applies to sqliteOsWriteLock().
-**
-** On WinNT/2K/XP systems, LockFileEx() and UnlockFileEx() are available,
-** which means we can use reader/writer locks. When reader writer locks
-** are used, the lock is placed on the same range of bytes that is used
-** for probabilistic locking in Win95/98/ME. Hence, the locking scheme
-** will support two or more Win95 readers or two or more WinNT readers.
-** But a single Win95 reader will lock out all WinNT readers and a single
-** WinNT reader will lock out all other Win95 readers.
-**
-** Note: On MacOS we use the resource fork for locking.
-**
-** The following #defines specify the range of bytes used for locking.
-** N_LOCKBYTE is the number of bytes available for doing the locking.
-** The first byte used to hold the lock while the lock is changing does
-** not count toward this number. FIRST_LOCKBYTE is the address of
-** the first byte in the range of bytes used for locking.
-*/
-#define N_LOCKBYTE 10239
-#if OS_MAC
-# define FIRST_LOCKBYTE (0x000fffff - N_LOCKBYTE)
-#else
-# define FIRST_LOCKBYTE (0xffffffff - N_LOCKBYTE)
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Change the status of the lock on the file "id" to be a readlock.
-** If the file was write locked, then this reduces the lock to a read.
-** If the file was read locked, then this acquires a new read lock.
-**
-** Return STQLITE_OK on success and STQLITE_BUSY on failure. If this
-** library was compiled with large file support (LFS) but LFS is not
-** available on the host, then an STQLITE_NOLFS is returned.
-*/
-int sqliteOsReadLock(OsFile *id){
-#if OS_UNIX
- int rc;
- sqliteOsEnterMutex();
- if( id->pLock->cnt>0 ){
- if( !id->locked ){
- id->pLock->cnt++;
- id->locked = 1;
- id->pOpen->nLock++;
- }
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else if( id->locked || id->pLock->cnt==0 ){
- struct flock lock;
- int s;
- lock.l_type = F_RDLCK;
- lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
- lock.l_start = lock.l_len = 0L;
- s = fcntl(id->fd, F_SETLK, &lock);
- if( s!=0 ){
- rc = (errno==EINVAL) ? STQLITE_NOLFS : STQLITE_BUSY;
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- if( !id->locked ){
- id->pOpen->nLock++;
- id->locked = 1;
- }
- id->pLock->cnt = 1;
- }
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_BUSY;
- }
- sqliteOsLeaveMutex();
- return rc;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- int rc;
- if( id->locked>0 ){
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- int lk;
- int res;
- int cnt = 100;
- sqliteRandomness(sizeof(lk), &lk);
- lk = (lk & 0x7fffffff)%N_LOCKBYTE + 1;
- while( cnt-->0 && (res = LockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE, 0, 1, 0))==0 ){
- Sleep(1);
- }
- if( res ){
- UnlockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE+1, 0, N_LOCKBYTE, 0);
- if( isNT() ){
- OVERLAPPED ovlp;
- ovlp.Offset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE+1;
- ovlp.OffsetHigh = 0;
- ovlp.hEvent = 0;
- res = LockFileEx(id->h, LOCKFILE_FAIL_IMMEDIATELY,
- 0, N_LOCKBYTE, 0, &ovlp);
- }else{
- res = LockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE+lk, 0, 1, 0);
- }
- UnlockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE, 0, 1, 0);
- }
- if( res ){
- id->locked = lk;
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_BUSY;
- }
- }
- return rc;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- int rc;
- if( id->locked>0 || id->refNumRF == -1 ){
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- int lk;
- OSErr res;
- int cnt = 5;
- ParamBlockRec params;
- sqliteRandomness(sizeof(lk), &lk);
- lk = (lk & 0x7fffffff)%N_LOCKBYTE + 1;
- memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
- params.ioParam.ioRefNum = id->refNumRF;
- params.ioParam.ioPosMode = fsFromStart;
- params.ioParam.ioPosOffset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE;
- params.ioParam.ioRetqCount = 1;
- while( cnt-->0 && (res = PBLockRangeSync(&params))!=noErr ){
- UInt32 finalTicks;
- Delay(1, &finalTicks); /* 1/60 sec */
- }
- if( res == noErr ){
- params.ioParam.ioPosOffset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE+1;
- params.ioParam.ioRetqCount = N_LOCKBYTE;
- PBUnlockRangeSync(&params);
- params.ioParam.ioPosOffset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE+lk;
- params.ioParam.ioRetqCount = 1;
- res = PBLockRangeSync(&params);
- params.ioParam.ioPosOffset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE;
- params.ioParam.ioRetqCount = 1;
- PBUnlockRangeSync(&params);
- }
- if( res == noErr ){
- id->locked = lk;
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_BUSY;
- }
- }
- return rc;
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the lock status to be an exclusive or write lock. Return
-** STQLITE_OK on success and STQLITE_BUSY on a failure. If this
-** library was compiled with large file support (LFS) but LFS is not
-** available on the host, then an STQLITE_NOLFS is returned.
-*/
-int sqliteOsWriteLock(OsFile *id){
-#if OS_UNIX
- int rc;
- sqliteOsEnterMutex();
- if( id->pLock->cnt==0 || (id->pLock->cnt==1 && id->locked==1) ){
- struct flock lock;
- int s;
- lock.l_type = F_WRLCK;
- lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
- lock.l_start = lock.l_len = 0L;
- s = fcntl(id->fd, F_SETLK, &lock);
- if( s!=0 ){
- rc = (errno==EINVAL) ? STQLITE_NOLFS : STQLITE_BUSY;
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- if( !id->locked ){
- id->pOpen->nLock++;
- id->locked = 1;
- }
- id->pLock->cnt = -1;
- }
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_BUSY;
- }
- sqliteOsLeaveMutex();
- return rc;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- int rc;
- if( id->locked<0 ){
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- int res;
- int cnt = 100;
- while( cnt-->0 && (res = LockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE, 0, 1, 0))==0 ){
- Sleep(1);
- }
- if( res ){
- if( id->locked>0 ){
- if( isNT() ){
- UnlockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE+1, 0, N_LOCKBYTE, 0);
- }else{
- res = UnlockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE + id->locked, 0, 1, 0);
- }
- }
- if( res ){
- res = LockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE+1, 0, N_LOCKBYTE, 0);
- }else{
- res = 0;
- }
- UnlockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE, 0, 1, 0);
- }
- if( res ){
- id->locked = -1;
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_BUSY;
- }
- }
- return rc;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- int rc;
- if( id->locked<0 || id->refNumRF == -1 ){
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- OSErr res;
- int cnt = 5;
- ParamBlockRec params;
- memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
- params.ioParam.ioRefNum = id->refNumRF;
- params.ioParam.ioPosMode = fsFromStart;
- params.ioParam.ioPosOffset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE;
- params.ioParam.ioRetqCount = 1;
- while( cnt-->0 && (res = PBLockRangeSync(&params))!=noErr ){
- UInt32 finalTicks;
- Delay(1, &finalTicks); /* 1/60 sec */
- }
- if( res == noErr ){
- params.ioParam.ioPosOffset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE + id->locked;
- params.ioParam.ioRetqCount = 1;
- if( id->locked==0
- || PBUnlockRangeSync(&params)==noErr ){
- params.ioParam.ioPosOffset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE+1;
- params.ioParam.ioRetqCount = N_LOCKBYTE;
- res = PBLockRangeSync(&params);
- }else{
- res = afpRangeNotLocked;
- }
- params.ioParam.ioPosOffset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE;
- params.ioParam.ioRetqCount = 1;
- PBUnlockRangeSync(&params);
- }
- if( res == noErr ){
- id->locked = -1;
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_BUSY;
- }
- }
- return rc;
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Unlock the given file descriptor. If the file descriptor was
-** not previously locked, then this routine is a no-op. If this
-** library was compiled with large file support (LFS) but LFS is not
-** available on the host, then an STQLITE_NOLFS is returned.
-*/
-int sqliteOsUnlock(OsFile *id){
-#if OS_UNIX
- int rc;
- if( !id->locked ) return STQLITE_OK;
- sqliteOsEnterMutex();
- assert( id->pLock->cnt!=0 );
- if( id->pLock->cnt>1 ){
- id->pLock->cnt--;
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else{
- struct flock lock;
- int s;
- lock.l_type = F_UNLCK;
- lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
- lock.l_start = lock.l_len = 0L;
- s = fcntl(id->fd, F_SETLK, &lock);
- if( s!=0 ){
- rc = (errno==EINVAL) ? STQLITE_NOLFS : STQLITE_BUSY;
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- id->pLock->cnt = 0;
- }
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- /* Decrement the count of locks against this same file. When the
- ** count reaches zero, close any other file descriptors whose close
- ** was deferred because of outstanding locks.
- */
- struct openCnt *pOpen = id->pOpen;
- pOpen->nLock--;
- assert( pOpen->nLock>=0 );
- if( pOpen->nLock==0 && pOpen->nPending>0 ){
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<pOpen->nPending; i++){
- close(pOpen->aPending[i]);
- }
- sqliteFree(pOpen->aPending);
- pOpen->nPending = 0;
- pOpen->aPending = 0;
- }
- }
- sqliteOsLeaveMutex();
- id->locked = 0;
- return rc;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- int rc;
- if( id->locked==0 ){
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else if( isNT() || id->locked<0 ){
- UnlockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE+1, 0, N_LOCKBYTE, 0);
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- id->locked = 0;
- }else{
- UnlockFile(id->h, FIRST_LOCKBYTE+id->locked, 0, 1, 0);
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- id->locked = 0;
- }
- return rc;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- int rc;
- ParamBlockRec params;
- memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
- params.ioParam.ioRefNum = id->refNumRF;
- params.ioParam.ioPosMode = fsFromStart;
- if( id->locked==0 || id->refNumRF == -1 ){
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }else if( id->locked<0 ){
- params.ioParam.ioPosOffset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE+1;
- params.ioParam.ioRetqCount = N_LOCKBYTE;
- PBUnlockRangeSync(&params);
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- id->locked = 0;
- }else{
- params.ioParam.ioPosOffset = FIRST_LOCKBYTE+id->locked;
- params.ioParam.ioRetqCount = 1;
- PBUnlockRangeSync(&params);
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- id->locked = 0;
- }
- return rc;
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Get information to seed the random number generator. The seed
-** is written into the buffer zBuf[256]. The calling function must
-** supply a sufficiently large buffer.
-*/
-int sqliteOsRandomSeed(char *zBuf){
- /* We have to initialize zBuf to prevent valgrind from reporting
- ** errors. The reports issued by valgrind are incorrect - we would
- ** prefer that the randomness be increased by making use of the
- ** uninitialized space in zBuf - but valgrind errors tend to worry
- ** some users. Rather than argue, it seems easier just to initialize
- ** the whole array and silence valgrind, even if that means less randomness
- ** in the random seed.
- **
- ** When testing, initializing zBuf[] to zero is all we do. That means
- ** that we always use the same random number sequence.* This makes the
- ** tests repeatable.
- */
- memset(zBuf, 0, 256);
-#if OS_UNIX && !defined(STQLITE_TEST)
- {
- int pid;
- time((time_t*)zBuf);
- pid = getpid();
- memcpy(&zBuf[sizeof(time_t)], &pid, sizeof(pid));
- }
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN && !defined(STQLITE_TEST)
- GetSystemTime((LPSYSTEMTIME)zBuf);
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- {
- int pid;
- Microseconds((UnsignedWide*)zBuf);
- pid = getpid();
- memcpy(&zBuf[sizeof(UnsignedWide)], &pid, sizeof(pid));
- }
-#endif
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Sleep for a little while. Return the amount of time slept.
-*/
-int sqliteOsSleep(int ms){
-#if OS_UNIX
-#if defined(HAVE_USLEEP) && HAVE_USLEEP
- usleep(ms*1000);
- return ms;
-#else
- sleep((ms+999)/1000);
- return 1000*((ms+999)/1000);
-#endif
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- Sleep(ms);
- return ms;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- UInt32 finalTicks;
- UInt32 ticks = (((UInt32)ms+16)*3)/50; /* 1/60 sec per tick */
- Delay(ticks, &finalTicks);
- return (int)((ticks*50)/3);
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Static variables used for thread synchronization
-*/
-static int inMutex = 0;
-#ifdef STQLITE_UNIX_THREADS
- static pthread_mutex_t mutex = PTHREAD_MUTEX_INITIALIZER;
-#endif
-#ifdef STQLITE_W32_THREADS
- static CRITICAL_SECTION cs;
-#endif
-#ifdef STQLITE_MACOS_MULTITASKING
- static MPCriticalRegionID criticalRegion;
-#endif
-
-/*
-** The following pair of routine implement mutual exclusion for
-** multi-threaded processes. Only a single thread is allowed to
-** executed code that is surrounded by EnterMutex() and LeaveMutex().
-**
-** STQLite uses only a single Mutex. There is not much critical
-** code and what little there is executes quickly and without blocking.
-*/
-void sqliteOsEnterMutex(){
-#ifdef STQLITE_UNIX_THREADS
- pthread_mutex_lock(&mutex);
-#endif
-#ifdef STQLITE_W32_THREADS
- static int isInit = 0;
- while( !isInit ){
- static long lock = 0;
- if( InterlockedIncrement(&lock)==1 ){
- InitializeCriticalSection(&cs);
- isInit = 1;
- }else{
- Sleep(1);
- }
- }
- EnterCriticalSection(&cs);
-#endif
-#ifdef STQLITE_MACOS_MULTITASKING
- static volatile int notInit = 1;
- if( notInit ){
- if( notInit == 2 ) /* as close as you can get to thread safe init */
- MPYield();
- else{
- notInit = 2;
- MPCreateCriticalRegion(&criticalRegion);
- notInit = 0;
- }
- }
- MPEnterCriticalRegion(criticalRegion, kDurationForever);
-#endif
- assert( !inMutex );
- inMutex = 1;
-}
-void sqliteOsLeaveMutex(){
- assert( inMutex );
- inMutex = 0;
-#ifdef STQLITE_UNIX_THREADS
- pthread_mutex_unlock(&mutex);
-#endif
-#ifdef STQLITE_W32_THREADS
- LeaveCriticalSection(&cs);
-#endif
-#ifdef STQLITE_MACOS_MULTITASKING
- MPExitCriticalRegion(criticalRegion);
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Turn a relative pathname into a full pathname. Return a pointer
-** to the full pathname stored in space obtained from sqliteMalloc().
-** The calling function is responsible for freeing this space once it
-** is no longer needed.
-*/
-char *sqliteOsFullPathname(const char *zRelative){
-#if OS_UNIX
- char *zFull = 0;
- if( zRelative[0]=='/' ){
- sqliteSetString(&zFull, zRelative, (char*)0);
- }else{
- char zBuf[5000];
- sqliteSetString(&zFull, getcwd(zBuf, sizeof(zBuf)), "/", zRelative,
- (char*)0);
- }
- return zFull;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- char *zNotUsed;
- char *zFull;
- int nByte;
- nByte = GetFullPathName(zRelative, 0, 0, &zNotUsed) + 1;
- zFull = sqliteMalloc( nByte );
- if( zFull==0 ) return 0;
- GetFullPathName(zRelative, nByte, zFull, &zNotUsed);
- return zFull;
-#endif
-#if OS_MAC
- char *zFull = 0;
- if( zRelative[0]==':' ){
- char zBuf[_MAX_PATH+1];
- sqliteSetString(&zFull, getcwd(zBuf, sizeof(zBuf)), &(zRelative[1]),
- (char*)0);
- }else{
- if( strchr(zRelative, ':') ){
- sqliteSetString(&zFull, zRelative, (char*)0);
- }else{
- char zBuf[_MAX_PATH+1];
- sqliteSetString(&zFull, getcwd(zBuf, sizeof(zBuf)), zRelative, (char*)0);
- }
- }
- return zFull;
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** The following variable, if set to a now-zero value, become the result
-** returned from sqliteOsCurrentTime(). This is used for testing.
-*/
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-int sqlite_current_time = 0;
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Find the current time (in Universal Coordinated Time). Write the
-** current time and date as a Julian Day number into *prNow and
-** return 0. Return 1 if the time and date cannot be found.
-*/
-int sqliteOsCurrentTime(double *prNow){
-#if OS_UNIX
- time_t t;
- time(&t);
- *prNow = t/86400.0 + 2440587.5;
-#endif
-#if OS_WIN
- FILETIME ft;
- /* FILETIME structure is a 64-bit value representing the number of
- 100-nanosecond intervals since January 1, 1601 (= JD 2305813.5).
- */
- double now;
- GetSystemTimeAsFileTime( &ft );
- now = ((double)ft.dwHighDateTime) * 4294967296.0;
- *prNow = (now + ft.dwLowDateTime)/864000000000.0 + 2305813.5;
-#endif
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
- if( sqlite_current_time ){
- *prNow = sqlite_current_time/86400.0 + 2440587.5;
- }
-#endif
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/os.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/os.h
deleted file mode 100644
index eb01b8d..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/os.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,192 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 16
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-******************************************************************************
-**
-** This header file (together with is companion C source-code file
-** "os.c") attempt to abstract the underlying operating system so that
-** the STQLite library will work on both POSIX and windows systems.
-*/
-#ifndef _STQLITE_OS_H_
-#define _STQLITE_OS_H_
-
-#include "config.h"
-/*
-** Helpful hint: To get this to compile on HP/UX, add -D_INCLUDE_POSIX_SOURCE
-** to the compiler command line.
-*/
-
-/*
-** These #defines should enable >2GB file support on Posix if the
-** underlying operating system supports it. If the OS lacks
-** large file support, or if the OS is windows, these should be no-ops.
-**
-** Large file support can be disabled using the -DSTQLITE_DISABLE_LFS switch
-** on the compiler command line. This is necessary if you are compiling
-** on a recent machine (ex: RedHat 7.2) but you want your code to work
-** on an older machine (ex: RedHat 6.0). If you compile on RedHat 7.2
-** without this option, LFS is enable. But LFS does not exist in the kernel
-** in RedHat 6.0, so the code won't work. Hence, for maximum binary
-** portability you should omit LFS.
-**
-** Similar is true for MacOS. LFS is only supported on MacOS 9 and later.
-*/
-#ifndef STQLITE_DISABLE_LFS
-# define _LARGE_FILE 1
-# ifndef _FILE_OFFSET_BITS
-# define _FILE_OFFSET_BITS 64
-# endif
-# define _LARGEFILE_SOURCE 1
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Temporary files are named starting with this prefix followed by 16 random
-** alphanumeric characters, and no file extension. They are stored in the
-** OS's standard temporary file directory, and are deleted prior to exit.
-** If sqlite is being embedded in another program, you may wish to change the
-** prefix to reflect your program's name, so that if your program exits
-** prematurely, old temporary files can be easily identified. This can be done
-** using -DTEMP_FILE_PREFIX=myprefix_ on the compiler command line.
-*/
-#ifndef TEMP_FILE_PREFIX
-# define TEMP_FILE_PREFIX "sqlite_"
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Figure out if we are dealing with Unix, Windows or MacOS.
-**
-** N.B. MacOS means Mac Classic (or Carbon). Treat Darwin (OS X) as Unix.
-** The MacOS build is designed to use CodeWarrior (tested with v8)
-*/
-#ifndef OS_UNIX
-# ifndef OS_WIN
-# ifndef OS_MAC
-# if defined(__MACOS__)
-# define OS_MAC 1
-# define OS_WIN 0
-# define OS_UNIX 0
-# elif defined(_WIN32) || defined(WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__) || defined(__MINGW32__) || defined(__BORLANDC__)
-# define OS_MAC 0
-# define OS_WIN 1
-# define OS_UNIX 0
-# else
-# define OS_MAC 0
-# define OS_WIN 0
-# define OS_UNIX 1
-# endif
-# else
-# define OS_WIN 0
-# define OS_UNIX 0
-# endif
-# else
-# define OS_MAC 0
-# define OS_UNIX 0
-# endif
-#else
-# define OS_MAC 0
-# ifndef OS_WIN
-# define OS_WIN 0
-# endif
-#endif
-
-/*
-** A handle for an open file is stored in an OsFile object.
-*/
-#if OS_UNIX
-# include <sys/types.h>
-# include <sys/stat.h>
-# include <fcntl.h>
-# include <unistd.h>
- typedef struct OsFile OsFile;
- struct OsFile {
- struct openCnt *pOpen; /* Info about all open fd's on this inode */
- struct lockInfo *pLock; /* Info about locks on this inode */
- int fd; /* The file descriptor */
- int locked; /* True if this instance holds the lock */
- int dirfd; /* File descriptor for the directory */
- };
-# define STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE 200
-# if defined(HAVE_USLEEP) && HAVE_USLEEP
-# define STQLITE_MIN_SLEEP_MS 1
-# else
-# define STQLITE_MIN_SLEEP_MS 1000
-# endif
-#endif
-
-#if OS_WIN
-#include <windows.h>
-#include <winbase.h>
- typedef struct OsFile OsFile;
- struct OsFile {
- HANDLE h; /* Handle for accessing the file */
- int locked; /* 0: unlocked, <0: write lock, >0: read lock */
- };
-# if defined(_MSC_VER) || defined(__BORLANDC__)
- typedef __int64 off_t;
-# else
-# if !defined(_CYGWIN_TYPES_H)
- typedef long long off_t;
-# if defined(__MINGW32__)
-# define _OFF_T_
-# endif
-# endif
-# endif
-# define STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE (MAX_PATH+50)
-# define STQLITE_MIN_SLEEP_MS 1
-#endif
-
-#if OS_MAC
-# include <unistd.h>
-# include <Files.h>
- typedef struct OsFile OsFile;
- struct OsFile {
- SInt16 refNum; /* Data fork/file reference number */
- SInt16 refNumRF; /* Resource fork reference number (for locking) */
- int locked; /* 0: unlocked, <0: write lock, >0: read lock */
- int delOnClose; /* True if file is to be deleted on close */
- char *pathToDel; /* Name of file to delete on close */
- };
-# ifdef _LARGE_FILE
- typedef SInt64 off_t;
-# else
- typedef SInt32 off_t;
-# endif
-# define STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE _MAX_PATH
-# define STQLITE_MIN_SLEEP_MS 17
-#endif
-
-int sqliteOsDelete(const char*);
-int sqliteOsFileExists(const char*);
-int sqliteOsFileRename(const char*, const char*);
-int sqliteOsOpenReadWrite(const char*, OsFile*, int*);
-int sqliteOsOpenExclusive(const char*, OsFile*, int);
-int sqliteOsOpenReadOnly(const char*, OsFile*);
-int sqliteOsOpenDirectory(const char*, OsFile*);
-int sqliteOsTempFileName(char*);
-int sqliteOsClose(OsFile*);
-int sqliteOsRead(OsFile*, void*, int amt);
-int sqliteOsWrite(OsFile*, const void*, int amt);
-int sqliteOsSeek(OsFile*, off_t offset);
-int sqliteOsSync(OsFile*);
-int sqliteOsTruncate(OsFile*, off_t size);
-int sqliteOsFileSize(OsFile*, off_t *pSize);
-int sqliteOsReadLock(OsFile*);
-int sqliteOsWriteLock(OsFile*);
-int sqliteOsUnlock(OsFile*);
-int sqliteOsRandomSeed(char*);
-int sqliteOsSleep(int ms);
-int sqliteOsCurrentTime(double*);
-void sqliteOsEnterMutex(void);
-void sqliteOsLeaveMutex(void);
-char *sqliteOsFullPathname(const char*);
-
-
-
-#endif /* _STQLITE_OS_H_ */
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pager.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pager.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 79d5813..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pager.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2220 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This is the implementation of the page cache subsystem or "pager".
-**
-** The pager is used to access a database disk file. It implements
-** atomic commit and rollback through the use of a journal file that
-** is separate from the database file. The pager also implements file
-** locking to prevent two processes from writing the same database
-** file simultaneously, or one process from reading the database while
-** another is writing.
-**
-** @(#) $Id: pager.c,v 1.101 2004/02/25 02:20:41 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "os.h" /* Must be first to enable large file support */
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include "pager.h"
-#include <assert.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
-/*
-** Macros for troubleshooting. Normally turned off
-*/
-#if 0
-static Pager *mainPager = 0;
-#define SET_PAGER(X) if( mainPager==0 ) mainPager = (X)
-#define CLR_PAGER(X) if( mainPager==(X) ) mainPager = 0
-#define TRACE1(X) if( pPager==mainPager ) fprintf(stderr,X)
-#define TRACE2(X,Y) if( pPager==mainPager ) fprintf(stderr,X,Y)
-#define TRACE3(X,Y,Z) if( pPager==mainPager ) fprintf(stderr,X,Y,Z)
-#else
-#define SET_PAGER(X)
-#define CLR_PAGER(X)
-#define TRACE1(X)
-#define TRACE2(X,Y)
-#define TRACE3(X,Y,Z)
-#endif
-
-
-/*
-** The page cache as a whole is always in one of the following
-** states:
-**
-** STQLITE_UNLOCK The page cache is not currently reading or
-** writing the database file. There is no
-** data held in memory. This is the initial
-** state.
-**
-** STQLITE_READLOCK The page cache is reading the database.
-** Writing is not permitted. There can be
-** multiple readers accessing the same database
-** file at the same time.
-**
-** STQLITE_WRITELOCK The page cache is writing the database.
-** Access is exclusive. No other processes or
-** threads can be reading or writing while one
-** process is writing.
-**
-** The page cache comes up in STQLITE_UNLOCK. The first time a
-** sqlite_page_get() occurs, the state transitions to STQLITE_READLOCK.
-** After all pages have been released using sqlite_page_unref(),
-** the state transitions back to STQLITE_UNLOCK. The first time
-** that sqlite_page_write() is called, the state transitions to
-** STQLITE_WRITELOCK. (Note that sqlite_page_write() can only be
-** called on an outstanding page which means that the pager must
-** be in STQLITE_READLOCK before it transitions to STQLITE_WRITELOCK.)
-** The sqlite_page_rollback() and sqlite_page_commit() functions
-** transition the state from STQLITE_WRITELOCK back to STQLITE_READLOCK.
-*/
-#define STQLITE_UNLOCK 0
-#define STQLITE_READLOCK 1
-#define STQLITE_WRITELOCK 2
-
-
-/*
-** Each in-memory image of a page begins with the following header.
-** This header is only visible to this pager module. The client
-** code that calls pager sees only the data that follows the header.
-**
-** Client code should call sqlitepager_write() on a page prior to making
-** any modifications to that page. The first time sqlitepager_write()
-** is called, the original page contents are written into the rollback
-** journal and PgHdr.inJournal and PgHdr.needSync are set. Later, once
-** the journal page has made it onto the disk surface, PgHdr.needSync
-** is cleared. The modified page cannot be written back into the original
-** database file until the journal pages has been synced to disk and the
-** PgHdr.needSync has been cleared.
-**
-** The PgHdr.dirty flag is set when sqlitepager_write() is called and
-** is cleared again when the page content is written back to the original
-** database file.
-*/
-typedef struct PgHdr PgHdr;
-struct PgHdr {
- Pager *pPager; /* The pager to which this page belongs */
- Pgno pgno; /* The page number for this page */
- PgHdr *pNextHash, *pPrevHash; /* Hash collision chain for PgHdr.pgno */
- int nRef; /* Number of users of this page */
- PgHdr *pNextFree, *pPrevFree; /* Freelist of pages where nRef==0 */
- PgHdr *pNextAll, *pPrevAll; /* A list of all pages */
- PgHdr *pNextCkpt, *pPrevCkpt; /* List of pages in the checkpoint journal */
- u8 inJournal; /* TRUE if has been written to journal */
- u8 inCkpt; /* TRUE if written to the checkpoint journal */
- u8 dirty; /* TRUE if we need to write back changes */
- u8 needSync; /* Sync journal before writing this page */
- u8 alwaysRollback; /* Disable dont_rollback() for this page */
- PgHdr *pDirty; /* Dirty pages sorted by PgHdr.pgno */
- /* STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE bytes of page data follow this header */
- /* Pager.nExtra bytes of local data follow the page data */
-};
-
-
-/*
-** A macro used for invoking the codec if there is one
-*/
-#ifdef STQLITE_HAS_CODEC
-# define CODEC(P,D,N,X) if( P->xCodec ){ P->xCodec(P->pCodecArg,D,N,X); }
-#else
-# define CODEC(P,D,N,X)
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Convert a pointer to a PgHdr into a pointer to its data
-** and back again.
-*/
-#define PGHDR_TO_DATA(P) ((void*)(&(P)[1]))
-#define DATA_TO_PGHDR(D) (&((PgHdr*)(D))[-1])
-#define PGHDR_TO_EXTRA(P) ((void*)&((char*)(&(P)[1]))[STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE])
-
-/*
-** How big to make the hash table used for locating in-memory pages
-** by page number.
-*/
-#define N_PG_HASH 2048
-
-/*
-** Hash a page number
-*/
-#define pager_hash(PN) ((PN)&(N_PG_HASH-1))
-
-/*
-** A open page cache is an instance of the following structure.
-*/
-struct Pager {
- char *zFilename; /* Name of the database file */
- char *zJournal; /* Name of the journal file */
- char *zDirectory; /* Directory hold database and journal files */
- OsFile fd, jfd; /* File descriptors for database and journal */
- OsFile cpfd; /* File descriptor for the checkpoint journal */
- int dbSize; /* Number of pages in the file */
- int origDbSize; /* dbSize before the current change */
- int ckptSize; /* Size of database (in pages) at ckpt_begin() */
- off_t ckptJSize; /* Size of journal at ckpt_begin() */
- int nRec; /* Number of pages written to the journal */
- u32 cksumInit; /* Quasi-random value added to every checksum */
- int ckptNRec; /* Number of records in the checkpoint journal */
- int nExtra; /* Add this many bytes to each in-memory page */
- void (*xDestructor)(void*); /* Call this routine when freeing pages */
- int nPage; /* Total number of in-memory pages */
- int nRef; /* Number of in-memory pages with PgHdr.nRef>0 */
- int mxPage; /* Maximum number of pages to hold in cache */
- int nHit, nMiss, nOvfl; /* Cache hits, missing, and LRU overflows */
- void (*xCodec)(void*,void*,Pgno,int); /* Routine for en/decoding data */
- void *pCodecArg; /* First argument to xCodec() */
- u8 journalOpen; /* True if journal file descriptors is valid */
- u8 journalStarted; /* True if header of journal is synced */
- u8 useJournal; /* Use a rollback journal on this file */
- u8 ckptOpen; /* True if the checkpoint journal is open */
- u8 ckptInUse; /* True we are in a checkpoint */
- u8 ckptAutoopen; /* Open ckpt journal when main journal is opened*/
- u8 noSync; /* Do not sync the journal if true */
- u8 fullSync; /* Do extra syncs of the journal for robustness */
- u8 state; /* STQLITE_UNLOCK, _READLOCK or _WRITELOCK */
- u8 errMask; /* One of several kinds of errors */
- u8 tempFile; /* zFilename is a temporary file */
- u8 readOnly; /* True for a read-only database */
- u8 needSync; /* True if an fsync() is needed on the journal */
- u8 dirtyFile; /* True if database file has changed in any way */
- u8 alwaysRollback; /* Disable dont_rollback() for all pages */
- u8 *aInJournal; /* One bit for each page in the database file */
- u8 *aInCkpt; /* One bit for each page in the database */
- PgHdr *pFirst, *pLast; /* List of free pages */
- PgHdr *pFirstSynced; /* First free page with PgHdr.needSync==0 */
- PgHdr *pAll; /* List of all pages */
- PgHdr *pCkpt; /* List of pages in the checkpoint journal */
- PgHdr *aHash[N_PG_HASH]; /* Hash table to map page number of PgHdr */
-};
-
-/*
-** These are bits that can be set in Pager.errMask.
-*/
-#define PAGER_ERR_FULL 0x01 /* a write() failed */
-#define PAGER_ERR_MEM 0x02 /* malloc() failed */
-#define PAGER_ERR_LOCK 0x04 /* error in the locking protocol */
-#define PAGER_ERR_CORRUPT 0x08 /* database or journal corruption */
-#define PAGER_ERR_DISK 0x10 /* general disk I/O error - bad hard drive? */
-
-/*
-** The journal file contains page records in the following
-** format.
-**
-** Actually, this structure is the complete page record for pager
-** formats less than 3. Beginning with format 3, this record is surrounded
-** by two checksums.
-*/
-typedef struct PageRecord PageRecord;
-struct PageRecord {
- Pgno pgno; /* The page number */
- char aData[STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE]; /* Original data for page pgno */
-};
-
-/*
-** Journal files begin with the following magic string. The data
-** was obtained from /dev/random. It is used only as a sanity check.
-**
-** There are three journal formats (so far). The 1st journal format writes
-** 32-bit integers in the byte-order of the host machine. New
-** formats writes integers as big-endian. All new journals use the
-** new format, but we have to be able to read an older journal in order
-** to rollback journals created by older versions of the library.
-**
-** The 3rd journal format (added for 2.8.0) adds additional sanity
-** checking information to the journal. If the power fails while the
-** journal is being written, semi-random garbage data might appear in
-** the journal file after power is restored. If an attempt is then made
-** to roll the journal back, the database could be corrupted. The additional
-** sanity checking data is an attempt to discover the garbage in the
-** journal and ignore it.
-**
-** The sanity checking information for the 3rd journal format consists
-** of a 32-bit checksum on each page of data. The checksum covers both
-** the page number and the STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE bytes of data for the page.
-** This cksum is initialized to a 32-bit random value that appears in the
-** journal file right after the header. The random initializer is important,
-** because garbage data that appears at the end of a journal is likely
-** data that was once in other files that have now been deleted. If the
-** garbage data came from an obsolete journal file, the checksums might
-** be correct. But by initializing the checksum to random value which
-** is different for every journal, we minimize that risk.
-*/
-static const unsigned char aJournalMagic1[] = {
- 0xd9, 0xd5, 0x05, 0xf9, 0x20, 0xa1, 0x63, 0xd4,
-};
-static const unsigned char aJournalMagic2[] = {
- 0xd9, 0xd5, 0x05, 0xf9, 0x20, 0xa1, 0x63, 0xd5,
-};
-static const unsigned char aJournalMagic3[] = {
- 0xd9, 0xd5, 0x05, 0xf9, 0x20, 0xa1, 0x63, 0xd6,
-};
-#define JOURNAL_FORMAT_1 1
-#define JOURNAL_FORMAT_2 2
-#define JOURNAL_FORMAT_3 3
-
-/*
-** The following integer determines what format to use when creating
-** new primary journal files. By default we always use format 3.
-** When testing, we can set this value to older journal formats in order to
-** make sure that newer versions of the library are able to rollback older
-** journal files.
-**
-** Note that checkpoint journals always use format 2 and omit the header.
-*/
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-int journal_format = 3;
-#else
-# define journal_format 3
-#endif
-
-/*
-** The size of the header and of each page in the journal varies according
-** to which journal format is being used. The following macros figure out
-** the sizes based on format numbers.
-*/
-#define JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(X) \
- (sizeof(aJournalMagic1) + sizeof(Pgno) + ((X)>=3)*2*sizeof(u32))
-#define JOURNAL_PG_SZ(X) \
- (STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE + sizeof(Pgno) + ((X)>=3)*sizeof(u32))
-
-/*
-** Enable reference count tracking here:
-*/
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
- int pager_refinfo_enable = 0;
- static void pager_refinfo(PgHdr *p){
- static int cnt = 0;
- if( !pager_refinfo_enable ) return;
- printf(
- "REFCNT: %4d addr=0x%08x nRef=%d\n",
- p->pgno, (int)PGHDR_TO_DATA(p), p->nRef
- );
- cnt++; /* Something to set a breakpoint on */
- }
-# define REFINFO(X) pager_refinfo(X)
-#else
-# define REFINFO(X)
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Read a 32-bit integer from the given file descriptor. Store the integer
-** that is read in *pRes. Return STQLITE_OK if everything worked, or an
-** error code is something goes wrong.
-**
-** If the journal format is 2 or 3, read a big-endian integer. If the
-** journal format is 1, read an integer in the native byte-order of the
-** host machine.
-*/
-static int read32bits(int format, OsFile *fd, u32 *pRes){
- u32 res;
- int rc;
- rc = sqliteOsRead(fd, &res, sizeof(res));
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK && format>JOURNAL_FORMAT_1 ){
- unsigned char ac[4];
- memcpy(ac, &res, 4);
- res = (ac[0]<<24) | (ac[1]<<16) | (ac[2]<<8) | ac[3];
- }
- *pRes = res;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Write a 32-bit integer into the given file descriptor. Return STQLITE_OK
-** on success or an error code is something goes wrong.
-**
-** If the journal format is 2 or 3, write the integer as 4 big-endian
-** bytes. If the journal format is 1, write the integer in the native
-** byte order. In normal operation, only formats 2 and 3 are used.
-** Journal format 1 is only used for testing.
-*/
-static int write32bits(OsFile *fd, u32 val){
- unsigned char ac[4];
- if( journal_format<=1 ){
- return sqliteOsWrite(fd, &val, 4);
- }
- ac[0] = (val>>24) & 0xff;
- ac[1] = (val>>16) & 0xff;
- ac[2] = (val>>8) & 0xff;
- ac[3] = val & 0xff;
- return sqliteOsWrite(fd, ac, 4);
-}
-
-/*
-** Write a 32-bit integer into a page header right before the
-** page data. This will overwrite the PgHdr.pDirty pointer.
-**
-** The integer is big-endian for formats 2 and 3 and native byte order
-** for journal format 1.
-*/
-static void store32bits(u32 val, PgHdr *p, int offset){
- unsigned char *ac;
- ac = &((unsigned char*)PGHDR_TO_DATA(p))[offset];
- if( journal_format<=1 ){
- memcpy(ac, &val, 4);
- }else{
- ac[0] = (val>>24) & 0xff;
- ac[1] = (val>>16) & 0xff;
- ac[2] = (val>>8) & 0xff;
- ac[3] = val & 0xff;
- }
-}
-
-
-/*
-** Convert the bits in the pPager->errMask into an approprate
-** return code.
-*/
-static int pager_errcode(Pager *pPager){
- int rc = STQLITE_OK;
- if( pPager->errMask & PAGER_ERR_LOCK ) rc = STQLITE_PROTOCOL;
- if( pPager->errMask & PAGER_ERR_DISK ) rc = STQLITE_IOERR;
- if( pPager->errMask & PAGER_ERR_FULL ) rc = STQLITE_FULL;
- if( pPager->errMask & PAGER_ERR_MEM ) rc = STQLITE_NOMEM;
- if( pPager->errMask & PAGER_ERR_CORRUPT ) rc = STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Add or remove a page from the list of all pages that are in the
-** checkpoint journal.
-**
-** The Pager keeps a separate list of pages that are currently in
-** the checkpoint journal. This helps the sqlitepager_ckpt_commit()
-** routine run MUCH faster for the common case where there are many
-** pages in memory but only a few are in the checkpoint journal.
-*/
-static void page_add_to_ckpt_list(PgHdr *pPg){
- Pager *pPager = pPg->pPager;
- if( pPg->inCkpt ) return;
- assert( pPg->pPrevCkpt==0 && pPg->pNextCkpt==0 );
- pPg->pPrevCkpt = 0;
- if( pPager->pCkpt ){
- pPager->pCkpt->pPrevCkpt = pPg;
- }
- pPg->pNextCkpt = pPager->pCkpt;
- pPager->pCkpt = pPg;
- pPg->inCkpt = 1;
-}
-static void page_remove_from_ckpt_list(PgHdr *pPg){
- if( !pPg->inCkpt ) return;
- if( pPg->pPrevCkpt ){
- assert( pPg->pPrevCkpt->pNextCkpt==pPg );
- pPg->pPrevCkpt->pNextCkpt = pPg->pNextCkpt;
- }else{
- assert( pPg->pPager->pCkpt==pPg );
- pPg->pPager->pCkpt = pPg->pNextCkpt;
- }
- if( pPg->pNextCkpt ){
- assert( pPg->pNextCkpt->pPrevCkpt==pPg );
- pPg->pNextCkpt->pPrevCkpt = pPg->pPrevCkpt;
- }
- pPg->pNextCkpt = 0;
- pPg->pPrevCkpt = 0;
- pPg->inCkpt = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Find a page in the hash table given its page number. Return
-** a pointer to the page or NULL if not found.
-*/
-static PgHdr *pager_lookup(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno){
- PgHdr *p = pPager->aHash[pager_hash(pgno)];
- while( p && p->pgno!=pgno ){
- p = p->pNextHash;
- }
- return p;
-}
-
-/*
-** Unlock the database and clear the in-memory cache. This routine
-** sets the state of the pager back to what it was when it was first
-** opened. Any outstanding pages are invalidated and subsequent attempts
-** to access those pages will likely result in a coredump.
-*/
-static void pager_reset(Pager *pPager){
- PgHdr *pPg, *pNext;
- for(pPg=pPager->pAll; pPg; pPg=pNext){
- pNext = pPg->pNextAll;
- sqliteFree(pPg);
- }
- pPager->pFirst = 0;
- pPager->pFirstSynced = 0;
- pPager->pLast = 0;
- pPager->pAll = 0;
- memset(pPager->aHash, 0, sizeof(pPager->aHash));
- pPager->nPage = 0;
- if( pPager->state>=STQLITE_WRITELOCK ){
- sqlitepager_rollback(pPager);
- }
- sqliteOsUnlock(&pPager->fd);
- pPager->state = STQLITE_UNLOCK;
- pPager->dbSize = -1;
- pPager->nRef = 0;
- assert( pPager->journalOpen==0 );
-}
-
-/*
-** When this routine is called, the pager has the journal file open and
-** a write lock on the database. This routine releases the database
-** write lock and acquires a read lock in its place. The journal file
-** is deleted and closed.
-**
-** TODO: Consider keeping the journal file open for temporary databases.
-** This might give a performance improvement on windows where opening
-** a file is an expensive operation.
-*/
-static int pager_unwritelock(Pager *pPager){
- int rc;
- PgHdr *pPg;
- if( pPager->state<STQLITE_WRITELOCK ) return STQLITE_OK;
- sqlitepager_ckpt_commit(pPager);
- if( pPager->ckptOpen ){
- sqliteOsClose(&pPager->cpfd);
- pPager->ckptOpen = 0;
- }
- if( pPager->journalOpen ){
- sqliteOsClose(&pPager->jfd);
- pPager->journalOpen = 0;
- sqliteOsDelete(pPager->zJournal);
- sqliteFree( pPager->aInJournal );
- pPager->aInJournal = 0;
- for(pPg=pPager->pAll; pPg; pPg=pPg->pNextAll){
- pPg->inJournal = 0;
- pPg->dirty = 0;
- pPg->needSync = 0;
- }
- }else{
- assert( pPager->dirtyFile==0 || pPager->useJournal==0 );
- }
- rc = sqliteOsReadLock(&pPager->fd);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- pPager->state = STQLITE_READLOCK;
- }else{
- /* This can only happen if a process does a BEGIN, then forks and the
- ** child process does the COMMIT. Because of the semantics of unix
- ** file locking, the unlock will fail.
- */
- pPager->state = STQLITE_UNLOCK;
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Compute and return a checksum for the page of data.
-**
-** This is not a real checksum. It is really just the sum of the
-** random initial value and the page number. We considered do a checksum
-** of the database, but that was found to be too slow.
-*/
-static u32 pager_cksum(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno, const char *aData){
- u32 cksum = pPager->cksumInit + pgno;
- return cksum;
-}
-
-/*
-** Read a single page from the journal file opened on file descriptor
-** jfd. Playback this one page.
-**
-** There are three different journal formats. The format parameter determines
-** which format is used by the journal that is played back.
-*/
-static int pager_playback_one_page(Pager *pPager, OsFile *jfd, int format){
- int rc;
- PgHdr *pPg; /* An existing page in the cache */
- PageRecord pgRec;
- u32 cksum;
-
- rc = read32bits(format, jfd, &pgRec.pgno);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ) return rc;
- rc = sqliteOsRead(jfd, &pgRec.aData, sizeof(pgRec.aData));
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ) return rc;
-
- /* Sanity checking on the page. This is more important that I originally
- ** thought. If a power failure occurs while the journal is being written,
- ** it could cause invalid data to be written into the journal. We need to
- ** detect this invalid data (with high probability) and ignore it.
- */
- if( pgRec.pgno==0 ){
- return STQLITE_DONE;
- }
- if( pgRec.pgno>(unsigned)pPager->dbSize ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- if( format>=JOURNAL_FORMAT_3 ){
- rc = read32bits(format, jfd, &cksum);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- if( pager_cksum(pPager, pgRec.pgno, pgRec.aData)!=cksum ){
- return STQLITE_DONE;
- }
- }
-
- /* Playback the page. Update the in-memory copy of the page
- ** at the same time, if there is one.
- */
- pPg = pager_lookup(pPager, pgRec.pgno);
- TRACE2("PLAYBACK %d\n", pgRec.pgno);
- sqliteOsSeek(&pPager->fd, (pgRec.pgno-1)*(off_t)STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- rc = sqliteOsWrite(&pPager->fd, pgRec.aData, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- if( pPg ){
- /* No page should ever be rolled back that is in use, except for page
- ** 1 which is held in use in order to keep the lock on the database
- ** active.
- */
- assert( pPg->nRef==0 || pPg->pgno==1 );
- memcpy(PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg), pgRec.aData, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- memset(PGHDR_TO_EXTRA(pPg), 0, pPager->nExtra);
- pPg->dirty = 0;
- pPg->needSync = 0;
- CODEC(pPager, PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg), pPg->pgno, 3);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Playback the journal and thus restore the database file to
-** the state it was in before we started making changes.
-**
-** The journal file format is as follows:
-**
-** * 8 byte prefix. One of the aJournalMagic123 vectors defined
-** above. The format of the journal file is determined by which
-** of the three prefix vectors is seen.
-** * 4 byte big-endian integer which is the number of valid page records
-** in the journal. If this value is 0xffffffff, then compute the
-** number of page records from the journal size. This field appears
-** in format 3 only.
-** * 4 byte big-endian integer which is the initial value for the
-** sanity checksum. This field appears in format 3 only.
-** * 4 byte integer which is the number of pages to truncate the
-** database to during a rollback.
-** * Zero or more pages instances, each as follows:
-** + 4 byte page number.
-** + STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE bytes of data.
-** + 4 byte checksum (format 3 only)
-**
-** When we speak of the journal header, we mean the first 4 bullets above.
-** Each entry in the journal is an instance of the 5th bullet. Note that
-** bullets 2 and 3 only appear in format-3 journals.
-**
-** Call the value from the second bullet "nRec". nRec is the number of
-** valid page entries in the journal. In most cases, you can compute the
-** value of nRec from the size of the journal file. But if a power
-** failure occurred while the journal was being written, it could be the
-** case that the size of the journal file had already been increased but
-** the extra entries had not yet made it safely to disk. In such a case,
-** the value of nRec computed from the file size would be too large. For
-** that reason, we always use the nRec value in the header.
-**
-** If the nRec value is 0xffffffff it means that nRec should be computed
-** from the file size. This value is used when the user selects the
-** no-sync option for the journal. A power failure could lead to corruption
-** in this case. But for things like temporary table (which will be
-** deleted when the power is restored) we don't care.
-**
-** Journal formats 1 and 2 do not have an nRec value in the header so we
-** have to compute nRec from the file size. This has risks (as described
-** above) which is why all persistent tables have been changed to use
-** format 3.
-**
-** If the file opened as the journal file is not a well-formed
-** journal file then the database will likely already be
-** corrupted, so the PAGER_ERR_CORRUPT bit is set in pPager->errMask
-** and STQLITE_CORRUPT is returned. If it all works, then this routine
-** returns STQLITE_OK.
-*/
-static int pager_playback(Pager *pPager, int useJournalSize){
- off_t szJ; /* Size of the journal file in bytes */
- int nRec; /* Number of Records in the journal */
- int i; /* Loop counter */
- Pgno mxPg = 0; /* Size of the original file in pages */
- int format; /* Format of the journal file. */
- unsigned char aMagic[sizeof(aJournalMagic1)];
- int rc;
-
- /* Figure out how many records are in the journal. Abort early if
- ** the journal is empty.
- */
- assert( pPager->journalOpen );
- sqliteOsSeek(&pPager->jfd, 0);
- rc = sqliteOsFileSize(&pPager->jfd, &szJ);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- goto end_playback;
- }
-
- /* If the journal file is too small to contain a complete header,
- ** it must mean that the process that created the journal was just
- ** beginning to write the journal file when it died. In that case,
- ** the database file should have still been completely unchanged.
- ** Nothing needs to be rolled back. We can safely ignore this journal.
- */
- if( szJ < sizeof(aMagic)+sizeof(Pgno) ){
- goto end_playback;
- }
-
- /* Read the beginning of the journal and truncate the
- ** database file back to its original size.
- */
- rc = sqliteOsRead(&pPager->jfd, aMagic, sizeof(aMagic));
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = STQLITE_PROTOCOL;
- goto end_playback;
- }
- if( memcmp(aMagic, aJournalMagic3, sizeof(aMagic))==0 ){
- format = JOURNAL_FORMAT_3;
- }else if( memcmp(aMagic, aJournalMagic2, sizeof(aMagic))==0 ){
- format = JOURNAL_FORMAT_2;
- }else if( memcmp(aMagic, aJournalMagic1, sizeof(aMagic))==0 ){
- format = JOURNAL_FORMAT_1;
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_PROTOCOL;
- goto end_playback;
- }
- if( format>=JOURNAL_FORMAT_3 ){
- if( szJ < sizeof(aMagic) + 3*sizeof(u32) ){
- /* Ignore the journal if it is too small to contain a complete
- ** header. We already did this test once above, but at the prior
- ** test, we did not know the journal format and so we had to assume
- ** the smallest possible header. Now we know the header is bigger
- ** than the minimum so we test again.
- */
- goto end_playback;
- }
- rc = read32bits(format, &pPager->jfd, (u32*)&nRec);
- if( rc ) goto end_playback;
- rc = read32bits(format, &pPager->jfd, &pPager->cksumInit);
- if( rc ) goto end_playback;
- if( nRec==0xffffffff || useJournalSize ){
- nRec = (szJ - JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(3))/JOURNAL_PG_SZ(3);
- }
- }else{
- nRec = (szJ - JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(2))/JOURNAL_PG_SZ(2);
- assert( nRec*JOURNAL_PG_SZ(2)+JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(2)==szJ );
- }
- rc = read32bits(format, &pPager->jfd, &mxPg);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- goto end_playback;
- }
- assert( pPager->origDbSize==0 || pPager->origDbSize==mxPg );
- rc = sqliteOsTruncate(&pPager->fd, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE*(off_t)mxPg);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- goto end_playback;
- }
- pPager->dbSize = mxPg;
-
- /* Copy original pages out of the journal and back into the database file.
- */
- for(i=0; i<nRec; i++){
- rc = pager_playback_one_page(pPager, &pPager->jfd, format);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- if( rc==STQLITE_DONE ){
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }
- break;
- }
- }
-
- /* Pages that have been written to the journal but never synced
- ** where not restored by the loop above. We have to restore those
- ** pages by reading them back from the original database.
- */
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- PgHdr *pPg;
- for(pPg=pPager->pAll; pPg; pPg=pPg->pNextAll){
- char zBuf[STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE];
- if( !pPg->dirty ) continue;
- if( (int)pPg->pgno <= pPager->origDbSize ){
- sqliteOsSeek(&pPager->fd, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE*(off_t)(pPg->pgno-1));
- rc = sqliteOsRead(&pPager->fd, zBuf, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- TRACE2("REFETCH %d\n", pPg->pgno);
- CODEC(pPager, zBuf, pPg->pgno, 2);
- if( rc ) break;
- }else{
- memset(zBuf, 0, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- }
- if( pPg->nRef==0 || memcmp(zBuf, PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg), STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE) ){
- memcpy(PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg), zBuf, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- memset(PGHDR_TO_EXTRA(pPg), 0, pPager->nExtra);
- }
- pPg->needSync = 0;
- pPg->dirty = 0;
- }
- }
-
-end_playback:
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- pager_unwritelock(pPager);
- pPager->errMask |= PAGER_ERR_CORRUPT;
- rc = STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- }else{
- rc = pager_unwritelock(pPager);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Playback the checkpoint journal.
-**
-** This is similar to playing back the transaction journal but with
-** a few extra twists.
-**
-** (1) The number of pages in the database file at the start of
-** the checkpoint is stored in pPager->ckptSize, not in the
-** journal file itself.
-**
-** (2) In addition to playing back the checkpoint journal, also
-** playback all pages of the transaction journal beginning
-** at offset pPager->ckptJSize.
-*/
-static int pager_ckpt_playback(Pager *pPager){
- off_t szJ; /* Size of the full journal */
- int nRec; /* Number of Records */
- int i; /* Loop counter */
- int rc;
-
- /* Truncate the database back to its original size.
- */
- rc = sqliteOsTruncate(&pPager->fd, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE*(off_t)pPager->ckptSize);
- pPager->dbSize = pPager->ckptSize;
-
- /* Figure out how many records are in the checkpoint journal.
- */
- assert( pPager->ckptInUse && pPager->journalOpen );
- sqliteOsSeek(&pPager->cpfd, 0);
- nRec = pPager->ckptNRec;
-
- /* Copy original pages out of the checkpoint journal and back into the
- ** database file. Note that the checkpoint journal always uses format
- ** 2 instead of format 3 since it does not need to be concerned with
- ** power failures corrupting the journal and can thus omit the checksums.
- */
- for(i=nRec-1; i>=0; i--){
- rc = pager_playback_one_page(pPager, &pPager->cpfd, 2);
- assert( rc!=STQLITE_DONE );
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ) goto end_ckpt_playback;
- }
-
- /* Figure out how many pages need to be copied out of the transaction
- ** journal.
- */
- rc = sqliteOsSeek(&pPager->jfd, pPager->ckptJSize);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- goto end_ckpt_playback;
- }
- rc = sqliteOsFileSize(&pPager->jfd, &szJ);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- goto end_ckpt_playback;
- }
- nRec = (szJ - pPager->ckptJSize)/JOURNAL_PG_SZ(journal_format);
- for(i=nRec-1; i>=0; i--){
- rc = pager_playback_one_page(pPager, &pPager->jfd, journal_format);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- assert( rc!=STQLITE_DONE );
- goto end_ckpt_playback;
- }
- }
-
-end_ckpt_playback:
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- pPager->errMask |= PAGER_ERR_CORRUPT;
- rc = STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the maximum number of in-memory pages that are allowed.
-**
-** The maximum number is the absolute value of the mxPage parameter.
-** If mxPage is negative, the noSync flag is also set. noSync bypasses
-** calls to sqliteOsSync(). The pager runs much faster with noSync on,
-** but if the operating system crashes or there is an abrupt power
-** failure, the database file might be left in an inconsistent and
-** unrepairable state.
-*/
-void sqlitepager_set_cachesize(Pager *pPager, int mxPage){
- if( mxPage>=0 ){
- pPager->noSync = pPager->tempFile;
- if( pPager->noSync==0 ) pPager->needSync = 0;
- }else{
- pPager->noSync = 1;
- mxPage = -mxPage;
- }
- if( mxPage>10 ){
- pPager->mxPage = mxPage;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Adjust the robustness of the database to damage due to OS crashes
-** or power failures by changing the number of syncs()s when writing
-** the rollback journal. There are three levels:
-**
-** OFF sqliteOsSync() is never called. This is the default
-** for temporary and transient files.
-**
-** NORMAL The journal is synced once before writes begin on the
-** database. This is normally adequate protection, but
-** it is theoretically possible, though very unlikely,
-** that an inopertune power failure could leave the journal
-** in a state which would cause damage to the database
-** when it is rolled back.
-**
-** FULL The journal is synced twice before writes begin on the
-** database (with some additional information - the nRec field
-** of the journal header - being written in between the two
-** syncs). If we assume that writing a
-** single disk sector is atomic, then this mode provides
-** assurance that the journal will not be corrupted to the
-** point of causing damage to the database during rollback.
-**
-** Numeric values associated with these states are OFF==1, NORMAL=2,
-** and FULL=3.
-*/
-void sqlitepager_set_safety_level(Pager *pPager, int level){
- pPager->noSync = level==1 || pPager->tempFile;
- pPager->fullSync = level==3 && !pPager->tempFile;
- if( pPager->noSync==0 ) pPager->needSync = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Open a temporary file. Write the name of the file into zName
-** (zName must be at least STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE bytes long.) Write
-** the file descriptor into *fd. Return STQLITE_OK on success or some
-** other error code if we fail.
-**
-** The OS will automatically delete the temporary file when it is
-** closed.
-*/
-static int sqlitepager_opentemp(char *zFile, OsFile *fd){
- int cnt = 8;
- int rc;
- do{
- cnt--;
- sqliteOsTempFileName(zFile);
- rc = sqliteOsOpenExclusive(zFile, fd, 1);
- }while( cnt>0 && rc!=STQLITE_OK );
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Create a new page cache and put a pointer to the page cache in *ppPager.
-** The file to be cached need not exist. The file is not locked until
-** the first call to sqlitepager_get() and is only held open until the
-** last page is released using sqlitepager_unref().
-**
-** If zFilename is NULL then a randomly-named temporary file is created
-** and used as the file to be cached. The file will be deleted
-** automatically when it is closed.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_open(
- Pager **ppPager, /* Return the Pager structure here */
- const char *zFilename, /* Name of the database file to open */
- int mxPage, /* Max number of in-memory cache pages */
- int nExtra, /* Extra bytes append to each in-memory page */
- int useJournal /* TRUE to use a rollback journal on this file */
-){
- Pager *pPager;
- char *zFullPathname;
- int nameLen;
- OsFile fd;
- int rc, i;
- int tempFile;
- int readOnly = 0;
- char zTemp[STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE];
-
- *ppPager = 0;
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ){
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- if( zFilename && zFilename[0] ){
- zFullPathname = sqliteOsFullPathname(zFilename);
- rc = sqliteOsOpenReadWrite(zFullPathname, &fd, &readOnly);
- tempFile = 0;
- }else{
- rc = sqlitepager_opentemp(zTemp, &fd);
- zFilename = zTemp;
- zFullPathname = sqliteOsFullPathname(zFilename);
- tempFile = 1;
- }
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ){
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteFree(zFullPathname);
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- nameLen = strlen(zFullPathname);
- pPager = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(*pPager) + nameLen*3 + 30 );
- if( pPager==0 ){
- sqliteOsClose(&fd);
- sqliteFree(zFullPathname);
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- SET_PAGER(pPager);
- pPager->zFilename = (char*)&pPager[1];
- pPager->zDirectory = &pPager->zFilename[nameLen+1];
- pPager->zJournal = &pPager->zDirectory[nameLen+1];
- strcpy(pPager->zFilename, zFullPathname);
- strcpy(pPager->zDirectory, zFullPathname);
- for(i=nameLen; i>0 && pPager->zDirectory[i-1]!='/'; i--){}
- if( i>0 ) pPager->zDirectory[i-1] = 0;
- strcpy(pPager->zJournal, zFullPathname);
- sqliteFree(zFullPathname);
- strcpy(&pPager->zJournal[nameLen], "-journal");
- pPager->fd = fd;
- pPager->journalOpen = 0;
- pPager->useJournal = useJournal;
- pPager->ckptOpen = 0;
- pPager->ckptInUse = 0;
- pPager->nRef = 0;
- pPager->dbSize = -1;
- pPager->ckptSize = 0;
- pPager->ckptJSize = 0;
- pPager->nPage = 0;
- pPager->mxPage = mxPage>5 ? mxPage : 10;
- pPager->state = STQLITE_UNLOCK;
- pPager->errMask = 0;
- pPager->tempFile = tempFile;
- pPager->readOnly = readOnly;
- pPager->needSync = 0;
- pPager->noSync = pPager->tempFile || !useJournal;
- pPager->pFirst = 0;
- pPager->pFirstSynced = 0;
- pPager->pLast = 0;
- pPager->nExtra = nExtra;
- memset(pPager->aHash, 0, sizeof(pPager->aHash));
- *ppPager = pPager;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Set the destructor for this pager. If not NULL, the destructor is called
-** when the reference count on each page reaches zero. The destructor can
-** be used to clean up information in the extra segment appended to each page.
-**
-** The destructor is not called as a result sqlitepager_close().
-** Destructors are only called by sqlitepager_unref().
-*/
-void sqlitepager_set_destructor(Pager *pPager, void (*xDesc)(void*)){
- pPager->xDestructor = xDesc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the total number of pages in the disk file associated with
-** pPager.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_pagecount(Pager *pPager){
- off_t n;
- assert( pPager!=0 );
- if( pPager->dbSize>=0 ){
- return pPager->dbSize;
- }
- if( sqliteOsFileSize(&pPager->fd, &n)!=STQLITE_OK ){
- pPager->errMask |= PAGER_ERR_DISK;
- return 0;
- }
- n /= STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE;
- if( pPager->state!=STQLITE_UNLOCK ){
- pPager->dbSize = n;
- }
- return n;
-}
-
-/*
-** Forward declaration
-*/
-static int syncJournal(Pager*);
-
-/*
-** Truncate the file to the number of pages specified.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_truncate(Pager *pPager, Pgno nPage){
- int rc;
- if( pPager->dbSize<0 ){
- sqlitepager_pagecount(pPager);
- }
- if( pPager->errMask!=0 ){
- rc = pager_errcode(pPager);
- return rc;
- }
- if( nPage>=(unsigned)pPager->dbSize ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- syncJournal(pPager);
- rc = sqliteOsTruncate(&pPager->fd, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE*(off_t)nPage);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- pPager->dbSize = nPage;
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Shutdown the page cache. Free all memory and close all files.
-**
-** If a transaction was in progress when this routine is called, that
-** transaction is rolled back. All outstanding pages are invalidated
-** and their memory is freed. Any attempt to use a page associated
-** with this page cache after this function returns will likely
-** result in a coredump.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_close(Pager *pPager){
- PgHdr *pPg, *pNext;
- switch( pPager->state ){
- case STQLITE_WRITELOCK: {
- sqlitepager_rollback(pPager);
- sqliteOsUnlock(&pPager->fd);
- assert( pPager->journalOpen==0 );
- break;
- }
- case STQLITE_READLOCK: {
- sqliteOsUnlock(&pPager->fd);
- break;
- }
- default: {
- /* Do nothing */
- break;
- }
- }
- for(pPg=pPager->pAll; pPg; pPg=pNext){
- pNext = pPg->pNextAll;
- sqliteFree(pPg);
- }
- sqliteOsClose(&pPager->fd);
- assert( pPager->journalOpen==0 );
- /* Temp files are automatically deleted by the OS
- ** if( pPager->tempFile ){
- ** sqliteOsDelete(pPager->zFilename);
- ** }
- */
- CLR_PAGER(pPager);
- if( pPager->zFilename!=(char*)&pPager[1] ){
- assert( 0 ); /* Cannot happen */
- sqliteFree(pPager->zFilename);
- sqliteFree(pPager->zJournal);
- sqliteFree(pPager->zDirectory);
- }
- sqliteFree(pPager);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the page number for the given page data.
-*/
-Pgno sqlitepager_pagenumber(void *pData){
- PgHdr *p = DATA_TO_PGHDR(pData);
- return p->pgno;
-}
-
-/*
-** Increment the reference count for a page. If the page is
-** currently on the freelist (the reference count is zero) then
-** remove it from the freelist.
-*/
-#define page_ref(P) ((P)->nRef==0?_page_ref(P):(void)(P)->nRef++)
-static void _page_ref(PgHdr *pPg){
- if( pPg->nRef==0 ){
- /* The page is currently on the freelist. Remove it. */
- if( pPg==pPg->pPager->pFirstSynced ){
- PgHdr *p = pPg->pNextFree;
- while( p && p->needSync ){ p = p->pNextFree; }
- pPg->pPager->pFirstSynced = p;
- }
- if( pPg->pPrevFree ){
- pPg->pPrevFree->pNextFree = pPg->pNextFree;
- }else{
- pPg->pPager->pFirst = pPg->pNextFree;
- }
- if( pPg->pNextFree ){
- pPg->pNextFree->pPrevFree = pPg->pPrevFree;
- }else{
- pPg->pPager->pLast = pPg->pPrevFree;
- }
- pPg->pPager->nRef++;
- }
- pPg->nRef++;
- REFINFO(pPg);
-}
-
-/*
-** Increment the reference count for a page. The input pointer is
-** a reference to the page data.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_ref(void *pData){
- PgHdr *pPg = DATA_TO_PGHDR(pData);
- page_ref(pPg);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Sync the journal. In other words, make sure all the pages that have
-** been written to the journal have actually reached the surface of the
-** disk. It is not safe to modify the original database file until after
-** the journal has been synced. If the original database is modified before
-** the journal is synced and a power failure occurs, the unsynced journal
-** data would be lost and we would be unable to completely rollback the
-** database changes. Database corruption would occur.
-**
-** This routine also updates the nRec field in the header of the journal.
-** (See comments on the pager_playback() routine for additional information.)
-** If the sync mode is FULL, two syncs will occur. First the whole journal
-** is synced, then the nRec field is updated, then a second sync occurs.
-**
-** For temporary databases, we do not care if we are able to rollback
-** after a power failure, so sync occurs.
-**
-** This routine clears the needSync field of every page current held in
-** memory.
-*/
-static int syncJournal(Pager *pPager){
- PgHdr *pPg;
- int rc = STQLITE_OK;
-
- /* Sync the journal before modifying the main database
- ** (assuming there is a journal and it needs to be synced.)
- */
- if( pPager->needSync ){
- if( !pPager->tempFile ){
- assert( pPager->journalOpen );
- /* assert( !pPager->noSync ); // noSync might be set if synchronous
- ** was turned off after the transaction was started. Ticket #615 */
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- {
- /* Make sure the pPager->nRec counter we are keeping agrees
- ** with the nRec computed from the size of the journal file.
- */
- off_t hdrSz, pgSz, jSz;
- hdrSz = JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(journal_format);
- pgSz = JOURNAL_PG_SZ(journal_format);
- rc = sqliteOsFileSize(&pPager->jfd, &jSz);
- if( rc!=0 ) return rc;
- assert( pPager->nRec*pgSz+hdrSz==jSz );
- }
-#endif
- if( journal_format>=3 ){
- /* Write the nRec value into the journal file header */
- off_t szJ;
- if( pPager->fullSync ){
- TRACE1("SYNC\n");
- rc = sqliteOsSync(&pPager->jfd);
- if( rc!=0 ) return rc;
- }
- sqliteOsSeek(&pPager->jfd, sizeof(aJournalMagic1));
- rc = write32bits(&pPager->jfd, pPager->nRec);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- szJ = JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(journal_format) +
- pPager->nRec*JOURNAL_PG_SZ(journal_format);
- sqliteOsSeek(&pPager->jfd, szJ);
- }
- TRACE1("SYNC\n");
- rc = sqliteOsSync(&pPager->jfd);
- if( rc!=0 ) return rc;
- pPager->journalStarted = 1;
- }
- pPager->needSync = 0;
-
- /* Erase the needSync flag from every page.
- */
- for(pPg=pPager->pAll; pPg; pPg=pPg->pNextAll){
- pPg->needSync = 0;
- }
- pPager->pFirstSynced = pPager->pFirst;
- }
-
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- /* If the Pager.needSync flag is clear then the PgHdr.needSync
- ** flag must also be clear for all pages. Verify that this
- ** invariant is true.
- */
- else{
- for(pPg=pPager->pAll; pPg; pPg=pPg->pNextAll){
- assert( pPg->needSync==0 );
- }
- assert( pPager->pFirstSynced==pPager->pFirst );
- }
-#endif
-
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Given a list of pages (connected by the PgHdr.pDirty pointer) write
-** every one of those pages out to the database file and mark them all
-** as clean.
-*/
-static int pager_write_pagelist(PgHdr *pList){
- Pager *pPager;
- int rc;
-
- if( pList==0 ) return STQLITE_OK;
- pPager = pList->pPager;
- while( pList ){
- assert( pList->dirty );
- sqliteOsSeek(&pPager->fd, (pList->pgno-1)*(off_t)STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- CODEC(pPager, PGHDR_TO_DATA(pList), pList->pgno, 6);
- TRACE2("STORE %d\n", pList->pgno);
- rc = sqliteOsWrite(&pPager->fd, PGHDR_TO_DATA(pList), STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- CODEC(pPager, PGHDR_TO_DATA(pList), pList->pgno, 0);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- pList->dirty = 0;
- pList = pList->pDirty;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Collect every dirty page into a dirty list and
-** return a pointer to the head of that list. All pages are
-** collected even if they are still in use.
-*/
-static PgHdr *pager_get_all_dirty_pages(Pager *pPager){
- PgHdr *p, *pList;
- pList = 0;
- for(p=pPager->pAll; p; p=p->pNextAll){
- if( p->dirty ){
- p->pDirty = pList;
- pList = p;
- }
- }
- return pList;
-}
-
-/*
-** Acquire a page.
-**
-** A read lock on the disk file is obtained when the first page is acquired.
-** This read lock is dropped when the last page is released.
-**
-** A _get works for any page number greater than 0. If the database
-** file is smaller than the requested page, then no actual disk
-** read occurs and the memory image of the page is initialized to
-** all zeros. The extra data appended to a page is always initialized
-** to zeros the first time a page is loaded into memory.
-**
-** The acquisition might fail for several reasons. In all cases,
-** an appropriate error code is returned and *ppPage is set to NULL.
-**
-** See also sqlitepager_lookup(). Both this routine and _lookup() attempt
-** to find a page in the in-memory cache first. If the page is not already
-** in memory, this routine goes to disk to read it in whereas _lookup()
-** just returns 0. This routine acquires a read-lock the first time it
-** has to go to disk, and could also playback an old journal if necessary.
-** Since _lookup() never goes to disk, it never has to deal with locks
-** or journal files.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_get(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno, void **ppPage){
- PgHdr *pPg;
- int rc;
-
- /* Make sure we have not hit any critical errors.
- */
- assert( pPager!=0 );
- assert( pgno!=0 );
- *ppPage = 0;
- if( pPager->errMask & ~(PAGER_ERR_FULL) ){
- return pager_errcode(pPager);
- }
-
- /* If this is the first page accessed, then get a read lock
- ** on the database file.
- */
- if( pPager->nRef==0 ){
- rc = sqliteOsReadLock(&pPager->fd);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- return rc;
- }
- pPager->state = STQLITE_READLOCK;
-
- /* If a journal file exists, try to play it back.
- */
- if( pPager->useJournal && sqliteOsFileExists(pPager->zJournal) ){
- int rc;
-
- /* Get a write lock on the database
- */
- rc = sqliteOsWriteLock(&pPager->fd);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- if( sqliteOsUnlock(&pPager->fd)!=STQLITE_OK ){
- /* This should never happen! */
- rc = STQLITE_INTERNAL;
- }
- return rc;
- }
- pPager->state = STQLITE_WRITELOCK;
-
- /* Open the journal for reading only. Return STQLITE_BUSY if
- ** we are unable to open the journal file.
- **
- ** The journal file does not need to be locked itself. The
- ** journal file is never open unless the main database file holds
- ** a write lock, so there is never any chance of two or more
- ** processes opening the journal at the same time.
- */
- rc = sqliteOsOpenReadOnly(pPager->zJournal, &pPager->jfd);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqliteOsUnlock(&pPager->fd);
- assert( rc==STQLITE_OK );
- return STQLITE_BUSY;
- }
- pPager->journalOpen = 1;
- pPager->journalStarted = 0;
-
- /* Playback and delete the journal. Drop the database write
- ** lock and reacquire the read lock.
- */
- rc = pager_playback(pPager, 0);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- return rc;
- }
- }
- pPg = 0;
- }else{
- /* Search for page in cache */
- pPg = pager_lookup(pPager, pgno);
- }
- if( pPg==0 ){
- /* The requested page is not in the page cache. */
- int h;
- pPager->nMiss++;
- if( pPager->nPage<pPager->mxPage || pPager->pFirst==0 ){
- /* Create a new page */
- pPg = sqliteMallocRaw( sizeof(*pPg) + STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE
- + sizeof(u32) + pPager->nExtra );
- if( pPg==0 ){
- pager_unwritelock(pPager);
- pPager->errMask |= PAGER_ERR_MEM;
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- memset(pPg, 0, sizeof(*pPg));
- pPg->pPager = pPager;
- pPg->pNextAll = pPager->pAll;
- if( pPager->pAll ){
- pPager->pAll->pPrevAll = pPg;
- }
- pPg->pPrevAll = 0;
- pPager->pAll = pPg;
- pPager->nPage++;
- }else{
- /* Find a page to recycle. Try to locate a page that does not
- ** require us to do an fsync() on the journal.
- */
- pPg = pPager->pFirstSynced;
-
- /* If we could not find a page that does not require an fsync()
- ** on the journal file then fsync the journal file. This is a
- ** very slow operation, so we work hard to avoid it. But sometimes
- ** it can't be helped.
- */
- if( pPg==0 ){
- int rc = syncJournal(pPager);
- if( rc!=0 ){
- sqlitepager_rollback(pPager);
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }
- pPg = pPager->pFirst;
- }
- assert( pPg->nRef==0 );
-
- /* Write the page to the database file if it is dirty.
- */
- if( pPg->dirty ){
- assert( pPg->needSync==0 );
- pPg->pDirty = 0;
- rc = pager_write_pagelist( pPg );
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqlitepager_rollback(pPager);
- return STQLITE_IOERR;
- }
- }
- assert( pPg->dirty==0 );
-
- /* If the page we are recycling is marked as alwaysRollback, then
- ** set the global alwaysRollback flag, thus disabling the
- ** sqlite_dont_rollback() optimization for the rest of this transaction.
- ** It is necessary to do this because the page marked alwaysRollback
- ** might be reloaded at a later time but at that point we won't remember
- ** that is was marked alwaysRollback. This means that all pages must
- ** be marked as alwaysRollback from here on out.
- */
- if( pPg->alwaysRollback ){
- pPager->alwaysRollback = 1;
- }
-
- /* Unlink the old page from the free list and the hash table
- */
- if( pPg==pPager->pFirstSynced ){
- PgHdr *p = pPg->pNextFree;
- while( p && p->needSync ){ p = p->pNextFree; }
- pPager->pFirstSynced = p;
- }
- if( pPg->pPrevFree ){
- pPg->pPrevFree->pNextFree = pPg->pNextFree;
- }else{
- assert( pPager->pFirst==pPg );
- pPager->pFirst = pPg->pNextFree;
- }
- if( pPg->pNextFree ){
- pPg->pNextFree->pPrevFree = pPg->pPrevFree;
- }else{
- assert( pPager->pLast==pPg );
- pPager->pLast = pPg->pPrevFree;
- }
- pPg->pNextFree = pPg->pPrevFree = 0;
- if( pPg->pNextHash ){
- pPg->pNextHash->pPrevHash = pPg->pPrevHash;
- }
- if( pPg->pPrevHash ){
- pPg->pPrevHash->pNextHash = pPg->pNextHash;
- }else{
- h = pager_hash(pPg->pgno);
- assert( pPager->aHash[h]==pPg );
- pPager->aHash[h] = pPg->pNextHash;
- }
- pPg->pNextHash = pPg->pPrevHash = 0;
- pPager->nOvfl++;
- }
- pPg->pgno = pgno;
- if( pPager->aInJournal && (int)pgno<=pPager->origDbSize ){
- sqliteCheckMemory(pPager->aInJournal, pgno/8);
- assert( pPager->journalOpen );
- pPg->inJournal = (pPager->aInJournal[pgno/8] & (1<<(pgno&7)))!=0;
- pPg->needSync = 0;
- }else{
- pPg->inJournal = 0;
- pPg->needSync = 0;
- }
- if( pPager->aInCkpt && (int)pgno<=pPager->ckptSize
- && (pPager->aInCkpt[pgno/8] & (1<<(pgno&7)))!=0 ){
- page_add_to_ckpt_list(pPg);
- }else{
- page_remove_from_ckpt_list(pPg);
- }
- pPg->dirty = 0;
- pPg->nRef = 1;
- REFINFO(pPg);
- pPager->nRef++;
- h = pager_hash(pgno);
- pPg->pNextHash = pPager->aHash[h];
- pPager->aHash[h] = pPg;
- if( pPg->pNextHash ){
- assert( pPg->pNextHash->pPrevHash==0 );
- pPg->pNextHash->pPrevHash = pPg;
- }
- if( pPager->nExtra>0 ){
- memset(PGHDR_TO_EXTRA(pPg), 0, pPager->nExtra);
- }
- if( pPager->dbSize<0 ) sqlitepager_pagecount(pPager);
- if( pPager->errMask!=0 ){
- sqlitepager_unref(PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg));
- rc = pager_errcode(pPager);
- return rc;
- }
- if( pPager->dbSize<(int)pgno ){
- memset(PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg), 0, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- }else{
- int rc;
- sqliteOsSeek(&pPager->fd, (pgno-1)*(off_t)STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- rc = sqliteOsRead(&pPager->fd, PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg), STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- TRACE2("FETCH %d\n", pPg->pgno);
- CODEC(pPager, PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg), pPg->pgno, 3);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- off_t fileSize;
- if( sqliteOsFileSize(&pPager->fd,&fileSize)!=STQLITE_OK
- || fileSize>=pgno*STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE ){
- sqlitepager_unref(PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg));
- return rc;
- }else{
- memset(PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg), 0, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- }
- }
- }
- }else{
- /* The requested page is in the page cache. */
- pPager->nHit++;
- page_ref(pPg);
- }
- *ppPage = PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg);
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Acquire a page if it is already in the in-memory cache. Do
-** not read the page from disk. Return a pointer to the page,
-** or 0 if the page is not in cache.
-**
-** See also sqlitepager_get(). The difference between this routine
-** and sqlitepager_get() is that _get() will go to the disk and read
-** in the page if the page is not already in cache. This routine
-** returns NULL if the page is not in cache or if a disk I/O error
-** has ever happened.
-*/
-void *sqlitepager_lookup(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno){
- PgHdr *pPg;
-
- assert( pPager!=0 );
- assert( pgno!=0 );
- if( pPager->errMask & ~(PAGER_ERR_FULL) ){
- return 0;
- }
- /* if( pPager->nRef==0 ){
- ** return 0;
- ** }
- */
- pPg = pager_lookup(pPager, pgno);
- if( pPg==0 ) return 0;
- page_ref(pPg);
- return PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg);
-}
-
-/*
-** Release a page.
-**
-** If the number of references to the page drop to zero, then the
-** page is added to the LRU list. When all references to all pages
-** are released, a rollback occurs and the lock on the database is
-** removed.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_unref(void *pData){
- PgHdr *pPg;
-
- /* Decrement the reference count for this page
- */
- pPg = DATA_TO_PGHDR(pData);
- assert( pPg->nRef>0 );
- pPg->nRef--;
- REFINFO(pPg);
-
- /* When the number of references to a page reach 0, call the
- ** destructor and add the page to the freelist.
- */
- if( pPg->nRef==0 ){
- Pager *pPager;
- pPager = pPg->pPager;
- pPg->pNextFree = 0;
- pPg->pPrevFree = pPager->pLast;
- pPager->pLast = pPg;
- if( pPg->pPrevFree ){
- pPg->pPrevFree->pNextFree = pPg;
- }else{
- pPager->pFirst = pPg;
- }
- if( pPg->needSync==0 && pPager->pFirstSynced==0 ){
- pPager->pFirstSynced = pPg;
- }
- if( pPager->xDestructor ){
- pPager->xDestructor(pData);
- }
-
- /* When all pages reach the freelist, drop the read lock from
- ** the database file.
- */
- pPager->nRef--;
- assert( pPager->nRef>=0 );
- if( pPager->nRef==0 ){
- pager_reset(pPager);
- }
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Create a journal file for pPager. There should already be a write
-** lock on the database file when this routine is called.
-**
-** Return STQLITE_OK if everything. Return an error code and release the
-** write lock if anything goes wrong.
-*/
-static int pager_open_journal(Pager *pPager){
- int rc;
- assert( pPager->state==STQLITE_WRITELOCK );
- assert( pPager->journalOpen==0 );
- assert( pPager->useJournal );
- sqlitepager_pagecount(pPager);
- pPager->aInJournal = sqliteMalloc( pPager->dbSize/8 + 1 );
- if( pPager->aInJournal==0 ){
- sqliteOsReadLock(&pPager->fd);
- pPager->state = STQLITE_READLOCK;
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- rc = sqliteOsOpenExclusive(pPager->zJournal, &pPager->jfd,pPager->tempFile);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteFree(pPager->aInJournal);
- pPager->aInJournal = 0;
- sqliteOsReadLock(&pPager->fd);
- pPager->state = STQLITE_READLOCK;
- return STQLITE_CANTOPEN;
- }
- sqliteOsOpenDirectory(pPager->zDirectory, &pPager->jfd);
- pPager->journalOpen = 1;
- pPager->journalStarted = 0;
- pPager->needSync = 0;
- pPager->alwaysRollback = 0;
- pPager->nRec = 0;
- if( pPager->errMask!=0 ){
- rc = pager_errcode(pPager);
- return rc;
- }
- pPager->origDbSize = pPager->dbSize;
- if( journal_format==JOURNAL_FORMAT_3 ){
- rc = sqliteOsWrite(&pPager->jfd, aJournalMagic3, sizeof(aJournalMagic3));
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = write32bits(&pPager->jfd, pPager->noSync ? 0xffffffff : 0);
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteRandomness(sizeof(pPager->cksumInit), &pPager->cksumInit);
- rc = write32bits(&pPager->jfd, pPager->cksumInit);
- }
- }else if( journal_format==JOURNAL_FORMAT_2 ){
- rc = sqliteOsWrite(&pPager->jfd, aJournalMagic2, sizeof(aJournalMagic2));
- }else{
- assert( journal_format==JOURNAL_FORMAT_1 );
- rc = sqliteOsWrite(&pPager->jfd, aJournalMagic1, sizeof(aJournalMagic1));
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = write32bits(&pPager->jfd, pPager->dbSize);
- }
- if( pPager->ckptAutoopen && rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqlitepager_ckpt_begin(pPager);
- }
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = pager_unwritelock(pPager);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = STQLITE_FULL;
- }
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Acquire a write-lock on the database. The lock is removed when
-** the any of the following happen:
-**
-** * sqlitepager_commit() is called.
-** * sqlitepager_rollback() is called.
-** * sqlitepager_close() is called.
-** * sqlitepager_unref() is called to on every outstanding page.
-**
-** The parameter to this routine is a pointer to any open page of the
-** database file. Nothing changes about the page - it is used merely
-** to acquire a pointer to the Pager structure and as proof that there
-** is already a read-lock on the database.
-**
-** A journal file is opened if this is not a temporary file. For
-** temporary files, the opening of the journal file is deferred until
-** there is an actual need to write to the journal.
-**
-** If the database is already write-locked, this routine is a no-op.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_begin(void *pData){
- PgHdr *pPg = DATA_TO_PGHDR(pData);
- Pager *pPager = pPg->pPager;
- int rc = STQLITE_OK;
- assert( pPg->nRef>0 );
- assert( pPager->state!=STQLITE_UNLOCK );
- if( pPager->state==STQLITE_READLOCK ){
- assert( pPager->aInJournal==0 );
- rc = sqliteOsWriteLock(&pPager->fd);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- return rc;
- }
- pPager->state = STQLITE_WRITELOCK;
- pPager->dirtyFile = 0;
- TRACE1("TRANSACTION\n");
- if( pPager->useJournal && !pPager->tempFile ){
- rc = pager_open_journal(pPager);
- }
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Mark a data page as writeable. The page is written into the journal
-** if it is not there already. This routine must be called before making
-** changes to a page.
-**
-** The first time this routine is called, the pager creates a new
-** journal and acquires a write lock on the database. If the write
-** lock could not be acquired, this routine returns STQLITE_BUSY. The
-** calling routine must check for that return value and be careful not to
-** change any page data until this routine returns STQLITE_OK.
-**
-** If the journal file could not be written because the disk is full,
-** then this routine returns STQLITE_FULL and does an immediate rollback.
-** All subsequent write attempts also return STQLITE_FULL until there
-** is a call to sqlitepager_commit() or sqlitepager_rollback() to
-** reset.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_write(void *pData){
- PgHdr *pPg = DATA_TO_PGHDR(pData);
- Pager *pPager = pPg->pPager;
- int rc = STQLITE_OK;
-
- /* Check for errors
- */
- if( pPager->errMask ){
- return pager_errcode(pPager);
- }
- if( pPager->readOnly ){
- return STQLITE_PERM;
- }
-
- /* Mark the page as dirty. If the page has already been written
- ** to the journal then we can return right away.
- */
- pPg->dirty = 1;
- if( pPg->inJournal && (pPg->inCkpt || pPager->ckptInUse==0) ){
- pPager->dirtyFile = 1;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
-
- /* If we get this far, it means that the page needs to be
- ** written to the transaction journal or the ckeckpoint journal
- ** or both.
- **
- ** First check to see that the transaction journal exists and
- ** create it if it does not.
- */
- assert( pPager->state!=STQLITE_UNLOCK );
- rc = sqlitepager_begin(pData);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- return rc;
- }
- assert( pPager->state==STQLITE_WRITELOCK );
- if( !pPager->journalOpen && pPager->useJournal ){
- rc = pager_open_journal(pPager);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ) return rc;
- }
- assert( pPager->journalOpen || !pPager->useJournal );
- pPager->dirtyFile = 1;
-
- /* The transaction journal now exists and we have a write lock on the
- ** main database file. Write the current page to the transaction
- ** journal if it is not there already.
- */
- if( !pPg->inJournal && pPager->useJournal ){
- if( (int)pPg->pgno <= pPager->origDbSize ){
- int szPg;
- u32 saved;
- if( journal_format>=JOURNAL_FORMAT_3 ){
- u32 cksum = pager_cksum(pPager, pPg->pgno, pData);
- saved = *(u32*)PGHDR_TO_EXTRA(pPg);
- store32bits(cksum, pPg, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- szPg = STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE+8;
- }else{
- szPg = STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE+4;
- }
- store32bits(pPg->pgno, pPg, -4);
- CODEC(pPager, pData, pPg->pgno, 7);
- rc = sqliteOsWrite(&pPager->jfd, &((char*)pData)[-4], szPg);
- TRACE3("JOURNAL %d %d\n", pPg->pgno, pPg->needSync);
- CODEC(pPager, pData, pPg->pgno, 0);
- if( journal_format>=JOURNAL_FORMAT_3 ){
- *(u32*)PGHDR_TO_EXTRA(pPg) = saved;
- }
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqlitepager_rollback(pPager);
- pPager->errMask |= PAGER_ERR_FULL;
- return rc;
- }
- pPager->nRec++;
- assert( pPager->aInJournal!=0 );
- pPager->aInJournal[pPg->pgno/8] |= 1<<(pPg->pgno&7);
- pPg->needSync = !pPager->noSync;
- pPg->inJournal = 1;
- if( pPager->ckptInUse ){
- pPager->aInCkpt[pPg->pgno/8] |= 1<<(pPg->pgno&7);
- page_add_to_ckpt_list(pPg);
- }
- }else{
- pPg->needSync = !pPager->journalStarted && !pPager->noSync;
- TRACE3("APPEND %d %d\n", pPg->pgno, pPg->needSync);
- }
- if( pPg->needSync ){
- pPager->needSync = 1;
- }
- }
-
- /* If the checkpoint journal is open and the page is not in it,
- ** then write the current page to the checkpoint journal. Note that
- ** the checkpoint journal always uses the simplier format 2 that lacks
- ** checksums. The header is also omitted from the checkpoint journal.
- */
- if( pPager->ckptInUse && !pPg->inCkpt && (int)pPg->pgno<=pPager->ckptSize ){
- assert( pPg->inJournal || (int)pPg->pgno>pPager->origDbSize );
- store32bits(pPg->pgno, pPg, -4);
- CODEC(pPager, pData, pPg->pgno, 7);
- rc = sqliteOsWrite(&pPager->cpfd, &((char*)pData)[-4], STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE+4);
- TRACE2("CKPT-JOURNAL %d\n", pPg->pgno);
- CODEC(pPager, pData, pPg->pgno, 0);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqlitepager_rollback(pPager);
- pPager->errMask |= PAGER_ERR_FULL;
- return rc;
- }
- pPager->ckptNRec++;
- assert( pPager->aInCkpt!=0 );
- pPager->aInCkpt[pPg->pgno/8] |= 1<<(pPg->pgno&7);
- page_add_to_ckpt_list(pPg);
- }
-
- /* Update the database size and return.
- */
- if( pPager->dbSize<(int)pPg->pgno ){
- pPager->dbSize = pPg->pgno;
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return TRUE if the page given in the argument was previously passed
-** to sqlitepager_write(). In other words, return TRUE if it is ok
-** to change the content of the page.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_iswriteable(void *pData){
- PgHdr *pPg = DATA_TO_PGHDR(pData);
- return pPg->dirty;
-}
-
-/*
-** Replace the content of a single page with the information in the third
-** argument.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_overwrite(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno, void *pData){
- void *pPage;
- int rc;
-
- rc = sqlitepager_get(pPager, pgno, &pPage);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqlitepager_write(pPage);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- memcpy(pPage, pData, STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE);
- }
- sqlitepager_unref(pPage);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** A call to this routine tells the pager that it is not necessary to
-** write the information on page "pgno" back to the disk, even though
-** that page might be marked as dirty.
-**
-** The overlying software layer calls this routine when all of the data
-** on the given page is unused. The pager marks the page as clean so
-** that it does not get written to disk.
-**
-** Tests show that this optimization, together with the
-** sqlitepager_dont_rollback() below, more than double the speed
-** of large INSERT operations and quadruple the speed of large DELETEs.
-**
-** When this routine is called, set the alwaysRollback flag to true.
-** Subsequent calls to sqlitepager_dont_rollback() for the same page
-** will thereafter be ignored. This is necessary to avoid a problem
-** where a page with data is added to the freelist during one part of
-** a transaction then removed from the freelist during a later part
-** of the same transaction and reused for some other purpose. When it
-** is first added to the freelist, this routine is called. When reused,
-** the dont_rollback() routine is called. But because the page contains
-** critical data, we still need to be sure it gets rolled back in spite
-** of the dont_rollback() call.
-*/
-void sqlitepager_dont_write(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno){
- PgHdr *pPg;
-
- pPg = pager_lookup(pPager, pgno);
- pPg->alwaysRollback = 1;
- if( pPg && pPg->dirty ){
- if( pPager->dbSize==(int)pPg->pgno && pPager->origDbSize<pPager->dbSize ){
- /* If this pages is the last page in the file and the file has grown
- ** during the current transaction, then do NOT mark the page as clean.
- ** When the database file grows, we must make sure that the last page
- ** gets written at least once so that the disk file will be the correct
- ** size. If you do not write this page and the size of the file
- ** on the disk ends up being too small, that can lead to database
- ** corruption during the next transaction.
- */
- }else{
- TRACE2("DONT_WRITE %d\n", pgno);
- pPg->dirty = 0;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** A call to this routine tells the pager that if a rollback occurs,
-** it is not necessary to restore the data on the given page. This
-** means that the pager does not have to record the given page in the
-** rollback journal.
-*/
-void sqlitepager_dont_rollback(void *pData){
- PgHdr *pPg = DATA_TO_PGHDR(pData);
- Pager *pPager = pPg->pPager;
-
- if( pPager->state!=STQLITE_WRITELOCK || pPager->journalOpen==0 ) return;
- if( pPg->alwaysRollback || pPager->alwaysRollback ) return;
- if( !pPg->inJournal && (int)pPg->pgno <= pPager->origDbSize ){
- assert( pPager->aInJournal!=0 );
- pPager->aInJournal[pPg->pgno/8] |= 1<<(pPg->pgno&7);
- pPg->inJournal = 1;
- if( pPager->ckptInUse ){
- pPager->aInCkpt[pPg->pgno/8] |= 1<<(pPg->pgno&7);
- page_add_to_ckpt_list(pPg);
- }
- TRACE2("DONT_ROLLBACK %d\n", pPg->pgno);
- }
- if( pPager->ckptInUse && !pPg->inCkpt && (int)pPg->pgno<=pPager->ckptSize ){
- assert( pPg->inJournal || (int)pPg->pgno>pPager->origDbSize );
- assert( pPager->aInCkpt!=0 );
- pPager->aInCkpt[pPg->pgno/8] |= 1<<(pPg->pgno&7);
- page_add_to_ckpt_list(pPg);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Commit all changes to the database and release the write lock.
-**
-** If the commit fails for any reason, a rollback attempt is made
-** and an error code is returned. If the commit worked, STQLITE_OK
-** is returned.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_commit(Pager *pPager){
- int rc;
- PgHdr *pPg;
-
- if( pPager->errMask==PAGER_ERR_FULL ){
- rc = sqlitepager_rollback(pPager);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = STQLITE_FULL;
- }
- return rc;
- }
- if( pPager->errMask!=0 ){
- rc = pager_errcode(pPager);
- return rc;
- }
- if( pPager->state!=STQLITE_WRITELOCK ){
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- TRACE1("COMMIT\n");
- if( pPager->dirtyFile==0 ){
- /* Exit early (without doing the time-consuming sqliteOsSync() calls)
- ** if there have been no changes to the database file. */
- assert( pPager->needSync==0 );
- rc = pager_unwritelock(pPager);
- pPager->dbSize = -1;
- return rc;
- }
- assert( pPager->journalOpen );
- rc = syncJournal(pPager);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- goto commit_abort;
- }
- pPg = pager_get_all_dirty_pages(pPager);
- if( pPg ){
- rc = pager_write_pagelist(pPg);
- if( rc || (!pPager->noSync && sqliteOsSync(&pPager->fd)!=STQLITE_OK) ){
- goto commit_abort;
- }
- }
- rc = pager_unwritelock(pPager);
- pPager->dbSize = -1;
- return rc;
-
- /* Jump here if anything goes wrong during the commit process.
- */
-commit_abort:
- rc = sqlitepager_rollback(pPager);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = STQLITE_FULL;
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Rollback all changes. The database falls back to read-only mode.
-** All in-memory cache pages revert to their original data contents.
-** The journal is deleted.
-**
-** This routine cannot fail unless some other process is not following
-** the correct locking protocol (STQLITE_PROTOCOL) or unless some other
-** process is writing trash into the journal file (STQLITE_CORRUPT) or
-** unless a prior malloc() failed (STQLITE_NOMEM). Appropriate error
-** codes are returned for all these occasions. Otherwise,
-** STQLITE_OK is returned.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_rollback(Pager *pPager){
- int rc;
- TRACE1("ROLLBACK\n");
- if( !pPager->dirtyFile || !pPager->journalOpen ){
- rc = pager_unwritelock(pPager);
- pPager->dbSize = -1;
- return rc;
- }
-
- if( pPager->errMask!=0 && pPager->errMask!=PAGER_ERR_FULL ){
- if( pPager->state>=STQLITE_WRITELOCK ){
- pager_playback(pPager, 1);
- }
- return pager_errcode(pPager);
- }
- if( pPager->state!=STQLITE_WRITELOCK ){
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- rc = pager_playback(pPager, 1);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- pPager->errMask |= PAGER_ERR_CORRUPT;
- }
- pPager->dbSize = -1;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return TRUE if the database file is opened read-only. Return FALSE
-** if the database is (in theory) writable.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_isreadonly(Pager *pPager){
- return pPager->readOnly;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is used for testing and analysis only.
-*/
-int *sqlitepager_stats(Pager *pPager){
- static int a[9];
- a[0] = pPager->nRef;
- a[1] = pPager->nPage;
- a[2] = pPager->mxPage;
- a[3] = pPager->dbSize;
- a[4] = pPager->state;
- a[5] = pPager->errMask;
- a[6] = pPager->nHit;
- a[7] = pPager->nMiss;
- a[8] = pPager->nOvfl;
- return a;
-}
-
-/*
-** Set the checkpoint.
-**
-** This routine should be called with the transaction journal already
-** open. A new checkpoint journal is created that can be used to rollback
-** changes of a single SQL command within a larger transaction.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_ckpt_begin(Pager *pPager){
- int rc;
- char zTemp[STQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE];
- if( !pPager->journalOpen ){
- pPager->ckptAutoopen = 1;
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- assert( pPager->journalOpen );
- assert( !pPager->ckptInUse );
- pPager->aInCkpt = sqliteMalloc( pPager->dbSize/8 + 1 );
- if( pPager->aInCkpt==0 ){
- sqliteOsReadLock(&pPager->fd);
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- rc = sqliteOsFileSize(&pPager->jfd, &pPager->ckptJSize);
- if( rc ) goto ckpt_begin_failed;
- assert( pPager->ckptJSize ==
- pPager->nRec*JOURNAL_PG_SZ(journal_format)+JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(journal_format) );
-#endif
- pPager->ckptJSize = pPager->nRec*JOURNAL_PG_SZ(journal_format)
- + JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(journal_format);
- pPager->ckptSize = pPager->dbSize;
- if( !pPager->ckptOpen ){
- rc = sqlitepager_opentemp(zTemp, &pPager->cpfd);
- if( rc ) goto ckpt_begin_failed;
- pPager->ckptOpen = 1;
- pPager->ckptNRec = 0;
- }
- pPager->ckptInUse = 1;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-
-ckpt_begin_failed:
- if( pPager->aInCkpt ){
- sqliteFree(pPager->aInCkpt);
- pPager->aInCkpt = 0;
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Commit a checkpoint.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_ckpt_commit(Pager *pPager){
- if( pPager->ckptInUse ){
- PgHdr *pPg, *pNext;
- sqliteOsSeek(&pPager->cpfd, 0);
- /* sqliteOsTruncate(&pPager->cpfd, 0); */
- pPager->ckptNRec = 0;
- pPager->ckptInUse = 0;
- sqliteFree( pPager->aInCkpt );
- pPager->aInCkpt = 0;
- for(pPg=pPager->pCkpt; pPg; pPg=pNext){
- pNext = pPg->pNextCkpt;
- assert( pPg->inCkpt );
- pPg->inCkpt = 0;
- pPg->pPrevCkpt = pPg->pNextCkpt = 0;
- }
- pPager->pCkpt = 0;
- }
- pPager->ckptAutoopen = 0;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-/*
-** Rollback a checkpoint.
-*/
-int sqlitepager_ckpt_rollback(Pager *pPager){
- int rc;
- if( pPager->ckptInUse ){
- rc = pager_ckpt_playback(pPager);
- sqlitepager_ckpt_commit(pPager);
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- }
- pPager->ckptAutoopen = 0;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the full pathname of the database file.
-*/
-const char *sqlitepager_filename(Pager *pPager){
- return pPager->zFilename;
-}
-
-/*
-** Set the codec for this pager
-*/
-void sqlitepager_set_codec(
- Pager *pPager,
- void (*xCodec)(void*,void*,Pgno,int),
- void *pCodecArg
-){
- pPager->xCodec = xCodec;
- pPager->pCodecArg = pCodecArg;
-}
-
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-/*
-** Print a listing of all referenced pages and their ref count.
-*/
-void sqlitepager_refdump(Pager *pPager){
- PgHdr *pPg;
- for(pPg=pPager->pAll; pPg; pPg=pPg->pNextAll){
- if( pPg->nRef<=0 ) continue;
- printf("PAGE %3d addr=0x%08x nRef=%d\n",
- pPg->pgno, (int)PGHDR_TO_DATA(pPg), pPg->nRef);
- }
-}
-#endif
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pager.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pager.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 31b305a..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pager.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,107 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This header file defines the interface that the sqlite page cache
-** subsystem. The page cache subsystem reads and writes a file a page
-** at a time and provides a journal for rollback.
-**
-** @(#) $Id: pager.h,v 1.26 2004/02/11 02:18:07 drh Exp $
-*/
-
-/*
-** The size of one page
-**
-** You can change this value to another (reasonable) value you want.
-** It need not be a power of two, though the interface to the disk
-** will likely be faster if it is.
-**
-** Experiments show that a page size of 1024 gives the best speed
-** for common usages. The speed differences for different sizes
-** such as 512, 2048, 4096, an so forth, is minimal. Note, however,
-** that changing the page size results in a completely imcompatible
-** file format.
-*/
-#ifndef STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE
-#define STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE 1024
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Number of extra bytes of data allocated at the end of each page and
-** stored on disk but not used by the higher level btree layer. Changing
-** this value results in a completely incompatible file format.
-*/
-#ifndef STQLITE_PAGE_RESERVE
-#define STQLITE_PAGE_RESERVE 0
-#endif
-
-/*
-** The total number of usable bytes stored on disk for each page.
-** The usable bytes come at the beginning of the page and the reserve
-** bytes come at the end.
-*/
-#define STQLITE_USABLE_SIZE (STQLITE_PAGE_SIZE-STQLITE_PAGE_RESERVE)
-
-/*
-** Maximum number of pages in one database. (This is a limitation of
-** imposed by 4GB files size limits.)
-*/
-#define STQLITE_MAX_PAGE 1073741823
-
-/*
-** The type used to represent a page number. The first page in a file
-** is called page 1. 0 is used to represent "not a page".
-*/
-typedef unsigned int Pgno;
-
-/*
-** Each open file is managed by a separate instance of the "Pager" structure.
-*/
-typedef struct Pager Pager;
-
-/*
-** See source code comments for a detailed description of the following
-** routines:
-*/
-int sqlitepager_open(Pager **ppPager, const char *zFilename,
- int nPage, int nExtra, int useJournal);
-void sqlitepager_set_destructor(Pager*, void(*)(void*));
-void sqlitepager_set_cachesize(Pager*, int);
-int sqlitepager_close(Pager *pPager);
-int sqlitepager_get(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno, void **ppPage);
-void *sqlitepager_lookup(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno);
-int sqlitepager_ref(void*);
-int sqlitepager_unref(void*);
-Pgno sqlitepager_pagenumber(void*);
-int sqlitepager_write(void*);
-int sqlitepager_iswriteable(void*);
-int sqlitepager_overwrite(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno, void*);
-int sqlitepager_pagecount(Pager*);
-int sqlitepager_truncate(Pager*,Pgno);
-int sqlitepager_begin(void*);
-int sqlitepager_commit(Pager*);
-int sqlitepager_rollback(Pager*);
-int sqlitepager_isreadonly(Pager*);
-int sqlitepager_ckpt_begin(Pager*);
-int sqlitepager_ckpt_commit(Pager*);
-int sqlitepager_ckpt_rollback(Pager*);
-void sqlitepager_dont_rollback(void*);
-void sqlitepager_dont_write(Pager*, Pgno);
-int *sqlitepager_stats(Pager*);
-void sqlitepager_set_safety_level(Pager*,int);
-const char *sqlitepager_filename(Pager*);
-int sqlitepager_rename(Pager*, const char *zNewName);
-void sqlitepager_set_codec(Pager*,void(*)(void*,void*,Pgno,int),void*);
-
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
-void sqlitepager_refdump(Pager*);
-int pager_refinfo_enable;
-int journal_format;
-#endif
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/parse.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/parse.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 5ecb220..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/parse.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,4035 +0,0 @@
-/* Driver template for the LEMON parser generator.
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code.
-*/
-/* First off, code is include which follows the "include" declaration
-** in the input file. */
-#include <stdio.h>
-#line 33 "parse.y"
-
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include "parse.h"
-
-/*
-** An instance of this structure holds information about the
-** LIMIT clause of a SELECT statement.
-*/
-struct LimitVal {
- int limit; /* The LIMIT value. -1 if there is no limit */
- int offset; /* The OFFSET. 0 if there is none */
-};
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure describes the event of a
-** TRIGGER. "a" is the event type, one of TK_UPDATE, TK_INSERT,
-** TK_DELETE, or TK_INSTEAD. If the event is of the form
-**
-** UPDATE ON (a,b,c)
-**
-** Then the "b" IdList records the list "a,b,c".
-*/
-struct TrigEvent { int a; IdList * b; };
-
-
-#line 34 "parse.c"
-/* Next is all token values, in a form suitable for use by makeheaders.
-** This section will be null unless lemon is run with the -m switch.
-*/
-/*
-** These constants (all generated automatically by the parser generator)
-** specify the various kinds of tokens (terminals) that the parser
-** understands.
-**
-** Each symbol here is a terminal symbol in the grammar.
-*/
-/* Make sure the INTERFACE macro is defined.
-*/
-#ifndef INTERFACE
-# define INTERFACE 1
-#endif
-/* The next thing included is series of defines which control
-** various aspects of the generated parser.
-** YYCODETYPE is the data type used for storing terminal
-** and nonterminal numbers. "unsigned char" is
-** used if there are fewer than 250 terminals
-** and nonterminals. "int" is used otherwise.
-** YYNOCODE is a number of type YYCODETYPE which corresponds
-** to no legal terminal or nonterminal number. This
-** number is used to fill in empty Q_SLOTS of the hash
-** table.
-** YYFALLBACK If defined, this indicates that one or more tokens
-** have fall-back values which should be used if the
-** original value of the token will not parse.
-** YYACTIONTYPE is the data type used for storing terminal
-** and nonterminal numbers. "unsigned char" is
-** used if there are fewer than 250 rules and
-** states combined. "int" is used otherwise.
-** sqliteParserTOKENTYPE is the data type used for minor tokens given
-** directly to the parser from the tokenizer.
-** YYMINORTYPE is the data type used for all minor tokens.
-** This is typically a union of many types, one of
-** which is sqliteParserTOKENTYPE. The entry in the union
-** for base tokens is called "yy0".
-** YYSTACKDEPTH is the maximum depth of the parser's stack.
-** sqliteParserARG_SDECL A static variable declaration for the %extra_argument
-** sqliteParserARG_PDECL A parameter declaration for the %extra_argument
-** sqliteParserARG_STORE Code to store %extra_argument into yypParser
-** sqliteParserARG_FETCH Code to extract %extra_argument from yypParser
-** YYNSTATE the combined number of states.
-** YYNRULE the number of rules in the grammar
-** YYERRORSYMBOL is the code number of the error symbol. If not
-** defined, then do no error processing.
-*/
-/*  */
-#define YYCODETYPE unsigned char
-#define YYNOCODE 221
-#define YYACTIONTYPE unsigned short int
-#define sqliteParserTOKENTYPE Token
-typedef union {
- sqliteParserTOKENTYPE yy0;
- TriggerStep * yy19;
- struct LimitVal yy124;
- Select* yy179;
- Expr * yy182;
- Expr* yy242;
- struct TrigEvent yy290;
- Token yy298;
- SrcList* yy307;
- IdList* yy320;
- ExprList* yy322;
- int yy372;
- struct {int value; int mask;} yy407;
- int yy441;
-} YYMINORTYPE;
-#define YYSTACKDEPTH 100
-#define sqliteParserARG_SDECL Parse *pParse;
-#define sqliteParserARG_PDECL ,Parse *pParse
-#define sqliteParserARG_FETCH Parse *pParse = yypParser->pParse
-#define sqliteParserARG_STORE yypParser->pParse = pParse
-#define YYNSTATE 563
-#define YYNRULE 293
-#define YYERRORSYMBOL 131
-#define YYERRSYMDT yy441
-#define YYFALLBACK 1
-#define YY_NO_ACTION (YYNSTATE+YYNRULE+2)
-#define YY_ACCEPT_ACTION (YYNSTATE+YYNRULE+1)
-#define YY_ERROR_ACTION (YYNSTATE+YYNRULE)
-
-/* Next are that tables used to determine what action to take based on the
-** current state and lookahead token. These tables are used to implement
-** functions that take a state number and lookahead value and return an
-** action integer.
-**
-** Suppose the action integer is N. Then the action is determined as
-** follows
-**
-** 0 <= N < YYNSTATE Shift N. That is, push the lookahead
-** token onto the stack and goto state N.
-**
-** YYNSTATE <= N < YYNSTATE+YYNRULE Reduce by rule N-YYNSTATE.
-**
-** N == YYNSTATE+YYNRULE A syntax error has occurred.
-**
-** N == YYNSTATE+YYNRULE+1 The parser accepts its input.
-**
-** N == YYNSTATE+YYNRULE+2 No such action. Denotes unused
-** Q_SLOTS in the yy_action[] table.
-**
-** The action table is constructed as a single large table named yy_action[].
-** Given state S and lookahead X, the action is computed as
-**
-** yy_action[ yy_shift_ofst[S] + X ]
-**
-** If the index value yy_shift_ofst[S]+X is out of range or if the value
-** yy_lookahead[yy_shift_ofst[S]+X] is not equal to X or if yy_shift_ofst[S]
-** is equal to YY_SHIFT_USE_DFLT, it means that the action is not in the table
-** and that yy_default[S] should be used instead.
-**
-** The formula above is for computing the action when the lookahead is
-** a terminal symbol. If the lookahead is a non-terminal (as occurs after
-** a reduce action) then the yy_reduce_ofst[] array is used in place of
-** the yy_shift_ofst[] array and YY_REDUCE_USE_DFLT is used in place of
-** YY_SHIFT_USE_DFLT.
-**
-** The following are the tables generated in this section:
-**
-** yy_action[] A single table containing all actions.
-** yy_lookahead[] A table containing the lookahead for each entry in
-** yy_action. Used to detect hash collisions.
-** yy_shift_ofst[] For each state, the offset into yy_action for
-** shifting terminals.
-** yy_reduce_ofst[] For each state, the offset into yy_action for
-** shifting non-terminals after a reduce.
-** yy_default[] Default action for each state.
-*/
-static YYACTIONTYPE yy_action[] = {
- /* 0 */ 264, 5, 262, 119, 123, 117, 121, 129, 131, 133,
- /* 10 */ 135, 144, 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 568, 106, 106,
- /* 20 */ 143, 857, 1, 562, 3, 142, 129, 131, 133, 135,
- /* 30 */ 144, 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 174, 103, 8, 115,
- /* 40 */ 104, 139, 127, 125, 156, 161, 157, 162, 166, 119,
- /* 50 */ 123, 117, 121, 129, 131, 133, 135, 144, 146, 148,
- /* 60 */ 150, 152, 154, 31, 361, 392, 263, 143, 363, 369,
- /* 70 */ 374, 97, 142, 148, 150, 152, 154, 68, 75, 377,
- /* 80 */ 167, 64, 218, 46, 20, 289, 115, 104, 139, 127,
- /* 90 */ 125, 156, 161, 157, 162, 166, 119, 123, 117, 121,
- /* 100 */ 129, 131, 133, 135, 144, 146, 148, 150, 152, 154,
- /* 110 */ 193, 41, 336, 563, 44, 54, 60, 62, 308, 331,
- /* 120 */ 175, 20, 560, 561, 572, 333, 640, 18, 359, 144,
- /* 130 */ 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 143, 181, 179, 303, 18,
- /* 140 */ 142, 84, 86, 20, 177, 66, 67, 111, 21, 22,
- /* 150 */ 112, 105, 83, 792, 115, 104, 139, 127, 125, 156,
- /* 160 */ 161, 157, 162, 166, 119, 123, 117, 121, 129, 131,
- /* 170 */ 133, 135, 144, 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 790, 560,
- /* 180 */ 561, 46, 13, 113, 183, 21, 22, 534, 361, 2,
- /* 190 */ 3, 14, 363, 369, 374, 338, 361, 690, 544, 542,
- /* 200 */ 363, 369, 374, 377, 836, 143, 15, 21, 22, 16,
- /* 210 */ 142, 377, 44, 54, 60, 62, 308, 331, 396, 535,
- /* 220 */ 17, 9, 191, 333, 115, 104, 139, 127, 125, 156,
- /* 230 */ 161, 157, 162, 166, 119, 123, 117, 121, 129, 131,
- /* 240 */ 133, 135, 144, 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 571, 230,
- /* 250 */ 340, 343, 143, 20, 536, 537, 538, 142, 402, 337,
- /* 260 */ 398, 339, 357, 68, 346, 347, 32, 64, 266, 391,
- /* 270 */ 37, 115, 104, 139, 127, 125, 156, 161, 157, 162,
- /* 280 */ 166, 119, 123, 117, 121, 129, 131, 133, 135, 144,
- /* 290 */ 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 839, 193, 651, 291, 298,
- /* 300 */ 300, 221, 357, 43, 173, 689, 175, 251, 330, 36,
- /* 310 */ 37, 106, 232, 40, 335, 58, 137, 21, 22, 330,
- /* 320 */ 411, 143, 181, 179, 47, 59, 142, 358, 390, 174,
- /* 330 */ 177, 66, 67, 111, 448, 49, 112, 105, 583, 213,
- /* 340 */ 115, 104, 139, 127, 125, 156, 161, 157, 162, 166,
- /* 350 */ 119, 123, 117, 121, 129, 131, 133, 135, 144, 146,
- /* 360 */ 148, 150, 152, 154, 306, 301, 106, 249, 259, 113,
- /* 370 */ 183, 793, 70, 253, 281, 219, 20, 106, 20, 11,
- /* 380 */ 106, 482, 454, 444, 299, 143, 169, 10, 171, 172,
- /* 390 */ 142, 169, 73, 171, 172, 103, 688, 69, 174, 169,
- /* 400 */ 252, 171, 172, 12, 115, 104, 139, 127, 125, 156,
- /* 410 */ 161, 157, 162, 166, 119, 123, 117, 121, 129, 131,
- /* 420 */ 133, 135, 144, 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 95, 237,
- /* 430 */ 313, 20, 143, 295, 244, 424, 169, 142, 171, 172,
- /* 440 */ 21, 22, 21, 22, 219, 386, 316, 323, 325, 837,
- /* 450 */ 19, 115, 104, 139, 127, 125, 156, 161, 157, 162,
- /* 460 */ 166, 119, 123, 117, 121, 129, 131, 133, 135, 144,
- /* 470 */ 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 106, 661, 20, 264, 143,
- /* 480 */ 262, 844, 315, 169, 142, 171, 172, 333, 38, 842,
- /* 490 */ 10, 356, 348, 184, 421, 21, 22, 282, 115, 104,
- /* 500 */ 139, 127, 125, 156, 161, 157, 162, 166, 119, 123,
- /* 510 */ 117, 121, 129, 131, 133, 135, 144, 146, 148, 150,
- /* 520 */ 152, 154, 69, 254, 262, 251, 143, 639, 663, 35,
- /* 530 */ 65, 142, 726, 313, 283, 259, 185, 417, 419, 418,
- /* 540 */ 284, 21, 22, 690, 263, 115, 104, 139, 127, 125,
- /* 550 */ 156, 161, 157, 162, 166, 119, 123, 117, 121, 129,
- /* 560 */ 131, 133, 135, 144, 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 256,
- /* 570 */ 20, 791, 424, 143, 169, 52, 171, 172, 142, 169,
- /* 580 */ 24, 171, 172, 247, 53, 315, 26, 169, 263, 171,
- /* 590 */ 172, 253, 115, 164, 139, 127, 125, 156, 161, 157,
- /* 600 */ 162, 166, 119, 123, 117, 121, 129, 131, 133, 135,
- /* 610 */ 144, 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 426, 349, 252, 425,
- /* 620 */ 143, 262, 575, 297, 591, 142, 169, 296, 171, 172,
- /* 630 */ 169, 471, 171, 172, 21, 22, 427, 221, 91, 115,
- /* 640 */ 227, 139, 127, 125, 156, 161, 157, 162, 166, 119,
- /* 650 */ 123, 117, 121, 129, 131, 133, 135, 144, 146, 148,
- /* 660 */ 150, 152, 154, 388, 312, 106, 89, 143, 720, 376,
- /* 670 */ 387, 170, 142, 487, 666, 248, 320, 216, 319, 217,
- /* 680 */ 28, 459, 30, 305, 189, 263, 209, 104, 139, 127,
- /* 690 */ 125, 156, 161, 157, 162, 166, 119, 123, 117, 121,
- /* 700 */ 129, 131, 133, 135, 144, 146, 148, 150, 152, 154,
- /* 710 */ 106, 106, 809, 494, 143, 489, 106, 816, 33, 142,
- /* 720 */ 395, 234, 273, 217, 274, 420, 20, 545, 114, 481,
- /* 730 */ 137, 429, 576, 321, 116, 139, 127, 125, 156, 161,
- /* 740 */ 157, 162, 166, 119, 123, 117, 121, 129, 131, 133,
- /* 750 */ 135, 144, 146, 148, 150, 152, 154, 7, 322, 23,
- /* 760 */ 25, 27, 394, 68, 415, 416, 10, 64, 197, 477,
- /* 770 */ 577, 533, 266, 548, 578, 831, 276, 201, 520, 4,
- /* 780 */ 6, 245, 430, 557, 29, 266, 491, 106, 441, 497,
- /* 790 */ 21, 22, 205, 168, 443, 195, 193, 531, 276, 448,
- /* 800 */ 276, 808, 267, 272, 529, 174, 175, 318, 440, 341,
- /* 810 */ 344, 106, 342, 345, 69, 286, 68, 582, 69, 69,
- /* 820 */ 64, 540, 181, 179, 541, 328, 302, 366, 217, 118,
- /* 830 */ 177, 66, 67, 111, 34, 143, 112, 105, 445, 510,
- /* 840 */ 142, 215, 278, 800, 467, 276, 498, 503, 444, 193,
- /* 850 */ 106, 219, 486, 443, 42, 73, 231, 73, 45, 175,
- /* 860 */ 449, 39, 225, 229, 278, 451, 278, 68, 174, 113,
- /* 870 */ 183, 64, 371, 55, 106, 181, 179, 292, 69, 276,
- /* 880 */ 276, 69, 48, 177, 66, 67, 111, 224, 276, 112,
- /* 890 */ 105, 106, 481, 393, 106, 106, 63, 106, 106, 106,
- /* 900 */ 193, 653, 106, 467, 233, 51, 380, 437, 526, 120,
- /* 910 */ 175, 278, 122, 124, 219, 126, 128, 130, 69, 453,
- /* 920 */ 132, 106, 113, 183, 451, 106, 181, 179, 159, 106,
- /* 930 */ 106, 106, 518, 106, 177, 66, 67, 111, 106, 134,
- /* 940 */ 112, 105, 422, 136, 106, 278, 278, 138, 141, 145,
- /* 950 */ 720, 147, 106, 329, 275, 274, 149, 106, 852, 158,
- /* 960 */ 106, 106, 151, 106, 106, 351, 106, 352, 106, 464,
- /* 970 */ 153, 106, 106, 113, 183, 155, 106, 106, 163, 165,
- /* 980 */ 106, 176, 178, 106, 180, 106, 182, 106, 401, 190,
- /* 990 */ 192, 106, 106, 293, 210, 212, 106, 367, 214, 274,
- /* 1000 */ 372, 226, 274, 228, 381, 241, 274, 106, 106, 246,
- /* 1010 */ 280, 290, 106, 69, 375, 438, 472, 274, 422, 832,
- /* 1020 */ 106, 73, 474, 73, 458, 412, 462, 480, 464, 478,
- /* 1030 */ 466, 690, 515, 519, 475, 478, 516, 50, 479, 221,
- /* 1040 */ 690, 221, 56, 57, 61, 592, 71, 69, 593, 73,
- /* 1050 */ 72, 74, 245, 242, 93, 81, 76, 69, 77, 240,
- /* 1060 */ 78, 82, 79, 245, 85, 554, 80, 88, 87, 90,
- /* 1070 */ 92, 94, 96, 102, 100, 99, 101, 107, 109, 160,
- /* 1080 */ 154, 667, 98, 508, 108, 668, 110, 220, 211, 669,
- /* 1090 */ 137, 140, 188, 194, 186, 196, 187, 199, 198, 200,
- /* 1100 */ 203, 204, 202, 207, 206, 208, 221, 223, 222, 235,
- /* 1110 */ 236, 239, 238, 217, 250, 258, 243, 261, 279, 270,
- /* 1120 */ 271, 255, 257, 260, 269, 265, 285, 294, 277, 268,
- /* 1130 */ 287, 304, 309, 307, 327, 312, 288, 354, 389, 314,
- /* 1140 */ 364, 365, 370, 378, 379, 382, 310, 49, 311, 362,
- /* 1150 */ 368, 373, 317, 324, 326, 332, 350, 355, 383, 400,
- /* 1160 */ 353, 397, 399, 403, 404, 334, 405, 406, 407, 384,
- /* 1170 */ 413, 409, 824, 414, 360, 385, 829, 423, 410, 431,
- /* 1180 */ 428, 432, 830, 433, 434, 436, 439, 798, 799, 447,
- /* 1190 */ 442, 450, 727, 728, 446, 823, 452, 838, 455, 445,
- /* 1200 */ 456, 457, 408, 435, 460, 461, 463, 840, 465, 468,
- /* 1210 */ 470, 469, 476, 841, 483, 485, 843, 660, 662, 493,
- /* 1220 */ 806, 496, 473, 849, 499, 719, 501, 484, 488, 490,
- /* 1230 */ 492, 502, 504, 495, 500, 507, 505, 506, 509, 722,
- /* 1240 */ 513, 511, 512, 514, 517, 725, 528, 522, 524, 525,
- /* 1250 */ 527, 523, 807, 530, 810, 532, 811, 812, 813, 814,
- /* 1260 */ 817, 819, 539, 820, 818, 815, 521, 543, 546, 552,
- /* 1270 */ 556, 550, 850, 547, 549, 851, 555, 558, 551, 855,
- /* 1280 */ 553, 559,
-};
-static YYCODETYPE yy_lookahead[] = {
- /* 0 */ 21, 9, 23, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76,
- /* 10 */ 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 9, 140, 140,
- /* 20 */ 41, 132, 133, 134, 135, 46, 74, 75, 76, 77,
- /* 30 */ 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 158, 158, 138, 60,
- /* 40 */ 61, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 70,
- /* 50 */ 71, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, 80,
- /* 60 */ 81, 82, 83, 19, 90, 21, 87, 41, 94, 95,
- /* 70 */ 96, 192, 46, 80, 81, 82, 83, 19, 174, 105,
- /* 80 */ 19, 23, 204, 62, 23, 181, 60, 61, 62, 63,
- /* 90 */ 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73,
- /* 100 */ 74, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83,
- /* 110 */ 52, 90, 91, 0, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98,
- /* 120 */ 62, 23, 9, 10, 9, 104, 20, 12, 22, 78,
- /* 130 */ 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 41, 78, 79, 80, 12,
- /* 140 */ 46, 78, 79, 23, 86, 87, 88, 89, 87, 88,
- /* 150 */ 92, 93, 89, 127, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65,
- /* 160 */ 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75,
- /* 170 */ 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 14, 9,
- /* 180 */ 10, 62, 15, 125, 126, 87, 88, 140, 90, 134,
- /* 190 */ 135, 24, 94, 95, 96, 23, 90, 9, 78, 79,
- /* 200 */ 94, 95, 96, 105, 11, 41, 39, 87, 88, 42,
- /* 210 */ 46, 105, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 17, 99,
- /* 220 */ 53, 139, 128, 104, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65,
- /* 230 */ 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75,
- /* 240 */ 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 9, 19,
- /* 250 */ 78, 79, 41, 23, 207, 208, 209, 46, 57, 87,
- /* 260 */ 59, 89, 140, 19, 92, 93, 144, 23, 152, 147,
- /* 270 */ 148, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68,
- /* 280 */ 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77, 78,
- /* 290 */ 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 14, 52, 9, 182, 20,
- /* 300 */ 20, 113, 140, 156, 20, 20, 62, 22, 161, 147,
- /* 310 */ 148, 140, 20, 155, 156, 26, 200, 87, 88, 161,
- /* 320 */ 127, 41, 78, 79, 93, 36, 46, 165, 166, 158,
- /* 330 */ 86, 87, 88, 89, 53, 104, 92, 93, 9, 128,
- /* 340 */ 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69,
- /* 350 */ 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79,
- /* 360 */ 80, 81, 82, 83, 20, 194, 140, 183, 184, 125,
- /* 370 */ 126, 127, 146, 88, 19, 204, 23, 140, 23, 31,
- /* 380 */ 140, 100, 101, 102, 158, 41, 107, 99, 109, 110,
- /* 390 */ 46, 107, 111, 109, 110, 158, 20, 171, 158, 107,
- /* 400 */ 115, 109, 110, 170, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65,
- /* 410 */ 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75,
- /* 420 */ 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 191, 192,
- /* 430 */ 47, 23, 41, 80, 194, 140, 107, 46, 109, 110,
- /* 440 */ 87, 88, 87, 88, 204, 62, 100, 101, 102, 11,
- /* 450 */ 140, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68,
- /* 460 */ 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77, 78,
- /* 470 */ 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 140, 9, 23, 21, 41,
- /* 480 */ 23, 9, 99, 107, 46, 109, 110, 104, 149, 9,
- /* 490 */ 99, 152, 153, 158, 199, 87, 88, 146, 60, 61,
- /* 500 */ 62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71,
- /* 510 */ 72, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81,
- /* 520 */ 82, 83, 171, 115, 23, 22, 41, 20, 9, 22,
- /* 530 */ 19, 46, 9, 47, 183, 184, 201, 100, 101, 102,
- /* 540 */ 189, 87, 88, 19, 87, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64,
- /* 550 */ 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74,
- /* 560 */ 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 115,
- /* 570 */ 23, 14, 140, 41, 107, 34, 109, 110, 46, 107,
- /* 580 */ 138, 109, 110, 22, 43, 99, 138, 107, 87, 109,
- /* 590 */ 110, 88, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 67,
- /* 600 */ 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77,
- /* 610 */ 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 25, 19, 115, 28,
- /* 620 */ 41, 23, 9, 108, 113, 46, 107, 112, 109, 110,
- /* 630 */ 107, 199, 109, 110, 87, 88, 45, 113, 22, 60,
- /* 640 */ 61, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 70,
- /* 650 */ 71, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, 80,
- /* 660 */ 81, 82, 83, 161, 162, 140, 50, 41, 9, 139,
- /* 670 */ 168, 108, 46, 17, 111, 114, 91, 20, 93, 22,
- /* 680 */ 138, 22, 142, 158, 127, 87, 129, 61, 62, 63,
- /* 690 */ 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73,
- /* 700 */ 74, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83,
- /* 710 */ 140, 140, 9, 57, 41, 59, 140, 9, 145, 46,
- /* 720 */ 143, 20, 20, 22, 22, 49, 23, 19, 158, 158,
- /* 730 */ 200, 18, 9, 29, 158, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66,
- /* 740 */ 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76,
- /* 750 */ 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 11, 54, 13,
- /* 760 */ 14, 15, 16, 19, 55, 56, 99, 23, 15, 198,
- /* 770 */ 9, 63, 152, 27, 9, 99, 140, 24, 32, 136,
- /* 780 */ 137, 122, 205, 37, 141, 152, 130, 140, 211, 146,
- /* 790 */ 87, 88, 39, 146, 146, 42, 52, 51, 140, 53,
- /* 800 */ 140, 9, 182, 167, 58, 158, 62, 103, 95, 89,
- /* 810 */ 89, 140, 92, 92, 171, 182, 19, 9, 171, 171,
- /* 820 */ 23, 89, 78, 79, 92, 167, 20, 167, 22, 158,
- /* 830 */ 86, 87, 88, 89, 20, 41, 92, 93, 60, 196,
- /* 840 */ 46, 194, 206, 130, 196, 140, 100, 101, 102, 52,
- /* 850 */ 140, 204, 106, 146, 140, 111, 146, 111, 139, 62,
- /* 860 */ 212, 150, 68, 69, 206, 217, 206, 19, 158, 125,
- /* 870 */ 126, 23, 167, 48, 140, 78, 79, 80, 171, 140,
- /* 880 */ 140, 171, 139, 86, 87, 88, 89, 93, 140, 92,
- /* 890 */ 93, 140, 158, 146, 140, 140, 19, 140, 140, 140,
- /* 900 */ 52, 123, 140, 196, 194, 44, 167, 167, 116, 158,
- /* 910 */ 62, 206, 158, 158, 204, 158, 158, 158, 171, 212,
- /* 920 */ 158, 140, 125, 126, 217, 140, 78, 79, 62, 140,
- /* 930 */ 140, 140, 198, 140, 86, 87, 88, 89, 140, 158,
- /* 940 */ 92, 93, 22, 158, 140, 206, 206, 158, 158, 158,
- /* 950 */ 9, 158, 140, 20, 206, 22, 158, 140, 9, 93,
- /* 960 */ 140, 140, 158, 140, 140, 20, 140, 22, 140, 140,
- /* 970 */ 158, 140, 140, 125, 126, 158, 140, 140, 158, 158,
- /* 980 */ 140, 158, 158, 140, 158, 140, 158, 140, 146, 158,
- /* 990 */ 158, 140, 140, 140, 158, 158, 140, 20, 158, 22,
- /* 1000 */ 20, 158, 22, 158, 20, 158, 22, 140, 140, 158,
- /* 1010 */ 158, 158, 140, 171, 158, 20, 20, 22, 22, 99,
- /* 1020 */ 140, 111, 146, 111, 195, 158, 158, 20, 140, 22,
- /* 1030 */ 158, 103, 146, 20, 124, 22, 124, 164, 158, 113,
- /* 1040 */ 114, 113, 157, 139, 139, 113, 172, 171, 113, 111,
- /* 1050 */ 171, 173, 122, 119, 117, 180, 175, 171, 176, 120,
- /* 1060 */ 177, 121, 178, 122, 89, 116, 179, 154, 89, 154,
- /* 1070 */ 154, 118, 22, 151, 98, 157, 23, 113, 113, 93,
- /* 1080 */ 83, 111, 193, 195, 140, 111, 140, 140, 127, 111,
- /* 1090 */ 200, 200, 14, 19, 202, 20, 203, 140, 22, 20,
- /* 1100 */ 140, 20, 22, 140, 22, 20, 113, 186, 140, 140,
- /* 1110 */ 186, 157, 193, 22, 185, 115, 118, 186, 99, 116,
- /* 1120 */ 19, 140, 140, 140, 188, 140, 20, 113, 157, 187,
- /* 1130 */ 187, 20, 140, 139, 19, 162, 188, 20, 166, 140,
- /* 1140 */ 48, 19, 19, 48, 19, 97, 159, 104, 160, 140,
- /* 1150 */ 139, 139, 163, 163, 163, 151, 154, 152, 140, 21,
- /* 1160 */ 154, 140, 140, 140, 213, 164, 214, 99, 140, 159,
- /* 1170 */ 40, 215, 11, 38, 166, 160, 99, 140, 216, 130,
- /* 1180 */ 49, 140, 99, 99, 140, 19, 139, 9, 130, 169,
- /* 1190 */ 11, 14, 123, 123, 170, 9, 9, 14, 169, 60,
- /* 1200 */ 140, 103, 186, 186, 140, 63, 176, 9, 63, 123,
- /* 1210 */ 19, 140, 19, 9, 114, 176, 9, 9, 9, 186,
- /* 1220 */ 9, 186, 197, 9, 114, 9, 186, 140, 140, 140,
- /* 1230 */ 140, 176, 169, 140, 140, 103, 140, 186, 176, 9,
- /* 1240 */ 186, 123, 140, 197, 19, 9, 87, 140, 114, 140,
- /* 1250 */ 35, 186, 9, 140, 9, 152, 9, 9, 9, 9,
- /* 1260 */ 9, 9, 210, 9, 9, 9, 169, 210, 140, 140,
- /* 1270 */ 33, 152, 9, 20, 218, 9, 152, 218, 21, 9,
- /* 1280 */ 219, 140,
-};
-#define YY_SHIFT_USE_DFLT (-68)
-static short yy_shift_ofst[] = {
- /* 0 */ 170, 113, -68, 746, -8, -68, 8, 127, 288, 239,
- /* 10 */ 348, 167, -68, -68, -68, -68, -68, -68, 547, -68,
- /* 20 */ -68, -68, -68, 115, 613, 115, 723, 115, 761, 44,
- /* 30 */ 765, 547, 507, 814, 808, 98, -68, 501, -68, 21,
- /* 40 */ -68, 547, 119, -68, 667, -68, 231, 667, -68, 861,
- /* 50 */ -68, 541, -68, -68, 825, 289, 667, -68, -68, -68,
- /* 60 */ 667, -68, 877, 848, 511, 58, 932, 935, 744, -68,
- /* 70 */ 279, 938, -68, 515, -68, 561, 930, 934, 939, 937,
- /* 80 */ 940, -68, 63, -68, 975, -68, 979, -68, 616, 63,
- /* 90 */ -68, 63, -68, 953, 848, 1050, 848, 976, 289, -68,
- /* 100 */ 1053, -68, -68, 485, 848, -68, 964, 547, 965, 547,
- /* 110 */ -68, -68, -68, -68, 673, 848, 626, 848, -48, 848,
- /* 120 */ -48, 848, -48, 848, -48, 848, -67, 848, -67, 848,
- /* 130 */ 51, 848, 51, 848, 51, 848, 51, 848, -67, 794,
- /* 140 */ 848, -67, -68, -68, 848, -7, 848, -7, 848, 997,
- /* 150 */ 848, 997, 848, 997, 848, -68, -68, 866, -68, 986,
- /* 160 */ -68, -68, 848, 532, 848, -67, 61, 744, 284, 563,
- /* 170 */ 970, 974, 978, -68, 485, 848, 673, 848, -68, 848,
- /* 180 */ -68, 848, -68, 244, 26, 961, 557, 1078, -68, 848,
- /* 190 */ 94, 848, 485, 1074, 753, 1075, -68, 1076, 547, 1079,
- /* 200 */ -68, 1080, 547, 1081, -68, 1082, 547, 1085, -68, 848,
- /* 210 */ 164, 848, 211, 848, 485, 657, -68, 848, -68, -68,
- /* 220 */ 993, 547, -68, -68, -68, 848, 579, 848, 673, 230,
- /* 230 */ 744, 292, -68, 701, -68, 993, -68, 976, 289, -68,
- /* 240 */ 848, 485, 998, 848, 1091, 848, 485, -68, -68, 503,
- /* 250 */ -68, -68, -68, 408, -68, 454, -68, 1000, -68, 355,
- /* 260 */ 993, 457, -68, -68, 547, -68, -68, 1019, 1003, -68,
- /* 270 */ 1101, 547, 702, -68, 547, -68, 289, -68, -68, 848,
- /* 280 */ 485, 938, 376, 285, 1106, 457, 1019, 1003, -68, 797,
- /* 290 */ -21, -68, -68, 1014, 353, -68, -68, -68, -68, 280,
- /* 300 */ -68, 806, -68, 1111, -68, 344, 667, -68, 547, 1115,
- /* 310 */ -68, 486, -68, 547, -68, 346, 704, -68, 585, -68,
- /* 320 */ -68, -68, -68, 704, -68, 704, -68, 547, 933, -68,
- /* 330 */ -68, 1053, -68, 861, -68, -68, 172, -68, -68, -68,
- /* 340 */ 720, -68, -68, 721, -68, -68, -68, -68, 598, 63,
- /* 350 */ 945, -68, 63, 1117, -68, -68, -68, -68, 106, -26,
- /* 360 */ -68, 547, -68, 1092, 1122, 547, 977, 667, -68, 1123,
- /* 370 */ 547, 980, 667, -68, 848, 391, -68, 1095, 1125, 547,
- /* 380 */ 984, 1048, 547, 1115, -68, 383, 1043, -68, -68, -68,
- /* 390 */ -68, -68, 938, 329, 713, 201, 547, -68, 547, 1138,
- /* 400 */ 938, 467, 547, 591, 437, 1068, 547, 993, 1130, 193,
- /* 410 */ 1161, 848, 438, 1135, 709, -68, -68, 1077, 1083, 676,
- /* 420 */ 547, 920, 547, -68, -68, -68, -68, 1131, -68, -68,
- /* 430 */ 1049, 547, 1084, 547, 524, 1166, 547, 995, 288, 1178,
- /* 440 */ 1058, 1179, 281, 472, 778, 167, -68, 1069, 1070, 1177,
- /* 450 */ 1186, 1187, 281, 1183, 1139, 547, 1098, 547, 659, 547,
- /* 460 */ 1142, 848, 485, 1198, 1145, 848, 485, 1086, 547, 1191,
- /* 470 */ 547, 996, -68, 910, 480, 1193, 848, 1007, 848, 485,
- /* 480 */ 1204, 485, 1100, 547, 941, 1207, 656, 547, 1208, 547,
- /* 490 */ 1209, 547, 188, 1211, 547, 188, 1214, 519, 1110, 547,
- /* 500 */ 993, 941, 1216, 1139, 547, 928, 1132, 547, 659, 1230,
- /* 510 */ 1118, 547, 993, 1191, 912, 523, 1225, 848, 1013, 1236,
- /* 520 */ 1139, 547, 926, 1134, 547, 792, 1215, 1159, 1243, 703,
- /* 530 */ 1245, 501, 708, 120, 1247, 1248, 1249, 1250, 732, 1251,
- /* 540 */ 1252, 1254, 732, 1255, -68, 547, 1253, 1256, 1237, 501,
- /* 550 */ 1257, 547, 949, 1263, 501, 1266, -68, 1237, 547, 1270,
- /* 560 */ -68, -68, -68,
-};
-#define YY_REDUCE_USE_DFLT (-123)
-static short yy_reduce_ofst[] = {
- /* 0 */ -111, 55, -123, 643, -123, -123, -123, -100, 82, -123,
- /* 10 */ -123, 233, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, 310, -123,
- /* 20 */ -123, -123, -123, 442, -123, 448, -123, 542, -123, 540,
- /* 30 */ -123, 122, 573, -123, -123, 162, -123, 339, 711, 158,
- /* 40 */ -123, 714, 147, -123, 719, -123, -123, 743, -123, 873,
- /* 50 */ -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, 885, 904, -123, -123, -123,
- /* 60 */ 905, -123, -123, 525, -123, 171, -123, -123, 226, -123,
- /* 70 */ 874, 879, -123, 878, -96, 881, 882, 883, 884, 887,
- /* 80 */ 875, -123, 913, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, 915,
- /* 90 */ -123, 916, -123, -123, 237, -123, -121, 889, 918, -123,
- /* 100 */ 922, -123, -123, 890, 570, -123, -123, 944, -123, 946,
- /* 110 */ -123, -123, -123, -123, 890, 576, 890, 671, 890, 751,
- /* 120 */ 890, 754, 890, 755, 890, 757, 890, 758, 890, 759,
- /* 130 */ 890, 762, 890, 781, 890, 785, 890, 789, 890, 891,
- /* 140 */ 790, 890, -123, -123, 791, 890, 793, 890, 798, 890,
- /* 150 */ 804, 890, 812, 890, 817, 890, -123, -123, -123, -123,
- /* 160 */ -123, -123, 820, 890, 821, 890, 947, 647, 874, -123,
- /* 170 */ -123, -123, -123, -123, 890, 823, 890, 824, 890, 826,
- /* 180 */ 890, 828, 890, 335, 890, 892, 893, -123, -123, 831,
- /* 190 */ 890, 832, 890, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, 957, -123,
- /* 200 */ -123, -123, 960, -123, -123, -123, 963, -123, -123, 836,
- /* 210 */ 890, 837, 890, 840, 890, -123, -123, -122, -123, -123,
- /* 220 */ 921, 968, -123, -123, -123, 843, 890, 845, 890, 969,
- /* 230 */ 710, 874, -123, -123, -123, 924, -123, 919, 954, -123,
- /* 240 */ 847, 890, -123, 240, -123, 851, 890, -123, 184, 929,
- /* 250 */ -123, -123, -123, 981, -123, 982, -123, -123, -123, 983,
- /* 260 */ 931, 620, -123, -123, 985, -123, -123, 942, 936, -123,
- /* 270 */ -123, 636, -123, -123, 748, -123, 971, -123, -123, 852,
- /* 280 */ 890, 351, 874, 929, -123, 633, 943, 948, -123, 853,
- /* 290 */ 116, -123, -123, -123, 944, -123, -123, -123, -123, 890,
- /* 300 */ -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, 890, 994, -123, 992, 987,
- /* 310 */ 988, 973, -123, 999, -123, -123, 989, -123, -123, -123,
- /* 320 */ -123, -123, -123, 990, -123, 991, -123, 658, -123, -123,
- /* 330 */ -123, 1004, -123, 1001, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123,
- /* 340 */ -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, 1005, 1002,
- /* 350 */ -123, -123, 1006, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, 972, 1008,
- /* 360 */ -123, 1009, -123, -123, -123, 660, -123, 1011, -123, -123,
- /* 370 */ 705, -123, 1012, -123, 856, 530, -123, -123, -123, 739,
- /* 380 */ -123, -123, 1018, 1010, 1015, 502, -123, -123, -123, -123,
- /* 390 */ -123, -123, 747, 874, 577, -123, 1021, -123, 1022, -123,
- /* 400 */ 842, 874, 1023, 951, 952, -123, 1028, 1016, 956, 962,
- /* 410 */ -123, 867, 890, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123,
- /* 420 */ 295, -123, 1037, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123, -123,
- /* 430 */ -123, 1041, -123, 1044, 1017, -123, 740, -123, 1047, -123,
- /* 440 */ -123, -123, 648, 874, 1020, 1024, -123, -123, -123, -123,
- /* 450 */ -123, -123, 707, -123, 1029, 1060, -123, 829, 1030, 1064,
- /* 460 */ -123, 868, 890, -123, -123, 872, 890, -123, 1071, 1025,
- /* 470 */ 432, -123, -123, 876, 874, -123, 571, -123, 880, 890,
- /* 480 */ -123, 890, -123, 1087, 1039, -123, -123, 1088, -123, 1089,
- /* 490 */ -123, 1090, 1033, -123, 1093, 1035, -123, 874, -123, 1094,
- /* 500 */ 1040, 1055, -123, 1063, 1096, 1051, -123, 888, 1062, -123,
- /* 510 */ -123, 1102, 1054, 1046, 886, 874, -123, 734, -123, -123,
- /* 520 */ 1097, 1107, 1065, -123, 1109, -123, -123, -123, -123, 1113,
- /* 530 */ -123, 1103, -123, 47, -123, -123, -123, -123, 1052, -123,
- /* 540 */ -123, -123, 1057, -123, -123, 1128, -123, -123, 1056, 1119,
- /* 550 */ -123, 1129, 1061, -123, 1124, -123, -123, 1059, 1141, -123,
- /* 560 */ -123, -123, -123,
-};
-static YYACTIONTYPE yy_default[] = {
- /* 0 */ 570, 570, 564, 856, 856, 566, 856, 572, 856, 856,
- /* 10 */ 856, 856, 652, 655, 656, 657, 658, 659, 573, 574,
- /* 20 */ 591, 592, 593, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 30 */ 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 584, 594, 604, 586,
- /* 40 */ 603, 856, 856, 605, 651, 616, 856, 651, 617, 636,
- /* 50 */ 634, 856, 637, 638, 856, 708, 651, 618, 706, 707,
- /* 60 */ 651, 619, 856, 856, 737, 797, 743, 738, 856, 664,
- /* 70 */ 856, 856, 665, 673, 675, 682, 720, 711, 713, 701,
- /* 80 */ 715, 670, 856, 600, 856, 601, 856, 602, 716, 856,
- /* 90 */ 717, 856, 718, 856, 856, 702, 856, 709, 708, 703,
- /* 100 */ 856, 588, 710, 705, 856, 736, 856, 856, 739, 856,
- /* 110 */ 740, 741, 742, 744, 747, 856, 748, 856, 749, 856,
- /* 120 */ 750, 856, 751, 856, 752, 856, 753, 856, 754, 856,
- /* 130 */ 755, 856, 756, 856, 757, 856, 758, 856, 759, 856,
- /* 140 */ 856, 760, 761, 762, 856, 763, 856, 764, 856, 765,
- /* 150 */ 856, 766, 856, 767, 856, 768, 769, 856, 770, 856,
- /* 160 */ 773, 771, 856, 856, 856, 779, 856, 797, 856, 856,
- /* 170 */ 856, 856, 856, 782, 796, 856, 774, 856, 775, 856,
- /* 180 */ 776, 856, 777, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 787, 856,
- /* 190 */ 856, 856, 788, 856, 856, 856, 845, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 200 */ 846, 856, 856, 856, 847, 856, 856, 856, 848, 856,
- /* 210 */ 856, 856, 856, 856, 789, 856, 781, 797, 794, 795,
- /* 220 */ 690, 856, 691, 785, 772, 856, 856, 856, 780, 856,
- /* 230 */ 797, 856, 784, 856, 783, 690, 786, 709, 708, 704,
- /* 240 */ 856, 714, 856, 797, 712, 856, 721, 674, 685, 683,
- /* 250 */ 684, 692, 693, 856, 694, 856, 695, 856, 696, 856,
- /* 260 */ 690, 681, 589, 590, 856, 679, 680, 698, 700, 686,
- /* 270 */ 856, 856, 856, 699, 856, 803, 708, 805, 804, 856,
- /* 280 */ 697, 685, 856, 856, 856, 681, 698, 700, 687, 856,
- /* 290 */ 681, 676, 677, 856, 856, 678, 671, 672, 778, 856,
- /* 300 */ 735, 856, 745, 856, 746, 856, 651, 620, 856, 801,
- /* 310 */ 624, 621, 625, 856, 626, 856, 856, 627, 856, 630,
- /* 320 */ 631, 632, 633, 856, 628, 856, 629, 856, 856, 802,
- /* 330 */ 622, 856, 623, 636, 635, 606, 856, 607, 608, 609,
- /* 340 */ 856, 610, 613, 856, 611, 614, 612, 615, 595, 856,
- /* 350 */ 856, 596, 856, 856, 597, 599, 598, 587, 856, 856,
- /* 360 */ 641, 856, 644, 856, 856, 856, 856, 651, 645, 856,
- /* 370 */ 856, 856, 651, 646, 856, 651, 647, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 380 */ 856, 856, 856, 801, 624, 649, 856, 648, 650, 642,
- /* 390 */ 643, 585, 856, 856, 581, 856, 856, 579, 856, 856,
- /* 400 */ 856, 856, 856, 828, 856, 856, 856, 690, 833, 856,
- /* 410 */ 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 834, 835, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 420 */ 856, 856, 856, 733, 734, 825, 826, 856, 827, 580,
- /* 430 */ 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 440 */ 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 654, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 450 */ 856, 856, 856, 856, 653, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 460 */ 856, 856, 723, 856, 856, 856, 724, 856, 856, 731,
- /* 470 */ 856, 856, 732, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 729,
- /* 480 */ 856, 730, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 490 */ 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 500 */ 690, 856, 856, 653, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 510 */ 856, 856, 690, 731, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 520 */ 653, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 530 */ 856, 856, 856, 822, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856,
- /* 540 */ 856, 856, 856, 856, 821, 856, 856, 856, 854, 856,
- /* 550 */ 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 856, 853, 854, 856, 856,
- /* 560 */ 567, 569, 565,
-};
-#define YY_SZ_ACTTAB (sizeof(yy_action)/sizeof(yy_action[0]))
-
-/* The next table maps tokens into fallback tokens. If a construct
-** like the following:
-**
-** %fallback ID X Y Z.
-**
-** appears in the grammer, then ID becomes a fallback token for X, Y,
-** and Z. Whenever one of the tokens X, Y, or Z is input to the parser
-** but it does not parse, the type of the token is changed to ID and
-** the parse is retried before an error is thrown.
-*/
-#ifdef YYFALLBACK
-static const YYCODETYPE yyFallback[] = {
- 0, /* $ => nothing */
- 0, /* END_OF_FILE => nothing */
- 0, /* ILLEGAL => nothing */
- 0, /* SPACE => nothing */
- 0, /* UNCLOSED_STRING => nothing */
- 0, /* COMMENT => nothing */
- 0, /* FUNCTION => nothing */
- 0, /* COLUMN => nothing */
- 0, /* AGG_FUNCTION => nothing */
- 0, /* SEMI => nothing */
- 23, /* EXPLAIN => ID */
- 23, /* BEGIN => ID */
- 0, /* TRANSACTION => nothing */
- 0, /* COMMIT => nothing */
- 23, /* END => ID */
- 0, /* ROLLBACK => nothing */
- 0, /* CREATE => nothing */
- 0, /* TABLE => nothing */
- 23, /* TEMP => ID */
- 0, /* LP => nothing */
- 0, /* RP => nothing */
- 0, /* AS => nothing */
- 0, /* COMMA => nothing */
- 0, /* ID => nothing */
- 23, /* ABORT => ID */
- 23, /* AFTER => ID */
- 23, /* ASC => ID */
- 23, /* ATTACH => ID */
- 23, /* BEFORE => ID */
- 23, /* CASCADE => ID */
- 23, /* CLUSTER => ID */
- 23, /* CONFLICT => ID */
- 23, /* COPY => ID */
- 23, /* DATABASE => ID */
- 23, /* DEFERRED => ID */
- 23, /* DELIMITERS => ID */
- 23, /* DESC => ID */
- 23, /* DETACH => ID */
- 23, /* EACH => ID */
- 23, /* FAIL => ID */
- 23, /* FOR => ID */
- 23, /* GLOB => ID */
- 23, /* IGNORE => ID */
- 23, /* IMMEDIATE => ID */
- 23, /* INITIALLY => ID */
- 23, /* INSTEAD => ID */
- 23, /* LIKE => ID */
- 23, /* MATCH => ID */
- 23, /* KEY => ID */
- 23, /* OF => ID */
- 23, /* OFFSET => ID */
- 23, /* PRAGMA => ID */
- 23, /* RAISE => ID */
- 23, /* REPLACE => ID */
- 23, /* RESTRICT => ID */
- 23, /* ROW => ID */
- 23, /* STATEMENT => ID */
- 23, /* TRIGGER => ID */
- 23, /* VACUUM => ID */
- 23, /* VIEW => ID */
- 0, /* OR => nothing */
- 0, /* AND => nothing */
- 0, /* NOT => nothing */
- 0, /* EQ => nothing */
- 0, /* NE => nothing */
- 0, /* ISNULL => nothing */
- 0, /* NOTNULL => nothing */
- 0, /* IS => nothing */
- 0, /* BETWEEN => nothing */
- 0, /* IN => nothing */
- 0, /* GT => nothing */
- 0, /* GE => nothing */
- 0, /* LT => nothing */
- 0, /* LE => nothing */
- 0, /* BITAND => nothing */
- 0, /* BITOR => nothing */
- 0, /* LSHIFT => nothing */
- 0, /* RSHIFT => nothing */
- 0, /* PLUS => nothing */
- 0, /* MINUS => nothing */
- 0, /* STAR => nothing */
- 0, /* SLASH => nothing */
- 0, /* REM => nothing */
- 0, /* CONCAT => nothing */
- 0, /* UMINUS => nothing */
- 0, /* UPLUS => nothing */
- 0, /* BITNOT => nothing */
- 0, /* STRING => nothing */
- 0, /* JOIN_KW => nothing */
- 0, /* INTEGER => nothing */
- 0, /* CONSTRAINT => nothing */
- 0, /* DEFAULT => nothing */
- 0, /* FLOAT => nothing */
- 0, /* NULL => nothing */
- 0, /* PRIMARY => nothing */
- 0, /* UNITQUE => nothing */
- 0, /* CHECK => nothing */
- 0, /* REFERENCES => nothing */
- 0, /* COLLATE => nothing */
- 0, /* ON => nothing */
- 0, /* DELETE => nothing */
- 0, /* UPDATE => nothing */
- 0, /* INSERT => nothing */
- 0, /* SET => nothing */
- 0, /* DEFERRABLE => nothing */
- 0, /* FOREIGN => nothing */
- 0, /* DROP => nothing */
- 0, /* UNION => nothing */
- 0, /* ALL => nothing */
- 0, /* INTERSECT => nothing */
- 0, /* EXCEPT => nothing */
- 0, /* SELECT => nothing */
- 0, /* DISTINCT => nothing */
- 0, /* DOT => nothing */
- 0, /* FROM => nothing */
- 0, /* JOIN => nothing */
- 0, /* USING => nothing */
- 0, /* ORDER => nothing */
- 0, /* BY => nothing */
- 0, /* GROUP => nothing */
- 0, /* HAVING => nothing */
- 0, /* LIMIT => nothing */
- 0, /* WHERE => nothing */
- 0, /* INTO => nothing */
- 0, /* VALUES => nothing */
- 0, /* VARIABLE => nothing */
- 0, /* CASE => nothing */
- 0, /* WHEN => nothing */
- 0, /* THEN => nothing */
- 0, /* ELSE => nothing */
- 0, /* INDEX => nothing */
-};
-#endif /* YYFALLBACK */
-
-/* The following structure represents a single element of the
-** parser's stack. Information stored includes:
-**
-** + The state number for the parser at this level of the stack.
-**
-** + The value of the token stored at this level of the stack.
-** (In other words, the "major" token.)
-**
-** + The semantic value stored at this level of the stack. This is
-** the information used by the action routines in the grammar.
-** It is sometimes called the "minor" token.
-*/
-struct yyStackEntry {
- int stateno; /* The state-number */
- int major; /* The major token value. This is the code
- ** number for the token at this stack level */
- YYMINORTYPE minor; /* The user-supplied minor token value. This
- ** is the value of the token */
-};
-typedef struct yyStackEntry yyStackEntry;
-
-/* The state of the parser is completely contained in an instance of
-** the following structure */
-struct yyParser {
- int yyidx; /* Index of top element in stack */
- int yyerrcnt; /* Shifts left before out of the error */
- sqliteParserARG_SDECL /* A place to hold %extra_argument */
- yyStackEntry yystack[YYSTACKDEPTH]; /* The parser's stack */
-};
-typedef struct yyParser yyParser;
-
-#ifndef NDEBUG
-#include <stdio.h>
-static FILE *yyTraceFILE = 0;
-static char *yyTracePrompt = 0;
-#endif /* NDEBUG */
-
-#ifndef NDEBUG
-/*
-** Turn parser tracing on by giving a stream to which to write the trace
-** and a prompt to preface each trace message. Tracing is turned off
-** by making either argument NULL
-**
-** Inputs:
-** <ul>
-** <li> A FILE* to which trace output should be written.
-** If NULL, then tracing is turned off.
-** <li> A prefix string written at the beginning of every
-** line of trace output. If NULL, then tracing is
-** turned off.
-** </ul>
-**
-** Outputs:
-** None.
-*/
-void sqliteParserTrace(FILE *TraceFILE, char *zTracePrompt){
- yyTraceFILE = TraceFILE;
- yyTracePrompt = zTracePrompt;
- if( yyTraceFILE==0 ) yyTracePrompt = 0;
- else if( yyTracePrompt==0 ) yyTraceFILE = 0;
-}
-#endif /* NDEBUG */
-
-#ifndef NDEBUG
-/* For tracing shifts, the names of all terminals and nonterminals
-** are required. The following table supplies these names */
-static const char *yyTokenName[] = {
- "$", "END_OF_FILE", "ILLEGAL", "SPACE",
- "UNCLOSED_STRING", "COMMENT", "FUNCTION", "COLUMN",
- "AGG_FUNCTION", "SEMI", "EXPLAIN", "BEGIN",
- "TRANSACTION", "COMMIT", "END", "ROLLBACK",
- "CREATE", "TABLE", "TEMP", "LP",
- "RP", "AS", "COMMA", "ID",
- "ABORT", "AFTER", "ASC", "ATTACH",
- "BEFORE", "CASCADE", "CLUSTER", "CONFLICT",
- "COPY", "DATABASE", "DEFERRED", "DELIMITERS",
- "DESC", "DETACH", "EACH", "FAIL",
- "FOR", "GLOB", "IGNORE", "IMMEDIATE",
- "INITIALLY", "INSTEAD", "LIKE", "MATCH",
- "KEY", "OF", "OFFSET", "PRAGMA",
- "RAISE", "REPLACE", "RESTRICT", "ROW",
- "STATEMENT", "TRIGGER", "VACUUM", "VIEW",
- "OR", "AND", "NOT", "EQ",
- "NE", "ISNULL", "NOTNULL", "IS",
- "BETWEEN", "IN", "GT", "GE",
- "LT", "LE", "BITAND", "BITOR",
- "LSHIFT", "RSHIFT", "PLUS", "MINUS",
- "STAR", "SLASH", "REM", "CONCAT",
- "UMINUS", "UPLUS", "BITNOT", "STRING",
- "JOIN_KW", "INTEGER", "CONSTRAINT", "DEFAULT",
- "FLOAT", "NULL", "PRIMARY", "UNITQUE",
- "CHECK", "REFERENCES", "COLLATE", "ON",
- "DELETE", "UPDATE", "INSERT", "SET",
- "DEFERRABLE", "FOREIGN", "DROP", "UNION",
- "ALL", "INTERSECT", "EXCEPT", "SELECT",
- "DISTINCT", "DOT", "FROM", "JOIN",
- "USING", "ORDER", "BY", "GROUP",
- "HAVING", "LIMIT", "WHERE", "INTO",
- "VALUES", "VARIABLE", "CASE", "WHEN",
- "THEN", "ELSE", "INDEX", "error",
- "input", "cmdlist", "ecmd", "explain",
- "cmdx", "cmd", "trans_opt", "onconf",
- "nm", "create_table", "create_table_args", "temp",
- "columnlist", "conslist_opt", "select", "column",
- "columnid", "type", "carglist", "id",
- "ids", "typename", "signed", "carg",
- "ccons", "sortorder", "expr", "idxlist_opt",
- "refargs", "defer_subclause", "refarg", "refact",
- "init_deferred_pred_opt", "conslist", "tcons", "idxlist",
- "defer_subclause_opt", "orconf", "resolvetype", "oneselect",
- "multiselect_op", "distinct", "selcollist", "from",
- "where_opt", "groupby_opt", "having_opt", "orderby_opt",
- "limit_opt", "sclp", "as", "seltablist",
- "stl_prefix", "joinop", "dbnm", "on_opt",
- "using_opt", "seltablist_paren", "joinop2", "sortlist",
- "sortitem", "collate", "exprlist", "setlist",
- "insert_cmd", "inscollist_opt", "itemlist", "inscollist",
- "likeop", "case_operand", "case_exprlist", "case_else",
- "expritem", "uniqueflag", "idxitem", "plus_num",
- "minus_num", "plus_opt", "number", "trigger_decl",
- "trigger_cmd_list", "trigger_time", "trigger_event", "foreach_clause",
- "when_clause", "trigger_cmd", "database_kw_opt", "key_opt",
-};
-#endif /* NDEBUG */
-
-#ifndef NDEBUG
-/* For tracing reduce actions, the names of all rules are required.
-*/
-static const char *yyRuleName[] = {
- /* 0 */ "input ::= cmdlist",
- /* 1 */ "cmdlist ::= cmdlist ecmd",
- /* 2 */ "cmdlist ::= ecmd",
- /* 3 */ "ecmd ::= explain cmdx SEMI",
- /* 4 */ "ecmd ::= SEMI",
- /* 5 */ "cmdx ::= cmd",
- /* 6 */ "explain ::= EXPLAIN",
- /* 7 */ "explain ::=",
- /* 8 */ "cmd ::= BEGIN trans_opt onconf",
- /* 9 */ "trans_opt ::=",
- /* 10 */ "trans_opt ::= TRANSACTION",
- /* 11 */ "trans_opt ::= TRANSACTION nm",
- /* 12 */ "cmd ::= COMMIT trans_opt",
- /* 13 */ "cmd ::= END trans_opt",
- /* 14 */ "cmd ::= ROLLBACK trans_opt",
- /* 15 */ "cmd ::= create_table create_table_args",
- /* 16 */ "create_table ::= CREATE temp TABLE nm",
- /* 17 */ "temp ::= TEMP",
- /* 18 */ "temp ::=",
- /* 19 */ "create_table_args ::= LP columnlist conslist_opt RP",
- /* 20 */ "create_table_args ::= AS select",
- /* 21 */ "columnlist ::= columnlist COMMA column",
- /* 22 */ "columnlist ::= column",
- /* 23 */ "column ::= columnid type carglist",
- /* 24 */ "columnid ::= nm",
- /* 25 */ "id ::= ID",
- /* 26 */ "ids ::= ID",
- /* 27 */ "ids ::= STRING",
- /* 28 */ "nm ::= ID",
- /* 29 */ "nm ::= STRING",
- /* 30 */ "nm ::= JOIN_KW",
- /* 31 */ "type ::=",
- /* 32 */ "type ::= typename",
- /* 33 */ "type ::= typename LP signed RP",
- /* 34 */ "type ::= typename LP signed COMMA signed RP",
- /* 35 */ "typename ::= ids",
- /* 36 */ "typename ::= typename ids",
- /* 37 */ "signed ::= INTEGER",
- /* 38 */ "signed ::= PLUS INTEGER",
- /* 39 */ "signed ::= MINUS INTEGER",
- /* 40 */ "carglist ::= carglist carg",
- /* 41 */ "carglist ::=",
- /* 42 */ "carg ::= CONSTRAINT nm ccons",
- /* 43 */ "carg ::= ccons",
- /* 44 */ "carg ::= DEFAULT STRING",
- /* 45 */ "carg ::= DEFAULT ID",
- /* 46 */ "carg ::= DEFAULT INTEGER",
- /* 47 */ "carg ::= DEFAULT PLUS INTEGER",
- /* 48 */ "carg ::= DEFAULT MINUS INTEGER",
- /* 49 */ "carg ::= DEFAULT FLOAT",
- /* 50 */ "carg ::= DEFAULT PLUS FLOAT",
- /* 51 */ "carg ::= DEFAULT MINUS FLOAT",
- /* 52 */ "carg ::= DEFAULT NULL",
- /* 53 */ "ccons ::= NULL onconf",
- /* 54 */ "ccons ::= NOT NULL onconf",
- /* 55 */ "ccons ::= PRIMARY KEY sortorder onconf",
- /* 56 */ "ccons ::= UNITQUE onconf",
- /* 57 */ "ccons ::= CHECK LP expr RP onconf",
- /* 58 */ "ccons ::= REFERENCES nm idxlist_opt refargs",
- /* 59 */ "ccons ::= defer_subclause",
- /* 60 */ "ccons ::= COLLATE id",
- /* 61 */ "refargs ::=",
- /* 62 */ "refargs ::= refargs refarg",
- /* 63 */ "refarg ::= MATCH nm",
- /* 64 */ "refarg ::= ON DELETE refact",
- /* 65 */ "refarg ::= ON UPDATE refact",
- /* 66 */ "refarg ::= ON INSERT refact",
- /* 67 */ "refact ::= SET NULL",
- /* 68 */ "refact ::= SET DEFAULT",
- /* 69 */ "refact ::= CASCADE",
- /* 70 */ "refact ::= RESTRICT",
- /* 71 */ "defer_subclause ::= NOT DEFERRABLE init_deferred_pred_opt",
- /* 72 */ "defer_subclause ::= DEFERRABLE init_deferred_pred_opt",
- /* 73 */ "init_deferred_pred_opt ::=",
- /* 74 */ "init_deferred_pred_opt ::= INITIALLY DEFERRED",
- /* 75 */ "init_deferred_pred_opt ::= INITIALLY IMMEDIATE",
- /* 76 */ "conslist_opt ::=",
- /* 77 */ "conslist_opt ::= COMMA conslist",
- /* 78 */ "conslist ::= conslist COMMA tcons",
- /* 79 */ "conslist ::= conslist tcons",
- /* 80 */ "conslist ::= tcons",
- /* 81 */ "tcons ::= CONSTRAINT nm",
- /* 82 */ "tcons ::= PRIMARY KEY LP idxlist RP onconf",
- /* 83 */ "tcons ::= UNITQUE LP idxlist RP onconf",
- /* 84 */ "tcons ::= CHECK expr onconf",
- /* 85 */ "tcons ::= FOREIGN KEY LP idxlist RP REFERENCES nm idxlist_opt refargs defer_subclause_opt",
- /* 86 */ "defer_subclause_opt ::=",
- /* 87 */ "defer_subclause_opt ::= defer_subclause",
- /* 88 */ "onconf ::=",
- /* 89 */ "onconf ::= ON CONFLICT resolvetype",
- /* 90 */ "orconf ::=",
- /* 91 */ "orconf ::= OR resolvetype",
- /* 92 */ "resolvetype ::= ROLLBACK",
- /* 93 */ "resolvetype ::= ABORT",
- /* 94 */ "resolvetype ::= FAIL",
- /* 95 */ "resolvetype ::= IGNORE",
- /* 96 */ "resolvetype ::= REPLACE",
- /* 97 */ "cmd ::= DROP TABLE nm",
- /* 98 */ "cmd ::= CREATE temp VIEW nm AS select",
- /* 99 */ "cmd ::= DROP VIEW nm",
- /* 100 */ "cmd ::= select",
- /* 101 */ "select ::= oneselect",
- /* 102 */ "select ::= select multiselect_op oneselect",
- /* 103 */ "multiselect_op ::= UNION",
- /* 104 */ "multiselect_op ::= UNION ALL",
- /* 105 */ "multiselect_op ::= INTERSECT",
- /* 106 */ "multiselect_op ::= EXCEPT",
- /* 107 */ "oneselect ::= SELECT distinct selcollist from where_opt groupby_opt having_opt orderby_opt limit_opt",
- /* 108 */ "distinct ::= DISTINCT",
- /* 109 */ "distinct ::= ALL",
- /* 110 */ "distinct ::=",
- /* 111 */ "sclp ::= selcollist COMMA",
- /* 112 */ "sclp ::=",
- /* 113 */ "selcollist ::= sclp expr as",
- /* 114 */ "selcollist ::= sclp STAR",
- /* 115 */ "selcollist ::= sclp nm DOT STAR",
- /* 116 */ "as ::= AS nm",
- /* 117 */ "as ::= ids",
- /* 118 */ "as ::=",
- /* 119 */ "from ::=",
- /* 120 */ "from ::= FROM seltablist",
- /* 121 */ "stl_prefix ::= seltablist joinop",
- /* 122 */ "stl_prefix ::=",
- /* 123 */ "seltablist ::= stl_prefix nm dbnm as on_opt using_opt",
- /* 124 */ "seltablist ::= stl_prefix LP seltablist_paren RP as on_opt using_opt",
- /* 125 */ "seltablist_paren ::= select",
- /* 126 */ "seltablist_paren ::= seltablist",
- /* 127 */ "dbnm ::=",
- /* 128 */ "dbnm ::= DOT nm",
- /* 129 */ "joinop ::= COMMA",
- /* 130 */ "joinop ::= JOIN",
- /* 131 */ "joinop ::= JOIN_KW JOIN",
- /* 132 */ "joinop ::= JOIN_KW nm JOIN",
- /* 133 */ "joinop ::= JOIN_KW nm nm JOIN",
- /* 134 */ "on_opt ::= ON expr",
- /* 135 */ "on_opt ::=",
- /* 136 */ "using_opt ::= USING LP idxlist RP",
- /* 137 */ "using_opt ::=",
- /* 138 */ "orderby_opt ::=",
- /* 139 */ "orderby_opt ::= ORDER BY sortlist",
- /* 140 */ "sortlist ::= sortlist COMMA sortitem collate sortorder",
- /* 141 */ "sortlist ::= sortitem collate sortorder",
- /* 142 */ "sortitem ::= expr",
- /* 143 */ "sortorder ::= ASC",
- /* 144 */ "sortorder ::= DESC",
- /* 145 */ "sortorder ::=",
- /* 146 */ "collate ::=",
- /* 147 */ "collate ::= COLLATE id",
- /* 148 */ "groupby_opt ::=",
- /* 149 */ "groupby_opt ::= GROUP BY exprlist",
- /* 150 */ "having_opt ::=",
- /* 151 */ "having_opt ::= HAVING expr",
- /* 152 */ "limit_opt ::=",
- /* 153 */ "limit_opt ::= LIMIT signed",
- /* 154 */ "limit_opt ::= LIMIT signed OFFSET signed",
- /* 155 */ "limit_opt ::= LIMIT signed COMMA signed",
- /* 156 */ "cmd ::= DELETE FROM nm dbnm where_opt",
- /* 157 */ "where_opt ::=",
- /* 158 */ "where_opt ::= WHERE expr",
- /* 159 */ "cmd ::= UPDATE orconf nm dbnm SET setlist where_opt",
- /* 160 */ "setlist ::= setlist COMMA nm EQ expr",
- /* 161 */ "setlist ::= nm EQ expr",
- /* 162 */ "cmd ::= insert_cmd INTO nm dbnm inscollist_opt VALUES LP itemlist RP",
- /* 163 */ "cmd ::= insert_cmd INTO nm dbnm inscollist_opt select",
- /* 164 */ "insert_cmd ::= INSERT orconf",
- /* 165 */ "insert_cmd ::= REPLACE",
- /* 166 */ "itemlist ::= itemlist COMMA expr",
- /* 167 */ "itemlist ::= expr",
- /* 168 */ "inscollist_opt ::=",
- /* 169 */ "inscollist_opt ::= LP inscollist RP",
- /* 170 */ "inscollist ::= inscollist COMMA nm",
- /* 171 */ "inscollist ::= nm",
- /* 172 */ "expr ::= LP expr RP",
- /* 173 */ "expr ::= NULL",
- /* 174 */ "expr ::= ID",
- /* 175 */ "expr ::= JOIN_KW",
- /* 176 */ "expr ::= nm DOT nm",
- /* 177 */ "expr ::= nm DOT nm DOT nm",
- /* 178 */ "expr ::= INTEGER",
- /* 179 */ "expr ::= FLOAT",
- /* 180 */ "expr ::= STRING",
- /* 181 */ "expr ::= VARIABLE",
- /* 182 */ "expr ::= ID LP exprlist RP",
- /* 183 */ "expr ::= ID LP STAR RP",
- /* 184 */ "expr ::= expr AND expr",
- /* 185 */ "expr ::= expr OR expr",
- /* 186 */ "expr ::= expr LT expr",
- /* 187 */ "expr ::= expr GT expr",
- /* 188 */ "expr ::= expr LE expr",
- /* 189 */ "expr ::= expr GE expr",
- /* 190 */ "expr ::= expr NE expr",
- /* 191 */ "expr ::= expr EQ expr",
- /* 192 */ "expr ::= expr BITAND expr",
- /* 193 */ "expr ::= expr BITOR expr",
- /* 194 */ "expr ::= expr LSHIFT expr",
- /* 195 */ "expr ::= expr RSHIFT expr",
- /* 196 */ "expr ::= expr likeop expr",
- /* 197 */ "expr ::= expr NOT likeop expr",
- /* 198 */ "likeop ::= LIKE",
- /* 199 */ "likeop ::= GLOB",
- /* 200 */ "expr ::= expr PLUS expr",
- /* 201 */ "expr ::= expr MINUS expr",
- /* 202 */ "expr ::= expr STAR expr",
- /* 203 */ "expr ::= expr SLASH expr",
- /* 204 */ "expr ::= expr REM expr",
- /* 205 */ "expr ::= expr CONCAT expr",
- /* 206 */ "expr ::= expr ISNULL",
- /* 207 */ "expr ::= expr IS NULL",
- /* 208 */ "expr ::= expr NOTNULL",
- /* 209 */ "expr ::= expr NOT NULL",
- /* 210 */ "expr ::= expr IS NOT NULL",
- /* 211 */ "expr ::= NOT expr",
- /* 212 */ "expr ::= BITNOT expr",
- /* 213 */ "expr ::= MINUS expr",
- /* 214 */ "expr ::= PLUS expr",
- /* 215 */ "expr ::= LP select RP",
- /* 216 */ "expr ::= expr BETWEEN expr AND expr",
- /* 217 */ "expr ::= expr NOT BETWEEN expr AND expr",
- /* 218 */ "expr ::= expr IN LP exprlist RP",
- /* 219 */ "expr ::= expr IN LP select RP",
- /* 220 */ "expr ::= expr NOT IN LP exprlist RP",
- /* 221 */ "expr ::= expr NOT IN LP select RP",
- /* 222 */ "expr ::= expr IN nm dbnm",
- /* 223 */ "expr ::= expr NOT IN nm dbnm",
- /* 224 */ "expr ::= CASE case_operand case_exprlist case_else END",
- /* 225 */ "case_exprlist ::= case_exprlist WHEN expr THEN expr",
- /* 226 */ "case_exprlist ::= WHEN expr THEN expr",
- /* 227 */ "case_else ::= ELSE expr",
- /* 228 */ "case_else ::=",
- /* 229 */ "case_operand ::= expr",
- /* 230 */ "case_operand ::=",
- /* 231 */ "exprlist ::= exprlist COMMA expritem",
- /* 232 */ "exprlist ::= expritem",
- /* 233 */ "expritem ::= expr",
- /* 234 */ "expritem ::=",
- /* 235 */ "cmd ::= CREATE uniqueflag INDEX nm ON nm dbnm LP idxlist RP onconf",
- /* 236 */ "uniqueflag ::= UNITQUE",
- /* 237 */ "uniqueflag ::=",
- /* 238 */ "idxlist_opt ::=",
- /* 239 */ "idxlist_opt ::= LP idxlist RP",
- /* 240 */ "idxlist ::= idxlist COMMA idxitem",
- /* 241 */ "idxlist ::= idxitem",
- /* 242 */ "idxitem ::= nm sortorder",
- /* 243 */ "cmd ::= DROP INDEX nm dbnm",
- /* 244 */ "cmd ::= COPY orconf nm dbnm FROM nm USING DELIMITERS STRING",
- /* 245 */ "cmd ::= COPY orconf nm dbnm FROM nm",
- /* 246 */ "cmd ::= VACUUM",
- /* 247 */ "cmd ::= VACUUM nm",
- /* 248 */ "cmd ::= PRAGMA ids EQ nm",
- /* 249 */ "cmd ::= PRAGMA ids EQ ON",
- /* 250 */ "cmd ::= PRAGMA ids EQ plus_num",
- /* 251 */ "cmd ::= PRAGMA ids EQ minus_num",
- /* 252 */ "cmd ::= PRAGMA ids LP nm RP",
- /* 253 */ "cmd ::= PRAGMA ids",
- /* 254 */ "plus_num ::= plus_opt number",
- /* 255 */ "minus_num ::= MINUS number",
- /* 256 */ "number ::= INTEGER",
- /* 257 */ "number ::= FLOAT",
- /* 258 */ "plus_opt ::= PLUS",
- /* 259 */ "plus_opt ::=",
- /* 260 */ "cmd ::= CREATE trigger_decl BEGIN trigger_cmd_list END",
- /* 261 */ "trigger_decl ::= temp TRIGGER nm trigger_time trigger_event ON nm dbnm foreach_clause when_clause",
- /* 262 */ "trigger_time ::= BEFORE",
- /* 263 */ "trigger_time ::= AFTER",
- /* 264 */ "trigger_time ::= INSTEAD OF",
- /* 265 */ "trigger_time ::=",
- /* 266 */ "trigger_event ::= DELETE",
- /* 267 */ "trigger_event ::= INSERT",
- /* 268 */ "trigger_event ::= UPDATE",
- /* 269 */ "trigger_event ::= UPDATE OF inscollist",
- /* 270 */ "foreach_clause ::=",
- /* 271 */ "foreach_clause ::= FOR EACH ROW",
- /* 272 */ "foreach_clause ::= FOR EACH STATEMENT",
- /* 273 */ "when_clause ::=",
- /* 274 */ "when_clause ::= WHEN expr",
- /* 275 */ "trigger_cmd_list ::= trigger_cmd SEMI trigger_cmd_list",
- /* 276 */ "trigger_cmd_list ::=",
- /* 277 */ "trigger_cmd ::= UPDATE orconf nm SET setlist where_opt",
- /* 278 */ "trigger_cmd ::= insert_cmd INTO nm inscollist_opt VALUES LP itemlist RP",
- /* 279 */ "trigger_cmd ::= insert_cmd INTO nm inscollist_opt select",
- /* 280 */ "trigger_cmd ::= DELETE FROM nm where_opt",
- /* 281 */ "trigger_cmd ::= select",
- /* 282 */ "expr ::= RAISE LP IGNORE RP",
- /* 283 */ "expr ::= RAISE LP ROLLBACK COMMA nm RP",
- /* 284 */ "expr ::= RAISE LP ABORT COMMA nm RP",
- /* 285 */ "expr ::= RAISE LP FAIL COMMA nm RP",
- /* 286 */ "cmd ::= DROP TRIGGER nm dbnm",
- /* 287 */ "cmd ::= ATTACH database_kw_opt ids AS nm key_opt",
- /* 288 */ "key_opt ::= USING ids",
- /* 289 */ "key_opt ::=",
- /* 290 */ "database_kw_opt ::= DATABASE",
- /* 291 */ "database_kw_opt ::=",
- /* 292 */ "cmd ::= DETACH database_kw_opt nm",
-};
-#endif /* NDEBUG */
-
-/*
-** This function returns the symbolic name associated with a token
-** value.
-*/
-const char *sqliteParserTokenName(int tokenType){
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( tokenType>0 && tokenType<(sizeof(yyTokenName)/sizeof(yyTokenName[0])) ){
- return yyTokenName[tokenType];
- }else{
- return "Unknown";
- }
-#else
- return "";
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** This function allocates a new parser.
-** The only argument is a pointer to a function which works like
-** malloc.
-**
-** Inputs:
-** A pointer to the function used to allocate memory.
-**
-** Outputs:
-** A pointer to a parser. This pointer is used in subsequent calls
-** to sqliteParser and sqliteParserFree.
-*/
-void *sqliteParserAlloc(void *(*mallocProc)(size_t)){
- yyParser *pParser;
- pParser = (yyParser*)(*mallocProc)( (size_t)sizeof(yyParser) );
- if( pParser ){
- pParser->yyidx = -1;
- }
- return pParser;
-}
-
-/* The following function deletes the value associated with a
-** symbol. The symbol can be either a terminal or nonterminal.
-** "yymajor" is the symbol code, and "yypminor" is a pointer to
-** the value.
-*/
-static void yy_destructor(YYCODETYPE yymajor, YYMINORTYPE *yypminor){
- switch( yymajor ){
- /* Here is inserted the actions which take place when a
- ** terminal or non-terminal is destroyed. This can happen
- ** when the symbol is popped from the stack during a
- ** reduce or during error processing or when a parser is
- ** being destroyed before it is finished parsing.
- **
- ** Note: during a reduce, the only symbols destroyed are those
- ** which appear on the RHS of the rule, but which are not used
- ** inside the C code.
- */
- case 146:
-#line 286 "parse.y"
-{sqliteSelectDelete((yypminor->yy179));}
-#line 1235 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 158:
-#line 533 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprDelete((yypminor->yy242));}
-#line 1240 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 159:
-#line 746 "parse.y"
-{sqliteIdListDelete((yypminor->yy320));}
-#line 1245 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 167:
-#line 744 "parse.y"
-{sqliteIdListDelete((yypminor->yy320));}
-#line 1250 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 171:
-#line 288 "parse.y"
-{sqliteSelectDelete((yypminor->yy179));}
-#line 1255 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 174:
-#line 322 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprListDelete((yypminor->yy322));}
-#line 1260 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 175:
-#line 353 "parse.y"
-{sqliteSrcListDelete((yypminor->yy307));}
-#line 1265 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 176:
-#line 483 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprDelete((yypminor->yy242));}
-#line 1270 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 177:
-#line 459 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprListDelete((yypminor->yy322));}
-#line 1275 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 178:
-#line 464 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprDelete((yypminor->yy242));}
-#line 1280 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 179:
-#line 431 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprListDelete((yypminor->yy322));}
-#line 1285 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 181:
-#line 324 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprListDelete((yypminor->yy322));}
-#line 1290 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 183:
-#line 349 "parse.y"
-{sqliteSrcListDelete((yypminor->yy307));}
-#line 1295 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 184:
-#line 351 "parse.y"
-{sqliteSrcListDelete((yypminor->yy307));}
-#line 1300 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 187:
-#line 420 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprDelete((yypminor->yy242));}
-#line 1305 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 188:
-#line 425 "parse.y"
-{sqliteIdListDelete((yypminor->yy320));}
-#line 1310 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 189:
-#line 400 "parse.y"
-{sqliteSelectDelete((yypminor->yy179));}
-#line 1315 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 191:
-#line 433 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprListDelete((yypminor->yy322));}
-#line 1320 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 192:
-#line 435 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprDelete((yypminor->yy242));}
-#line 1325 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 194:
-#line 719 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprListDelete((yypminor->yy322));}
-#line 1330 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 195:
-#line 489 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprListDelete((yypminor->yy322));}
-#line 1335 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 197:
-#line 520 "parse.y"
-{sqliteIdListDelete((yypminor->yy320));}
-#line 1340 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 198:
-#line 514 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprListDelete((yypminor->yy322));}
-#line 1345 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 199:
-#line 522 "parse.y"
-{sqliteIdListDelete((yypminor->yy320));}
-#line 1350 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 202:
-#line 702 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprListDelete((yypminor->yy322));}
-#line 1355 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 204:
-#line 721 "parse.y"
-{sqliteExprDelete((yypminor->yy242));}
-#line 1360 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 212:
-#line 828 "parse.y"
-{sqliteDeleteTriggerStep((yypminor->yy19));}
-#line 1365 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 214:
-#line 812 "parse.y"
-{sqliteIdListDelete((yypminor->yy290).b);}
-#line 1370 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 217:
-#line 836 "parse.y"
-{sqliteDeleteTriggerStep((yypminor->yy19));}
-#line 1375 "parse.c"
- break;
- default: break; /* If no destructor action specified: do nothing */
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Pop the parser's stack once.
-**
-** If there is a destructor routine associated with the token which
-** is popped from the stack, then call it.
-**
-** Return the major token number for the symbol popped.
-*/
-static int yy_pop_parser_stack(yyParser *pParser){
- YYCODETYPE yymajor;
- yyStackEntry *yytos = &pParser->yystack[pParser->yyidx];
-
- if( pParser->yyidx<0 ) return 0;
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( yyTraceFILE && pParser->yyidx>=0 ){
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE,"%sPopping %s\n",
- yyTracePrompt,
- yyTokenName[yytos->major]);
- }
-#endif
- yymajor = yytos->major;
- yy_destructor( yymajor, &yytos->minor);
- pParser->yyidx--;
- return yymajor;
-}
-
-/*
-** Deallocate and destroy a parser. Destructors are all called for
-** all stack elements before shutting the parser down.
-**
-** Inputs:
-** <ul>
-** <li> A pointer to the parser. This should be a pointer
-** obtained from sqliteParserAlloc.
-** <li> A pointer to a function used to reclaim memory obtained
-** from malloc.
-** </ul>
-*/
-void sqliteParserFree(
- void *p, /* The parser to be deleted */
- void (*freeProc)(void*) /* Function used to reclaim memory */
-){
- yyParser *pParser = (yyParser*)p;
- if( pParser==0 ) return;
- while( pParser->yyidx>=0 ) yy_pop_parser_stack(pParser);
- (*freeProc)((void*)pParser);
-}
-
-/*
-** Find the appropriate action for a parser given the terminal
-** look-ahead token iLookAhead.
-**
-** If the look-ahead token is YYNOCODE, then check to see if the action is
-** independent of the look-ahead. If it is, return the action, otherwise
-** return YY_NO_ACTION.
-*/
-static int yy_find_shift_action(
- yyParser *pParser, /* The parser */
- int iLookAhead /* The look-ahead token */
-){
- int i;
- int stateno = pParser->yystack[pParser->yyidx].stateno;
-
- /* if( pParser->yyidx<0 ) return YY_NO_ACTION; */
- i = yy_shift_ofst[stateno];
- if( i==YY_SHIFT_USE_DFLT ){
- return yy_default[stateno];
- }
- if( iLookAhead==YYNOCODE ){
- return YY_NO_ACTION;
- }
- i += iLookAhead;
- if( i<0 || i>=YY_SZ_ACTTAB || yy_lookahead[i]!=iLookAhead ){
-#ifdef YYFALLBACK
- int iFallback; /* Fallback token */
- if( iLookAhead<sizeof(yyFallback)/sizeof(yyFallback[0])
- && (iFallback = yyFallback[iLookAhead])!=0 ){
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( yyTraceFILE ){
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE, "%sFALLBACK %s => %s\n",
- yyTracePrompt, yyTokenName[iLookAhead], yyTokenName[iFallback]);
- }
-#endif
- return yy_find_shift_action(pParser, iFallback);
- }
-#endif
- return yy_default[stateno];
- }else{
- return yy_action[i];
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Find the appropriate action for a parser given the non-terminal
-** look-ahead token iLookAhead.
-**
-** If the look-ahead token is YYNOCODE, then check to see if the action is
-** independent of the look-ahead. If it is, return the action, otherwise
-** return YY_NO_ACTION.
-*/
-static int yy_find_reduce_action(
- yyParser *pParser, /* The parser */
- int iLookAhead /* The look-ahead token */
-){
- int i;
- int stateno = pParser->yystack[pParser->yyidx].stateno;
-
- i = yy_reduce_ofst[stateno];
- if( i==YY_REDUCE_USE_DFLT ){
- return yy_default[stateno];
- }
- if( iLookAhead==YYNOCODE ){
- return YY_NO_ACTION;
- }
- i += iLookAhead;
- if( i<0 || i>=YY_SZ_ACTTAB || yy_lookahead[i]!=iLookAhead ){
- return yy_default[stateno];
- }else{
- return yy_action[i];
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Perform a shift action.
-*/
-static void yy_shift(
- yyParser *yypParser, /* The parser to be shifted */
- int yyNewState, /* The new state to shift in */
- int yyMajor, /* The major token to shift in */
- YYMINORTYPE *yypMinor /* Pointer ot the minor token to shift in */
-){
- yyStackEntry *yytos;
- yypParser->yyidx++;
- if( yypParser->yyidx>=YYSTACKDEPTH ){
- sqliteParserARG_FETCH;
- yypParser->yyidx--;
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( yyTraceFILE ){
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE,"%sStack Overflow!\n",yyTracePrompt);
- }
-#endif
- while( yypParser->yyidx>=0 ) yy_pop_parser_stack(yypParser);
- /* Here code is inserted which will execute if the parser
- ** stack every overflows */
- sqliteParserARG_STORE; /* Suppress warning about unused %extra_argument var */
- return;
- }
- yytos = &yypParser->yystack[yypParser->yyidx];
- yytos->stateno = yyNewState;
- yytos->major = yyMajor;
- yytos->minor = *yypMinor;
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( yyTraceFILE && yypParser->yyidx>0 ){
- int i;
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE,"%sShift %d\n",yyTracePrompt,yyNewState);
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE,"%sStack:",yyTracePrompt);
- for(i=1; i<=yypParser->yyidx; i++)
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE," %s",yyTokenName[yypParser->yystack[i].major]);
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE,"\n");
- }
-#endif
-}
-
-/* The following table contains information about every rule that
-** is used during the reduce.
-*/
-static struct {
- YYCODETYPE lhs; /* Symbol on the left-hand side of the rule */
- unsigned char nrhs; /* Number of right-hand side symbols in the rule */
-} yyRuleInfo[] = {
- { 132, 1 },
- { 133, 2 },
- { 133, 1 },
- { 134, 3 },
- { 134, 1 },
- { 136, 1 },
- { 135, 1 },
- { 135, 0 },
- { 137, 3 },
- { 138, 0 },
- { 138, 1 },
- { 138, 2 },
- { 137, 2 },
- { 137, 2 },
- { 137, 2 },
- { 137, 2 },
- { 141, 4 },
- { 143, 1 },
- { 143, 0 },
- { 142, 4 },
- { 142, 2 },
- { 144, 3 },
- { 144, 1 },
- { 147, 3 },
- { 148, 1 },
- { 151, 1 },
- { 152, 1 },
- { 152, 1 },
- { 140, 1 },
- { 140, 1 },
- { 140, 1 },
- { 149, 0 },
- { 149, 1 },
- { 149, 4 },
- { 149, 6 },
- { 153, 1 },
- { 153, 2 },
- { 154, 1 },
- { 154, 2 },
- { 154, 2 },
- { 150, 2 },
- { 150, 0 },
- { 155, 3 },
- { 155, 1 },
- { 155, 2 },
- { 155, 2 },
- { 155, 2 },
- { 155, 3 },
- { 155, 3 },
- { 155, 2 },
- { 155, 3 },
- { 155, 3 },
- { 155, 2 },
- { 156, 2 },
- { 156, 3 },
- { 156, 4 },
- { 156, 2 },
- { 156, 5 },
- { 156, 4 },
- { 156, 1 },
- { 156, 2 },
- { 160, 0 },
- { 160, 2 },
- { 162, 2 },
- { 162, 3 },
- { 162, 3 },
- { 162, 3 },
- { 163, 2 },
- { 163, 2 },
- { 163, 1 },
- { 163, 1 },
- { 161, 3 },
- { 161, 2 },
- { 164, 0 },
- { 164, 2 },
- { 164, 2 },
- { 145, 0 },
- { 145, 2 },
- { 165, 3 },
- { 165, 2 },
- { 165, 1 },
- { 166, 2 },
- { 166, 6 },
- { 166, 5 },
- { 166, 3 },
- { 166, 10 },
- { 168, 0 },
- { 168, 1 },
- { 139, 0 },
- { 139, 3 },
- { 169, 0 },
- { 169, 2 },
- { 170, 1 },
- { 170, 1 },
- { 170, 1 },
- { 170, 1 },
- { 170, 1 },
- { 137, 3 },
- { 137, 6 },
- { 137, 3 },
- { 137, 1 },
- { 146, 1 },
- { 146, 3 },
- { 172, 1 },
- { 172, 2 },
- { 172, 1 },
- { 172, 1 },
- { 171, 9 },
- { 173, 1 },
- { 173, 1 },
- { 173, 0 },
- { 181, 2 },
- { 181, 0 },
- { 174, 3 },
- { 174, 2 },
- { 174, 4 },
- { 182, 2 },
- { 182, 1 },
- { 182, 0 },
- { 175, 0 },
- { 175, 2 },
- { 184, 2 },
- { 184, 0 },
- { 183, 6 },
- { 183, 7 },
- { 189, 1 },
- { 189, 1 },
- { 186, 0 },
- { 186, 2 },
- { 185, 1 },
- { 185, 1 },
- { 185, 2 },
- { 185, 3 },
- { 185, 4 },
- { 187, 2 },
- { 187, 0 },
- { 188, 4 },
- { 188, 0 },
- { 179, 0 },
- { 179, 3 },
- { 191, 5 },
- { 191, 3 },
- { 192, 1 },
- { 157, 1 },
- { 157, 1 },
- { 157, 0 },
- { 193, 0 },
- { 193, 2 },
- { 177, 0 },
- { 177, 3 },
- { 178, 0 },
- { 178, 2 },
- { 180, 0 },
- { 180, 2 },
- { 180, 4 },
- { 180, 4 },
- { 137, 5 },
- { 176, 0 },
- { 176, 2 },
- { 137, 7 },
- { 195, 5 },
- { 195, 3 },
- { 137, 9 },
- { 137, 6 },
- { 196, 2 },
- { 196, 1 },
- { 198, 3 },
- { 198, 1 },
- { 197, 0 },
- { 197, 3 },
- { 199, 3 },
- { 199, 1 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 1 },
- { 158, 1 },
- { 158, 1 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 5 },
- { 158, 1 },
- { 158, 1 },
- { 158, 1 },
- { 158, 1 },
- { 158, 4 },
- { 158, 4 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 4 },
- { 200, 1 },
- { 200, 1 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 2 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 2 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 4 },
- { 158, 2 },
- { 158, 2 },
- { 158, 2 },
- { 158, 2 },
- { 158, 3 },
- { 158, 5 },
- { 158, 6 },
- { 158, 5 },
- { 158, 5 },
- { 158, 6 },
- { 158, 6 },
- { 158, 4 },
- { 158, 5 },
- { 158, 5 },
- { 202, 5 },
- { 202, 4 },
- { 203, 2 },
- { 203, 0 },
- { 201, 1 },
- { 201, 0 },
- { 194, 3 },
- { 194, 1 },
- { 204, 1 },
- { 204, 0 },
- { 137, 11 },
- { 205, 1 },
- { 205, 0 },
- { 159, 0 },
- { 159, 3 },
- { 167, 3 },
- { 167, 1 },
- { 206, 2 },
- { 137, 4 },
- { 137, 9 },
- { 137, 6 },
- { 137, 1 },
- { 137, 2 },
- { 137, 4 },
- { 137, 4 },
- { 137, 4 },
- { 137, 4 },
- { 137, 5 },
- { 137, 2 },
- { 207, 2 },
- { 208, 2 },
- { 210, 1 },
- { 210, 1 },
- { 209, 1 },
- { 209, 0 },
- { 137, 5 },
- { 211, 10 },
- { 213, 1 },
- { 213, 1 },
- { 213, 2 },
- { 213, 0 },
- { 214, 1 },
- { 214, 1 },
- { 214, 1 },
- { 214, 3 },
- { 215, 0 },
- { 215, 3 },
- { 215, 3 },
- { 216, 0 },
- { 216, 2 },
- { 212, 3 },
- { 212, 0 },
- { 217, 6 },
- { 217, 8 },
- { 217, 5 },
- { 217, 4 },
- { 217, 1 },
- { 158, 4 },
- { 158, 6 },
- { 158, 6 },
- { 158, 6 },
- { 137, 4 },
- { 137, 6 },
- { 219, 2 },
- { 219, 0 },
- { 218, 1 },
- { 218, 0 },
- { 137, 3 },
-};
-
-static void yy_accept(yyParser*); /* Forward Declaration */
-
-/*
-** Perform a reduce action and the shift that must immediately
-** follow the reduce.
-*/
-static void yy_reduce(
- yyParser *yypParser, /* The parser */
- int yyruleno /* Number of the rule by which to reduce */
-){
- int yygoto; /* The next state */
- int yyact; /* The next action */
- YYMINORTYPE yygotominor; /* The LHS of the rule reduced */
- yyStackEntry *yymsp; /* The top of the parser's stack */
- int yysize; /* Amount to pop the stack */
- sqliteParserARG_FETCH;
- yymsp = &yypParser->yystack[yypParser->yyidx];
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( yyTraceFILE && yyruleno>=0
- && yyruleno<sizeof(yyRuleName)/sizeof(yyRuleName[0]) ){
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE, "%sReduce [%s].\n", yyTracePrompt,
- yyRuleName[yyruleno]);
- }
-#endif /* NDEBUG */
-
- switch( yyruleno ){
- /* Beginning here are the reduction cases. A typical example
- ** follows:
- ** case 0:
- ** #line <lineno> <grammarfile>
- ** { ... } // User supplied code
- ** #line <lineno> <thisfile>
- ** break;
- */
- case 0:
- /* No destructor defined for cmdlist */
- break;
- case 1:
- /* No destructor defined for cmdlist */
- /* No destructor defined for ecmd */
- break;
- case 2:
- /* No destructor defined for ecmd */
- break;
- case 3:
- /* No destructor defined for explain */
- /* No destructor defined for cmdx */
- /* No destructor defined for SEMI */
- break;
- case 4:
- /* No destructor defined for SEMI */
- break;
- case 5:
-#line 72 "parse.y"
-{ sqliteExec(pParse); }
-#line 1901 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for cmd */
- break;
- case 6:
-#line 73 "parse.y"
-{ sqliteBeginParse(pParse, 1); }
-#line 1907 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for EXPLAIN */
- break;
- case 7:
-#line 74 "parse.y"
-{ sqliteBeginParse(pParse, 0); }
-#line 1913 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 8:
-#line 79 "parse.y"
-{sqliteBeginTransaction(pParse,yymsp[0].minor.yy372);}
-#line 1918 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for BEGIN */
- /* No destructor defined for trans_opt */
- break;
- case 9:
- break;
- case 10:
- /* No destructor defined for TRANSACTION */
- break;
- case 11:
- /* No destructor defined for TRANSACTION */
- /* No destructor defined for nm */
- break;
- case 12:
-#line 83 "parse.y"
-{sqliteCommitTransaction(pParse);}
-#line 1934 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COMMIT */
- /* No destructor defined for trans_opt */
- break;
- case 13:
-#line 84 "parse.y"
-{sqliteCommitTransaction(pParse);}
-#line 1941 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for END */
- /* No destructor defined for trans_opt */
- break;
- case 14:
-#line 85 "parse.y"
-{sqliteRollbackTransaction(pParse);}
-#line 1948 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ROLLBACK */
- /* No destructor defined for trans_opt */
- break;
- case 15:
- /* No destructor defined for create_table */
- /* No destructor defined for create_table_args */
- break;
- case 16:
-#line 90 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteStartTable(pParse,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298,yymsp[-2].minor.yy372,0);
-}
-#line 1961 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for TABLE */
- break;
- case 17:
-#line 94 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = 1;}
-#line 1967 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for TEMP */
- break;
- case 18:
-#line 95 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = 0;}
-#line 1973 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 19:
-#line 96 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteEndTable(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,0);
-}
-#line 1980 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for columnlist */
- /* No destructor defined for conslist_opt */
- break;
- case 20:
-#line 99 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteEndTable(pParse,0,yymsp[0].minor.yy179);
- sqliteSelectDelete(yymsp[0].minor.yy179);
-}
-#line 1991 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for AS */
- break;
- case 21:
- /* No destructor defined for columnlist */
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- /* No destructor defined for column */
- break;
- case 22:
- /* No destructor defined for column */
- break;
- case 23:
- /* No destructor defined for columnid */
- /* No destructor defined for type */
- /* No destructor defined for carglist */
- break;
- case 24:
-#line 111 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddColumn(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298);}
-#line 2010 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 25:
-#line 117 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy0;}
-#line 2015 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 26:
-#line 149 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy0;}
-#line 2020 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 27:
-#line 150 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy0;}
-#line 2025 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 28:
-#line 155 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy0;}
-#line 2030 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 29:
-#line 156 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy0;}
-#line 2035 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 30:
-#line 157 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy0;}
-#line 2040 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 31:
- break;
- case 32:
-#line 160 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddColumnType(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298);}
-#line 2047 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 33:
-#line 161 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddColumnType(pParse,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);}
-#line 2052 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for signed */
- break;
- case 34:
-#line 163 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddColumnType(pParse,&yymsp[-5].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);}
-#line 2059 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for signed */
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- /* No destructor defined for signed */
- break;
- case 35:
-#line 165 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy298;}
-#line 2068 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 36:
-#line 166 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[-1].minor.yy298;}
-#line 2073 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ids */
- break;
- case 37:
-#line 168 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = atoi(yymsp[0].minor.yy0.z); }
-#line 2079 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 38:
-#line 169 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = atoi(yymsp[0].minor.yy0.z); }
-#line 2084 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for PLUS */
- break;
- case 39:
-#line 170 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = -atoi(yymsp[0].minor.yy0.z); }
-#line 2090 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for MINUS */
- break;
- case 40:
- /* No destructor defined for carglist */
- /* No destructor defined for carg */
- break;
- case 41:
- break;
- case 42:
- /* No destructor defined for CONSTRAINT */
- /* No destructor defined for nm */
- /* No destructor defined for ccons */
- break;
- case 43:
- /* No destructor defined for ccons */
- break;
- case 44:
-#line 175 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddDefaultValue(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,0);}
-#line 2110 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DEFAULT */
- break;
- case 45:
-#line 176 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddDefaultValue(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,0);}
-#line 2116 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DEFAULT */
- break;
- case 46:
-#line 177 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddDefaultValue(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,0);}
-#line 2122 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DEFAULT */
- break;
- case 47:
-#line 178 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddDefaultValue(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,0);}
-#line 2128 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DEFAULT */
- /* No destructor defined for PLUS */
- break;
- case 48:
-#line 179 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddDefaultValue(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,1);}
-#line 2135 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DEFAULT */
- /* No destructor defined for MINUS */
- break;
- case 49:
-#line 180 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddDefaultValue(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,0);}
-#line 2142 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DEFAULT */
- break;
- case 50:
-#line 181 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddDefaultValue(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,0);}
-#line 2148 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DEFAULT */
- /* No destructor defined for PLUS */
- break;
- case 51:
-#line 182 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddDefaultValue(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,1);}
-#line 2155 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DEFAULT */
- /* No destructor defined for MINUS */
- break;
- case 52:
- /* No destructor defined for DEFAULT */
- /* No destructor defined for NULL */
- break;
- case 53:
- /* No destructor defined for NULL */
- /* No destructor defined for onconf */
- break;
- case 54:
-#line 189 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddNotNull(pParse, yymsp[0].minor.yy372);}
-#line 2170 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for NOT */
- /* No destructor defined for NULL */
- break;
- case 55:
-#line 190 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddPrimaryKey(pParse,0,yymsp[0].minor.yy372);}
-#line 2177 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for PRIMARY */
- /* No destructor defined for KEY */
- /* No destructor defined for sortorder */
- break;
- case 56:
-#line 191 "parse.y"
-{sqliteCreateIndex(pParse,0,0,0,yymsp[0].minor.yy372,0,0);}
-#line 2185 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for UNITQUE */
- break;
- case 57:
- /* No destructor defined for CHECK */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- yy_destructor(158,&yymsp[-2].minor);
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- /* No destructor defined for onconf */
- break;
- case 58:
-#line 194 "parse.y"
-{sqliteCreateForeignKey(pParse,0,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298,yymsp[-1].minor.yy320,yymsp[0].minor.yy372);}
-#line 2198 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for REFERENCES */
- break;
- case 59:
-#line 195 "parse.y"
-{sqliteDeferForeignKey(pParse,yymsp[0].minor.yy372);}
-#line 2204 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 60:
-#line 196 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteAddCollateType(pParse, sqliteCollateType(yymsp[0].minor.yy298.z, yymsp[0].minor.yy298.n));
-}
-#line 2211 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COLLATE */
- break;
- case 61:
-#line 206 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Restrict * 0x010101; }
-#line 2217 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 62:
-#line 207 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = (yymsp[-1].minor.yy372 & yymsp[0].minor.yy407.mask) | yymsp[0].minor.yy407.value; }
-#line 2222 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 63:
-#line 209 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy407.value = 0; yygotominor.yy407.mask = 0x000000; }
-#line 2227 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for MATCH */
- /* No destructor defined for nm */
- break;
- case 64:
-#line 210 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy407.value = yymsp[0].minor.yy372; yygotominor.yy407.mask = 0x0000ff; }
-#line 2234 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ON */
- /* No destructor defined for DELETE */
- break;
- case 65:
-#line 211 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy407.value = yymsp[0].minor.yy372<<8; yygotominor.yy407.mask = 0x00ff00; }
-#line 2241 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ON */
- /* No destructor defined for UPDATE */
- break;
- case 66:
-#line 212 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy407.value = yymsp[0].minor.yy372<<16; yygotominor.yy407.mask = 0xff0000; }
-#line 2248 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ON */
- /* No destructor defined for INSERT */
- break;
- case 67:
-#line 214 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_SetNull; }
-#line 2255 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for SET */
- /* No destructor defined for NULL */
- break;
- case 68:
-#line 215 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_SetDflt; }
-#line 2262 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for SET */
- /* No destructor defined for DEFAULT */
- break;
- case 69:
-#line 216 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Cascade; }
-#line 2269 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for CASCADE */
- break;
- case 70:
-#line 217 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Restrict; }
-#line 2275 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for RESTRICT */
- break;
- case 71:
-#line 219 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = yymsp[0].minor.yy372;}
-#line 2281 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for NOT */
- /* No destructor defined for DEFERRABLE */
- break;
- case 72:
-#line 220 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = yymsp[0].minor.yy372;}
-#line 2288 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DEFERRABLE */
- break;
- case 73:
-#line 222 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = 0;}
-#line 2294 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 74:
-#line 223 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = 1;}
-#line 2299 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INITIALLY */
- /* No destructor defined for DEFERRED */
- break;
- case 75:
-#line 224 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = 0;}
-#line 2306 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INITIALLY */
- /* No destructor defined for IMMEDIATE */
- break;
- case 76:
- break;
- case 77:
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- /* No destructor defined for conslist */
- break;
- case 78:
- /* No destructor defined for conslist */
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- /* No destructor defined for tcons */
- break;
- case 79:
- /* No destructor defined for conslist */
- /* No destructor defined for tcons */
- break;
- case 80:
- /* No destructor defined for tcons */
- break;
- case 81:
- /* No destructor defined for CONSTRAINT */
- /* No destructor defined for nm */
- break;
- case 82:
-#line 236 "parse.y"
-{sqliteAddPrimaryKey(pParse,yymsp[-2].minor.yy320,yymsp[0].minor.yy372);}
-#line 2335 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for PRIMARY */
- /* No destructor defined for KEY */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- break;
- case 83:
-#line 238 "parse.y"
-{sqliteCreateIndex(pParse,0,0,yymsp[-2].minor.yy320,yymsp[0].minor.yy372,0,0);}
-#line 2344 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for UNITQUE */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- break;
- case 84:
- /* No destructor defined for CHECK */
- yy_destructor(158,&yymsp[-1].minor);
- /* No destructor defined for onconf */
- break;
- case 85:
-#line 241 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteCreateForeignKey(pParse, yymsp[-6].minor.yy320, &yymsp[-3].minor.yy298, yymsp[-2].minor.yy320, yymsp[-1].minor.yy372);
- sqliteDeferForeignKey(pParse, yymsp[0].minor.yy372);
-}
-#line 2360 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for FOREIGN */
- /* No destructor defined for KEY */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- /* No destructor defined for REFERENCES */
- break;
- case 86:
-#line 246 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = 0;}
-#line 2370 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 87:
-#line 247 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = yymsp[0].minor.yy372;}
-#line 2375 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 88:
-#line 255 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Default; }
-#line 2380 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 89:
-#line 256 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = yymsp[0].minor.yy372; }
-#line 2385 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ON */
- /* No destructor defined for CONFLICT */
- break;
- case 90:
-#line 257 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Default; }
-#line 2392 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 91:
-#line 258 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = yymsp[0].minor.yy372; }
-#line 2397 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for OR */
- break;
- case 92:
-#line 259 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Rollback; }
-#line 2403 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ROLLBACK */
- break;
- case 93:
-#line 260 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Abort; }
-#line 2409 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ABORT */
- break;
- case 94:
-#line 261 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Fail; }
-#line 2415 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for FAIL */
- break;
- case 95:
-#line 262 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Ignore; }
-#line 2421 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for IGNORE */
- break;
- case 96:
-#line 263 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Replace; }
-#line 2427 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for REPLACE */
- break;
- case 97:
-#line 267 "parse.y"
-{sqliteDropTable(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298,0);}
-#line 2433 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DROP */
- /* No destructor defined for TABLE */
- break;
- case 98:
-#line 271 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteCreateView(pParse, &yymsp[-5].minor.yy0, &yymsp[-2].minor.yy298, yymsp[0].minor.yy179, yymsp[-4].minor.yy372);
-}
-#line 2442 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for VIEW */
- /* No destructor defined for AS */
- break;
- case 99:
-#line 274 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteDropTable(pParse, &yymsp[0].minor.yy298, 1);
-}
-#line 2451 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DROP */
- /* No destructor defined for VIEW */
- break;
- case 100:
-#line 280 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteSelect(pParse, yymsp[0].minor.yy179, SRT_Callback, 0, 0, 0, 0);
- sqliteSelectDelete(yymsp[0].minor.yy179);
-}
-#line 2461 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 101:
-#line 290 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy179 = yymsp[0].minor.yy179;}
-#line 2466 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 102:
-#line 291 "parse.y"
-{
- if( yymsp[0].minor.yy179 ){
- yymsp[0].minor.yy179->op = yymsp[-1].minor.yy372;
- yymsp[0].minor.yy179->pPrior = yymsp[-2].minor.yy179;
- }
- yygotominor.yy179 = yymsp[0].minor.yy179;
-}
-#line 2477 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 103:
-#line 299 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = TK_UNION;}
-#line 2482 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for UNION */
- break;
- case 104:
-#line 300 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = TK_ALL;}
-#line 2488 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for UNION */
- /* No destructor defined for ALL */
- break;
- case 105:
-#line 301 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = TK_INTERSECT;}
-#line 2495 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INTERSECT */
- break;
- case 106:
-#line 302 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = TK_EXCEPT;}
-#line 2501 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for EXCEPT */
- break;
- case 107:
-#line 304 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy179 = sqliteSelectNew(yymsp[-6].minor.yy322,yymsp[-5].minor.yy307,yymsp[-4].minor.yy242,yymsp[-3].minor.yy322,yymsp[-2].minor.yy242,yymsp[-1].minor.yy322,yymsp[-7].minor.yy372,yymsp[0].minor.yy124.limit,yymsp[0].minor.yy124.offset);
-}
-#line 2509 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for SELECT */
- break;
- case 108:
-#line 312 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = 1;}
-#line 2515 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DISTINCT */
- break;
- case 109:
-#line 313 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = 0;}
-#line 2521 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ALL */
- break;
- case 110:
-#line 314 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = 0;}
-#line 2527 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 111:
-#line 325 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = yymsp[-1].minor.yy322;}
-#line 2532 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 112:
-#line 326 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = 0;}
-#line 2538 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 113:
-#line 327 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(yymsp[-2].minor.yy322,yymsp[-1].minor.yy242,yymsp[0].minor.yy298.n?&yymsp[0].minor.yy298:0);
-}
-#line 2545 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 114:
-#line 330 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(yymsp[-1].minor.yy322, sqliteExpr(TK_ALL, 0, 0, 0), 0);
-}
-#line 2552 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for STAR */
- break;
- case 115:
-#line 333 "parse.y"
-{
- Expr *pRight = sqliteExpr(TK_ALL, 0, 0, 0);
- Expr *pLeft = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &yymsp[-2].minor.yy298);
- yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(yymsp[-3].minor.yy322, sqliteExpr(TK_DOT, pLeft, pRight, 0), 0);
-}
-#line 2562 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DOT */
- /* No destructor defined for STAR */
- break;
- case 116:
-#line 343 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy298; }
-#line 2569 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for AS */
- break;
- case 117:
-#line 344 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy298; }
-#line 2575 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 118:
-#line 345 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy298.n = 0; }
-#line 2580 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 119:
-#line 357 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy307 = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(*yygotominor.yy307));}
-#line 2585 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 120:
-#line 358 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy307 = yymsp[0].minor.yy307;}
-#line 2590 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for FROM */
- break;
- case 121:
-#line 363 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy307 = yymsp[-1].minor.yy307;
- if( yygotominor.yy307 && yygotominor.yy307->nSrc>0 ) yygotominor.yy307->a[yygotominor.yy307->nSrc-1].jointype = yymsp[0].minor.yy372;
-}
-#line 2599 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 122:
-#line 367 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy307 = 0;}
-#line 2604 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 123:
-#line 368 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy307 = sqliteSrcListAppend(yymsp[-5].minor.yy307,&yymsp[-4].minor.yy298,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy298);
- if( yymsp[-2].minor.yy298.n ) sqliteSrcListAddAlias(yygotominor.yy307,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298);
- if( yymsp[-1].minor.yy242 ){
- if( yygotominor.yy307 && yygotominor.yy307->nSrc>1 ){ yygotominor.yy307->a[yygotominor.yy307->nSrc-2].pOn = yymsp[-1].minor.yy242; }
- else { sqliteExprDelete(yymsp[-1].minor.yy242); }
- }
- if( yymsp[0].minor.yy320 ){
- if( yygotominor.yy307 && yygotominor.yy307->nSrc>1 ){ yygotominor.yy307->a[yygotominor.yy307->nSrc-2].pUsing = yymsp[0].minor.yy320; }
- else { sqliteIdListDelete(yymsp[0].minor.yy320); }
- }
-}
-#line 2620 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 124:
-#line 381 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy307 = sqliteSrcListAppend(yymsp[-6].minor.yy307,0,0);
- yygotominor.yy307->a[yygotominor.yy307->nSrc-1].pSelect = yymsp[-4].minor.yy179;
- if( yymsp[-2].minor.yy298.n ) sqliteSrcListAddAlias(yygotominor.yy307,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298);
- if( yymsp[-1].minor.yy242 ){
- if( yygotominor.yy307 && yygotominor.yy307->nSrc>1 ){ yygotominor.yy307->a[yygotominor.yy307->nSrc-2].pOn = yymsp[-1].minor.yy242; }
- else { sqliteExprDelete(yymsp[-1].minor.yy242); }
- }
- if( yymsp[0].minor.yy320 ){
- if( yygotominor.yy307 && yygotominor.yy307->nSrc>1 ){ yygotominor.yy307->a[yygotominor.yy307->nSrc-2].pUsing = yymsp[0].minor.yy320; }
- else { sqliteIdListDelete(yymsp[0].minor.yy320); }
- }
-}
-#line 2637 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- break;
- case 125:
-#line 401 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy179 = yymsp[0].minor.yy179;}
-#line 2644 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 126:
-#line 402 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy179 = sqliteSelectNew(0,yymsp[0].minor.yy307,0,0,0,0,0,-1,0);
-}
-#line 2651 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 127:
-#line 407 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298.z=0; yygotominor.yy298.n=0;}
-#line 2656 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 128:
-#line 408 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy298;}
-#line 2661 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DOT */
- break;
- case 129:
-#line 412 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = JT_INNER; }
-#line 2667 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 130:
-#line 413 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = JT_INNER; }
-#line 2673 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for JOIN */
- break;
- case 131:
-#line 414 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = sqliteJoinType(pParse,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy0,0,0); }
-#line 2679 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for JOIN */
- break;
- case 132:
-#line 415 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = sqliteJoinType(pParse,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy0,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy298,0); }
-#line 2685 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for JOIN */
- break;
- case 133:
-#line 417 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = sqliteJoinType(pParse,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy0,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy298); }
-#line 2691 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for JOIN */
- break;
- case 134:
-#line 421 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = yymsp[0].minor.yy242;}
-#line 2697 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ON */
- break;
- case 135:
-#line 422 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = 0;}
-#line 2703 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 136:
-#line 426 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy320 = yymsp[-1].minor.yy320;}
-#line 2708 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for USING */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- break;
- case 137:
-#line 427 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy320 = 0;}
-#line 2716 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 138:
-#line 437 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = 0;}
-#line 2721 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 139:
-#line 438 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = yymsp[0].minor.yy322;}
-#line 2726 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ORDER */
- /* No destructor defined for BY */
- break;
- case 140:
-#line 439 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(yymsp[-4].minor.yy322,yymsp[-2].minor.yy242,0);
- if( yygotominor.yy322 ) yygotominor.yy322->a[yygotominor.yy322->nExpr-1].sortOrder = yymsp[-1].minor.yy372+yymsp[0].minor.yy372;
-}
-#line 2736 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 141:
-#line 443 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(0,yymsp[-2].minor.yy242,0);
- if( yygotominor.yy322 ) yygotominor.yy322->a[0].sortOrder = yymsp[-1].minor.yy372+yymsp[0].minor.yy372;
-}
-#line 2745 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 142:
-#line 447 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = yymsp[0].minor.yy242;}
-#line 2750 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 143:
-#line 452 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = STQLITE_SO_ASC;}
-#line 2755 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ASC */
- break;
- case 144:
-#line 453 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = STQLITE_SO_DESC;}
-#line 2761 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DESC */
- break;
- case 145:
-#line 454 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = STQLITE_SO_ASC;}
-#line 2767 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 146:
-#line 455 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = STQLITE_SO_UNK;}
-#line 2772 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 147:
-#line 456 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = sqliteCollateType(yymsp[0].minor.yy298.z, yymsp[0].minor.yy298.n);}
-#line 2777 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COLLATE */
- break;
- case 148:
-#line 460 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = 0;}
-#line 2783 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 149:
-#line 461 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = yymsp[0].minor.yy322;}
-#line 2788 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for GROUP */
- /* No destructor defined for BY */
- break;
- case 150:
-#line 465 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = 0;}
-#line 2795 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 151:
-#line 466 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = yymsp[0].minor.yy242;}
-#line 2800 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for HAVING */
- break;
- case 152:
-#line 469 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy124.limit = -1; yygotominor.yy124.offset = 0;}
-#line 2806 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 153:
-#line 470 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy124.limit = yymsp[0].minor.yy372; yygotominor.yy124.offset = 0;}
-#line 2811 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LIMIT */
- break;
- case 154:
-#line 472 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy124.limit = yymsp[-2].minor.yy372; yygotominor.yy124.offset = yymsp[0].minor.yy372;}
-#line 2817 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LIMIT */
- /* No destructor defined for OFFSET */
- break;
- case 155:
-#line 474 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy124.limit = yymsp[0].minor.yy372; yygotominor.yy124.offset = yymsp[-2].minor.yy372;}
-#line 2824 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LIMIT */
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 156:
-#line 478 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteDeleteFrom(pParse, sqliteSrcListAppend(0,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy298), yymsp[0].minor.yy242);
-}
-#line 2833 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DELETE */
- /* No destructor defined for FROM */
- break;
- case 157:
-#line 485 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = 0;}
-#line 2840 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 158:
-#line 486 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = yymsp[0].minor.yy242;}
-#line 2845 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for WHERE */
- break;
- case 159:
-#line 494 "parse.y"
-{sqliteUpdate(pParse,sqliteSrcListAppend(0,&yymsp[-4].minor.yy298,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy298),yymsp[-1].minor.yy322,yymsp[0].minor.yy242,yymsp[-5].minor.yy372);}
-#line 2851 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for UPDATE */
- /* No destructor defined for SET */
- break;
- case 160:
-#line 497 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(yymsp[-4].minor.yy322,yymsp[0].minor.yy242,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298);}
-#line 2858 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- /* No destructor defined for EQ */
- break;
- case 161:
-#line 498 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(0,yymsp[0].minor.yy242,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298);}
-#line 2865 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for EQ */
- break;
- case 162:
-#line 504 "parse.y"
-{sqliteInsert(pParse, sqliteSrcListAppend(0,&yymsp[-6].minor.yy298,&yymsp[-5].minor.yy298), yymsp[-1].minor.yy322, 0, yymsp[-4].minor.yy320, yymsp[-8].minor.yy372);}
-#line 2871 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INTO */
- /* No destructor defined for VALUES */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- break;
- case 163:
-#line 506 "parse.y"
-{sqliteInsert(pParse, sqliteSrcListAppend(0,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy298,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298), 0, yymsp[0].minor.yy179, yymsp[-1].minor.yy320, yymsp[-5].minor.yy372);}
-#line 2880 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INTO */
- break;
- case 164:
-#line 509 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = yymsp[0].minor.yy372;}
-#line 2886 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INSERT */
- break;
- case 165:
-#line 510 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Replace;}
-#line 2892 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for REPLACE */
- break;
- case 166:
-#line 516 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(yymsp[-2].minor.yy322,yymsp[0].minor.yy242,0);}
-#line 2898 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 167:
-#line 517 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(0,yymsp[0].minor.yy242,0);}
-#line 2904 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 168:
-#line 524 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy320 = 0;}
-#line 2909 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 169:
-#line 525 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy320 = yymsp[-1].minor.yy320;}
-#line 2914 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- break;
- case 170:
-#line 526 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy320 = sqliteIdListAppend(yymsp[-2].minor.yy320,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298);}
-#line 2921 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 171:
-#line 527 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy320 = sqliteIdListAppend(0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298);}
-#line 2927 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 172:
-#line 535 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = yymsp[-1].minor.yy242; sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0); }
-#line 2932 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 173:
-#line 536 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NULL, 0, 0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);}
-#line 2937 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 174:
-#line 537 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);}
-#line 2942 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 175:
-#line 538 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);}
-#line 2947 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 176:
-#line 539 "parse.y"
-{
- Expr *temp1 = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &yymsp[-2].minor.yy298);
- Expr *temp2 = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy298);
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_DOT, temp1, temp2, 0);
-}
-#line 2956 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DOT */
- break;
- case 177:
-#line 544 "parse.y"
-{
- Expr *temp1 = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &yymsp[-4].minor.yy298);
- Expr *temp2 = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &yymsp[-2].minor.yy298);
- Expr *temp3 = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy298);
- Expr *temp4 = sqliteExpr(TK_DOT, temp2, temp3, 0);
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_DOT, temp1, temp4, 0);
-}
-#line 2968 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DOT */
- /* No destructor defined for DOT */
- break;
- case 178:
-#line 551 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_INTEGER, 0, 0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);}
-#line 2975 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 179:
-#line 552 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_FLOAT, 0, 0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);}
-#line 2980 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 180:
-#line 553 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_STRING, 0, 0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);}
-#line 2985 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 181:
-#line 554 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_VARIABLE, 0, 0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->iTable = ++pParse->nVar;
-}
-#line 2993 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 182:
-#line 558 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExprFunction(yymsp[-1].minor.yy322, &yymsp[-3].minor.yy0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3001 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- break;
- case 183:
-#line 562 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExprFunction(0, &yymsp[-3].minor.yy0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3010 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for STAR */
- break;
- case 184:
-#line 566 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_AND, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3017 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for AND */
- break;
- case 185:
-#line 567 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_OR, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3023 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for OR */
- break;
- case 186:
-#line 568 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_LT, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3029 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LT */
- break;
- case 187:
-#line 569 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_GT, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3035 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for GT */
- break;
- case 188:
-#line 570 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_LE, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3041 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LE */
- break;
- case 189:
-#line 571 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_GE, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3047 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for GE */
- break;
- case 190:
-#line 572 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NE, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3053 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for NE */
- break;
- case 191:
-#line 573 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_EQ, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3059 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for EQ */
- break;
- case 192:
-#line 574 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_BITAND, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3065 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for BITAND */
- break;
- case 193:
-#line 575 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_BITOR, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3071 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for BITOR */
- break;
- case 194:
-#line 576 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_LSHIFT, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3077 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LSHIFT */
- break;
- case 195:
-#line 577 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_RSHIFT, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3083 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for RSHIFT */
- break;
- case 196:
-#line 578 "parse.y"
-{
- ExprList *pList = sqliteExprListAppend(0, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);
- pList = sqliteExprListAppend(pList, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, 0);
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExprFunction(pList, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->op = yymsp[-1].minor.yy372;
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242, &yymsp[-2].minor.yy242->span, &yymsp[0].minor.yy242->span);
-}
-#line 3095 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 197:
-#line 585 "parse.y"
-{
- ExprList *pList = sqliteExprListAppend(0, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);
- pList = sqliteExprListAppend(pList, yymsp[-3].minor.yy242, 0);
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExprFunction(pList, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->op = yymsp[-1].minor.yy372;
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NOT, yygotominor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy242->span);
-}
-#line 3107 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for NOT */
- break;
- case 198:
-#line 594 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = TK_LIKE;}
-#line 3113 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LIKE */
- break;
- case 199:
-#line 595 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy372 = TK_GLOB;}
-#line 3119 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for GLOB */
- break;
- case 200:
-#line 596 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_PLUS, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3125 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for PLUS */
- break;
- case 201:
-#line 597 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_MINUS, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3131 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for MINUS */
- break;
- case 202:
-#line 598 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_STAR, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3137 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for STAR */
- break;
- case 203:
-#line 599 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_SLASH, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3143 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for SLASH */
- break;
- case 204:
-#line 600 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_REM, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3149 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for REM */
- break;
- case 205:
-#line 601 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_CONCAT, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);}
-#line 3155 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for CONCAT */
- break;
- case 206:
-#line 602 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_ISNULL, yymsp[-1].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3164 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 207:
-#line 606 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_ISNULL, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3172 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for IS */
- break;
- case 208:
-#line 610 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NOTNULL, yymsp[-1].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3181 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 209:
-#line 614 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NOTNULL, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3189 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for NOT */
- break;
- case 210:
-#line 618 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NOTNULL, yymsp[-3].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3198 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for IS */
- /* No destructor defined for NOT */
- break;
- case 211:
-#line 622 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NOT, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy242->span);
-}
-#line 3208 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 212:
-#line 626 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_BITNOT, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy242->span);
-}
-#line 3216 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 213:
-#line 630 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_UMINUS, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy242->span);
-}
-#line 3224 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 214:
-#line 634 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_UPLUS, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy242->span);
-}
-#line 3232 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 215:
-#line 638 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_SELECT, 0, 0, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->pSelect = yymsp[-1].minor.yy179;
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3241 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 216:
-#line 643 "parse.y"
-{
- ExprList *pList = sqliteExprListAppend(0, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, 0);
- pList = sqliteExprListAppend(pList, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_BETWEEN, yymsp[-4].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->pList = pList;
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-4].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy242->span);
-}
-#line 3252 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for BETWEEN */
- /* No destructor defined for AND */
- break;
- case 217:
-#line 650 "parse.y"
-{
- ExprList *pList = sqliteExprListAppend(0, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, 0);
- pList = sqliteExprListAppend(pList, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_BETWEEN, yymsp[-5].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->pList = pList;
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NOT, yygotominor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-5].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy242->span);
-}
-#line 3266 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for NOT */
- /* No destructor defined for BETWEEN */
- /* No destructor defined for AND */
- break;
- case 218:
-#line 658 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_IN, yymsp[-4].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->pList = yymsp[-1].minor.yy322;
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-4].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3278 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for IN */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- break;
- case 219:
-#line 663 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_IN, yymsp[-4].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->pSelect = yymsp[-1].minor.yy179;
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-4].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3289 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for IN */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- break;
- case 220:
-#line 668 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_IN, yymsp[-5].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->pList = yymsp[-1].minor.yy322;
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NOT, yygotominor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-5].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3301 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for NOT */
- /* No destructor defined for IN */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- break;
- case 221:
-#line 674 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_IN, yymsp[-5].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->pSelect = yymsp[-1].minor.yy179;
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NOT, yygotominor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-5].minor.yy242->span,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3314 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for NOT */
- /* No destructor defined for IN */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- break;
- case 222:
-#line 680 "parse.y"
-{
- SrcList *pSrc = sqliteSrcListAppend(0, &yymsp[-1].minor.yy298, &yymsp[0].minor.yy298);
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_IN, yymsp[-3].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->pSelect = sqliteSelectNew(0,pSrc,0,0,0,0,0,-1,0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy242->span,yymsp[0].minor.yy298.z?&yymsp[0].minor.yy298:&yymsp[-1].minor.yy298);
-}
-#line 3327 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for IN */
- break;
- case 223:
-#line 686 "parse.y"
-{
- SrcList *pSrc = sqliteSrcListAppend(0, &yymsp[-1].minor.yy298, &yymsp[0].minor.yy298);
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_IN, yymsp[-4].minor.yy242, 0, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->pSelect = sqliteSelectNew(0,pSrc,0,0,0,0,0,-1,0);
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_NOT, yygotominor.yy242, 0, 0);
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242,&yymsp[-4].minor.yy242->span,yymsp[0].minor.yy298.z?&yymsp[0].minor.yy298:&yymsp[-1].minor.yy298);
-}
-#line 3339 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for NOT */
- /* No destructor defined for IN */
- break;
- case 224:
-#line 696 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_CASE, yymsp[-3].minor.yy242, yymsp[-1].minor.yy242, 0);
- if( yygotominor.yy242 ) yygotominor.yy242->pList = yymsp[-2].minor.yy322;
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242, &yymsp[-4].minor.yy0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3350 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 225:
-#line 703 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(yymsp[-4].minor.yy322, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, 0);
- yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(yygotominor.yy322, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);
-}
-#line 3358 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for WHEN */
- /* No destructor defined for THEN */
- break;
- case 226:
-#line 707 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(0, yymsp[-2].minor.yy242, 0);
- yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(yygotominor.yy322, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, 0);
-}
-#line 3368 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for WHEN */
- /* No destructor defined for THEN */
- break;
- case 227:
-#line 712 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = yymsp[0].minor.yy242;}
-#line 3375 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ELSE */
- break;
- case 228:
-#line 713 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = 0;}
-#line 3381 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 229:
-#line 715 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = yymsp[0].minor.yy242;}
-#line 3386 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 230:
-#line 716 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = 0;}
-#line 3391 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 231:
-#line 724 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(yymsp[-2].minor.yy322,yymsp[0].minor.yy242,0);}
-#line 3396 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 232:
-#line 725 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy322 = sqliteExprListAppend(0,yymsp[0].minor.yy242,0);}
-#line 3402 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 233:
-#line 726 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = yymsp[0].minor.yy242;}
-#line 3407 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 234:
-#line 727 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy242 = 0;}
-#line 3412 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 235:
-#line 732 "parse.y"
-{
- SrcList *pSrc = sqliteSrcListAppend(0, &yymsp[-5].minor.yy298, &yymsp[-4].minor.yy298);
- if( yymsp[-9].minor.yy372!=OE_None ) yymsp[-9].minor.yy372 = yymsp[0].minor.yy372;
- if( yymsp[-9].minor.yy372==OE_Default) yymsp[-9].minor.yy372 = OE_Abort;
- sqliteCreateIndex(pParse, &yymsp[-7].minor.yy298, pSrc, yymsp[-2].minor.yy320, yymsp[-9].minor.yy372, &yymsp[-10].minor.yy0, &yymsp[-1].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3422 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INDEX */
- /* No destructor defined for ON */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- break;
- case 236:
-#line 740 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_Abort; }
-#line 3430 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for UNITQUE */
- break;
- case 237:
-#line 741 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = OE_None; }
-#line 3436 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 238:
-#line 749 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy320 = 0;}
-#line 3441 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 239:
-#line 750 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy320 = yymsp[-1].minor.yy320;}
-#line 3446 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- break;
- case 240:
-#line 751 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy320 = sqliteIdListAppend(yymsp[-2].minor.yy320,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298);}
-#line 3453 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 241:
-#line 752 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy320 = sqliteIdListAppend(0,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298);}
-#line 3459 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 242:
-#line 753 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[-1].minor.yy298;}
-#line 3464 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for sortorder */
- break;
- case 243:
-#line 758 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteDropIndex(pParse, sqliteSrcListAppend(0,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298));
-}
-#line 3472 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DROP */
- /* No destructor defined for INDEX */
- break;
- case 244:
-#line 766 "parse.y"
-{sqliteCopy(pParse,sqliteSrcListAppend(0,&yymsp[-6].minor.yy298,&yymsp[-5].minor.yy298),&yymsp[-3].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,yymsp[-7].minor.yy372);}
-#line 3479 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COPY */
- /* No destructor defined for FROM */
- /* No destructor defined for USING */
- /* No destructor defined for DELIMITERS */
- break;
- case 245:
-#line 768 "parse.y"
-{sqliteCopy(pParse,sqliteSrcListAppend(0,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy298,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298),&yymsp[0].minor.yy298,0,yymsp[-4].minor.yy372);}
-#line 3488 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for COPY */
- /* No destructor defined for FROM */
- break;
- case 246:
-#line 772 "parse.y"
-{sqliteVacuum(pParse,0);}
-#line 3495 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for VACUUM */
- break;
- case 247:
-#line 773 "parse.y"
-{sqliteVacuum(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298);}
-#line 3501 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for VACUUM */
- break;
- case 248:
-#line 777 "parse.y"
-{sqlitePragma(pParse,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298,0);}
-#line 3507 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for PRAGMA */
- /* No destructor defined for EQ */
- break;
- case 249:
-#line 778 "parse.y"
-{sqlitePragma(pParse,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy0,0);}
-#line 3514 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for PRAGMA */
- /* No destructor defined for EQ */
- break;
- case 250:
-#line 779 "parse.y"
-{sqlitePragma(pParse,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298,0);}
-#line 3521 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for PRAGMA */
- /* No destructor defined for EQ */
- break;
- case 251:
-#line 780 "parse.y"
-{sqlitePragma(pParse,&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298,1);}
-#line 3528 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for PRAGMA */
- /* No destructor defined for EQ */
- break;
- case 252:
-#line 781 "parse.y"
-{sqlitePragma(pParse,&yymsp[-3].minor.yy298,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy298,0);}
-#line 3535 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for PRAGMA */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- break;
- case 253:
-#line 782 "parse.y"
-{sqlitePragma(pParse,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298,0);}
-#line 3543 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for PRAGMA */
- break;
- case 254:
-#line 783 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy298;}
-#line 3549 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for plus_opt */
- break;
- case 255:
-#line 784 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy298;}
-#line 3555 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for MINUS */
- break;
- case 256:
-#line 785 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy0;}
-#line 3561 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 257:
-#line 786 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy0;}
-#line 3566 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 258:
- /* No destructor defined for PLUS */
- break;
- case 259:
- break;
- case 260:
-#line 792 "parse.y"
-{
- Token all;
- all.z = yymsp[-4].minor.yy0.z;
- all.n = (yymsp[0].minor.yy0.z - yymsp[-4].minor.yy0.z) + yymsp[0].minor.yy0.n;
- sqliteFinishTrigger(pParse, yymsp[-1].minor.yy19, &all);
-}
-#line 3581 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for trigger_decl */
- /* No destructor defined for BEGIN */
- break;
- case 261:
-#line 800 "parse.y"
-{
- SrcList *pTab = sqliteSrcListAppend(0, &yymsp[-3].minor.yy298, &yymsp[-2].minor.yy298);
- sqliteBeginTrigger(pParse, &yymsp[-7].minor.yy298, yymsp[-6].minor.yy372, yymsp[-5].minor.yy290.a, yymsp[-5].minor.yy290.b, pTab, yymsp[-1].minor.yy372, yymsp[0].minor.yy182, yymsp[-9].minor.yy372);
-}
-#line 3591 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for TRIGGER */
- /* No destructor defined for ON */
- break;
- case 262:
-#line 806 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = TK_BEFORE; }
-#line 3598 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for BEFORE */
- break;
- case 263:
-#line 807 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = TK_AFTER; }
-#line 3604 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for AFTER */
- break;
- case 264:
-#line 808 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = TK_INSTEAD;}
-#line 3610 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INSTEAD */
- /* No destructor defined for OF */
- break;
- case 265:
-#line 809 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = TK_BEFORE; }
-#line 3617 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 266:
-#line 813 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy290.a = TK_DELETE; yygotominor.yy290.b = 0; }
-#line 3622 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DELETE */
- break;
- case 267:
-#line 814 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy290.a = TK_INSERT; yygotominor.yy290.b = 0; }
-#line 3628 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INSERT */
- break;
- case 268:
-#line 815 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy290.a = TK_UPDATE; yygotominor.yy290.b = 0;}
-#line 3634 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for UPDATE */
- break;
- case 269:
-#line 816 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy290.a = TK_UPDATE; yygotominor.yy290.b = yymsp[0].minor.yy320; }
-#line 3640 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for UPDATE */
- /* No destructor defined for OF */
- break;
- case 270:
-#line 819 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = TK_ROW; }
-#line 3647 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 271:
-#line 820 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = TK_ROW; }
-#line 3652 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for FOR */
- /* No destructor defined for EACH */
- /* No destructor defined for ROW */
- break;
- case 272:
-#line 821 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy372 = TK_STATEMENT; }
-#line 3660 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for FOR */
- /* No destructor defined for EACH */
- /* No destructor defined for STATEMENT */
- break;
- case 273:
-#line 824 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy182 = 0; }
-#line 3668 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 274:
-#line 825 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy182 = yymsp[0].minor.yy242; }
-#line 3673 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for WHEN */
- break;
- case 275:
-#line 829 "parse.y"
-{
- yymsp[-2].minor.yy19->pNext = yymsp[0].minor.yy19;
- yygotominor.yy19 = yymsp[-2].minor.yy19;
-}
-#line 3682 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for SEMI */
- break;
- case 276:
-#line 833 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy19 = 0; }
-#line 3688 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 277:
-#line 839 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy19 = sqliteTriggerUpdateStep(&yymsp[-3].minor.yy298, yymsp[-1].minor.yy322, yymsp[0].minor.yy242, yymsp[-4].minor.yy372); }
-#line 3693 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for UPDATE */
- /* No destructor defined for SET */
- break;
- case 278:
-#line 844 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy19 = sqliteTriggerInsertStep(&yymsp[-5].minor.yy298, yymsp[-4].minor.yy320, yymsp[-1].minor.yy322, 0, yymsp[-7].minor.yy372);}
-#line 3700 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INTO */
- /* No destructor defined for VALUES */
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for RP */
- break;
- case 279:
-#line 847 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy19 = sqliteTriggerInsertStep(&yymsp[-2].minor.yy298, yymsp[-1].minor.yy320, 0, yymsp[0].minor.yy179, yymsp[-4].minor.yy372);}
-#line 3709 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for INTO */
- break;
- case 280:
-#line 851 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy19 = sqliteTriggerDeleteStep(&yymsp[-1].minor.yy298, yymsp[0].minor.yy242);}
-#line 3715 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DELETE */
- /* No destructor defined for FROM */
- break;
- case 281:
-#line 854 "parse.y"
-{yygotominor.yy19 = sqliteTriggerSelectStep(yymsp[0].minor.yy179); }
-#line 3722 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 282:
-#line 857 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_RAISE, 0, 0, 0);
- yygotominor.yy242->iColumn = OE_Ignore;
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242, &yymsp[-3].minor.yy0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3731 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for IGNORE */
- break;
- case 283:
-#line 862 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_RAISE, 0, 0, &yymsp[-1].minor.yy298);
- yygotominor.yy242->iColumn = OE_Rollback;
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242, &yymsp[-5].minor.yy0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3742 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for ROLLBACK */
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 284:
-#line 867 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_RAISE, 0, 0, &yymsp[-1].minor.yy298);
- yygotominor.yy242->iColumn = OE_Abort;
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242, &yymsp[-5].minor.yy0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3754 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for ABORT */
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 285:
-#line 872 "parse.y"
-{
- yygotominor.yy242 = sqliteExpr(TK_RAISE, 0, 0, &yymsp[-1].minor.yy298);
- yygotominor.yy242->iColumn = OE_Fail;
- sqliteExprSpan(yygotominor.yy242, &yymsp[-5].minor.yy0, &yymsp[0].minor.yy0);
-}
-#line 3766 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for LP */
- /* No destructor defined for FAIL */
- /* No destructor defined for COMMA */
- break;
- case 286:
-#line 879 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteDropTrigger(pParse,sqliteSrcListAppend(0,&yymsp[-1].minor.yy298,&yymsp[0].minor.yy298));
-}
-#line 3776 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DROP */
- /* No destructor defined for TRIGGER */
- break;
- case 287:
-#line 884 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteAttach(pParse, &yymsp[-3].minor.yy298, &yymsp[-1].minor.yy298, &yymsp[0].minor.yy298);
-}
-#line 3785 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for ATTACH */
- /* No destructor defined for database_kw_opt */
- /* No destructor defined for AS */
- break;
- case 288:
-#line 888 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy298 = yymsp[0].minor.yy298; }
-#line 3793 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for USING */
- break;
- case 289:
-#line 889 "parse.y"
-{ yygotominor.yy298.z = 0; yygotominor.yy298.n = 0; }
-#line 3799 "parse.c"
- break;
- case 290:
- /* No destructor defined for DATABASE */
- break;
- case 291:
- break;
- case 292:
-#line 895 "parse.y"
-{
- sqliteDetach(pParse, &yymsp[0].minor.yy298);
-}
-#line 3811 "parse.c"
- /* No destructor defined for DETACH */
- /* No destructor defined for database_kw_opt */
- break;
- };
- yygoto = yyRuleInfo[yyruleno].lhs;
- yysize = yyRuleInfo[yyruleno].nrhs;
- yypParser->yyidx -= yysize;
- yyact = yy_find_reduce_action(yypParser,yygoto);
- if( yyact < YYNSTATE ){
- yy_shift(yypParser,yyact,yygoto,&yygotominor);
- }else if( yyact == YYNSTATE + YYNRULE + 1 ){
- yy_accept(yypParser);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** The following code executes when the parse fails
-*/
-static void yy_parse_failed(
- yyParser *yypParser /* The parser */
-){
- sqliteParserARG_FETCH;
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( yyTraceFILE ){
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE,"%sFail!\n",yyTracePrompt);
- }
-#endif
- while( yypParser->yyidx>=0 ) yy_pop_parser_stack(yypParser);
- /* Here code is inserted which will be executed whenever the
- ** parser fails */
- sqliteParserARG_STORE; /* Suppress warning about unused %extra_argument variable */
-}
-
-/*
-** The following code executes when a syntax error first occurs.
-*/
-static void yy_syntax_error(
- yyParser *yypParser, /* The parser */
- int yymajor, /* The major type of the error token */
- YYMINORTYPE yyminor /* The minor type of the error token */
-){
- sqliteParserARG_FETCH;
-#define TOKEN (yyminor.yy0)
-#line 23 "parse.y"
-
- if( pParse->zErrMsg==0 ){
- if( TOKEN.z[0] ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "near \"%T\": syntax error", &TOKEN);
- }else{
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "incomplete SQL statement");
- }
- }
-
-#line 3865 "parse.c"
- sqliteParserARG_STORE; /* Suppress warning about unused %extra_argument variable */
-}
-
-/*
-** The following is executed when the parser accepts
-*/
-static void yy_accept(
- yyParser *yypParser /* The parser */
-){
- sqliteParserARG_FETCH;
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( yyTraceFILE ){
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE,"%sAccept!\n",yyTracePrompt);
- }
-#endif
- while( yypParser->yyidx>=0 ) yy_pop_parser_stack(yypParser);
- /* Here code is inserted which will be executed whenever the
- ** parser accepts */
- sqliteParserARG_STORE; /* Suppress warning about unused %extra_argument variable */
-}
-
-/* The main parser program.
-** The first argument is a pointer to a structure obtained from
-** "sqliteParserAlloc" which describes the current state of the parser.
-** The second argument is the major token number. The third is
-** the minor token. The fourth optional argument is whatever the
-** user wants (and specified in the grammar) and is available for
-** use by the action routines.
-**
-** Inputs:
-** <ul>
-** <li> A pointer to the parser (an opaque structure.)
-** <li> The major token number.
-** <li> The minor token number.
-** <li> An option argument of a grammar-specified type.
-** </ul>
-**
-** Outputs:
-** None.
-*/
-void sqliteParser(
- void *yyp, /* The parser */
- int yymajor, /* The major token code number */
- sqliteParserTOKENTYPE yyminor /* The value for the token */
- sqliteParserARG_PDECL /* Optional %extra_argument parameter */
-){
- YYMINORTYPE yyminorunion;
- int yyact; /* The parser action. */
- int yyendofinput; /* True if we are at the end of input */
- int yyerrorhit = 0; /* True if yymajor has invoked an error */
- yyParser *yypParser; /* The parser */
-
- /* (re)initialize the parser, if necessary */
- yypParser = (yyParser*)yyp;
- if( yypParser->yyidx<0 ){
- if( yymajor==0 ) return;
- yypParser->yyidx = 0;
- yypParser->yyerrcnt = -1;
- yypParser->yystack[0].stateno = 0;
- yypParser->yystack[0].major = 0;
- }
- yyminorunion.yy0 = yyminor;
- yyendofinput = (yymajor==0);
- sqliteParserARG_STORE;
-
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( yyTraceFILE ){
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE,"%sInput %s\n",yyTracePrompt,yyTokenName[yymajor]);
- }
-#endif
-
- do{
- yyact = yy_find_shift_action(yypParser,yymajor);
- if( yyact<YYNSTATE ){
- yy_shift(yypParser,yyact,yymajor,&yyminorunion);
- yypParser->yyerrcnt--;
- if( yyendofinput && yypParser->yyidx>=0 ){
- yymajor = 0;
- }else{
- yymajor = YYNOCODE;
- }
- }else if( yyact < YYNSTATE + YYNRULE ){
- yy_reduce(yypParser,yyact-YYNSTATE);
- }else if( yyact == YY_ERROR_ACTION ){
- int yymx;
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( yyTraceFILE ){
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE,"%sSyntax Error!\n",yyTracePrompt);
- }
-#endif
-#ifdef YYERRORSYMBOL
- /* A syntax error has occurred.
- ** The response to an error depends upon whether or not the
- ** grammar defines an error token "ERROR".
- **
- ** This is what we do if the grammar does define ERROR:
- **
- ** * Call the %syntax_error function.
- **
- ** * Begin popping the stack until we enter a state where
- ** it is legal to shift the error symbol, then shift
- ** the error symbol.
- **
- ** * Set the error count to three.
- **
- ** * Begin accepting and shifting new tokens. No new error
- ** processing will occur until three tokens have been
- ** shifted successfully.
- **
- */
- if( yypParser->yyerrcnt<0 ){
- yy_syntax_error(yypParser,yymajor,yyminorunion);
- }
- yymx = yypParser->yystack[yypParser->yyidx].major;
- if( yymx==YYERRORSYMBOL || yyerrorhit ){
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( yyTraceFILE ){
- fprintf(yyTraceFILE,"%sDiscard input token %s\n",
- yyTracePrompt,yyTokenName[yymajor]);
- }
-#endif
- yy_destructor(yymajor,&yyminorunion);
- yymajor = YYNOCODE;
- }else{
- while(
- yypParser->yyidx >= 0 &&
- yymx != YYERRORSYMBOL &&
- (yyact = yy_find_shift_action(yypParser,YYERRORSYMBOL)) >= YYNSTATE
- ){
- yy_pop_parser_stack(yypParser);
- }
- if( yypParser->yyidx < 0 || yymajor==0 ){
- yy_destructor(yymajor,&yyminorunion);
- yy_parse_failed(yypParser);
- yymajor = YYNOCODE;
- }else if( yymx!=YYERRORSYMBOL ){
- YYMINORTYPE u2;
- u2.YYERRSYMDT = 0;
- yy_shift(yypParser,yyact,YYERRORSYMBOL,&u2);
- }
- }
- yypParser->yyerrcnt = 3;
- yyerrorhit = 1;
-#else /* YYERRORSYMBOL is not defined */
- /* This is what we do if the grammar does not define ERROR:
- **
- ** * Report an error message, and throw away the input token.
- **
- ** * If the input token is $, then fail the parse.
- **
- ** As before, subsequent error messages are suppressed until
- ** three input tokens have been successfully shifted.
- */
- if( yypParser->yyerrcnt<=0 ){
- yy_syntax_error(yypParser,yymajor,yyminorunion);
- }
- yypParser->yyerrcnt = 3;
- yy_destructor(yymajor,&yyminorunion);
- if( yyendofinput ){
- yy_parse_failed(yypParser);
- }
- yymajor = YYNOCODE;
-#endif
- }else{
- yy_accept(yypParser);
- yymajor = YYNOCODE;
- }
- }while( yymajor!=YYNOCODE && yypParser->yyidx>=0 );
- return;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/parse.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/parse.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 3594928..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/parse.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,130 +0,0 @@
-#define TK_END_OF_FILE 1
-#define TK_ILLEGAL 2
-#define TK_SPACE 3
-#define TK_UNCLOSED_STRING 4
-#define TK_COMMENT 5
-#define TK_FUNCTION 6
-#define TK_COLUMN 7
-#define TK_AGG_FUNCTION 8
-#define TK_SEMI 9
-#define TK_EXPLAIN 10
-#define TK_BEGIN 11
-#define TK_TRANSACTION 12
-#define TK_COMMIT 13
-#define TK_END 14
-#define TK_ROLLBACK 15
-#define TK_CREATE 16
-#define TK_TABLE 17
-#define TK_TEMP 18
-#define TK_LP 19
-#define TK_RP 20
-#define TK_AS 21
-#define TK_COMMA 22
-#define TK_ID 23
-#define TK_ABORT 24
-#define TK_AFTER 25
-#define TK_ASC 26
-#define TK_ATTACH 27
-#define TK_BEFORE 28
-#define TK_CASCADE 29
-#define TK_CLUSTER 30
-#define TK_CONFLICT 31
-#define TK_COPY 32
-#define TK_DATABASE 33
-#define TK_DEFERRED 34
-#define TK_DELIMITERS 35
-#define TK_DESC 36
-#define TK_DETACH 37
-#define TK_EACH 38
-#define TK_FAIL 39
-#define TK_FOR 40
-#define TK_GLOB 41
-#define TK_IGNORE 42
-#define TK_IMMEDIATE 43
-#define TK_INITIALLY 44
-#define TK_INSTEAD 45
-#define TK_LIKE 46
-#define TK_MATCH 47
-#define TK_KEY 48
-#define TK_OF 49
-#define TK_OFFSET 50
-#define TK_PRAGMA 51
-#define TK_RAISE 52
-#define TK_REPLACE 53
-#define TK_RESTRICT 54
-#define TK_ROW 55
-#define TK_STATEMENT 56
-#define TK_TRIGGER 57
-#define TK_VACUUM 58
-#define TK_VIEW 59
-#define TK_OR 60
-#define TK_AND 61
-#define TK_NOT 62
-#define TK_EQ 63
-#define TK_NE 64
-#define TK_ISNULL 65
-#define TK_NOTNULL 66
-#define TK_IS 67
-#define TK_BETWEEN 68
-#define TK_IN 69
-#define TK_GT 70
-#define TK_GE 71
-#define TK_LT 72
-#define TK_LE 73
-#define TK_BITAND 74
-#define TK_BITOR 75
-#define TK_LSHIFT 76
-#define TK_RSHIFT 77
-#define TK_PLUS 78
-#define TK_MINUS 79
-#define TK_STAR 80
-#define TK_SLASH 81
-#define TK_REM 82
-#define TK_CONCAT 83
-#define TK_UMINUS 84
-#define TK_UPLUS 85
-#define TK_BITNOT 86
-#define TK_STRING 87
-#define TK_JOIN_KW 88
-#define TK_INTEGER 89
-#define TK_CONSTRAINT 90
-#define TK_DEFAULT 91
-#define TK_FLOAT 92
-#define TK_NULL 93
-#define TK_PRIMARY 94
-#define TK_UNITQUE 95
-#define TK_CHECK 96
-#define TK_REFERENCES 97
-#define TK_COLLATE 98
-#define TK_ON 99
-#define TK_DELETE 100
-#define TK_UPDATE 101
-#define TK_INSERT 102
-#define TK_SET 103
-#define TK_DEFERRABLE 104
-#define TK_FOREIGN 105
-#define TK_DROP 106
-#define TK_UNION 107
-#define TK_ALL 108
-#define TK_INTERSECT 109
-#define TK_EXCEPT 110
-#define TK_SELECT 111
-#define TK_DISTINCT 112
-#define TK_DOT 113
-#define TK_FROM 114
-#define TK_JOIN 115
-#define TK_USING 116
-#define TK_ORDER 117
-#define TK_BY 118
-#define TK_GROUP 119
-#define TK_HAVING 120
-#define TK_LIMIT 121
-#define TK_WHERE 122
-#define TK_INTO 123
-#define TK_VALUES 124
-#define TK_VARIABLE 125
-#define TK_CASE 126
-#define TK_WHEN 127
-#define TK_THEN 128
-#define TK_ELSE 129
-#define TK_INDEX 130
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pragma.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pragma.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 6534766..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/pragma.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,699 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2003 April 6
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains code used to implement the PRAGMA command.
-**
-** $Id: pragma.c,v 1.18 2004/02/22 20:05:01 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include <ctype.h>
-
-/*
-** Interpret the given string as a boolean value.
-*/
-static int getBoolean(const char *z){
- static char *azTrue[] = { "yes", "on", "true" };
- int i;
- if( z[0]==0 ) return 0;
- if( isdigit(z[0]) || (z[0]=='-' && isdigit(z[1])) ){
- return atoi(z);
- }
- for(i=0; i<sizeof(azTrue)/sizeof(azTrue[0]); i++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(z,azTrue[i])==0 ) return 1;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Interpret the given string as a safety level. Return 0 for OFF,
-** 1 for ON or NORMAL and 2 for FULL. Return 1 for an empty or
-** unrecognized string argument.
-**
-** Note that the values returned are one less that the values that
-** should be passed into sqliteBtreeSetSafetyLevel(). The is done
-** to support legacy SQL code. The safety level used to be boolean
-** and older scripts may have used numbers 0 for OFF and 1 for ON.
-*/
-static int getSafetyLevel(char *z){
- static const struct {
- const char *zWord;
- int val;
- } aKey[] = {
- { "no", 0 },
- { "off", 0 },
- { "false", 0 },
- { "yes", 1 },
- { "on", 1 },
- { "true", 1 },
- { "full", 2 },
- };
- int i;
- if( z[0]==0 ) return 1;
- if( isdigit(z[0]) || (z[0]=='-' && isdigit(z[1])) ){
- return atoi(z);
- }
- for(i=0; i<sizeof(aKey)/sizeof(aKey[0]); i++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(z,aKey[i].zWord)==0 ) return aKey[i].val;
- }
- return 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Interpret the given string as a temp db location. Return 1 for file
-** backed temporary databases, 2 for the Red-Black tree in memory database
-** and 0 to use the compile-time default.
-*/
-static int getTempStore(char *z){
- if( z[0]>='0' || z[0]<='2' ){
- return z[0] - '0';
- }else if( sqliteStrICmp(z, "file")==0 ){
- return 1;
- }else if( sqliteStrICmp(z, "memory")==0 ){
- return 2;
- }else{
- return 0;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Check to see if zRight and zLeft refer to a pragma that queries
-** or changes one of the flags in db->flags. Return 1 if so and 0 if not.
-** Also, implement the pragma.
-*/
-static int flagPragma(Parse *pParse, const char *zLeft, const char *zRight){
- static const struct {
- const char *zName; /* Name of the pragma */
- int mask; /* Mask for the db->flags value */
- } aPragma[] = {
- { "vdbe_trace", STQLITE_VdbeTrace },
- { "full_column_names", STQLITE_FullColNames },
- { "short_column_names", STQLITE_ShortColNames },
- { "show_datatypes", STQLITE_ReportTypes },
- { "count_changes", STQLITE_CountRows },
- { "empty_result_callbacks", STQLITE_NullCallback },
- };
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<sizeof(aPragma)/sizeof(aPragma[0]); i++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, aPragma[i].zName)==0 ){
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- Vdbe *v;
- if( strcmp(zLeft,zRight)==0 && (v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse))!=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_ColumnName, 0, 1, aPragma[i].zName, P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_ColumnName, 1, 0, "boolean", P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeCode(v, OP_Integer, (db->flags & aPragma[i].mask)!=0, 0,
- OP_Callback, 1, 0,
- 0);
- }else if( getBoolean(zRight) ){
- db->flags |= aPragma[i].mask;
- }else{
- db->flags &= ~aPragma[i].mask;
- }
- return 1;
- }
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Process a pragma statement.
-**
-** Pragmas are of this form:
-**
-** PRAGMA id = value
-**
-** The identifier might also be a string. The value is a string, and
-** identifier, or a number. If minusFlag is true, then the value is
-** a number that was preceded by a minus sign.
-*/
-void sqlitePragma(Parse *pParse, Token *pLeft, Token *pRight, int minusFlag){
- char *zLeft = 0;
- char *zRight = 0;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- Vdbe *v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) return;
-
- zLeft = sqliteStrNDup(pLeft->z, pLeft->n);
- sqliteDequote(zLeft);
- if( minusFlag ){
- zRight = 0;
- sqliteSetNString(&zRight, "-", 1, pRight->z, pRight->n, 0);
- }else{
- zRight = sqliteStrNDup(pRight->z, pRight->n);
- sqliteDequote(zRight);
- }
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_PRAGMA, zLeft, zRight, 0) ){
- sqliteFree(zLeft);
- sqliteFree(zRight);
- return;
- }
-
- /*
- ** PRAGMA default_cache_size
- ** PRAGMA default_cache_size=N
- **
- ** The first form reports the current persistent setting for the
- ** page cache size. The value returned is the maximum number of
- ** pages in the page cache. The second form sets both the current
- ** page cache size value and the persistent page cache size value
- ** stored in the database file.
- **
- ** The default cache size is stored in meta-value 2 of page 1 of the
- ** database file. The cache size is actually the absolute value of
- ** this memory location. The sign of meta-value 2 determines the
- ** synchronous setting. A negative value means synchronous is off
- ** and a positive value means synchronous is on.
- */
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft,"default_cache_size")==0 ){
- static VdbeOpList getCacheSize[] = {
- { OP_ReadCookie, 0, 2, 0},
- { OP_AbsValue, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_Dup, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_Integer, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_Ne, 0, 6, 0},
- { OP_Integer, 0, 0, 0}, /* 5 */
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 1, "cache_size"},
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0},
- };
- int addr;
- if( pRight->z==pLeft->z ){
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(getCacheSize), getCacheSize);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP1(v, addr+5, MAX_PAGES);
- }else{
- int size = atoi(zRight);
- if( size<0 ) size = -size;
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, size, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ReadCookie, 0, 2);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Ge, 0, addr+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Negative, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetCookie, 0, 2);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- db->cache_size = db->cache_size<0 ? -size : size;
- sqliteBtreeSetCacheSize(db->aDb[0].pBt, db->cache_size);
- }
- }else
-
- /*
- ** PRAGMA cache_size
- ** PRAGMA cache_size=N
- **
- ** The first form reports the current local setting for the
- ** page cache size. The local setting can be different from
- ** the persistent cache size value that is stored in the database
- ** file itself. The value returned is the maximum number of
- ** pages in the page cache. The second form sets the local
- ** page cache size value. It does not change the persistent
- ** cache size stored on the disk so the cache size will revert
- ** to its default value when the database is closed and reopened.
- ** N should be a positive integer.
- */
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft,"cache_size")==0 ){
- static VdbeOpList getCacheSize[] = {
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 1, "cache_size"},
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0},
- };
- if( pRight->z==pLeft->z ){
- int size = db->cache_size;;
- if( size<0 ) size = -size;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, size, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(getCacheSize), getCacheSize);
- }else{
- int size = atoi(zRight);
- if( size<0 ) size = -size;
- if( db->cache_size<0 ) size = -size;
- db->cache_size = size;
- sqliteBtreeSetCacheSize(db->aDb[0].pBt, db->cache_size);
- }
- }else
-
- /*
- ** PRAGMA default_synchronous
- ** PRAGMA default_synchronous=ON|OFF|NORMAL|FULL
- **
- ** The first form returns the persistent value of the "synchronous" setting
- ** that is stored in the database. This is the synchronous setting that
- ** is used whenever the database is opened unless overridden by a separate
- ** "synchronous" pragma. The second form changes the persistent and the
- ** local synchronous setting to the value given.
- **
- ** If synchronous is OFF, STQLite does not attempt any fsync() systems calls
- ** to make sure data is committed to disk. Write operations are very fast,
- ** but a power failure can leave the database in an inconsistent state.
- ** If synchronous is ON or NORMAL, STQLite will do an fsync() system call to
- ** make sure data is being written to disk. The risk of corruption due to
- ** a power loss in this mode is negligible but non-zero. If synchronous
- ** is FULL, extra fsync()s occur to reduce the risk of corruption to near
- ** zero, but with a write performance penalty. The default mode is NORMAL.
- */
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft,"default_synchronous")==0 ){
- static VdbeOpList getSync[] = {
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 1, "synchronous"},
- { OP_ReadCookie, 0, 3, 0},
- { OP_Dup, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_If, 0, 0, 0}, /* 3 */
- { OP_ReadCookie, 0, 2, 0},
- { OP_Integer, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_Lt, 0, 5, 0},
- { OP_AddImm, 1, 0, 0},
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0},
- { OP_Halt, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_AddImm, -1, 0, 0}, /* 10 */
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0}
- };
- if( pRight->z==pLeft->z ){
- int addr = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(getSync), getSync);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr+3, addr+10);
- }else{
- int addr;
- int size = db->cache_size;
- if( size<0 ) size = -size;
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ReadCookie, 0, 2);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 0, 0);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Ne, 0, addr+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AddImm, MAX_PAGES, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AbsValue, 0, 0);
- db->safety_level = getSafetyLevel(zRight)+1;
- if( db->safety_level==1 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Negative, 0, 0);
- size = -size;
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetCookie, 0, 2);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, db->safety_level, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetCookie, 0, 3);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- db->cache_size = size;
- sqliteBtreeSetCacheSize(db->aDb[0].pBt, db->cache_size);
- sqliteBtreeSetSafetyLevel(db->aDb[0].pBt, db->safety_level);
- }
- }else
-
- /*
- ** PRAGMA synchronous
- ** PRAGMA synchronous=OFF|ON|NORMAL|FULL
- **
- ** Return or set the local value of the synchronous flag. Changing
- ** the local value does not make changes to the disk file and the
- ** default value will be restored the next time the database is
- ** opened.
- */
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft,"synchronous")==0 ){
- static VdbeOpList getSync[] = {
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 1, "synchronous"},
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0},
- };
- if( pRight->z==pLeft->z ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, db->safety_level-1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(getSync), getSync);
- }else{
- int size = db->cache_size;
- if( size<0 ) size = -size;
- db->safety_level = getSafetyLevel(zRight)+1;
- if( db->safety_level==1 ) size = -size;
- db->cache_size = size;
- sqliteBtreeSetCacheSize(db->aDb[0].pBt, db->cache_size);
- sqliteBtreeSetSafetyLevel(db->aDb[0].pBt, db->safety_level);
- }
- }else
-
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, "trigger_overhead_test")==0 ){
- if( getBoolean(zRight) ){
- always_code_trigger_setup = 1;
- }else{
- always_code_trigger_setup = 0;
- }
- }else
-#endif
-
- if( flagPragma(pParse, zLeft, zRight) ){
- /* The flagPragma() call also generates any necessary code */
- }else
-
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, "table_info")==0 ){
- Table *pTab;
- pTab = sqliteFindTable(db, zRight, 0);
- if( pTab ){
- static VdbeOpList tableInfoPreface[] = {
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 0, "cid"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 1, 0, "name"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 2, 0, "type"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 3, 0, "notnull"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 4, 0, "dflt_value"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 5, 1, "pk"},
- };
- int i;
- sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(tableInfoPreface), tableInfoPreface);
- sqliteViewGetColumnNames(pParse, pTab);
- for(i=0; i<pTab->nCol; i++){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, i, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, pTab->aCol[i].zName, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0,
- pTab->aCol[i].zType ? pTab->aCol[i].zType : "numeric", 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pTab->aCol[i].notNull, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0,
- pTab->aCol[i].zDflt, P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pTab->aCol[i].isPrimKey, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Callback, 6, 0);
- }
- }
- }else
-
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, "index_info")==0 ){
- Index *pIdx;
- Table *pTab;
- pIdx = sqliteFindIndex(db, zRight, 0);
- if( pIdx ){
- static VdbeOpList tableInfoPreface[] = {
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 0, "seqno"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 1, 0, "cid"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 2, 1, "name"},
- };
- int i;
- pTab = pIdx->pTable;
- sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(tableInfoPreface), tableInfoPreface);
- for(i=0; i<pIdx->nColumn; i++){
- int cnum = pIdx->aiColumn[i];
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, i, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, cnum, 0);
- assert( pTab->nCol>cnum );
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, pTab->aCol[cnum].zName, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Callback, 3, 0);
- }
- }
- }else
-
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, "index_list")==0 ){
- Index *pIdx;
- Table *pTab;
- pTab = sqliteFindTable(db, zRight, 0);
- if( pTab ){
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- pIdx = pTab->pIndex;
- }
- if( pTab && pIdx ){
- int i = 0;
- static VdbeOpList indexListPreface[] = {
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 0, "seq"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 1, 0, "name"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 2, 1, "unique"},
- };
-
- sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(indexListPreface), indexListPreface);
- while(pIdx){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, i, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, pIdx->zName, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pIdx->onError!=OE_None, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Callback, 3, 0);
- ++i;
- pIdx = pIdx->pNext;
- }
- }
- }else
-
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, "foreign_key_list")==0 ){
- FKey *pFK;
- Table *pTab;
- pTab = sqliteFindTable(db, zRight, 0);
- if( pTab ){
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- pFK = pTab->pFKey;
- }
- if( pTab && pFK ){
- int i = 0;
- static VdbeOpList indexListPreface[] = {
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 0, "id"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 1, 0, "seq"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 2, 0, "table"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 3, 0, "from"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 4, 1, "to"},
- };
-
- sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(indexListPreface), indexListPreface);
- while(pFK){
- int j;
- for(j=0; j<pFK->nCol; j++){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, i, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, j, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, pFK->zTo, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0,
- pTab->aCol[pFK->aCol[j].iFrom].zName, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, pFK->aCol[j].zCol, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Callback, 5, 0);
- }
- ++i;
- pFK = pFK->pNextFrom;
- }
- }
- }else
-
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, "database_list")==0 ){
- int i;
- static VdbeOpList indexListPreface[] = {
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 0, "seq"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 1, 0, "name"},
- { OP_ColumnName, 2, 1, "file"},
- };
-
- sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(indexListPreface), indexListPreface);
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- if( db->aDb[i].pBt==0 ) continue;
- assert( db->aDb[i].zName!=0 );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, i, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0, db->aDb[i].zName, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_String, 0, 0,
- sqliteBtreeGetFilename(db->aDb[i].pBt), 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Callback, 3, 0);
- }
- }else
-
-
- /*
- ** PRAGMA temp_store
- ** PRAGMA temp_store = "default"|"memory"|"file"
- **
- ** Return or set the local value of the temp_store flag. Changing
- ** the local value does not make changes to the disk file and the default
- ** value will be restored the next time the database is opened.
- **
- ** Note that it is possible for the library compile-time options to
- ** override this setting
- */
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, "temp_store")==0 ){
- static VdbeOpList getTmpDbLoc[] = {
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 1, "temp_store"},
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0},
- };
- if( pRight->z==pLeft->z ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, db->temp_store, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(getTmpDbLoc), getTmpDbLoc);
- }else{
- if (&db->aDb[1].pBt != 0) {
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "The temporary database already exists - "
- "its location cannot now be changed");
- } else {
- db->temp_store = getTempStore(zRight);
- }
- }
- }else
-
- /*
- ** PRAGMA default_temp_store
- ** PRAGMA default_temp_store = "default"|"memory"|"file"
- **
- ** Return or set the value of the persistent temp_store flag (as
- ** well as the value currently in force).
- **
- ** Note that it is possible for the library compile-time options to
- ** override this setting
- */
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, "default_temp_store")==0 ){
- static VdbeOpList getTmpDbLoc[] = {
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 1, "temp_store"},
- { OP_ReadCookie, 0, 5, 0},
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0}};
- if( pRight->z==pLeft->z ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(getTmpDbLoc), getTmpDbLoc);
- }else{
- if (&db->aDb[1].pBt != 0) {
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "The temporary database already exists - "
- "its location cannot now be changed");
- } else {
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 0, 0);
- db->temp_store = getTempStore(zRight);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, db->temp_store, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetCookie, 0, 5);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- }
- }
- }else
-
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, "parser_trace")==0 ){
- extern void sqliteParserTrace(FILE*, char *);
- if( getBoolean(zRight) ){
- sqliteParserTrace(stdout, "parser: ");
- }else{
- sqliteParserTrace(0, 0);
- }
- }else
-#endif
-
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zLeft, "integrity_check")==0 ){
- int i, j, addr;
-
- /* Code that initializes the integrity check program. Set the
- ** error count 0
- */
- static VdbeOpList initCode[] = {
- { OP_Integer, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_MemStore, 0, 1, 0},
- { OP_ColumnName, 0, 1, "integrity_check"},
- };
-
- /* Code to do an BTree integrity check on a single database file.
- */
- static VdbeOpList checkDb[] = {
- { OP_SetInsert, 0, 0, "2"},
- { OP_Integer, 0, 0, 0}, /* 1 */
- { OP_OpenRead, 0, 2, 0},
- { OP_Rewind, 0, 7, 0}, /* 3 */
- { OP_Column, 0, 3, 0}, /* 4 */
- { OP_SetInsert, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_Next, 0, 4, 0}, /* 6 */
- { OP_IntegrityCk, 0, 0, 0}, /* 7 */
- { OP_Dup, 0, 1, 0},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, "ok"},
- { OP_StrEq, 0, 12, 0}, /* 10 */
- { OP_MemIncr, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, "*** in database "},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, 0}, /* 13 */
- { OP_String, 0, 0, " ***\n"},
- { OP_Pull, 3, 0, 0},
- { OP_Concat, 4, 1, 0},
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0},
- };
-
- /* Code that appears at the end of the integrity check. If no error
- ** messages have been generated, output OK. Otherwise output the
- ** error message
- */
- static VdbeOpList endCode[] = {
- { OP_MemLoad, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_Integer, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_Ne, 0, 0, 0}, /* 2 */
- { OP_String, 0, 0, "ok"},
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0},
- };
-
- /* Initialize the VDBE program */
- sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(initCode), initCode);
-
- /* Do an integrity check on each database file */
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- HashElem *x;
-
- /* Do an integrity check of the B-Tree
- */
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(checkDb), checkDb);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP1(v, addr+1, i);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr+3, addr+7);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr+6, addr+4);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr+7, i);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr+10, addr+ArraySize(checkDb));
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, addr+13, db->aDb[i].zName, P3_STATIC);
-
- /* Make sure all the indices are constructed correctly.
- */
- sqliteCodeVerifySchema(pParse, i);
- for(x=sqliteHashFirst(&db->aDb[i].tblHash); x; x=sqliteHashNext(x)){
- Table *pTab = sqliteHashData(x);
- Index *pIdx;
- int loopTop;
-
- if( pTab->pIndex==0 ) continue;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, i, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_OpenRead, 1, pTab->tnum, pTab->zName, 0);
- for(j=0, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, j++){
- if( pIdx->tnum==0 ) continue;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pIdx->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_OpenRead, j+2, pIdx->tnum, pIdx->zName, 0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, 1, 1);
- loopTop = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemIncr, 1, 0);
- for(j=0, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, j++){
- int k, jmp2;
- static VdbeOpList idxErr[] = {
- { OP_MemIncr, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, "rowid "},
- { OP_Recno, 1, 0, 0},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, " missing from index "},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, 0}, /* 4 */
- { OP_Concat, 4, 0, 0},
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0},
- };
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Recno, 1, 0);
- for(k=0; k<pIdx->nColumn; k++){
- int idx = pIdx->aiColumn[k];
- if( idx==pTab->iPKey ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Recno, 1, 0);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, 1, idx);
- }
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeIdxKey, pIdx->nColumn, 0);
- if( db->file_format>=4 ) sqliteAddIdxKeyType(v, pIdx);
- jmp2 = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Found, j+2, 0);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(idxErr), idxErr);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, addr+4, pIdx->zName, P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, jmp2, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v));
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Next, 1, loopTop+1);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, loopTop, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v));
- for(j=0, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, j++){
- static VdbeOpList cntIdx[] = {
- { OP_Integer, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_MemStore, 2, 1, 0},
- { OP_Rewind, 0, 0, 0}, /* 2 */
- { OP_MemIncr, 2, 0, 0},
- { OP_Next, 0, 0, 0}, /* 4 */
- { OP_MemLoad, 1, 0, 0},
- { OP_MemLoad, 2, 0, 0},
- { OP_Eq, 0, 0, 0}, /* 7 */
- { OP_MemIncr, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, "wrong # of entries in index "},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, 0}, /* 10 */
- { OP_Concat, 2, 0, 0},
- { OP_Callback, 1, 0, 0},
- };
- if( pIdx->tnum==0 ) continue;
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(cntIdx), cntIdx);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP1(v, addr+2, j+2);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr+2, addr+5);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP1(v, addr+4, j+2);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr+4, addr+3);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr+7, addr+ArraySize(cntIdx));
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, addr+10, pIdx->zName, P3_STATIC);
- }
- }
- }
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(endCode), endCode);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr+2, addr+ArraySize(endCode));
- }else
-
- {}
- sqliteFree(zLeft);
- sqliteFree(zRight);
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/printf.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/printf.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 24cb9f7..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/printf.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,855 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** The "printf" code that follows dates from the 1980's. It is in
-** the public domain. The original comments are included here for
-** completeness. They are very out-of-date but might be useful as
-** an historical reference. Most of the "enhancements" have been backed
-** out so that the functionality is now the same as standard printf().
-**
-**************************************************************************
-**
-** The following modules is an enhanced replacement for the "printf" subroutines
-** found in the standard C library. The following enhancements are
-** supported:
-**
-** + Additional functions. The standard set of "printf" functions
-** includes printf, fprintf, sprintf, vprintf, vfprintf, and
-** vsprintf. This module adds the following:
-**
-** * snprintf -- Works like sprintf, but has an extra argument
-** which is the size of the buffer written to.
-**
-** * mprintf -- Similar to sprintf. Writes output to memory
-** obtained from malloc.
-**
-** * xprintf -- Calls a function to dispose of output.
-**
-** * nprintf -- No output, but returns the number of characters
-** that would have been output by printf.
-**
-** * A v- version (ex: vsnprintf) of every function is also
-** supplied.
-**
-** + A few extensions to the formatting notation are supported:
-**
-** * The "=" flag (similar to "-") causes the output to be
-** be centered in the appropriately sized field.
-**
-** * The %b field outputs an integer in binary notation.
-**
-** * The %c field now accepts a precision. The character output
-** is repeated by the number of times the precision specifies.
-**
-** * The %' field works like %c, but takes as its character the
-** next character of the format string, instead of the next
-** argument. For example, printf("%.78'-") prints 78 minus
-** signs, the same as printf("%.78c",'-').
-**
-** + When compiled using GCC on a SPARC, this version of printf is
-** faster than the library printf for SUN OS 4.1.
-**
-** + All functions are fully reentrant.
-**
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-/*
-** Conversion types fall into various categories as defined by the
-** following enumeration.
-*/
-#define etRADIX 1 /* Integer types. %d, %x, %o, and so forth */
-#define etFLOAT 2 /* Floating point. %f */
-#define etEXP 3 /* Exponentional notation. %e and %E */
-#define etGENERIC 4 /* Floating or exponential, depending on exponent. %g */
-#define etSIZE 5 /* Return number of characters processed so far. %n */
-#define etSTRING 6 /* Strings. %s */
-#define etDYNSTRING 7 /* Dynamically allocated strings. %z */
-#define etPERCENT 8 /* Percent symbol. %% */
-#define etCHARX 9 /* Characters. %c */
-#define etERROR 10 /* Used to indicate no such conversion type */
-/* The rest are extensions, not normally found in printf() */
-#define etCHARLIT 11 /* Literal characters. %' */
-#define etSTQLESCAPE 12 /* Strings with '\'' doubled. %q */
-#define etSTQLESCAPE2 13 /* Strings with '\'' doubled and enclosed in '',
- NULL pointers replaced by SQL NULL. %Q */
-#define etTOKEN 14 /* a pointer to a Token structure */
-#define etSRCLIST 15 /* a pointer to a SrcList */
-
-
-/*
-** An "etByte" is an 8-bit unsigned value.
-*/
-typedef unsigned char etByte;
-
-/*
-** Each builtin conversion character (ex: the 'd' in "%d") is described
-** by an instance of the following structure
-*/
-typedef struct et_info { /* Information about each format field */
- char fmttype; /* The format field code letter */
- etByte base; /* The base for radix conversion */
- etByte flags; /* One or more of FLAG_ constants below */
- etByte type; /* Conversion paradigm */
- char *charset; /* The character set for conversion */
- char *prefix; /* Prefix on non-zero values in alt format */
-} et_info;
-
-/*
-** Allowed values for et_info.flags
-*/
-#define FLAG_SIGNED 1 /* True if the value to convert is signed */
-#define FLAG_INTERN 2 /* True if for internal use only */
-
-
-/*
-** The following table is searched linearly, so it is good to put the
-** most frequently used conversion types first.
-*/
-static et_info fmtinfo[] = {
- { 'd', 10, 1, etRADIX, "0123456789", 0 },
- { 's', 0, 0, etSTRING, 0, 0 },
- { 'z', 0, 2, etDYNSTRING, 0, 0 },
- { 'q', 0, 0, etSTQLESCAPE, 0, 0 },
- { 'Q', 0, 0, etSTQLESCAPE2, 0, 0 },
- { 'c', 0, 0, etCHARX, 0, 0 },
- { 'o', 8, 0, etRADIX, "01234567", "0" },
- { 'u', 10, 0, etRADIX, "0123456789", 0 },
- { 'x', 16, 0, etRADIX, "0123456789abcdef", "x0" },
- { 'X', 16, 0, etRADIX, "0123456789ABCDEF", "X0" },
- { 'f', 0, 1, etFLOAT, 0, 0 },
- { 'e', 0, 1, etEXP, "e", 0 },
- { 'E', 0, 1, etEXP, "E", 0 },
- { 'g', 0, 1, etGENERIC, "e", 0 },
- { 'G', 0, 1, etGENERIC, "E", 0 },
- { 'i', 10, 1, etRADIX, "0123456789", 0 },
- { 'n', 0, 0, etSIZE, 0, 0 },
- { '%', 0, 0, etPERCENT, 0, 0 },
- { 'p', 10, 0, etRADIX, "0123456789", 0 },
- { 'T', 0, 2, etTOKEN, 0, 0 },
- { 'S', 0, 2, etSRCLIST, 0, 0 },
-};
-#define etNINFO (sizeof(fmtinfo)/sizeof(fmtinfo[0]))
-
-/*
-** If NOFLOATINGPOINT is defined, then none of the floating point
-** conversions will work.
-*/
-#ifndef etNOFLOATINGPOINT
-/*
-** "*val" is a double such that 0.1 <= *val < 10.0
-** Return the ascii code for the leading digit of *val, then
-** multiply "*val" by 10.0 to renormalize.
-**
-** Example:
-** input: *val = 3.14159
-** output: *val = 1.4159 function return = '3'
-**
-** The counter *cnt is incremented each time. After counter exceeds
-** 16 (the number of significant digits in a 64-bit float) '0' is
-** always returned.
-*/
-static int et_getdigit(LONGDOUBLE_TYPE *val, int *cnt){
- int digit;
- LONGDOUBLE_TYPE d;
- if( (*cnt)++ >= 16 ) return '0';
- digit = (int)*val;
- d = digit;
- digit += '0';
- *val = (*val - d)*10.0;
- return digit;
-}
-#endif
-
-#define etBUFSIZE 1000 /* Size of the output buffer */
-
-/*
-** The root program. All variations call this core.
-**
-** INPUTS:
-** func This is a pointer to a function taking three arguments
-** 1. A pointer to anything. Same as the "arg" parameter.
-** 2. A pointer to the list of characters to be output
-** (Note, this list is NOT null terminated.)
-** 3. An integer number of characters to be output.
-** (Note: This number might be zero.)
-**
-** arg This is the pointer to anything which will be passed as the
-** first argument to "func". Use it for whatever you like.
-**
-** fmt This is the format string, as in the usual print.
-**
-** ap This is a pointer to a list of arguments. Same as in
-** vfprint.
-**
-** OUTPUTS:
-** The return value is the total number of characters sent to
-** the function "func". Returns -1 on a error.
-**
-** Note that the order in which automatic variables are declared below
-** seems to make a big difference in determining how fast this beast
-** will run.
-*/
-static int vxprintf(
- void (*func)(void*,const char*,int), /* Consumer of text */
- void *arg, /* First argument to the consumer */
- int useExtended, /* Allow extended %-conversions */
- const char *fmt, /* Format string */
- va_list ap /* arguments */
-){
- int c; /* Next character in the format string */
- char *bufpt; /* Pointer to the conversion buffer */
- int precision; /* Precision of the current field */
- int length; /* Length of the field */
- int idx; /* A general purpose loop counter */
- int count; /* Total number of characters output */
- int width; /* Width of the current field */
- etByte flag_leftjustify; /* True if "-" flag is present */
- etByte flag_plussign; /* True if "+" flag is present */
- etByte flag_blanksign; /* True if " " flag is present */
- etByte flag_alternateform; /* True if "#" flag is present */
- etByte flag_zeropad; /* True if field width constant starts with zero */
- etByte flag_long; /* True if "l" flag is present */
- unsigned long longvalue; /* Value for integer types */
- LONGDOUBLE_TYPE realvalue; /* Value for real types */
- et_info *infop; /* Pointer to the appropriate info structure */
- char buf[etBUFSIZE]; /* Conversion buffer */
- char prefix; /* Prefix character. "+" or "-" or " " or '\0'. */
- etByte errorflag = 0; /* True if an error is encountered */
- etByte xtype; /* Conversion paradigm */
- char *zExtra; /* Extra memory used for etTCLESCAPE conversions */
- static char spaces[] = " ";
-#define etSPACESIZE (sizeof(spaces)-1)
-#ifndef etNOFLOATINGPOINT
- int exp; /* exponent of real numbers */
- double rounder; /* Used for rounding floating point values */
- etByte flag_dp; /* True if decimal point should be shown */
- etByte flag_rtz; /* True if trailing zeros should be removed */
- etByte flag_exp; /* True to force display of the exponent */
- int nsd; /* Number of significant digits returned */
-#endif
-
- count = length = 0;
- bufpt = 0;
- for(; (c=(*fmt))!=0; ++fmt){
- if( c!='%' ){
- int amt;
- bufpt = (char *)fmt;
- amt = 1;
- while( (c=(*++fmt))!='%' && c!=0 ) amt++;
- (*func)(arg,bufpt,amt);
- count += amt;
- if( c==0 ) break;
- }
- if( (c=(*++fmt))==0 ){
- errorflag = 1;
- (*func)(arg,"%",1);
- count++;
- break;
- }
- /* Find out what flags are present */
- flag_leftjustify = flag_plussign = flag_blanksign =
- flag_alternateform = flag_zeropad = 0;
- do{
- switch( c ){
- case '-': flag_leftjustify = 1; c = 0; break;
- case '+': flag_plussign = 1; c = 0; break;
- case ' ': flag_blanksign = 1; c = 0; break;
- case '#': flag_alternateform = 1; c = 0; break;
- case '0': flag_zeropad = 1; c = 0; break;
- default: break;
- }
- }while( c==0 && (c=(*++fmt))!=0 );
- /* Get the field width */
- width = 0;
- if( c=='*' ){
- width = va_arg(ap,int);
- if( width<0 ){
- flag_leftjustify = 1;
- width = -width;
- }
- c = *++fmt;
- }else{
- while( c>='0' && c<='9' ){
- width = width*10 + c - '0';
- c = *++fmt;
- }
- }
- if( width > etBUFSIZE-10 ){
- width = etBUFSIZE-10;
- }
- /* Get the precision */
- if( c=='.' ){
- precision = 0;
- c = *++fmt;
- if( c=='*' ){
- precision = va_arg(ap,int);
- if( precision<0 ) precision = -precision;
- c = *++fmt;
- }else{
- while( c>='0' && c<='9' ){
- precision = precision*10 + c - '0';
- c = *++fmt;
- }
- }
- /* Limit the precision to prevent overflowing buf[] during conversion */
- if( precision>etBUFSIZE-40 ) precision = etBUFSIZE-40;
- }else{
- precision = -1;
- }
- /* Get the conversion type modifier */
- if( c=='l' ){
- flag_long = 1;
- c = *++fmt;
- }else{
- flag_long = 0;
- }
- /* Fetch the info entry for the field */
- infop = 0;
- xtype = etERROR;
- for(idx=0; idx<etNINFO; idx++){
- if( c==fmtinfo[idx].fmttype ){
- infop = &fmtinfo[idx];
- if( useExtended || (infop->flags & FLAG_INTERN)==0 ){
- xtype = infop->type;
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- zExtra = 0;
-
- /*
- ** At this point, variables are initialized as follows:
- **
- ** flag_alternateform TRUE if a '#' is present.
- ** flag_plussign TRUE if a '+' is present.
- ** flag_leftjustify TRUE if a '-' is present or if the
- ** field width was negative.
- ** flag_zeropad TRUE if the width began with 0.
- ** flag_long TRUE if the letter 'l' (ell) prefixed
- ** the conversion character.
- ** flag_blanksign TRUE if a ' ' is present.
- ** width The specified field width. This is
- ** always non-negative. Zero is the default.
- ** precision The specified precision. The default
- ** is -1.
- ** xtype The class of the conversion.
- ** infop Pointer to the appropriate info struct.
- */
- switch( xtype ){
- case etRADIX:
- if( flag_long ) longvalue = va_arg(ap,long);
- else longvalue = va_arg(ap,int);
-#if 1
- /* For the format %#x, the value zero is printed "0" not "0x0".
- ** I think this is stupid. */
- if( longvalue==0 ) flag_alternateform = 0;
-#else
- /* More sensible: turn off the prefix for octal (to prevent "00"),
- ** but leave the prefix for hex. */
- if( longvalue==0 && infop->base==8 ) flag_alternateform = 0;
-#endif
- if( infop->flags & FLAG_SIGNED ){
- if( *(long*)&longvalue<0 ){
- longvalue = -*(long*)&longvalue;
- prefix = '-';
- }else if( flag_plussign ) prefix = '+';
- else if( flag_blanksign ) prefix = ' ';
- else prefix = 0;
- }else prefix = 0;
- if( flag_zeropad && precision<width-(prefix!=0) ){
- precision = width-(prefix!=0);
- }
- bufpt = &buf[etBUFSIZE-1];
- {
- register char *cset; /* Use registers for speed */
- register int base;
- cset = infop->charset;
- base = infop->base;
- do{ /* Convert to ascii */
- *(--bufpt) = cset[longvalue%base];
- longvalue = longvalue/base;
- }while( longvalue>0 );
- }
- length = &buf[etBUFSIZE-1]-bufpt;
- for(idx=precision-length; idx>0; idx--){
- *(--bufpt) = '0'; /* Zero pad */
- }
- if( prefix ) *(--bufpt) = prefix; /* Add sign */
- if( flag_alternateform && infop->prefix ){ /* Add "0" or "0x" */
- char *pre, x;
- pre = infop->prefix;
- if( *bufpt!=pre[0] ){
- for(pre=infop->prefix; (x=(*pre))!=0; pre++) *(--bufpt) = x;
- }
- }
- length = &buf[etBUFSIZE-1]-bufpt;
- break;
- case etFLOAT:
- case etEXP:
- case etGENERIC:
- realvalue = va_arg(ap,double);
-#ifndef etNOFLOATINGPOINT
- if( precision<0 ) precision = 6; /* Set default precision */
- if( precision>etBUFSIZE-10 ) precision = etBUFSIZE-10;
- if( realvalue<0.0 ){
- realvalue = -realvalue;
- prefix = '-';
- }else{
- if( flag_plussign ) prefix = '+';
- else if( flag_blanksign ) prefix = ' ';
- else prefix = 0;
- }
- if( infop->type==etGENERIC && precision>0 ) precision--;
- rounder = 0.0;
-#if 0
- /* Rounding works like BSD when the constant 0.4999 is used. Wierd! */
- for(idx=precision, rounder=0.4999; idx>0; idx--, rounder*=0.1);
-#else
- /* It makes more sense to use 0.5 */
- for(idx=precision, rounder=0.5; idx>0; idx--, rounder*=0.1);
-#endif
- if( infop->type==etFLOAT ) realvalue += rounder;
- /* Normalize realvalue to within 10.0 > realvalue >= 1.0 */
- exp = 0;
- if( realvalue>0.0 ){
- while( realvalue>=1e8 && exp<=350 ){ realvalue *= 1e-8; exp+=8; }
- while( realvalue>=10.0 && exp<=350 ){ realvalue *= 0.1; exp++; }
- while( realvalue<1e-8 && exp>=-350 ){ realvalue *= 1e8; exp-=8; }
- while( realvalue<1.0 && exp>=-350 ){ realvalue *= 10.0; exp--; }
- if( exp>350 || exp<-350 ){
- bufpt = "NaN";
- length = 3;
- break;
- }
- }
- bufpt = buf;
- /*
- ** If the field type is etGENERIC, then convert to either etEXP
- ** or etFLOAT, as appropriate.
- */
- flag_exp = xtype==etEXP;
- if( xtype!=etFLOAT ){
- realvalue += rounder;
- if( realvalue>=10.0 ){ realvalue *= 0.1; exp++; }
- }
- if( xtype==etGENERIC ){
- flag_rtz = !flag_alternateform;
- if( exp<-4 || exp>precision ){
- xtype = etEXP;
- }else{
- precision = precision - exp;
- xtype = etFLOAT;
- }
- }else{
- flag_rtz = 0;
- }
- /*
- ** The "exp+precision" test causes output to be of type etEXP if
- ** the precision is too large to fit in buf[].
- */
- nsd = 0;
- if( xtype==etFLOAT && exp+precision<etBUFSIZE-30 ){
- flag_dp = (precision>0 || flag_alternateform);
- if( prefix ) *(bufpt++) = prefix; /* Sign */
- if( exp<0 ) *(bufpt++) = '0'; /* Digits before "." */
- else for(; exp>=0; exp--) *(bufpt++) = et_getdigit(&realvalue,&nsd);
- if( flag_dp ) *(bufpt++) = '.'; /* The decimal point */
- for(exp++; exp<0 && precision>0; precision--, exp++){
- *(bufpt++) = '0';
- }
- while( (precision--)>0 ) *(bufpt++) = et_getdigit(&realvalue,&nsd);
- *(bufpt--) = 0; /* Null terminate */
- if( flag_rtz && flag_dp ){ /* Remove trailing zeros and "." */
- while( bufpt>=buf && *bufpt=='0' ) *(bufpt--) = 0;
- if( bufpt>=buf && *bufpt=='.' ) *(bufpt--) = 0;
- }
- bufpt++; /* point to next free slot */
- }else{ /* etEXP or etGENERIC */
- flag_dp = (precision>0 || flag_alternateform);
- if( prefix ) *(bufpt++) = prefix; /* Sign */
- *(bufpt++) = et_getdigit(&realvalue,&nsd); /* First digit */
- if( flag_dp ) *(bufpt++) = '.'; /* Decimal point */
- while( (precision--)>0 ) *(bufpt++) = et_getdigit(&realvalue,&nsd);
- bufpt--; /* point to last digit */
- if( flag_rtz && flag_dp ){ /* Remove tail zeros */
- while( bufpt>=buf && *bufpt=='0' ) *(bufpt--) = 0;
- if( bufpt>=buf && *bufpt=='.' ) *(bufpt--) = 0;
- }
- bufpt++; /* point to next free slot */
- if( exp || flag_exp ){
- *(bufpt++) = infop->charset[0];
- if( exp<0 ){ *(bufpt++) = '-'; exp = -exp; } /* sign of exp */
- else { *(bufpt++) = '+'; }
- if( exp>=100 ){
- *(bufpt++) = (exp/100)+'0'; /* 100's digit */
- exp %= 100;
- }
- *(bufpt++) = exp/10+'0'; /* 10's digit */
- *(bufpt++) = exp%10+'0'; /* 1's digit */
- }
- }
- /* The converted number is in buf[] and zero terminated. Output it.
- ** Note that the number is in the usual order, not reversed as with
- ** integer conversions. */
- length = bufpt-buf;
- bufpt = buf;
-
- /* Special case: Add leading zeros if the flag_zeropad flag is
- ** set and we are not left justified */
- if( flag_zeropad && !flag_leftjustify && length < width){
- int i;
- int nPad = width - length;
- for(i=width; i>=nPad; i--){
- bufpt[i] = bufpt[i-nPad];
- }
- i = prefix!=0;
- while( nPad-- ) bufpt[i++] = '0';
- length = width;
- }
-#endif
- break;
- case etSIZE:
- *(va_arg(ap,int*)) = count;
- length = width = 0;
- break;
- case etPERCENT:
- buf[0] = '%';
- bufpt = buf;
- length = 1;
- break;
- case etCHARLIT:
- case etCHARX:
- c = buf[0] = (xtype==etCHARX ? va_arg(ap,int) : *++fmt);
- if( precision>=0 ){
- for(idx=1; idx<precision; idx++) buf[idx] = c;
- length = precision;
- }else{
- length =1;
- }
- bufpt = buf;
- break;
- case etSTRING:
- case etDYNSTRING:
- bufpt = va_arg(ap,char*);
- if( bufpt==0 ){
- bufpt = "";
- }else if( xtype==etDYNSTRING ){
- zExtra = bufpt;
- }
- length = strlen(bufpt);
- if( precision>=0 && precision<length ) length = precision;
- break;
- case etSTQLESCAPE:
- case etSTQLESCAPE2:
- {
- int i, j, n, c, isnull;
- char *arg = va_arg(ap,char*);
- isnull = arg==0;
- if( isnull ) arg = (xtype==etSTQLESCAPE2 ? "NULL" : "(NULL)");
- for(i=n=0; (c=arg[i])!=0; i++){
- if( c=='\'' ) n++;
- }
- n += i + 1 + ((!isnull && xtype==etSTQLESCAPE2) ? 2 : 0);
- if( n>etBUFSIZE ){
- bufpt = zExtra = sqliteMalloc( n );
- if( bufpt==0 ) return -1;
- }else{
- bufpt = buf;
- }
- j = 0;
- if( !isnull && xtype==etSTQLESCAPE2 ) bufpt[j++] = '\'';
- for(i=0; (c=arg[i])!=0; i++){
- bufpt[j++] = c;
- if( c=='\'' ) bufpt[j++] = c;
- }
- if( !isnull && xtype==etSTQLESCAPE2 ) bufpt[j++] = '\'';
- bufpt[j] = 0;
- length = j;
- if( precision>=0 && precision<length ) length = precision;
- }
- break;
- case etTOKEN: {
- Token *pToken = va_arg(ap, Token*);
- (*func)(arg, pToken->z, pToken->n);
- length = width = 0;
- break;
- }
- case etSRCLIST: {
- SrcList *pSrc = va_arg(ap, SrcList*);
- int k = va_arg(ap, int);
- struct SrcList_item *pItem = &pSrc->a[k];
- assert( k>=0 && k<pSrc->nSrc );
- if( pItem->zDatabase && pItem->zDatabase[0] ){
- (*func)(arg, pItem->zDatabase, strlen(pItem->zDatabase));
- (*func)(arg, ".", 1);
- }
- (*func)(arg, pItem->zName, strlen(pItem->zName));
- length = width = 0;
- break;
- }
- case etERROR:
- buf[0] = '%';
- buf[1] = c;
- errorflag = 0;
- idx = 1+(c!=0);
- (*func)(arg,"%",idx);
- count += idx;
- if( c==0 ) fmt--;
- break;
- }/* End switch over the format type */
- /*
- ** The text of the conversion is pointed to by "bufpt" and is
- ** "length" characters long. The field width is "width". Do
- ** the output.
- */
- if( !flag_leftjustify ){
- register int nspace;
- nspace = width-length;
- if( nspace>0 ){
- count += nspace;
- while( nspace>=etSPACESIZE ){
- (*func)(arg,spaces,etSPACESIZE);
- nspace -= etSPACESIZE;
- }
- if( nspace>0 ) (*func)(arg,spaces,nspace);
- }
- }
- if( length>0 ){
- (*func)(arg,bufpt,length);
- count += length;
- }
- if( flag_leftjustify ){
- register int nspace;
- nspace = width-length;
- if( nspace>0 ){
- count += nspace;
- while( nspace>=etSPACESIZE ){
- (*func)(arg,spaces,etSPACESIZE);
- nspace -= etSPACESIZE;
- }
- if( nspace>0 ) (*func)(arg,spaces,nspace);
- }
- }
- if( zExtra ){
- sqliteFree(zExtra);
- }
- }/* End for loop over the format string */
- return errorflag ? -1 : count;
-} /* End of function */
-
-
-/* This structure is used to store state information about the
-** write to memory that is currently in progress.
-*/
-struct sgMprintf {
- char *zBase; /* A base allocation */
- char *zText; /* The string collected so far */
- int nChar; /* Length of the string so far */
- int nTotal; /* Output size if unconstrained */
- int nAlloc; /* Amount of space allocated in zText */
- void *(*xRealloc)(void*,int); /* Function used to realloc memory */
-};
-
-/*
-** This function implements the callback from vxprintf.
-**
-** This routine add nNewChar characters of text in zNewText to
-** the sgMprintf structure pointed to by "arg".
-*/
-static void mout(void *arg, const char *zNewText, int nNewChar){
- struct sgMprintf *pM = (struct sgMprintf*)arg;
- pM->nTotal += nNewChar;
- if( pM->nChar + nNewChar + 1 > pM->nAlloc ){
- if( pM->xRealloc==0 ){
- nNewChar = pM->nAlloc - pM->nChar - 1;
- }else{
- pM->nAlloc = pM->nChar + nNewChar*2 + 1;
- if( pM->zText==pM->zBase ){
- pM->zText = pM->xRealloc(0, pM->nAlloc);
- if( pM->zText && pM->nChar ){
- memcpy(pM->zText, pM->zBase, pM->nChar);
- }
- }else{
- pM->zText = pM->xRealloc(pM->zText, pM->nAlloc);
- }
- }
- }
- if( pM->zText && nNewChar>0 ){
- memcpy(&pM->zText[pM->nChar], zNewText, nNewChar);
- pM->nChar += nNewChar;
- pM->zText[pM->nChar] = 0;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is a wrapper around xprintf() that invokes mout() as
-** the consumer.
-*/
-static char *base_vprintf(
- void *(*xRealloc)(void*,int), /* Routine to realloc memory. May be NULL */
- int useInternal, /* Use internal %-conversions if true */
- char *zInitBuf, /* Initially write here, before mallocing */
- int nInitBuf, /* Size of zInitBuf[] */
- const char *zFormat, /* format string */
- va_list ap /* arguments */
-){
- struct sgMprintf sM;
- sM.zBase = sM.zText = zInitBuf;
- sM.nChar = sM.nTotal = 0;
- sM.nAlloc = nInitBuf;
- sM.xRealloc = xRealloc;
- vxprintf(mout, &sM, useInternal, zFormat, ap);
- if( xRealloc ){
- if( sM.zText==sM.zBase ){
- sM.zText = xRealloc(0, sM.nChar+1);
- memcpy(sM.zText, sM.zBase, sM.nChar+1);
- }else if( sM.nAlloc>sM.nChar+10 ){
- sM.zText = xRealloc(sM.zText, sM.nChar+1);
- }
- }
- return sM.zText;
-}
-
-/*
-** Realloc that is a real function, not a macro.
-*/
-static void *printf_realloc(void *old, int size){
- return sqliteRealloc(old,size);
-}
-
-/*
-** Print into memory obtained from sqliteMalloc(). Use the internal
-** %-conversion extensions.
-*/
-char *sqliteVMPrintf(const char *zFormat, va_list ap){
- char zBase[1000];
- return base_vprintf(printf_realloc, 1, zBase, sizeof(zBase), zFormat, ap);
-}
-
-/*
-** Print into memory obtained from sqliteMalloc(). Use the internal
-** %-conversion extensions.
-*/
-char *sqliteMPrintf(const char *zFormat, ...){
- va_list ap;
- char *z;
- char zBase[1000];
- va_start(ap, zFormat);
- z = base_vprintf(printf_realloc, 1, zBase, sizeof(zBase), zFormat, ap);
- va_end(ap);
- return z;
-}
-
-/*
-** Print into memory obtained from malloc(). Do not use the internal
-** %-conversion extensions. This routine is for use by external users.
-*/
-char *sqlite_mprintf(const char *zFormat, ...){
- va_list ap;
- char *z;
- char zBuf[200];
-
- va_start(ap,zFormat);
- z = base_vprintf((void*(*)(void*,int))realloc, 0,
- zBuf, sizeof(zBuf), zFormat, ap);
- va_end(ap);
- return z;
-}
-
-/* This is the varargs version of sqlite_mprintf.
-*/
-char *sqlite_vmprintf(const char *zFormat, va_list ap){
- char zBuf[200];
- return base_vprintf((void*(*)(void*,int))realloc, 0,
- zBuf, sizeof(zBuf), zFormat, ap);
-}
-
-/*
-** sqlite_snprintf() works like snprintf() except that it ignores the
-** current locale settings. This is important for STQLite because we
-** are not able to use a "," as the decimal point in place of "." as
-** specified by some locales.
-*/
-char *sqlite_snprintf(int n, char *zBuf, const char *zFormat, ...){
- char *z;
- va_list ap;
-
- va_start(ap,zFormat);
- z = base_vprintf(0, 0, zBuf, n, zFormat, ap);
- va_end(ap);
- return z;
-}
-
-/*
-** The following four routines implement the varargs versions of the
-** sqlite_exec() and sqlite_get_table() interfaces. See the sqlite.h
-** header files for a more detailed description of how these interfaces
-** work.
-**
-** These routines are all just simple wrappers.
-*/
-int sqlite_exec_printf(
- sqlite *db, /* An open database */
- const char *sqlFormat, /* printf-style format string for the SQL */
- sqlite_callback xCallback, /* Callback function */
- void *pArg, /* 1st argument to callback function */
- char **errmsg, /* Error msg written here */
- ... /* Arguments to the format string. */
-){
- va_list ap;
- int rc;
-
- va_start(ap, errmsg);
- rc = sqlite_exec_vprintf(db, sqlFormat, xCallback, pArg, errmsg, ap);
- va_end(ap);
- return rc;
-}
-int sqlite_exec_vprintf(
- sqlite *db, /* An open database */
- const char *sqlFormat, /* printf-style format string for the SQL */
- sqlite_callback xCallback, /* Callback function */
- void *pArg, /* 1st argument to callback function */
- char **errmsg, /* Error msg written here */
- va_list ap /* Arguments to the format string. */
-){
- char *zSql;
- int rc;
-
- zSql = sqlite_vmprintf(sqlFormat, ap);
- rc = sqlite_exec(db, zSql, xCallback, pArg, errmsg);
- free(zSql);
- return rc;
-}
-int sqlite_get_table_printf(
- sqlite *db, /* An open database */
- const char *sqlFormat, /* printf-style format string for the SQL */
- char ***resultp, /* Result written to a char *[] that this points to */
- int *nrow, /* Number of result rows written here */
- int *ncol, /* Number of result columns written here */
- char **errmsg, /* Error msg written here */
- ... /* Arguments to the format string */
-){
- va_list ap;
- int rc;
-
- va_start(ap, errmsg);
- rc = sqlite_get_table_vprintf(db, sqlFormat, resultp, nrow, ncol, errmsg, ap);
- va_end(ap);
- return rc;
-}
-int sqlite_get_table_vprintf(
- sqlite *db, /* An open database */
- const char *sqlFormat, /* printf-style format string for the SQL */
- char ***resultp, /* Result written to a char *[] that this points to */
- int *nrow, /* Number of result rows written here */
- int *ncolumn, /* Number of result columns written here */
- char **errmsg, /* Error msg written here */
- va_list ap /* Arguments to the format string */
-){
- char *zSql;
- int rc;
-
- zSql = sqlite_vmprintf(sqlFormat, ap);
- rc = sqlite_get_table(db, zSql, resultp, nrow, ncolumn, errmsg);
- free(zSql);
- return rc;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/random.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/random.c
deleted file mode 100644
index ffa4cc9..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/random.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,97 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains code to implement a pseudo-random number
-** generator (PRNG) for STQLite.
-**
-** Random numbers are used by some of the database backends in order
-** to generate random integer keys for tables or random filenames.
-**
-** $Id: random.c,v 1.11 2004/02/11 09:46:33 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include "os.h"
-
-
-/*
-** Get a single 8-bit random value from the RC4 PRNG. The Mutex
-** must be held while executing this routine.
-**
-** Why not just use a library random generator like lrand48() for this?
-** Because the OP_NewRecno opcode in the VDBE depends on having a very
-** good source of random numbers. The lrand48() library function may
-** well be good enough. But maybe not. Or maybe lrand48() has some
-** subtle problems on some systems that could cause problems. It is hard
-** to know. To minimize the risk of problems due to bad lrand48()
-** implementations, STQLite uses this random number generator based
-** on RC4, which we know works very well.
-*/
-static int randomByte(){
- unsigned char t;
-
- /* All threads share a single random number generator.
- ** This structure is the current state of the generator.
- */
- static struct {
- unsigned char isInit; /* True if initialized */
- unsigned char i, j; /* State variables */
- unsigned char s[256]; /* State variables */
- } prng;
-
- /* Initialize the state of the random number generator once,
- ** the first time this routine is called. The seed value does
- ** not need to contain a lot of randomness since we are not
- ** trying to do secure encryption or anything like that...
- **
- ** Nothing in this file or anywhere else in STQLite does any kind of
- ** encryption. The RC4 algorithm is being used as a PRNG (pseudo-random
- ** number generator) not as an encryption tqdevice.
- */
- if( !prng.isInit ){
- int i;
- char k[256];
- prng.j = 0;
- prng.i = 0;
- sqliteOsRandomSeed(k);
- for(i=0; i<256; i++){
- prng.s[i] = i;
- }
- for(i=0; i<256; i++){
- prng.j += prng.s[i] + k[i];
- t = prng.s[prng.j];
- prng.s[prng.j] = prng.s[i];
- prng.s[i] = t;
- }
- prng.isInit = 1;
- }
-
- /* Generate and return single random byte
- */
- prng.i++;
- t = prng.s[prng.i];
- prng.j += t;
- prng.s[prng.i] = prng.s[prng.j];
- prng.s[prng.j] = t;
- t += prng.s[prng.i];
- return prng.s[t];
-}
-
-/*
-** Return N random bytes.
-*/
-void sqliteRandomness(int N, void *pBuf){
- unsigned char *zBuf = pBuf;
- sqliteOsEnterMutex();
- while( N-- ){
- *(zBuf++) = randomByte();
- }
- sqliteOsLeaveMutex();
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/select.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/select.c
deleted file mode 100644
index d29c4a5..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/select.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2404 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains C code routines that are called by the parser
-** to handle SELECT statements in STQLite.
-**
-** $Id: select.c,v 1.160 2004/03/02 18:37:41 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-
-/*
-** Allocate a new Select structure and return a pointer to that
-** structure.
-*/
-Select *sqliteSelectNew(
- ExprList *pEList, /* which columns to include in the result */
- SrcList *pSrc, /* the FROM clause -- which tables to scan */
- Expr *pWhere, /* the WHERE clause */
- ExprList *pGroupBy, /* the GROUP BY clause */
- Expr *pHaving, /* the HAVING clause */
- ExprList *pOrderBy, /* the ORDER BY clause */
- int isDistinct, /* true if the DISTINCT keyword is present */
- int nLimit, /* LIMIT value. -1 means not used */
- int nOffset /* OFFSET value. 0 means no offset */
-){
- Select *pNew;
- pNew = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(*pNew) );
- if( pNew==0 ){
- sqliteExprListDelete(pEList);
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pSrc);
- sqliteExprDelete(pWhere);
- sqliteExprListDelete(pGroupBy);
- sqliteExprDelete(pHaving);
- sqliteExprListDelete(pOrderBy);
- }else{
- if( pEList==0 ){
- pEList = sqliteExprListAppend(0, sqliteExpr(TK_ALL,0,0,0), 0);
- }
- pNew->pEList = pEList;
- pNew->pSrc = pSrc;
- pNew->pWhere = pWhere;
- pNew->pGroupBy = pGroupBy;
- pNew->pHaving = pHaving;
- pNew->pOrderBy = pOrderBy;
- pNew->isDistinct = isDistinct;
- pNew->op = TK_SELECT;
- pNew->nLimit = nLimit;
- pNew->nOffset = nOffset;
- pNew->iLimit = -1;
- pNew->iOffset = -1;
- }
- return pNew;
-}
-
-/*
-** Given 1 to 3 identifiers preceeding the JOIN keyword, determine the
-** type of join. Return an integer constant that expresses that type
-** in terms of the following bit values:
-**
-** JT_INNER
-** JT_OUTER
-** JT_NATURAL
-** JT_LEFT
-** JT_RIGHT
-**
-** A full outer join is the combination of JT_LEFT and JT_RIGHT.
-**
-** If an illegal or unsupported join type is seen, then still return
-** a join type, but put an error in the pParse structure.
-*/
-int sqliteJoinType(Parse *pParse, Token *pA, Token *pB, Token *pC){
- int jointype = 0;
- Token *apAll[3];
- Token *p;
- static struct {
- const char *zKeyword;
- int nChar;
- int code;
- } keywords[] = {
- { "natural", 7, JT_NATURAL },
- { "left", 4, JT_LEFT|JT_OUTER },
- { "right", 5, JT_RIGHT|JT_OUTER },
- { "full", 4, JT_LEFT|JT_RIGHT|JT_OUTER },
- { "outer", 5, JT_OUTER },
- { "inner", 5, JT_INNER },
- { "cross", 5, JT_INNER },
- };
- int i, j;
- apAll[0] = pA;
- apAll[1] = pB;
- apAll[2] = pC;
- for(i=0; i<3 && apAll[i]; i++){
- p = apAll[i];
- for(j=0; j<sizeof(keywords)/sizeof(keywords[0]); j++){
- if( p->n==keywords[j].nChar
- && sqliteStrNICmp(p->z, keywords[j].zKeyword, p->n)==0 ){
- jointype |= keywords[j].code;
- break;
- }
- }
- if( j>=sizeof(keywords)/sizeof(keywords[0]) ){
- jointype |= JT_ERROR;
- break;
- }
- }
- if(
- (jointype & (JT_INNER|JT_OUTER))==(JT_INNER|JT_OUTER) ||
- (jointype & JT_ERROR)!=0
- ){
- static Token dummy = { 0, 0 };
- char *zSp1 = " ", *zSp2 = " ";
- if( pB==0 ){ pB = &dummy; zSp1 = 0; }
- if( pC==0 ){ pC = &dummy; zSp2 = 0; }
- sqliteSetNString(&pParse->zErrMsg, "unknown or unsupported join type: ", 0,
- pA->z, pA->n, zSp1, 1, pB->z, pB->n, zSp2, 1, pC->z, pC->n, 0);
- pParse->nErr++;
- jointype = JT_INNER;
- }else if( jointype & JT_RIGHT ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "RIGHT and FULL OUTER JOINs are not currently supported");
- jointype = JT_INNER;
- }
- return jointype;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the index of a column in a table. Return -1 if the column
-** is not contained in the table.
-*/
-static int columnIndex(Table *pTab, const char *zCol){
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<pTab->nCol; i++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(pTab->aCol[i].zName, zCol)==0 ) return i;
- }
- return -1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Add a term to the WHERE expression in *ppExpr that requires the
-** zCol column to be equal in the two tables pTab1 and pTab2.
-*/
-static void addWhereTerm(
- const char *zCol, /* Name of the column */
- const Table *pTab1, /* First table */
- const Table *pTab2, /* Second table */
- Expr **ppExpr /* Add the equality term to this expression */
-){
- Token dummy;
- Expr *pE1a, *pE1b, *pE1c;
- Expr *pE2a, *pE2b, *pE2c;
- Expr *pE;
-
- dummy.z = zCol;
- dummy.n = strlen(zCol);
- dummy.dyn = 0;
- pE1a = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &dummy);
- pE2a = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &dummy);
- dummy.z = pTab1->zName;
- dummy.n = strlen(dummy.z);
- pE1b = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &dummy);
- dummy.z = pTab2->zName;
- dummy.n = strlen(dummy.z);
- pE2b = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, &dummy);
- pE1c = sqliteExpr(TK_DOT, pE1b, pE1a, 0);
- pE2c = sqliteExpr(TK_DOT, pE2b, pE2a, 0);
- pE = sqliteExpr(TK_EQ, pE1c, pE2c, 0);
- ExprSetProperty(pE, EP_FromJoin);
- if( *ppExpr ){
- *ppExpr = sqliteExpr(TK_AND, *ppExpr, pE, 0);
- }else{
- *ppExpr = pE;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Set the EP_FromJoin property on all terms of the given expression.
-**
-** The EP_FromJoin property is used on terms of an expression to tell
-** the LEFT OUTER JOIN processing logic that this term is part of the
-** join restriction specified in the ON or USING clause and not a part
-** of the more general WHERE clause. These terms are moved over to the
-** WHERE clause during join processing but we need to remember that they
-** originated in the ON or USING clause.
-*/
-static void setJoinExpr(Expr *p){
- while( p ){
- ExprSetProperty(p, EP_FromJoin);
- setJoinExpr(p->pLeft);
- p = p->pRight;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine processes the join information for a SELECT statement.
-** ON and USING clauses are converted into extra terms of the WHERE clause.
-** NATURAL joins also create extra WHERE clause terms.
-**
-** This routine returns the number of errors encountered.
-*/
-static int sqliteProcessJoin(Parse *pParse, Select *p){
- SrcList *pSrc;
- int i, j;
- pSrc = p->pSrc;
- for(i=0; i<pSrc->nSrc-1; i++){
- struct SrcList_item *pTerm = &pSrc->a[i];
- struct SrcList_item *pOther = &pSrc->a[i+1];
-
- if( pTerm->pTab==0 || pOther->pTab==0 ) continue;
-
- /* When the NATURAL keyword is present, add WHERE clause terms for
- ** every column that the two tables have in common.
- */
- if( pTerm->jointype & JT_NATURAL ){
- Table *pTab;
- if( pTerm->pOn || pTerm->pUsing ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "a NATURAL join may not have "
- "an ON or USING clause", 0);
- return 1;
- }
- pTab = pTerm->pTab;
- for(j=0; j<pTab->nCol; j++){
- if( columnIndex(pOther->pTab, pTab->aCol[j].zName)>=0 ){
- addWhereTerm(pTab->aCol[j].zName, pTab, pOther->pTab, &p->pWhere);
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* Disallow both ON and USING clauses in the same join
- */
- if( pTerm->pOn && pTerm->pUsing ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot have both ON and USING "
- "clauses in the same join");
- return 1;
- }
-
- /* Add the ON clause to the end of the WHERE clause, connected by
- ** and AND operator.
- */
- if( pTerm->pOn ){
- setJoinExpr(pTerm->pOn);
- if( p->pWhere==0 ){
- p->pWhere = pTerm->pOn;
- }else{
- p->pWhere = sqliteExpr(TK_AND, p->pWhere, pTerm->pOn, 0);
- }
- pTerm->pOn = 0;
- }
-
- /* Create extra terms on the WHERE clause for each column named
- ** in the USING clause. Example: If the two tables to be joined are
- ** A and B and the USING clause names X, Y, and Z, then add this
- ** to the WHERE clause: A.X=B.X AND A.Y=B.Y AND A.Z=B.Z
- ** Report an error if any column mentioned in the USING clause is
- ** not contained in both tables to be joined.
- */
- if( pTerm->pUsing ){
- IdList *pList;
- int j;
- assert( i<pSrc->nSrc-1 );
- pList = pTerm->pUsing;
- for(j=0; j<pList->nId; j++){
- if( columnIndex(pTerm->pTab, pList->a[j].zName)<0 ||
- columnIndex(pOther->pTab, pList->a[j].zName)<0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot join using column %s - column "
- "not present in both tables", pList->a[j].zName);
- return 1;
- }
- addWhereTerm(pList->a[j].zName, pTerm->pTab, pOther->pTab, &p->pWhere);
- }
- }
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Delete the given Select structure and all of its substructures.
-*/
-void sqliteSelectDelete(Select *p){
- if( p==0 ) return;
- sqliteExprListDelete(p->pEList);
- sqliteSrcListDelete(p->pSrc);
- sqliteExprDelete(p->pWhere);
- sqliteExprListDelete(p->pGroupBy);
- sqliteExprDelete(p->pHaving);
- sqliteExprListDelete(p->pOrderBy);
- sqliteSelectDelete(p->pPrior);
- sqliteFree(p->zSelect);
- sqliteFree(p);
-}
-
-/*
-** Delete the aggregate information from the parse structure.
-*/
-static void sqliteAggregateInfoReset(Parse *pParse){
- sqliteFree(pParse->aAgg);
- pParse->aAgg = 0;
- pParse->nAgg = 0;
- pParse->useAgg = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Insert code into "v" that will push the record on the top of the
-** stack into the sorter.
-*/
-static void pushOntoSorter(Parse *pParse, Vdbe *v, ExprList *pOrderBy){
- char *zSortOrder;
- int i;
- zSortOrder = sqliteMalloc( pOrderBy->nExpr + 1 );
- if( zSortOrder==0 ) return;
- for(i=0; i<pOrderBy->nExpr; i++){
- int order = pOrderBy->a[i].sortOrder;
- int type;
- int c;
- if( (order & STQLITE_SO_TYPEMASK)==STQLITE_SO_TEXT ){
- type = STQLITE_SO_TEXT;
- }else if( (order & STQLITE_SO_TYPEMASK)==STQLITE_SO_NUM ){
- type = STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- }else if( pParse->db->file_format>=4 ){
- type = sqliteExprType(pOrderBy->a[i].pExpr);
- }else{
- type = STQLITE_SO_NUM;
- }
- if( (order & STQLITE_SO_DIRMASK)==STQLITE_SO_ASC ){
- c = type==STQLITE_SO_TEXT ? 'A' : '+';
- }else{
- c = type==STQLITE_SO_TEXT ? 'D' : '-';
- }
- zSortOrder[i] = c;
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pOrderBy->a[i].pExpr);
- }
- zSortOrder[pOrderBy->nExpr] = 0;
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_SortMakeKey, pOrderBy->nExpr, 0, zSortOrder, P3_DYNAMIC);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SortPut, 0, 0);
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine adds a P3 argument to the last VDBE opcode that was
-** inserted. The P3 argument added is a string suitable for the
-** OP_MakeKey or OP_MakeIdxKey opcodes. The string consists of
-** characters 't' or 'n' depending on whether or not the various
-** fields of the key to be generated should be treated as numeric
-** or as text. See the OP_MakeKey and OP_MakeIdxKey opcode
-** documentation for additional information about the P3 string.
-** See also the sqliteAddIdxKeyType() routine.
-*/
-void sqliteAddKeyType(Vdbe *v, ExprList *pEList){
- int nColumn = pEList->nExpr;
- char *zType = sqliteMalloc( nColumn+1 );
- int i;
- if( zType==0 ) return;
- for(i=0; i<nColumn; i++){
- zType[i] = sqliteExprType(pEList->a[i].pExpr)==STQLITE_SO_NUM ? 'n' : 't';
- }
- zType[i] = 0;
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, -1, zType, P3_DYNAMIC);
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine generates the code for the inside of the inner loop
-** of a SELECT.
-**
-** If srcTab and nColumn are both zero, then the pEList expressions
-** are evaluated in order to get the data for this row. If nColumn>0
-** then data is pulled from srcTab and pEList is used only to get the
-** datatypes for each column.
-*/
-static int selectInnerLoop(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- Select *p, /* The complete select statement being coded */
- ExprList *pEList, /* List of values being extracted */
- int srcTab, /* Pull data from this table */
- int nColumn, /* Number of columns in the source table */
- ExprList *pOrderBy, /* If not NULL, sort results using this key */
- int distinct, /* If >=0, make sure results are distinct */
- int eDest, /* How to dispose of the results */
- int iParm, /* An argument to the disposal method */
- int iContinue, /* Jump here to continue with next row */
- int iBreak /* Jump here to break out of the inner loop */
-){
- Vdbe *v = pParse->pVdbe;
- int i;
-
- if( v==0 ) return 0;
- assert( pEList!=0 );
-
- /* If there was a LIMIT clause on the SELECT statement, then do the check
- ** to see if this row should be output.
- */
- if( pOrderBy==0 ){
- if( p->iOffset>=0 ){
- int addr = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemIncr, p->iOffset, addr+2);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, iContinue);
- }
- if( p->iLimit>=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemIncr, p->iLimit, iBreak);
- }
- }
-
- /* Pull the requested columns.
- */
- if( nColumn>0 ){
- for(i=0; i<nColumn; i++){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, srcTab, i);
- }
- }else{
- nColumn = pEList->nExpr;
- for(i=0; i<pEList->nExpr; i++){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pEList->a[i].pExpr);
- }
- }
-
- /* If the DISTINCT keyword was present on the SELECT statement
- ** and this row has been seen before, then do not make this row
- ** part of the result.
- */
- if( distinct>=0 && pEList && pEList->nExpr>0 ){
-#if NULL_ALWAYS_DISTINCT
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IsNull, -pEList->nExpr, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+7);
-#endif
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeKey, pEList->nExpr, 1);
- if( pParse->db->file_format>=4 ) sqliteAddKeyType(v, pEList);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Distinct, distinct, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, pEList->nExpr+1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, iContinue);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutStrKey, distinct, 0);
- }
-
- switch( eDest ){
- /* In this mode, write each query result to the key of the temporary
- ** table iParm.
- */
- case SRT_Union: {
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeRecord, nColumn, NULL_ALWAYS_DISTINCT);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutStrKey, iParm, 0);
- break;
- }
-
- /* Store the result as data using a unique key.
- */
- case SRT_Table:
- case SRT_TempTable: {
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeRecord, nColumn, 0);
- if( pOrderBy ){
- pushOntoSorter(pParse, v, pOrderBy);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NewRecno, iParm, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pull, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, iParm, 0);
- }
- break;
- }
-
- /* Construct a record from the query result, but instead of
- ** saving that record, use it as a key to delete elements from
- ** the temporary table iParm.
- */
- case SRT_Except: {
- int addr;
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeRecord, nColumn, NULL_ALWAYS_DISTINCT);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotFound, iParm, addr+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Delete, iParm, 0);
- break;
- }
-
- /* If we are creating a set for an "expr IN (SELECT ...)" construct,
- ** then there should be a single item on the stack. Write this
- ** item into the set table with bogus data.
- */
- case SRT_Set: {
- int addr1 = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- int addr2;
- assert( nColumn==1 );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, -1, addr1+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- addr2 = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, 0);
- if( pOrderBy ){
- pushOntoSorter(pParse, v, pOrderBy);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutStrKey, iParm, 0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr2, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v));
- break;
- }
-
- /* If this is a scalar select that is part of an expression, then
- ** store the results in the appropriate memory cell and break out
- ** of the scan loop.
- */
- case SRT_Mem: {
- assert( nColumn==1 );
- if( pOrderBy ){
- pushOntoSorter(pParse, v, pOrderBy);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, iParm, 1);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, iBreak);
- }
- break;
- }
-
- /* Send the data to the callback function.
- */
- case SRT_Callback:
- case SRT_Sorter: {
- if( pOrderBy ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SortMakeRec, nColumn, 0);
- pushOntoSorter(pParse, v, pOrderBy);
- }else{
- assert( eDest==SRT_Callback );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Callback, nColumn, 0);
- }
- break;
- }
-
- /* Invoke a subroutine to handle the results. The subroutine itself
- ** is responsible for popping the results off of the stack.
- */
- case SRT_Subroutine: {
- if( pOrderBy ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeRecord, nColumn, 0);
- pushOntoSorter(pParse, v, pOrderBy);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Gosub, 0, iParm);
- }
- break;
- }
-
- /* Discard the results. This is used for SELECT statements inside
- ** the body of a TRIGGER. The purpose of such selects is to call
- ** user-defined functions that have side effects. We do not care
- ** about the actual results of the select.
- */
- default: {
- assert( eDest==SRT_Discard );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, nColumn, 0);
- break;
- }
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** If the inner loop was generated using a non-null pOrderBy argument,
-** then the results were placed in a sorter. After the loop is terminated
-** we need to run the sorter and output the results. The following
-** routine generates the code needed to do that.
-*/
-static void generateSortTail(
- Select *p, /* The SELECT statement */
- Vdbe *v, /* Generate code into this VDBE */
- int nColumn, /* Number of columns of data */
- int eDest, /* Write the sorted results here */
- int iParm /* Optional parameter associated with eDest */
-){
- int end1 = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- int end2 = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- int addr;
- if( eDest==SRT_Sorter ) return;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Sort, 0, 0);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SortNext, 0, end1);
- if( p->iOffset>=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemIncr, p->iOffset, addr+4);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, addr);
- }
- if( p->iLimit>=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemIncr, p->iLimit, end2);
- }
- switch( eDest ){
- case SRT_Callback: {
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SortCallback, nColumn, 0);
- break;
- }
- case SRT_Table:
- case SRT_TempTable: {
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NewRecno, iParm, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pull, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, iParm, 0);
- break;
- }
- case SRT_Set: {
- assert( nColumn==1 );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, -1, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutStrKey, iParm, 0);
- break;
- }
- case SRT_Mem: {
- assert( nColumn==1 );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, iParm, 1);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, end1);
- break;
- }
- case SRT_Subroutine: {
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<nColumn; i++){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, -1-i, i);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Gosub, 0, iParm);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- break;
- }
- default: {
- /* Do nothing */
- break;
- }
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, addr);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, end2);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, end1);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SortReset, 0, 0);
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code that will tell the VDBE the datatypes of
-** columns in the result set.
-**
-** This routine only generates code if the "PRAGMA show_datatypes=on"
-** has been executed. The datatypes are reported out in the azCol
-** parameter to the callback function. The first N azCol[] entries
-** are the names of the columns, and the second N entries are the
-** datatypes for the columns.
-**
-** The "datatype" for a result that is a column of a type is the
-** datatype definition extracted from the CREATE TABLE statement.
-** The datatype for an expression is either TEXT or NUMERIC. The
-** datatype for a ROWID field is INTEGER.
-*/
-static void generateColumnTypes(
- Parse *pParse, /* Parser context */
- SrcList *pTabList, /* List of tables */
- ExprList *pEList /* Expressions defining the result set */
-){
- Vdbe *v = pParse->pVdbe;
- int i, j;
- for(i=0; i<pEList->nExpr; i++){
- Expr *p = pEList->a[i].pExpr;
- char *zType = 0;
- if( p==0 ) continue;
- if( p->op==TK_COLUMN && pTabList ){
- Table *pTab;
- int iCol = p->iColumn;
- for(j=0; j<pTabList->nSrc && pTabList->a[j].iCursor!=p->iTable; j++){}
- assert( j<pTabList->nSrc );
- pTab = pTabList->a[j].pTab;
- if( iCol<0 ) iCol = pTab->iPKey;
- assert( iCol==-1 || (iCol>=0 && iCol<pTab->nCol) );
- if( iCol<0 ){
- zType = "INTEGER";
- }else{
- zType = pTab->aCol[iCol].zType;
- }
- }else{
- if( sqliteExprType(p)==STQLITE_SO_TEXT ){
- zType = "TEXT";
- }else{
- zType = "NUMERIC";
- }
- }
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_ColumnName, i + pEList->nExpr, 0, zType, 0);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code that will tell the VDBE the names of columns
-** in the result set. This information is used to provide the
-** azCol[] values in the callback.
-*/
-static void generateColumnNames(
- Parse *pParse, /* Parser context */
- SrcList *pTabList, /* List of tables */
- ExprList *pEList /* Expressions defining the result set */
-){
- Vdbe *v = pParse->pVdbe;
- int i, j;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- int fullNames, shortNames;
-
- assert( v!=0 );
- if( pParse->colNamesSet || v==0 || sqlite_malloc_failed ) return;
- pParse->colNamesSet = 1;
- fullNames = (db->flags & STQLITE_FullColNames)!=0;
- shortNames = (db->flags & STQLITE_ShortColNames)!=0;
- for(i=0; i<pEList->nExpr; i++){
- Expr *p;
- int p2 = i==pEList->nExpr-1;
- p = pEList->a[i].pExpr;
- if( p==0 ) continue;
- if( pEList->a[i].zName ){
- char *zName = pEList->a[i].zName;
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_ColumnName, i, p2, zName, 0);
- continue;
- }
- if( p->op==TK_COLUMN && pTabList ){
- Table *pTab;
- char *zCol;
- int iCol = p->iColumn;
- for(j=0; j<pTabList->nSrc && pTabList->a[j].iCursor!=p->iTable; j++){}
- assert( j<pTabList->nSrc );
- pTab = pTabList->a[j].pTab;
- if( iCol<0 ) iCol = pTab->iPKey;
- assert( iCol==-1 || (iCol>=0 && iCol<pTab->nCol) );
- if( iCol<0 ){
- zCol = "_ROWID_";
- }else{
- zCol = pTab->aCol[iCol].zName;
- }
- if( !shortNames && !fullNames && p->span.z && p->span.z[0] ){
- int addr = sqliteVdbeOp3(v,OP_ColumnName, i, p2, p->span.z, p->span.n);
- sqliteVdbeCompressSpace(v, addr);
- }else if( fullNames || (!shortNames && pTabList->nSrc>1) ){
- char *zName = 0;
- char *zTab;
-
- zTab = pTabList->a[j].zAlias;
- if( fullNames || zTab==0 ) zTab = pTab->zName;
- sqliteSetString(&zName, zTab, ".", zCol, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_ColumnName, i, p2, zName, P3_DYNAMIC);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_ColumnName, i, p2, zCol, 0);
- }
- }else if( p->span.z && p->span.z[0] ){
- int addr = sqliteVdbeOp3(v,OP_ColumnName, i, p2, p->span.z, p->span.n);
- sqliteVdbeCompressSpace(v, addr);
- }else{
- char zName[30];
- assert( p->op!=TK_COLUMN || pTabList==0 );
- sprintf(zName, "column%d", i+1);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_ColumnName, i, p2, zName, 0);
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Name of the connection operator, used for error messages.
-*/
-static const char *selectOpName(int id){
- char *z;
- switch( id ){
- case TK_ALL: z = "UNION ALL"; break;
- case TK_INTERSECT: z = "INTERSECT"; break;
- case TK_EXCEPT: z = "EXCEPT"; break;
- default: z = "UNION"; break;
- }
- return z;
-}
-
-/*
-** Forward declaration
-*/
-static int fillInColumnList(Parse*, Select*);
-
-/*
-** Given a SELECT statement, generate a Table structure that describes
-** the result set of that SELECT.
-*/
-Table *sqliteResultSetOfSelect(Parse *pParse, char *zTabName, Select *pSelect){
- Table *pTab;
- int i, j;
- ExprList *pEList;
- Column *aCol;
-
- if( fillInColumnList(pParse, pSelect) ){
- return 0;
- }
- pTab = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(Table) );
- if( pTab==0 ){
- return 0;
- }
- pTab->zName = zTabName ? sqliteStrDup(zTabName) : 0;
- pEList = pSelect->pEList;
- pTab->nCol = pEList->nExpr;
- assert( pTab->nCol>0 );
- pTab->aCol = aCol = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(pTab->aCol[0])*pTab->nCol );
- for(i=0; i<pTab->nCol; i++){
- Expr *p, *pR;
- if( pEList->a[i].zName ){
- aCol[i].zName = sqliteStrDup(pEList->a[i].zName);
- }else if( (p=pEList->a[i].pExpr)->op==TK_DOT
- && (pR=p->pRight)!=0 && pR->token.z && pR->token.z[0] ){
- int cnt;
- sqliteSetNString(&aCol[i].zName, pR->token.z, pR->token.n, 0);
- for(j=cnt=0; j<i; j++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(aCol[j].zName, aCol[i].zName)==0 ){
- int n;
- char zBuf[30];
- sprintf(zBuf,"_%d",++cnt);
- n = strlen(zBuf);
- sqliteSetNString(&aCol[i].zName, pR->token.z, pR->token.n, zBuf, n,0);
- j = -1;
- }
- }
- }else if( p->span.z && p->span.z[0] ){
- sqliteSetNString(&pTab->aCol[i].zName, p->span.z, p->span.n, 0);
- }else{
- char zBuf[30];
- sprintf(zBuf, "column%d", i+1);
- pTab->aCol[i].zName = sqliteStrDup(zBuf);
- }
- }
- pTab->iPKey = -1;
- return pTab;
-}
-
-/*
-** For the given SELECT statement, do three things.
-**
-** (1) Fill in the pTabList->a[].pTab fields in the SrcList that
-** defines the set of tables that should be scanned. For views,
-** fill pTabList->a[].pSelect with a copy of the SELECT statement
-** that implements the view. A copy is made of the view's SELECT
-** statement so that we can freely modify or delete that statement
-** without worrying about messing up the presistent representation
-** of the view.
-**
-** (2) Add terms to the WHERE clause to accomodate the NATURAL keyword
-** on joins and the ON and USING clause of joins.
-**
-** (3) Scan the list of columns in the result set (pEList) looking
-** for instances of the "*" operator or the TABLE.* operator.
-** If found, expand each "*" to be every column in every table
-** and TABLE.* to be every column in TABLE.
-**
-** Return 0 on success. If there are problems, leave an error message
-** in pParse and return non-zero.
-*/
-static int fillInColumnList(Parse *pParse, Select *p){
- int i, j, k, rc;
- SrcList *pTabList;
- ExprList *pEList;
- Table *pTab;
-
- if( p==0 || p->pSrc==0 ) return 1;
- pTabList = p->pSrc;
- pEList = p->pEList;
-
- /* Look up every table in the table list.
- */
- for(i=0; i<pTabList->nSrc; i++){
- if( pTabList->a[i].pTab ){
- /* This routine has run before! No need to continue */
- return 0;
- }
- if( pTabList->a[i].zName==0 ){
- /* A sub-query in the FROM clause of a SELECT */
- assert( pTabList->a[i].pSelect!=0 );
- if( pTabList->a[i].zAlias==0 ){
- char zFakeName[60];
- sprintf(zFakeName, "sqlite_subquery_%p_",
- (void*)pTabList->a[i].pSelect);
- sqliteSetString(&pTabList->a[i].zAlias, zFakeName, 0);
- }
- pTabList->a[i].pTab = pTab =
- sqliteResultSetOfSelect(pParse, pTabList->a[i].zAlias,
- pTabList->a[i].pSelect);
- if( pTab==0 ){
- return 1;
- }
- /* The isTransient flag indicates that the Table structure has been
- ** dynamically allocated and may be freed at any time. In other words,
- ** pTab is not pointing to a persistent table structure that defines
- ** part of the schema. */
- pTab->isTransient = 1;
- }else{
- /* An ordinary table or view name in the FROM clause */
- pTabList->a[i].pTab = pTab =
- sqliteLocateTable(pParse,pTabList->a[i].zName,pTabList->a[i].zDatabase);
- if( pTab==0 ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( pTab->pSelect ){
- /* We reach here if the named table is a really a view */
- if( sqliteViewGetColumnNames(pParse, pTab) ){
- return 1;
- }
- /* If pTabList->a[i].pSelect!=0 it means we are dealing with a
- ** view within a view. The SELECT structure has already been
- ** copied by the outer view so we can skip the copy step here
- ** in the inner view.
- */
- if( pTabList->a[i].pSelect==0 ){
- pTabList->a[i].pSelect = sqliteSelectDup(pTab->pSelect);
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* Process NATURAL keywords, and ON and USING clauses of joins.
- */
- if( sqliteProcessJoin(pParse, p) ) return 1;
-
- /* For every "*" that occurs in the column list, insert the names of
- ** all columns in all tables. And for every TABLE.* insert the names
- ** of all columns in TABLE. The parser inserted a special expression
- ** with the TK_ALL operator for each "*" that it found in the column list.
- ** The following code just has to locate the TK_ALL expressions and expand
- ** each one to the list of all columns in all tables.
- **
- ** The first loop just checks to see if there are any "*" operators
- ** that need expanding.
- */
- for(k=0; k<pEList->nExpr; k++){
- Expr *pE = pEList->a[k].pExpr;
- if( pE->op==TK_ALL ) break;
- if( pE->op==TK_DOT && pE->pRight && pE->pRight->op==TK_ALL
- && pE->pLeft && pE->pLeft->op==TK_ID ) break;
- }
- rc = 0;
- if( k<pEList->nExpr ){
- /*
- ** If we get here it means the result set contains one or more "*"
- ** operators that need to be expanded. Loop through each expression
- ** in the result set and expand them one by one.
- */
- struct ExprList_item *a = pEList->a;
- ExprList *pNew = 0;
- for(k=0; k<pEList->nExpr; k++){
- Expr *pE = a[k].pExpr;
- if( pE->op!=TK_ALL &&
- (pE->op!=TK_DOT || pE->pRight==0 || pE->pRight->op!=TK_ALL) ){
- /* This particular expression does not need to be expanded.
- */
- pNew = sqliteExprListAppend(pNew, a[k].pExpr, 0);
- pNew->a[pNew->nExpr-1].zName = a[k].zName;
- a[k].pExpr = 0;
- a[k].zName = 0;
- }else{
- /* This expression is a "*" or a "TABLE.*" and needs to be
- ** expanded. */
- int tableSeen = 0; /* Set to 1 when TABLE matches */
- Token *pName; /* text of name of TABLE */
- if( pE->op==TK_DOT && pE->pLeft ){
- pName = &pE->pLeft->token;
- }else{
- pName = 0;
- }
- for(i=0; i<pTabList->nSrc; i++){
- Table *pTab = pTabList->a[i].pTab;
- char *zTabName = pTabList->a[i].zAlias;
- if( zTabName==0 || zTabName[0]==0 ){
- zTabName = pTab->zName;
- }
- if( pName && (zTabName==0 || zTabName[0]==0 ||
- sqliteStrNICmp(pName->z, zTabName, pName->n)!=0 ||
- zTabName[pName->n]!=0) ){
- continue;
- }
- tableSeen = 1;
- for(j=0; j<pTab->nCol; j++){
- Expr *pExpr, *pLeft, *pRight;
- char *zName = pTab->aCol[j].zName;
-
- if( i>0 && (pTabList->a[i-1].jointype & JT_NATURAL)!=0 &&
- columnIndex(pTabList->a[i-1].pTab, zName)>=0 ){
- /* In a NATURAL join, omit the join columns from the
- ** table on the right */
- continue;
- }
- if( i>0 && sqliteIdListIndex(pTabList->a[i-1].pUsing, zName)>=0 ){
- /* In a join with a USING clause, omit columns in the
- ** using clause from the table on the right. */
- continue;
- }
- pRight = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, 0);
- if( pRight==0 ) break;
- pRight->token.z = zName;
- pRight->token.n = strlen(zName);
- pRight->token.dyn = 0;
- if( zTabName && pTabList->nSrc>1 ){
- pLeft = sqliteExpr(TK_ID, 0, 0, 0);
- pExpr = sqliteExpr(TK_DOT, pLeft, pRight, 0);
- if( pExpr==0 ) break;
- pLeft->token.z = zTabName;
- pLeft->token.n = strlen(zTabName);
- pLeft->token.dyn = 0;
- sqliteSetString((char**)&pExpr->span.z, zTabName, ".", zName, 0);
- pExpr->span.n = strlen(pExpr->span.z);
- pExpr->span.dyn = 1;
- pExpr->token.z = 0;
- pExpr->token.n = 0;
- pExpr->token.dyn = 0;
- }else{
- pExpr = pRight;
- pExpr->span = pExpr->token;
- }
- pNew = sqliteExprListAppend(pNew, pExpr, 0);
- }
- }
- if( !tableSeen ){
- if( pName ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "no such table: %T", pName);
- }else{
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "no tables specified");
- }
- rc = 1;
- }
- }
- }
- sqliteExprListDelete(pEList);
- p->pEList = pNew;
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine recursively unlinks the Select.pSrc.a[].pTab pointers
-** in a select structure. It just sets the pointers to NULL. This
-** routine is recursive in the sense that if the Select.pSrc.a[].pSelect
-** pointer is not NULL, this routine is called recursively on that pointer.
-**
-** This routine is called on the Select structure that defines a
-** VIEW in order to undo any bindings to tables. This is necessary
-** because those tables might be DROPed by a subsequent SQL command.
-** If the bindings are not removed, then the Select.pSrc->a[].pTab field
-** will be left pointing to a deallocated Table structure after the
-** DROP and a coredump will occur the next time the VIEW is used.
-*/
-void sqliteSelectUnbind(Select *p){
- int i;
- SrcList *pSrc = p->pSrc;
- Table *pTab;
- if( p==0 ) return;
- for(i=0; i<pSrc->nSrc; i++){
- if( (pTab = pSrc->a[i].pTab)!=0 ){
- if( pTab->isTransient ){
- sqliteDeleteTable(0, pTab);
- }
- pSrc->a[i].pTab = 0;
- if( pSrc->a[i].pSelect ){
- sqliteSelectUnbind(pSrc->a[i].pSelect);
- }
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine associates entries in an ORDER BY expression list with
-** columns in a result. For each ORDER BY expression, the opcode of
-** the top-level node is changed to TK_COLUMN and the iColumn value of
-** the top-level node is filled in with column number and the iTable
-** value of the top-level node is filled with iTable parameter.
-**
-** If there are prior SELECT clauses, they are processed first. A match
-** in an earlier SELECT takes precedence over a later SELECT.
-**
-** Any entry that does not match is flagged as an error. The number
-** of errors is returned.
-**
-** This routine does NOT correctly initialize the Expr.dataType field
-** of the ORDER BY expressions. The multiSelectSortOrder() routine
-** must be called to do that after the individual select statements
-** have all been analyzed. This routine is unable to compute Expr.dataType
-** because it must be called before the individual select statements
-** have been analyzed.
-*/
-static int matchOrderbyToColumn(
- Parse *pParse, /* A place to leave error messages */
- Select *pSelect, /* Match to result columns of this SELECT */
- ExprList *pOrderBy, /* The ORDER BY values to match against columns */
- int iTable, /* Insert this value in iTable */
- int mustComplete /* If TRUE all ORDER BYs must match */
-){
- int nErr = 0;
- int i, j;
- ExprList *pEList;
-
- if( pSelect==0 || pOrderBy==0 ) return 1;
- if( mustComplete ){
- for(i=0; i<pOrderBy->nExpr; i++){ pOrderBy->a[i].done = 0; }
- }
- if( fillInColumnList(pParse, pSelect) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( pSelect->pPrior ){
- if( matchOrderbyToColumn(pParse, pSelect->pPrior, pOrderBy, iTable, 0) ){
- return 1;
- }
- }
- pEList = pSelect->pEList;
- for(i=0; i<pOrderBy->nExpr; i++){
- Expr *pE = pOrderBy->a[i].pExpr;
- int iCol = -1;
- if( pOrderBy->a[i].done ) continue;
- if( sqliteExprIsInteger(pE, &iCol) ){
- if( iCol<=0 || iCol>pEList->nExpr ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "ORDER BY position %d should be between 1 and %d",
- iCol, pEList->nExpr);
- nErr++;
- break;
- }
- if( !mustComplete ) continue;
- iCol--;
- }
- for(j=0; iCol<0 && j<pEList->nExpr; j++){
- if( pEList->a[j].zName && (pE->op==TK_ID || pE->op==TK_STRING) ){
- char *zName, *zLabel;
- zName = pEList->a[j].zName;
- assert( pE->token.z );
- zLabel = sqliteStrNDup(pE->token.z, pE->token.n);
- sqliteDequote(zLabel);
- if( sqliteStrICmp(zName, zLabel)==0 ){
- iCol = j;
- }
- sqliteFree(zLabel);
- }
- if( iCol<0 && sqliteExprCompare(pE, pEList->a[j].pExpr) ){
- iCol = j;
- }
- }
- if( iCol>=0 ){
- pE->op = TK_COLUMN;
- pE->iColumn = iCol;
- pE->iTable = iTable;
- pOrderBy->a[i].done = 1;
- }
- if( iCol<0 && mustComplete ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "ORDER BY term number %d does not match any result column", i+1);
- nErr++;
- break;
- }
- }
- return nErr;
-}
-
-/*
-** Get a VDBE for the given parser context. Create a new one if necessary.
-** If an error occurs, return NULL and leave a message in pParse.
-*/
-Vdbe *sqliteGetVdbe(Parse *pParse){
- Vdbe *v = pParse->pVdbe;
- if( v==0 ){
- v = pParse->pVdbe = sqliteVdbeCreate(pParse->db);
- }
- return v;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine sets the Expr.dataType field on all elements of
-** the pOrderBy expression list. The pOrderBy list will have been
-** set up by matchOrderbyToColumn(). Hence each expression has
-** a TK_COLUMN as its root node. The Expr.iColumn refers to a
-** column in the result set. The datatype is set to STQLITE_SO_TEXT
-** if the corresponding column in p and every SELECT to the left of
-** p has a datatype of STQLITE_SO_TEXT. If the cooressponding column
-** in p or any of the left SELECTs is STQLITE_SO_NUM, then the datatype
-** of the order-by expression is set to STQLITE_SO_NUM.
-**
-** Examples:
-**
-** CREATE TABLE one(a INTEGER, b TEXT);
-** CREATE TABLE two(c VARCHAR(5), d FLOAT);
-**
-** SELECT b, b FROM one UNION SELECT d, c FROM two ORDER BY 1, 2;
-**
-** The primary sort key will use STQLITE_SO_NUM because the "d" in
-** the second SELECT is numeric. The 1st column of the first SELECT
-** is text but that does not matter because a numeric always overrides
-** a text.
-**
-** The secondary key will use the STQLITE_SO_TEXT sort order because
-** both the (second) "b" in the first SELECT and the "c" in the second
-** SELECT have a datatype of text.
-*/
-static void multiSelectSortOrder(Select *p, ExprList *pOrderBy){
- int i;
- ExprList *pEList;
- if( pOrderBy==0 ) return;
- if( p==0 ){
- for(i=0; i<pOrderBy->nExpr; i++){
- pOrderBy->a[i].pExpr->dataType = STQLITE_SO_TEXT;
- }
- return;
- }
- multiSelectSortOrder(p->pPrior, pOrderBy);
- pEList = p->pEList;
- for(i=0; i<pOrderBy->nExpr; i++){
- Expr *pE = pOrderBy->a[i].pExpr;
- if( pE->dataType==STQLITE_SO_NUM ) continue;
- assert( pE->iColumn>=0 );
- if( pEList->nExpr>pE->iColumn ){
- pE->dataType = sqliteExprType(pEList->a[pE->iColumn].pExpr);
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Compute the iLimit and iOffset fields of the SELECT based on the
-** nLimit and nOffset fields. nLimit and nOffset hold the integers
-** that appear in the original SQL statement after the LIMIT and OFFSET
-** keywords. Or that hold -1 and 0 if those keywords are omitted.
-** iLimit and iOffset are the integer memory register numbers for
-** counters used to compute the limit and offset. If there is no
-** limit and/or offset, then iLimit and iOffset are negative.
-**
-** This routine changes the values if iLimit and iOffset only if
-** a limit or offset is defined by nLimit and nOffset. iLimit and
-** iOffset should have been preset to appropriate default values
-** (usually but not always -1) prior to calling this routine.
-** Only if nLimit>=0 or nOffset>0 do the limit registers get
-** redefined. The UNION ALL operator uses this property to force
-** the reuse of the same limit and offset registers across multiple
-** SELECT statements.
-*/
-static void computeLimitRegisters(Parse *pParse, Select *p){
- /*
- ** If the comparison is p->nLimit>0 then "LIMIT 0" shows
- ** all rows. It is the same as no limit. If the comparision is
- ** p->nLimit>=0 then "LIMIT 0" show no rows at all.
- ** "LIMIT -1" always shows all rows. There is some
- ** contraversy about what the correct behavior should be.
- ** The current implementation interprets "LIMIT 0" to mean
- ** no rows.
- */
- if( p->nLimit>=0 ){
- int iMem = pParse->nMem++;
- Vdbe *v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) return;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, -p->nLimit, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, iMem, 1);
- p->iLimit = iMem;
- }
- if( p->nOffset>0 ){
- int iMem = pParse->nMem++;
- Vdbe *v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) return;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, -p->nOffset, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, iMem, 1);
- p->iOffset = iMem;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called to process a query that is really the union
-** or intersection of two or more separate queries.
-**
-** "p" points to the right-most of the two queries. the query on the
-** left is p->pPrior. The left query could also be a compound query
-** in which case this routine will be called recursively.
-**
-** The results of the total query are to be written into a destination
-** of type eDest with parameter iParm.
-**
-** Example 1: Consider a three-way compound SQL statement.
-**
-** SELECT a FROM t1 UNION SELECT b FROM t2 UNION SELECT c FROM t3
-**
-** This statement is parsed up as follows:
-**
-** SELECT c FROM t3
-** |
-** `-----> SELECT b FROM t2
-** |
-** `------> SELECT a FROM t1
-**
-** The arrows in the diagram above represent the Select.pPrior pointer.
-** So if this routine is called with p equal to the t3 query, then
-** pPrior will be the t2 query. p->op will be TK_UNION in this case.
-**
-** Notice that because of the way STQLite parses compound SELECTs, the
-** individual selects always group from left to right.
-*/
-static int multiSelect(Parse *pParse, Select *p, int eDest, int iParm){
- int rc; /* Success code from a subroutine */
- Select *pPrior; /* Another SELECT immediately to our left */
- Vdbe *v; /* Generate code to this VDBE */
-
- /* Make sure there is no ORDER BY or LIMIT clause on prior SELECTs. Only
- ** the last SELECT in the series may have an ORDER BY or LIMIT.
- */
- if( p==0 || p->pPrior==0 ) return 1;
- pPrior = p->pPrior;
- if( pPrior->pOrderBy ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,"ORDER BY clause should come after %s not before",
- selectOpName(p->op));
- return 1;
- }
- if( pPrior->nLimit>=0 || pPrior->nOffset>0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,"LIMIT clause should come after %s not before",
- selectOpName(p->op));
- return 1;
- }
-
- /* Make sure we have a valid query engine. If not, create a new one.
- */
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) return 1;
-
- /* Create the destination temporary table if necessary
- */
- if( eDest==SRT_TempTable ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenTemp, iParm, 0);
- eDest = SRT_Table;
- }
-
- /* Generate code for the left and right SELECT statements.
- */
- switch( p->op ){
- case TK_ALL: {
- if( p->pOrderBy==0 ){
- pPrior->nLimit = p->nLimit;
- pPrior->nOffset = p->nOffset;
- rc = sqliteSelect(pParse, pPrior, eDest, iParm, 0, 0, 0);
- if( rc ) return rc;
- p->pPrior = 0;
- p->iLimit = pPrior->iLimit;
- p->iOffset = pPrior->iOffset;
- p->nLimit = -1;
- p->nOffset = 0;
- rc = sqliteSelect(pParse, p, eDest, iParm, 0, 0, 0);
- p->pPrior = pPrior;
- if( rc ) return rc;
- break;
- }
- /* For UNION ALL ... ORDER BY fall through to the next case */
- }
- case TK_EXCEPT:
- case TK_UNION: {
- int unionTab; /* Cursor number of the temporary table holding result */
- int op; /* One of the SRT_ operations to apply to self */
- int priorOp; /* The SRT_ operation to apply to prior selects */
- int nLimit, nOffset; /* Saved values of p->nLimit and p->nOffset */
- ExprList *pOrderBy; /* The ORDER BY clause for the right SELECT */
-
- priorOp = p->op==TK_ALL ? SRT_Table : SRT_Union;
- if( eDest==priorOp && p->pOrderBy==0 && p->nLimit<0 && p->nOffset==0 ){
- /* We can reuse a temporary table generated by a SELECT to our
- ** right.
- */
- unionTab = iParm;
- }else{
- /* We will need to create our own temporary table to hold the
- ** intermediate results.
- */
- unionTab = pParse->nTab++;
- if( p->pOrderBy
- && matchOrderbyToColumn(pParse, p, p->pOrderBy, unionTab, 1) ){
- return 1;
- }
- if( p->op!=TK_ALL ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenTemp, unionTab, 1);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_KeyAsData, unionTab, 1);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenTemp, unionTab, 0);
- }
- }
-
- /* Code the SELECT statements to our left
- */
- rc = sqliteSelect(pParse, pPrior, priorOp, unionTab, 0, 0, 0);
- if( rc ) return rc;
-
- /* Code the current SELECT statement
- */
- switch( p->op ){
- case TK_EXCEPT: op = SRT_Except; break;
- case TK_UNION: op = SRT_Union; break;
- case TK_ALL: op = SRT_Table; break;
- }
- p->pPrior = 0;
- pOrderBy = p->pOrderBy;
- p->pOrderBy = 0;
- nLimit = p->nLimit;
- p->nLimit = -1;
- nOffset = p->nOffset;
- p->nOffset = 0;
- rc = sqliteSelect(pParse, p, op, unionTab, 0, 0, 0);
- p->pPrior = pPrior;
- p->pOrderBy = pOrderBy;
- p->nLimit = nLimit;
- p->nOffset = nOffset;
- if( rc ) return rc;
-
- /* Convert the data in the temporary table into whatever form
- ** it is that we currently need.
- */
- if( eDest!=priorOp || unionTab!=iParm ){
- int iCont, iBreak, iStart;
- assert( p->pEList );
- if( eDest==SRT_Callback ){
- generateColumnNames(pParse, 0, p->pEList);
- generateColumnTypes(pParse, p->pSrc, p->pEList);
- }
- iBreak = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- iCont = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, unionTab, iBreak);
- computeLimitRegisters(pParse, p);
- iStart = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- multiSelectSortOrder(p, p->pOrderBy);
- rc = selectInnerLoop(pParse, p, p->pEList, unionTab, p->pEList->nExpr,
- p->pOrderBy, -1, eDest, iParm,
- iCont, iBreak);
- if( rc ) return 1;
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, iCont);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Next, unionTab, iStart);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, iBreak);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, unionTab, 0);
- if( p->pOrderBy ){
- generateSortTail(p, v, p->pEList->nExpr, eDest, iParm);
- }
- }
- break;
- }
- case TK_INTERSECT: {
- int tab1, tab2;
- int iCont, iBreak, iStart;
- int nLimit, nOffset;
-
- /* INTERSECT is different from the others since it requires
- ** two temporary tables. Hence it has its own case. Begin
- ** by allocating the tables we will need.
- */
- tab1 = pParse->nTab++;
- tab2 = pParse->nTab++;
- if( p->pOrderBy && matchOrderbyToColumn(pParse,p,p->pOrderBy,tab1,1) ){
- return 1;
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenTemp, tab1, 1);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_KeyAsData, tab1, 1);
-
- /* Code the SELECTs to our left into temporary table "tab1".
- */
- rc = sqliteSelect(pParse, pPrior, SRT_Union, tab1, 0, 0, 0);
- if( rc ) return rc;
-
- /* Code the current SELECT into temporary table "tab2"
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenTemp, tab2, 1);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_KeyAsData, tab2, 1);
- p->pPrior = 0;
- nLimit = p->nLimit;
- p->nLimit = -1;
- nOffset = p->nOffset;
- p->nOffset = 0;
- rc = sqliteSelect(pParse, p, SRT_Union, tab2, 0, 0, 0);
- p->pPrior = pPrior;
- p->nLimit = nLimit;
- p->nOffset = nOffset;
- if( rc ) return rc;
-
- /* Generate code to take the intersection of the two temporary
- ** tables.
- */
- assert( p->pEList );
- if( eDest==SRT_Callback ){
- generateColumnNames(pParse, 0, p->pEList);
- generateColumnTypes(pParse, p->pSrc, p->pEList);
- }
- iBreak = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- iCont = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, tab1, iBreak);
- computeLimitRegisters(pParse, p);
- iStart = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_FullKey, tab1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotFound, tab2, iCont);
- multiSelectSortOrder(p, p->pOrderBy);
- rc = selectInnerLoop(pParse, p, p->pEList, tab1, p->pEList->nExpr,
- p->pOrderBy, -1, eDest, iParm,
- iCont, iBreak);
- if( rc ) return 1;
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, iCont);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Next, tab1, iStart);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, iBreak);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, tab2, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, tab1, 0);
- if( p->pOrderBy ){
- generateSortTail(p, v, p->pEList->nExpr, eDest, iParm);
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- assert( p->pEList && pPrior->pEList );
- if( p->pEList->nExpr!=pPrior->pEList->nExpr ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "SELECTs to the left and right of %s"
- " do not have the same number of result columns", selectOpName(p->op));
- return 1;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Scan through the expression pExpr. Replace every reference to
-** a column in table number iTable with a copy of the iColumn-th
-** entry in pEList. (But leave references to the ROWID column
-** unchanged.)
-**
-** This routine is part of the flattening procedure. A subquery
-** whose result set is defined by pEList appears as entry in the
-** FROM clause of a SELECT such that the VDBE cursor assigned to that
-** FORM clause entry is iTable. This routine make the necessary
-** changes to pExpr so that it refers directly to the source table
-** of the subquery rather the result set of the subquery.
-*/
-static void substExprList(ExprList*,int,ExprList*); /* Forward Decl */
-static void substExpr(Expr *pExpr, int iTable, ExprList *pEList){
- if( pExpr==0 ) return;
- if( pExpr->op==TK_COLUMN && pExpr->iTable==iTable ){
- if( pExpr->iColumn<0 ){
- pExpr->op = TK_NULL;
- }else{
- Expr *pNew;
- assert( pEList!=0 && pExpr->iColumn<pEList->nExpr );
- assert( pExpr->pLeft==0 && pExpr->pRight==0 && pExpr->pList==0 );
- pNew = pEList->a[pExpr->iColumn].pExpr;
- assert( pNew!=0 );
- pExpr->op = pNew->op;
- pExpr->dataType = pNew->dataType;
- assert( pExpr->pLeft==0 );
- pExpr->pLeft = sqliteExprDup(pNew->pLeft);
- assert( pExpr->pRight==0 );
- pExpr->pRight = sqliteExprDup(pNew->pRight);
- assert( pExpr->pList==0 );
- pExpr->pList = sqliteExprListDup(pNew->pList);
- pExpr->iTable = pNew->iTable;
- pExpr->iColumn = pNew->iColumn;
- pExpr->iAgg = pNew->iAgg;
- sqliteTokenCopy(&pExpr->token, &pNew->token);
- sqliteTokenCopy(&pExpr->span, &pNew->span);
- }
- }else{
- substExpr(pExpr->pLeft, iTable, pEList);
- substExpr(pExpr->pRight, iTable, pEList);
- substExprList(pExpr->pList, iTable, pEList);
- }
-}
-static void
-substExprList(ExprList *pList, int iTable, ExprList *pEList){
- int i;
- if( pList==0 ) return;
- for(i=0; i<pList->nExpr; i++){
- substExpr(pList->a[i].pExpr, iTable, pEList);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine attempts to flatten subqueries in order to speed
-** execution. It returns 1 if it makes changes and 0 if no flattening
-** occurs.
-**
-** To understand the concept of flattening, consider the following
-** query:
-**
-** SELECT a FROM (SELECT x+y AS a FROM t1 WHERE z<100) WHERE a>5
-**
-** The default way of implementing this query is to execute the
-** subquery first and store the results in a temporary table, then
-** run the outer query on that temporary table. This requires two
-** passes over the data. Furthermore, because the temporary table
-** has no indices, the WHERE clause on the outer query cannot be
-** optimized.
-**
-** This routine attempts to rewrite queries such as the above into
-** a single flat select, like this:
-**
-** SELECT x+y AS a FROM t1 WHERE z<100 AND a>5
-**
-** The code generated for this simpification gives the same result
-** but only has to scan the data once. And because indices might
-** exist on the table t1, a complete scan of the data might be
-** avoided.
-**
-** Flattening is only attempted if all of the following are true:
-**
-** (1) The subquery and the outer query do not both use aggregates.
-**
-** (2) The subquery is not an aggregate or the outer query is not a join.
-**
-** (3) The subquery is not the right operand of a left outer join, or
-** the subquery is not itself a join. (Ticket #306)
-**
-** (4) The subquery is not DISTINCT or the outer query is not a join.
-**
-** (5) The subquery is not DISTINCT or the outer query does not use
-** aggregates.
-**
-** (6) The subquery does not use aggregates or the outer query is not
-** DISTINCT.
-**
-** (7) The subquery has a FROM clause.
-**
-** (8) The subquery does not use LIMIT or the outer query is not a join.
-**
-** (9) The subquery does not use LIMIT or the outer query does not use
-** aggregates.
-**
-** (10) The subquery does not use aggregates or the outer query does not
-** use LIMIT.
-**
-** (11) The subquery and the outer query do not both have ORDER BY clauses.
-**
-** (12) The subquery is not the right term of a LEFT OUTER JOIN or the
-** subquery has no WHERE clause. (added by ticket #350)
-**
-** In this routine, the "p" parameter is a pointer to the outer query.
-** The subquery is p->pSrc->a[iFrom]. isAgg is true if the outer query
-** uses aggregates and subqueryIsAgg is true if the subquery uses aggregates.
-**
-** If flattening is not attempted, this routine is a no-op and returns 0.
-** If flattening is attempted this routine returns 1.
-**
-** All of the expression analysis must occur on both the outer query and
-** the subquery before this routine runs.
-*/
-static int flattenSubquery(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parsing context */
- Select *p, /* The parent or outer SELECT statement */
- int iFrom, /* Index in p->pSrc->a[] of the inner subquery */
- int isAgg, /* True if outer SELECT uses aggregate functions */
- int subqueryIsAgg /* True if the subquery uses aggregate functions */
-){
- Select *pSub; /* The inner query or "subquery" */
- SrcList *pSrc; /* The FROM clause of the outer query */
- SrcList *pSubSrc; /* The FROM clause of the subquery */
- ExprList *pList; /* The result set of the outer query */
- int iParent; /* VDBE cursor number of the pSub result set temp table */
- int i;
- Expr *pWhere;
-
- /* Check to see if flattening is permitted. Return 0 if not.
- */
- if( p==0 ) return 0;
- pSrc = p->pSrc;
- assert( pSrc && iFrom>=0 && iFrom<pSrc->nSrc );
- pSub = pSrc->a[iFrom].pSelect;
- assert( pSub!=0 );
- if( isAgg && subqueryIsAgg ) return 0;
- if( subqueryIsAgg && pSrc->nSrc>1 ) return 0;
- pSubSrc = pSub->pSrc;
- assert( pSubSrc );
- if( pSubSrc->nSrc==0 ) return 0;
- if( (pSub->isDistinct || pSub->nLimit>=0) && (pSrc->nSrc>1 || isAgg) ){
- return 0;
- }
- if( (p->isDistinct || p->nLimit>=0) && subqueryIsAgg ) return 0;
- if( p->pOrderBy && pSub->pOrderBy ) return 0;
-
- /* Restriction 3: If the subquery is a join, make sure the subquery is
- ** not used as the right operand of an outer join. Examples of why this
- ** is not allowed:
- **
- ** t1 LEFT OUTER JOIN (t2 JOIN t3)
- **
- ** If we flatten the above, we would get
- **
- ** (t1 LEFT OUTER JOIN t2) JOIN t3
- **
- ** which is not at all the same thing.
- */
- if( pSubSrc->nSrc>1 && iFrom>0 && (pSrc->a[iFrom-1].jointype & JT_OUTER)!=0 ){
- return 0;
- }
-
- /* Restriction 12: If the subquery is the right operand of a left outer
- ** join, make sure the subquery has no WHERE clause.
- ** An examples of why this is not allowed:
- **
- ** t1 LEFT OUTER JOIN (SELECT * FROM t2 WHERE t2.x>0)
- **
- ** If we flatten the above, we would get
- **
- ** (t1 LEFT OUTER JOIN t2) WHERE t2.x>0
- **
- ** But the t2.x>0 test will always fail on a NULL row of t2, which
- ** effectively converts the OUTER JOIN into an INNER JOIN.
- */
- if( iFrom>0 && (pSrc->a[iFrom-1].jointype & JT_OUTER)!=0
- && pSub->pWhere!=0 ){
- return 0;
- }
-
- /* If we reach this point, it means flattening is permitted for the
- ** iFrom-th entry of the FROM clause in the outer query.
- */
-
- /* Move all of the FROM elements of the subquery into the
- ** the FROM clause of the outer query. Before doing this, remember
- ** the cursor number for the original outer query FROM element in
- ** iParent. The iParent cursor will never be used. Subsequent code
- ** will scan expressions looking for iParent references and replace
- ** those references with expressions that resolve to the subquery FROM
- ** elements we are now copying in.
- */
- iParent = pSrc->a[iFrom].iCursor;
- {
- int nSubSrc = pSubSrc->nSrc;
- int jointype = pSrc->a[iFrom].jointype;
-
- if( pSrc->a[iFrom].pTab && pSrc->a[iFrom].pTab->isTransient ){
- sqliteDeleteTable(0, pSrc->a[iFrom].pTab);
- }
- sqliteFree(pSrc->a[iFrom].zDatabase);
- sqliteFree(pSrc->a[iFrom].zName);
- sqliteFree(pSrc->a[iFrom].zAlias);
- if( nSubSrc>1 ){
- int extra = nSubSrc - 1;
- for(i=1; i<nSubSrc; i++){
- pSrc = sqliteSrcListAppend(pSrc, 0, 0);
- }
- p->pSrc = pSrc;
- for(i=pSrc->nSrc-1; i-extra>=iFrom; i--){
- pSrc->a[i] = pSrc->a[i-extra];
- }
- }
- for(i=0; i<nSubSrc; i++){
- pSrc->a[i+iFrom] = pSubSrc->a[i];
- memset(&pSubSrc->a[i], 0, sizeof(pSubSrc->a[i]));
- }
- pSrc->a[iFrom+nSubSrc-1].jointype = jointype;
- }
-
- /* Now begin substituting subquery result set expressions for
- ** references to the iParent in the outer query.
- **
- ** Example:
- **
- ** SELECT a+5, b*10 FROM (SELECT x*3 AS a, y+10 AS b FROM t1) WHERE a>b;
- ** \ \_____________ subquery __________/ /
- ** \_____________________ outer query ______________________________/
- **
- ** We look at every expression in the outer query and every place we see
- ** "a" we substitute "x*3" and every place we see "b" we substitute "y+10".
- */
- substExprList(p->pEList, iParent, pSub->pEList);
- pList = p->pEList;
- for(i=0; i<pList->nExpr; i++){
- Expr *pExpr;
- if( pList->a[i].zName==0 && (pExpr = pList->a[i].pExpr)->span.z!=0 ){
- pList->a[i].zName = sqliteStrNDup(pExpr->span.z, pExpr->span.n);
- }
- }
- if( isAgg ){
- substExprList(p->pGroupBy, iParent, pSub->pEList);
- substExpr(p->pHaving, iParent, pSub->pEList);
- }
- if( pSub->pOrderBy ){
- assert( p->pOrderBy==0 );
- p->pOrderBy = pSub->pOrderBy;
- pSub->pOrderBy = 0;
- }else if( p->pOrderBy ){
- substExprList(p->pOrderBy, iParent, pSub->pEList);
- }
- if( pSub->pWhere ){
- pWhere = sqliteExprDup(pSub->pWhere);
- }else{
- pWhere = 0;
- }
- if( subqueryIsAgg ){
- assert( p->pHaving==0 );
- p->pHaving = p->pWhere;
- p->pWhere = pWhere;
- substExpr(p->pHaving, iParent, pSub->pEList);
- if( pSub->pHaving ){
- Expr *pHaving = sqliteExprDup(pSub->pHaving);
- if( p->pHaving ){
- p->pHaving = sqliteExpr(TK_AND, p->pHaving, pHaving, 0);
- }else{
- p->pHaving = pHaving;
- }
- }
- assert( p->pGroupBy==0 );
- p->pGroupBy = sqliteExprListDup(pSub->pGroupBy);
- }else if( p->pWhere==0 ){
- p->pWhere = pWhere;
- }else{
- substExpr(p->pWhere, iParent, pSub->pEList);
- if( pWhere ){
- p->pWhere = sqliteExpr(TK_AND, p->pWhere, pWhere, 0);
- }
- }
-
- /* The flattened query is distinct if either the inner or the
- ** outer query is distinct.
- */
- p->isDistinct = p->isDistinct || pSub->isDistinct;
-
- /* Transfer the limit expression from the subquery to the outer
- ** query.
- */
- if( pSub->nLimit>=0 ){
- if( p->nLimit<0 ){
- p->nLimit = pSub->nLimit;
- }else if( p->nLimit+p->nOffset > pSub->nLimit+pSub->nOffset ){
- p->nLimit = pSub->nLimit + pSub->nOffset - p->nOffset;
- }
- }
- p->nOffset += pSub->nOffset;
-
- /* Finially, delete what is left of the subquery and return
- ** success.
- */
- sqliteSelectDelete(pSub);
- return 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Analyze the SELECT statement passed in as an argument to see if it
-** is a simple min() or max() query. If it is and this query can be
-** satisfied using a single seek to the beginning or end of an index,
-** then generate the code for this SELECT and return 1. If this is not a
-** simple min() or max() query, then return 0;
-**
-** A simply min() or max() query looks like this:
-**
-** SELECT min(a) FROM table;
-** SELECT max(a) FROM table;
-**
-** The query may have only a single table in its FROM argument. There
-** can be no GROUP BY or HAVING or WHERE clauses. The result set must
-** be the min() or max() of a single column of the table. The column
-** in the min() or max() function must be indexed.
-**
-** The parameters to this routine are the same as for sqliteSelect().
-** See the header comment on that routine for additional information.
-*/
-static int simpleMinMaxQuery(Parse *pParse, Select *p, int eDest, int iParm){
- Expr *pExpr;
- int iCol;
- Table *pTab;
- Index *pIdx;
- int base;
- Vdbe *v;
- int seekOp;
- int cont;
- ExprList eList;
- struct ExprList_item eListItem;
-
- /* Check to see if this query is a simple min() or max() query. Return
- ** zero if it is not.
- */
- if( p->pGroupBy || p->pHaving || p->pWhere ) return 0;
- if( p->pSrc->nSrc!=1 ) return 0;
- if( p->pEList->nExpr!=1 ) return 0;
- pExpr = p->pEList->a[0].pExpr;
- if( pExpr->op!=TK_AGG_FUNCTION ) return 0;
- if( pExpr->pList==0 || pExpr->pList->nExpr!=1 ) return 0;
- if( pExpr->token.n!=3 ) return 0;
- if( sqliteStrNICmp(pExpr->token.z,"min",3)==0 ){
- seekOp = OP_Rewind;
- }else if( sqliteStrNICmp(pExpr->token.z,"max",3)==0 ){
- seekOp = OP_Last;
- }else{
- return 0;
- }
- pExpr = pExpr->pList->a[0].pExpr;
- if( pExpr->op!=TK_COLUMN ) return 0;
- iCol = pExpr->iColumn;
- pTab = p->pSrc->a[0].pTab;
-
- /* If we get to here, it means the query is of the correct form.
- ** Check to make sure we have an index and make pIdx point to the
- ** appropriate index. If the min() or max() is on an INTEGER PRIMARY
- ** key column, no index is necessary so set pIdx to NULL. If no
- ** usable index is found, return 0.
- */
- if( iCol<0 ){
- pIdx = 0;
- }else{
- for(pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext){
- assert( pIdx->nColumn>=1 );
- if( pIdx->aiColumn[0]==iCol ) break;
- }
- if( pIdx==0 ) return 0;
- }
-
- /* Identify column types if we will be using the callback. This
- ** step is skipped if the output is going to a table or a memory cell.
- ** The column names have already been generated in the calling function.
- */
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) return 0;
- if( eDest==SRT_Callback ){
- generateColumnTypes(pParse, p->pSrc, p->pEList);
- }
-
- /* If the output is destined for a temporary table, open that table.
- */
- if( eDest==SRT_TempTable ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenTemp, iParm, 0);
- }
-
- /* Generating code to find the min or the max. Basically all we have
- ** to do is find the first or the last entry in the chosen index. If
- ** the min() or max() is on the INTEGER PRIMARY KEY, then find the first
- ** or last entry in the main table.
- */
- sqliteCodeVerifySchema(pParse, pTab->iDb);
- base = p->pSrc->a[0].iCursor;
- computeLimitRegisters(pParse, p);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pTab->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_OpenRead, base, pTab->tnum, pTab->zName, 0);
- cont = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- if( pIdx==0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, seekOp, base, 0);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pIdx->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_OpenRead, base+1, pIdx->tnum, pIdx->zName, P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, seekOp, base+1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IdxRecno, base+1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, base+1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, base, 0);
- }
- eList.nExpr = 1;
- memset(&eListItem, 0, sizeof(eListItem));
- eList.a = &eListItem;
- eList.a[0].pExpr = pExpr;
- selectInnerLoop(pParse, p, &eList, 0, 0, 0, -1, eDest, iParm, cont, cont);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, cont);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, base, 0);
- return 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate code for the given SELECT statement.
-**
-** The results are distributed in various ways depending on the
-** value of eDest and iParm.
-**
-** eDest Value Result
-** ------------ -------------------------------------------
-** SRT_Callback Invoke the callback for each row of the result.
-**
-** SRT_Mem Store first result in memory cell iParm
-**
-** SRT_Set Store results as keys of a table with cursor iParm
-**
-** SRT_Union Store results as a key in a temporary table iParm
-**
-** SRT_Except Remove results from the temporary table iParm.
-**
-** SRT_Table Store results in temporary table iParm
-**
-** The table above is incomplete. Additional eDist value have be added
-** since this comment was written. See the selectInnerLoop() function for
-** a complete listing of the allowed values of eDest and their meanings.
-**
-** This routine returns the number of errors. If any errors are
-** encountered, then an appropriate error message is left in
-** pParse->zErrMsg.
-**
-** This routine does NOT free the Select structure passed in. The
-** calling function needs to do that.
-**
-** The pParent, parentTab, and *pParentAgg fields are filled in if this
-** SELECT is a subquery. This routine may try to combine this SELECT
-** with its parent to form a single flat query. In so doing, it might
-** change the parent query from a non-aggregate to an aggregate query.
-** For that reason, the pParentAgg flag is passed as a pointer, so it
-** can be changed.
-**
-** Example 1: The meaning of the pParent parameter.
-**
-** SELECT * FROM t1 JOIN (SELECT x, count(*) FROM t2) JOIN t3;
-** \ \_______ subquery _______/ /
-** \ /
-** \____________________ outer query ___________________/
-**
-** This routine is called for the outer query first. For that call,
-** pParent will be NULL. During the processing of the outer query, this
-** routine is called recursively to handle the subquery. For the recursive
-** call, pParent will point to the outer query. Because the subquery is
-** the second element in a three-way join, the parentTab parameter will
-** be 1 (the 2nd value of a 0-indexed array.)
-*/
-int sqliteSelect(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- Select *p, /* The SELECT statement being coded. */
- int eDest, /* How to dispose of the results */
- int iParm, /* A parameter used by the eDest disposal method */
- Select *pParent, /* Another SELECT for which this is a sub-query */
- int parentTab, /* Index in pParent->pSrc of this query */
- int *pParentAgg /* True if pParent uses aggregate functions */
-){
- int i;
- WhereInfo *pWInfo;
- Vdbe *v;
- int isAgg = 0; /* True for select lists like "count(*)" */
- ExprList *pEList; /* List of columns to extract. */
- SrcList *pTabList; /* List of tables to select from */
- Expr *pWhere; /* The WHERE clause. May be NULL */
- ExprList *pOrderBy; /* The ORDER BY clause. May be NULL */
- ExprList *pGroupBy; /* The GROUP BY clause. May be NULL */
- Expr *pHaving; /* The HAVING clause. May be NULL */
- int isDistinct; /* True if the DISTINCT keyword is present */
- int distinct; /* Table to use for the distinct set */
- int rc = 1; /* Value to return from this function */
-
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed || pParse->nErr || p==0 ) return 1;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_SELECT, 0, 0, 0) ) return 1;
-
- /* If there is are a sequence of queries, do the earlier ones first.
- */
- if( p->pPrior ){
- return multiSelect(pParse, p, eDest, iParm);
- }
-
- /* Make local copies of the parameters for this query.
- */
- pTabList = p->pSrc;
- pWhere = p->pWhere;
- pOrderBy = p->pOrderBy;
- pGroupBy = p->pGroupBy;
- pHaving = p->pHaving;
- isDistinct = p->isDistinct;
-
- /* Allocate VDBE cursors for each table in the FROM clause
- */
- sqliteSrcListAssignCursors(pParse, pTabList);
-
- /*
- ** Do not even attempt to generate any code if we have already seen
- ** errors before this routine starts.
- */
- if( pParse->nErr>0 ) goto select_end;
-
- /* Expand any "*" terms in the result set. (For example the "*" in
- ** "SELECT * FROM t1") The fillInColumnlist() routine also does some
- ** other housekeeping - see the header comment for details.
- */
- if( fillInColumnList(pParse, p) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- pWhere = p->pWhere;
- pEList = p->pEList;
- if( pEList==0 ) goto select_end;
-
- /* If writing to memory or generating a set
- ** only a single column may be output.
- */
- if( (eDest==SRT_Mem || eDest==SRT_Set) && pEList->nExpr>1 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "only a single result allowed for "
- "a SELECT that is part of an expression");
- goto select_end;
- }
-
- /* ORDER BY is ignored for some destinations.
- */
- switch( eDest ){
- case SRT_Union:
- case SRT_Except:
- case SRT_Discard:
- pOrderBy = 0;
- break;
- default:
- break;
- }
-
- /* At this point, we should have allocated all the cursors that we
- ** need to handle subquerys and temporary tables.
- **
- ** Resolve the column names and do a semantics check on all the expressions.
- */
- for(i=0; i<pEList->nExpr; i++){
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pTabList, 0, pEList->a[i].pExpr) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- if( sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pEList->a[i].pExpr, 1, &isAgg) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- }
- if( pWhere ){
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pTabList, pEList, pWhere) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- if( sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pWhere, 0, 0) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- }
- if( pHaving ){
- if( pGroupBy==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "a GROUP BY clause is required before HAVING");
- goto select_end;
- }
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pTabList, pEList, pHaving) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- if( sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pHaving, 1, &isAgg) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- }
- if( pOrderBy ){
- for(i=0; i<pOrderBy->nExpr; i++){
- int iCol;
- Expr *pE = pOrderBy->a[i].pExpr;
- if( sqliteExprIsInteger(pE, &iCol) && iCol>0 && iCol<=pEList->nExpr ){
- sqliteExprDelete(pE);
- pE = pOrderBy->a[i].pExpr = sqliteExprDup(pEList->a[iCol-1].pExpr);
- }
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pTabList, pEList, pE) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- if( sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pE, isAgg, 0) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- if( sqliteExprIsConstant(pE) ){
- if( sqliteExprIsInteger(pE, &iCol)==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "ORDER BY terms must not be non-integer constants");
- goto select_end;
- }else if( iCol<=0 || iCol>pEList->nExpr ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "ORDER BY column number %d out of range - should be "
- "between 1 and %d", iCol, pEList->nExpr);
- goto select_end;
- }
- }
- }
- }
- if( pGroupBy ){
- for(i=0; i<pGroupBy->nExpr; i++){
- int iCol;
- Expr *pE = pGroupBy->a[i].pExpr;
- if( sqliteExprIsInteger(pE, &iCol) && iCol>0 && iCol<=pEList->nExpr ){
- sqliteExprDelete(pE);
- pE = pGroupBy->a[i].pExpr = sqliteExprDup(pEList->a[iCol-1].pExpr);
- }
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pTabList, pEList, pE) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- if( sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pE, isAgg, 0) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- if( sqliteExprIsConstant(pE) ){
- if( sqliteExprIsInteger(pE, &iCol)==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "GROUP BY terms must not be non-integer constants");
- goto select_end;
- }else if( iCol<=0 || iCol>pEList->nExpr ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse,
- "GROUP BY column number %d out of range - should be "
- "between 1 and %d", iCol, pEList->nExpr);
- goto select_end;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* Begin generating code.
- */
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) goto select_end;
-
- /* Identify column names if we will be using them in a callback. This
- ** step is skipped if the output is going to some other destination.
- */
- if( eDest==SRT_Callback ){
- generateColumnNames(pParse, pTabList, pEList);
- }
-
- /* Check for the special case of a min() or max() function by itself
- ** in the result set.
- */
- if( simpleMinMaxQuery(pParse, p, eDest, iParm) ){
- rc = 0;
- goto select_end;
- }
-
- /* Generate code for all sub-queries in the FROM clause
- */
- for(i=0; i<pTabList->nSrc; i++){
- const char *zSavedAuthContext;
- int needRestoreContext;
-
- if( pTabList->a[i].pSelect==0 ) continue;
- if( pTabList->a[i].zName!=0 ){
- zSavedAuthContext = pParse->zAuthContext;
- pParse->zAuthContext = pTabList->a[i].zName;
- needRestoreContext = 1;
- }else{
- needRestoreContext = 0;
- }
- sqliteSelect(pParse, pTabList->a[i].pSelect, SRT_TempTable,
- pTabList->a[i].iCursor, p, i, &isAgg);
- if( needRestoreContext ){
- pParse->zAuthContext = zSavedAuthContext;
- }
- pTabList = p->pSrc;
- pWhere = p->pWhere;
- if( eDest!=SRT_Union && eDest!=SRT_Except && eDest!=SRT_Discard ){
- pOrderBy = p->pOrderBy;
- }
- pGroupBy = p->pGroupBy;
- pHaving = p->pHaving;
- isDistinct = p->isDistinct;
- }
-
- /* Check to see if this is a subquery that can be "flattened" into its parent.
- ** If flattening is a possiblity, do so and return immediately.
- */
- if( pParent && pParentAgg &&
- flattenSubquery(pParse, pParent, parentTab, *pParentAgg, isAgg) ){
- if( isAgg ) *pParentAgg = 1;
- return rc;
- }
-
- /* Set the limiter.
- */
- computeLimitRegisters(pParse, p);
-
- /* Identify column types if we will be using a callback. This
- ** step is skipped if the output is going to a destination other
- ** than a callback.
- **
- ** We have to do this separately from the creation of column names
- ** above because if the pTabList contains views then they will not
- ** have been resolved and we will not know the column types until
- ** now.
- */
- if( eDest==SRT_Callback ){
- generateColumnTypes(pParse, pTabList, pEList);
- }
-
- /* If the output is destined for a temporary table, open that table.
- */
- if( eDest==SRT_TempTable ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenTemp, iParm, 0);
- }
-
- /* Do an analysis of aggregate expressions.
- */
- sqliteAggregateInfoReset(pParse);
- if( isAgg || pGroupBy ){
- assert( pParse->nAgg==0 );
- isAgg = 1;
- for(i=0; i<pEList->nExpr; i++){
- if( sqliteExprAnalyzeAggregates(pParse, pEList->a[i].pExpr) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- }
- if( pGroupBy ){
- for(i=0; i<pGroupBy->nExpr; i++){
- if( sqliteExprAnalyzeAggregates(pParse, pGroupBy->a[i].pExpr) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- }
- }
- if( pHaving && sqliteExprAnalyzeAggregates(pParse, pHaving) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- if( pOrderBy ){
- for(i=0; i<pOrderBy->nExpr; i++){
- if( sqliteExprAnalyzeAggregates(pParse, pOrderBy->a[i].pExpr) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* Reset the aggregator
- */
- if( isAgg ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AggReset, 0, pParse->nAgg);
- for(i=0; i<pParse->nAgg; i++){
- FuncDef *pFunc;
- if( (pFunc = pParse->aAgg[i].pFunc)!=0 && pFunc->xFinalize!=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_AggInit, 0, i, (char*)pFunc, P3_POINTER);
- }
- }
- if( pGroupBy==0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AggFocus, 0, 0);
- }
- }
-
- /* Initialize the memory cell to NULL
- */
- if( eDest==SRT_Mem ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, iParm, 1);
- }
-
- /* Open a temporary table to use for the distinct set.
- */
- if( isDistinct ){
- distinct = pParse->nTab++;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenTemp, distinct, 1);
- }else{
- distinct = -1;
- }
-
- /* Begin the database scan
- */
- pWInfo = sqliteWhereBegin(pParse, pTabList, pWhere, 0,
- pGroupBy ? 0 : &pOrderBy);
- if( pWInfo==0 ) goto select_end;
-
- /* Use the standard inner loop if we are not dealing with
- ** aggregates
- */
- if( !isAgg ){
- if( selectInnerLoop(pParse, p, pEList, 0, 0, pOrderBy, distinct, eDest,
- iParm, pWInfo->iContinue, pWInfo->iBreak) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- }
-
- /* If we are dealing with aggregates, then do the special aggregate
- ** processing.
- */
- else{
- AggExpr *pAgg;
- if( pGroupBy ){
- int lbl1;
- for(i=0; i<pGroupBy->nExpr; i++){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pGroupBy->a[i].pExpr);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeKey, pGroupBy->nExpr, 0);
- if( pParse->db->file_format>=4 ) sqliteAddKeyType(v, pGroupBy);
- lbl1 = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AggFocus, 0, lbl1);
- for(i=0, pAgg=pParse->aAgg; i<pParse->nAgg; i++, pAgg++){
- if( pAgg->isAgg ) continue;
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pAgg->pExpr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AggSet, 0, i);
- }
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, lbl1);
- }
- for(i=0, pAgg=pParse->aAgg; i<pParse->nAgg; i++, pAgg++){
- Expr *pE;
- int nExpr;
- FuncDef *pDef;
- if( !pAgg->isAgg ) continue;
- assert( pAgg->pFunc!=0 );
- assert( pAgg->pFunc->xStep!=0 );
- pDef = pAgg->pFunc;
- pE = pAgg->pExpr;
- assert( pE!=0 );
- assert( pE->op==TK_AGG_FUNCTION );
- nExpr = sqliteExprCodeExprList(pParse, pE->pList, pDef->includeTypes);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, i, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_AggFunc, 0, nExpr, (char*)pDef, P3_POINTER);
- }
- }
-
- /* End the database scan loop.
- */
- sqliteWhereEnd(pWInfo);
-
- /* If we are processing aggregates, we need to set up a second loop
- ** over all of the aggregate values and process them.
- */
- if( isAgg ){
- int endagg = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- int startagg;
- startagg = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AggNext, 0, endagg);
- pParse->useAgg = 1;
- if( pHaving ){
- sqliteExprIfFalse(pParse, pHaving, startagg, 1);
- }
- if( selectInnerLoop(pParse, p, pEList, 0, 0, pOrderBy, distinct, eDest,
- iParm, startagg, endagg) ){
- goto select_end;
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, startagg);
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, endagg);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Noop, 0, 0);
- pParse->useAgg = 0;
- }
-
- /* If there is an ORDER BY clause, then we need to sort the results
- ** and send them to the callback one by one.
- */
- if( pOrderBy ){
- generateSortTail(p, v, pEList->nExpr, eDest, iParm);
- }
-
- /* If this was a subquery, we have now converted the subquery into a
- ** temporary table. So delete the subquery structure from the parent
- ** to prevent this subquery from being evaluated again and to force the
- ** the use of the temporary table.
- */
- if( pParent ){
- assert( pParent->pSrc->nSrc>parentTab );
- assert( pParent->pSrc->a[parentTab].pSelect==p );
- sqliteSelectDelete(p);
- pParent->pSrc->a[parentTab].pSelect = 0;
- }
-
- /* The SELECT was successfully coded. Set the return code to 0
- ** to indicate no errors.
- */
- rc = 0;
-
- /* Control jumps to here if an error is encountered above, or upon
- ** successful coding of the SELECT.
- */
-select_end:
- sqliteAggregateInfoReset(pParse);
- return rc;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/shell.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/shell.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 3147303..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/shell.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1350 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains code to implement the "sqlite" command line
-** utility for accessing STQLite databases.
-**
-** $Id: shell.c,v 1.91 2004/02/25 02:25:37 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include "sqlite.h"
-#include <ctype.h>
-
-#if !defined(_WIN32) && !defined(WIN32) && !defined(__MACOS__)
-# include <signal.h>
-# include <pwd.h>
-# include <unistd.h>
-# include <sys/types.h>
-#endif
-
-#ifdef __MACOS__
-# include <console.h>
-# include <signal.h>
-# include <unistd.h>
-# include <extras.h>
-# include <Files.h>
-# include <Folders.h>
-#endif
-
-#if defined(HAVE_READLINE) && HAVE_READLINE==1
-# include <readline/readline.h>
-# include <readline/history.h>
-#else
-# define readline(p) local_getline(p,stdin)
-# define add_history(X)
-# define read_history(X)
-# define write_history(X)
-# define stifle_history(X)
-#endif
-
-/* Make sure isatty() has a prototype.
-*/
-extern int isatty();
-
-/*
-** The following is the open STQLite database. We make a pointer
-** to this database a static variable so that it can be accessed
-** by the SIGINT handler to interrupt database processing.
-*/
-static sqlite *db = 0;
-
-/*
-** True if an interrupt (Control-C) has been received.
-*/
-static int seenInterrupt = 0;
-
-/*
-** This is the name of our program. It is set in main(), used
-** in a number of other places, mostly for error messages.
-*/
-static char *Argv0;
-
-/*
-** Prompt strings. Initialized in main. Settable with
-** .prompt main continue
-*/
-static char mainPrompt[20]; /* First line prompt. default: "sqlite> "*/
-static char continuePrompt[20]; /* Continuation prompt. default: " ...> " */
-
-
-/*
-** Determines if a string is a number of not.
-*/
-extern int sqliteIsNumber(const char*);
-
-/*
-** This routine reads a line of text from standard input, stores
-** the text in memory obtained from malloc() and returns a pointer
-** to the text. NULL is returned at end of file, or if malloc()
-** fails.
-**
-** The interface is like "readline" but no command-line editing
-** is done.
-*/
-static char *local_getline(char *zPrompt, FILE *in){
- char *zLine;
- int nLine;
- int n;
- int eol;
-
- if( zPrompt && *zPrompt ){
- printf("%s",zPrompt);
- fflush(stdout);
- }
- nLine = 100;
- zLine = malloc( nLine );
- if( zLine==0 ) return 0;
- n = 0;
- eol = 0;
- while( !eol ){
- if( n+100>nLine ){
- nLine = nLine*2 + 100;
- zLine = realloc(zLine, nLine);
- if( zLine==0 ) return 0;
- }
- if( fgets(&zLine[n], nLine - n, in)==0 ){
- if( n==0 ){
- free(zLine);
- return 0;
- }
- zLine[n] = 0;
- eol = 1;
- break;
- }
- while( zLine[n] ){ n++; }
- if( n>0 && zLine[n-1]=='\n' ){
- n--;
- zLine[n] = 0;
- eol = 1;
- }
- }
- zLine = realloc( zLine, n+1 );
- return zLine;
-}
-
-/*
-** Retrieve a single line of input text. "isatty" is true if text
-** is coming from a terminal. In that case, we issue a prompt and
-** attempt to use "readline" for command-line editing. If "isatty"
-** is false, use "local_getline" instead of "readline" and issue no prompt.
-**
-** zPrior is a string of prior text retrieved. If not the empty
-** string, then issue a continuation prompt.
-*/
-static char *one_input_line(const char *zPrior, FILE *in){
- char *zPrompt;
- char *zResult;
- if( in!=0 ){
- return local_getline(0, in);
- }
- if( zPrior && zPrior[0] ){
- zPrompt = continuePrompt;
- }else{
- zPrompt = mainPrompt;
- }
- zResult = readline(zPrompt);
- if( zResult ) add_history(zResult);
- return zResult;
-}
-
-struct previous_mode_data {
- int valid; /* Is there legit data in here? */
- int mode;
- int showHeader;
- int colWidth[100];
-};
-/*
-** An pointer to an instance of this structure is passed from
-** the main program to the callback. This is used to communicate
-** state and mode information.
-*/
-struct callback_data {
- sqlite *db; /* The database */
- int echoOn; /* True to echo input commands */
- int cnt; /* Number of records displayed so far */
- FILE *out; /* Write results here */
- int mode; /* An output mode setting */
- int showHeader; /* True to show column names in List or Column mode */
- char *zDestTable; /* Name of destination table when MODE_Insert */
- char separator[20]; /* Separator character for MODE_List */
- int colWidth[100]; /* Requested width of each column when in column mode*/
- int actualWidth[100]; /* Actual width of each column */
- char nullvalue[20]; /* The text to print when a NULL comes back from
- ** the database */
- struct previous_mode_data explainPrev;
- /* Holds the mode information just before
- ** .explain ON */
- char outfile[FILENAME_MAX]; /* Filename for *out */
- const char *zDbFilename; /* name of the database file */
- char *zKey; /* Encryption key */
-};
-
-/*
-** These are the allowed modes.
-*/
-#define MODE_Line 0 /* One column per line. Blank line between records */
-#define MODE_Column 1 /* One record per line in neat columns */
-#define MODE_List 2 /* One record per line with a separator */
-#define MODE_Semi 3 /* Same as MODE_List but append ";" to each line */
-#define MODE_Html 4 /* Generate an XHTML table */
-#define MODE_Insert 5 /* Generate SQL "insert" statements */
-#define MODE_NUM_OF 6 /* The number of modes (not a mode itself) */
-
-char *modeDescr[MODE_NUM_OF] = {
- "line",
- "column",
- "list",
- "semi",
- "html",
- "insert"
-};
-
-/*
-** Number of elements in an array
-*/
-#define ArraySize(X) (sizeof(X)/sizeof(X[0]))
-
-/*
-** Output the given string as a quoted string using SQL quoting conventions.
-*/
-static void output_quoted_string(FILE *out, const char *z){
- int i;
- int nSingle = 0;
- for(i=0; z[i]; i++){
- if( z[i]=='\'' ) nSingle++;
- }
- if( nSingle==0 ){
- fprintf(out,"'%s'",z);
- }else{
- fprintf(out,"'");
- while( *z ){
- for(i=0; z[i] && z[i]!='\''; i++){}
- if( i==0 ){
- fprintf(out,"''");
- z++;
- }else if( z[i]=='\'' ){
- fprintf(out,"%.*s''",i,z);
- z += i+1;
- }else{
- fprintf(out,"%s",z);
- break;
- }
- }
- fprintf(out,"'");
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Output the given string with characters that are special to
-** HTML escaped.
-*/
-static void output_html_string(FILE *out, const char *z){
- int i;
- while( *z ){
- for(i=0; z[i] && z[i]!='<' && z[i]!='&'; i++){}
- if( i>0 ){
- fprintf(out,"%.*s",i,z);
- }
- if( z[i]=='<' ){
- fprintf(out,"&lt;");
- }else if( z[i]=='&' ){
- fprintf(out,"&amp;");
- }else{
- break;
- }
- z += i + 1;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine runs when the user presses Ctrl-C
-*/
-static void interrupt_handler(int NotUsed){
- seenInterrupt = 1;
- if( db ) sqlite_interrupt(db);
-}
-
-/*
-** This is the callback routine that the STQLite library
-** invokes for each row of a query result.
-*/
-static int callback(void *pArg, int nArg, char **azArg, char **azCol){
- int i;
- struct callback_data *p = (struct callback_data*)pArg;
- switch( p->mode ){
- case MODE_Line: {
- int w = 5;
- if( azArg==0 ) break;
- for(i=0; i<nArg; i++){
- int len = strlen(azCol[i]);
- if( len>w ) w = len;
- }
- if( p->cnt++>0 ) fprintf(p->out,"\n");
- for(i=0; i<nArg; i++){
- fprintf(p->out,"%*s = %s\n", w, azCol[i],
- azArg[i] ? azArg[i] : p->nullvalue);
- }
- break;
- }
- case MODE_Column: {
- if( p->cnt++==0 ){
- for(i=0; i<nArg; i++){
- int w, n;
- if( i<ArraySize(p->colWidth) ){
- w = p->colWidth[i];
- }else{
- w = 0;
- }
- if( w<=0 ){
- w = strlen(azCol[i] ? azCol[i] : "");
- if( w<10 ) w = 10;
- n = strlen(azArg && azArg[i] ? azArg[i] : p->nullvalue);
- if( w<n ) w = n;
- }
- if( i<ArraySize(p->actualWidth) ){
- p->actualWidth[i] = w;
- }
- if( p->showHeader ){
- fprintf(p->out,"%-*.*s%s",w,w,azCol[i], i==nArg-1 ? "\n": " ");
- }
- }
- if( p->showHeader ){
- for(i=0; i<nArg; i++){
- int w;
- if( i<ArraySize(p->actualWidth) ){
- w = p->actualWidth[i];
- }else{
- w = 10;
- }
- fprintf(p->out,"%-*.*s%s",w,w,"-----------------------------------"
- "----------------------------------------------------------",
- i==nArg-1 ? "\n": " ");
- }
- }
- }
- if( azArg==0 ) break;
- for(i=0; i<nArg; i++){
- int w;
- if( i<ArraySize(p->actualWidth) ){
- w = p->actualWidth[i];
- }else{
- w = 10;
- }
- fprintf(p->out,"%-*.*s%s",w,w,
- azArg[i] ? azArg[i] : p->nullvalue, i==nArg-1 ? "\n": " ");
- }
- break;
- }
- case MODE_Semi:
- case MODE_List: {
- if( p->cnt++==0 && p->showHeader ){
- for(i=0; i<nArg; i++){
- fprintf(p->out,"%s%s",azCol[i], i==nArg-1 ? "\n" : p->separator);
- }
- }
- if( azArg==0 ) break;
- for(i=0; i<nArg; i++){
- char *z = azArg[i];
- if( z==0 ) z = p->nullvalue;
- fprintf(p->out, "%s", z);
- if( i<nArg-1 ){
- fprintf(p->out, "%s", p->separator);
- }else if( p->mode==MODE_Semi ){
- fprintf(p->out, ";\n");
- }else{
- fprintf(p->out, "\n");
- }
- }
- break;
- }
- case MODE_Html: {
- if( p->cnt++==0 && p->showHeader ){
- fprintf(p->out,"<TR>");
- for(i=0; i<nArg; i++){
- fprintf(p->out,"<TH>%s</TH>",azCol[i]);
- }
- fprintf(p->out,"</TR>\n");
- }
- if( azArg==0 ) break;
- fprintf(p->out,"<TR>");
- for(i=0; i<nArg; i++){
- fprintf(p->out,"<TD>");
- output_html_string(p->out, azArg[i] ? azArg[i] : p->nullvalue);
- fprintf(p->out,"</TD>\n");
- }
- fprintf(p->out,"</TR>\n");
- break;
- }
- case MODE_Insert: {
- if( azArg==0 ) break;
- fprintf(p->out,"INSERT INTO %s VALUES(",p->zDestTable);
- for(i=0; i<nArg; i++){
- char *zSep = i>0 ? ",": "";
- if( azArg[i]==0 ){
- fprintf(p->out,"%sNULL",zSep);
- }else if( sqliteIsNumber(azArg[i]) ){
- fprintf(p->out,"%s%s",zSep, azArg[i]);
- }else{
- if( zSep[0] ) fprintf(p->out,"%s",zSep);
- output_quoted_string(p->out, azArg[i]);
- }
- }
- fprintf(p->out,");\n");
- break;
- }
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Set the destination table field of the callback_data structure to
-** the name of the table given. Escape any quote characters in the
-** table name.
-*/
-static void set_table_name(struct callback_data *p, const char *zName){
- int i, n;
- int needQuote;
- char *z;
-
- if( p->zDestTable ){
- free(p->zDestTable);
- p->zDestTable = 0;
- }
- if( zName==0 ) return;
- needQuote = !isalpha(*zName) && *zName!='_';
- for(i=n=0; zName[i]; i++, n++){
- if( !isalnum(zName[i]) && zName[i]!='_' ){
- needQuote = 1;
- if( zName[i]=='\'' ) n++;
- }
- }
- if( needQuote ) n += 2;
- z = p->zDestTable = malloc( n+1 );
- if( z==0 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"Out of memory!\n");
- exit(1);
- }
- n = 0;
- if( needQuote ) z[n++] = '\'';
- for(i=0; zName[i]; i++){
- z[n++] = zName[i];
- if( zName[i]=='\'' ) z[n++] = '\'';
- }
- if( needQuote ) z[n++] = '\'';
- z[n] = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** This is a different callback routine used for dumping the database.
-** Each row received by this callback consists of a table name,
-** the table type ("index" or "table") and SQL to create the table.
-** This routine should print text sufficient to recreate the table.
-*/
-static int dump_callback(void *pArg, int nArg, char **azArg, char **azCol){
- struct callback_data *p = (struct callback_data *)pArg;
- if( nArg!=3 ) return 1;
- fprintf(p->out, "%s;\n", azArg[2]);
- if( strcmp(azArg[1],"table")==0 ){
- struct callback_data d2;
- d2 = *p;
- d2.mode = MODE_Insert;
- d2.zDestTable = 0;
- set_table_name(&d2, azArg[0]);
- sqlite_exec_printf(p->db,
- "SELECT * FROM '%q'",
- callback, &d2, 0, azArg[0]
- );
- set_table_name(&d2, 0);
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Text of a help message
-*/
-static char zHelp[] =
- ".databases List names and files of attached databases\n"
- ".dump ?TABLE? ... Dump the database in a text format\n"
- ".echo ON|OFF Turn command echo on or off\n"
- ".exit Exit this program\n"
- ".explain ON|OFF Turn output mode suitable for EXPLAIN on or off.\n"
- ".header(s) ON|OFF Turn display of headers on or off\n"
- ".help Show this message\n"
- ".indices TABLE Show names of all indices on TABLE\n"
- ".mode MODE Set mode to one of \"line(s)\", \"column(s)\", \n"
- " \"insert\", \"list\", or \"html\"\n"
- ".mode insert TABLE Generate SQL insert statements for TABLE\n"
- ".nullvalue STRING Print STRING instead of nothing for NULL data\n"
- ".output FILENAME Send output to FILENAME\n"
- ".output stdout Send output to the screen\n"
- ".prompt MAIN CONTINUE Replace the standard prompts\n"
- ".quit Exit this program\n"
- ".read FILENAME Execute SQL in FILENAME\n"
-#ifdef STQLITE_HAS_CODEC
- ".rekey OLD NEW NEW Change the encryption key\n"
-#endif
- ".schema ?TABLE? Show the CREATE statements\n"
- ".separator STRING Change separator string for \"list\" mode\n"
- ".show Show the current values for various settings\n"
- ".tables ?PATTERN? List names of tables matching a pattern\n"
- ".timeout MS Try opening locked tables for MS milliseconds\n"
- ".width NUM NUM ... Set column widths for \"column\" mode\n"
-;
-
-/* Forward reference */
-static void process_input(struct callback_data *p, FILE *in);
-
-/*
-** Make sure the database is open. If it is not, then open it. If
-** the database fails to open, print an error message and exit.
-*/
-static void open_db(struct callback_data *p){
- if( p->db==0 ){
- char *zErrMsg = 0;
-#ifdef STQLITE_HAS_CODEC
- int n = p->zKey ? strlen(p->zKey) : 0;
- db = p->db = sqlite_open_encrypted(p->zDbFilename, p->zKey, n, 0, &zErrMsg);
-#else
- db = p->db = sqlite_open(p->zDbFilename, 0, &zErrMsg);
-#endif
- if( p->db==0 ){
- if( zErrMsg ){
- fprintf(stderr,"Unable to open database \"%s\": %s\n",
- p->zDbFilename, zErrMsg);
- }else{
- fprintf(stderr,"Unable to open database %s\n", p->zDbFilename);
- }
- exit(1);
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** If an input line begins with "." then invoke this routine to
-** process that line.
-**
-** Return 1 to exit and 0 to continue.
-*/
-static int do_meta_command(char *zLine, struct callback_data *p){
- int i = 1;
- int nArg = 0;
- int n, c;
- int rc = 0;
- char *azArg[50];
-
- /* Parse the input line into tokens.
- */
- while( zLine[i] && nArg<ArraySize(azArg) ){
- while( isspace(zLine[i]) ){ i++; }
- if( zLine[i]=='\'' || zLine[i]=='"' ){
- int delim = zLine[i++];
- azArg[nArg++] = &zLine[i];
- while( zLine[i] && zLine[i]!=delim ){ i++; }
- if( zLine[i]==delim ){
- zLine[i++] = 0;
- }
- }else{
- azArg[nArg++] = &zLine[i];
- while( zLine[i] && !isspace(zLine[i]) ){ i++; }
- if( zLine[i] ) zLine[i++] = 0;
- }
- }
-
- /* Process the input line.
- */
- if( nArg==0 ) return rc;
- n = strlen(azArg[0]);
- c = azArg[0][0];
- if( c=='d' && n>1 && strncmp(azArg[0], "databases", n)==0 ){
- struct callback_data data;
- char *zErrMsg = 0;
- open_db(p);
- memcpy(&data, p, sizeof(data));
- data.showHeader = 0;
- data.mode = MODE_Column;
- sqlite_exec(p->db, "PRAGMA database_list; ", callback, &data, &zErrMsg);
- if( zErrMsg ){
- fprintf(stderr,"Error: %s\n", zErrMsg);
- sqlite_freemem(zErrMsg);
- }
- }else
-
- if( c=='d' && strncmp(azArg[0], "dump", n)==0 ){
- char *zErrMsg = 0;
- open_db(p);
- fprintf(p->out, "BEGIN TRANSACTION;\n");
- if( nArg==1 ){
- sqlite_exec(p->db,
- "SELECT name, type, sql FROM sqlite_master "
- "WHERE type!='meta' AND sql NOT NULL "
- "ORDER BY substr(type,2,1), name",
- dump_callback, p, &zErrMsg
- );
- }else{
- int i;
- for(i=1; i<nArg && zErrMsg==0; i++){
- sqlite_exec_printf(p->db,
- "SELECT name, type, sql FROM sqlite_master "
- "WHERE tbl_name LIKE '%q' AND type!='meta' AND sql NOT NULL "
- "ORDER BY substr(type,2,1), name",
- dump_callback, p, &zErrMsg, azArg[i]
- );
- }
- }
- if( zErrMsg ){
- fprintf(stderr,"Error: %s\n", zErrMsg);
- sqlite_freemem(zErrMsg);
- }else{
- fprintf(p->out, "COMMIT;\n");
- }
- }else
-
- if( c=='e' && strncmp(azArg[0], "echo", n)==0 && nArg>1 ){
- int j;
- char *z = azArg[1];
- int val = atoi(azArg[1]);
- for(j=0; z[j]; j++){
- if( isupper(z[j]) ) z[j] = tolower(z[j]);
- }
- if( strcmp(z,"on")==0 ){
- val = 1;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"yes")==0 ){
- val = 1;
- }
- p->echoOn = val;
- }else
-
- if( c=='e' && strncmp(azArg[0], "exit", n)==0 ){
- rc = 1;
- }else
-
- if( c=='e' && strncmp(azArg[0], "explain", n)==0 ){
- int j;
- char *z = nArg>=2 ? azArg[1] : "1";
- int val = atoi(z);
- for(j=0; z[j]; j++){
- if( isupper(z[j]) ) z[j] = tolower(z[j]);
- }
- if( strcmp(z,"on")==0 ){
- val = 1;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"yes")==0 ){
- val = 1;
- }
- if(val == 1) {
- if(!p->explainPrev.valid) {
- p->explainPrev.valid = 1;
- p->explainPrev.mode = p->mode;
- p->explainPrev.showHeader = p->showHeader;
- memcpy(p->explainPrev.colWidth,p->colWidth,sizeof(p->colWidth));
- }
- /* We could put this code under the !p->explainValid
- ** condition so that it does not execute if we are already in
- ** explain mode. However, always executing it allows us an easy
- ** was to reset to explain mode in case the user previously
- ** did an .explain followed by a .width, .mode or .header
- ** command.
- */
- p->mode = MODE_Column;
- p->showHeader = 1;
- memset(p->colWidth,0,ArraySize(p->colWidth));
- p->colWidth[0] = 4;
- p->colWidth[1] = 12;
- p->colWidth[2] = 10;
- p->colWidth[3] = 10;
- p->colWidth[4] = 35;
- }else if (p->explainPrev.valid) {
- p->explainPrev.valid = 0;
- p->mode = p->explainPrev.mode;
- p->showHeader = p->explainPrev.showHeader;
- memcpy(p->colWidth,p->explainPrev.colWidth,sizeof(p->colWidth));
- }
- }else
-
- if( c=='h' && (strncmp(azArg[0], "header", n)==0
- ||
- strncmp(azArg[0], "headers", n)==0 )&& nArg>1 ){
- int j;
- char *z = azArg[1];
- int val = atoi(azArg[1]);
- for(j=0; z[j]; j++){
- if( isupper(z[j]) ) z[j] = tolower(z[j]);
- }
- if( strcmp(z,"on")==0 ){
- val = 1;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"yes")==0 ){
- val = 1;
- }
- p->showHeader = val;
- }else
-
- if( c=='h' && strncmp(azArg[0], "help", n)==0 ){
- fprintf(stderr,zHelp);
- }else
-
- if( c=='i' && strncmp(azArg[0], "indices", n)==0 && nArg>1 ){
- struct callback_data data;
- char *zErrMsg = 0;
- open_db(p);
- memcpy(&data, p, sizeof(data));
- data.showHeader = 0;
- data.mode = MODE_List;
- sqlite_exec_printf(p->db,
- "SELECT name FROM sqlite_master "
- "WHERE type='index' AND tbl_name LIKE '%q' "
- "UNION ALL "
- "SELECT name FROM sqlite_temp_master "
- "WHERE type='index' AND tbl_name LIKE '%q' "
- "ORDER BY 1",
- callback, &data, &zErrMsg, azArg[1], azArg[1]
- );
- if( zErrMsg ){
- fprintf(stderr,"Error: %s\n", zErrMsg);
- sqlite_freemem(zErrMsg);
- }
- }else
-
- if( c=='m' && strncmp(azArg[0], "mode", n)==0 && nArg>=2 ){
- int n2 = strlen(azArg[1]);
- if( strncmp(azArg[1],"line",n2)==0
- ||
- strncmp(azArg[1],"lines",n2)==0 ){
- p->mode = MODE_Line;
- }else if( strncmp(azArg[1],"column",n2)==0
- ||
- strncmp(azArg[1],"columns",n2)==0 ){
- p->mode = MODE_Column;
- }else if( strncmp(azArg[1],"list",n2)==0 ){
- p->mode = MODE_List;
- }else if( strncmp(azArg[1],"html",n2)==0 ){
- p->mode = MODE_Html;
- }else if( strncmp(azArg[1],"insert",n2)==0 ){
- p->mode = MODE_Insert;
- if( nArg>=3 ){
- set_table_name(p, azArg[2]);
- }else{
- set_table_name(p, "table");
- }
- }else {
- fprintf(stderr,"mode should be on of: column html insert line list\n");
- }
- }else
-
- if( c=='n' && strncmp(azArg[0], "nullvalue", n)==0 && nArg==2 ) {
- sprintf(p->nullvalue, "%.*s", (int)ArraySize(p->nullvalue)-1, azArg[1]);
- }else
-
- if( c=='o' && strncmp(azArg[0], "output", n)==0 && nArg==2 ){
- if( p->out!=stdout ){
- fclose(p->out);
- }
- if( strcmp(azArg[1],"stdout")==0 ){
- p->out = stdout;
- strcpy(p->outfile,"stdout");
- }else{
- p->out = fopen(azArg[1], "wb");
- if( p->out==0 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"can't write to \"%s\"\n", azArg[1]);
- p->out = stdout;
- } else {
- strcpy(p->outfile,azArg[1]);
- }
- }
- }else
-
- if( c=='p' && strncmp(azArg[0], "prompt", n)==0 && (nArg==2 || nArg==3)){
- if( nArg >= 2) {
- strncpy(mainPrompt,azArg[1],(int)ArraySize(mainPrompt)-1);
- }
- if( nArg >= 3) {
- strncpy(continuePrompt,azArg[2],(int)ArraySize(continuePrompt)-1);
- }
- }else
-
- if( c=='q' && strncmp(azArg[0], "quit", n)==0 ){
- rc = 1;
- }else
-
- if( c=='r' && strncmp(azArg[0], "read", n)==0 && nArg==2 ){
- FILE *alt = fopen(azArg[1], "rb");
- if( alt==0 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"can't open \"%s\"\n", azArg[1]);
- }else{
- process_input(p, alt);
- fclose(alt);
- }
- }else
-
-#ifdef STQLITE_HAS_CODEC
- if( c=='r' && strncmp(azArg[0],"rekey", n)==0 && nArg==4 ){
- char *zOld = p->zKey;
- if( zOld==0 ) zOld = "";
- if( strcmp(azArg[1],zOld) ){
- fprintf(stderr,"old key is incorrect\n");
- }else if( strcmp(azArg[2], azArg[3]) ){
- fprintf(stderr,"2nd copy of new key does not match the 1st\n");
- }else{
- sqlite_freemem(p->zKey);
- p->zKey = sqlite_mprintf("%s", azArg[2]);
- sqlite_rekey(p->db, p->zKey, strlen(p->zKey));
- }
- }else
-#endif
-
- if( c=='s' && strncmp(azArg[0], "schema", n)==0 ){
- struct callback_data data;
- char *zErrMsg = 0;
- open_db(p);
- memcpy(&data, p, sizeof(data));
- data.showHeader = 0;
- data.mode = MODE_Semi;
- if( nArg>1 ){
- extern int sqliteStrICmp(const char*,const char*);
- if( sqliteStrICmp(azArg[1],"sqlite_master")==0 ){
- char *new_argv[2], *new_colv[2];
- new_argv[0] = "CREATE TABLE sqlite_master (\n"
- " type text,\n"
- " name text,\n"
- " tbl_name text,\n"
- " rootpage integer,\n"
- " sql text\n"
- ")";
- new_argv[1] = 0;
- new_colv[0] = "sql";
- new_colv[1] = 0;
- callback(&data, 1, new_argv, new_colv);
- }else if( sqliteStrICmp(azArg[1],"sqlite_temp_master")==0 ){
- char *new_argv[2], *new_colv[2];
- new_argv[0] = "CREATE TEMP TABLE sqlite_temp_master (\n"
- " type text,\n"
- " name text,\n"
- " tbl_name text,\n"
- " rootpage integer,\n"
- " sql text\n"
- ")";
- new_argv[1] = 0;
- new_colv[0] = "sql";
- new_colv[1] = 0;
- callback(&data, 1, new_argv, new_colv);
- }else{
- sqlite_exec_printf(p->db,
- "SELECT sql FROM "
- " (SELECT * FROM sqlite_master UNION ALL"
- " SELECT * FROM sqlite_temp_master) "
- "WHERE tbl_name LIKE '%q' AND type!='meta' AND sql NOTNULL "
- "ORDER BY substr(type,2,1), name",
- callback, &data, &zErrMsg, azArg[1]);
- }
- }else{
- sqlite_exec(p->db,
- "SELECT sql FROM "
- " (SELECT * FROM sqlite_master UNION ALL"
- " SELECT * FROM sqlite_temp_master) "
- "WHERE type!='meta' AND sql NOTNULL "
- "ORDER BY substr(type,2,1), name",
- callback, &data, &zErrMsg
- );
- }
- if( zErrMsg ){
- fprintf(stderr,"Error: %s\n", zErrMsg);
- sqlite_freemem(zErrMsg);
- }
- }else
-
- if( c=='s' && strncmp(azArg[0], "separator", n)==0 && nArg==2 ){
- sprintf(p->separator, "%.*s", (int)ArraySize(p->separator)-1, azArg[1]);
- }else
-
- if( c=='s' && strncmp(azArg[0], "show", n)==0){
- int i;
- fprintf(p->out,"%9.9s: %s\n","echo", p->echoOn ? "on" : "off");
- fprintf(p->out,"%9.9s: %s\n","explain", p->explainPrev.valid ? "on" :"off");
- fprintf(p->out,"%9.9s: %s\n","headers", p->showHeader ? "on" : "off");
- fprintf(p->out,"%9.9s: %s\n","mode", modeDescr[p->mode]);
- fprintf(p->out,"%9.9s: %s\n","nullvalue", p->nullvalue);
- fprintf(p->out,"%9.9s: %s\n","output",
- strlen(p->outfile) ? p->outfile : "stdout");
- fprintf(p->out,"%9.9s: %s\n","separator", p->separator);
- fprintf(p->out,"%9.9s: ","width");
- for (i=0;i<(int)ArraySize(p->colWidth) && p->colWidth[i] != 0;i++) {
- fprintf(p->out,"%d ",p->colWidth[i]);
- }
- fprintf(p->out,"\n\n");
- }else
-
- if( c=='t' && n>1 && strncmp(azArg[0], "tables", n)==0 ){
- char **azResult;
- int nRow, rc;
- char *zErrMsg;
- open_db(p);
- if( nArg==1 ){
- rc = sqlite_get_table(p->db,
- "SELECT name FROM sqlite_master "
- "WHERE type IN ('table','view') "
- "UNION ALL "
- "SELECT name FROM sqlite_temp_master "
- "WHERE type IN ('table','view') "
- "ORDER BY 1",
- &azResult, &nRow, 0, &zErrMsg
- );
- }else{
- rc = sqlite_get_table_printf(p->db,
- "SELECT name FROM sqlite_master "
- "WHERE type IN ('table','view') AND name LIKE '%%%q%%' "
- "UNION ALL "
- "SELECT name FROM sqlite_temp_master "
- "WHERE type IN ('table','view') AND name LIKE '%%%q%%' "
- "ORDER BY 1",
- &azResult, &nRow, 0, &zErrMsg, azArg[1], azArg[1]
- );
- }
- if( zErrMsg ){
- fprintf(stderr,"Error: %s\n", zErrMsg);
- sqlite_freemem(zErrMsg);
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- int len, maxlen = 0;
- int i, j;
- int nPrintCol, nPrintRow;
- for(i=1; i<=nRow; i++){
- if( azResult[i]==0 ) continue;
- len = strlen(azResult[i]);
- if( len>maxlen ) maxlen = len;
- }
- nPrintCol = 80/(maxlen+2);
- if( nPrintCol<1 ) nPrintCol = 1;
- nPrintRow = (nRow + nPrintCol - 1)/nPrintCol;
- for(i=0; i<nPrintRow; i++){
- for(j=i+1; j<=nRow; j+=nPrintRow){
- char *zSp = j<=nPrintRow ? "" : " ";
- printf("%s%-*s", zSp, maxlen, azResult[j] ? azResult[j] : "");
- }
- printf("\n");
- }
- }
- sqlite_free_table(azResult);
- }else
-
- if( c=='t' && n>1 && strncmp(azArg[0], "timeout", n)==0 && nArg>=2 ){
- open_db(p);
- sqlite_busy_timeout(p->db, atoi(azArg[1]));
- }else
-
- if( c=='w' && strncmp(azArg[0], "width", n)==0 ){
- int j;
- for(j=1; j<nArg && j<ArraySize(p->colWidth); j++){
- p->colWidth[j-1] = atoi(azArg[j]);
- }
- }else
-
- {
- fprintf(stderr, "unknown command or invalid arguments: "
- " \"%s\". Enter \".help\" for help\n", azArg[0]);
- }
-
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return TRUE if the last non-whitespace character in z[] is a semicolon.
-** z[] is N characters long.
-*/
-static int _ends_with_semicolon(const char *z, int N){
- while( N>0 && isspace(z[N-1]) ){ N--; }
- return N>0 && z[N-1]==';';
-}
-
-/*
-** Test to see if a line consists entirely of whitespace.
-*/
-static int _all_whitespace(const char *z){
- for(; *z; z++){
- if( isspace(*z) ) continue;
- if( *z=='/' && z[1]=='*' ){
- z += 2;
- while( *z && (*z!='*' || z[1]!='/') ){ z++; }
- if( *z==0 ) return 0;
- z++;
- continue;
- }
- if( *z=='-' && z[1]=='-' ){
- z += 2;
- while( *z && *z!='\n' ){ z++; }
- if( *z==0 ) return 1;
- continue;
- }
- return 0;
- }
- return 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return TRUE if the line typed in is an SQL command terminator other
-** than a semi-colon. The SQL Server style "go" command is understood
-** as is the Oracle "/".
-*/
-static int _is_command_terminator(const char *zLine){
- extern int sqliteStrNICmp(const char*,const char*,int);
- while( isspace(*zLine) ){ zLine++; };
- if( zLine[0]=='/' && _all_whitespace(&zLine[1]) ) return 1; /* Oracle */
- if( sqliteStrNICmp(zLine,"go",2)==0 && _all_whitespace(&zLine[2]) ){
- return 1; /* SQL Server */
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Read input from *in and process it. If *in==0 then input
-** is interactive - the user is typing it it. Otherwise, input
-** is coming from a file or tqdevice. A prompt is issued and history
-** is saved only if input is interactive. An interrupt signal will
-** cause this routine to exit immediately, unless input is interactive.
-*/
-static void process_input(struct callback_data *p, FILE *in){
- char *zLine;
- char *zSql = 0;
- int nSql = 0;
- char *zErrMsg;
- int rc;
- while( fflush(p->out), (zLine = one_input_line(zSql, in))!=0 ){
- if( seenInterrupt ){
- if( in!=0 ) break;
- seenInterrupt = 0;
- }
- if( p->echoOn ) printf("%s\n", zLine);
- if( (zSql==0 || zSql[0]==0) && _all_whitespace(zLine) ) continue;
- if( zLine && zLine[0]=='.' && nSql==0 ){
- int rc = do_meta_command(zLine, p);
- free(zLine);
- if( rc ) break;
- continue;
- }
- if( _is_command_terminator(zLine) ){
- strcpy(zLine,";");
- }
- if( zSql==0 ){
- int i;
- for(i=0; zLine[i] && isspace(zLine[i]); i++){}
- if( zLine[i]!=0 ){
- nSql = strlen(zLine);
- zSql = malloc( nSql+1 );
- strcpy(zSql, zLine);
- }
- }else{
- int len = strlen(zLine);
- zSql = realloc( zSql, nSql + len + 2 );
- if( zSql==0 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"%s: out of memory!\n", Argv0);
- exit(1);
- }
- strcpy(&zSql[nSql++], "\n");
- strcpy(&zSql[nSql], zLine);
- nSql += len;
- }
- free(zLine);
- if( zSql && _ends_with_semicolon(zSql, nSql) && sqlite_complete(zSql) ){
- p->cnt = 0;
- open_db(p);
- rc = sqlite_exec(p->db, zSql, callback, p, &zErrMsg);
- if( rc || zErrMsg ){
- if( in!=0 && !p->echoOn ) printf("%s\n",zSql);
- if( zErrMsg!=0 ){
- printf("SQL error: %s\n", zErrMsg);
- sqlite_freemem(zErrMsg);
- zErrMsg = 0;
- }else{
- printf("SQL error: %s\n", sqlite_error_string(rc));
- }
- }
- free(zSql);
- zSql = 0;
- nSql = 0;
- }
- }
- if( zSql ){
- if( !_all_whitespace(zSql) ) printf("Incomplete SQL: %s\n", zSql);
- free(zSql);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Return a pathname which is the user's home directory. A
-** 0 return indicates an error of some kind. Space to hold the
-** resulting string is obtained from malloc(). The calling
-** function should free the result.
-*/
-static char *find_home_dir(void){
- char *home_dir = NULL;
-
-#if !defined(_WIN32) && !defined(WIN32) && !defined(__MACOS__)
- struct passwd *pwent;
- uid_t uid = getuid();
- if( (pwent=getpwuid(uid)) != NULL) {
- home_dir = pwent->pw_dir;
- }
-#endif
-
-#ifdef __MACOS__
- char home_path[_MAX_PATH+1];
- home_dir = getcwd(home_path, _MAX_PATH);
-#endif
-
- if (!home_dir) {
- home_dir = getenv("HOME");
- if (!home_dir) {
- home_dir = getenv("HOMEPATH"); /* Windows? */
- }
- }
-
-#if defined(_WIN32) || defined(WIN32)
- if (!home_dir) {
- home_dir = "c:";
- }
-#endif
-
- if( home_dir ){
- char *z = malloc( strlen(home_dir)+1 );
- if( z ) strcpy(z, home_dir);
- home_dir = z;
- }
-
- return home_dir;
-}
-
-/*
-** Read input from the file given by sqliterc_override. Or if that
-** parameter is NULL, take input from ~/.sqliterc
-*/
-static void process_sqliterc(
- struct callback_data *p, /* Configuration data */
- const char *sqliterc_override /* Name of config file. NULL to use default */
-){
- char *home_dir = NULL;
- const char *sqliterc = sqliterc_override;
- char *zBuf;
- FILE *in = NULL;
-
- if (sqliterc == NULL) {
- home_dir = find_home_dir();
- if( home_dir==0 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"%s: cannot locate your home directory!\n", Argv0);
- return;
- }
- zBuf = malloc(strlen(home_dir) + 15);
- if( zBuf==0 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"%s: out of memory!\n", Argv0);
- exit(1);
- }
- sprintf(zBuf,"%s/.sqliterc",home_dir);
- free(home_dir);
- sqliterc = (const char*)zBuf;
- }
- in = fopen(sqliterc,"rb");
- if( in ){
- if( isatty(fileno(stdout)) ){
- printf("Loading resources from %s\n",sqliterc);
- }
- process_input(p,in);
- fclose(in);
- }
- return;
-}
-
-/*
-** Show available command line options
-*/
-static const char zOptions[] =
- " -init filename read/process named file\n"
- " -echo print commands before execution\n"
- " -[no]header turn headers on or off\n"
- " -column set output mode to 'column'\n"
- " -html set output mode to HTML\n"
-#ifdef STQLITE_HAS_CODEC
- " -key KEY encryption key\n"
-#endif
- " -line set output mode to 'line'\n"
- " -list set output mode to 'list'\n"
- " -separator 'x' set output field separator (|)\n"
- " -nullvalue 'text' set text string for NULL values\n"
- " -version show STQLite version\n"
- " -help show this text, also show dot-commands\n"
-;
-static void usage(int showDetail){
- fprintf(stderr, "Usage: %s [OPTIONS] FILENAME [SQL]\n", Argv0);
- if( showDetail ){
- fprintf(stderr, "Options are:\n%s", zOptions);
- }else{
- fprintf(stderr, "Use the -help option for additional information\n");
- }
- exit(1);
-}
-
-/*
-** Initialize the state information in data
-*/
-void main_init(struct callback_data *data) {
- memset(data, 0, sizeof(*data));
- data->mode = MODE_List;
- strcpy(data->separator,"|");
- data->showHeader = 0;
- strcpy(mainPrompt,"sqlite> ");
- strcpy(continuePrompt," ...> ");
-}
-
-int main(int argc, char **argv){
- char *zErrMsg = 0;
- struct callback_data data;
- const char *zInitFile = 0;
- char *zFirstCmd = 0;
- int i;
- extern int sqliteOsFileExists(const char*);
-
-#ifdef __MACOS__
- argc = ccommand(&argv);
-#endif
-
- Argv0 = argv[0];
- main_init(&data);
-
- /* Make sure we have a valid signal handler early, before anything
- ** else is done.
- */
-#ifdef SIGINT
- signal(SIGINT, interrupt_handler);
-#endif
-
- /* Do an initial pass through the command-line argument to locate
- ** the name of the database file, the name of the initialization file,
- ** and the first command to execute.
- */
- for(i=1; i<argc-1; i++){
- if( argv[i][0]!='-' ) break;
- if( strcmp(argv[i],"-separator")==0 || strcmp(argv[i],"-nullvalue")==0 ){
- i++;
- }else if( strcmp(argv[i],"-init")==0 ){
- i++;
- zInitFile = argv[i];
- }else if( strcmp(argv[i],"-key")==0 ){
- i++;
- data.zKey = sqlite_mprintf("%s",argv[i]);
- }
- }
- if( i<argc ){
- data.zDbFilename = argv[i++];
- }else{
- data.zDbFilename = ":memory:";
- }
- if( i<argc ){
- zFirstCmd = argv[i++];
- }
- data.out = stdout;
-
- /* Go ahead and open the database file if it already exists. If the
- ** file does not exist, delay opening it. This prevents empty database
- ** files from being created if a user mistypes the database name argument
- ** to the sqlite command-line tool.
- */
- if( sqliteOsFileExists(data.zDbFilename) ){
- open_db(&data);
- }
-
- /* Process the initialization file if there is one. If no -init option
- ** is given on the command line, look for a file named ~/.sqliterc and
- ** try to process it.
- */
- process_sqliterc(&data,zInitFile);
-
- /* Make a second pass through the command-line argument and set
- ** options. This second pass is delayed until after the initialization
- ** file is processed so that the command-line arguments will override
- ** settings in the initialization file.
- */
- for(i=1; i<argc && argv[i][0]=='-'; i++){
- char *z = argv[i];
- if( strcmp(z,"-init")==0 || strcmp(z,"-key")==0 ){
- i++;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-html")==0 ){
- data.mode = MODE_Html;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-list")==0 ){
- data.mode = MODE_List;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-line")==0 ){
- data.mode = MODE_Line;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-column")==0 ){
- data.mode = MODE_Column;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-separator")==0 ){
- i++;
- sprintf(data.separator,"%.*s",(int)sizeof(data.separator)-1,argv[i]);
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-nullvalue")==0 ){
- i++;
- sprintf(data.nullvalue,"%.*s",(int)sizeof(data.nullvalue)-1,argv[i]);
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-header")==0 ){
- data.showHeader = 1;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-noheader")==0 ){
- data.showHeader = 0;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-echo")==0 ){
- data.echoOn = 1;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-version")==0 ){
- printf("%s\n", sqlite_version);
- return 1;
- }else if( strcmp(z,"-help")==0 ){
- usage(1);
- }else{
- fprintf(stderr,"%s: unknown option: %s\n", Argv0, z);
- fprintf(stderr,"Use -help for a list of options.\n");
- return 1;
- }
- }
-
- if( zFirstCmd ){
- /* Run just the command that follows the database name
- */
- if( zFirstCmd[0]=='.' ){
- do_meta_command(zFirstCmd, &data);
- exit(0);
- }else{
- int rc;
- open_db(&data);
- rc = sqlite_exec(data.db, zFirstCmd, callback, &data, &zErrMsg);
- if( rc!=0 && zErrMsg!=0 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"SQL error: %s\n", zErrMsg);
- exit(1);
- }
- }
- }else{
- /* Run commands received from standard input
- */
- if( isatty(fileno(stdout)) && isatty(fileno(stdin)) ){
- char *zHome;
- char *zHistory = 0;
- printf(
- "STQLite version %s\n"
- "Enter \".help\" for instructions\n",
- sqlite_version
- );
- zHome = find_home_dir();
- if( zHome && (zHistory = malloc(strlen(zHome)+20))!=0 ){
- sprintf(zHistory,"%s/.sqlite_history", zHome);
- }
- if( zHistory ) read_history(zHistory);
- process_input(&data, 0);
- if( zHistory ){
- stifle_history(100);
- write_history(zHistory);
- }
- }else{
- process_input(&data, stdin);
- }
- }
- set_table_name(&data, 0);
- if( db ) sqlite_close(db);
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/sqlite.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/sqlite.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 5037ea6..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/sqlite.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,834 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This header file defines the interface that the STQLite library
-** presents to client programs.
-**
-** @(#) $Id: sqlite.h.in,v 1.59 2004/02/25 22:51:06 rdc Exp $
-*/
-#ifndef _STQLITE_H_
-#define _STQLITE_H_
-#include <stdarg.h> /* Needed for the definition of va_list */
-
-/*
-** Make sure we can call this stuff from C++.
-*/
-#ifdef __cplusplus
-extern "C" {
-#endif
-
-/*
-** The version of the STQLite library.
-*/
-#define STQLITE_VERSION "2.8.13"
-
-/*
-** The version string is also compiled into the library so that a program
-** can check to make sure that the lib*.a file and the *.h file are from
-** the same version.
-*/
-extern const char sqlite_version[];
-
-/*
-** The STQLITE_UTF8 macro is defined if the library expects to see
-** UTF-8 encoded data. The STQLITE_ISO8859 macro is defined if the
-** iso8859 encoded should be used.
-*/
-#define STQLITE_ISO8859 1
-
-/*
-** The following constant holds one of two strings, "UTF-8" or "iso8859",
-** depending on which character encoding the STQLite library expects to
-** see. The character encoding makes a difference for the LIKE and GLOB
-** operators and for the LENGTH() and SUBSTR() functions.
-*/
-extern const char sqlite_encoding[];
-
-/*
-** Each open sqlite database is represented by an instance of the
-** following opaque structure.
-*/
-typedef struct sqlite sqlite;
-
-/*
-** A function to open a new sqlite database.
-**
-** If the database does not exist and mode indicates write
-** permission, then a new database is created. If the database
-** does not exist and mode does not indicate write permission,
-** then the open fails, an error message generated (if errmsg!=0)
-** and the function returns 0.
-**
-** If mode does not indicates user write permission, then the
-** database is opened read-only.
-**
-** The Truth: As currently implemented, all databases are opened
-** for writing all the time. Maybe someday we will provide the
-** ability to open a database readonly. The mode parameters is
-** provided in anticipation of that enhancement.
-*/
-sqlite *sqlite_open(const char *filename, int mode, char **errmsg);
-
-/*
-** A function to close the database.
-**
-** Call this function with a pointer to a structure that was previously
-** returned from sqlite_open() and the corresponding database will by closed.
-*/
-void sqlite_close(sqlite *);
-
-/*
-** The type for a callback function.
-*/
-typedef int (*sqlite_callback)(void*,int,char**, char**);
-
-/*
-** A function to executes one or more statements of SQL.
-**
-** If one or more of the SQL statements are queries, then
-** the callback function specified by the 3rd parameter is
-** invoked once for each row of the query result. This callback
-** should normally return 0. If the callback returns a non-zero
-** value then the query is aborted, all subsequent SQL statements
-** are skipped and the sqlite_exec() function returns the STQLITE_ABORT.
-**
-** The 4th parameter is an arbitrary pointer that is passed
-** to the callback function as its first parameter.
-**
-** The 2nd parameter to the callback function is the number of
-** columns in the query result. The 3rd parameter to the callback
-** is an array of strings holding the values for each column.
-** The 4th parameter to the callback is an array of strings holding
-** the names of each column.
-**
-** The callback function may be NULL, even for queries. A NULL
-** callback is not an error. It just means that no callback
-** will be invoked.
-**
-** If an error occurs while parsing or evaluating the SQL (but
-** not while executing the callback) then an appropriate error
-** message is written into memory obtained from malloc() and
-** *errmsg is made to point to that message. The calling function
-** is responsible for freeing the memory that holds the error
-** message. Use sqlite_freemem() for this. If errmsg==NULL,
-** then no error message is ever written.
-**
-** The return value is is STQLITE_OK if there are no errors and
-** some other return code if there is an error. The particular
-** return value depends on the type of error.
-**
-** If the query could not be executed because a database file is
-** locked or busy, then this function returns STQLITE_BUSY. (This
-** behavior can be modified somewhat using the sqlite_busy_handler()
-** and sqlite_busy_timeout() functions below.)
-*/
-int sqlite_exec(
- sqlite*, /* An open database */
- const char *sql, /* SQL to be executed */
- sqlite_callback, /* Callback function */
- void *, /* 1st argument to callback function */
- char **errmsg /* Error msg written here */
-);
-
-/*
-** Return values for sqlite_exec() and sqlite_step()
-*/
-#define STQLITE_OK 0 /* Successful result */
-#define STQLITE_ERROR 1 /* SQL error or missing database */
-#define STQLITE_INTERNAL 2 /* An internal logic error in STQLite */
-#define STQLITE_PERM 3 /* Access permission denied */
-#define STQLITE_ABORT 4 /* Callback routine requested an abort */
-#define STQLITE_BUSY 5 /* The database file is locked */
-#define STQLITE_LOCKED 6 /* A table in the database is locked */
-#define STQLITE_NOMEM 7 /* A malloc() failed */
-#define STQLITE_READONLY 8 /* Attempt to write a readonly database */
-#define STQLITE_INTERRUPT 9 /* Operation terminated by sqlite_interrupt() */
-#define STQLITE_IOERR 10 /* Some kind of disk I/O error occurred */
-#define STQLITE_CORRUPT 11 /* The database disk image is malformed */
-#define STQLITE_NOTFOUND 12 /* (Internal Only) Table or record not found */
-#define STQLITE_FULL 13 /* Insertion failed because database is full */
-#define STQLITE_CANTOPEN 14 /* Unable to open the database file */
-#define STQLITE_PROTOCOL 15 /* Database lock protocol error */
-#define STQLITE_EMPTY 16 /* (Internal Only) Database table is empty */
-#define STQLITE_SCHEMA 17 /* The database schema changed */
-#define STQLITE_TOOBIG 18 /* Too much data for one row of a table */
-#define STQLITE_CONSTRAINT 19 /* Abort due to contraint violation */
-#define STQLITE_MISMATCH 20 /* Data type mismatch */
-#define STQLITE_MISUSE 21 /* Library used incorrectly */
-#define STQLITE_NOLFS 22 /* Uses OS features not supported on host */
-#define STQLITE_AUTH 23 /* Authorization denied */
-#define STQLITE_FORMAT 24 /* Auxiliary database format error */
-#define STQLITE_RANGE 25 /* 2nd parameter to sqlite_bind out of range */
-#define STQLITE_NOTADB 26 /* File opened that is not a database file */
-#define STQLITE_ROW 100 /* sqlite_step() has another row ready */
-#define STQLITE_DONE 101 /* sqlite_step() has finished executing */
-
-/*
-** Each entry in an STQLite table has a unique integer key. (The key is
-** the value of the INTEGER PRIMARY KEY column if there is such a column,
-** otherwise the key is generated at random. The unique key is always
-** available as the ROWID, OID, or _ROWID_ column.) The following routine
-** returns the integer key of the most recent insert in the database.
-**
-** This function is similar to the mysql_insert_id() function from MySQL.
-*/
-int sqlite_last_insert_rowid(sqlite*);
-
-/*
-** This function returns the number of database rows that were changed
-** (or inserted or deleted) by the most recent called sqlite_exec().
-**
-** All changes are counted, even if they were later undone by a
-** ROLLBACK or ABORT. Except, changes associated with creating and
-** dropping tables are not counted.
-**
-** If a callback invokes sqlite_exec() recursively, then the changes
-** in the inner, recursive call are counted together with the changes
-** in the outer call.
-**
-** STQLite implements the command "DELETE FROM table" without a WHERE clause
-** by dropping and recreating the table. (This is much faster than going
-** through and deleting individual elements form the table.) Because of
-** this optimization, the change count for "DELETE FROM table" will be
-** zero regardless of the number of elements that were originally in the
-** table. To get an accurate count of the number of rows deleted, use
-** "DELETE FROM table WHERE 1" instead.
-*/
-int sqlite_changes(sqlite*);
-
-/*
-** This function returns the number of database rows that were changed
-** by the last INSERT, UPDATE, or DELETE statment executed by sqlite_exec(),
-** or by the last VM to run to completion. The change count is not updated
-** by SQL statements other than INSERT, UPDATE or DELETE.
-**
-** Changes are counted, even if they are later undone by a ROLLBACK or
-** ABORT. Changes associated with trigger programs that execute as a
-** result of the INSERT, UPDATE, or DELETE statement are not counted.
-**
-** If a callback invokes sqlite_exec() recursively, then the changes
-** in the inner, recursive call are counted together with the changes
-** in the outer call.
-**
-** STQLite implements the command "DELETE FROM table" without a WHERE clause
-** by dropping and recreating the table. (This is much faster than going
-** through and deleting individual elements form the table.) Because of
-** this optimization, the change count for "DELETE FROM table" will be
-** zero regardless of the number of elements that were originally in the
-** table. To get an accurate count of the number of rows deleted, use
-** "DELETE FROM table WHERE 1" instead.
-**
-******* THIS IS AN EXPERIMENTAL API AND IS SUBJECT TO CHANGE ******
-*/
-int sqlite_last_statement_changes(sqlite*);
-
-/* If the parameter to this routine is one of the return value constants
-** defined above, then this routine returns a constant text string which
-** descripts (in English) the meaning of the return value.
-*/
-const char *sqlite_error_string(int);
-#define sqliteErrStr sqlite_error_string /* Legacy. Do not use in new code. */
-
-/* This function causes any pending database operation to abort and
-** return at its earliest opportunity. This routine is typically
-** called in response to a user action such as pressing "Cancel"
-** or Ctrl-C where the user wants a long query operation to halt
-** immediately.
-*/
-void sqlite_interrupt(sqlite*);
-
-
-/* This function returns true if the given input string comprises
-** one or more complete SQL statements.
-**
-** The algorithm is simple. If the last token other than spaces
-** and comments is a semicolon, then return true. otherwise return
-** false.
-*/
-int sqlite_complete(const char *sql);
-
-/*
-** This routine identifies a callback function that is invoked
-** whenever an attempt is made to open a database table that is
-** currently locked by another process or thread. If the busy callback
-** is NULL, then sqlite_exec() returns STQLITE_BUSY immediately if
-** it finds a locked table. If the busy callback is not NULL, then
-** sqlite_exec() invokes the callback with three arguments. The
-** second argument is the name of the locked table and the third
-** argument is the number of times the table has been busy. If the
-** busy callback returns 0, then sqlite_exec() immediately returns
-** STQLITE_BUSY. If the callback returns non-zero, then sqlite_exec()
-** tries to open the table again and the cycle repeats.
-**
-** The default busy callback is NULL.
-**
-** Sqlite is re-entrant, so the busy handler may start a new query.
-** (It is not clear why anyone would every want to do this, but it
-** is allowed, in theory.) But the busy handler may not close the
-** database. Closing the database from a busy handler will delete
-** data structures out from under the executing query and will
-** probably result in a coredump.
-*/
-void sqlite_busy_handler(sqlite*, int(*)(void*,const char*,int), void*);
-
-/*
-** This routine sets a busy handler that sleeps for a while when a
-** table is locked. The handler will sleep multiple times until
-** at least "ms" milleseconds of sleeping have been done. After
-** "ms" milleseconds of sleeping, the handler returns 0 which
-** causes sqlite_exec() to return STQLITE_BUSY.
-**
-** Calling this routine with an argument less than or equal to zero
-** turns off all busy handlers.
-*/
-void sqlite_busy_timeout(sqlite*, int ms);
-
-/*
-** This next routine is really just a wrapper around sqlite_exec().
-** Instead of invoking a user-supplied callback for each row of the
-** result, this routine remembers each row of the result in memory
-** obtained from malloc(), then returns all of the result after the
-** query has finished.
-**
-** As an example, suppose the query result where this table:
-**
-** Name | Age
-** -----------------------
-** Alice | 43
-** Bob | 28
-** Cindy | 21
-**
-** If the 3rd argument were &azResult then after the function returns
-** azResult will contain the following data:
-**
-** azResult[0] = "Name";
-** azResult[1] = "Age";
-** azResult[2] = "Alice";
-** azResult[3] = "43";
-** azResult[4] = "Bob";
-** azResult[5] = "28";
-** azResult[6] = "Cindy";
-** azResult[7] = "21";
-**
-** Notice that there is an extra row of data containing the column
-** headers. But the *nrow return value is still 3. *ncolumn is
-** set to 2. In general, the number of values inserted into azResult
-** will be ((*nrow) + 1)*(*ncolumn).
-**
-** After the calling function has finished using the result, it should
-** pass the result data pointer to sqlite_free_table() in order to
-** release the memory that was malloc-ed. Because of the way the
-** malloc() happens, the calling function must not try to call
-** malloc() directly. Only sqlite_free_table() is able to release
-** the memory properly and safely.
-**
-** The return value of this routine is the same as from sqlite_exec().
-*/
-int sqlite_get_table(
- sqlite*, /* An open database */
- const char *sql, /* SQL to be executed */
- char ***resultp, /* Result written to a char *[] that this points to */
- int *nrow, /* Number of result rows written here */
- int *ncolumn, /* Number of result columns written here */
- char **errmsg /* Error msg written here */
-);
-
-/*
-** Call this routine to free the memory that sqlite_get_table() allocated.
-*/
-void sqlite_free_table(char **result);
-
-/*
-** The following routines are wrappers around sqlite_exec() and
-** sqlite_get_table(). The only difference between the routines that
-** follow and the originals is that the second argument to the
-** routines that follow is really a printf()-style format
-** string describing the SQL to be executed. Arguments to the format
-** string appear at the end of the argument list.
-**
-** All of the usual printf formatting options apply. In addition, there
-** is a "%q" option. %q works like %s in that it substitutes a null-terminated
-** string from the argument list. But %q also doubles every '\'' character.
-** %q is designed for use inside a string literal. By doubling each '\''
-** character it escapes that character and allows it to be inserted into
-** the string.
-**
-** For example, so some string variable contains text as follows:
-**
-** char *zText = "It's a happy day!";
-**
-** We can use this text in an SQL statement as follows:
-**
-** sqlite_exec_printf(db, "INSERT INTO table VALUES('%q')",
-** callback1, 0, 0, zText);
-**
-** Because the %q format string is used, the '\'' character in zText
-** is escaped and the SQL generated is as follows:
-**
-** INSERT INTO table1 VALUES('It''s a happy day!')
-**
-** This is correct. Had we used %s instead of %q, the generated SQL
-** would have looked like this:
-**
-** INSERT INTO table1 VALUES('It's a happy day!');
-**
-** This second example is an SQL syntax error. As a general rule you
-** should always use %q instead of %s when inserting text into a string
-** literal.
-*/
-int sqlite_exec_printf(
- sqlite*, /* An open database */
- const char *sqlFormat, /* printf-style format string for the SQL */
- sqlite_callback, /* Callback function */
- void *, /* 1st argument to callback function */
- char **errmsg, /* Error msg written here */
- ... /* Arguments to the format string. */
-);
-int sqlite_exec_vprintf(
- sqlite*, /* An open database */
- const char *sqlFormat, /* printf-style format string for the SQL */
- sqlite_callback, /* Callback function */
- void *, /* 1st argument to callback function */
- char **errmsg, /* Error msg written here */
- va_list ap /* Arguments to the format string. */
-);
-int sqlite_get_table_printf(
- sqlite*, /* An open database */
- const char *sqlFormat, /* printf-style format string for the SQL */
- char ***resultp, /* Result written to a char *[] that this points to */
- int *nrow, /* Number of result rows written here */
- int *ncolumn, /* Number of result columns written here */
- char **errmsg, /* Error msg written here */
- ... /* Arguments to the format string */
-);
-int sqlite_get_table_vprintf(
- sqlite*, /* An open database */
- const char *sqlFormat, /* printf-style format string for the SQL */
- char ***resultp, /* Result written to a char *[] that this points to */
- int *nrow, /* Number of result rows written here */
- int *ncolumn, /* Number of result columns written here */
- char **errmsg, /* Error msg written here */
- va_list ap /* Arguments to the format string */
-);
-char *sqlite_mprintf(const char*,...);
-char *sqlite_vmprintf(const char*, va_list);
-
-/*
-** Windows systems should call this routine to free memory that
-** is returned in the in the errmsg parameter of sqlite_open() when
-** STQLite is a DLL. For some reason, it does not work to call free()
-** directly.
-*/
-void sqlite_freemem(void *p);
-
-/*
-** Windows systems need functions to call to return the sqlite_version
-** and sqlite_encoding strings.
-*/
-const char *sqlite_libversion(void);
-const char *sqlite_libencoding(void);
-
-/*
-** A pointer to the following structure is used to communicate with
-** the implementations of user-defined functions.
-*/
-typedef struct sqlite_func sqlite_func;
-
-/*
-** Use the following routines to create new user-defined functions. See
-** the documentation for details.
-*/
-int sqlite_create_function(
- sqlite*, /* Database where the new function is registered */
- const char *zName, /* Name of the new function */
- int nArg, /* Number of arguments. -1 means any number */
- void (*xFunc)(sqlite_func*,int,const char**), /* C code to implement */
- void *pUserData /* Available via the sqlite_user_data() call */
-);
-int sqlite_create_aggregate(
- sqlite*, /* Database where the new function is registered */
- const char *zName, /* Name of the function */
- int nArg, /* Number of arguments */
- void (*xStep)(sqlite_func*,int,const char**), /* Called for each row */
- void (*xFinalize)(sqlite_func*), /* Called once to get final result */
- void *pUserData /* Available via the sqlite_user_data() call */
-);
-
-/*
-** Use the following routine to define the datatype returned by a
-** user-defined function. The second argument can be one of the
-** constants STQLITE_NUMERIC, STQLITE_TEXT, or STQLITE_ARGS or it
-** can be an integer greater than or equal to zero. When the datatype
-** parameter is non-negative, the type of the result will be the
-** same as the datatype-th argument. If datatype==STQLITE_NUMERIC
-** then the result is always numeric. If datatype==STQLITE_TEXT then
-** the result is always text. If datatype==STQLITE_ARGS then the result
-** is numeric if any argument is numeric and is text otherwise.
-*/
-int sqlite_function_type(
- sqlite *db, /* The database there the function is registered */
- const char *zName, /* Name of the function */
- int datatype /* The datatype for this function */
-);
-#define STQLITE_NUMERIC (-1)
-#define STQLITE_TEXT (-2)
-#define STQLITE_ARGS (-3)
-
-/*
-** The user function implementations call one of the following four routines
-** in order to return their results. The first parameter to each of these
-** routines is a copy of the first argument to xFunc() or xFinialize().
-** The second parameter to these routines is the result to be returned.
-** A NULL can be passed as the second parameter to sqlite_set_result_string()
-** in order to return a NULL result.
-**
-** The 3rd argument to _string and _error is the number of characters to
-** take from the string. If this argument is negative, then all characters
-** up to and including the first '\000' are used.
-**
-** The sqlite_set_result_string() function allocates a buffer to hold the
-** result and returns a pointer to this buffer. The calling routine
-** (that is, the implmentation of a user function) can alter the content
-** of this buffer if desired.
-*/
-char *sqlite_set_result_string(sqlite_func*,const char*,int);
-void sqlite_set_result_int(sqlite_func*,int);
-void sqlite_set_result_double(sqlite_func*,double);
-void sqlite_set_result_error(sqlite_func*,const char*,int);
-
-/*
-** The pUserData parameter to the sqlite_create_function() and
-** sqlite_create_aggregate() routines used to register user functions
-** is available to the implementation of the function using this
-** call.
-*/
-void *sqlite_user_data(sqlite_func*);
-
-/*
-** Aggregate functions use the following routine to allocate
-** a structure for storing their state. The first time this routine
-** is called for a particular aggregate, a new structure of size nBytes
-** is allocated, zeroed, and returned. On subsequent calls (for the
-** same aggregate instance) the same buffer is returned. The implementation
-** of the aggregate can use the returned buffer to accumulate data.
-**
-** The buffer allocated is freed automatically be STQLite.
-*/
-void *sqlite_aggregate_context(sqlite_func*, int nBytes);
-
-/*
-** The next routine returns the number of calls to xStep for a particular
-** aggregate function instance. The current call to xStep counts so this
-** routine always returns at least 1.
-*/
-int sqlite_aggregate_count(sqlite_func*);
-
-/*
-** This routine registers a callback with the STQLite library. The
-** callback is invoked (at compile-time, not at run-time) for each
-** attempt to access a column of a table in the database. The callback
-** returns STQLITE_OK if access is allowed, STQLITE_DENY if the entire
-** SQL statement should be aborted with an error and STQLITE_IGNORE
-** if the column should be treated as a NULL value.
-*/
-int sqlite_set_authorizer(
- sqlite*,
- int (*xAuth)(void*,int,const char*,const char*,const char*,const char*),
- void *pUserData
-);
-
-/*
-** The second parameter to the access authorization function above will
-** be one of the values below. These values signify what kind of operation
-** is to be authorized. The 3rd and 4th parameters to the authorization
-** function will be parameters or NULL depending on which of the following
-** codes is used as the second parameter. The 5th parameter is the name
-** of the database ("main", "temp", etc.) if applicable. The 6th parameter
-** is the name of the inner-most trigger or view that is responsible for
-** the access attempt or NULL if this access attempt is directly from
-** input SQL code.
-**
-** Arg-3 Arg-4
-*/
-#define STQLITE_COPY 0 /* Table Name File Name */
-#define STQLITE_CREATE_INDEX 1 /* Index Name Table Name */
-#define STQLITE_CREATE_TABLE 2 /* Table Name NULL */
-#define STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_INDEX 3 /* Index Name Table Name */
-#define STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_TABLE 4 /* Table Name NULL */
-#define STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_TRIGGER 5 /* Trigger Name Table Name */
-#define STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_VIEW 6 /* View Name NULL */
-#define STQLITE_CREATE_TRIGGER 7 /* Trigger Name Table Name */
-#define STQLITE_CREATE_VIEW 8 /* View Name NULL */
-#define STQLITE_DELETE 9 /* Table Name NULL */
-#define STQLITE_DROP_INDEX 10 /* Index Name Table Name */
-#define STQLITE_DROP_TABLE 11 /* Table Name NULL */
-#define STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_INDEX 12 /* Index Name Table Name */
-#define STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_TABLE 13 /* Table Name NULL */
-#define STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_TRIGGER 14 /* Trigger Name Table Name */
-#define STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_VIEW 15 /* View Name NULL */
-#define STQLITE_DROP_TRIGGER 16 /* Trigger Name Table Name */
-#define STQLITE_DROP_VIEW 17 /* View Name NULL */
-#define STQLITE_INSERT 18 /* Table Name NULL */
-#define STQLITE_PRAGMA 19 /* Pragma Name 1st arg or NULL */
-#define STQLITE_READ 20 /* Table Name Column Name */
-#define STQLITE_SELECT 21 /* NULL NULL */
-#define STQLITE_TRANSACTION 22 /* NULL NULL */
-#define STQLITE_UPDATE 23 /* Table Name Column Name */
-#define STQLITE_ATTACH 24 /* Filename NULL */
-#define STQLITE_DETACH 25 /* Database Name NULL */
-
-
-/*
-** The return value of the authorization function should be one of the
-** following constants:
-*/
-/* #define STQLITE_OK 0 // Allow access (This is actually defined above) */
-#define STQLITE_DENY 1 /* Abort the SQL statement with an error */
-#define STQLITE_IGNORE 2 /* Don't allow access, but don't generate an error */
-
-/*
-** Register a function that is called at every invocation of sqlite_exec()
-** or sqlite_compile(). This function can be used (for example) to generate
-** a log file of all SQL executed against a database.
-*/
-void *sqlite_trace(sqlite*, void(*xTrace)(void*,const char*), void*);
-
-/*** The Callback-Free API
-**
-** The following routines implement a new way to access STQLite that does not
-** involve the use of callbacks.
-**
-** An sqlite_vm is an opaque object that represents a single SQL statement
-** that is ready to be executed.
-*/
-typedef struct sqlite_vm sqlite_vm;
-
-/*
-** To execute an STQLite query without the use of callbacks, you first have
-** to compile the SQL using this routine. The 1st parameter "db" is a pointer
-** to an sqlite object obtained from sqlite_open(). The 2nd parameter
-** "zSql" is the text of the SQL to be compiled. The remaining parameters
-** are all outputs.
-**
-** *pzTail is made to point to the first character past the end of the first
-** SQL statement in zSql. This routine only compiles the first statement
-** in zSql, so *pzTail is left pointing to what remains uncompiled.
-**
-** *ppVm is left pointing to a "virtual machine" that can be used to execute
-** the compiled statement. Or if there is an error, *ppVm may be set to NULL.
-** If the input text contained no SQL (if the input is and empty string or
-** a comment) then *ppVm is set to NULL.
-**
-** If any errors are detected during compilation, an error message is written
-** into space obtained from malloc() and *pzErrMsg is made to point to that
-** error message. The calling routine is responsible for freeing the text
-** of this message when it has finished with it. Use sqlite_freemem() to
-** free the message. pzErrMsg may be NULL in which case no error message
-** will be generated.
-**
-** On success, STQLITE_OK is returned. Otherwise and error code is returned.
-*/
-int sqlite_compile(
- sqlite *db, /* The open database */
- const char *zSql, /* SQL statement to be compiled */
- const char **pzTail, /* OUT: uncompiled tail of zSql */
- sqlite_vm **ppVm, /* OUT: the virtual machine to execute zSql */
- char **pzErrmsg /* OUT: Error message. */
-);
-
-/*
-** After an SQL statement has been compiled, it is handed to this routine
-** to be executed. This routine executes the statement as far as it can
-** go then returns. The return value will be one of STQLITE_DONE,
-** STQLITE_ERROR, STQLITE_BUSY, STQLITE_ROW, or STQLITE_MISUSE.
-**
-** STQLITE_DONE means that the execute of the SQL statement is complete
-** an no errors have occurred. sqlite_step() should not be called again
-** for the same virtual machine. *pN is set to the number of columns in
-** the result set and *pazColName is set to an array of strings that
-** describe the column names and datatypes. The name of the i-th column
-** is (*pazColName)[i] and the datatype of the i-th column is
-** (*pazColName)[i+*pN]. *pazValue is set to NULL.
-**
-** STQLITE_ERROR means that the virtual machine encountered a run-time
-** error. sqlite_step() should not be called again for the same
-** virtual machine. *pN is set to 0 and *pazColName and *pazValue are set
-** to NULL. Use sqlite_finalize() to obtain the specific error code
-** and the error message text for the error.
-**
-** STQLITE_BUSY means that an attempt to open the database failed because
-** another thread or process is holding a lock. The calling routine
-** can try again to open the database by calling sqlite_step() again.
-** The return code will only be STQLITE_BUSY if no busy handler is registered
-** using the sqlite_busy_handler() or sqlite_busy_timeout() routines. If
-** a busy handler callback has been registered but returns 0, then this
-** routine will return STQLITE_ERROR and sqltie_finalize() will return
-** STQLITE_BUSY when it is called.
-**
-** STQLITE_ROW means that a single row of the result is now available.
-** The data is contained in *pazValue. The value of the i-th column is
-** (*azValue)[i]. *pN and *pazColName are set as described in STQLITE_DONE.
-** Invoke sqlite_step() again to advance to the next row.
-**
-** STQLITE_MISUSE is returned if sqlite_step() is called incorrectly.
-** For example, if you call sqlite_step() after the virtual machine
-** has halted (after a prior call to sqlite_step() has returned STQLITE_DONE)
-** or if you call sqlite_step() with an incorrectly initialized virtual
-** machine or a virtual machine that has been deleted or that is associated
-** with an sqlite structure that has been closed.
-*/
-int sqlite_step(
- sqlite_vm *pVm, /* The virtual machine to execute */
- int *pN, /* OUT: Number of columns in result */
- const char ***pazValue, /* OUT: Column data */
- const char ***pazColName /* OUT: Column names and datatypes */
-);
-
-/*
-** This routine is called to delete a virtual machine after it has finished
-** executing. The return value is the result code. STQLITE_OK is returned
-** if the statement executed successfully and some other value is returned if
-** there was any kind of error. If an error occurred and pzErrMsg is not
-** NULL, then an error message is written into memory obtained from malloc()
-** and *pzErrMsg is made to point to that error message. The calling routine
-** should use sqlite_freemem() to delete this message when it has finished
-** with it.
-**
-** This routine can be called at any point during the execution of the
-** virtual machine. If the virtual machine has not completed execution
-** when this routine is called, that is like encountering an error or
-** an interrupt. (See sqlite_interrupt().) Incomplete updates may be
-** rolled back and transactions cancelled, depending on the circumstances,
-** and the result code returned will be STQLITE_ABORT.
-*/
-int sqlite_finalize(sqlite_vm*, char **pzErrMsg);
-
-/*
-** This routine deletes the virtual machine, writes any error message to
-** *pzErrMsg and returns an STQLite return code in the same way as the
-** sqlite_finalize() function.
-**
-** Additionally, if ppVm is not NULL, *ppVm is left pointing to a new virtual
-** machine loaded with the compiled version of the original query ready for
-** execution.
-**
-** If sqlite_reset() returns STQLITE_SCHEMA, then *ppVm is set to NULL.
-**
-******* THIS IS AN EXPERIMENTAL API AND IS SUBJECT TO CHANGE ******
-*/
-int sqlite_reset(sqlite_vm*, char **pzErrMsg);
-
-/*
-** If the SQL that was handed to sqlite_compile contains variables that
-** are represeted in the SQL text by a question mark ('?'). This routine
-** is used to assign values to those variables.
-**
-** The first parameter is a virtual machine obtained from sqlite_compile().
-** The 2nd "idx" parameter determines which variable in the SQL statement
-** to bind the value to. The left most '?' is 1. The 3rd parameter is
-** the value to assign to that variable. The 4th parameter is the number
-** of bytes in the value, including the terminating \000 for strings.
-** Finally, the 5th "copy" parameter is TRUE if STQLite should make its
-** own private copy of this value, or false if the space that the 3rd
-** parameter points to will be unchanging and can be used directly by
-** STQLite.
-**
-** Unbound variables are treated as having a value of NULL. To explicitly
-** set a variable to NULL, call this routine with the 3rd parameter as a
-** NULL pointer.
-**
-** If the 4th "len" parameter is -1, then strlen() is used to find the
-** length.
-**
-** This routine can only be called immediately after sqlite_compile()
-** or sqlite_reset() and before any calls to sqlite_step().
-**
-******* THIS IS AN EXPERIMENTAL API AND IS SUBJECT TO CHANGE ******
-*/
-int sqlite_bind(sqlite_vm*, int idx, const char *value, int len, int copy);
-
-/*
-** This routine configures a callback function - the progress callback - that
-** is invoked periodically during long running calls to sqlite_exec(),
-** sqlite_step() and sqlite_get_table(). An example use for this API is to keep
-** a GUI updated during a large query.
-**
-** The progress callback is invoked once for every N virtual machine opcodes,
-** where N is the second argument to this function. The progress callback
-** itself is identified by the third argument to this function. The fourth
-** argument to this function is a void pointer passed to the progress callback
-** function each time it is invoked.
-**
-** If a call to sqlite_exec(), sqlite_step() or sqlite_get_table() results
-** in less than N opcodes being executed, then the progress callback is not
-** invoked.
-**
-** Calling this routine overwrites any previously installed progress callback.
-** To remove the progress callback altogether, pass NULL as the third
-** argument to this function.
-**
-** If the progress callback returns a result other than 0, then the current
-** query is immediately terminated and any database changes rolled back. If the
-** query was part of a larger transaction, then the transaction is not rolled
-** back and remains active. The sqlite_exec() call returns STQLITE_ABORT.
-**
-******* THIS IS AN EXPERIMENTAL API AND IS SUBJECT TO CHANGE ******
-*/
-void sqlite_progress_handler(sqlite*, int, int(*)(void*), void*);
-
-/*
-** Register a callback function to be invoked whenever a new transaction
-** is committed. The pArg argument is passed through to the callback.
-** callback. If the callback function returns non-zero, then the commit
-** is converted into a rollback.
-**
-** If another function was previously registered, its pArg value is returned.
-** Otherwise NULL is returned.
-**
-** Registering a NULL function disables the callback.
-**
-******* THIS IS AN EXPERIMENTAL API AND IS SUBJECT TO CHANGE ******
-*/
-void *sqlite_commit_hook(sqlite*, int(*)(void*), void*);
-
-/*
-** Open an encrypted STQLite database. If pKey==0 or nKey==0, this routine
-** is the same as sqlite_open().
-**
-** The code to implement this API is not available in the public release
-** of STQLite.
-*/
-sqlite *sqlite_open_encrypted(
- const char *zFilename, /* Name of the encrypted database */
- const void *pKey, /* Pointer to the key */
- int nKey, /* Number of bytes in the key */
- int *pErrcode, /* Write error code here */
- char **pzErrmsg /* Write error message here */
-);
-
-/*
-** Change the key on an open database. If the current database is not
-** encrypted, this routine will encrypt it. If pNew==0 or nNew==0, the
-** database is decrypted.
-**
-** The code to implement this API is not available in the public release
-** of STQLite.
-*/
-int sqlite_rekey(
- sqlite *db, /* Database to be rekeyed */
- const void *pKey, int nKey /* The new key */
-);
-
-#ifdef __cplusplus
-} /* End of the 'extern "C"' block */
-#endif
-
-#endif /* _STQLITE_H_ */
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/sqliteInt.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/sqliteInt.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 3f713cd..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/sqliteInt.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1266 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** Internal interface definitions for STQLite.
-**
-** @(#) $Id: sqliteInt.h,v 1.220 2004/02/25 13:47:33 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "config.h"
-#include "sqlite.h"
-#include "hash.h"
-#include "parse.h"
-#include "btree.h"
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-#include <assert.h>
-
-/*
-** The maximum number of in-memory pages to use for the main database
-** table and for temporary tables.
-*/
-#define MAX_PAGES 2000
-#define TEMP_PAGES 500
-
-/*
-** If the following macro is set to 1, then NULL values are considered
-** distinct for the SELECT DISTINCT statement and for UNION or EXCEPT
-** compound queries. No other SQL database engine (among those tested)
-** works this way except for OCELOT. But the SQL92 spec implies that
-** this is how things should work.
-**
-** If the following macro is set to 0, then NULLs are indistinct for
-** SELECT DISTINCT and for UNION.
-*/
-#define NULL_ALWAYS_DISTINCT 0
-
-/*
-** If the following macro is set to 1, then NULL values are considered
-** distinct when determining whether or not two entries are the same
-** in a UNITQUE index. This is the way PostgreSQL, Oracle, DB2, MySQL,
-** OCELOT, and Firebird all work. The SQL92 spec explicitly says this
-** is the way things are suppose to work.
-**
-** If the following macro is set to 0, the NULLs are indistinct for
-** a UNITQUE index. In this mode, you can only have a single NULL entry
-** for a column declared UNITQUE. This is the way Informix and SQL Server
-** work.
-*/
-#define NULL_DISTINCT_FOR_UNITQUE 1
-
-/*
-** The maximum number of attached databases. This must be at least 2
-** in order to support the main database file (0) and the file used to
-** hold temporary tables (1). And it must be less than 256 because
-** an unsigned character is used to stored the database index.
-*/
-#define MAX_ATTACHED 10
-
-/*
-** The next macro is used to determine where TEMP tables and indices
-** are stored. Possible values:
-**
-** 0 Always use a temporary files
-** 1 Use a file unless overridden by "PRAGMA temp_store"
-** 2 Use memory unless overridden by "PRAGMA temp_store"
-** 3 Always use memory
-*/
-#ifndef TEMP_STORE
-# define TEMP_STORE 1
-#endif
-
-/*
-** When building STQLite for embedded systems where memory is scarce,
-** you can define one or more of the following macros to omit extra
-** features of the library and thus keep the size of the library to
-** a minimum.
-*/
-/* #define STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION 1 */
-/* #define STQLITE_OMIT_INMEMORYDB 1 */
-/* #define STQLITE_OMIT_VACUUM 1 */
-/* #define STQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS 1 */
-/* #define STQLITE_OMIT_PROGRESS_CALLBACK 1 */
-
-/*
-** Integers of known sizes. These typedefs might change for architectures
-** where the sizes very. Preprocessor macros are available so that the
-** types can be conveniently redefined at compile-type. Like this:
-**
-** cc '-DUINTPTR_TYPE=long long int' ...
-*/
-#ifndef UINT32_TYPE
-# define UINT32_TYPE unsigned int
-#endif
-#ifndef UINT16_TYPE
-# define UINT16_TYPE unsigned short int
-#endif
-#ifndef UINT8_TYPE
-# define UINT8_TYPE unsigned char
-#endif
-#ifndef INT8_TYPE
-# define INT8_TYPE signed char
-#endif
-#ifndef INTPTR_TYPE
-# if STQLITE_PTR_SZ==4
-# define INTPTR_TYPE int
-# else
-# define INTPTR_TYPE long long
-# endif
-#endif
-typedef UINT32_TYPE u32; /* 4-byte unsigned integer */
-typedef UINT16_TYPE u16; /* 2-byte unsigned integer */
-typedef UINT8_TYPE u8; /* 1-byte unsigned integer */
-typedef UINT8_TYPE i8; /* 1-byte signed integer */
-typedef INTPTR_TYPE ptr; /* Big enough to hold a pointer */
-typedef unsigned INTPTR_TYPE uptr; /* Big enough to hold a pointer */
-
-/*
-** Defer sourcing vdbe.h until after the "u8" typedef is defined.
-*/
-#include "vdbe.h"
-
-/*
-** Most C compilers these days recognize "long double", don't they?
-** Just in case we encounter one that does not, we will create a macro
-** for long double so that it can be easily changed to just "double".
-*/
-#ifndef LONGDOUBLE_TYPE
-# define LONGDOUBLE_TYPE long double
-#endif
-
-/*
-** This macro casts a pointer to an integer. Useful for doing
-** pointer arithmetic.
-*/
-#define Addr(X) ((uptr)X)
-
-/*
-** The maximum number of bytes of data that can be put into a single
-** row of a single table. The upper bound on this limit is 16777215
-** bytes (or 16MB-1). We have arbitrarily set the limit to just 1MB
-** here because the overflow page chain is inefficient for really big
-** records and we want to discourage people from thinking that
-** multi-megabyte records are OK. If your needs are different, you can
-** change this define and recompile to increase or decrease the record
-** size.
-**
-** The 16777198 is computed as follows: 238 bytes of payload on the
-** original pages plus 16448 overflow pages each holding 1020 bytes of
-** data.
-*/
-#define MAX_BYTES_PER_ROW 1048576
-/* #define MAX_BYTES_PER_ROW 16777198 */
-
-/*
-** If memory allocation problems are found, recompile with
-**
-** -DMEMORY_DEBUG=1
-**
-** to enable some sanity checking on malloc() and free(). To
-** check for memory leaks, recompile with
-**
-** -DMEMORY_DEBUG=2
-**
-** and a line of text will be written to standard error for
-** each malloc() and free(). This output can be analyzed
-** by an AWK script to determine if there are any leaks.
-*/
-#ifdef MEMORY_DEBUG
-# define sqliteMalloc(X) sqliteMalloc_(X,1,__FILE__,__LINE__)
-# define sqliteMallocRaw(X) sqliteMalloc_(X,0,__FILE__,__LINE__)
-# define sqliteFree(X) sqliteFree_(X,__FILE__,__LINE__)
-# define sqliteRealloc(X,Y) sqliteRealloc_(X,Y,__FILE__,__LINE__)
-# define sqliteStrDup(X) sqliteStrDup_(X,__FILE__,__LINE__)
-# define sqliteStrNDup(X,Y) sqliteStrNDup_(X,Y,__FILE__,__LINE__)
- void sqliteStrRealloc(char**);
-#else
-# define sqliteRealloc_(X,Y) sqliteRealloc(X,Y)
-# define sqliteStrRealloc(X)
-#endif
-
-/*
-** This variable gets set if malloc() ever fails. After it gets set,
-** the STQLite library shuts down permanently.
-*/
-extern int sqlite_malloc_failed;
-
-/*
-** The following global variables are used for testing and debugging
-** only. They only work if MEMORY_DEBUG is defined.
-*/
-#ifdef MEMORY_DEBUG
-extern int sqlite_nMalloc; /* Number of sqliteMalloc() calls */
-extern int sqlite_nFree; /* Number of sqliteFree() calls */
-extern int sqlite_iMallocFail; /* Fail sqliteMalloc() after this many calls */
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Name of the master database table. The master database table
-** is a special table that holds the names and attributes of all
-** user tables and indices.
-*/
-#define MASTER_NAME "sqlite_master"
-#define TEMP_MASTER_NAME "sqlite_temp_master"
-
-/*
-** The name of the schema table.
-*/
-#define SCHEMA_TABLE(x) (x?TEMP_MASTER_NAME:MASTER_NAME)
-
-/*
-** A convenience macro that returns the number of elements in
-** an array.
-*/
-#define ArraySize(X) (sizeof(X)/sizeof(X[0]))
-
-/*
-** Forward references to structures
-*/
-typedef struct Column Column;
-typedef struct Table Table;
-typedef struct Index Index;
-typedef struct Instruction Instruction;
-typedef struct Expr Expr;
-typedef struct ExprList ExprList;
-typedef struct Parse Parse;
-typedef struct Token Token;
-typedef struct IdList IdList;
-typedef struct SrcList SrcList;
-typedef struct WhereInfo WhereInfo;
-typedef struct WhereLevel WhereLevel;
-typedef struct Select Select;
-typedef struct AggExpr AggExpr;
-typedef struct FuncDef FuncDef;
-typedef struct Trigger Trigger;
-typedef struct TriggerStep TriggerStep;
-typedef struct TriggerStack TriggerStack;
-typedef struct FKey FKey;
-typedef struct Db Db;
-typedef struct AuthContext AuthContext;
-
-/*
-** Each database file to be accessed by the system is an instance
-** of the following structure. There are normally two of these structures
-** in the sqlite.aDb[] array. aDb[0] is the main database file and
-** aDb[1] is the database file used to hold temporary tables. Additional
-** databases may be attached.
-*/
-struct Db {
- char *zName; /* Name of this database */
- Btree *pBt; /* The B*Tree structure for this database file */
- int schema_cookie; /* Database schema version number for this file */
- Hash tblHash; /* All tables indexed by name */
- Hash idxHash; /* All (named) indices indexed by name */
- Hash trigHash; /* All triggers indexed by name */
- Hash aFKey; /* Foreign keys indexed by to-table */
- u8 inTrans; /* 0: not writable. 1: Transaction. 2: Checkpoint */
- u16 flags; /* Flags associated with this database */
- void *pAux; /* Auxiliary data. Usually NULL */
- void (*xFreeAux)(void*); /* Routine to free pAux */
-};
-
-/*
-** These macros can be used to test, set, or clear bits in the
-** Db.flags field.
-*/
-#define DbHasProperty(D,I,P) (((D)->aDb[I].flags&(P))==(P))
-#define DbHasAnyProperty(D,I,P) (((D)->aDb[I].flags&(P))!=0)
-#define DbSetProperty(D,I,P) (D)->aDb[I].flags|=(P)
-#define DbClearProperty(D,I,P) (D)->aDb[I].flags&=~(P)
-
-/*
-** Allowed values for the DB.flags field.
-**
-** The DB_Locked flag is set when the first OP_Transaction or OP_Checkpoint
-** opcode is emitted for a database. This prevents multiple occurances
-** of those opcodes for the same database in the same program. Similarly,
-** the DB_Cookie flag is set when the OP_VerifyCookie opcode is emitted,
-** and prevents duplicate OP_VerifyCookies from taking up space and slowing
-** down execution.
-**
-** The DB_SchemaLoaded flag is set after the database schema has been
-** read into internal hash tables.
-**
-** DB_UnresetViews means that one or more views have column names that
-** have been filled out. If the schema changes, these column names might
-** changes and so the view will need to be reset.
-*/
-#define DB_Locked 0x0001 /* OP_Transaction opcode has been emitted */
-#define DB_Cookie 0x0002 /* OP_VerifyCookie opcode has been emiited */
-#define DB_SchemaLoaded 0x0004 /* The schema has been loaded */
-#define DB_UnresetViews 0x0008 /* Some views have defined column names */
-
-
-/*
-** Each database is an instance of the following structure.
-**
-** The sqlite.file_format is initialized by the database file
-** and helps determines how the data in the database file is
-** represented. This field allows newer versions of the library
-** to read and write older databases. The various file formats
-** are as follows:
-**
-** file_format==1 Version 2.1.0.
-** file_format==2 Version 2.2.0. Add support for INTEGER PRIMARY KEY.
-** file_format==3 Version 2.6.0. Fix empty-string index bug.
-** file_format==4 Version 2.7.0. Add support for separate numeric and
-** text datatypes.
-**
-** The sqlite.temp_store determines where temporary database files
-** are stored. If 1, then a file is created to hold those tables. If
-** 2, then they are held in memory. 0 means use the default value in
-** the TEMP_STORE macro.
-**
-** The sqlite.lastRowid records the last insert rowid generated by an
-** insert statement. Inserts on views do not affect its value. Each
-** trigger has its own context, so that lastRowid can be updated inside
-** triggers as usual. The previous value will be restored once the trigger
-** exits. Upon entering a before or instead of trigger, lastRowid is no
-** longer (since after version 2.8.12) reset to -1.
-**
-** The sqlite.nChange does not count changes within triggers and keeps no
-** context. It is reset at start of sqlite_exec.
-** The sqlite.lsChange represents the number of changes made by the last
-** insert, update, or delete statement. It remains constant throughout the
-** length of a statement and is then updated by OP_SetCounts. It keeps a
-** context stack just like lastRowid so that the count of changes
-** within a trigger is not seen outside the trigger. Changes to views do not
-** affect the value of lsChange.
-** The sqlite.csChange keeps track of the number of current changes (since
-** the last statement) and is used to update sqlite_lsChange.
-*/
-struct sqlite {
- int nDb; /* Number of backends currently in use */
- Db *aDb; /* All backends */
- Db aDbStatic[2]; /* Static space for the 2 default backends */
- int flags; /* Miscellanous flags. See below */
- u8 file_format; /* What file format version is this database? */
- u8 safety_level; /* How aggressive at synching data to disk */
- u8 want_to_close; /* Close after all VDBEs are deallocated */
- u8 temp_store; /* 1=file, 2=memory, 0=compile-time default */
- u8 onError; /* Default conflict algorithm */
- int next_cookie; /* Next value of aDb[0].schema_cookie */
- int cache_size; /* Number of pages to use in the cache */
- int nTable; /* Number of tables in the database */
- void *pBusyArg; /* 1st Argument to the busy callback */
- int (*xBusyCallback)(void *,const char*,int); /* The busy callback */
- void *pCommitArg; /* Argument to xCommitCallback() */
- int (*xCommitCallback)(void*);/* Invoked at every commit. */
- Hash aFunc; /* All functions that can be in SQL exprs */
- int lastRowid; /* ROWID of most recent insert (see above) */
- int priorNewRowid; /* Last randomly generated ROWID */
- int magic; /* Magic number for detect library misuse */
- int nChange; /* Number of rows changed (see above) */
- int lsChange; /* Last statement change count (see above) */
- int csChange; /* Current statement change count (see above) */
- struct sqliteInitInfo { /* Information used during initialization */
- int iDb; /* When back is being initialized */
- int newTnum; /* Rootpage of table being initialized */
- u8 busy; /* TRUE if currently initializing */
- } init;
- struct Vdbe *pVdbe; /* List of active virtual machines */
- void (*xTrace)(void*,const char*); /* Trace function */
- void *pTraceArg; /* Argument to the trace function */
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- int (*xAuth)(void*,int,const char*,const char*,const char*,const char*);
- /* Access authorization function */
- void *pAuthArg; /* 1st argument to the access auth function */
-#endif
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_PROGRESS_CALLBACK
- int (*xProgress)(void *); /* The progress callback */
- void *pProgressArg; /* Argument to the progress callback */
- int nProgressOps; /* Number of opcodes for progress callback */
-#endif
-};
-
-/*
-** Possible values for the sqlite.flags and or Db.flags fields.
-**
-** On sqlite.flags, the STQLITE_InTrans value means that we have
-** executed a BEGIN. On Db.flags, STQLITE_InTrans means a statement
-** transaction is active on that particular database file.
-*/
-#define STQLITE_VdbeTrace 0x00000001 /* True to trace VDBE execution */
-#define STQLITE_Initialized 0x00000002 /* True after initialization */
-#define STQLITE_Interrupt 0x00000004 /* Cancel current operation */
-#define STQLITE_InTrans 0x00000008 /* True if in a transaction */
-#define STQLITE_InternChanges 0x00000010 /* Uncommitted Hash table changes */
-#define STQLITE_FullColNames 0x00000020 /* Show full column names on SELECT */
-#define STQLITE_ShortColNames 0x00000040 /* Show short columns names */
-#define STQLITE_CountRows 0x00000080 /* Count rows changed by INSERT, */
- /* DELETE, or UPDATE and return */
- /* the count using a callback. */
-#define STQLITE_NullCallback 0x00000100 /* Invoke the callback once if the */
- /* result set is empty */
-#define STQLITE_ReportTypes 0x00000200 /* Include information on datatypes */
- /* in 4th argument of callback */
-
-/*
-** Possible values for the sqlite.magic field.
-** The numbers are obtained at random and have no special meaning, other
-** than being distinct from one another.
-*/
-#define STQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN 0xa029a697 /* Database is open */
-#define STQLITE_MAGIC_CLOSED 0x9f3c2d33 /* Database is closed */
-#define STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY 0xf03b7906 /* Database currently in use */
-#define STQLITE_MAGIC_ERROR 0xb5357930 /* An STQLITE_MISUSE error occurred */
-
-/*
-** Each SQL function is defined by an instance of the following
-** structure. A pointer to this structure is stored in the sqlite.aFunc
-** hash table. When multiple functions have the same name, the hash table
-** points to a linked list of these structures.
-*/
-struct FuncDef {
- void (*xFunc)(sqlite_func*,int,const char**); /* Regular function */
- void (*xStep)(sqlite_func*,int,const char**); /* Aggregate function step */
- void (*xFinalize)(sqlite_func*); /* Aggregate function finializer */
- signed char nArg; /* Number of arguments. -1 means unlimited */
- signed char dataType; /* Arg that determines datatype. -1=NUMERIC, */
- /* -2=TEXT. -3=STQLITE_ARGS */
- u8 includeTypes; /* Add datatypes to args of xFunc and xStep */
- void *pUserData; /* User data parameter */
- FuncDef *pNext; /* Next function with same name */
-};
-
-/*
-** information about each column of an SQL table is held in an instance
-** of this structure.
-*/
-struct Column {
- char *zName; /* Name of this column */
- char *zDflt; /* Default value of this column */
- char *zType; /* Data type for this column */
- u8 notNull; /* True if there is a NOT NULL constraint */
- u8 isPrimKey; /* True if this column is part of the PRIMARY KEY */
- u8 sortOrder; /* Some combination of STQLITE_SO_... values */
- u8 dottedName; /* True if zName contains a "." character */
-};
-
-/*
-** The allowed sort orders.
-**
-** The TEXT and NUM values use bits that do not overlap with DESC and ASC.
-** That way the two can be combined into a single number.
-*/
-#define STQLITE_SO_UNK 0 /* Use the default collating type. (SCT_NUM) */
-#define STQLITE_SO_TEXT 2 /* Sort using memcmp() */
-#define STQLITE_SO_NUM 4 /* Sort using sqliteCompare() */
-#define STQLITE_SO_TYPEMASK 6 /* Mask to extract the collating sequence */
-#define STQLITE_SO_ASC 0 /* Sort in ascending order */
-#define STQLITE_SO_DESC 1 /* Sort in descending order */
-#define STQLITE_SO_DIRMASK 1 /* Mask to extract the sort direction */
-
-/*
-** Each SQL table is represented in memory by an instance of the
-** following structure.
-**
-** Table.zName is the name of the table. The case of the original
-** CREATE TABLE statement is stored, but case is not significant for
-** comparisons.
-**
-** Table.nCol is the number of columns in this table. Table.aCol is a
-** pointer to an array of Column structures, one for each column.
-**
-** If the table has an INTEGER PRIMARY KEY, then Table.iPKey is the index of
-** the column that is that key. Otherwise Table.iPKey is negative. Note
-** that the datatype of the PRIMARY KEY must be INTEGER for this field to
-** be set. An INTEGER PRIMARY KEY is used as the rowid for each row of
-** the table. If a table has no INTEGER PRIMARY KEY, then a random rowid
-** is generated for each row of the table. Table.hasPrimKey is true if
-** the table has any PRIMARY KEY, INTEGER or otherwise.
-**
-** Table.tnum is the page number for the root BTree page of the table in the
-** database file. If Table.iDb is the index of the database table backend
-** in sqlite.aDb[]. 0 is for the main database and 1 is for the file that
-** holds temporary tables and indices. If Table.isTransient
-** is true, then the table is stored in a file that is automatically deleted
-** when the VDBE cursor to the table is closed. In this case Table.tnum
-** refers VDBE cursor number that holds the table open, not to the root
-** page number. Transient tables are used to hold the results of a
-** sub-query that appears instead of a real table name in the FROM clause
-** of a SELECT statement.
-*/
-struct Table {
- char *zName; /* Name of the table */
- int nCol; /* Number of columns in this table */
- Column *aCol; /* Information about each column */
- int iPKey; /* If not less then 0, use aCol[iPKey] as the primary key */
- Index *pIndex; /* List of SQL indexes on this table. */
- int tnum; /* Root BTree node for this table (see note above) */
- Select *pSelect; /* NULL for tables. Points to definition if a view. */
- u8 readOnly; /* True if this table should not be written by the user */
- u8 iDb; /* Index into sqlite.aDb[] of the backend for this table */
- u8 isTransient; /* True if automatically deleted when VDBE finishes */
- u8 hasPrimKey; /* True if there exists a primary key */
- u8 keyConf; /* What to do in case of uniqueness conflict on iPKey */
- Trigger *pTrigger; /* List of SQL triggers on this table */
- FKey *pFKey; /* Linked list of all foreign keys in this table */
-};
-
-/*
-** Each foreign key constraint is an instance of the following structure.
-**
-** A foreign key is associated with two tables. The "from" table is
-** the table that contains the REFERENCES clause that creates the foreign
-** key. The "to" table is the table that is named in the REFERENCES clause.
-** Consider this example:
-**
-** CREATE TABLE ex1(
-** a INTEGER PRIMARY KEY,
-** b INTEGER CONSTRAINT fk1 REFERENCES ex2(x)
-** );
-**
-** For foreign key "fk1", the from-table is "ex1" and the to-table is "ex2".
-**
-** Each REFERENCES clause generates an instance of the following structure
-** which is attached to the from-table. The to-table need not exist when
-** the from-table is created. The existance of the to-table is not checked
-** until an attempt is made to insert data into the from-table.
-**
-** The sqlite.aFKey hash table stores pointers to this structure
-** given the name of a to-table. For each to-table, all foreign keys
-** associated with that table are on a linked list using the FKey.pNextTo
-** field.
-*/
-struct FKey {
- Table *pFrom; /* The table that constains the REFERENCES clause */
- FKey *pNextFrom; /* Next foreign key in pFrom */
- char *zTo; /* Name of table that the key points to */
- FKey *pNextTo; /* Next foreign key that points to zTo */
- int nCol; /* Number of columns in this key */
- struct sColMap { /* Mapping of columns in pFrom to columns in zTo */
- int iFrom; /* Index of column in pFrom */
- char *zCol; /* Name of column in zTo. If 0 use PRIMARY KEY */
- } *aCol; /* One entry for each of nCol column s */
- u8 isDeferred; /* True if constraint checking is deferred till COMMIT */
- u8 updateConf; /* How to resolve conflicts that occur on UPDATE */
- u8 deleteConf; /* How to resolve conflicts that occur on DELETE */
- u8 insertConf; /* How to resolve conflicts that occur on INSERT */
-};
-
-/*
-** STQLite supports many different ways to resolve a contraint
-** error. ROLLBACK processing means that a constraint violation
-** causes the operation in process to fail and for the current transaction
-** to be rolled back. ABORT processing means the operation in process
-** fails and any prior changes from that one operation are backed out,
-** but the transaction is not rolled back. FAIL processing means that
-** the operation in progress stops and returns an error code. But prior
-** changes due to the same operation are not backed out and no rollback
-** occurs. IGNORE means that the particular row that caused the constraint
-** error is not inserted or updated. Processing continues and no error
-** is returned. REPLACE means that preexisting database rows that caused
-** a UNITQUE constraint violation are removed so that the new insert or
-** update can proceed. Processing continues and no error is reported.
-**
-** RESTRICT, SETNULL, and CASCADE actions apply only to foreign keys.
-** RESTRICT is the same as ABORT for IMMEDIATE foreign keys and the
-** same as ROLLBACK for DEFERRED keys. SETNULL means that the foreign
-** key is set to NULL. CASCADE means that a DELETE or UPDATE of the
-** referenced table row is propagated into the row that holds the
-** foreign key.
-**
-** The following symbolic values are used to record which type
-** of action to take.
-*/
-#define OE_None 0 /* There is no constraint to check */
-#define OE_Rollback 1 /* Fail the operation and rollback the transaction */
-#define OE_Abort 2 /* Back out changes but do no rollback transaction */
-#define OE_Fail 3 /* Stop the operation but leave all prior changes */
-#define OE_Ignore 4 /* Ignore the error. Do not do the INSERT or UPDATE */
-#define OE_Replace 5 /* Delete existing record, then do INSERT or UPDATE */
-
-#define OE_Restrict 6 /* OE_Abort for IMMEDIATE, OE_Rollback for DEFERRED */
-#define OE_SetNull 7 /* Set the foreign key value to NULL */
-#define OE_SetDflt 8 /* Set the foreign key value to its default */
-#define OE_Cascade 9 /* Cascade the changes */
-
-#define OE_Default 99 /* Do whatever the default action is */
-
-/*
-** Each SQL index is represented in memory by an
-** instance of the following structure.
-**
-** The columns of the table that are to be indexed are described
-** by the aiColumn[] field of this structure. For example, suppose
-** we have the following table and index:
-**
-** CREATE TABLE Ex1(c1 int, c2 int, c3 text);
-** CREATE INDEX Ex2 ON Ex1(c3,c1);
-**
-** In the Table structure describing Ex1, nCol==3 because there are
-** three columns in the table. In the Index structure describing
-** Ex2, nColumn==2 since 2 of the 3 columns of Ex1 are indexed.
-** The value of aiColumn is {2, 0}. aiColumn[0]==2 because the
-** first column to be indexed (c3) has an index of 2 in Ex1.aCol[].
-** The second column to be indexed (c1) has an index of 0 in
-** Ex1.aCol[], hence Ex2.aiColumn[1]==0.
-**
-** The Index.onError field determines whether or not the indexed columns
-** must be unique and what to do if they are not. When Index.onError=OE_None,
-** it means this is not a unique index. Otherwise it is a unique index
-** and the value of Index.onError indicate the which conflict resolution
-** algorithm to employ whenever an attempt is made to insert a non-unique
-** element.
-*/
-struct Index {
- char *zName; /* Name of this index */
- int nColumn; /* Number of columns in the table used by this index */
- int *aiColumn; /* Which columns are used by this index. 1st is 0 */
- Table *pTable; /* The SQL table being indexed */
- int tnum; /* Page containing root of this index in database file */
- u8 onError; /* OE_Abort, OE_Ignore, OE_Replace, or OE_None */
- u8 autoIndex; /* True if is automatically created (ex: by UNITQUE) */
- u8 iDb; /* Index in sqlite.aDb[] of where this index is stored */
- Index *pNext; /* The next index associated with the same table */
-};
-
-/*
-** Each token coming out of the lexer is an instance of
-** this structure. Tokens are also used as part of an expression.
-**
-** Note if Token.z==0 then Token.dyn and Token.n are undefined and
-** may contain random values. Do not make any assuptions about Token.dyn
-** and Token.n when Token.z==0.
-*/
-struct Token {
- const char *z; /* Text of the token. Not NULL-terminated! */
- unsigned dyn : 1; /* True for malloced memory, false for static */
- unsigned n : 31; /* Number of characters in this token */
-};
-
-/*
-** Each node of an expression in the parse tree is an instance
-** of this structure.
-**
-** Expr.op is the opcode. The integer parser token codes are reused
-** as opcodes here. For example, the parser defines TK_GE to be an integer
-** code representing the ">=" operator. This same integer code is reused
-** to represent the greater-than-or-equal-to operator in the expression
-** tree.
-**
-** Expr.pRight and Expr.pLeft are subexpressions. Expr.pList is a list
-** of argument if the expression is a function.
-**
-** Expr.token is the operator token for this node. For some expressions
-** that have subexpressions, Expr.token can be the complete text that gave
-** rise to the Expr. In the latter case, the token is marked as being
-** a compound token.
-**
-** An expression of the form ID or ID.ID refers to a column in a table.
-** For such expressions, Expr.op is set to TK_COLUMN and Expr.iTable is
-** the integer cursor number of a VDBE cursor pointing to that table and
-** Expr.iColumn is the column number for the specific column. If the
-** expression is used as a result in an aggregate SELECT, then the
-** value is also stored in the Expr.iAgg column in the aggregate so that
-** it can be accessed after all aggregates are computed.
-**
-** If the expression is a function, the Expr.iTable is an integer code
-** representing which function. If the expression is an unbound variable
-** marker (a question mark character '?' in the original SQL) then the
-** Expr.iTable holds the index number for that variable.
-**
-** The Expr.pSelect field points to a SELECT statement. The SELECT might
-** be the right operand of an IN operator. Or, if a scalar SELECT appears
-** in an expression the opcode is TK_SELECT and Expr.pSelect is the only
-** operand.
-*/
-struct Expr {
- u8 op; /* Operation performed by this node */
- u8 dataType; /* Either STQLITE_SO_TEXT or STQLITE_SO_NUM */
- u8 iDb; /* Database referenced by this expression */
- u8 flags; /* Various flags. See below */
- Expr *pLeft, *pRight; /* Left and right subnodes */
- ExprList *pList; /* A list of expressions used as function arguments
- ** or in "<expr> IN (<expr-list)" */
- Token token; /* An operand token */
- Token span; /* Complete text of the expression */
- int iTable, iColumn; /* When op==TK_COLUMN, then this expr node means the
- ** iColumn-th field of the iTable-th table. */
- int iAgg; /* When op==TK_COLUMN and pParse->useAgg==TRUE, pull
- ** result from the iAgg-th element of the aggregator */
- Select *pSelect; /* When the expression is a sub-select. Also the
- ** right side of "<expr> IN (<select>)" */
-};
-
-/*
-** The following are the meanings of bits in the Expr.flags field.
-*/
-#define EP_FromJoin 0x0001 /* Originated in ON or USING clause of a join */
-
-/*
-** These macros can be used to test, set, or clear bits in the
-** Expr.flags field.
-*/
-#define ExprHasProperty(E,P) (((E)->flags&(P))==(P))
-#define ExprHasAnyProperty(E,P) (((E)->flags&(P))!=0)
-#define ExprSetProperty(E,P) (E)->flags|=(P)
-#define ExprClearProperty(E,P) (E)->flags&=~(P)
-
-/*
-** A list of expressions. Each expression may optionally have a
-** name. An expr/name combination can be used in several ways, such
-** as the list of "expr AS ID" fields following a "SELECT" or in the
-** list of "ID = expr" items in an UPDATE. A list of expressions can
-** also be used as the argument to a function, in which case the a.zName
-** field is not used.
-*/
-struct ExprList {
- int nExpr; /* Number of expressions on the list */
- int nAlloc; /* Number of entries allocated below */
- struct ExprList_item {
- Expr *pExpr; /* The list of expressions */
- char *zName; /* Token associated with this expression */
- u8 sortOrder; /* 1 for DESC or 0 for ASC */
- u8 isAgg; /* True if this is an aggregate like count(*) */
- u8 done; /* A flag to indicate when processing is finished */
- } *a; /* One entry for each expression */
-};
-
-/*
-** An instance of this structure can hold a simple list of identifiers,
-** such as the list "a,b,c" in the following statements:
-**
-** INSERT INTO t(a,b,c) VALUES ...;
-** CREATE INDEX idx ON t(a,b,c);
-** CREATE TRIGGER trig BEFORE UPDATE ON t(a,b,c) ...;
-**
-** The IdList.a.idx field is used when the IdList represents the list of
-** column names after a table name in an INSERT statement. In the statement
-**
-** INSERT INTO t(a,b,c) ...
-**
-** If "a" is the k-th column of table "t", then IdList.a[0].idx==k.
-*/
-struct IdList {
- int nId; /* Number of identifiers on the list */
- int nAlloc; /* Number of entries allocated for a[] below */
- struct IdList_item {
- char *zName; /* Name of the identifier */
- int idx; /* Index in some Table.aCol[] of a column named zName */
- } *a;
-};
-
-/*
-** The following structure describes the FROM clause of a SELECT statement.
-** Each table or subquery in the FROM clause is a separate element of
-** the SrcList.a[] array.
-**
-** With the addition of multiple database support, the following structure
-** can also be used to describe a particular table such as the table that
-** is modified by an INSERT, DELETE, or UPDATE statement. In standard SQL,
-** such a table must be a simple name: ID. But in STQLite, the table can
-** now be identified by a database name, a dot, then the table name: ID.ID.
-*/
-struct SrcList {
- u16 nSrc; /* Number of tables or subqueries in the FROM clause */
- u16 nAlloc; /* Number of entries allocated in a[] below */
- struct SrcList_item {
- char *zDatabase; /* Name of database holding this table */
- char *zName; /* Name of the table */
- char *zAlias; /* The "B" part of a "A AS B" phrase. zName is the "A" */
- Table *pTab; /* An SQL table corresponding to zName */
- Select *pSelect; /* A SELECT statement used in place of a table name */
- int jointype; /* Type of join between this table and the next */
- int iCursor; /* The VDBE cursor number used to access this table */
- Expr *pOn; /* The ON clause of a join */
- IdList *pUsing; /* The USING clause of a join */
- } a[1]; /* One entry for each identifier on the list */
-};
-
-/*
-** Permitted values of the SrcList.a.jointype field
-*/
-#define JT_INNER 0x0001 /* Any kind of inner or cross join */
-#define JT_NATURAL 0x0002 /* True for a "natural" join */
-#define JT_LEFT 0x0004 /* Left outer join */
-#define JT_RIGHT 0x0008 /* Right outer join */
-#define JT_OUTER 0x0010 /* The "OUTER" keyword is present */
-#define JT_ERROR 0x0020 /* unknown or unsupported join type */
-
-/*
-** For each nested loop in a WHERE clause implementation, the WhereInfo
-** structure contains a single instance of this structure. This structure
-** is intended to be private the the where.c module and should not be
-** access or modified by other modules.
-*/
-struct WhereLevel {
- int iMem; /* Memory cell used by this level */
- Index *pIdx; /* Index used */
- int iCur; /* Cursor number used for this index */
- int score; /* How well this indexed scored */
- int brk; /* Jump here to break out of the loop */
- int cont; /* Jump here to continue with the next loop cycle */
- int op, p1, p2; /* Opcode used to terminate the loop */
- int iLeftJoin; /* Memory cell used to implement LEFT OUTER JOIN */
- int top; /* First instruction of interior of the loop */
- int inOp, inP1, inP2;/* Opcode used to implement an IN operator */
- int bRev; /* Do the scan in the reverse direction */
-};
-
-/*
-** The WHERE clause processing routine has two halves. The
-** first part does the start of the WHERE loop and the second
-** half does the tail of the WHERE loop. An instance of
-** this structure is returned by the first half and passed
-** into the second half to give some continuity.
-*/
-struct WhereInfo {
- Parse *pParse;
- SrcList *pTabList; /* List of tables in the join */
- int iContinue; /* Jump here to continue with next record */
- int iBreak; /* Jump here to break out of the loop */
- int nLevel; /* Number of nested loop */
- int savedNTab; /* Value of pParse->nTab before WhereBegin() */
- int peakNTab; /* Value of pParse->nTab after WhereBegin() */
- WhereLevel a[1]; /* Information about each nest loop in the WHERE */
-};
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure contains all information
-** needed to generate code for a single SELECT statement.
-**
-** The zSelect field is used when the Select structure must be persistent.
-** Normally, the expression tree points to tokens in the original input
-** string that encodes the select. But if the Select structure must live
-** longer than its input string (for example when it is used to describe
-** a VIEW) we have to make a copy of the input string so that the nodes
-** of the expression tree will have something to point to. zSelect is used
-** to hold that copy.
-**
-** nLimit is set to -1 if there is no LIMIT clause. nOffset is set to 0.
-** If there is a LIMIT clause, the parser sets nLimit to the value of the
-** limit and nOffset to the value of the offset (or 0 if there is not
-** offset). But later on, nLimit and nOffset become the memory locations
-** in the VDBE that record the limit and offset counters.
-*/
-struct Select {
- ExprList *pEList; /* The fields of the result */
- u8 op; /* One of: TK_UNION TK_ALL TK_INTERSECT TK_EXCEPT */
- u8 isDistinct; /* True if the DISTINCT keyword is present */
- SrcList *pSrc; /* The FROM clause */
- Expr *pWhere; /* The WHERE clause */
- ExprList *pGroupBy; /* The GROUP BY clause */
- Expr *pHaving; /* The HAVING clause */
- ExprList *pOrderBy; /* The ORDER BY clause */
- Select *pPrior; /* Prior select in a compound select statement */
- int nLimit, nOffset; /* LIMIT and OFFSET values. -1 means not used */
- int iLimit, iOffset; /* Memory registers holding LIMIT & OFFSET counters */
- char *zSelect; /* Complete text of the SELECT command */
-};
-
-/*
-** The results of a select can be distributed in several ways.
-*/
-#define SRT_Callback 1 /* Invoke a callback with each row of result */
-#define SRT_Mem 2 /* Store result in a memory cell */
-#define SRT_Set 3 /* Store result as unique keys in a table */
-#define SRT_Union 5 /* Store result as keys in a table */
-#define SRT_Except 6 /* Remove result from a UNION table */
-#define SRT_Table 7 /* Store result as data with a unique key */
-#define SRT_TempTable 8 /* Store result in a trasient table */
-#define SRT_Discard 9 /* Do not save the results anywhere */
-#define SRT_Sorter 10 /* Store results in the sorter */
-#define SRT_Subroutine 11 /* Call a subroutine to handle results */
-
-/*
-** When a SELECT uses aggregate functions (like "count(*)" or "avg(f1)")
-** we have to do some additional analysis of expressions. An instance
-** of the following structure holds information about a single subexpression
-** somewhere in the SELECT statement. An array of these structures holds
-** all the information we need to generate code for aggregate
-** expressions.
-**
-** Note that when analyzing a SELECT containing aggregates, both
-** non-aggregate field variables and aggregate functions are stored
-** in the AggExpr array of the Parser structure.
-**
-** The pExpr field points to an expression that is part of either the
-** field list, the GROUP BY clause, the HAVING clause or the ORDER BY
-** clause. The expression will be freed when those clauses are cleaned
-** up. Do not try to delete the expression attached to AggExpr.pExpr.
-**
-** If AggExpr.pExpr==0, that means the expression is "count(*)".
-*/
-struct AggExpr {
- int isAgg; /* if TRUE contains an aggregate function */
- Expr *pExpr; /* The expression */
- FuncDef *pFunc; /* Information about the aggregate function */
-};
-
-/*
-** An SQL parser context. A copy of this structure is passed through
-** the parser and down into all the parser action routine in order to
-** carry around information that is global to the entire parse.
-*/
-struct Parse {
- sqlite *db; /* The main database structure */
- int rc; /* Return code from execution */
- char *zErrMsg; /* An error message */
- Token sErrToken; /* The token at which the error occurred */
- Token sFirstToken; /* The first token parsed */
- Token sLastToken; /* The last token parsed */
- const char *zTail; /* All SQL text past the last semicolon parsed */
- Table *pNewTable; /* A table being constructed by CREATE TABLE */
- Vdbe *pVdbe; /* An engine for executing database bytecode */
- u8 colNamesSet; /* TRUE after OP_ColumnName has been issued to pVdbe */
- u8 explain; /* True if the EXPLAIN flag is found on the query */
- u8 nameClash; /* A permanent table name clashes with temp table name */
- u8 useAgg; /* If true, extract field values from the aggregator
- ** while generating expressions. Normally false */
- int nErr; /* Number of errors seen */
- int nTab; /* Number of previously allocated VDBE cursors */
- int nMem; /* Number of memory cells used so far */
- int nSet; /* Number of sets used so far */
- int nAgg; /* Number of aggregate expressions */
- int nVar; /* Number of '?' variables seen in the SQL so far */
- AggExpr *aAgg; /* An array of aggregate expressions */
- const char *zAuthContext; /* The 6th parameter to db->xAuth callbacks */
- Trigger *pNewTrigger; /* Trigger under construct by a CREATE TRIGGER */
- TriggerStack *trigStack; /* Trigger actions being coded */
-};
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure can be declared on a stack and used
-** to save the Parse.zAuthContext value so that it can be restored later.
-*/
-struct AuthContext {
- const char *zAuthContext; /* Put saved Parse.zAuthContext here */
- Parse *pParse; /* The Parse structure */
-};
-
-/*
-** Bitfield flags for P2 value in OP_PutIntKey and OP_Delete
-*/
-#define OPFLAG_NCHANGE 1 /* Set to update db->nChange */
-#define OPFLAG_LASTROWID 2 /* Set to update db->lastRowid */
-#define OPFLAG_CSCHANGE 4 /* Set to update db->csChange */
-
-/*
- * Each trigger present in the database schema is stored as an instance of
- * struct Trigger.
- *
- * Pointers to instances of struct Trigger are stored in two ways.
- * 1. In the "trigHash" hash table (part of the sqlite* that represents the
- * database). This allows Trigger structures to be retrieved by name.
- * 2. All triggers associated with a single table form a linked list, using the
- * pNext member of struct Trigger. A pointer to the first element of the
- * linked list is stored as the "pTrigger" member of the associated
- * struct Table.
- *
- * The "step_list" member points to the first element of a linked list
- * containing the SQL statements specified as the trigger program.
- */
-struct Trigger {
- char *name; /* The name of the trigger */
- char *table; /* The table or view to which the trigger applies */
- u8 iDb; /* Database containing this trigger */
- u8 iTabDb; /* Database containing Trigger.table */
- u8 op; /* One of TK_DELETE, TK_UPDATE, TK_INSERT */
- u8 tr_tm; /* One of TK_BEFORE, TK_AFTER */
- Expr *pWhen; /* The WHEN clause of the expresion (may be NULL) */
- IdList *pColumns; /* If this is an UPDATE OF <column-list> trigger,
- the <column-list> is stored here */
- int foreach; /* One of TK_ROW or TK_STATEMENT */
- Token nameToken; /* Token containing zName. Use during parsing only */
-
- TriggerStep *step_list; /* Link list of trigger program steps */
- Trigger *pNext; /* Next trigger associated with the table */
-};
-
-/*
- * An instance of struct TriggerStep is used to store a single SQL statement
- * that is a part of a trigger-program.
- *
- * Instances of struct TriggerStep are stored in a singly linked list (linked
- * using the "pNext" member) referenced by the "step_list" member of the
- * associated struct Trigger instance. The first element of the linked list is
- * the first step of the trigger-program.
- *
- * The "op" member indicates whether this is a "DELETE", "INSERT", "UPDATE" or
- * "SELECT" statement. The meanings of the other members is determined by the
- * value of "op" as follows:
- *
- * (op == TK_INSERT)
- * orconf -> stores the ON CONFLICT algorithm
- * pSelect -> If this is an INSERT INTO ... SELECT ... statement, then
- * this stores a pointer to the SELECT statement. Otherwise NULL.
- * target -> A token holding the name of the table to insert into.
- * pExprList -> If this is an INSERT INTO ... VALUES ... statement, then
- * this stores values to be inserted. Otherwise NULL.
- * pIdList -> If this is an INSERT INTO ... (<column-names>) VALUES ...
- * statement, then this stores the column-names to be
- * inserted into.
- *
- * (op == TK_DELETE)
- * target -> A token holding the name of the table to delete from.
- * pWhere -> The WHERE clause of the DELETE statement if one is specified.
- * Otherwise NULL.
- *
- * (op == TK_UPDATE)
- * target -> A token holding the name of the table to update rows of.
- * pWhere -> The WHERE clause of the UPDATE statement if one is specified.
- * Otherwise NULL.
- * pExprList -> A list of the columns to update and the expressions to update
- * them to. See sqliteUpdate() documentation of "pChanges"
- * argument.
- *
- */
-struct TriggerStep {
- int op; /* One of TK_DELETE, TK_UPDATE, TK_INSERT, TK_SELECT */
- int orconf; /* OE_Rollback etc. */
- Trigger *pTrig; /* The trigger that this step is a part of */
-
- Select *pSelect; /* Valid for SELECT and sometimes
- INSERT steps (when pExprList == 0) */
- Token target; /* Valid for DELETE, UPDATE, INSERT steps */
- Expr *pWhere; /* Valid for DELETE, UPDATE steps */
- ExprList *pExprList; /* Valid for UPDATE statements and sometimes
- INSERT steps (when pSelect == 0) */
- IdList *pIdList; /* Valid for INSERT statements only */
-
- TriggerStep * pNext; /* Next in the link-list */
-};
-
-/*
- * An instance of struct TriggerStack stores information required during code
- * generation of a single trigger program. While the trigger program is being
- * coded, its associated TriggerStack instance is pointed to by the
- * "pTriggerStack" member of the Parse structure.
- *
- * The pTab member points to the table that triggers are being coded on. The
- * newIdx member contains the index of the vdbe cursor that points at the temp
- * table that stores the new.* references. If new.* references are not valid
- * for the trigger being coded (for example an ON DELETE trigger), then newIdx
- * is set to -1. The oldIdx member is analogous to newIdx, for old.* references.
- *
- * The ON CONFLICT policy to be used for the trigger program steps is stored
- * as the orconf member. If this is OE_Default, then the ON CONFLICT clause
- * specified for individual triggers steps is used.
- *
- * struct TriggerStack has a "pNext" member, to allow linked lists to be
- * constructed. When coding nested triggers (triggers fired by other triggers)
- * each nested trigger stores its parent trigger's TriggerStack as the "pNext"
- * pointer. Once the nested trigger has been coded, the pNext value is restored
- * to the pTriggerStack member of the Parse stucture and coding of the parent
- * trigger continues.
- *
- * Before a nested trigger is coded, the linked list pointed to by the
- * pTriggerStack is scanned to ensure that the trigger is not about to be coded
- * recursively. If this condition is detected, the nested trigger is not coded.
- */
-struct TriggerStack {
- Table *pTab; /* Table that triggers are currently being coded on */
- int newIdx; /* Index of vdbe cursor to "new" temp table */
- int oldIdx; /* Index of vdbe cursor to "old" temp table */
- int orconf; /* Current orconf policy */
- int ignoreJump; /* where to jump to for a RAISE(IGNORE) */
- Trigger *pTrigger; /* The trigger currently being coded */
- TriggerStack *pNext; /* Next trigger down on the trigger stack */
-};
-
-/*
-** The following structure contains information used by the sqliteFix...
-** routines as they walk the parse tree to make database references
-** explicit.
-*/
-typedef struct DbFixer DbFixer;
-struct DbFixer {
- Parse *pParse; /* The parsing context. Error messages written here */
- const char *zDb; /* Make sure all objects are contained in this database */
- const char *zType; /* Type of the container - used for error messages */
- const Token *pName; /* Name of the container - used for error messages */
-};
-
-/*
- * This global flag is set for performance testing of triggers. When it is set
- * STQLite will perform the overhead of building new and old trigger references
- * even when no triggers exist
- */
-extern int always_code_trigger_setup;
-
-/*
-** Internal function prototypes
-*/
-int sqliteStrICmp(const char *, const char *);
-int sqliteStrNICmp(const char *, const char *, int);
-int sqliteHashNoCase(const char *, int);
-int sqliteIsNumber(const char*);
-int sqliteCompare(const char *, const char *);
-int sqliteSortCompare(const char *, const char *);
-void sqliteRealToSortable(double r, char *);
-#ifdef MEMORY_DEBUG
- void *sqliteMalloc_(int,int,char*,int);
- void sqliteFree_(void*,char*,int);
- void *sqliteRealloc_(void*,int,char*,int);
- char *sqliteStrDup_(const char*,char*,int);
- char *sqliteStrNDup_(const char*, int,char*,int);
- void sqliteCheckMemory(void*,int);
-#else
- void *sqliteMalloc(int);
- void *sqliteMallocRaw(int);
- void sqliteFree(void*);
- void *sqliteRealloc(void*,int);
- char *sqliteStrDup(const char*);
- char *sqliteStrNDup(const char*, int);
-# define sqliteCheckMemory(a,b)
-#endif
-char *sqliteMPrintf(const char*, ...);
-char *sqliteVMPrintf(const char*, va_list);
-void sqliteSetString(char **, const char *, ...);
-void sqliteSetNString(char **, ...);
-void sqliteErrorMsg(Parse*, const char*, ...);
-void sqliteDequote(char*);
-int sqliteKeywordCode(const char*, int);
-int sqliteRunParser(Parse*, const char*, char **);
-void sqliteExec(Parse*);
-Expr *sqliteExpr(int, Expr*, Expr*, Token*);
-void sqliteExprSpan(Expr*,Token*,Token*);
-Expr *sqliteExprFunction(ExprList*, Token*);
-void sqliteExprDelete(Expr*);
-ExprList *sqliteExprListAppend(ExprList*,Expr*,Token*);
-void sqliteExprListDelete(ExprList*);
-int sqliteInit(sqlite*, char**);
-void sqlitePragma(Parse*,Token*,Token*,int);
-void sqliteResetInternalSchema(sqlite*, int);
-void sqliteBeginParse(Parse*,int);
-void sqliteRollbackInternalChanges(sqlite*);
-void sqliteCommitInternalChanges(sqlite*);
-Table *sqliteResultSetOfSelect(Parse*,char*,Select*);
-void sqliteOpenMasterTable(Vdbe *v, int);
-void sqliteStartTable(Parse*,Token*,Token*,int,int);
-void sqliteAddColumn(Parse*,Token*);
-void sqliteAddNotNull(Parse*, int);
-void sqliteAddPrimaryKey(Parse*, IdList*, int);
-void sqliteAddColumnType(Parse*,Token*,Token*);
-void sqliteAddDefaultValue(Parse*,Token*,int);
-int sqliteCollateType(const char*, int);
-void sqliteAddCollateType(Parse*, int);
-void sqliteEndTable(Parse*,Token*,Select*);
-void sqliteCreateView(Parse*,Token*,Token*,Select*,int);
-int sqliteViewGetColumnNames(Parse*,Table*);
-void sqliteDropTable(Parse*, Token*, int);
-void sqliteDeleteTable(sqlite*, Table*);
-void sqliteInsert(Parse*, SrcList*, ExprList*, Select*, IdList*, int);
-IdList *sqliteIdListAppend(IdList*, Token*);
-int sqliteIdListIndex(IdList*,const char*);
-SrcList *sqliteSrcListAppend(SrcList*, Token*, Token*);
-void sqliteSrcListAddAlias(SrcList*, Token*);
-void sqliteSrcListAssignCursors(Parse*, SrcList*);
-void sqliteIdListDelete(IdList*);
-void sqliteSrcListDelete(SrcList*);
-void sqliteCreateIndex(Parse*,Token*,SrcList*,IdList*,int,Token*,Token*);
-void sqliteDropIndex(Parse*, SrcList*);
-void sqliteAddKeyType(Vdbe*, ExprList*);
-void sqliteAddIdxKeyType(Vdbe*, Index*);
-int sqliteSelect(Parse*, Select*, int, int, Select*, int, int*);
-Select *sqliteSelectNew(ExprList*,SrcList*,Expr*,ExprList*,Expr*,ExprList*,
- int,int,int);
-void sqliteSelectDelete(Select*);
-void sqliteSelectUnbind(Select*);
-Table *sqliteSrcListLookup(Parse*, SrcList*);
-int sqliteIsReadOnly(Parse*, Table*, int);
-void sqliteDeleteFrom(Parse*, SrcList*, Expr*);
-void sqliteUpdate(Parse*, SrcList*, ExprList*, Expr*, int);
-WhereInfo *sqliteWhereBegin(Parse*, SrcList*, Expr*, int, ExprList**);
-void sqliteWhereEnd(WhereInfo*);
-void sqliteExprCode(Parse*, Expr*);
-int sqliteExprCodeExprList(Parse*, ExprList*, int);
-void sqliteExprIfTrue(Parse*, Expr*, int, int);
-void sqliteExprIfFalse(Parse*, Expr*, int, int);
-Table *sqliteFindTable(sqlite*,const char*, const char*);
-Table *sqliteLocateTable(Parse*,const char*, const char*);
-Index *sqliteFindIndex(sqlite*,const char*, const char*);
-void sqliteUnlinkAndDeleteIndex(sqlite*,Index*);
-void sqliteCopy(Parse*, SrcList*, Token*, Token*, int);
-void sqliteVacuum(Parse*, Token*);
-int sqliteRunVacuum(char**, sqlite*);
-int sqliteGlobCompare(const unsigned char*,const unsigned char*);
-int sqliteLikeCompare(const unsigned char*,const unsigned char*);
-char *sqliteTableNameFromToken(Token*);
-int sqliteExprCheck(Parse*, Expr*, int, int*);
-int sqliteExprType(Expr*);
-int sqliteExprCompare(Expr*, Expr*);
-int sqliteFuncId(Token*);
-int sqliteExprResolveIds(Parse*, SrcList*, ExprList*, Expr*);
-int sqliteExprAnalyzeAggregates(Parse*, Expr*);
-Vdbe *sqliteGetVdbe(Parse*);
-void sqliteRandomness(int, void*);
-void sqliteRollbackAll(sqlite*);
-void sqliteCodeVerifySchema(Parse*, int);
-void sqliteBeginTransaction(Parse*, int);
-void sqliteCommitTransaction(Parse*);
-void sqliteRollbackTransaction(Parse*);
-int sqliteExprIsConstant(Expr*);
-int sqliteExprIsInteger(Expr*, int*);
-int sqliteIsRowid(const char*);
-void sqliteGenerateRowDelete(sqlite*, Vdbe*, Table*, int, int);
-void sqliteGenerateRowIndexDelete(sqlite*, Vdbe*, Table*, int, char*);
-void sqliteGenerateConstraintChecks(Parse*,Table*,int,char*,int,int,int,int);
-void sqliteCompleteInsertion(Parse*, Table*, int, char*, int, int, int);
-int sqliteOpenTableAndIndices(Parse*, Table*, int);
-void sqliteBeginWriteOperation(Parse*, int, int);
-void sqliteEndWriteOperation(Parse*);
-Expr *sqliteExprDup(Expr*);
-void sqliteTokenCopy(Token*, Token*);
-ExprList *sqliteExprListDup(ExprList*);
-SrcList *sqliteSrcListDup(SrcList*);
-IdList *sqliteIdListDup(IdList*);
-Select *sqliteSelectDup(Select*);
-FuncDef *sqliteFindFunction(sqlite*,const char*,int,int,int);
-void sqliteRegisterBuiltinFunctions(sqlite*);
-void sqliteRegisterDateTimeFunctions(sqlite*);
-int sqliteSafetyOn(sqlite*);
-int sqliteSafetyOff(sqlite*);
-int sqliteSafetyCheck(sqlite*);
-void sqliteChangeCookie(sqlite*, Vdbe*);
-void sqliteBeginTrigger(Parse*, Token*,int,int,IdList*,SrcList*,int,Expr*,int);
-void sqliteFinishTrigger(Parse*, TriggerStep*, Token*);
-void sqliteDropTrigger(Parse*, SrcList*);
-void sqliteDropTriggerPtr(Parse*, Trigger*, int);
-int sqliteTriggersExist(Parse* , Trigger* , int , int , int, ExprList*);
-int sqliteCodeRowTrigger(Parse*, int, ExprList*, int, Table *, int, int,
- int, int);
-void sqliteViewTriggers(Parse*, Table*, Expr*, int, ExprList*);
-void sqliteDeleteTriggerStep(TriggerStep*);
-TriggerStep *sqliteTriggerSelectStep(Select*);
-TriggerStep *sqliteTriggerInsertStep(Token*, IdList*, ExprList*, Select*, int);
-TriggerStep *sqliteTriggerUpdateStep(Token*, ExprList*, Expr*, int);
-TriggerStep *sqliteTriggerDeleteStep(Token*, Expr*);
-void sqliteDeleteTrigger(Trigger*);
-int sqliteJoinType(Parse*, Token*, Token*, Token*);
-void sqliteCreateForeignKey(Parse*, IdList*, Token*, IdList*, int);
-void sqliteDeferForeignKey(Parse*, int);
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- void sqliteAuthRead(Parse*,Expr*,SrcList*);
- int sqliteAuthCheck(Parse*,int, const char*, const char*, const char*);
- void sqliteAuthContextPush(Parse*, AuthContext*, const char*);
- void sqliteAuthContextPop(AuthContext*);
-#else
-# define sqliteAuthRead(a,b,c)
-# define sqliteAuthCheck(a,b,c,d,e) STQLITE_OK
-# define sqliteAuthContextPush(a,b,c)
-# define sqliteAuthContextPop(a) ((void)(a))
-#endif
-void sqliteAttach(Parse*, Token*, Token*, Token*);
-void sqliteDetach(Parse*, Token*);
-int sqliteBtreeFactory(const sqlite *db, const char *zFilename,
- int mode, int nPg, Btree **ppBtree);
-int sqliteFixInit(DbFixer*, Parse*, int, const char*, const Token*);
-int sqliteFixSrcList(DbFixer*, SrcList*);
-int sqliteFixSelect(DbFixer*, Select*);
-int sqliteFixExpr(DbFixer*, Expr*);
-int sqliteFixExprList(DbFixer*, ExprList*);
-int sqliteFixTriggerStep(DbFixer*, TriggerStep*);
-double sqliteAtoF(const char *z, const char **);
-char *sqlite_snprintf(int,char*,const char*,...);
-int sqliteFitsIn32Bits(const char *);
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/table.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/table.c
deleted file mode 100644
index b33bad9..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/table.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,203 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains the sqlite_get_table() and sqlite_free_table()
-** interface routines. These are just wrappers around the main
-** interface routine of sqlite_exec().
-**
-** These routines are in a separate files so that they will not be linked
-** if they are not used.
-*/
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-/*
-** This structure is used to pass data from sqlite_get_table() through
-** to the callback function is uses to build the result.
-*/
-typedef struct TabResult {
- char **azResult;
- char *zErrMsg;
- int nResult;
- int nAlloc;
- int nRow;
- int nColumn;
- int nData;
- int rc;
-} TabResult;
-
-/*
-** This routine is called once for each row in the result table. Its job
-** is to fill in the TabResult structure appropriately, allocating new
-** memory as necessary.
-*/
-static int sqlite_get_table_cb(void *pArg, int nCol, char **argv, char **colv){
- TabResult *p = (TabResult*)pArg;
- int need;
- int i;
- char *z;
-
- /* Make sure there is enough space in p->azResult to hold everything
- ** we need to remember from this invocation of the callback.
- */
- if( p->nRow==0 && argv!=0 ){
- need = nCol*2;
- }else{
- need = nCol;
- }
- if( p->nData + need >= p->nAlloc ){
- char **azNew;
- p->nAlloc = p->nAlloc*2 + need + 1;
- azNew = realloc( p->azResult, sizeof(char*)*p->nAlloc );
- if( azNew==0 ){
- p->rc = STQLITE_NOMEM;
- return 1;
- }
- p->azResult = azNew;
- }
-
- /* If this is the first row, then generate an extra row containing
- ** the names of all columns.
- */
- if( p->nRow==0 ){
- p->nColumn = nCol;
- for(i=0; i<nCol; i++){
- if( colv[i]==0 ){
- z = 0;
- }else{
- z = malloc( strlen(colv[i])+1 );
- if( z==0 ){
- p->rc = STQLITE_NOMEM;
- return 1;
- }
- strcpy(z, colv[i]);
- }
- p->azResult[p->nData++] = z;
- }
- }else if( p->nColumn!=nCol ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg,
- "sqlite_get_table() called with two or more incompatible queries",
- (char*)0);
- p->rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- return 1;
- }
-
- /* Copy over the row data
- */
- if( argv!=0 ){
- for(i=0; i<nCol; i++){
- if( argv[i]==0 ){
- z = 0;
- }else{
- z = malloc( strlen(argv[i])+1 );
- if( z==0 ){
- p->rc = STQLITE_NOMEM;
- return 1;
- }
- strcpy(z, argv[i]);
- }
- p->azResult[p->nData++] = z;
- }
- p->nRow++;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Query the database. But instead of invoking a callback for each row,
-** malloc() for space to hold the result and return the entire results
-** at the conclusion of the call.
-**
-** The result that is written to ***pazResult is held in memory obtained
-** from malloc(). But the caller cannot free this memory directly.
-** Instead, the entire table should be passed to sqlite_free_table() when
-** the calling procedure is finished using it.
-*/
-int sqlite_get_table(
- sqlite *db, /* The database on which the SQL executes */
- const char *zSql, /* The SQL to be executed */
- char ***pazResult, /* Write the result table here */
- int *pnRow, /* Write the number of rows in the result here */
- int *pnColumn, /* Write the number of columns of result here */
- char **pzErrMsg /* Write error messages here */
-){
- int rc;
- TabResult res;
- if( pazResult==0 ){ return STQLITE_ERROR; }
- *pazResult = 0;
- if( pnColumn ) *pnColumn = 0;
- if( pnRow ) *pnRow = 0;
- res.zErrMsg = 0;
- res.nResult = 0;
- res.nRow = 0;
- res.nColumn = 0;
- res.nData = 1;
- res.nAlloc = 20;
- res.rc = STQLITE_OK;
- res.azResult = malloc( sizeof(char*)*res.nAlloc );
- if( res.azResult==0 ){
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- res.azResult[0] = 0;
- rc = sqlite_exec(db, zSql, sqlite_get_table_cb, &res, pzErrMsg);
- if( res.azResult ){
- res.azResult[0] = (char*)res.nData;
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_ABORT ){
- sqlite_free_table(&res.azResult[1]);
- if( res.zErrMsg ){
- if( pzErrMsg ){
- free(*pzErrMsg);
- *pzErrMsg = res.zErrMsg;
- sqliteStrRealloc(pzErrMsg);
- }else{
- sqliteFree(res.zErrMsg);
- }
- }
- return res.rc;
- }
- sqliteFree(res.zErrMsg);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- sqlite_free_table(&res.azResult[1]);
- return rc;
- }
- if( res.nAlloc>res.nData ){
- char **azNew;
- azNew = realloc( res.azResult, sizeof(char*)*(res.nData+1) );
- if( azNew==0 ){
- sqlite_free_table(&res.azResult[1]);
- return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- }
- res.nAlloc = res.nData+1;
- res.azResult = azNew;
- }
- *pazResult = &res.azResult[1];
- if( pnColumn ) *pnColumn = res.nColumn;
- if( pnRow ) *pnRow = res.nRow;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine frees the space the sqlite_get_table() malloced.
-*/
-void sqlite_free_table(
- char **azResult /* Result returned from from sqlite_get_table() */
-){
- if( azResult ){
- int i, n;
- azResult--;
- if( azResult==0 ) return;
- n = (int)azResult[0];
- for(i=1; i<n; i++){ if( azResult[i] ) free(azResult[i]); }
- free(azResult);
- }
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/tokenize.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/tokenize.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 1d413b4..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/tokenize.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,679 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** An tokenizer for SQL
-**
-** This file contains C code that splits an SQL input string up into
-** individual tokens and sends those tokens one-by-one over to the
-** parser for analysis.
-**
-** $Id: tokenize.c,v 1.68 2004/02/14 23:59:58 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include "os.h"
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-
-/*
-** All the keywords of the SQL language are stored as in a hash
-** table composed of instances of the following structure.
-*/
-typedef struct Keyword Keyword;
-struct Keyword {
- char *zName; /* The keyword name */
- u8 tokenType; /* Token value for this keyword */
- u8 len; /* Length of this keyword */
- u8 iNext; /* Index in aKeywordTable[] of next with same hash */
-};
-
-/*
-** These are the keywords
-*/
-static Keyword aKeywordTable[] = {
- { "ABORT", TK_ABORT, },
- { "AFTER", TK_AFTER, },
- { "ALL", TK_ALL, },
- { "AND", TK_AND, },
- { "AS", TK_AS, },
- { "ASC", TK_ASC, },
- { "ATTACH", TK_ATTACH, },
- { "BEFORE", TK_BEFORE, },
- { "BEGIN", TK_BEGIN, },
- { "BETWEEN", TK_BETWEEN, },
- { "BY", TK_BY, },
- { "CASCADE", TK_CASCADE, },
- { "CASE", TK_CASE, },
- { "CHECK", TK_CHECK, },
- { "CLUSTER", TK_CLUSTER, },
- { "COLLATE", TK_COLLATE, },
- { "COMMIT", TK_COMMIT, },
- { "CONFLICT", TK_CONFLICT, },
- { "CONSTRAINT", TK_CONSTRAINT, },
- { "COPY", TK_COPY, },
- { "CREATE", TK_CREATE, },
- { "CROSS", TK_JOIN_KW, },
- { "DATABASE", TK_DATABASE, },
- { "DEFAULT", TK_DEFAULT, },
- { "DEFERRED", TK_DEFERRED, },
- { "DEFERRABLE", TK_DEFERRABLE, },
- { "DELETE", TK_DELETE, },
- { "DELIMITERS", TK_DELIMITERS, },
- { "DESC", TK_DESC, },
- { "DETACH", TK_DETACH, },
- { "DISTINCT", TK_DISTINCT, },
- { "DROP", TK_DROP, },
- { "END", TK_END, },
- { "EACH", TK_EACH, },
- { "ELSE", TK_ELSE, },
- { "EXCEPT", TK_EXCEPT, },
- { "EXPLAIN", TK_EXPLAIN, },
- { "FAIL", TK_FAIL, },
- { "FOR", TK_FOR, },
- { "FOREIGN", TK_FOREIGN, },
- { "FROM", TK_FROM, },
- { "FULL", TK_JOIN_KW, },
- { "GLOB", TK_GLOB, },
- { "GROUP", TK_GROUP, },
- { "HAVING", TK_HAVING, },
- { "IGNORE", TK_IGNORE, },
- { "IMMEDIATE", TK_IMMEDIATE, },
- { "IN", TK_IN, },
- { "INDEX", TK_INDEX, },
- { "INITIALLY", TK_INITIALLY, },
- { "INNER", TK_JOIN_KW, },
- { "INSERT", TK_INSERT, },
- { "INSTEAD", TK_INSTEAD, },
- { "INTERSECT", TK_INTERSECT, },
- { "INTO", TK_INTO, },
- { "IS", TK_IS, },
- { "ISNULL", TK_ISNULL, },
- { "JOIN", TK_JOIN, },
- { "KEY", TK_KEY, },
- { "LEFT", TK_JOIN_KW, },
- { "LIKE", TK_LIKE, },
- { "LIMIT", TK_LIMIT, },
- { "MATCH", TK_MATCH, },
- { "NATURAL", TK_JOIN_KW, },
- { "NOT", TK_NOT, },
- { "NOTNULL", TK_NOTNULL, },
- { "NULL", TK_NULL, },
- { "OF", TK_OF, },
- { "OFFSET", TK_OFFSET, },
- { "ON", TK_ON, },
- { "OR", TK_OR, },
- { "ORDER", TK_ORDER, },
- { "OUTER", TK_JOIN_KW, },
- { "PRAGMA", TK_PRAGMA, },
- { "PRIMARY", TK_PRIMARY, },
- { "RAISE", TK_RAISE, },
- { "REFERENCES", TK_REFERENCES, },
- { "REPLACE", TK_REPLACE, },
- { "RESTRICT", TK_RESTRICT, },
- { "RIGHT", TK_JOIN_KW, },
- { "ROLLBACK", TK_ROLLBACK, },
- { "ROW", TK_ROW, },
- { "SELECT", TK_SELECT, },
- { "SET", TK_SET, },
- { "STATEMENT", TK_STATEMENT, },
- { "TABLE", TK_TABLE, },
- { "TEMP", TK_TEMP, },
- { "TEMPORARY", TK_TEMP, },
- { "THEN", TK_THEN, },
- { "TRANSACTION", TK_TRANSACTION, },
- { "TRIGGER", TK_TRIGGER, },
- { "UNION", TK_UNION, },
- { "UNITQUE", TK_UNITQUE, },
- { "UPDATE", TK_UPDATE, },
- { "USING", TK_USING, },
- { "VACUUM", TK_VACUUM, },
- { "VALUES", TK_VALUES, },
- { "VIEW", TK_VIEW, },
- { "WHEN", TK_WHEN, },
- { "WHERE", TK_WHERE, },
-};
-
-/*
-** This is the hash table
-*/
-#define KEY_HASH_SIZE 101
-static u8 aiHashTable[KEY_HASH_SIZE];
-
-
-/*
-** This function looks up an identifier to determine if it is a
-** keyword. If it is a keyword, the token code of that keyword is
-** returned. If the input is not a keyword, TK_ID is returned.
-*/
-int sqliteKeywordCode(const char *z, int n){
- int h, i;
- Keyword *p;
- static char needInit = 1;
- if( needInit ){
- /* Initialize the keyword hash table */
- sqliteOsEnterMutex();
- if( needInit ){
- int nk;
- nk = sizeof(aKeywordTable)/sizeof(aKeywordTable[0]);
- for(i=0; i<nk; i++){
- aKeywordTable[i].len = strlen(aKeywordTable[i].zName);
- h = sqliteHashNoCase(aKeywordTable[i].zName, aKeywordTable[i].len);
- h %= KEY_HASH_SIZE;
- aKeywordTable[i].iNext = aiHashTable[h];
- aiHashTable[h] = i+1;
- }
- needInit = 0;
- }
- sqliteOsLeaveMutex();
- }
- h = sqliteHashNoCase(z, n) % KEY_HASH_SIZE;
- for(i=aiHashTable[h]; i; i=p->iNext){
- p = &aKeywordTable[i-1];
- if( p->len==n && sqliteStrNICmp(p->zName, z, n)==0 ){
- return p->tokenType;
- }
- }
- return TK_ID;
-}
-
-
-/*
-** If X is a character that can be used in an identifier and
-** X&0x80==0 then isIdChar[X] will be 1. If X&0x80==0x80 then
-** X is always an identifier character. (Hence all UTF-8
-** characters can be part of an identifier). isIdChar[X] will
-** be 0 for every character in the lower 128 ASCII characters
-** that cannot be used as part of an identifier.
-**
-** In this implementation, an identifier can be a string of
-** alphabetic characters, digits, and "_" plus any character
-** with the high-order bit set. The latter rule means that
-** any sequence of UTF-8 characters or characters taken from
-** an extended ISO8859 character set can form an identifier.
-*/
-static const char isIdChar[] = {
-/* x0 x1 x2 x3 x4 x5 x6 x7 x8 x9 xA xB xC xD xE xF */
- 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 0x */
- 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 1x */
- 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 2x */
- 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 3x */
- 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, /* 4x */
- 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, /* 5x */
- 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, /* 6x */
- 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 7x */
-};
-
-
-/*
-** Return the length of the token that begins at z[0].
-** Store the token type in *tokenType before returning.
-*/
-static int sqliteGetToken(const unsigned char *z, int *tokenType){
- int i;
- switch( *z ){
- case ' ': case '\t': case '\n': case '\f': case '\r': {
- for(i=1; isspace(z[i]); i++){}
- *tokenType = TK_SPACE;
- return i;
- }
- case '-': {
- if( z[1]=='-' ){
- for(i=2; z[i] && z[i]!='\n'; i++){}
- *tokenType = TK_COMMENT;
- return i;
- }
- *tokenType = TK_MINUS;
- return 1;
- }
- case '(': {
- *tokenType = TK_LP;
- return 1;
- }
- case ')': {
- *tokenType = TK_RP;
- return 1;
- }
- case ';': {
- *tokenType = TK_SEMI;
- return 1;
- }
- case '+': {
- *tokenType = TK_PLUS;
- return 1;
- }
- case '*': {
- *tokenType = TK_STAR;
- return 1;
- }
- case '/': {
- if( z[1]!='*' || z[2]==0 ){
- *tokenType = TK_SLASH;
- return 1;
- }
- for(i=3; z[i] && (z[i]!='/' || z[i-1]!='*'); i++){}
- if( z[i] ) i++;
- *tokenType = TK_COMMENT;
- return i;
- }
- case '%': {
- *tokenType = TK_REM;
- return 1;
- }
- case '=': {
- *tokenType = TK_EQ;
- return 1 + (z[1]=='=');
- }
- case '<': {
- if( z[1]=='=' ){
- *tokenType = TK_LE;
- return 2;
- }else if( z[1]=='>' ){
- *tokenType = TK_NE;
- return 2;
- }else if( z[1]=='<' ){
- *tokenType = TK_LSHIFT;
- return 2;
- }else{
- *tokenType = TK_LT;
- return 1;
- }
- }
- case '>': {
- if( z[1]=='=' ){
- *tokenType = TK_GE;
- return 2;
- }else if( z[1]=='>' ){
- *tokenType = TK_RSHIFT;
- return 2;
- }else{
- *tokenType = TK_GT;
- return 1;
- }
- }
- case '!': {
- if( z[1]!='=' ){
- *tokenType = TK_ILLEGAL;
- return 2;
- }else{
- *tokenType = TK_NE;
- return 2;
- }
- }
- case '|': {
- if( z[1]!='|' ){
- *tokenType = TK_BITOR;
- return 1;
- }else{
- *tokenType = TK_CONCAT;
- return 2;
- }
- }
- case ',': {
- *tokenType = TK_COMMA;
- return 1;
- }
- case '&': {
- *tokenType = TK_BITAND;
- return 1;
- }
- case '~': {
- *tokenType = TK_BITNOT;
- return 1;
- }
- case '\'': case '"': {
- int delim = z[0];
- for(i=1; z[i]; i++){
- if( z[i]==delim ){
- if( z[i+1]==delim ){
- i++;
- }else{
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- if( z[i] ) i++;
- *tokenType = TK_STRING;
- return i;
- }
- case '.': {
- *tokenType = TK_DOT;
- return 1;
- }
- case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4':
- case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9': {
- *tokenType = TK_INTEGER;
- for(i=1; isdigit(z[i]); i++){}
- if( z[i]=='.' && isdigit(z[i+1]) ){
- i += 2;
- while( isdigit(z[i]) ){ i++; }
- *tokenType = TK_FLOAT;
- }
- if( (z[i]=='e' || z[i]=='E') &&
- ( isdigit(z[i+1])
- || ((z[i+1]=='+' || z[i+1]=='-') && isdigit(z[i+2]))
- )
- ){
- i += 2;
- while( isdigit(z[i]) ){ i++; }
- *tokenType = TK_FLOAT;
- }
- return i;
- }
- case '[': {
- for(i=1; z[i] && z[i-1]!=']'; i++){}
- *tokenType = TK_ID;
- return i;
- }
- case '?': {
- *tokenType = TK_VARIABLE;
- return 1;
- }
- default: {
- if( (*z&0x80)==0 && !isIdChar[*z] ){
- break;
- }
- for(i=1; (z[i]&0x80)!=0 || isIdChar[z[i]]; i++){}
- *tokenType = sqliteKeywordCode((char*)z, i);
- return i;
- }
- }
- *tokenType = TK_ILLEGAL;
- return 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Run the parser on the given SQL string. The parser structure is
-** passed in. An STQLITE_ status code is returned. If an error occurs
-** and pzErrMsg!=NULL then an error message might be written into
-** memory obtained from malloc() and *pzErrMsg made to point to that
-** error message. Or maybe not.
-*/
-int sqliteRunParser(Parse *pParse, const char *zSql, char **pzErrMsg){
- int nErr = 0;
- int i;
- void *pEngine;
- int tokenType;
- int lastTokenParsed = -1;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- extern void *sqliteParserAlloc(void*(*)(int));
- extern void sqliteParserFree(void*, void(*)(void*));
- extern int sqliteParser(void*, int, Token, Parse*);
-
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_Interrupt;
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_OK;
- i = 0;
- pEngine = sqliteParserAlloc((void*(*)(int))malloc);
- if( pEngine==0 ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "out of memory", (char*)0);
- return 1;
- }
- pParse->sLastToken.dyn = 0;
- pParse->zTail = zSql;
- while( sqlite_malloc_failed==0 && zSql[i]!=0 ){
- assert( i>=0 );
- pParse->sLastToken.z = &zSql[i];
- assert( pParse->sLastToken.dyn==0 );
- pParse->sLastToken.n = sqliteGetToken((unsigned char*)&zSql[i], &tokenType);
- i += pParse->sLastToken.n;
- switch( tokenType ){
- case TK_SPACE:
- case TK_COMMENT: {
- if( (db->flags & STQLITE_Interrupt)!=0 ){
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_INTERRUPT;
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "interrupt", (char*)0);
- goto abort_parse;
- }
- break;
- }
- case TK_ILLEGAL: {
- sqliteSetNString(pzErrMsg, "unrecognized token: \"", -1,
- pParse->sLastToken.z, pParse->sLastToken.n, "\"", 1, 0);
- nErr++;
- goto abort_parse;
- }
- case TK_SEMI: {
- pParse->zTail = &zSql[i];
- /* Fall thru into the default case */
- }
- default: {
- sqliteParser(pEngine, tokenType, pParse->sLastToken, pParse);
- lastTokenParsed = tokenType;
- if( pParse->rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- goto abort_parse;
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-abort_parse:
- if( zSql[i]==0 && nErr==0 && pParse->rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- if( lastTokenParsed!=TK_SEMI ){
- sqliteParser(pEngine, TK_SEMI, pParse->sLastToken, pParse);
- pParse->zTail = &zSql[i];
- }
- sqliteParser(pEngine, 0, pParse->sLastToken, pParse);
- }
- sqliteParserFree(pEngine, free);
- if( pParse->rc!=STQLITE_OK && pParse->rc!=STQLITE_DONE && pParse->zErrMsg==0 ){
- sqliteSetString(&pParse->zErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(pParse->rc),
- (char*)0);
- }
- if( pParse->zErrMsg ){
- if( pzErrMsg && *pzErrMsg==0 ){
- *pzErrMsg = pParse->zErrMsg;
- }else{
- sqliteFree(pParse->zErrMsg);
- }
- pParse->zErrMsg = 0;
- if( !nErr ) nErr++;
- }
- if( pParse->pVdbe && pParse->nErr>0 ){
- sqliteVdbeDelete(pParse->pVdbe);
- pParse->pVdbe = 0;
- }
- if( pParse->pNewTable ){
- sqliteDeleteTable(pParse->db, pParse->pNewTable);
- pParse->pNewTable = 0;
- }
- if( pParse->pNewTrigger ){
- sqliteDeleteTrigger(pParse->pNewTrigger);
- pParse->pNewTrigger = 0;
- }
- if( nErr>0 && (pParse->rc==STQLITE_OK || pParse->rc==STQLITE_DONE) ){
- pParse->rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- return nErr;
-}
-
-/*
-** Token types used by the sqlite_complete() routine. See the header
-** comments on that procedure for additional information.
-*/
-#define tkEXPLAIN 0
-#define tkCREATE 1
-#define tkTEMP 2
-#define tkTRIGGER 3
-#define tkEND 4
-#define tkSEMI 5
-#define tkWS 6
-#define tkOTHER 7
-
-/*
-** Return TRUE if the given SQL string ends in a semicolon.
-**
-** Special handling is require for CREATE TRIGGER statements.
-** Whenever the CREATE TRIGGER keywords are seen, the statement
-** must end with ";END;".
-**
-** This implementation uses a state machine with 7 states:
-**
-** (0) START At the beginning or end of an SQL statement. This routine
-** returns 1 if it ends in the START state and 0 if it ends
-** in any other state.
-**
-** (1) EXPLAIN The keyword EXPLAIN has been seen at the beginning of
-** a statement.
-**
-** (2) CREATE The keyword CREATE has been seen at the beginning of a
-** statement, possibly preceeded by EXPLAIN and/or followed by
-** TEMP or TEMPORARY
-**
-** (3) NORMAL We are in the middle of statement which ends with a single
-** semicolon.
-**
-** (4) TRIGGER We are in the middle of a trigger definition that must be
-** ended by a semicolon, the keyword END, and another semicolon.
-**
-** (5) SEMI We've seen the first semicolon in the ";END;" that occurs at
-** the end of a trigger definition.
-**
-** (6) END We've seen the ";END" of the ";END;" that occurs at the end
-** of a trigger difinition.
-**
-** Transitions between states above are determined by tokens extracted
-** from the input. The following tokens are significant:
-**
-** (0) tkEXPLAIN The "explain" keyword.
-** (1) tkCREATE The "create" keyword.
-** (2) tkTEMP The "temp" or "temporary" keyword.
-** (3) tkTRIGGER The "trigger" keyword.
-** (4) tkEND The "end" keyword.
-** (5) tkSEMI A semicolon.
-** (6) tkWS Whitespace
-** (7) tkOTHER Any other SQL token.
-**
-** Whitespace never causes a state transition and is always ignored.
-*/
-int sqlite_complete(const char *zSql){
- u8 state = 0; /* Current state, using numbers defined in header comment */
- u8 token; /* Value of the next token */
-
- /* The following matrix defines the transition from one state to another
- ** according to what token is seen. trans[state][token] returns the
- ** next state.
- */
- static const u8 trans[7][8] = {
- /* Token: */
- /* State: ** EXPLAIN CREATE TEMP TRIGGER END SEMI WS OTHER */
- /* 0 START: */ { 1, 2, 3, 3, 3, 0, 0, 3, },
- /* 1 EXPLAIN: */ { 3, 2, 3, 3, 3, 0, 1, 3, },
- /* 2 CREATE: */ { 3, 3, 2, 4, 3, 0, 2, 3, },
- /* 3 NORMAL: */ { 3, 3, 3, 3, 3, 0, 3, 3, },
- /* 4 TRIGGER: */ { 4, 4, 4, 4, 4, 5, 4, 4, },
- /* 5 SEMI: */ { 4, 4, 4, 4, 6, 5, 5, 4, },
- /* 6 END: */ { 4, 4, 4, 4, 4, 0, 6, 4, },
- };
-
- while( *zSql ){
- switch( *zSql ){
- case ';': { /* A semicolon */
- token = tkSEMI;
- break;
- }
- case ' ':
- case '\r':
- case '\t':
- case '\n':
- case '\f': { /* White space is ignored */
- token = tkWS;
- break;
- }
- case '/': { /* C-style comments */
- if( zSql[1]!='*' ){
- token = tkOTHER;
- break;
- }
- zSql += 2;
- while( zSql[0] && (zSql[0]!='*' || zSql[1]!='/') ){ zSql++; }
- if( zSql[0]==0 ) return 0;
- zSql++;
- token = tkWS;
- break;
- }
- case '-': { /* SQL-style comments from "--" to end of line */
- if( zSql[1]!='-' ){
- token = tkOTHER;
- break;
- }
- while( *zSql && *zSql!='\n' ){ zSql++; }
- if( *zSql==0 ) return state==0;
- token = tkWS;
- break;
- }
- case '[': { /* Microsoft-style identifiers in [...] */
- zSql++;
- while( *zSql && *zSql!=']' ){ zSql++; }
- if( *zSql==0 ) return 0;
- token = tkOTHER;
- break;
- }
- case '"': /* single- and double-quoted strings */
- case '\'': {
- int c = *zSql;
- zSql++;
- while( *zSql && *zSql!=c ){ zSql++; }
- if( *zSql==0 ) return 0;
- token = tkOTHER;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- if( isIdChar[(u8)*zSql] ){
- /* Keywords and unquoted identifiers */
- int nId;
- for(nId=1; isIdChar[(u8)zSql[nId]]; nId++){}
- switch( *zSql ){
- case 'c': case 'C': {
- if( nId==6 && sqliteStrNICmp(zSql, "create", 6)==0 ){
- token = tkCREATE;
- }else{
- token = tkOTHER;
- }
- break;
- }
- case 't': case 'T': {
- if( nId==7 && sqliteStrNICmp(zSql, "trigger", 7)==0 ){
- token = tkTRIGGER;
- }else if( nId==4 && sqliteStrNICmp(zSql, "temp", 4)==0 ){
- token = tkTEMP;
- }else if( nId==9 && sqliteStrNICmp(zSql, "temporary", 9)==0 ){
- token = tkTEMP;
- }else{
- token = tkOTHER;
- }
- break;
- }
- case 'e': case 'E': {
- if( nId==3 && sqliteStrNICmp(zSql, "end", 3)==0 ){
- token = tkEND;
- }else if( nId==7 && sqliteStrNICmp(zSql, "explain", 7)==0 ){
- token = tkEXPLAIN;
- }else{
- token = tkOTHER;
- }
- break;
- }
- default: {
- token = tkOTHER;
- break;
- }
- }
- zSql += nId-1;
- }else{
- /* Operators and special symbols */
- token = tkOTHER;
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- state = trans[state][token];
- zSql++;
- }
- return state==0;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/trigger.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/trigger.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 1d4fcd4..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/trigger.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,764 +0,0 @@
-/*
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-*
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-/*
-** Delete a linked list of TriggerStep structures.
-*/
-void sqliteDeleteTriggerStep(TriggerStep *pTriggerStep){
- while( pTriggerStep ){
- TriggerStep * pTmp = pTriggerStep;
- pTriggerStep = pTriggerStep->pNext;
-
- if( pTmp->target.dyn ) sqliteFree((char*)pTmp->target.z);
- sqliteExprDelete(pTmp->pWhere);
- sqliteExprListDelete(pTmp->pExprList);
- sqliteSelectDelete(pTmp->pSelect);
- sqliteIdListDelete(pTmp->pIdList);
-
- sqliteFree(pTmp);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** This is called by the parser when it sees a CREATE TRIGGER statement
-** up to the point of the BEGIN before the trigger actions. A Trigger
-** structure is generated based on the information available and stored
-** in pParse->pNewTrigger. After the trigger actions have been parsed, the
-** sqliteFinishTrigger() function is called to complete the trigger
-** construction process.
-*/
-void sqliteBeginTrigger(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parse context of the CREATE TRIGGER statement */
- Token *pName, /* The name of the trigger */
- int tr_tm, /* One of TK_BEFORE, TK_AFTER, TK_INSTEAD */
- int op, /* One of TK_INSERT, TK_UPDATE, TK_DELETE */
- IdList *pColumns, /* column list if this is an UPDATE OF trigger */
- SrcList *pTableName,/* The name of the table/view the trigger applies to */
- int foreach, /* One of TK_ROW or TK_STATEMENT */
- Expr *pWhen, /* WHEN clause */
- int isTemp /* True if the TEMPORARY keyword is present */
-){
- Trigger *nt;
- Table *tab;
- char *zName = 0; /* Name of the trigger */
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
- int iDb; /* When database to store the trigger in */
- DbFixer sFix;
-
- /* Check that:
- ** 1. the trigger name does not already exist.
- ** 2. the table (or view) does exist in the same database as the trigger.
- ** 3. that we are not trying to create a trigger on the sqlite_master table
- ** 4. That we are not trying to create an INSTEAD OF trigger on a table.
- ** 5. That we are not trying to create a BEFORE or AFTER trigger on a view.
- */
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto trigger_cleanup;
- assert( pTableName->nSrc==1 );
- if( db->init.busy
- && sqliteFixInit(&sFix, pParse, db->init.iDb, "trigger", pName)
- && sqliteFixSrcList(&sFix, pTableName)
- ){
- goto trigger_cleanup;
- }
- tab = sqliteSrcListLookup(pParse, pTableName);
- if( !tab ){
- goto trigger_cleanup;
- }
- iDb = isTemp ? 1 : tab->iDb;
- if( iDb>=2 && !db->init.busy ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "triggers may not be added to auxiliary "
- "database %s", db->aDb[tab->iDb].zName);
- goto trigger_cleanup;
- }
-
- zName = sqliteStrNDup(pName->z, pName->n);
- sqliteDequote(zName);
- if( sqliteHashFind(&(db->aDb[iDb].trigHash), zName,pName->n+1) ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "trigger %T already exists", pName);
- goto trigger_cleanup;
- }
- if( sqliteStrNICmp(tab->zName, "sqlite_", 7)==0 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot create trigger on system table");
- pParse->nErr++;
- goto trigger_cleanup;
- }
- if( tab->pSelect && tr_tm != TK_INSTEAD ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot create %s trigger on view: %S",
- (tr_tm == TK_BEFORE)?"BEFORE":"AFTER", pTableName, 0);
- goto trigger_cleanup;
- }
- if( !tab->pSelect && tr_tm == TK_INSTEAD ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "cannot create INSTEAD OF"
- " trigger on table: %S", pTableName, 0);
- goto trigger_cleanup;
- }
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- {
- int code = STQLITE_CREATE_TRIGGER;
- const char *zDb = db->aDb[tab->iDb].zName;
- const char *zDbTrig = isTemp ? db->aDb[1].zName : zDb;
- if( tab->iDb==1 || isTemp ) code = STQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_TRIGGER;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, code, zName, tab->zName, zDbTrig) ){
- goto trigger_cleanup;
- }
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_INSERT, SCHEMA_TABLE(tab->iDb), 0, zDb)){
- goto trigger_cleanup;
- }
- }
-#endif
-
- /* INSTEAD OF triggers can only appear on views and BEGIN triggers
- ** cannot appear on views. So we might as well translate every
- ** INSTEAD OF trigger into a BEFORE trigger. It simplifies code
- ** elsewhere.
- */
- if (tr_tm == TK_INSTEAD){
- tr_tm = TK_BEFORE;
- }
-
- /* Build the Trigger object */
- nt = (Trigger*)sqliteMalloc(sizeof(Trigger));
- if( nt==0 ) goto trigger_cleanup;
- nt->name = zName;
- zName = 0;
- nt->table = sqliteStrDup(pTableName->a[0].zName);
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto trigger_cleanup;
- nt->iDb = iDb;
- nt->iTabDb = tab->iDb;
- nt->op = op;
- nt->tr_tm = tr_tm;
- nt->pWhen = sqliteExprDup(pWhen);
- nt->pColumns = sqliteIdListDup(pColumns);
- nt->foreach = foreach;
- sqliteTokenCopy(&nt->nameToken,pName);
- assert( pParse->pNewTrigger==0 );
- pParse->pNewTrigger = nt;
-
-trigger_cleanup:
- sqliteFree(zName);
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pTableName);
- sqliteIdListDelete(pColumns);
- sqliteExprDelete(pWhen);
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is called after all of the trigger actions have been parsed
-** in order to complete the process of building the trigger.
-*/
-void sqliteFinishTrigger(
- Parse *pParse, /* Parser context */
- TriggerStep *pStepList, /* The triggered program */
- Token *pAll /* Token that describes the complete CREATE TRIGGER */
-){
- Trigger *nt = 0; /* The trigger whose construction is finishing up */
- sqlite *db = pParse->db; /* The database */
- DbFixer sFix;
-
- if( pParse->nErr || pParse->pNewTrigger==0 ) goto triggerfinish_cleanup;
- nt = pParse->pNewTrigger;
- pParse->pNewTrigger = 0;
- nt->step_list = pStepList;
- while( pStepList ){
- pStepList->pTrig = nt;
- pStepList = pStepList->pNext;
- }
- if( sqliteFixInit(&sFix, pParse, nt->iDb, "trigger", &nt->nameToken)
- && sqliteFixTriggerStep(&sFix, nt->step_list) ){
- goto triggerfinish_cleanup;
- }
-
- /* if we are not initializing, and this trigger is not on a TEMP table,
- ** build the sqlite_master entry
- */
- if( !db->init.busy ){
- static VdbeOpList insertTrig[] = {
- { OP_NewRecno, 0, 0, 0 },
- { OP_String, 0, 0, "trigger" },
- { OP_String, 0, 0, 0 }, /* 2: trigger name */
- { OP_String, 0, 0, 0 }, /* 3: table name */
- { OP_Integer, 0, 0, 0 },
- { OP_String, 0, 0, 0 }, /* 5: SQL */
- { OP_MakeRecord, 5, 0, 0 },
- { OP_PutIntKey, 0, 0, 0 },
- };
- int addr;
- Vdbe *v;
-
- /* Make an entry in the sqlite_master table */
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) goto triggerfinish_cleanup;
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 0, 0);
- sqliteOpenMasterTable(v, nt->iDb);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(insertTrig), insertTrig);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, addr+2, nt->name, 0);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, addr+3, nt->table, 0);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, addr+5, pAll->z, pAll->n);
- if( nt->iDb==0 ){
- sqliteChangeCookie(db, v);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, 0, 0);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- }
-
- if( !pParse->explain ){
- Table *pTab;
- sqliteHashInsert(&db->aDb[nt->iDb].trigHash,
- nt->name, strlen(nt->name)+1, nt);
- pTab = sqliteLocateTable(pParse, nt->table, db->aDb[nt->iTabDb].zName);
- assert( pTab!=0 );
- nt->pNext = pTab->pTrigger;
- pTab->pTrigger = nt;
- nt = 0;
- }
-
-triggerfinish_cleanup:
- sqliteDeleteTrigger(nt);
- sqliteDeleteTrigger(pParse->pNewTrigger);
- pParse->pNewTrigger = 0;
- sqliteDeleteTriggerStep(pStepList);
-}
-
-/*
-** Make a copy of all components of the given trigger step. This has
-** the effect of copying all Expr.token.z values into memory obtained
-** from sqliteMalloc(). As initially created, the Expr.token.z values
-** all point to the input string that was fed to the parser. But that
-** string is ephemeral - it will go away as soon as the sqlite_exec()
-** call that started the parser exits. This routine makes a persistent
-** copy of all the Expr.token.z strings so that the TriggerStep structure
-** will be valid even after the sqlite_exec() call returns.
-*/
-static void sqlitePersistTriggerStep(TriggerStep *p){
- if( p->target.z ){
- p->target.z = sqliteStrNDup(p->target.z, p->target.n);
- p->target.dyn = 1;
- }
- if( p->pSelect ){
- Select *pNew = sqliteSelectDup(p->pSelect);
- sqliteSelectDelete(p->pSelect);
- p->pSelect = pNew;
- }
- if( p->pWhere ){
- Expr *pNew = sqliteExprDup(p->pWhere);
- sqliteExprDelete(p->pWhere);
- p->pWhere = pNew;
- }
- if( p->pExprList ){
- ExprList *pNew = sqliteExprListDup(p->pExprList);
- sqliteExprListDelete(p->pExprList);
- p->pExprList = pNew;
- }
- if( p->pIdList ){
- IdList *pNew = sqliteIdListDup(p->pIdList);
- sqliteIdListDelete(p->pIdList);
- p->pIdList = pNew;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Turn a SELECT statement (that the pSelect parameter points to) into
-** a trigger step. Return a pointer to a TriggerStep structure.
-**
-** The parser calls this routine when it finds a SELECT statement in
-** body of a TRIGGER.
-*/
-TriggerStep *sqliteTriggerSelectStep(Select *pSelect){
- TriggerStep *pTriggerStep = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(TriggerStep));
- if( pTriggerStep==0 ) return 0;
-
- pTriggerStep->op = TK_SELECT;
- pTriggerStep->pSelect = pSelect;
- pTriggerStep->orconf = OE_Default;
- sqlitePersistTriggerStep(pTriggerStep);
-
- return pTriggerStep;
-}
-
-/*
-** Build a trigger step out of an INSERT statement. Return a pointer
-** to the new trigger step.
-**
-** The parser calls this routine when it sees an INSERT inside the
-** body of a trigger.
-*/
-TriggerStep *sqliteTriggerInsertStep(
- Token *pTableName, /* Name of the table into which we insert */
- IdList *pColumn, /* List of columns in pTableName to insert into */
- ExprList *pEList, /* The VALUE clause: a list of values to be inserted */
- Select *pSelect, /* A SELECT statement that supplies values */
- int orconf /* The conflict algorithm (OE_Abort, OE_Replace, etc.) */
-){
- TriggerStep *pTriggerStep = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(TriggerStep));
- if( pTriggerStep==0 ) return 0;
-
- assert(pEList == 0 || pSelect == 0);
- assert(pEList != 0 || pSelect != 0);
-
- pTriggerStep->op = TK_INSERT;
- pTriggerStep->pSelect = pSelect;
- pTriggerStep->target = *pTableName;
- pTriggerStep->pIdList = pColumn;
- pTriggerStep->pExprList = pEList;
- pTriggerStep->orconf = orconf;
- sqlitePersistTriggerStep(pTriggerStep);
-
- return pTriggerStep;
-}
-
-/*
-** Construct a trigger step that implements an UPDATE statement and return
-** a pointer to that trigger step. The parser calls this routine when it
-** sees an UPDATE statement inside the body of a CREATE TRIGGER.
-*/
-TriggerStep *sqliteTriggerUpdateStep(
- Token *pTableName, /* Name of the table to be updated */
- ExprList *pEList, /* The SET clause: list of column and new values */
- Expr *pWhere, /* The WHERE clause */
- int orconf /* The conflict algorithm. (OE_Abort, OE_Ignore, etc) */
-){
- TriggerStep *pTriggerStep = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(TriggerStep));
- if( pTriggerStep==0 ) return 0;
-
- pTriggerStep->op = TK_UPDATE;
- pTriggerStep->target = *pTableName;
- pTriggerStep->pExprList = pEList;
- pTriggerStep->pWhere = pWhere;
- pTriggerStep->orconf = orconf;
- sqlitePersistTriggerStep(pTriggerStep);
-
- return pTriggerStep;
-}
-
-/*
-** Construct a trigger step that implements a DELETE statement and return
-** a pointer to that trigger step. The parser calls this routine when it
-** sees a DELETE statement inside the body of a CREATE TRIGGER.
-*/
-TriggerStep *sqliteTriggerDeleteStep(Token *pTableName, Expr *pWhere){
- TriggerStep *pTriggerStep = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(TriggerStep));
- if( pTriggerStep==0 ) return 0;
-
- pTriggerStep->op = TK_DELETE;
- pTriggerStep->target = *pTableName;
- pTriggerStep->pWhere = pWhere;
- pTriggerStep->orconf = OE_Default;
- sqlitePersistTriggerStep(pTriggerStep);
-
- return pTriggerStep;
-}
-
-/*
-** Recursively delete a Trigger structure
-*/
-void sqliteDeleteTrigger(Trigger *pTrigger){
- if( pTrigger==0 ) return;
- sqliteDeleteTriggerStep(pTrigger->step_list);
- sqliteFree(pTrigger->name);
- sqliteFree(pTrigger->table);
- sqliteExprDelete(pTrigger->pWhen);
- sqliteIdListDelete(pTrigger->pColumns);
- if( pTrigger->nameToken.dyn ) sqliteFree((char*)pTrigger->nameToken.z);
- sqliteFree(pTrigger);
-}
-
-/*
- * This function is called to drop a trigger from the database schema.
- *
- * This may be called directly from the parser and therefore identifies
- * the trigger by name. The sqliteDropTriggerPtr() routine does the
- * same job as this routine except it take a spointer to the trigger
- * instead of the trigger name.
- *
- * Note that this function does not delete the trigger entirely. Instead it
- * removes it from the internal schema and places it in the trigDrop hash
- * table. This is so that the trigger can be restored into the database schema
- * if the transaction is rolled back.
- */
-void sqliteDropTrigger(Parse *pParse, SrcList *pName){
- Trigger *pTrigger;
- int i;
- const char *zDb;
- const char *zName;
- int nName;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
-
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto drop_trigger_cleanup;
- assert( pName->nSrc==1 );
- zDb = pName->a[0].zDatabase;
- zName = pName->a[0].zName;
- nName = strlen(zName);
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- int j = (i<2) ? i^1 : i; /* Search TEMP before MAIN */
- if( zDb && sqliteStrICmp(db->aDb[j].zName, zDb) ) continue;
- pTrigger = sqliteHashFind(&(db->aDb[j].trigHash), zName, nName+1);
- if( pTrigger ) break;
- }
- if( !pTrigger ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "no such trigger: %S", pName, 0);
- goto drop_trigger_cleanup;
- }
- sqliteDropTriggerPtr(pParse, pTrigger, 0);
-
-drop_trigger_cleanup:
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pName);
-}
-
-/*
-** Drop a trigger given a pointer to that trigger. If nested is false,
-** then also generate code to remove the trigger from the STQLITE_MASTER
-** table.
-*/
-void sqliteDropTriggerPtr(Parse *pParse, Trigger *pTrigger, int nested){
- Table *pTable;
- Vdbe *v;
- sqlite *db = pParse->db;
-
- assert( pTrigger->iDb<db->nDb );
- if( pTrigger->iDb>=2 ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "triggers may not be removed from "
- "auxiliary database %s", db->aDb[pTrigger->iDb].zName);
- return;
- }
- pTable = sqliteFindTable(db, pTrigger->table,db->aDb[pTrigger->iTabDb].zName);
- assert(pTable);
- assert( pTable->iDb==pTrigger->iDb || pTrigger->iDb==1 );
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- {
- int code = STQLITE_DROP_TRIGGER;
- const char *zDb = db->aDb[pTrigger->iDb].zName;
- const char *zTab = SCHEMA_TABLE(pTrigger->iDb);
- if( pTrigger->iDb ) code = STQLITE_DROP_TEMP_TRIGGER;
- if( sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, code, pTrigger->name, pTable->zName, zDb) ||
- sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_DELETE, zTab, 0, zDb) ){
- return;
- }
- }
-#endif
-
- /* Generate code to destroy the database record of the trigger.
- */
- if( pTable!=0 && !nested && (v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse))!=0 ){
- int base;
- static VdbeOpList dropTrigger[] = {
- { OP_Rewind, 0, ADDR(9), 0},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, 0}, /* 1 */
- { OP_Column, 0, 1, 0},
- { OP_Ne, 0, ADDR(8), 0},
- { OP_String, 0, 0, "trigger"},
- { OP_Column, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_Ne, 0, ADDR(8), 0},
- { OP_Delete, 0, 0, 0},
- { OP_Next, 0, ADDR(1), 0}, /* 8 */
- };
-
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 0, 0);
- sqliteOpenMasterTable(v, pTrigger->iDb);
- base = sqliteVdbeAddOpList(v, ArraySize(dropTrigger), dropTrigger);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(v, base+1, pTrigger->name, 0);
- if( pTrigger->iDb==0 ){
- sqliteChangeCookie(db, v);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, 0, 0);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
- }
-
- /*
- * If this is not an "explain", then delete the trigger structure.
- */
- if( !pParse->explain ){
- const char *zName = pTrigger->name;
- int nName = strlen(zName);
- if( pTable->pTrigger == pTrigger ){
- pTable->pTrigger = pTrigger->pNext;
- }else{
- Trigger *cc = pTable->pTrigger;
- while( cc ){
- if( cc->pNext == pTrigger ){
- cc->pNext = cc->pNext->pNext;
- break;
- }
- cc = cc->pNext;
- }
- assert(cc);
- }
- sqliteHashInsert(&(db->aDb[pTrigger->iDb].trigHash), zName, nName+1, 0);
- sqliteDeleteTrigger(pTrigger);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** pEList is the SET clause of an UPDATE statement. Each entry
-** in pEList is of the format <id>=<expr>. If any of the entries
-** in pEList have an <id> which matches an identifier in pIdList,
-** then return TRUE. If pIdList==NULL, then it is considered a
-** wildcard that matches anything. Likewise if pEList==NULL then
-** it matches anything so always return true. Return false only
-** if there is no match.
-*/
-static int checkColumnOverLap(IdList *pIdList, ExprList *pEList){
- int e;
- if( !pIdList || !pEList ) return 1;
- for(e=0; e<pEList->nExpr; e++){
- if( sqliteIdListIndex(pIdList, pEList->a[e].zName)>=0 ) return 1;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/* A global variable that is TRUE if we should always set up temp tables for
- * for triggers, even if there are no triggers to code. This is used to test
- * how much overhead the triggers algorithm is causing.
- *
- * This flag can be set or cleared using the "trigger_overhead_test" pragma.
- * The pragma is not documented since it is not really part of the interface
- * to STQLite, just the test procedure.
-*/
-int always_code_trigger_setup = 0;
-
-/*
- * Returns true if a trigger matching op, tr_tm and foreach that is NOT already
- * on the Parse objects trigger-stack (to prevent recursive trigger firing) is
- * found in the list specified as pTrigger.
- */
-int sqliteTriggersExist(
- Parse *pParse, /* Used to check for recursive triggers */
- Trigger *pTrigger, /* A list of triggers associated with a table */
- int op, /* one of TK_DELETE, TK_INSERT, TK_UPDATE */
- int tr_tm, /* one of TK_BEFORE, TK_AFTER */
- int foreach, /* one of TK_ROW or TK_STATEMENT */
- ExprList *pChanges /* Columns that change in an UPDATE statement */
-){
- Trigger * pTriggerCursor;
-
- if( always_code_trigger_setup ){
- return 1;
- }
-
- pTriggerCursor = pTrigger;
- while( pTriggerCursor ){
- if( pTriggerCursor->op == op &&
- pTriggerCursor->tr_tm == tr_tm &&
- pTriggerCursor->foreach == foreach &&
- checkColumnOverLap(pTriggerCursor->pColumns, pChanges) ){
- TriggerStack * ss;
- ss = pParse->trigStack;
- while( ss && ss->pTrigger != pTrigger ){
- ss = ss->pNext;
- }
- if( !ss )return 1;
- }
- pTriggerCursor = pTriggerCursor->pNext;
- }
-
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Convert the pStep->target token into a SrcList and return a pointer
-** to that SrcList.
-**
-** This routine adds a specific database name, if needed, to the target when
-** forming the SrcList. This prevents a trigger in one database from
-** referring to a target in another database. An exception is when the
-** trigger is in TEMP in which case it can refer to any other database it
-** wants.
-*/
-static SrcList *targetSrcList(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parsing context */
- TriggerStep *pStep /* The trigger containing the target token */
-){
- Token sDb; /* Dummy database name token */
- int iDb; /* Index of the database to use */
- SrcList *pSrc; /* SrcList to be returned */
-
- iDb = pStep->pTrig->iDb;
- if( iDb==0 || iDb>=2 ){
- assert( iDb<pParse->db->nDb );
- sDb.z = pParse->db->aDb[iDb].zName;
- sDb.n = strlen(sDb.z);
- pSrc = sqliteSrcListAppend(0, &sDb, &pStep->target);
- } else {
- pSrc = sqliteSrcListAppend(0, &pStep->target, 0);
- }
- return pSrc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate VDBE code for zero or more statements inside the body of a
-** trigger.
-*/
-static int codeTriggerProgram(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- TriggerStep *pStepList, /* List of statements inside the trigger body */
- int orconfin /* Conflict algorithm. (OE_Abort, etc) */
-){
- TriggerStep * pTriggerStep = pStepList;
- int orconf;
-
- while( pTriggerStep ){
- int saveNTab = pParse->nTab;
-
- orconf = (orconfin == OE_Default)?pTriggerStep->orconf:orconfin;
- pParse->trigStack->orconf = orconf;
- switch( pTriggerStep->op ){
- case TK_SELECT: {
- Select * ss = sqliteSelectDup(pTriggerStep->pSelect);
- assert(ss);
- assert(ss->pSrc);
- sqliteSelect(pParse, ss, SRT_Discard, 0, 0, 0, 0);
- sqliteSelectDelete(ss);
- break;
- }
- case TK_UPDATE: {
- SrcList *pSrc;
- pSrc = targetSrcList(pParse, pTriggerStep);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(pParse->pVdbe, OP_ListPush, 0, 0);
- sqliteUpdate(pParse, pSrc,
- sqliteExprListDup(pTriggerStep->pExprList),
- sqliteExprDup(pTriggerStep->pWhere), orconf);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(pParse->pVdbe, OP_ListPop, 0, 0);
- break;
- }
- case TK_INSERT: {
- SrcList *pSrc;
- pSrc = targetSrcList(pParse, pTriggerStep);
- sqliteInsert(pParse, pSrc,
- sqliteExprListDup(pTriggerStep->pExprList),
- sqliteSelectDup(pTriggerStep->pSelect),
- sqliteIdListDup(pTriggerStep->pIdList), orconf);
- break;
- }
- case TK_DELETE: {
- SrcList *pSrc;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(pParse->pVdbe, OP_ListPush, 0, 0);
- pSrc = targetSrcList(pParse, pTriggerStep);
- sqliteDeleteFrom(pParse, pSrc, sqliteExprDup(pTriggerStep->pWhere));
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(pParse->pVdbe, OP_ListPop, 0, 0);
- break;
- }
- default:
- assert(0);
- }
- pParse->nTab = saveNTab;
- pTriggerStep = pTriggerStep->pNext;
- }
-
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** This is called to code FOR EACH ROW triggers.
-**
-** When the code that this function generates is executed, the following
-** must be true:
-**
-** 1. No cursors may be open in the main database. (But newIdx and oldIdx
-** can be indices of cursors in temporary tables. See below.)
-**
-** 2. If the triggers being coded are ON INSERT or ON UPDATE triggers, then
-** a temporary vdbe cursor (index newIdx) must be open and pointing at
-** a row containing values to be substituted for new.* expressions in the
-** trigger program(s).
-**
-** 3. If the triggers being coded are ON DELETE or ON UPDATE triggers, then
-** a temporary vdbe cursor (index oldIdx) must be open and pointing at
-** a row containing values to be substituted for old.* expressions in the
-** trigger program(s).
-**
-*/
-int sqliteCodeRowTrigger(
- Parse *pParse, /* Parse context */
- int op, /* One of TK_UPDATE, TK_INSERT, TK_DELETE */
- ExprList *pChanges, /* Changes list for any UPDATE OF triggers */
- int tr_tm, /* One of TK_BEFORE, TK_AFTER */
- Table *pTab, /* The table to code triggers from */
- int newIdx, /* The indice of the "new" row to access */
- int oldIdx, /* The indice of the "old" row to access */
- int orconf, /* ON CONFLICT policy */
- int ignoreJump /* Instruction to jump to for RAISE(IGNORE) */
-){
- Trigger * pTrigger;
- TriggerStack * pTriggerStack;
-
- assert(op == TK_UPDATE || op == TK_INSERT || op == TK_DELETE);
- assert(tr_tm == TK_BEFORE || tr_tm == TK_AFTER );
-
- assert(newIdx != -1 || oldIdx != -1);
-
- pTrigger = pTab->pTrigger;
- while( pTrigger ){
- int fire_this = 0;
-
- /* determine whether we should code this trigger */
- if( pTrigger->op == op && pTrigger->tr_tm == tr_tm &&
- pTrigger->foreach == TK_ROW ){
- fire_this = 1;
- pTriggerStack = pParse->trigStack;
- while( pTriggerStack ){
- if( pTriggerStack->pTrigger == pTrigger ){
- fire_this = 0;
- }
- pTriggerStack = pTriggerStack->pNext;
- }
- if( op == TK_UPDATE && pTrigger->pColumns &&
- !checkColumnOverLap(pTrigger->pColumns, pChanges) ){
- fire_this = 0;
- }
- }
-
- if( fire_this && (pTriggerStack = sqliteMalloc(sizeof(TriggerStack)))!=0 ){
- int endTrigger;
- SrcList dummyTablist;
- Expr * whenExpr;
- AuthContext sContext;
-
- dummyTablist.nSrc = 0;
-
- /* Push an entry on to the trigger stack */
- pTriggerStack->pTrigger = pTrigger;
- pTriggerStack->newIdx = newIdx;
- pTriggerStack->oldIdx = oldIdx;
- pTriggerStack->pTab = pTab;
- pTriggerStack->pNext = pParse->trigStack;
- pTriggerStack->ignoreJump = ignoreJump;
- pParse->trigStack = pTriggerStack;
- sqliteAuthContextPush(pParse, &sContext, pTrigger->name);
-
- /* code the WHEN clause */
- endTrigger = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(pParse->pVdbe);
- whenExpr = sqliteExprDup(pTrigger->pWhen);
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, &dummyTablist, 0, whenExpr) ){
- pParse->trigStack = pParse->trigStack->pNext;
- sqliteFree(pTriggerStack);
- sqliteExprDelete(whenExpr);
- return 1;
- }
- sqliteExprIfFalse(pParse, whenExpr, endTrigger, 1);
- sqliteExprDelete(whenExpr);
-
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(pParse->pVdbe, OP_ContextPush, 0, 0);
- codeTriggerProgram(pParse, pTrigger->step_list, orconf);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(pParse->pVdbe, OP_ContextPop, 0, 0);
-
- /* Pop the entry off the trigger stack */
- pParse->trigStack = pParse->trigStack->pNext;
- sqliteAuthContextPop(&sContext);
- sqliteFree(pTriggerStack);
-
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(pParse->pVdbe, endTrigger);
- }
- pTrigger = pTrigger->pNext;
- }
-
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/trolltech.patch b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/trolltech.patch
deleted file mode 100644
index cbafffb..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/trolltech.patch
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,39 +0,0 @@
-diff -du ./config.h /home/harald/troll/qt-3.3/src/3rdparty/sqlite/config.h
---- ./config.h 2004-03-30 19:13:22.000000000 +0200
-+++ /home/harald/troll/qt-3.3/src/3rdparty/sqlite/config.h 2004-01-08 14:29:23.000000000 +0100
-@@ -1 +1,23 @@
--#define SQLITE_PTR_SZ 4
-+#include <qglobal.h>
-+#include <qconfig.h>
-+
-+#ifndef QT_POINTER_SIZE
-+# ifdef Q_OS_WIN32
-+# define QT_POINTER_SIZE 4
-+# elif Q_OS_WIN64
-+# define QT_POINTER_SIZE 8
-+# else
-+# error This platform is unsupported
-+# endif
-+#endif /* QT_POINTER_SIZE */
-+
-+#define SQLITE_PTR_SZ QT_POINTER_SIZE
-+
-+#ifdef UNICODE
-+# undef UNICODE
-+#endif
-+
-+#ifdef Q_CC_MSVC
-+# pragma warning(disable: 4018)
-+# pragma warning(disable: 4761)
-+#endif
-diff -du ./os.h /home/harald/troll/qt-3.3/src/3rdparty/sqlite/os.h
---- ./os.h 2004-03-30 19:13:19.000000000 +0200
-+++ /home/harald/troll/qt-3.3/src/3rdparty/sqlite/os.h 2004-01-08 14:29:23.000000000 +0100
-@@ -17,6 +17,7 @@
- #ifndef _SQLITE_OS_H_
- #define _SQLITE_OS_H_
-
-+#include "config.h"
- /*
- ** Helpful hint: To get this to compile on HP/UX, add -D_INCLUDE_POSIX_SOURCE
- ** to the compiler command line.
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/update.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/update.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 8cbb500..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/update.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,452 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains C code routines that are called by the parser
-** to handle UPDATE statements.
-**
-** $Id: update.c,v 1.70 2004/02/22 20:05:02 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-/*
-** Process an UPDATE statement.
-**
-** UPDATE OR IGNORE table_wxyz SET a=b, c=d WHERE e<5 AND f NOT NULL;
-** \_______/ \________/ \______/ \________________/
-* onError pTabList pChanges pWhere
-*/
-void sqliteUpdate(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- SrcList *pTabList, /* The table in which we should change things */
- ExprList *pChanges, /* Things to be changed */
- Expr *pWhere, /* The WHERE clause. May be null */
- int onError /* How to handle constraint errors */
-){
- int i, j; /* Loop counters */
- Table *pTab; /* The table to be updated */
- int addr; /* VDBE instruction address of the start of the loop */
- WhereInfo *pWInfo; /* Information about the WHERE clause */
- Vdbe *v; /* The virtual database engine */
- Index *pIdx; /* For looping over indices */
- int nIdx; /* Number of indices that need updating */
- int nIdxTotal; /* Total number of indices */
- int iCur; /* VDBE Cursor number of pTab */
- sqlite *db; /* The database structure */
- Index **apIdx = 0; /* An array of indices that need updating too */
- char *aIdxUsed = 0; /* aIdxUsed[i]==1 if the i-th index is used */
- int *aXRef = 0; /* aXRef[i] is the index in pChanges->a[] of the
- ** an expression for the i-th column of the table.
- ** aXRef[i]==-1 if the i-th column is not changed. */
- int chngRecno; /* True if the record number is being changed */
- Expr *pRecnoExpr; /* Expression defining the new record number */
- int openAll; /* True if all indices need to be opened */
- int isView; /* Trying to update a view */
- AuthContext sContext; /* The authorization context */
-
- int before_triggers; /* True if there are any BEFORE triggers */
- int after_triggers; /* True if there are any AFTER triggers */
- int row_triggers_exist = 0; /* True if any row triggers exist */
-
- int newIdx = -1; /* index of trigger "new" temp table */
- int oldIdx = -1; /* index of trigger "old" temp table */
-
- sContext.pParse = 0;
- if( pParse->nErr || sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto update_cleanup;
- db = pParse->db;
- assert( pTabList->nSrc==1 );
-
- /* Locate the table which we want to update.
- */
- pTab = sqliteSrcListLookup(pParse, pTabList);
- if( pTab==0 ) goto update_cleanup;
- before_triggers = sqliteTriggersExist(pParse, pTab->pTrigger,
- TK_UPDATE, TK_BEFORE, TK_ROW, pChanges);
- after_triggers = sqliteTriggersExist(pParse, pTab->pTrigger,
- TK_UPDATE, TK_AFTER, TK_ROW, pChanges);
- row_triggers_exist = before_triggers || after_triggers;
- isView = pTab->pSelect!=0;
- if( sqliteIsReadOnly(pParse, pTab, before_triggers) ){
- goto update_cleanup;
- }
- if( isView ){
- if( sqliteViewGetColumnNames(pParse, pTab) ){
- goto update_cleanup;
- }
- }
- aXRef = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(int) * pTab->nCol );
- if( aXRef==0 ) goto update_cleanup;
- for(i=0; i<pTab->nCol; i++) aXRef[i] = -1;
-
- /* If there are FOR EACH ROW triggers, allocate cursors for the
- ** special OLD and NEW tables
- */
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- newIdx = pParse->nTab++;
- oldIdx = pParse->nTab++;
- }
-
- /* Allocate a cursors for the main database table and for all indices.
- ** The index cursors might not be used, but if they are used they
- ** need to occur right after the database cursor. So go ahead and
- ** allocate enough space, just in case.
- */
- pTabList->a[0].iCursor = iCur = pParse->nTab++;
- for(pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext){
- pParse->nTab++;
- }
-
- /* Resolve the column names in all the expressions of the
- ** of the UPDATE statement. Also find the column index
- ** for each column to be updated in the pChanges array. For each
- ** column to be updated, make sure we have authorization to change
- ** that column.
- */
- chngRecno = 0;
- for(i=0; i<pChanges->nExpr; i++){
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pTabList, 0, pChanges->a[i].pExpr) ){
- goto update_cleanup;
- }
- if( sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pChanges->a[i].pExpr, 0, 0) ){
- goto update_cleanup;
- }
- for(j=0; j<pTab->nCol; j++){
- if( sqliteStrICmp(pTab->aCol[j].zName, pChanges->a[i].zName)==0 ){
- if( j==pTab->iPKey ){
- chngRecno = 1;
- pRecnoExpr = pChanges->a[i].pExpr;
- }
- aXRef[j] = i;
- break;
- }
- }
- if( j>=pTab->nCol ){
- if( sqliteIsRowid(pChanges->a[i].zName) ){
- chngRecno = 1;
- pRecnoExpr = pChanges->a[i].pExpr;
- }else{
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "no such column: %s", pChanges->a[i].zName);
- goto update_cleanup;
- }
- }
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
- {
- int rc;
- rc = sqliteAuthCheck(pParse, STQLITE_UPDATE, pTab->zName,
- pTab->aCol[j].zName, db->aDb[pTab->iDb].zName);
- if( rc==STQLITE_DENY ){
- goto update_cleanup;
- }else if( rc==STQLITE_IGNORE ){
- aXRef[j] = -1;
- }
- }
-#endif
- }
-
- /* Allocate memory for the array apIdx[] and fill it with pointers to every
- ** index that needs to be updated. Indices only need updating if their
- ** key includes one of the columns named in pChanges or if the record
- ** number of the original table entry is changing.
- */
- for(nIdx=nIdxTotal=0, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, nIdxTotal++){
- if( chngRecno ){
- i = 0;
- }else {
- for(i=0; i<pIdx->nColumn; i++){
- if( aXRef[pIdx->aiColumn[i]]>=0 ) break;
- }
- }
- if( i<pIdx->nColumn ) nIdx++;
- }
- if( nIdxTotal>0 ){
- apIdx = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(Index*) * nIdx + nIdxTotal );
- if( apIdx==0 ) goto update_cleanup;
- aIdxUsed = (char*)&apIdx[nIdx];
- }
- for(nIdx=j=0, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, j++){
- if( chngRecno ){
- i = 0;
- }else{
- for(i=0; i<pIdx->nColumn; i++){
- if( aXRef[pIdx->aiColumn[i]]>=0 ) break;
- }
- }
- if( i<pIdx->nColumn ){
- apIdx[nIdx++] = pIdx;
- aIdxUsed[j] = 1;
- }else{
- aIdxUsed[j] = 0;
- }
- }
-
- /* Resolve the column names in all the expressions in the
- ** WHERE clause.
- */
- if( pWhere ){
- if( sqliteExprResolveIds(pParse, pTabList, 0, pWhere) ){
- goto update_cleanup;
- }
- if( sqliteExprCheck(pParse, pWhere, 0, 0) ){
- goto update_cleanup;
- }
- }
-
- /* Start the view context
- */
- if( isView ){
- sqliteAuthContextPush(pParse, &sContext, pTab->zName);
- }
-
- /* Begin generating code.
- */
- v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- if( v==0 ) goto update_cleanup;
- sqliteBeginWriteOperation(pParse, 1, pTab->iDb);
-
- /* If we are trying to update a view, construct that view into
- ** a temporary table.
- */
- if( isView ){
- Select *pView;
- pView = sqliteSelectDup(pTab->pSelect);
- sqliteSelect(pParse, pView, SRT_TempTable, iCur, 0, 0, 0);
- sqliteSelectDelete(pView);
- }
-
- /* Begin the database scan
- */
- pWInfo = sqliteWhereBegin(pParse, pTabList, pWhere, 1, 0);
- if( pWInfo==0 ) goto update_cleanup;
-
- /* Remember the index of every item to be updated.
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListWrite, 0, 0);
-
- /* End the database scan loop.
- */
- sqliteWhereEnd(pWInfo);
-
- /* Initialize the count of updated rows
- */
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows && !pParse->trigStack ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 0, 0);
- }
-
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- /* Create pseudo-tables for NEW and OLD
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenPseudo, oldIdx, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenPseudo, newIdx, 0);
-
- /* The top of the update loop for when there are triggers.
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListRewind, 0, 0);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListRead, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 0, 0);
-
- /* Open a cursor and make it point to the record that is
- ** being updated.
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 0, 0);
- if( !isView ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pTab->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenRead, iCur, pTab->tnum);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, iCur, 0);
-
- /* Generate the OLD table
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Recno, iCur, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_RowData, iCur, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, oldIdx, 0);
-
- /* Generate the NEW table
- */
- if( chngRecno ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pRecnoExpr);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Recno, iCur, 0);
- }
- for(i=0; i<pTab->nCol; i++){
- if( i==pTab->iPKey ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- continue;
- }
- j = aXRef[i];
- if( j<0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, iCur, i);
- }else{
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pChanges->a[j].pExpr);
- }
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeRecord, pTab->nCol, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_PutIntKey, newIdx, 0);
- if( !isView ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur, 0);
- }
-
- /* Fire the BEFORE and INSTEAD OF triggers
- */
- if( sqliteCodeRowTrigger(pParse, TK_UPDATE, pChanges, TK_BEFORE, pTab,
- newIdx, oldIdx, onError, addr) ){
- goto update_cleanup;
- }
- }
-
- if( !isView ){
- /*
- ** Open every index that needs updating. Note that if any
- ** index could potentially invoke a REPLACE conflict resolution
- ** action, then we need to open all indices because we might need
- ** to be deleting some records.
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pTab->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenWrite, iCur, pTab->tnum);
- if( onError==OE_Replace ){
- openAll = 1;
- }else{
- openAll = 0;
- for(pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext){
- if( pIdx->onError==OE_Replace ){
- openAll = 1;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- for(i=0, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, i++){
- if( openAll || aIdxUsed[i] ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pIdx->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_OpenWrite, iCur+i+1, pIdx->tnum);
- assert( pParse->nTab>iCur+i+1 );
- }
- }
-
- /* Loop over every record that needs updating. We have to load
- ** the old data for each record to be updated because some columns
- ** might not change and we will need to copy the old value.
- ** Also, the old data is needed to delete the old index entires.
- ** So make the cursor point at the old record.
- */
- if( !row_triggers_exist ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListRewind, 0, 0);
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListRead, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 0, 0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotExists, iCur, addr);
-
- /* If the record number will change, push the record number as it
- ** will be after the update. (The old record number is currently
- ** on top of the stack.)
- */
- if( chngRecno ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pRecnoExpr);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MustBeInt, 0, 0);
- }
-
- /* Compute new data for this record.
- */
- for(i=0; i<pTab->nCol; i++){
- if( i==pTab->iPKey ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- continue;
- }
- j = aXRef[i];
- if( j<0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Column, iCur, i);
- }else{
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pChanges->a[j].pExpr);
- }
- }
-
- /* Do constraint checks
- */
- sqliteGenerateConstraintChecks(pParse, pTab, iCur, aIdxUsed, chngRecno, 1,
- onError, addr);
-
- /* Delete the old indices for the current record.
- */
- sqliteGenerateRowIndexDelete(db, v, pTab, iCur, aIdxUsed);
-
- /* If changing the record number, delete the old record.
- */
- if( chngRecno ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Delete, iCur, 0);
- }
-
- /* Create the new index entries and the new record.
- */
- sqliteCompleteInsertion(pParse, pTab, iCur, aIdxUsed, chngRecno, 1, -1);
- }
-
- /* Increment the row counter
- */
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows && !pParse->trigStack){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_AddImm, 1, 0);
- }
-
- /* If there are triggers, close all the cursors after each iteration
- ** through the loop. The fire the after triggers.
- */
- if( row_triggers_exist ){
- if( !isView ){
- for(i=0, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, i++){
- if( openAll || aIdxUsed[i] )
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur+i+1, 0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur, 0);
- pParse->nTab = iCur;
- }
- if( sqliteCodeRowTrigger(pParse, TK_UPDATE, pChanges, TK_AFTER, pTab,
- newIdx, oldIdx, onError, addr) ){
- goto update_cleanup;
- }
- }
-
- /* Repeat the above with the next record to be updated, until
- ** all record selected by the WHERE clause have been updated.
- */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, addr);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP2(v, addr, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v));
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ListReset, 0, 0);
-
- /* Close all tables if there were no FOR EACH ROW triggers */
- if( !row_triggers_exist ){
- for(i=0, pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext, i++){
- if( openAll || aIdxUsed[i] ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur+i+1, 0);
- }
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, iCur, 0);
- pParse->nTab = iCur;
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, newIdx, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, oldIdx, 0);
- }
-
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetCounts, 0, 0);
- sqliteEndWriteOperation(pParse);
-
- /*
- ** Return the number of rows that were changed.
- */
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_CountRows && !pParse->trigStack ){
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_ColumnName, 0, 1, "rows updated", P3_STATIC);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Callback, 1, 0);
- }
-
-update_cleanup:
- sqliteAuthContextPop(&sContext);
- sqliteFree(apIdx);
- sqliteFree(aXRef);
- sqliteSrcListDelete(pTabList);
- sqliteExprListDelete(pChanges);
- sqliteExprDelete(pWhere);
- return;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/util.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/util.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 42f7482..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/util.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1135 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** Utility functions used throughout sqlite.
-**
-** This file contains functions for allocating memory, comparing
-** strings, and stuff like that.
-**
-** $Id: util.c,v 1.74 2004/02/22 17:49:34 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include <stdarg.h>
-#include <ctype.h>
-
-/*
-** If malloc() ever fails, this global variable gets set to 1.
-** This causes the library to abort and never again function.
-*/
-int sqlite_malloc_failed = 0;
-
-/*
-** If MEMORY_DEBUG is defined, then use versions of malloc() and
-** free() that track memory usage and check for buffer overruns.
-*/
-#ifdef MEMORY_DEBUG
-
-/*
-** For keeping track of the number of mallocs and frees. This
-** is used to check for memory leaks.
-*/
-int sqlite_nMalloc; /* Number of sqliteMalloc() calls */
-int sqlite_nFree; /* Number of sqliteFree() calls */
-int sqlite_iMallocFail; /* Fail sqliteMalloc() after this many calls */
-#if MEMORY_DEBUG>1
-static int memcnt = 0;
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Number of 32-bit guard words
-*/
-#define N_GUARD 1
-
-/*
-** Allocate new memory and set it to zero. Return NULL if
-** no memory is available.
-*/
-void *sqliteMalloc_(int n, int bZero, char *zFile, int line){
- void *p;
- int *pi;
- int i, k;
- if( sqlite_iMallocFail>=0 ){
- sqlite_iMallocFail--;
- if( sqlite_iMallocFail==0 ){
- sqlite_malloc_failed++;
-#if MEMORY_DEBUG>1
- fprintf(stderr,"**** failed to allocate %d bytes at %s:%d\n",
- n, zFile,line);
-#endif
- sqlite_iMallocFail--;
- return 0;
- }
- }
- if( n==0 ) return 0;
- k = (n+sizeof(int)-1)/sizeof(int);
- pi = malloc( (N_GUARD*2+1+k)*sizeof(int));
- if( pi==0 ){
- sqlite_malloc_failed++;
- return 0;
- }
- sqlite_nMalloc++;
- for(i=0; i<N_GUARD; i++) pi[i] = 0xdead1122;
- pi[N_GUARD] = n;
- for(i=0; i<N_GUARD; i++) pi[k+1+N_GUARD+i] = 0xdead3344;
- p = &pi[N_GUARD+1];
- memset(p, bZero==0, n);
-#if MEMORY_DEBUG>1
- fprintf(stderr,"%06d malloc %d bytes at 0x%x from %s:%d\n",
- ++memcnt, n, (int)p, zFile,line);
-#endif
- return p;
-}
-
-/*
-** Check to see if the given pointer was obtained from sqliteMalloc()
-** and is able to hold at least N bytes. Raise an exception if this
-** is not the case.
-**
-** This routine is used for testing purposes only.
-*/
-void sqliteCheckMemory(void *p, int N){
- int *pi = p;
- int n, i, k;
- pi -= N_GUARD+1;
- for(i=0; i<N_GUARD; i++){
- assert( pi[i]==0xdead1122 );
- }
- n = pi[N_GUARD];
- assert( N>=0 && N<n );
- k = (n+sizeof(int)-1)/sizeof(int);
- for(i=0; i<N_GUARD; i++){
- assert( pi[k+N_GUARD+1+i]==0xdead3344 );
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Free memory previously obtained from sqliteMalloc()
-*/
-void sqliteFree_(void *p, char *zFile, int line){
- if( p ){
- int *pi, i, k, n;
- pi = p;
- pi -= N_GUARD+1;
- sqlite_nFree++;
- for(i=0; i<N_GUARD; i++){
- if( pi[i]!=0xdead1122 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"Low-end memory corruption at 0x%x\n", (int)p);
- return;
- }
- }
- n = pi[N_GUARD];
- k = (n+sizeof(int)-1)/sizeof(int);
- for(i=0; i<N_GUARD; i++){
- if( pi[k+N_GUARD+1+i]!=0xdead3344 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"High-end memory corruption at 0x%x\n", (int)p);
- return;
- }
- }
- memset(pi, 0xff, (k+N_GUARD*2+1)*sizeof(int));
-#if MEMORY_DEBUG>1
- fprintf(stderr,"%06d free %d bytes at 0x%x from %s:%d\n",
- ++memcnt, n, (int)p, zFile,line);
-#endif
- free(pi);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Resize a prior allocation. If p==0, then this routine
-** works just like sqliteMalloc(). If n==0, then this routine
-** works just like sqliteFree().
-*/
-void *sqliteRealloc_(void *oldP, int n, char *zFile, int line){
- int *oldPi, *pi, i, k, oldN, oldK;
- void *p;
- if( oldP==0 ){
- return sqliteMalloc_(n,1,zFile,line);
- }
- if( n==0 ){
- sqliteFree_(oldP,zFile,line);
- return 0;
- }
- oldPi = oldP;
- oldPi -= N_GUARD+1;
- if( oldPi[0]!=0xdead1122 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"Low-end memory corruption in realloc at 0x%x\n", (int)oldP);
- return 0;
- }
- oldN = oldPi[N_GUARD];
- oldK = (oldN+sizeof(int)-1)/sizeof(int);
- for(i=0; i<N_GUARD; i++){
- if( oldPi[oldK+N_GUARD+1+i]!=0xdead3344 ){
- fprintf(stderr,"High-end memory corruption in realloc at 0x%x\n",
- (int)oldP);
- return 0;
- }
- }
- k = (n + sizeof(int) - 1)/sizeof(int);
- pi = malloc( (k+N_GUARD*2+1)*sizeof(int) );
- if( pi==0 ){
- sqlite_malloc_failed++;
- return 0;
- }
- for(i=0; i<N_GUARD; i++) pi[i] = 0xdead1122;
- pi[N_GUARD] = n;
- for(i=0; i<N_GUARD; i++) pi[k+N_GUARD+1+i] = 0xdead3344;
- p = &pi[N_GUARD+1];
- memcpy(p, oldP, n>oldN ? oldN : n);
- if( n>oldN ){
- memset(&((char*)p)[oldN], 0, n-oldN);
- }
- memset(oldPi, 0xab, (oldK+N_GUARD+2)*sizeof(int));
- free(oldPi);
-#if MEMORY_DEBUG>1
- fprintf(stderr,"%06d realloc %d to %d bytes at 0x%x to 0x%x at %s:%d\n",
- ++memcnt, oldN, n, (int)oldP, (int)p, zFile, line);
-#endif
- return p;
-}
-
-/*
-** Make a duplicate of a string into memory obtained from malloc()
-** Free the original string using sqliteFree().
-**
-** This routine is called on all strings that are passed outside of
-** the STQLite library. That way clients can free the string using free()
-** rather than having to call sqliteFree().
-*/
-void sqliteStrRealloc(char **pz){
- char *zNew;
- if( pz==0 || *pz==0 ) return;
- zNew = malloc( strlen(*pz) + 1 );
- if( zNew==0 ){
- sqlite_malloc_failed++;
- sqliteFree(*pz);
- *pz = 0;
- }
- strcpy(zNew, *pz);
- sqliteFree(*pz);
- *pz = zNew;
-}
-
-/*
-** Make a copy of a string in memory obtained from sqliteMalloc()
-*/
-char *sqliteStrDup_(const char *z, char *zFile, int line){
- char *zNew;
- if( z==0 ) return 0;
- zNew = sqliteMalloc_(strlen(z)+1, 0, zFile, line);
- if( zNew ) strcpy(zNew, z);
- return zNew;
-}
-char *sqliteStrNDup_(const char *z, int n, char *zFile, int line){
- char *zNew;
- if( z==0 ) return 0;
- zNew = sqliteMalloc_(n+1, 0, zFile, line);
- if( zNew ){
- memcpy(zNew, z, n);
- zNew[n] = 0;
- }
- return zNew;
-}
-#endif /* MEMORY_DEBUG */
-
-/*
-** The following versions of malloc() and free() are for use in a
-** normal build.
-*/
-#if !defined(MEMORY_DEBUG)
-
-/*
-** Allocate new memory and set it to zero. Return NULL if
-** no memory is available. See also sqliteMallocRaw().
-*/
-void *sqliteMalloc(int n){
- void *p;
- if( (p = malloc(n))==0 ){
- if( n>0 ) sqlite_malloc_failed++;
- }else{
- memset(p, 0, n);
- }
- return p;
-}
-
-/*
-** Allocate new memory but do not set it to zero. Return NULL if
-** no memory is available. See also sqliteMalloc().
-*/
-void *sqliteMallocRaw(int n){
- void *p;
- if( (p = malloc(n))==0 ){
- if( n>0 ) sqlite_malloc_failed++;
- }
- return p;
-}
-
-/*
-** Free memory previously obtained from sqliteMalloc()
-*/
-void sqliteFree(void *p){
- if( p ){
- free(p);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Resize a prior allocation. If p==0, then this routine
-** works just like sqliteMalloc(). If n==0, then this routine
-** works just like sqliteFree().
-*/
-void *sqliteRealloc(void *p, int n){
- void *p2;
- if( p==0 ){
- return sqliteMalloc(n);
- }
- if( n==0 ){
- sqliteFree(p);
- return 0;
- }
- p2 = realloc(p, n);
- if( p2==0 ){
- sqlite_malloc_failed++;
- }
- return p2;
-}
-
-/*
-** Make a copy of a string in memory obtained from sqliteMalloc()
-*/
-char *sqliteStrDup(const char *z){
- char *zNew;
- if( z==0 ) return 0;
- zNew = sqliteMallocRaw(strlen(z)+1);
- if( zNew ) strcpy(zNew, z);
- return zNew;
-}
-char *sqliteStrNDup(const char *z, int n){
- char *zNew;
- if( z==0 ) return 0;
- zNew = sqliteMallocRaw(n+1);
- if( zNew ){
- memcpy(zNew, z, n);
- zNew[n] = 0;
- }
- return zNew;
-}
-#endif /* !defined(MEMORY_DEBUG) */
-
-/*
-** Create a string from the 2nd and subsequent arguments (up to the
-** first NULL argument), store the string in memory obtained from
-** sqliteMalloc() and make the pointer indicated by the 1st argument
-** point to that string. The 1st argument must either be NULL or
-** point to memory obtained from sqliteMalloc().
-*/
-void sqliteSetString(char **pz, const char *zFirst, ...){
- va_list ap;
- int nByte;
- const char *z;
- char *zResult;
-
- if( pz==0 ) return;
- nByte = strlen(zFirst) + 1;
- va_start(ap, zFirst);
- while( (z = va_arg(ap, const char*))!=0 ){
- nByte += strlen(z);
- }
- va_end(ap);
- sqliteFree(*pz);
- *pz = zResult = sqliteMallocRaw( nByte );
- if( zResult==0 ){
- return;
- }
- strcpy(zResult, zFirst);
- zResult += strlen(zResult);
- va_start(ap, zFirst);
- while( (z = va_arg(ap, const char*))!=0 ){
- strcpy(zResult, z);
- zResult += strlen(zResult);
- }
- va_end(ap);
-#ifdef MEMORY_DEBUG
-#if MEMORY_DEBUG>1
- fprintf(stderr,"string at 0x%x is %s\n", (int)*pz, *pz);
-#endif
-#endif
-}
-
-/*
-** Works like sqliteSetString, but each string is now followed by
-** a length integer which specifies how much of the source string
-** to copy (in bytes). -1 means use the whole string. The 1st
-** argument must either be NULL or point to memory obtained from
-** sqliteMalloc().
-*/
-void sqliteSetNString(char **pz, ...){
- va_list ap;
- int nByte;
- const char *z;
- char *zResult;
- int n;
-
- if( pz==0 ) return;
- nByte = 0;
- va_start(ap, pz);
- while( (z = va_arg(ap, const char*))!=0 ){
- n = va_arg(ap, int);
- if( n<=0 ) n = strlen(z);
- nByte += n;
- }
- va_end(ap);
- sqliteFree(*pz);
- *pz = zResult = sqliteMallocRaw( nByte + 1 );
- if( zResult==0 ) return;
- va_start(ap, pz);
- while( (z = va_arg(ap, const char*))!=0 ){
- n = va_arg(ap, int);
- if( n<=0 ) n = strlen(z);
- strncpy(zResult, z, n);
- zResult += n;
- }
- *zResult = 0;
-#ifdef MEMORY_DEBUG
-#if MEMORY_DEBUG>1
- fprintf(stderr,"string at 0x%x is %s\n", (int)*pz, *pz);
-#endif
-#endif
- va_end(ap);
-}
-
-/*
-** Add an error message to pParse->zErrMsg and increment pParse->nErr.
-** The following formatting characters are allowed:
-**
-** %s Insert a string
-** %z A string that should be freed after use
-** %d Insert an integer
-** %T Insert a token
-** %S Insert the first element of a SrcList
-*/
-void sqliteErrorMsg(Parse *pParse, const char *zFormat, ...){
- va_list ap;
- pParse->nErr++;
- sqliteFree(pParse->zErrMsg);
- va_start(ap, zFormat);
- pParse->zErrMsg = sqliteVMPrintf(zFormat, ap);
- va_end(ap);
-}
-
-/*
-** Convert an SQL-style quoted string into a normal string by removing
-** the quote characters. The conversion is done in-place. If the
-** input does not begin with a quote character, then this routine
-** is a no-op.
-**
-** 2002-Feb-14: This routine is extended to remove MS-Access style
-** brackets from around identifers. For example: "[a-b-c]" becomes
-** "a-b-c".
-*/
-void sqliteDequote(char *z){
- int quote;
- int i, j;
- if( z==0 ) return;
- quote = z[0];
- switch( quote ){
- case '\'': break;
- case '"': break;
- case '[': quote = ']'; break;
- default: return;
- }
- for(i=1, j=0; z[i]; i++){
- if( z[i]==quote ){
- if( z[i+1]==quote ){
- z[j++] = quote;
- i++;
- }else{
- z[j++] = 0;
- break;
- }
- }else{
- z[j++] = z[i];
- }
- }
-}
-
-/* An array to map all upper-case characters into their corresponding
-** lower-case character.
-*/
-static unsigned char UpperToLower[] = {
- 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17,
- 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35,
- 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53,
- 54, 55, 56, 57, 58, 59, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 97, 98, 99,100,101,102,103,
- 104,105,106,107,108,109,110,111,112,113,114,115,116,117,118,119,120,121,
- 122, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99,100,101,102,103,104,105,106,107,
- 108,109,110,111,112,113,114,115,116,117,118,119,120,121,122,123,124,125,
- 126,127,128,129,130,131,132,133,134,135,136,137,138,139,140,141,142,143,
- 144,145,146,147,148,149,150,151,152,153,154,155,156,157,158,159,160,161,
- 162,163,164,165,166,167,168,169,170,171,172,173,174,175,176,177,178,179,
- 180,181,182,183,184,185,186,187,188,189,190,191,192,193,194,195,196,197,
- 198,199,200,201,202,203,204,205,206,207,208,209,210,211,212,213,214,215,
- 216,217,218,219,220,221,222,223,224,225,226,227,228,229,230,231,232,233,
- 234,235,236,237,238,239,240,241,242,243,244,245,246,247,248,249,250,251,
- 252,253,254,255
-};
-
-/*
-** This function computes a hash on the name of a keyword.
-** Case is not significant.
-*/
-int sqliteHashNoCase(const char *z, int n){
- int h = 0;
- if( n<=0 ) n = strlen(z);
- while( n > 0 ){
- h = (h<<3) ^ h ^ UpperToLower[(unsigned char)*z++];
- n--;
- }
- return h & 0x7fffffff;
-}
-
-/*
-** Some systems have stricmp(). Others have strcasecmp(). Because
-** there is no consistency, we will define our own.
-*/
-int sqliteStrICmp(const char *zLeft, const char *zRight){
- register unsigned char *a, *b;
- a = (unsigned char *)zLeft;
- b = (unsigned char *)zRight;
- while( *a!=0 && UpperToLower[*a]==UpperToLower[*b]){ a++; b++; }
- return *a - *b;
-}
-int sqliteStrNICmp(const char *zLeft, const char *zRight, int N){
- register unsigned char *a, *b;
- a = (unsigned char *)zLeft;
- b = (unsigned char *)zRight;
- while( N-- > 0 && *a!=0 && UpperToLower[*a]==UpperToLower[*b]){ a++; b++; }
- return N<0 ? 0 : *a - *b;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return TRUE if z is a pure numeric string. Return FALSE if the
-** string contains any character which is not part of a number.
-**
-** Am empty string is considered non-numeric.
-*/
-int sqliteIsNumber(const char *z){
- if( *z=='-' || *z=='+' ) z++;
- if( !isdigit(*z) ){
- return 0;
- }
- z++;
- while( isdigit(*z) ){ z++; }
- if( *z=='.' ){
- z++;
- if( !isdigit(*z) ) return 0;
- while( isdigit(*z) ){ z++; }
- }
- if( *z=='e' || *z=='E' ){
- z++;
- if( *z=='+' || *z=='-' ) z++;
- if( !isdigit(*z) ) return 0;
- while( isdigit(*z) ){ z++; }
- }
- return *z==0;
-}
-
-/*
-** The string z[] is an ascii representation of a real number.
-** Convert this string to a double.
-**
-** This routine assumes that z[] really is a valid number. If it
-** is not, the result is undefined.
-**
-** This routine is used instead of the library atof() function because
-** the library atof() might want to use "," as the decimal point instead
-** of "." depending on how locale is set. But that would cause problems
-** for SQL. So this routine always uses "." regardless of locale.
-*/
-double sqliteAtoF(const char *z, const char **pzEnd){
- int sign = 1;
- LONGDOUBLE_TYPE v1 = 0.0;
- if( *z=='-' ){
- sign = -1;
- z++;
- }else if( *z=='+' ){
- z++;
- }
- while( isdigit(*z) ){
- v1 = v1*10.0 + (*z - '0');
- z++;
- }
- if( *z=='.' ){
- LONGDOUBLE_TYPE divisor = 1.0;
- z++;
- while( isdigit(*z) ){
- v1 = v1*10.0 + (*z - '0');
- divisor *= 10.0;
- z++;
- }
- v1 /= divisor;
- }
- if( *z=='e' || *z=='E' ){
- int esign = 1;
- int eval = 0;
- LONGDOUBLE_TYPE scale = 1.0;
- z++;
- if( *z=='-' ){
- esign = -1;
- z++;
- }else if( *z=='+' ){
- z++;
- }
- while( isdigit(*z) ){
- eval = eval*10 + *z - '0';
- z++;
- }
- while( eval>=64 ){ scale *= 1.0e+64; eval -= 64; }
- while( eval>=16 ){ scale *= 1.0e+16; eval -= 16; }
- while( eval>=4 ){ scale *= 1.0e+4; eval -= 4; }
- while( eval>=1 ){ scale *= 1.0e+1; eval -= 1; }
- if( esign<0 ){
- v1 /= scale;
- }else{
- v1 *= scale;
- }
- }
- if( pzEnd ) *pzEnd = z;
- return sign<0 ? -v1 : v1;
-}
-
-/*
-** The string zNum represents an integer. There might be some other
-** information following the integer too, but that part is ignored.
-** If the integer that the prefix of zNum represents will fit in a
-** 32-bit signed integer, return TRUE. Otherwise return FALSE.
-**
-** This routine returns FALSE for the string -2147483648 even that
-** that number will, in theory fit in a 32-bit integer. But positive
-** 2147483648 will not fit in 32 bits. So it seems safer to return
-** false.
-*/
-int sqliteFitsIn32Bits(const char *zNum){
- int i, c;
- if( *zNum=='-' || *zNum=='+' ) zNum++;
- for(i=0; (c=zNum[i])>='0' && c<='9'; i++){}
- return i<10 || (i==10 && memcmp(zNum,"2147483647",10)<=0);
-}
-
-/* This comparison routine is what we use for comparison operations
-** between numeric values in an SQL expression. "Numeric" is a little
-** bit misleading here. What we mean is that the strings have a
-** type of "numeric" from the point of view of SQL. The strings
-** do not necessarily contain numbers. They could contain text.
-**
-** If the input strings both look like actual numbers then they
-** compare in numerical order. Numerical strings are always less
-** than non-numeric strings so if one input string looks like a
-** number and the other does not, then the one that looks like
-** a number is the smaller. Non-numeric strings compare in
-** lexigraphical order (the same order as strcmp()).
-*/
-int sqliteCompare(const char *atext, const char *btext){
- int result;
- int isNumA, isNumB;
- if( atext==0 ){
- return -1;
- }else if( btext==0 ){
- return 1;
- }
- isNumA = sqliteIsNumber(atext);
- isNumB = sqliteIsNumber(btext);
- if( isNumA ){
- if( !isNumB ){
- result = -1;
- }else{
- double rA, rB;
- rA = sqliteAtoF(atext, 0);
- rB = sqliteAtoF(btext, 0);
- if( rA<rB ){
- result = -1;
- }else if( rA>rB ){
- result = +1;
- }else{
- result = 0;
- }
- }
- }else if( isNumB ){
- result = +1;
- }else {
- result = strcmp(atext, btext);
- }
- return result;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine is used for sorting. Each key is a list of one or more
-** null-terminated elements. The list is terminated by two nulls in
-** a row. For example, the following text is a key with three elements
-**
-** Aone\000Dtwo\000Athree\000\000
-**
-** All elements begin with one of the characters "+-AD" and end with "\000"
-** with zero or more text elements in between. Except, NULL elements
-** consist of the special two-character sequence "N\000".
-**
-** Both arguments will have the same number of elements. This routine
-** returns negative, zero, or positive if the first argument is less
-** than, equal to, or greater than the first. (Result is a-b).
-**
-** Each element begins with one of the characters "+", "-", "A", "D".
-** This character determines the sort order and collating sequence:
-**
-** + Sort numerically in ascending order
-** - Sort numerically in descending order
-** A Sort as strings in ascending order
-** D Sort as strings in descending order.
-**
-** For the "+" and "-" sorting, pure numeric strings (strings for which the
-** isNum() function above returns TRUE) always compare less than strings
-** that are not pure numerics. Non-numeric strings compare in memcmp()
-** order. This is the same sort order as the sqliteCompare() function
-** above generates.
-**
-** The last point is a change from version 2.6.3 to version 2.7.0. In
-** version 2.6.3 and earlier, substrings of digits compare in numerical
-** and case was used only to break a tie.
-**
-** Elements that begin with 'A' or 'D' compare in memcmp() order regardless
-** of whether or not they look like a number.
-**
-** Note that the sort order imposed by the rules above is the same
-** from the ordering defined by the "<", "<=", ">", and ">=" operators
-** of expressions and for indices. This was not the case for version
-** 2.6.3 and earlier.
-*/
-int sqliteSortCompare(const char *a, const char *b){
- int res = 0;
- int isNumA, isNumB;
- int dir = 0;
-
- while( res==0 && *a && *b ){
- if( a[0]=='N' || b[0]=='N' ){
- if( a[0]==b[0] ){
- a += 2;
- b += 2;
- continue;
- }
- if( a[0]=='N' ){
- dir = b[0];
- res = -1;
- }else{
- dir = a[0];
- res = +1;
- }
- break;
- }
- assert( a[0]==b[0] );
- if( (dir=a[0])=='A' || a[0]=='D' ){
- res = strcmp(&a[1],&b[1]);
- if( res ) break;
- }else{
- isNumA = sqliteIsNumber(&a[1]);
- isNumB = sqliteIsNumber(&b[1]);
- if( isNumA ){
- double rA, rB;
- if( !isNumB ){
- res = -1;
- break;
- }
- rA = sqliteAtoF(&a[1], 0);
- rB = sqliteAtoF(&b[1], 0);
- if( rA<rB ){
- res = -1;
- break;
- }
- if( rA>rB ){
- res = +1;
- break;
- }
- }else if( isNumB ){
- res = +1;
- break;
- }else{
- res = strcmp(&a[1],&b[1]);
- if( res ) break;
- }
- }
- a += strlen(&a[1]) + 2;
- b += strlen(&b[1]) + 2;
- }
- if( dir=='-' || dir=='D' ) res = -res;
- return res;
-}
-
-/*
-** Some powers of 64. These constants are needed in the
-** sqliteRealToSortable() routine below.
-*/
-#define _64e3 (64.0 * 64.0 * 64.0)
-#define _64e4 (64.0 * 64.0 * 64.0 * 64.0)
-#define _64e15 (_64e3 * _64e4 * _64e4 * _64e4)
-#define _64e16 (_64e4 * _64e4 * _64e4 * _64e4)
-#define _64e63 (_64e15 * _64e16 * _64e16 * _64e16)
-#define _64e64 (_64e16 * _64e16 * _64e16 * _64e16)
-
-/*
-** The following procedure converts a double-precision floating point
-** number into a string. The resulting string has the property that
-** two such strings comparied using strcmp() or memcmp() will give the
-** same results as a numeric comparison of the original floating point
-** numbers.
-**
-** This routine is used to generate database keys from floating point
-** numbers such that the keys sort in the same order as the original
-** floating point numbers even though the keys are compared using
-** memcmp().
-**
-** The calling function should have allocated at least 14 characters
-** of space for the buffer z[].
-*/
-void sqliteRealToSortable(double r, char *z){
- int neg;
- int exp;
- int cnt = 0;
-
- /* This array maps integers between 0 and 63 into base-64 digits.
- ** The digits must be chosen such at their ASCII codes are increasing.
- ** This means we can not use the traditional base-64 digit set. */
- static const char zDigit[] =
- "0123456789"
- "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ"
- "abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz"
- "|~";
- if( r<0.0 ){
- neg = 1;
- r = -r;
- *z++ = '-';
- } else {
- neg = 0;
- *z++ = '0';
- }
- exp = 0;
-
- if( r==0.0 ){
- exp = -1024;
- }else if( r<(0.5/64.0) ){
- while( r < 0.5/_64e64 && exp > -961 ){ r *= _64e64; exp -= 64; }
- while( r < 0.5/_64e16 && exp > -1009 ){ r *= _64e16; exp -= 16; }
- while( r < 0.5/_64e4 && exp > -1021 ){ r *= _64e4; exp -= 4; }
- while( r < 0.5/64.0 && exp > -1024 ){ r *= 64.0; exp -= 1; }
- }else if( r>=0.5 ){
- while( r >= 0.5*_64e63 && exp < 960 ){ r *= 1.0/_64e64; exp += 64; }
- while( r >= 0.5*_64e15 && exp < 1008 ){ r *= 1.0/_64e16; exp += 16; }
- while( r >= 0.5*_64e3 && exp < 1020 ){ r *= 1.0/_64e4; exp += 4; }
- while( r >= 0.5 && exp < 1023 ){ r *= 1.0/64.0; exp += 1; }
- }
- if( neg ){
- exp = -exp;
- r = -r;
- }
- exp += 1024;
- r += 0.5;
- if( exp<0 ) return;
- if( exp>=2048 || r>=1.0 ){
- strcpy(z, "~~~~~~~~~~~~");
- return;
- }
- *z++ = zDigit[(exp>>6)&0x3f];
- *z++ = zDigit[exp & 0x3f];
- while( r>0.0 && cnt<10 ){
- int digit;
- r *= 64.0;
- digit = (int)r;
- assert( digit>=0 && digit<64 );
- *z++ = zDigit[digit & 0x3f];
- r -= digit;
- cnt++;
- }
- *z = 0;
-}
-
-#ifdef STQLITE_UTF8
-/*
-** X is a pointer to the first byte of a UTF-8 character. Increment
-** X so that it points to the next character. This only works right
-** if X points to a well-formed UTF-8 string.
-*/
-#define sqliteNextChar(X) while( (0xc0&*++(X))==0x80 ){}
-#define sqliteCharVal(X) sqlite_utf8_to_int(X)
-
-#else /* !defined(STQLITE_UTF8) */
-/*
-** For iso8859 encoding, the next character is just the next byte.
-*/
-#define sqliteNextChar(X) (++(X));
-#define sqliteCharVal(X) ((int)*(X))
-
-#endif /* defined(STQLITE_UTF8) */
-
-
-#ifdef STQLITE_UTF8
-/*
-** Convert the UTF-8 character to which z points into a 31-bit
-** UCS character. This only works right if z points to a well-formed
-** UTF-8 string.
-*/
-static int sqlite_utf8_to_int(const unsigned char *z){
- int c;
- static const int initVal[] = {
- 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14,
- 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29,
- 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44,
- 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53, 54, 55, 56, 57, 58, 59,
- 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74,
- 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 84, 85, 86, 87, 88, 89,
- 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99, 100, 101, 102, 103, 104,
- 105, 106, 107, 108, 109, 110, 111, 112, 113, 114, 115, 116, 117, 118, 119,
- 120, 121, 122, 123, 124, 125, 126, 127, 128, 129, 130, 131, 132, 133, 134,
- 135, 136, 137, 138, 139, 140, 141, 142, 143, 144, 145, 146, 147, 148, 149,
- 150, 151, 152, 153, 154, 155, 156, 157, 158, 159, 160, 161, 162, 163, 164,
- 165, 166, 167, 168, 169, 170, 171, 172, 173, 174, 175, 176, 177, 178, 179,
- 180, 181, 182, 183, 184, 185, 186, 187, 188, 189, 190, 191, 0, 1, 2,
- 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17,
- 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 0,
- 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15,
- 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 0, 1, 2, 3, 0, 1, 254,
- 255,
- };
- c = initVal[*(z++)];
- while( (0xc0&*z)==0x80 ){
- c = (c<<6) | (0x3f&*(z++));
- }
- return c;
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Compare two UTF-8 strings for equality where the first string can
-** potentially be a "glob" expression. Return true (1) if they
-** are the same and false (0) if they are different.
-**
-** Globbing rules:
-**
-** '*' Matches any sequence of zero or more characters.
-**
-** '?' Matches exactly one character.
-**
-** [...] Matches one character from the enclosed list of
-** characters.
-**
-** [^...] Matches one character not in the enclosed list.
-**
-** With the [...] and [^...] matching, a ']' character can be included
-** in the list by making it the first character after '[' or '^'. A
-** range of characters can be specified using '-'. Example:
-** "[a-z]" matches any single lower-case letter. To match a '-', make
-** it the last character in the list.
-**
-** This routine is usually quick, but can be N**2 in the worst case.
-**
-** Hints: to match '*' or '?', put them in "[]". Like this:
-**
-** abc[*]xyz Matches "abc*xyz" only
-*/
-int
-sqliteGlobCompare(const unsigned char *zPattern, const unsigned char *zString){
- register int c;
- int invert;
- int seen;
- int c2;
-
- while( (c = *zPattern)!=0 ){
- switch( c ){
- case '*':
- while( (c=zPattern[1]) == '*' || c == '?' ){
- if( c=='?' ){
- if( *zString==0 ) return 0;
- sqliteNextChar(zString);
- }
- zPattern++;
- }
- if( c==0 ) return 1;
- if( c=='[' ){
- while( *zString && sqliteGlobCompare(&zPattern[1],zString)==0 ){
- sqliteNextChar(zString);
- }
- return *zString!=0;
- }else{
- while( (c2 = *zString)!=0 ){
- while( c2 != 0 && c2 != c ){ c2 = *++zString; }
- if( c2==0 ) return 0;
- if( sqliteGlobCompare(&zPattern[1],zString) ) return 1;
- sqliteNextChar(zString);
- }
- return 0;
- }
- case '?': {
- if( *zString==0 ) return 0;
- sqliteNextChar(zString);
- zPattern++;
- break;
- }
- case '[': {
- int prior_c = 0;
- seen = 0;
- invert = 0;
- c = sqliteCharVal(zString);
- if( c==0 ) return 0;
- c2 = *++zPattern;
- if( c2=='^' ){ invert = 1; c2 = *++zPattern; }
- if( c2==']' ){
- if( c==']' ) seen = 1;
- c2 = *++zPattern;
- }
- while( (c2 = sqliteCharVal(zPattern))!=0 && c2!=']' ){
- if( c2=='-' && zPattern[1]!=']' && zPattern[1]!=0 && prior_c>0 ){
- zPattern++;
- c2 = sqliteCharVal(zPattern);
- if( c>=prior_c && c<=c2 ) seen = 1;
- prior_c = 0;
- }else if( c==c2 ){
- seen = 1;
- prior_c = c2;
- }else{
- prior_c = c2;
- }
- sqliteNextChar(zPattern);
- }
- if( c2==0 || (seen ^ invert)==0 ) return 0;
- sqliteNextChar(zString);
- zPattern++;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- if( c != *zString ) return 0;
- zPattern++;
- zString++;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- return *zString==0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Compare two UTF-8 strings for equality using the "LIKE" operator of
-** SQL. The '%' character matches any sequence of 0 or more
-** characters and '_' matches any single character. Case is
-** not significant.
-**
-** This routine is just an adaptation of the sqliteGlobCompare()
-** routine above.
-*/
-int
-sqliteLikeCompare(const unsigned char *zPattern, const unsigned char *zString){
- register int c;
- int c2;
-
- while( (c = UpperToLower[*zPattern])!=0 ){
- switch( c ){
- case '%': {
- while( (c=zPattern[1]) == '%' || c == '_' ){
- if( c=='_' ){
- if( *zString==0 ) return 0;
- sqliteNextChar(zString);
- }
- zPattern++;
- }
- if( c==0 ) return 1;
- c = UpperToLower[c];
- while( (c2=UpperToLower[*zString])!=0 ){
- while( c2 != 0 && c2 != c ){ c2 = UpperToLower[*++zString]; }
- if( c2==0 ) return 0;
- if( sqliteLikeCompare(&zPattern[1],zString) ) return 1;
- sqliteNextChar(zString);
- }
- return 0;
- }
- case '_': {
- if( *zString==0 ) return 0;
- sqliteNextChar(zString);
- zPattern++;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- if( c != UpperToLower[*zString] ) return 0;
- zPattern++;
- zString++;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- return *zString==0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the sqlite.magic from STQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN to STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY.
-** Return an error (non-zero) if the magic was not STQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN
-** when this routine is called.
-**
-** This routine is a attempt to detect if two threads use the
-** same sqlite* pointer at the same time. There is a race
-** condition so it is possible that the error is not detected.
-** But usually the problem will be seen. The result will be an
-** error which can be used to debug the application that is
-** using STQLite incorrectly.
-**
-** Ticket #202: If db->magic is not a valid open value, take care not
-** to modify the db structure at all. It could be that db is a stale
-** pointer. In other words, it could be that there has been a prior
-** call to sqlite_close(db) and db has been deallocated. And we do
-** not want to write into deallocated memory.
-*/
-int sqliteSafetyOn(sqlite *db){
- if( db->magic==STQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN ){
- db->magic = STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY;
- return 0;
- }else if( db->magic==STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY || db->magic==STQLITE_MAGIC_ERROR
- || db->want_to_close ){
- db->magic = STQLITE_MAGIC_ERROR;
- db->flags |= STQLITE_Interrupt;
- }
- return 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the magic from STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY to STQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN.
-** Return an error (non-zero) if the magic was not STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY
-** when this routine is called.
-*/
-int sqliteSafetyOff(sqlite *db){
- if( db->magic==STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY ){
- db->magic = STQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN;
- return 0;
- }else if( db->magic==STQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN || db->magic==STQLITE_MAGIC_ERROR
- || db->want_to_close ){
- db->magic = STQLITE_MAGIC_ERROR;
- db->flags |= STQLITE_Interrupt;
- }
- return 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Check to make sure we are not currently executing an sqlite_exec().
-** If we are currently in an sqlite_exec(), return true and set
-** sqlite.magic to STQLITE_MAGIC_ERROR. This will cause a complete
-** shutdown of the database.
-**
-** This routine is used to try to detect when API routines are called
-** at the wrong time or in the wrong sequence.
-*/
-int sqliteSafetyCheck(sqlite *db){
- if( db->pVdbe!=0 ){
- db->magic = STQLITE_MAGIC_ERROR;
- return 1;
- }
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vacuum.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vacuum.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 7346114..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vacuum.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,320 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2003 April 6
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains code used to implement the VACUUM command.
-**
-** Most of the code in this file may be omitted by defining the
-** STQLITE_OMIT_VACUUM macro.
-**
-** $Id: vacuum.c,v 1.12 2004/02/25 02:33:35 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include "os.h"
-
-/*
-** A structure for holding a dynamic string - a string that can grow
-** without bound.
-*/
-typedef struct dynStr dynStr;
-struct dynStr {
- char *z; /* Text of the string in space obtained from sqliteMalloc() */
- int nAlloc; /* Amount of space allocated to z[] */
- int nUsed; /* Next unused slot in z[] */
-};
-
-/*
-** A structure that holds the vacuum context
-*/
-typedef struct vacuumStruct vacuumStruct;
-struct vacuumStruct {
- sqlite *dbOld; /* Original database */
- sqlite *dbNew; /* New database */
- char **pzErrMsg; /* Write errors here */
- int rc; /* Set to non-zero on an error */
- const char *zTable; /* Name of a table being copied */
- const char *zPragma; /* Pragma to execute with results */
- dynStr s1, s2; /* Two dynamic strings */
-};
-
-#if !defined(STQLITE_OMIT_VACUUM) || STQLITE_OMIT_VACUUM
-/*
-** Append text to a dynamic string
-*/
-static void appendText(dynStr *p, const char *zText, int nText){
- if( nText<0 ) nText = strlen(zText);
- if( p->z==0 || p->nUsed + nText + 1 >= p->nAlloc ){
- char *zNew;
- p->nAlloc = p->nUsed + nText + 1000;
- zNew = sqliteRealloc(p->z, p->nAlloc);
- if( zNew==0 ){
- sqliteFree(p->z);
- memset(p, 0, sizeof(*p));
- return;
- }
- p->z = zNew;
- }
- memcpy(&p->z[p->nUsed], zText, nText+1);
- p->nUsed += nText;
-}
-
-/*
-** Append text to a dynamic string, having first put the text in quotes.
-*/
-static void appendQuoted(dynStr *p, const char *zText){
- int i, j;
- appendText(p, "'", 1);
- for(i=j=0; zText[i]; i++){
- if( zText[i]=='\'' ){
- appendText(p, &zText[j], i-j+1);
- j = i + 1;
- appendText(p, "'", 1);
- }
- }
- if( j<i ){
- appendText(p, &zText[j], i-j);
- }
- appendText(p, "'", 1);
-}
-
-/*
-** Execute statements of SQL. If an error occurs, write the error
-** message into *pzErrMsg and return non-zero.
-*/
-static int execsql(char **pzErrMsg, sqlite *db, const char *zSql){
- char *zErrMsg = 0;
- int rc;
-
- /* printf("***** executing *****\n%s\n", zSql); */
- rc = sqlite_exec(db, zSql, 0, 0, &zErrMsg);
- if( zErrMsg ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, zErrMsg, (char*)0);
- sqlite_freemem(zErrMsg);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** This is the second stage callback. Each invocation contains all the
-** data for a single row of a single table in the original database. This
-** routine must write that information into the new database.
-*/
-static int vacuumCallback2(void *pArg, int argc, char **argv, char **NotUsed){
- vacuumStruct *p = (vacuumStruct*)pArg;
- const char *zSep = "(";
- int i;
-
- if( argv==0 ) return 0;
- p->s2.nUsed = 0;
- appendText(&p->s2, "INSERT INTO ", -1);
- appendQuoted(&p->s2, p->zTable);
- appendText(&p->s2, " VALUES", -1);
- for(i=0; i<argc; i++){
- appendText(&p->s2, zSep, 1);
- zSep = ",";
- if( argv[i]==0 ){
- appendText(&p->s2, "NULL", 4);
- }else{
- appendQuoted(&p->s2, argv[i]);
- }
- }
- appendText(&p->s2,")", 1);
- p->rc = execsql(p->pzErrMsg, p->dbNew, p->s2.z);
- return p->rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** This is the first stage callback. Each invocation contains three
-** arguments where are taken from the STQLITE_MASTER table of the original
-** database: (1) the entry type, (2) the entry name, and (3) the SQL for
-** the entry. In all cases, execute the SQL of the third argument.
-** For tables, run a query to select all entries in that table and
-** transfer them to the second-stage callback.
-*/
-static int vacuumCallback1(void *pArg, int argc, char **argv, char **NotUsed){
- vacuumStruct *p = (vacuumStruct*)pArg;
- int rc = 0;
- assert( argc==3 );
- if( argv==0 ) return 0;
- assert( argv[0]!=0 );
- assert( argv[1]!=0 );
- assert( argv[2]!=0 );
- rc = execsql(p->pzErrMsg, p->dbNew, argv[2]);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK && strcmp(argv[0],"table")==0 ){
- char *zErrMsg = 0;
- p->s1.nUsed = 0;
- appendText(&p->s1, "SELECT * FROM ", -1);
- appendQuoted(&p->s1, argv[1]);
- p->zTable = argv[1];
- rc = sqlite_exec(p->dbOld, p->s1.z, vacuumCallback2, p, &zErrMsg);
- if( zErrMsg ){
- sqliteSetString(p->pzErrMsg, zErrMsg, (char*)0);
- sqlite_freemem(zErrMsg);
- }
- }
- if( rc!=STQLITE_ABORT ) p->rc = rc;
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** This callback is used to transfer PRAGMA settings from one database
-** to the other. The value in argv[0] should be passed to a pragma
-** identified by ((vacuumStruct*)pArg)->zPragma.
-*/
-static int vacuumCallback3(void *pArg, int argc, char **argv, char **NotUsed){
- vacuumStruct *p = (vacuumStruct*)pArg;
- char zBuf[200];
- assert( argc==1 );
- if( argv==0 ) return 0;
- assert( argv[0]!=0 );
- assert( strlen(p->zPragma)<100 );
- assert( strlen(argv[0])<30 );
- sprintf(zBuf,"PRAGMA %s=%s;", p->zPragma, argv[0]);
- p->rc = execsql(p->pzErrMsg, p->dbNew, zBuf);
- return p->rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate a random name of 20 character in length.
-*/
-static void randomName(unsigned char *zBuf){
- static const unsigned char zChars[] =
- "abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz"
- "0123456789";
- int i;
- sqliteRandomness(20, zBuf);
- for(i=0; i<20; i++){
- zBuf[i] = zChars[ zBuf[i]%(sizeof(zChars)-1) ];
- }
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-** The non-standard VACUUM command is used to clean up the database,
-** collapse free space, etc. It is modelled after the VACUUM command
-** in PostgreSQL.
-**
-** In version 1.0.x of STQLite, the VACUUM command would call
-** gdbm_reorganize() on all the database tables. But beginning
-** with 2.0.0, STQLite no longer uses GDBM so this command has
-** become a no-op.
-*/
-void sqliteVacuum(Parse *pParse, Token *pTableName){
- Vdbe *v = sqliteGetVdbe(pParse);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Vacuum, 0, 0);
- return;
-}
-
-/*
-** This routine implements the OP_Vacuum opcode of the VDBE.
-*/
-int sqliteRunVacuum(char **pzErrMsg, sqlite *db){
-#if !defined(STQLITE_OMIT_VACUUM) || STQLITE_OMIT_VACUUM
- const char *zFilename; /* full pathname of the database file */
- int nFilename; /* number of characters in zFilename[] */
- char *zTemp = 0; /* a temporary file in same directory as zFilename */
- sqlite *dbNew = 0; /* The new vacuumed database */
- int rc = STQLITE_OK; /* Return code from service routines */
- int i; /* Loop counter */
- char *zErrMsg; /* Error message */
- vacuumStruct sVac; /* Information passed to callbacks */
-
- /* These are all of the pragmas that need to be transferred over
- ** to the new database */
- static const char *zPragma[] = {
- "default_synchronous",
- "default_cache_size",
- /* "default_temp_store", */
- };
-
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_InTrans ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "cannot VACUUM from within a transaction",
- (char*)0);
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- memset(&sVac, 0, sizeof(sVac));
-
- /* Get the full pathname of the database file and create two
- ** temporary filenames in the same directory as the original file.
- */
- zFilename = sqliteBtreeGetFilename(db->aDb[0].pBt);
- if( zFilename==0 ){
- /* This only happens with the in-memory database. VACUUM is a no-op
- ** there, so just return */
- return STQLITE_OK;
- }
- nFilename = strlen(zFilename);
- zTemp = sqliteMalloc( nFilename+100 );
- if( zTemp==0 ) return STQLITE_NOMEM;
- strcpy(zTemp, zFilename);
- for(i=0; i<10; i++){
- zTemp[nFilename] = '-';
- randomName(&zTemp[nFilename+1]);
- if( !sqliteOsFileExists(zTemp) ) break;
- }
- if( i>=10 ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "unable to create a temporary database file "
- "in the same directory as the original database", (char*)0);
- goto end_of_vacuum;
- }
-
-
- dbNew = sqlite_open(zTemp, 0, &zErrMsg);
- if( dbNew==0 ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "unable to open a temporary database at ",
- zTemp, " - ", zErrMsg, (char*)0);
- goto end_of_vacuum;
- }
- if( (rc = execsql(pzErrMsg, db, "BEGIN"))!=0 ) goto end_of_vacuum;
- if( (rc = execsql(pzErrMsg, dbNew, "PRAGMA synchronous=off; BEGIN"))!=0 ){
- goto end_of_vacuum;
- }
-
- sVac.dbOld = db;
- sVac.dbNew = dbNew;
- sVac.pzErrMsg = pzErrMsg;
- for(i=0; rc==STQLITE_OK && i<sizeof(zPragma)/sizeof(zPragma[0]); i++){
- char zBuf[200];
- assert( strlen(zPragma[i])<100 );
- sprintf(zBuf, "PRAGMA %s;", zPragma[i]);
- sVac.zPragma = zPragma[i];
- rc = sqlite_exec(db, zBuf, vacuumCallback3, &sVac, &zErrMsg);
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqlite_exec(db,
- "SELECT type, name, sql FROM sqlite_master "
- "WHERE sql NOT NULL AND type!='view' "
- "UNION ALL "
- "SELECT type, name, sql FROM sqlite_master "
- "WHERE sql NOT NULL AND type=='view'",
- vacuumCallback1, &sVac, &zErrMsg);
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqliteBtreeCopyFile(db->aDb[0].pBt, dbNew->aDb[0].pBt);
- sqlite_exec(db, "COMMIT", 0, 0, 0);
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, 0);
- }
-
-end_of_vacuum:
- if( rc && zErrMsg!=0 ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, "unable to vacuum database - ",
- zErrMsg, (char*)0);
- }
- sqlite_exec(db, "ROLLBACK", 0, 0, 0);
- if( dbNew ) sqlite_close(dbNew);
- sqliteOsDelete(zTemp);
- sqliteFree(zTemp);
- sqliteFree(sVac.s1.z);
- sqliteFree(sVac.s2.z);
- if( zErrMsg ) sqlite_freemem(zErrMsg);
- if( rc==STQLITE_ABORT ) sVac.rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- return sVac.rc;
-#endif
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbe.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbe.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 5171275..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbe.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,4885 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** The code in this file implements execution method of the
-** Virtual Database Engine (VDBE). A separate file ("vdbeaux.c")
-** handles housekeeping details such as creating and deleting
-** VDBE instances. This file is solely interested in executing
-** the VDBE program.
-**
-** In the external interface, an "sqlite_vm*" is an opaque pointer
-** to a VDBE.
-**
-** The SQL parser generates a program which is then executed by
-** the VDBE to do the work of the SQL statement. VDBE programs are
-** similar in form to assembly language. The program consists of
-** a linear sequence of operations. Each operation has an opcode
-** and 3 operands. Operands P1 and P2 are integers. Operand P3
-** is a null-terminated string. The P2 operand must be non-negative.
-** Opcodes will typically ignore one or more operands. Many opcodes
-** ignore all three operands.
-**
-** Computation results are stored on a stack. Each entry on the
-** stack is either an integer, a null-terminated string, a floating point
-** number, or the SQL "NULL" value. An inplicit conversion from one
-** type to the other occurs as necessary.
-**
-** Most of the code in this file is taken up by the sqliteVdbeExec()
-** function which does the work of interpreting a VDBE program.
-** But other routines are also provided to help in building up
-** a program instruction by instruction.
-**
-** Various scripts scan this source file in order to generate HTML
-** documentation, headers files, or other derived files. The formatting
-** of the code in this file is, therefore, important. See other comments
-** in this file for details. If in doubt, do not deviate from existing
-** commenting and indentation practices when changing or adding code.
-**
-** $Id: vdbe.c,v 1.268 2004/03/03 01:51:25 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include "os.h"
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include "vdbeInt.h"
-
-/*
-** The following global variable is incremented every time a cursor
-** moves, either by the OP_MoveTo or the OP_Next opcode. The test
-** procedures use this information to make sure that indices are
-** working correctly. This variable has no function other than to
-** help verify the correct operation of the library.
-*/
-int sqlite_search_count = 0;
-
-/*
-** When this global variable is positive, it gets decremented once before
-** each instruction in the VDBE. When reaches zero, the STQLITE_Interrupt
-** of the db.flags field is set in order to simulate and interrupt.
-**
-** This facility is used for testing purposes only. It does not function
-** in an ordinary build.
-*/
-int sqlite_interrupt_count = 0;
-
-/*
-** Advance the virtual machine to the next output row.
-**
-** The return vale will be either STQLITE_BUSY, STQLITE_DONE,
-** STQLITE_ROW, STQLITE_ERROR, or STQLITE_MISUSE.
-**
-** STQLITE_BUSY means that the virtual machine attempted to open
-** a locked database and there is no busy callback registered.
-** Call sqlite_step() again to retry the open. *pN is set to 0
-** and *pazColName and *pazValue are both set to NULL.
-**
-** STQLITE_DONE means that the virtual machine has finished
-** executing. sqlite_step() should not be called again on this
-** virtual machine. *pN and *pazColName are set appropriately
-** but *pazValue is set to NULL.
-**
-** STQLITE_ROW means that the virtual machine has generated another
-** row of the result set. *pN is set to the number of columns in
-** the row. *pazColName is set to the names of the columns followed
-** by the column datatypes. *pazValue is set to the values of each
-** column in the row. The value of the i-th column is (*pazValue)[i].
-** The name of the i-th column is (*pazColName)[i] and the datatype
-** of the i-th column is (*pazColName)[i+*pN].
-**
-** STQLITE_ERROR means that a run-time error (such as a constraint
-** violation) has occurred. The details of the error will be returned
-** by the next call to sqlite_finalize(). sqlite_step() should not
-** be called again on the VM.
-**
-** STQLITE_MISUSE means that the this routine was called inappropriately.
-** Perhaps it was called on a virtual machine that had already been
-** finalized or on one that had previously returned STQLITE_ERROR or
-** STQLITE_DONE. Or it could be the case the the same database connection
-** is being used simulataneously by two or more threads.
-*/
-int sqlite_step(
- sqlite_vm *pVm, /* The virtual machine to execute */
- int *pN, /* OUT: Number of columns in result */
- const char ***pazValue, /* OUT: Column data */
- const char ***pazColName /* OUT: Column names and datatypes */
-){
- Vdbe *p = (Vdbe*)pVm;
- sqlite *db;
- int rc;
-
- if( p->magic!=VDBE_MAGIC_RUN ){
- return STQLITE_MISUSE;
- }
- db = p->db;
- if( sqliteSafetyOn(db) ){
- p->rc = STQLITE_MISUSE;
- return STQLITE_MISUSE;
- }
- if( p->explain ){
- rc = sqliteVdbeList(p);
- }else{
- rc = sqliteVdbeExec(p);
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_DONE || rc==STQLITE_ROW ){
- if( pazColName ) *pazColName = (const char**)p->azColName;
- if( pN ) *pN = p->nResColumn;
- }else{
- if( pazColName) *pazColName = 0;
- if( pN ) *pN = 0;
- }
- if( pazValue ){
- if( rc==STQLITE_ROW ){
- *pazValue = (const char**)p->azResColumn;
- }else{
- *pazValue = 0;
- }
- }
- if( sqliteSafetyOff(db) ){
- return STQLITE_MISUSE;
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Insert a new aggregate element and make it the element that
-** has focus.
-**
-** Return 0 on success and 1 if memory is exhausted.
-*/
-static int AggInsert(Agg *p, char *zKey, int nKey){
- AggElem *pElem, *pOld;
- int i;
- Mem *pMem;
- pElem = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(AggElem) + nKey +
- (p->nMem-1)*sizeof(pElem->aMem[0]) );
- if( pElem==0 ) return 1;
- pElem->zKey = (char*)&pElem->aMem[p->nMem];
- memcpy(pElem->zKey, zKey, nKey);
- pElem->nKey = nKey;
- pOld = sqliteHashInsert(&p->hash, pElem->zKey, pElem->nKey, pElem);
- if( pOld!=0 ){
- assert( pOld==pElem ); /* Malloc failed on insert */
- sqliteFree(pOld);
- return 0;
- }
- for(i=0, pMem=pElem->aMem; i<p->nMem; i++, pMem++){
- pMem->flags = MEM_Null;
- }
- p->pCurrent = pElem;
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Get the AggElem currently in focus
-*/
-#define AggInFocus(P) ((P).pCurrent ? (P).pCurrent : _AggInFocus(&(P)))
-static AggElem *_AggInFocus(Agg *p){
- HashElem *pElem = sqliteHashFirst(&p->hash);
- if( pElem==0 ){
- AggInsert(p,"",1);
- pElem = sqliteHashFirst(&p->hash);
- }
- return pElem ? sqliteHashData(pElem) : 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Convert the given stack entity into a string if it isn't one
-** already.
-*/
-#define Stringify(P) if(((P)->flags & MEM_Str)==0){hardStringify(P);}
-static int hardStringify(Mem *pStack){
- int fg = pStack->flags;
- if( fg & MEM_Real ){
- sqlite_snprintf(sizeof(pStack->zShort),pStack->zShort,"%.15g",pStack->r);
- }else if( fg & MEM_Int ){
- sqlite_snprintf(sizeof(pStack->zShort),pStack->zShort,"%d",pStack->i);
- }else{
- pStack->zShort[0] = 0;
- }
- pStack->z = pStack->zShort;
- pStack->n = strlen(pStack->zShort)+1;
- pStack->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Short;
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Convert the given stack entity into a string that has been obtained
-** from sqliteMalloc(). This is different from Stringify() above in that
-** Stringify() will use the NBFS bytes of static string space if the string
-** will fit but this routine always mallocs for space.
-** Return non-zero if we run out of memory.
-*/
-#define Dynamicify(P) (((P)->flags & MEM_Dyn)==0 ? hardDynamicify(P):0)
-static int hardDynamicify(Mem *pStack){
- int fg = pStack->flags;
- char *z;
- if( (fg & MEM_Str)==0 ){
- hardStringify(pStack);
- }
- assert( (fg & MEM_Dyn)==0 );
- z = sqliteMallocRaw( pStack->n );
- if( z==0 ) return 1;
- memcpy(z, pStack->z, pStack->n);
- pStack->z = z;
- pStack->flags |= MEM_Dyn;
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** An ephemeral string value (signified by the MEM_Ephem flag) contains
-** a pointer to a dynamically allocated string where some other entity
-** is responsible for deallocating that string. Because the stack entry
-** does not control the string, it might be deleted without the stack
-** entry knowing it.
-**
-** This routine converts an ephemeral string into a dynamically allocated
-** string that the stack entry itself controls. In other words, it
-** converts an MEM_Ephem string into an MEM_Dyn string.
-*/
-#define Deephemeralize(P) \
- if( ((P)->flags&MEM_Ephem)!=0 && hardDeephem(P) ){ goto no_mem;}
-static int hardDeephem(Mem *pStack){
- char *z;
- assert( (pStack->flags & MEM_Ephem)!=0 );
- z = sqliteMallocRaw( pStack->n );
- if( z==0 ) return 1;
- memcpy(z, pStack->z, pStack->n);
- pStack->z = z;
- pStack->flags &= ~MEM_Ephem;
- pStack->flags |= MEM_Dyn;
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Release the memory associated with the given stack level. This
-** leaves the Mem.flags field in an inconsistent state.
-*/
-#define Release(P) if((P)->flags&MEM_Dyn){ sqliteFree((P)->z); }
-
-/*
-** Pop the stack N times.
-*/
-static void popStack(Mem **ppTos, int N){
- Mem *pTos = *ppTos;
- while( N>0 ){
- N--;
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- }
- *ppTos = pTos;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return TRUE if zNum is a 32-bit signed integer and write
-** the value of the integer into *pNum. If zNum is not an integer
-** or is an integer that is too large to be expressed with just 32
-** bits, then return false.
-**
-** Under Linux (RedHat 7.2) this routine is much faster than atoi()
-** for converting strings into integers.
-*/
-static int toInt(const char *zNum, int *pNum){
- int v = 0;
- int neg;
- int i, c;
- if( *zNum=='-' ){
- neg = 1;
- zNum++;
- }else if( *zNum=='+' ){
- neg = 0;
- zNum++;
- }else{
- neg = 0;
- }
- for(i=0; (c=zNum[i])>='0' && c<='9'; i++){
- v = v*10 + c - '0';
- }
- *pNum = neg ? -v : v;
- return c==0 && i>0 && (i<10 || (i==10 && memcmp(zNum,"2147483647",10)<=0));
-}
-
-/*
-** Convert the given stack entity into a integer if it isn't one
-** already.
-**
-** Any prior string or real representation is invalidated.
-** NULLs are converted into 0.
-*/
-#define Integerify(P) if(((P)->flags&MEM_Int)==0){ hardIntegerify(P); }
-static void hardIntegerify(Mem *pStack){
- if( pStack->flags & MEM_Real ){
- pStack->i = (int)pStack->r;
- Release(pStack);
- }else if( pStack->flags & MEM_Str ){
- toInt(pStack->z, &pStack->i);
- Release(pStack);
- }else{
- pStack->i = 0;
- }
- pStack->flags = MEM_Int;
-}
-
-/*
-** Get a valid Real representation for the given stack element.
-**
-** Any prior string or integer representation is retained.
-** NULLs are converted into 0.0.
-*/
-#define Realify(P) if(((P)->flags&MEM_Real)==0){ hardRealify(P); }
-static void hardRealify(Mem *pStack){
- if( pStack->flags & MEM_Str ){
- pStack->r = sqliteAtoF(pStack->z, 0);
- }else if( pStack->flags & MEM_Int ){
- pStack->r = pStack->i;
- }else{
- pStack->r = 0.0;
- }
- pStack->flags |= MEM_Real;
-}
-
-/*
-** The parameters are pointers to the head of two sorted lists
-** of Sorter structures. Merge these two lists together and return
-** a single sorted list. This routine forms the core of the merge-sort
-** algorithm.
-**
-** In the case of a tie, left sorts in front of right.
-*/
-static Sorter *Merge(Sorter *pLeft, Sorter *pRight){
- Sorter sHead;
- Sorter *pTail;
- pTail = &sHead;
- pTail->pNext = 0;
- while( pLeft && pRight ){
- int c = sqliteSortCompare(pLeft->zKey, pRight->zKey);
- if( c<=0 ){
- pTail->pNext = pLeft;
- pLeft = pLeft->pNext;
- }else{
- pTail->pNext = pRight;
- pRight = pRight->pNext;
- }
- pTail = pTail->pNext;
- }
- if( pLeft ){
- pTail->pNext = pLeft;
- }else if( pRight ){
- pTail->pNext = pRight;
- }
- return sHead.pNext;
-}
-
-/*
-** The following routine works like a replacement for the standard
-** library routine fgets(). The difference is in how end-of-line (EOL)
-** is handled. Standard fgets() uses LF for EOL under unix, CRLF
-** under windows, and CR under mac. This routine accepts any of these
-** character sequences as an EOL mark. The EOL mark is replaced by
-** a single LF character in zBuf.
-*/
-static char *vdbe_fgets(char *zBuf, int nBuf, FILE *in){
- int i, c;
- for(i=0; i<nBuf-1 && (c=getc(in))!=EOF; i++){
- zBuf[i] = c;
- if( c=='\r' || c=='\n' ){
- if( c=='\r' ){
- zBuf[i] = '\n';
- c = getc(in);
- if( c!=EOF && c!='\n' ) ungetc(c, in);
- }
- i++;
- break;
- }
- }
- zBuf[i] = 0;
- return i>0 ? zBuf : 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Make sure there is space in the Vdbe structure to hold at least
-** mxCursor cursors. If there is not currently enough space, then
-** allocate more.
-**
-** If a memory allocation error occurs, return 1. Return 0 if
-** everything works.
-*/
-static int expandCursorArraySize(Vdbe *p, int mxCursor){
- if( mxCursor>=p->nCursor ){
- Cursor *aCsr = sqliteRealloc( p->aCsr, (mxCursor+1)*sizeof(Cursor) );
- if( aCsr==0 ) return 1;
- p->aCsr = aCsr;
- memset(&p->aCsr[p->nCursor], 0, sizeof(Cursor)*(mxCursor+1-p->nCursor));
- p->nCursor = mxCursor+1;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE
-/*
-** The following routine only works on pentium-class processors.
-** It uses the RDTSC opcode to read cycle count value out of the
-** processor and returns that value. This can be used for high-res
-** profiling.
-*/
-__inline__ unsigned long long int hwtime(void){
- unsigned long long int x;
- __asm__("rdtsc\n\t"
- "mov %%edx, %%ecx\n\t"
- :"=A" (x));
- return x;
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-** The CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPT macro defined here looks to see if the
-** sqlite_interrupt() routine has been called. If it has been, then
-** processing of the VDBE program is interrupted.
-**
-** This macro added to every instruction that does a jump in order to
-** implement a loop. This test used to be on every single instruction,
-** but that meant we more testing that we needed. By only testing the
-** flag on jump instructions, we get a (small) speed improvement.
-*/
-#define CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPT \
- if( db->flags & STQLITE_Interrupt ) goto abort_due_to_interrupt;
-
-
-/*
-** Execute as much of a VDBE program as we can then return.
-**
-** sqliteVdbeMakeReady() must be called before this routine in order to
-** close the program with a final OP_Halt and to set up the callbacks
-** and the error message pointer.
-**
-** Whenever a row or result data is available, this routine will either
-** invoke the result callback (if there is one) or return with
-** STQLITE_ROW.
-**
-** If an attempt is made to open a locked database, then this routine
-** will either invoke the busy callback (if there is one) or it will
-** return STQLITE_BUSY.
-**
-** If an error occurs, an error message is written to memory obtained
-** from sqliteMalloc() and p->zErrMsg is made to point to that memory.
-** The error code is stored in p->rc and this routine returns STQLITE_ERROR.
-**
-** If the callback ever returns non-zero, then the program exits
-** immediately. There will be no error message but the p->rc field is
-** set to STQLITE_ABORT and this routine will return STQLITE_ERROR.
-**
-** A memory allocation error causes p->rc to be set to STQLITE_NOMEM and this
-** routine to return STQLITE_ERROR.
-**
-** Other fatal errors return STQLITE_ERROR.
-**
-** After this routine has finished, sqliteVdbeFinalize() should be
-** used to clean up the mess that was left behind.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeExec(
- Vdbe *p /* The VDBE */
-){
- int pc; /* The program counter */
- Op *pOp; /* Current operation */
- int rc = STQLITE_OK; /* Value to return */
- sqlite *db = p->db; /* The database */
- Mem *pTos; /* Top entry in the operand stack */
- char zBuf[100]; /* Space to sprintf() an integer */
-#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE
- unsigned long long start; /* CPU clock count at start of opcode */
- int origPc; /* Program counter at start of opcode */
-#endif
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_PROGRESS_CALLBACK
- int nProgressOps = 0; /* Opcodes executed since progress callback. */
-#endif
-
- if( p->magic!=VDBE_MAGIC_RUN ) return STQLITE_MISUSE;
- assert( db->magic==STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY );
- assert( p->rc==STQLITE_OK || p->rc==STQLITE_BUSY );
- p->rc = STQLITE_OK;
- assert( p->explain==0 );
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto no_mem;
- pTos = p->pTos;
- if( p->popStack ){
- popStack(&pTos, p->popStack);
- p->popStack = 0;
- }
- CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPT;
- for(pc=p->pc; rc==STQLITE_OK; pc++){
- assert( pc>=0 && pc<p->nOp );
- assert( pTos<=&p->aStack[pc] );
-#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE
- origPc = pc;
- start = hwtime();
-#endif
- pOp = &p->aOp[pc];
-
- /* Only allow tracing if NDEBUG is not defined.
- */
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( p->trace ){
- sqliteVdbePrintOp(p->trace, pc, pOp);
- }
-#endif
-
- /* Check to see if we need to simulate an interrupt. This only happens
- ** if we have a special test build.
- */
-#ifdef STQLITE_TEST
- if( sqlite_interrupt_count>0 ){
- sqlite_interrupt_count--;
- if( sqlite_interrupt_count==0 ){
- sqlite_interrupt(db);
- }
- }
-#endif
-
-#ifndef STQLITE_OMIT_PROGRESS_CALLBACK
- /* Call the progress callback if it is configured and the required number
- ** of VDBE ops have been executed (either since this invocation of
- ** sqliteVdbeExec() or since last time the progress callback was called).
- ** If the progress callback returns non-zero, exit the virtual machine with
- ** a return code STQLITE_ABORT.
- */
- if( db->xProgress ){
- if( db->nProgressOps==nProgressOps ){
- if( db->xProgress(db->pProgressArg)!=0 ){
- rc = STQLITE_ABORT;
- continue; /* skip to the next iteration of the for loop */
- }
- nProgressOps = 0;
- }
- nProgressOps++;
- }
-#endif
-
- switch( pOp->opcode ){
-
-/*****************************************************************************
-** What follows is a massive switch statement where each case implements a
-** separate instruction in the virtual machine. If we follow the usual
-** indentation conventions, each case should be indented by 6 spaces. But
-** that is a lot of wasted space on the left margin. So the code within
-** the switch statement will break with convention and be flush-left. Another
-** big comment (similar to this one) will mark the point in the code where
-** we transition back to normal indentation.
-**
-** The formatting of each case is important. The makefile for STQLite
-** generates two C files "opcodes.h" and "opcodes.c" by scanning this
-** file looking for lines that begin with "case OP_". The opcodes.h files
-** will be filled with #defines that give unique integer values to each
-** opcode and the opcodes.c file is filled with an array of strings where
-** each string is the symbolic name for the corresponding opcode.
-**
-** Documentation about VDBE opcodes is generated by scanning this file
-** for lines of that contain "Opcode:". That line and all subsequent
-** comment lines are used in the generation of the opcode.html documentation
-** file.
-**
-** SUMMARY:
-**
-** Formatting is important to scripts that scan this file.
-** Do not deviate from the formatting style currently in use.
-**
-*****************************************************************************/
-
-/* Opcode: Goto * P2 *
-**
-** An unconditional jump to address P2.
-** The next instruction executed will be
-** the one at index P2 from the beginning of
-** the program.
-*/
-case OP_Goto: {
- CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPT;
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Gosub * P2 *
-**
-** Push the current address plus 1 onto the return address stack
-** and then jump to address P2.
-**
-** The return address stack is of limited depth. If too many
-** OP_Gosub operations occur without intervening OP_Returns, then
-** the return address stack will fill up and processing will abort
-** with a fatal error.
-*/
-case OP_Gosub: {
- if( p->returnDepth>=sizeof(p->returnStack)/sizeof(p->returnStack[0]) ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, "return address stack overflow", (char*)0);
- p->rc = STQLITE_INTERNAL;
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- p->returnStack[p->returnDepth++] = pc+1;
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Return * * *
-**
-** Jump immediately to the next instruction after the last unreturned
-** OP_Gosub. If an OP_Return has occurred for all OP_Gosubs, then
-** processing aborts with a fatal error.
-*/
-case OP_Return: {
- if( p->returnDepth<=0 ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, "return address stack underflow", (char*)0);
- p->rc = STQLITE_INTERNAL;
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- p->returnDepth--;
- pc = p->returnStack[p->returnDepth] - 1;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Halt P1 P2 *
-**
-** Exit immediately. All open cursors, Lists, Sorts, etc are closed
-** automatically.
-**
-** P1 is the result code returned by sqlite_exec(). For a normal
-** halt, this should be STQLITE_OK (0). For errors, it can be some
-** other value. If P1!=0 then P2 will determine whether or not to
-** rollback the current transaction. Do not rollback if P2==OE_Fail.
-** Do the rollback if P2==OE_Rollback. If P2==OE_Abort, then back
-** out all changes that have occurred during this execution of the
-** VDBE, but do not rollback the transaction.
-**
-** There is an implied "Halt 0 0 0" instruction inserted at the very end of
-** every program. So a jump past the last instruction of the program
-** is the same as executing Halt.
-*/
-case OP_Halt: {
- p->magic = VDBE_MAGIC_HALT;
- p->pTos = pTos;
- if( pOp->p1!=STQLITE_OK ){
- p->rc = pOp->p1;
- p->errorAction = pOp->p2;
- if( pOp->p3 ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, pOp->p3, (char*)0);
- }
- return STQLITE_ERROR;
- }else{
- p->rc = STQLITE_OK;
- return STQLITE_DONE;
- }
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Integer P1 * P3
-**
-** The integer value P1 is pushed onto the stack. If P3 is not zero
-** then it is assumed to be a string representation of the same integer.
-*/
-case OP_Integer: {
- pTos++;
- pTos->i = pOp->p1;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- if( pOp->p3 ){
- pTos->z = pOp->p3;
- pTos->flags |= MEM_Str | MEM_Static;
- pTos->n = strlen(pOp->p3)+1;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: String * * P3
-**
-** The string value P3 is pushed onto the stack. If P3==0 then a
-** NULL is pushed onto the stack.
-*/
-case OP_String: {
- char *z = pOp->p3;
- pTos++;
- if( z==0 ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }else{
- pTos->z = z;
- pTos->n = strlen(z) + 1;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Static;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Variable P1 * *
-**
-** Push the value of variable P1 onto the stack. A variable is
-** an unknown in the original SQL string as handed to sqlite_compile().
-** Any occurance of the '?' character in the original SQL is considered
-** a variable. Variables in the SQL string are number from left to
-** right beginning with 1. The values of variables are set using the
-** sqlite_bind() API.
-*/
-case OP_Variable: {
- int j = pOp->p1 - 1;
- pTos++;
- if( j>=0 && j<p->nVar && p->azVar[j]!=0 ){
- pTos->z = p->azVar[j];
- pTos->n = p->anVar[j];
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Static;
- }else{
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Pop P1 * *
-**
-** P1 elements are popped off of the top of stack and discarded.
-*/
-case OP_Pop: {
- assert( pOp->p1>=0 );
- popStack(&pTos, pOp->p1);
- assert( pTos>=&p->aStack[-1] );
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Dup P1 P2 *
-**
-** A copy of the P1-th element of the stack
-** is made and pushed onto the top of the stack.
-** The top of the stack is element 0. So the
-** instruction "Dup 0 0 0" will make a copy of the
-** top of the stack.
-**
-** If the content of the P1-th element is a dynamically
-** allocated string, then a new copy of that string
-** is made if P2==0. If P2!=0, then just a pointer
-** to the string is copied.
-**
-** Also see the Pull instruction.
-*/
-case OP_Dup: {
- Mem *pFrom = &pTos[-pOp->p1];
- assert( pFrom<=pTos && pFrom>=p->aStack );
- pTos++;
- memcpy(pTos, pFrom, sizeof(*pFrom)-NBFS);
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Str ){
- if( pOp->p2 && (pTos->flags & (MEM_Dyn|MEM_Ephem)) ){
- pTos->flags &= ~MEM_Dyn;
- pTos->flags |= MEM_Ephem;
- }else if( pTos->flags & MEM_Short ){
- memcpy(pTos->zShort, pFrom->zShort, pTos->n);
- pTos->z = pTos->zShort;
- }else if( (pTos->flags & MEM_Static)==0 ){
- pTos->z = sqliteMallocRaw(pFrom->n);
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto no_mem;
- memcpy(pTos->z, pFrom->z, pFrom->n);
- pTos->flags &= ~(MEM_Static|MEM_Ephem|MEM_Short);
- pTos->flags |= MEM_Dyn;
- }
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Pull P1 * *
-**
-** The P1-th element is removed from its current location on
-** the stack and pushed back on top of the stack. The
-** top of the stack is element 0, so "Pull 0 0 0" is
-** a no-op. "Pull 1 0 0" swaps the top two elements of
-** the stack.
-**
-** See also the Dup instruction.
-*/
-case OP_Pull: {
- Mem *pFrom = &pTos[-pOp->p1];
- int i;
- Mem ts;
-
- ts = *pFrom;
- Deephemeralize(pTos);
- for(i=0; i<pOp->p1; i++, pFrom++){
- Deephemeralize(&pFrom[1]);
- *pFrom = pFrom[1];
- assert( (pFrom->flags & MEM_Ephem)==0 );
- if( pFrom->flags & MEM_Short ){
- assert( pFrom->flags & MEM_Str );
- assert( pFrom->z==pFrom[1].zShort );
- pFrom->z = pFrom->zShort;
- }
- }
- *pTos = ts;
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Short ){
- assert( pTos->flags & MEM_Str );
- assert( pTos->z==pTos[-pOp->p1].zShort );
- pTos->z = pTos->zShort;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Push P1 * *
-**
-** Overwrite the value of the P1-th element down on the
-** stack (P1==0 is the top of the stack) with the value
-** of the top of the stack. Then pop the top of the stack.
-*/
-case OP_Push: {
- Mem *pTo = &pTos[-pOp->p1];
-
- assert( pTo>=p->aStack );
- Deephemeralize(pTos);
- Release(pTo);
- *pTo = *pTos;
- if( pTo->flags & MEM_Short ){
- assert( pTo->z==pTos->zShort );
- pTo->z = pTo->zShort;
- }
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-
-/* Opcode: ColumnName P1 P2 P3
-**
-** P3 becomes the P1-th column name (first is 0). An array of pointers
-** to all column names is passed as the 4th parameter to the callback.
-** If P2==1 then this is the last column in the result set and thus the
-** number of columns in the result set will be P1. There must be at least
-** one OP_ColumnName with a P2==1 before invoking OP_Callback and the
-** number of columns specified in OP_Callback must one more than the P1
-** value of the OP_ColumnName that has P2==1.
-*/
-case OP_ColumnName: {
- assert( pOp->p1>=0 && pOp->p1<p->nOp );
- p->azColName[pOp->p1] = pOp->p3;
- p->nCallback = 0;
- if( pOp->p2 ) p->nResColumn = pOp->p1+1;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Callback P1 * *
-**
-** Pop P1 values off the stack and form them into an array. Then
-** invoke the callback function using the newly formed array as the
-** 3rd parameter.
-*/
-case OP_Callback: {
- int i;
- char **azArgv = p->zArgv;
- Mem *pCol;
-
- pCol = &pTos[1-pOp->p1];
- assert( pCol>=p->aStack );
- for(i=0; i<pOp->p1; i++, pCol++){
- if( pCol->flags & MEM_Null ){
- azArgv[i] = 0;
- }else{
- Stringify(pCol);
- azArgv[i] = pCol->z;
- }
- }
- azArgv[i] = 0;
- p->nCallback++;
- p->azResColumn = azArgv;
- assert( p->nResColumn==pOp->p1 );
- p->popStack = pOp->p1;
- p->pc = pc + 1;
- p->pTos = pTos;
- return STQLITE_ROW;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Concat P1 P2 P3
-**
-** Look at the first P1 elements of the stack. Append them all
-** together with the lowest element first. Use P3 as a separator.
-** Put the result on the top of the stack. The original P1 elements
-** are popped from the stack if P2==0 and retained if P2==1. If
-** any element of the stack is NULL, then the result is NULL.
-**
-** If P3 is NULL, then use no separator. When P1==1, this routine
-** makes a copy of the top stack element into memory obtained
-** from sqliteMalloc().
-*/
-case OP_Concat: {
- char *zNew;
- int nByte;
- int nField;
- int i, j;
- char *zSep;
- int nSep;
- Mem *pTerm;
-
- nField = pOp->p1;
- zSep = pOp->p3;
- if( zSep==0 ) zSep = "";
- nSep = strlen(zSep);
- assert( &pTos[1-nField] >= p->aStack );
- nByte = 1 - nSep;
- pTerm = &pTos[1-nField];
- for(i=0; i<nField; i++, pTerm++){
- if( pTerm->flags & MEM_Null ){
- nByte = -1;
- break;
- }else{
- Stringify(pTerm);
- nByte += pTerm->n - 1 + nSep;
- }
- }
- if( nByte<0 ){
- if( pOp->p2==0 ){
- popStack(&pTos, nField);
- }
- pTos++;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- break;
- }
- zNew = sqliteMallocRaw( nByte );
- if( zNew==0 ) goto no_mem;
- j = 0;
- pTerm = &pTos[1-nField];
- for(i=j=0; i<nField; i++, pTerm++){
- assert( pTerm->flags & MEM_Str );
- memcpy(&zNew[j], pTerm->z, pTerm->n-1);
- j += pTerm->n-1;
- if( nSep>0 && i<nField-1 ){
- memcpy(&zNew[j], zSep, nSep);
- j += nSep;
- }
- }
- zNew[j] = 0;
- if( pOp->p2==0 ){
- popStack(&pTos, nField);
- }
- pTos++;
- pTos->n = nByte;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str|MEM_Dyn;
- pTos->z = zNew;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Add * * *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack, add them together,
-** and push the result back onto the stack. If either element
-** is a string then it is converted to a double using the atof()
-** function before the addition.
-** If either operand is NULL, the result is NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: Multiply * * *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack, multiply them together,
-** and push the result back onto the stack. If either element
-** is a string then it is converted to a double using the atof()
-** function before the multiplication.
-** If either operand is NULL, the result is NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: Subtract * * *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack, subtract the
-** first (what was on top of the stack) from the second (the
-** next on stack)
-** and push the result back onto the stack. If either element
-** is a string then it is converted to a double using the atof()
-** function before the subtraction.
-** If either operand is NULL, the result is NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: Divide * * *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack, divide the
-** first (what was on top of the stack) from the second (the
-** next on stack)
-** and push the result back onto the stack. If either element
-** is a string then it is converted to a double using the atof()
-** function before the division. Division by zero returns NULL.
-** If either operand is NULL, the result is NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: Remainder * * *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack, divide the
-** first (what was on top of the stack) from the second (the
-** next on stack)
-** and push the remainder after division onto the stack. If either element
-** is a string then it is converted to a double using the atof()
-** function before the division. Division by zero returns NULL.
-** If either operand is NULL, the result is NULL.
-*/
-case OP_Add:
-case OP_Subtract:
-case OP_Multiply:
-case OP_Divide:
-case OP_Remainder: {
- Mem *pNos = &pTos[-1];
- assert( pNos>=p->aStack );
- if( ((pTos->flags | pNos->flags) & MEM_Null)!=0 ){
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- Release(pTos);
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }else if( (pTos->flags & pNos->flags & MEM_Int)==MEM_Int ){
- int a, b;
- a = pTos->i;
- b = pNos->i;
- switch( pOp->opcode ){
- case OP_Add: b += a; break;
- case OP_Subtract: b -= a; break;
- case OP_Multiply: b *= a; break;
- case OP_Divide: {
- if( a==0 ) goto divide_by_zero;
- b /= a;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- if( a==0 ) goto divide_by_zero;
- b %= a;
- break;
- }
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- Release(pTos);
- pTos->i = b;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- }else{
- double a, b;
- Realify(pTos);
- Realify(pNos);
- a = pTos->r;
- b = pNos->r;
- switch( pOp->opcode ){
- case OP_Add: b += a; break;
- case OP_Subtract: b -= a; break;
- case OP_Multiply: b *= a; break;
- case OP_Divide: {
- if( a==0.0 ) goto divide_by_zero;
- b /= a;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- int ia = (int)a;
- int ib = (int)b;
- if( ia==0.0 ) goto divide_by_zero;
- b = ib % ia;
- break;
- }
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- Release(pTos);
- pTos->r = b;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Real;
- }
- break;
-
-divide_by_zero:
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- Release(pTos);
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Function P1 * P3
-**
-** Invoke a user function (P3 is a pointer to a Function structure that
-** defines the function) with P1 string arguments taken from the stack.
-** Pop all arguments from the stack and push back the result.
-**
-** See also: AggFunc
-*/
-case OP_Function: {
- int n, i;
- Mem *pArg;
- char **azArgv;
- sqlite_func ctx;
-
- n = pOp->p1;
- pArg = &pTos[1-n];
- azArgv = p->zArgv;
- for(i=0; i<n; i++, pArg++){
- if( pArg->flags & MEM_Null ){
- azArgv[i] = 0;
- }else{
- Stringify(pArg);
- azArgv[i] = pArg->z;
- }
- }
- ctx.pFunc = (FuncDef*)pOp->p3;
- ctx.s.flags = MEM_Null;
- ctx.s.z = 0;
- ctx.isError = 0;
- ctx.isStep = 0;
- if( sqliteSafetyOff(db) ) goto abort_due_to_misuse;
- (*ctx.pFunc->xFunc)(&ctx, n, (const char**)azArgv);
- if( sqliteSafetyOn(db) ) goto abort_due_to_misuse;
- popStack(&pTos, n);
- pTos++;
- *pTos = ctx.s;
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Short ){
- pTos->z = pTos->zShort;
- }
- if( ctx.isError ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg,
- (pTos->flags & MEM_Str)!=0 ? pTos->z : "user function error", (char*)0);
- rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: BitAnd * * *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. Convert both elements
-** to integers. Push back onto the stack the bit-wise AND of the
-** two elements.
-** If either operand is NULL, the result is NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: BitOr * * *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. Convert both elements
-** to integers. Push back onto the stack the bit-wise OR of the
-** two elements.
-** If either operand is NULL, the result is NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: ShiftLeft * * *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. Convert both elements
-** to integers. Push back onto the stack the top element shifted
-** left by N bits where N is the second element on the stack.
-** If either operand is NULL, the result is NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: ShiftRight * * *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. Convert both elements
-** to integers. Push back onto the stack the top element shifted
-** right by N bits where N is the second element on the stack.
-** If either operand is NULL, the result is NULL.
-*/
-case OP_BitAnd:
-case OP_BitOr:
-case OP_ShiftLeft:
-case OP_ShiftRight: {
- Mem *pNos = &pTos[-1];
- int a, b;
-
- assert( pNos>=p->aStack );
- if( (pTos->flags | pNos->flags) & MEM_Null ){
- popStack(&pTos, 2);
- pTos++;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- break;
- }
- Integerify(pTos);
- Integerify(pNos);
- a = pTos->i;
- b = pNos->i;
- switch( pOp->opcode ){
- case OP_BitAnd: a &= b; break;
- case OP_BitOr: a |= b; break;
- case OP_ShiftLeft: a <<= b; break;
- case OP_ShiftRight: a >>= b; break;
- default: /* CANT HAPPEN */ break;
- }
- assert( (pTos->flags & MEM_Dyn)==0 );
- assert( (pNos->flags & MEM_Dyn)==0 );
- pTos--;
- Release(pTos);
- pTos->i = a;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: AddImm P1 * *
-**
-** Add the value P1 to whatever is on top of the stack. The result
-** is always an integer.
-**
-** To force the top of the stack to be an integer, just add 0.
-*/
-case OP_AddImm: {
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- Integerify(pTos);
- pTos->i += pOp->p1;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: ForceInt P1 P2 *
-**
-** Convert the top of the stack into an integer. If the current top of
-** the stack is not numeric (meaning that is is a NULL or a string that
-** does not look like an integer or floating point number) then pop the
-** stack and jump to P2. If the top of the stack is numeric then
-** convert it into the least integer that is greater than or equal to its
-** current value if P1==0, or to the least integer that is strictly
-** greater than its current value if P1==1.
-*/
-case OP_ForceInt: {
- int v;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- if( (pTos->flags & (MEM_Int|MEM_Real))==0
- && ((pTos->flags & MEM_Str)==0 || sqliteIsNumber(pTos->z)==0) ){
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- break;
- }
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Int ){
- v = pTos->i + (pOp->p1!=0);
- }else{
- Realify(pTos);
- v = (int)pTos->r;
- if( pTos->r>(double)v ) v++;
- if( pOp->p1 && pTos->r==(double)v ) v++;
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos->i = v;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: MustBeInt P1 P2 *
-**
-** Force the top of the stack to be an integer. If the top of the
-** stack is not an integer and cannot be converted into an integer
-** with out data loss, then jump immediately to P2, or if P2==0
-** raise an STQLITE_MISMATCH exception.
-**
-** If the top of the stack is not an integer and P2 is not zero and
-** P1 is 1, then the stack is popped. In all other cases, the depth
-** of the stack is unchanged.
-*/
-case OP_MustBeInt: {
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Int ){
- /* Do nothing */
- }else if( pTos->flags & MEM_Real ){
- int i = (int)pTos->r;
- double r = (double)i;
- if( r!=pTos->r ){
- goto mismatch;
- }
- pTos->i = i;
- }else if( pTos->flags & MEM_Str ){
- int v;
- if( !toInt(pTos->z, &v) ){
- double r;
- if( !sqliteIsNumber(pTos->z) ){
- goto mismatch;
- }
- Realify(pTos);
- v = (int)pTos->r;
- r = (double)v;
- if( r!=pTos->r ){
- goto mismatch;
- }
- }
- pTos->i = v;
- }else{
- goto mismatch;
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- break;
-
-mismatch:
- if( pOp->p2==0 ){
- rc = STQLITE_MISMATCH;
- goto abort_due_to_error;
- }else{
- if( pOp->p1 ) popStack(&pTos, 1);
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Eq P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If they are equal, then
-** jump to instruction P2. Otherwise, continue to the next instruction.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** If both values are numeric, they are converted to doubles using atof()
-** and compared for equality that way. Otherwise the strcmp() library
-** routine is used for the comparison. For a pure text comparison
-** use OP_StrEq.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: Ne P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If they are not equal, then
-** jump to instruction P2. Otherwise, continue to the next instruction.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** If both values are numeric, they are converted to doubles using atof()
-** and compared in that format. Otherwise the strcmp() library
-** routine is used for the comparison. For a pure text comparison
-** use OP_StrNe.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: Lt P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If second element (the
-** next on stack) is less than the first (the top of stack), then
-** jump to instruction P2. Otherwise, continue to the next instruction.
-** In other words, jump if NOS<TOS.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** If both values are numeric, they are converted to doubles using atof()
-** and compared in that format. Numeric values are always less than
-** non-numeric values. If both operands are non-numeric, the strcmp() library
-** routine is used for the comparison. For a pure text comparison
-** use OP_StrLt.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: Le P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If second element (the
-** next on stack) is less than or equal to the first (the top of stack),
-** then jump to instruction P2. In other words, jump if NOS<=TOS.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** If both values are numeric, they are converted to doubles using atof()
-** and compared in that format. Numeric values are always less than
-** non-numeric values. If both operands are non-numeric, the strcmp() library
-** routine is used for the comparison. For a pure text comparison
-** use OP_StrLe.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: Gt P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If second element (the
-** next on stack) is greater than the first (the top of stack),
-** then jump to instruction P2. In other words, jump if NOS>TOS.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** If both values are numeric, they are converted to doubles using atof()
-** and compared in that format. Numeric values are always less than
-** non-numeric values. If both operands are non-numeric, the strcmp() library
-** routine is used for the comparison. For a pure text comparison
-** use OP_StrGt.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: Ge P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If second element (the next
-** on stack) is greater than or equal to the first (the top of stack),
-** then jump to instruction P2. In other words, jump if NOS>=TOS.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** If both values are numeric, they are converted to doubles using atof()
-** and compared in that format. Numeric values are always less than
-** non-numeric values. If both operands are non-numeric, the strcmp() library
-** routine is used for the comparison. For a pure text comparison
-** use OP_StrGe.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-case OP_Eq:
-case OP_Ne:
-case OP_Lt:
-case OP_Le:
-case OP_Gt:
-case OP_Ge: {
- Mem *pNos = &pTos[-1];
- int c, v;
- int ft, fn;
- assert( pNos>=p->aStack );
- ft = pTos->flags;
- fn = pNos->flags;
- if( (ft | fn) & MEM_Null ){
- popStack(&pTos, 2);
- if( pOp->p2 ){
- if( pOp->p1 ) pc = pOp->p2-1;
- }else{
- pTos++;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }
- break;
- }else if( (ft & fn & MEM_Int)==MEM_Int ){
- c = pNos->i - pTos->i;
- }else if( (ft & MEM_Int)!=0 && (fn & MEM_Str)!=0 && toInt(pNos->z,&v) ){
- c = v - pTos->i;
- }else if( (fn & MEM_Int)!=0 && (ft & MEM_Str)!=0 && toInt(pTos->z,&v) ){
- c = pNos->i - v;
- }else{
- Stringify(pTos);
- Stringify(pNos);
- c = sqliteCompare(pNos->z, pTos->z);
- }
- switch( pOp->opcode ){
- case OP_Eq: c = c==0; break;
- case OP_Ne: c = c!=0; break;
- case OP_Lt: c = c<0; break;
- case OP_Le: c = c<=0; break;
- case OP_Gt: c = c>0; break;
- default: c = c>=0; break;
- }
- popStack(&pTos, 2);
- if( pOp->p2 ){
- if( c ) pc = pOp->p2-1;
- }else{
- pTos++;
- pTos->i = c;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- }
- break;
-}
-/* INSERT NO CODE HERE!
-**
-** The opcode numbers are extracted from this source file by doing
-**
-** grep '^case OP_' vdbe.c | ... >opcodes.h
-**
-** The opcodes are numbered in the order that they appear in this file.
-** But in order for the expression generating code to work right, the
-** string comparison operators that follow must be numbered exactly 6
-** greater than the numeric comparison opcodes above. So no other
-** cases can appear between the two.
-*/
-/* Opcode: StrEq P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If they are equal, then
-** jump to instruction P2. Otherwise, continue to the next instruction.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** The strcmp() library routine is used for the comparison. For a
-** numeric comparison, use OP_Eq.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: StrNe P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If they are not equal, then
-** jump to instruction P2. Otherwise, continue to the next instruction.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** The strcmp() library routine is used for the comparison. For a
-** numeric comparison, use OP_Ne.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: StrLt P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If second element (the
-** next on stack) is less than the first (the top of stack), then
-** jump to instruction P2. Otherwise, continue to the next instruction.
-** In other words, jump if NOS<TOS.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** The strcmp() library routine is used for the comparison. For a
-** numeric comparison, use OP_Lt.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: StrLe P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If second element (the
-** next on stack) is less than or equal to the first (the top of stack),
-** then jump to instruction P2. In other words, jump if NOS<=TOS.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** The strcmp() library routine is used for the comparison. For a
-** numeric comparison, use OP_Le.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: StrGt P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If second element (the
-** next on stack) is greater than the first (the top of stack),
-** then jump to instruction P2. In other words, jump if NOS>TOS.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** The strcmp() library routine is used for the comparison. For a
-** numeric comparison, use OP_Gt.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-/* Opcode: StrGe P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top two elements from the stack. If second element (the next
-** on stack) is greater than or equal to the first (the top of stack),
-** then jump to instruction P2. In other words, jump if NOS>=TOS.
-**
-** If either operand is NULL (and thus if the result is unknown) then
-** take the jump if P1 is true.
-**
-** The strcmp() library routine is used for the comparison. For a
-** numeric comparison, use OP_Ge.
-**
-** If P2 is zero, do not jump. Instead, push an integer 1 onto the
-** stack if the jump would have been taken, or a 0 if not. Push a
-** NULL if either operand was NULL.
-*/
-case OP_StrEq:
-case OP_StrNe:
-case OP_StrLt:
-case OP_StrLe:
-case OP_StrGt:
-case OP_StrGe: {
- Mem *pNos = &pTos[-1];
- int c;
- assert( pNos>=p->aStack );
- if( (pNos->flags | pTos->flags) & MEM_Null ){
- popStack(&pTos, 2);
- if( pOp->p2 ){
- if( pOp->p1 ) pc = pOp->p2-1;
- }else{
- pTos++;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }
- break;
- }else{
- Stringify(pTos);
- Stringify(pNos);
- c = strcmp(pNos->z, pTos->z);
- }
- /* The asserts on each case of the following switch are there to verify
- ** that string comparison opcodes are always exactly 6 greater than the
- ** corresponding numeric comparison opcodes. The code generator depends
- ** on this fact.
- */
- switch( pOp->opcode ){
- case OP_StrEq: c = c==0; assert( pOp->opcode-6==OP_Eq ); break;
- case OP_StrNe: c = c!=0; assert( pOp->opcode-6==OP_Ne ); break;
- case OP_StrLt: c = c<0; assert( pOp->opcode-6==OP_Lt ); break;
- case OP_StrLe: c = c<=0; assert( pOp->opcode-6==OP_Le ); break;
- case OP_StrGt: c = c>0; assert( pOp->opcode-6==OP_Gt ); break;
- default: c = c>=0; assert( pOp->opcode-6==OP_Ge ); break;
- }
- popStack(&pTos, 2);
- if( pOp->p2 ){
- if( c ) pc = pOp->p2-1;
- }else{
- pTos++;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- pTos->i = c;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: And * * *
-**
-** Pop two values off the stack. Take the logical AND of the
-** two values and push the resulting boolean value back onto the
-** stack.
-*/
-/* Opcode: Or * * *
-**
-** Pop two values off the stack. Take the logical OR of the
-** two values and push the resulting boolean value back onto the
-** stack.
-*/
-case OP_And:
-case OP_Or: {
- Mem *pNos = &pTos[-1];
- int v1, v2; /* 0==TRUE, 1==FALSE, 2==UNKNOWN or NULL */
-
- assert( pNos>=p->aStack );
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Null ){
- v1 = 2;
- }else{
- Integerify(pTos);
- v1 = pTos->i==0;
- }
- if( pNos->flags & MEM_Null ){
- v2 = 2;
- }else{
- Integerify(pNos);
- v2 = pNos->i==0;
- }
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_And ){
- static const unsigned char and_logic[] = { 0, 1, 2, 1, 1, 1, 2, 1, 2 };
- v1 = and_logic[v1*3+v2];
- }else{
- static const unsigned char or_logic[] = { 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 2, 0, 2, 2 };
- v1 = or_logic[v1*3+v2];
- }
- popStack(&pTos, 2);
- pTos++;
- if( v1==2 ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }else{
- pTos->i = v1==0;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Negative * * *
-**
-** Treat the top of the stack as a numeric quantity. Replace it
-** with its additive inverse. If the top of the stack is NULL
-** its value is unchanged.
-*/
-/* Opcode: AbsValue * * *
-**
-** Treat the top of the stack as a numeric quantity. Replace it
-** with its absolute value. If the top of the stack is NULL
-** its value is unchanged.
-*/
-case OP_Negative:
-case OP_AbsValue: {
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Real ){
- Release(pTos);
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_Negative || pTos->r<0.0 ){
- pTos->r = -pTos->r;
- }
- pTos->flags = MEM_Real;
- }else if( pTos->flags & MEM_Int ){
- Release(pTos);
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_Negative || pTos->i<0 ){
- pTos->i = -pTos->i;
- }
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- }else if( pTos->flags & MEM_Null ){
- /* Do nothing */
- }else{
- Realify(pTos);
- Release(pTos);
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_Negative || pTos->r<0.0 ){
- pTos->r = -pTos->r;
- }
- pTos->flags = MEM_Real;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Not * * *
-**
-** Interpret the top of the stack as a boolean value. Replace it
-** with its complement. If the top of the stack is NULL its value
-** is unchanged.
-*/
-case OP_Not: {
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Null ) break; /* Do nothing to NULLs */
- Integerify(pTos);
- Release(pTos);
- pTos->i = !pTos->i;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: BitNot * * *
-**
-** Interpret the top of the stack as an value. Replace it
-** with its ones-complement. If the top of the stack is NULL its
-** value is unchanged.
-*/
-case OP_BitNot: {
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Null ) break; /* Do nothing to NULLs */
- Integerify(pTos);
- Release(pTos);
- pTos->i = ~pTos->i;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Noop * * *
-**
-** Do nothing. This instruction is often useful as a jump
-** destination.
-*/
-case OP_Noop: {
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: If P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop a single boolean from the stack. If the boolean popped is
-** true, then jump to p2. Otherwise continue to the next instruction.
-** An integer is false if zero and true otherwise. A string is
-** false if it has zero length and true otherwise.
-**
-** If the value popped of the stack is NULL, then take the jump if P1
-** is true and fall through if P1 is false.
-*/
-/* Opcode: IfNot P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop a single boolean from the stack. If the boolean popped is
-** false, then jump to p2. Otherwise continue to the next instruction.
-** An integer is false if zero and true otherwise. A string is
-** false if it has zero length and true otherwise.
-**
-** If the value popped of the stack is NULL, then take the jump if P1
-** is true and fall through if P1 is false.
-*/
-case OP_If:
-case OP_IfNot: {
- int c;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Null ){
- c = pOp->p1;
- }else{
- Integerify(pTos);
- c = pTos->i;
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_IfNot ) c = !c;
- }
- assert( (pTos->flags & MEM_Dyn)==0 );
- pTos--;
- if( c ) pc = pOp->p2-1;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: IsNull P1 P2 *
-**
-** If any of the top abs(P1) values on the stack are NULL, then jump
-** to P2. Pop the stack P1 times if P1>0. If P1<0 leave the stack
-** unchanged.
-*/
-case OP_IsNull: {
- int i, cnt;
- Mem *pTerm;
- cnt = pOp->p1;
- if( cnt<0 ) cnt = -cnt;
- pTerm = &pTos[1-cnt];
- assert( pTerm>=p->aStack );
- for(i=0; i<cnt; i++, pTerm++){
- if( pTerm->flags & MEM_Null ){
- pc = pOp->p2-1;
- break;
- }
- }
- if( pOp->p1>0 ) popStack(&pTos, cnt);
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: NotNull P1 P2 *
-**
-** Jump to P2 if the top P1 values on the stack are all not NULL. Pop the
-** stack if P1 times if P1 is greater than zero. If P1 is less than
-** zero then leave the stack unchanged.
-*/
-case OP_NotNull: {
- int i, cnt;
- cnt = pOp->p1;
- if( cnt<0 ) cnt = -cnt;
- assert( &pTos[1-cnt] >= p->aStack );
- for(i=0; i<cnt && (pTos[1+i-cnt].flags & MEM_Null)==0; i++){}
- if( i>=cnt ) pc = pOp->p2-1;
- if( pOp->p1>0 ) popStack(&pTos, cnt);
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: MakeRecord P1 P2 *
-**
-** Convert the top P1 entries of the stack into a single entry
-** suitable for use as a data record in a database table. The
-** details of the format are irrelavant as long as the OP_Column
-** opcode can decode the record later. Refer to source code
-** comments for the details of the record format.
-**
-** If P2 is true (non-zero) and one or more of the P1 entries
-** that go into building the record is NULL, then add some extra
-** bytes to the record to make it distinct for other entries created
-** during the same run of the VDBE. The extra bytes added are a
-** counter that is reset with each run of the VDBE, so records
-** created this way will not necessarily be distinct across runs.
-** But they should be distinct for transient tables (created using
-** OP_OpenTemp) which is what they are intended for.
-**
-** (Later:) The P2==1 option was intended to make NULLs distinct
-** for the UNION operator. But I have since discovered that NULLs
-** are indistinct for UNION. So this option is never used.
-*/
-case OP_MakeRecord: {
- char *zNewRecord;
- int nByte;
- int nField;
- int i, j;
- int idxWidth;
- u32 addr;
- Mem *pRec;
- int addUnique = 0; /* True to cause bytes to be added to make the
- ** generated record distinct */
- char zTemp[NBFS]; /* Temp space for small records */
-
- /* Assuming the record contains N fields, the record format looks
- ** like this:
- **
- ** -------------------------------------------------------------------
- ** | idx0 | idx1 | ... | idx(N-1) | idx(N) | data0 | ... | data(N-1) |
- ** -------------------------------------------------------------------
- **
- ** All data fields are converted to strings before being stored and
- ** are stored with their null terminators. NULL entries omit the
- ** null terminator. Thus an empty string uses 1 byte and a NULL uses
- ** zero bytes. Data(0) is taken from the lowest element of the stack
- ** and data(N-1) is the top of the stack.
- **
- ** Each of the idx() entries is either 1, 2, or 3 bytes depending on
- ** how big the total record is. Idx(0) contains the offset to the start
- ** of data(0). Idx(k) contains the offset to the start of data(k).
- ** Idx(N) contains the total number of bytes in the record.
- */
- nField = pOp->p1;
- pRec = &pTos[1-nField];
- assert( pRec>=p->aStack );
- nByte = 0;
- for(i=0; i<nField; i++, pRec++){
- if( pRec->flags & MEM_Null ){
- addUnique = pOp->p2;
- }else{
- Stringify(pRec);
- nByte += pRec->n;
- }
- }
- if( addUnique ) nByte += sizeof(p->uniqueCnt);
- if( nByte + nField + 1 < 256 ){
- idxWidth = 1;
- }else if( nByte + 2*nField + 2 < 65536 ){
- idxWidth = 2;
- }else{
- idxWidth = 3;
- }
- nByte += idxWidth*(nField + 1);
- if( nByte>MAX_BYTES_PER_ROW ){
- rc = STQLITE_TOOBIG;
- goto abort_due_to_error;
- }
- if( nByte<=NBFS ){
- zNewRecord = zTemp;
- }else{
- zNewRecord = sqliteMallocRaw( nByte );
- if( zNewRecord==0 ) goto no_mem;
- }
- j = 0;
- addr = idxWidth*(nField+1) + addUnique*sizeof(p->uniqueCnt);
- for(i=0, pRec=&pTos[1-nField]; i<nField; i++, pRec++){
- zNewRecord[j++] = addr & 0xff;
- if( idxWidth>1 ){
- zNewRecord[j++] = (addr>>8)&0xff;
- if( idxWidth>2 ){
- zNewRecord[j++] = (addr>>16)&0xff;
- }
- }
- if( (pRec->flags & MEM_Null)==0 ){
- addr += pRec->n;
- }
- }
- zNewRecord[j++] = addr & 0xff;
- if( idxWidth>1 ){
- zNewRecord[j++] = (addr>>8)&0xff;
- if( idxWidth>2 ){
- zNewRecord[j++] = (addr>>16)&0xff;
- }
- }
- if( addUnique ){
- memcpy(&zNewRecord[j], &p->uniqueCnt, sizeof(p->uniqueCnt));
- p->uniqueCnt++;
- j += sizeof(p->uniqueCnt);
- }
- for(i=0, pRec=&pTos[1-nField]; i<nField; i++, pRec++){
- if( (pRec->flags & MEM_Null)==0 ){
- memcpy(&zNewRecord[j], pRec->z, pRec->n);
- j += pRec->n;
- }
- }
- popStack(&pTos, nField);
- pTos++;
- pTos->n = nByte;
- if( nByte<=NBFS ){
- assert( zNewRecord==zTemp );
- memcpy(pTos->zShort, zTemp, nByte);
- pTos->z = pTos->zShort;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Short;
- }else{
- assert( zNewRecord!=zTemp );
- pTos->z = zNewRecord;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Dyn;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: MakeKey P1 P2 P3
-**
-** Convert the top P1 entries of the stack into a single entry suitable
-** for use as the key in an index. The top P1 records are
-** converted to strings and merged. The null-terminators
-** are retained and used as separators.
-** The lowest entry in the stack is the first field and the top of the
-** stack becomes the last.
-**
-** If P2 is not zero, then the original entries remain on the stack
-** and the new key is pushed on top. If P2 is zero, the original
-** data is popped off the stack first then the new key is pushed
-** back in its place.
-**
-** P3 is a string that is P1 characters long. Each character is either
-** an 'n' or a 't' to indicates if the argument should be intepreted as
-** numeric or text type. The first character of P3 corresponds to the
-** lowest element on the stack. If P3 is NULL then all arguments are
-** assumed to be of the numeric type.
-**
-** The type makes a difference in that text-type fields may not be
-** introduced by 'b' (as described in the next paragraph). The
-** first character of a text-type field must be either 'a' (if it is NULL)
-** or 'c'. Numeric fields will be introduced by 'b' if their content
-** looks like a well-formed number. Otherwise the 'a' or 'c' will be
-** used.
-**
-** The key is a concatenation of fields. Each field is terminated by
-** a single 0x00 character. A NULL field is introduced by an 'a' and
-** is followed immediately by its 0x00 terminator. A numeric field is
-** introduced by a single character 'b' and is followed by a sequence
-** of characters that represent the number such that a comparison of
-** the character string using memcpy() sorts the numbers in numerical
-** order. The character strings for numbers are generated using the
-** sqliteRealToSortable() function. A text field is introduced by a
-** 'c' character and is followed by the exact text of the field. The
-** use of an 'a', 'b', or 'c' character at the beginning of each field
-** guarantees that NULLs sort before numbers and that numbers sort
-** before text. 0x00 characters do not occur except as separators
-** between fields.
-**
-** See also: MakeIdxKey, SortMakeKey
-*/
-/* Opcode: MakeIdxKey P1 P2 P3
-**
-** Convert the top P1 entries of the stack into a single entry suitable
-** for use as the key in an index. In addition, take one additional integer
-** off of the stack, treat that integer as a four-byte record number, and
-** append the four bytes to the key. Thus a total of P1+1 entries are
-** popped from the stack for this instruction and a single entry is pushed
-** back. The first P1 entries that are popped are strings and the last
-** entry (the lowest on the stack) is an integer record number.
-**
-** The converstion of the first P1 string entries occurs just like in
-** MakeKey. Each entry is separated from the others by a null.
-** The entire concatenation is null-terminated. The lowest entry
-** in the stack is the first field and the top of the stack becomes the
-** last.
-**
-** If P2 is not zero and one or more of the P1 entries that go into the
-** generated key is NULL, then jump to P2 after the new key has been
-** pushed on the stack. In other words, jump to P2 if the key is
-** guaranteed to be unique. This jump can be used to skip a subsequent
-** uniqueness test.
-**
-** P3 is a string that is P1 characters long. Each character is either
-** an 'n' or a 't' to indicates if the argument should be numeric or
-** text. The first character corresponds to the lowest element on the
-** stack. If P3 is null then all arguments are assumed to be numeric.
-**
-** See also: MakeKey, SortMakeKey
-*/
-case OP_MakeIdxKey:
-case OP_MakeKey: {
- char *zNewKey;
- int nByte;
- int nField;
- int addRowid;
- int i, j;
- int containsNull = 0;
- Mem *pRec;
- char zTemp[NBFS];
-
- addRowid = pOp->opcode==OP_MakeIdxKey;
- nField = pOp->p1;
- pRec = &pTos[1-nField];
- assert( pRec>=p->aStack );
- nByte = 0;
- for(j=0, i=0; i<nField; i++, j++, pRec++){
- int flags = pRec->flags;
- int len;
- char *z;
- if( flags & MEM_Null ){
- nByte += 2;
- containsNull = 1;
- }else if( pOp->p3 && pOp->p3[j]=='t' ){
- Stringify(pRec);
- pRec->flags &= ~(MEM_Int|MEM_Real);
- nByte += pRec->n+1;
- }else if( (flags & (MEM_Real|MEM_Int))!=0 || sqliteIsNumber(pRec->z) ){
- if( (flags & (MEM_Real|MEM_Int))==MEM_Int ){
- pRec->r = pRec->i;
- }else if( (flags & (MEM_Real|MEM_Int))==0 ){
- pRec->r = sqliteAtoF(pRec->z, 0);
- }
- Release(pRec);
- z = pRec->zShort;
- sqliteRealToSortable(pRec->r, z);
- len = strlen(z);
- pRec->z = 0;
- pRec->flags = MEM_Real;
- pRec->n = len+1;
- nByte += pRec->n+1;
- }else{
- nByte += pRec->n+1;
- }
- }
- if( nByte+sizeof(u32)>MAX_BYTES_PER_ROW ){
- rc = STQLITE_TOOBIG;
- goto abort_due_to_error;
- }
- if( addRowid ) nByte += sizeof(u32);
- if( nByte<=NBFS ){
- zNewKey = zTemp;
- }else{
- zNewKey = sqliteMallocRaw( nByte );
- if( zNewKey==0 ) goto no_mem;
- }
- j = 0;
- pRec = &pTos[1-nField];
- for(i=0; i<nField; i++, pRec++){
- if( pRec->flags & MEM_Null ){
- zNewKey[j++] = 'a';
- zNewKey[j++] = 0;
- }else if( pRec->flags==MEM_Real ){
- zNewKey[j++] = 'b';
- memcpy(&zNewKey[j], pRec->zShort, pRec->n);
- j += pRec->n;
- }else{
- assert( pRec->flags & MEM_Str );
- zNewKey[j++] = 'c';
- memcpy(&zNewKey[j], pRec->z, pRec->n);
- j += pRec->n;
- }
- }
- if( addRowid ){
- u32 iKey;
- pRec = &pTos[-nField];
- assert( pRec>=p->aStack );
- Integerify(pRec);
- iKey = intToKey(pRec->i);
- memcpy(&zNewKey[j], &iKey, sizeof(u32));
- popStack(&pTos, nField+1);
- if( pOp->p2 && containsNull ) pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }else{
- if( pOp->p2==0 ) popStack(&pTos, nField);
- }
- pTos++;
- pTos->n = nByte;
- if( nByte<=NBFS ){
- assert( zNewKey==zTemp );
- pTos->z = pTos->zShort;
- memcpy(pTos->zShort, zTemp, nByte);
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Short;
- }else{
- pTos->z = zNewKey;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Dyn;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: IncrKey * * *
-**
-** The top of the stack should contain an index key generated by
-** The MakeKey opcode. This routine increases the least significant
-** byte of that key by one. This is used so that the MoveTo opcode
-** will move to the first entry greater than the key rather than to
-** the key itself.
-*/
-case OP_IncrKey: {
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- /* The IncrKey opcode is only applied to keys generated by
- ** MakeKey or MakeIdxKey and the results of those operands
- ** are always dynamic strings or zShort[] strings. So we
- ** are always free to modify the string in place.
- */
- assert( pTos->flags & (MEM_Dyn|MEM_Short) );
- pTos->z[pTos->n-1]++;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Checkpoint P1 * *
-**
-** Begin a checkpoint. A checkpoint is the beginning of a operation that
-** is part of a larger transaction but which might need to be rolled back
-** itself without effecting the containing transaction. A checkpoint will
-** be automatically committed or rollback when the VDBE halts.
-**
-** The checkpoint is begun on the database file with index P1. The main
-** database file has an index of 0 and the file used for temporary tables
-** has an index of 1.
-*/
-case OP_Checkpoint: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- if( i>=0 && i<db->nDb && db->aDb[i].pBt && db->aDb[i].inTrans==1 ){
- rc = sqliteBtreeBeginCkpt(db->aDb[i].pBt);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ) db->aDb[i].inTrans = 2;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Transaction P1 * *
-**
-** Begin a transaction. The transaction ends when a Commit or Rollback
-** opcode is encountered. Depending on the ON CONFLICT setting, the
-** transaction might also be rolled back if an error is encountered.
-**
-** P1 is the index of the database file on which the transaction is
-** started. Index 0 is the main database file and index 1 is the
-** file used for temporary tables.
-**
-** A write lock is obtained on the database file when a transaction is
-** started. No other process can read or write the file while the
-** transaction is underway. Starting a transaction also creates a
-** rollback journal. A transaction must be started before any changes
-** can be made to the database.
-*/
-case OP_Transaction: {
- int busy = 1;
- int i = pOp->p1;
- assert( i>=0 && i<db->nDb );
- if( db->aDb[i].inTrans ) break;
- while( db->aDb[i].pBt!=0 && busy ){
- rc = sqliteBtreeBeginTrans(db->aDb[i].pBt);
- switch( rc ){
- case STQLITE_BUSY: {
- if( db->xBusyCallback==0 ){
- p->pc = pc;
- p->undoTransOnError = 1;
- p->rc = STQLITE_BUSY;
- p->pTos = pTos;
- return STQLITE_BUSY;
- }else if( (*db->xBusyCallback)(db->pBusyArg, "", busy++)==0 ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(rc), (char*)0);
- busy = 0;
- }
- break;
- }
- case STQLITE_READONLY: {
- rc = STQLITE_OK;
- /* Fall thru into the next case */
- }
- case STQLITE_OK: {
- p->inTempTrans = 0;
- busy = 0;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- goto abort_due_to_error;
- }
- }
- }
- db->aDb[i].inTrans = 1;
- p->undoTransOnError = 1;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Commit * * *
-**
-** Cause all modifications to the database that have been made since the
-** last Transaction to actually take effect. No additional modifications
-** are allowed until another transaction is started. The Commit instruction
-** deletes the journal file and releases the write lock on the database.
-** A read lock continues to be held if there are still cursors open.
-*/
-case OP_Commit: {
- int i;
- if( db->xCommitCallback!=0 ){
- if( sqliteSafetyOff(db) ) goto abort_due_to_misuse;
- if( db->xCommitCallback(db->pCommitArg)!=0 ){
- rc = STQLITE_CONSTRAINT;
- }
- if( sqliteSafetyOn(db) ) goto abort_due_to_misuse;
- }
- for(i=0; rc==STQLITE_OK && i<db->nDb; i++){
- if( db->aDb[i].inTrans ){
- rc = sqliteBtreeCommit(db->aDb[i].pBt);
- db->aDb[i].inTrans = 0;
- }
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- sqliteCommitInternalChanges(db);
- }else{
- sqliteRollbackAll(db);
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Rollback P1 * *
-**
-** Cause all modifications to the database that have been made since the
-** last Transaction to be undone. The database is restored to its state
-** before the Transaction opcode was executed. No additional modifications
-** are allowed until another transaction is started.
-**
-** P1 is the index of the database file that is committed. An index of 0
-** is used for the main database and an index of 1 is used for the file used
-** to hold temporary tables.
-**
-** This instruction automatically closes all cursors and releases both
-** the read and write locks on the indicated database.
-*/
-case OP_Rollback: {
- sqliteRollbackAll(db);
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: ReadCookie P1 P2 *
-**
-** Read cookie number P2 from database P1 and push it onto the stack.
-** P2==0 is the schema version. P2==1 is the database format.
-** P2==2 is the recommended pager cache size, and so forth. P1==0 is
-** the main database file and P1==1 is the database file used to store
-** temporary tables.
-**
-** There must be a read-lock on the database (either a transaction
-** must be started or there must be an open cursor) before
-** executing this instruction.
-*/
-case OP_ReadCookie: {
- int aMeta[STQLITE_N_BTREE_META];
- assert( pOp->p2<STQLITE_N_BTREE_META );
- assert( pOp->p1>=0 && pOp->p1<db->nDb );
- assert( db->aDb[pOp->p1].pBt!=0 );
- rc = sqliteBtreeGetMeta(db->aDb[pOp->p1].pBt, aMeta);
- pTos++;
- pTos->i = aMeta[1+pOp->p2];
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SetCookie P1 P2 *
-**
-** Write the top of the stack into cookie number P2 of database P1.
-** P2==0 is the schema version. P2==1 is the database format.
-** P2==2 is the recommended pager cache size, and so forth. P1==0 is
-** the main database file and P1==1 is the database file used to store
-** temporary tables.
-**
-** A transaction must be started before executing this opcode.
-*/
-case OP_SetCookie: {
- int aMeta[STQLITE_N_BTREE_META];
- assert( pOp->p2<STQLITE_N_BTREE_META );
- assert( pOp->p1>=0 && pOp->p1<db->nDb );
- assert( db->aDb[pOp->p1].pBt!=0 );
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- Integerify(pTos)
- rc = sqliteBtreeGetMeta(db->aDb[pOp->p1].pBt, aMeta);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- aMeta[1+pOp->p2] = pTos->i;
- rc = sqliteBtreeUpdateMeta(db->aDb[pOp->p1].pBt, aMeta);
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: VerifyCookie P1 P2 *
-**
-** Check the value of global database parameter number 0 (the
-** schema version) and make sure it is equal to P2.
-** P1 is the database number which is 0 for the main database file
-** and 1 for the file holding temporary tables and some higher number
-** for auxiliary databases.
-**
-** The cookie changes its value whenever the database schema changes.
-** This operation is used to detect when that the cookie has changed
-** and that the current process needs to reread the schema.
-**
-** Either a transaction needs to have been started or an OP_Open needs
-** to be executed (to establish a read lock) before this opcode is
-** invoked.
-*/
-case OP_VerifyCookie: {
- int aMeta[STQLITE_N_BTREE_META];
- assert( pOp->p1>=0 && pOp->p1<db->nDb );
- rc = sqliteBtreeGetMeta(db->aDb[pOp->p1].pBt, aMeta);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK && aMeta[1]!=pOp->p2 ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, "database schema has changed", (char*)0);
- rc = STQLITE_SCHEMA;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: OpenRead P1 P2 P3
-**
-** Open a read-only cursor for the database table whose root page is
-** P2 in a database file. The database file is determined by an
-** integer from the top of the stack. 0 means the main database and
-** 1 means the database used for temporary tables. Give the new
-** cursor an identifier of P1. The P1 values need not be contiguous
-** but all P1 values should be small integers. It is an error for
-** P1 to be negative.
-**
-** If P2==0 then take the root page number from the next of the stack.
-**
-** There will be a read lock on the database whenever there is an
-** open cursor. If the database was unlocked prior to this instruction
-** then a read lock is acquired as part of this instruction. A read
-** lock allows other processes to read the database but prohibits
-** any other process from modifying the database. The read lock is
-** released when all cursors are closed. If this instruction attempts
-** to get a read lock but fails, the script terminates with an
-** STQLITE_BUSY error code.
-**
-** The P3 value is the name of the table or index being opened.
-** The P3 value is not actually used by this opcode and may be
-** omitted. But the code generator usually inserts the index or
-** table name into P3 to make the code easier to read.
-**
-** See also OpenWrite.
-*/
-/* Opcode: OpenWrite P1 P2 P3
-**
-** Open a read/write cursor named P1 on the table or index whose root
-** page is P2. If P2==0 then take the root page number from the stack.
-**
-** The P3 value is the name of the table or index being opened.
-** The P3 value is not actually used by this opcode and may be
-** omitted. But the code generator usually inserts the index or
-** table name into P3 to make the code easier to read.
-**
-** This instruction works just like OpenRead except that it opens the cursor
-** in read/write mode. For a given table, there can be one or more read-only
-** cursors or a single read/write cursor but not both.
-**
-** See also OpenRead.
-*/
-case OP_OpenRead:
-case OP_OpenWrite: {
- int busy = 0;
- int i = pOp->p1;
- int p2 = pOp->p2;
- int wrFlag;
- Btree *pX;
- int iDb;
-
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- Integerify(pTos);
- iDb = pTos->i;
- pTos--;
- assert( iDb>=0 && iDb<db->nDb );
- pX = db->aDb[iDb].pBt;
- assert( pX!=0 );
- wrFlag = pOp->opcode==OP_OpenWrite;
- if( p2<=0 ){
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- Integerify(pTos);
- p2 = pTos->i;
- pTos--;
- if( p2<2 ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, "root page number less than 2", (char*)0);
- rc = STQLITE_INTERNAL;
- break;
- }
- }
- assert( i>=0 );
- if( expandCursorArraySize(p, i) ) goto no_mem;
- sqliteVdbeCleanupCursor(&p->aCsr[i]);
- memset(&p->aCsr[i], 0, sizeof(Cursor));
- p->aCsr[i].nullRow = 1;
- if( pX==0 ) break;
- do{
- rc = sqliteBtreeCursor(pX, p2, wrFlag, &p->aCsr[i].pCursor);
- switch( rc ){
- case STQLITE_BUSY: {
- if( db->xBusyCallback==0 ){
- p->pc = pc;
- p->rc = STQLITE_BUSY;
- p->pTos = &pTos[1 + (pOp->p2<=0)]; /* Operands must remain on stack */
- return STQLITE_BUSY;
- }else if( (*db->xBusyCallback)(db->pBusyArg, pOp->p3, ++busy)==0 ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(rc), (char*)0);
- busy = 0;
- }
- break;
- }
- case STQLITE_OK: {
- busy = 0;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- goto abort_due_to_error;
- }
- }
- }while( busy );
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: OpenTemp P1 P2 *
-**
-** Open a new cursor to a transient table.
-** The transient cursor is always opened read/write even if
-** the main database is read-only. The transient table is deleted
-** automatically when the cursor is closed.
-**
-** The cursor points to a BTree table if P2==0 and to a BTree index
-** if P2==1. A BTree table must have an integer key and can have arbitrary
-** data. A BTree index has no data but can have an arbitrary key.
-**
-** This opcode is used for tables that exist for the duration of a single
-** SQL statement only. Tables created using CREATE TEMPORARY TABLE
-** are opened using OP_OpenRead or OP_OpenWrite. "Temporary" in the
-** context of this opcode means for the duration of a single SQL statement
-** whereas "Temporary" in the context of CREATE TABLE means for the duration
-** of the connection to the database. Same word; different meanings.
-*/
-case OP_OpenTemp: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Cursor *pCx;
- assert( i>=0 );
- if( expandCursorArraySize(p, i) ) goto no_mem;
- pCx = &p->aCsr[i];
- sqliteVdbeCleanupCursor(pCx);
- memset(pCx, 0, sizeof(*pCx));
- pCx->nullRow = 1;
- rc = sqliteBtreeFactory(db, 0, 1, TEMP_PAGES, &pCx->pBt);
-
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqliteBtreeBeginTrans(pCx->pBt);
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- if( pOp->p2 ){
- int pgno;
- rc = sqliteBtreeCreateIndex(pCx->pBt, &pgno);
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- rc = sqliteBtreeCursor(pCx->pBt, pgno, 1, &pCx->pCursor);
- }
- }else{
- rc = sqliteBtreeCursor(pCx->pBt, 2, 1, &pCx->pCursor);
- }
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: OpenPseudo P1 * *
-**
-** Open a new cursor that points to a fake table that contains a single
-** row of data. Any attempt to write a second row of data causes the
-** first row to be deleted. All data is deleted when the cursor is
-** closed.
-**
-** A pseudo-table created by this opcode is useful for holding the
-** NEW or OLD tables in a trigger.
-*/
-case OP_OpenPseudo: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Cursor *pCx;
- assert( i>=0 );
- if( expandCursorArraySize(p, i) ) goto no_mem;
- pCx = &p->aCsr[i];
- sqliteVdbeCleanupCursor(pCx);
- memset(pCx, 0, sizeof(*pCx));
- pCx->nullRow = 1;
- pCx->pseudoTable = 1;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Close P1 * *
-**
-** Close a cursor previously opened as P1. If P1 is not
-** currently open, this instruction is a no-op.
-*/
-case OP_Close: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- if( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor ){
- sqliteVdbeCleanupCursor(&p->aCsr[i]);
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: MoveTo P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top of the stack and use its value as a key. Reposition
-** cursor P1 so that it points to an entry with a matching key. If
-** the table contains no record with a matching key, then the cursor
-** is left pointing at the first record that is greater than the key.
-** If there are no records greater than the key and P2 is not zero,
-** then an immediate jump to P2 is made.
-**
-** See also: Found, NotFound, Distinct, MoveLt
-*/
-/* Opcode: MoveLt P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top of the stack and use its value as a key. Reposition
-** cursor P1 so that it points to the entry with the largest key that is
-** less than the key popped from the stack.
-** If there are no records less than than the key and P2
-** is not zero then an immediate jump to P2 is made.
-**
-** See also: MoveTo
-*/
-case OP_MoveLt:
-case OP_MoveTo: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Cursor *pC;
-
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- pC = &p->aCsr[i];
- if( pC->pCursor!=0 ){
- int res, oc;
- pC->nullRow = 0;
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Int ){
- int iKey = intToKey(pTos->i);
- if( pOp->p2==0 && pOp->opcode==OP_MoveTo ){
- pC->movetoTarget = iKey;
- pC->deferredMoveto = 1;
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
- }
- sqliteBtreeMoveto(pC->pCursor, (char*)&iKey, sizeof(int), &res);
- pC->lastRecno = pTos->i;
- pC->recnoIsValid = res==0;
- }else{
- Stringify(pTos);
- sqliteBtreeMoveto(pC->pCursor, pTos->z, pTos->n, &res);
- pC->recnoIsValid = 0;
- }
- pC->deferredMoveto = 0;
- sqlite_search_count++;
- oc = pOp->opcode;
- if( oc==OP_MoveTo && res<0 ){
- sqliteBtreeNext(pC->pCursor, &res);
- pC->recnoIsValid = 0;
- if( res && pOp->p2>0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- }else if( oc==OP_MoveLt ){
- if( res>=0 ){
- sqliteBtreePrevious(pC->pCursor, &res);
- pC->recnoIsValid = 0;
- }else{
- /* res might be negative because the table is empty. Check to
- ** see if this is the case.
- */
- int keysize;
- res = sqliteBtreeKeySize(pC->pCursor,&keysize)!=0 || keysize==0;
- }
- if( res && pOp->p2>0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- }
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Distinct P1 P2 *
-**
-** Use the top of the stack as a string key. If a record with that key does
-** not exist in the table of cursor P1, then jump to P2. If the record
-** does already exist, then fall thru. The cursor is left pointing
-** at the record if it exists. The key is not popped from the stack.
-**
-** This operation is similar to NotFound except that this operation
-** does not pop the key from the stack.
-**
-** See also: Found, NotFound, MoveTo, IsUnique, NotExists
-*/
-/* Opcode: Found P1 P2 *
-**
-** Use the top of the stack as a string key. If a record with that key
-** does exist in table of P1, then jump to P2. If the record
-** does not exist, then fall thru. The cursor is left pointing
-** to the record if it exists. The key is popped from the stack.
-**
-** See also: Distinct, NotFound, MoveTo, IsUnique, NotExists
-*/
-/* Opcode: NotFound P1 P2 *
-**
-** Use the top of the stack as a string key. If a record with that key
-** does not exist in table of P1, then jump to P2. If the record
-** does exist, then fall thru. The cursor is left pointing to the
-** record if it exists. The key is popped from the stack.
-**
-** The difference between this operation and Distinct is that
-** Distinct does not pop the key from the stack.
-**
-** See also: Distinct, Found, MoveTo, NotExists, IsUnique
-*/
-case OP_Distinct:
-case OP_NotFound:
-case OP_Found: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- int alreadyExists = 0;
- Cursor *pC;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- if( (pC = &p->aCsr[i])->pCursor!=0 ){
- int res, rx;
- Stringify(pTos);
- rx = sqliteBtreeMoveto(pC->pCursor, pTos->z, pTos->n, &res);
- alreadyExists = rx==STQLITE_OK && res==0;
- pC->deferredMoveto = 0;
- }
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_Found ){
- if( alreadyExists ) pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }else{
- if( !alreadyExists ) pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- if( pOp->opcode!=OP_Distinct ){
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: IsUnique P1 P2 *
-**
-** The top of the stack is an integer record number. Call this
-** record number R. The next on the stack is an index key created
-** using MakeIdxKey. Call it K. This instruction pops R from the
-** stack but it leaves K unchanged.
-**
-** P1 is an index. So all but the last four bytes of K are an
-** index string. The last four bytes of K are a record number.
-**
-** This instruction asks if there is an entry in P1 where the
-** index string matches K but the record number is different
-** from R. If there is no such entry, then there is an immediate
-** jump to P2. If any entry does exist where the index string
-** matches K but the record number is not R, then the record
-** number for that entry is pushed onto the stack and control
-** falls through to the next instruction.
-**
-** See also: Distinct, NotFound, NotExists, Found
-*/
-case OP_IsUnique: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Mem *pNos = &pTos[-1];
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
- int R;
-
- /* Pop the value R off the top of the stack
- */
- assert( pNos>=p->aStack );
- Integerify(pTos);
- R = pTos->i;
- pTos--;
- assert( i>=0 && i<=p->nCursor );
- if( (pCrsr = p->aCsr[i].pCursor)!=0 ){
- int res, rc;
- int v; /* The record number on the P1 entry that matches K */
- char *zKey; /* The value of K */
- int nKey; /* Number of bytes in K */
-
- /* Make sure K is a string and make zKey point to K
- */
- Stringify(pNos);
- zKey = pNos->z;
- nKey = pNos->n;
- assert( nKey >= 4 );
-
- /* Search for an entry in P1 where all but the last four bytes match K.
- ** If there is no such entry, jump immediately to P2.
- */
- assert( p->aCsr[i].deferredMoveto==0 );
- rc = sqliteBtreeMoveto(pCrsr, zKey, nKey-4, &res);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ) goto abort_due_to_error;
- if( res<0 ){
- rc = sqliteBtreeNext(pCrsr, &res);
- if( res ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- break;
- }
- }
- rc = sqliteBtreeKeyCompare(pCrsr, zKey, nKey-4, 4, &res);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ) goto abort_due_to_error;
- if( res>0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- break;
- }
-
- /* At this point, pCrsr is pointing to an entry in P1 where all but
- ** the last for bytes of the key match K. Check to see if the last
- ** four bytes of the key are different from R. If the last four
- ** bytes equal R then jump immediately to P2.
- */
- sqliteBtreeKey(pCrsr, nKey - 4, 4, (char*)&v);
- v = keyToInt(v);
- if( v==R ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- break;
- }
-
- /* The last four bytes of the key are different from R. Convert the
- ** last four bytes of the key into an integer and push it onto the
- ** stack. (These bytes are the record number of an entry that
- ** violates a UNITQUE constraint.)
- */
- pTos++;
- pTos->i = v;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: NotExists P1 P2 *
-**
-** Use the top of the stack as a integer key. If a record with that key
-** does not exist in table of P1, then jump to P2. If the record
-** does exist, then fall thru. The cursor is left pointing to the
-** record if it exists. The integer key is popped from the stack.
-**
-** The difference between this operation and NotFound is that this
-** operation assumes the key is an integer and NotFound assumes it
-** is a string.
-**
-** See also: Distinct, Found, MoveTo, NotFound, IsUnique
-*/
-case OP_NotExists: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- if( (pCrsr = p->aCsr[i].pCursor)!=0 ){
- int res, rx, iKey;
- assert( pTos->flags & MEM_Int );
- iKey = intToKey(pTos->i);
- rx = sqliteBtreeMoveto(pCrsr, (char*)&iKey, sizeof(int), &res);
- p->aCsr[i].lastRecno = pTos->i;
- p->aCsr[i].recnoIsValid = res==0;
- p->aCsr[i].nullRow = 0;
- if( rx!=STQLITE_OK || res!=0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- p->aCsr[i].recnoIsValid = 0;
- }
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: NewRecno P1 * *
-**
-** Get a new integer record number used as the key to a table.
-** The record number is not previously used as a key in the database
-** table that cursor P1 points to. The new record number is pushed
-** onto the stack.
-*/
-case OP_NewRecno: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- int v = 0;
- Cursor *pC;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- if( (pC = &p->aCsr[i])->pCursor==0 ){
- v = 0;
- }else{
- /* The next rowid or record number (different terms for the same
- ** thing) is obtained in a two-step algorithm.
- **
- ** First we attempt to find the largest existing rowid and add one
- ** to that. But if the largest existing rowid is already the maximum
- ** positive integer, we have to fall through to the second
- ** probabilistic algorithm
- **
- ** The second algorithm is to select a rowid at random and see if
- ** it already exists in the table. If it does not exist, we have
- ** succeeded. If the random rowid does exist, we select a new one
- ** and try again, up to 1000 times.
- **
- ** For a table with less than 2 billion entries, the probability
- ** of not finding a unused rowid is about 1.0e-300. This is a
- ** non-zero probability, but it is still vanishingly small and should
- ** never cause a problem. You are much, much more likely to have a
- ** hardware failure than for this algorithm to fail.
- **
- ** The analysis in the previous paragraph assumes that you have a good
- ** source of random numbers. Is a library function like lrand48()
- ** good enough? Maybe. Maybe not. It's hard to know whether there
- ** might be subtle bugs is some implementations of lrand48() that
- ** could cause problems. To avoid uncertainty, STQLite uses its own
- ** random number generator based on the RC4 algorithm.
- **
- ** To promote locality of reference for repetitive inserts, the
- ** first few attempts at chosing a random rowid pick values just a little
- ** larger than the previous rowid. This has been shown experimentally
- ** to double the speed of the COPY operation.
- */
- int res, rx, cnt, x;
- cnt = 0;
- if( !pC->useRandomRowid ){
- if( pC->nextRowidValid ){
- v = pC->nextRowid;
- }else{
- rx = sqliteBtreeLast(pC->pCursor, &res);
- if( res ){
- v = 1;
- }else{
- sqliteBtreeKey(pC->pCursor, 0, sizeof(v), (void*)&v);
- v = keyToInt(v);
- if( v==0x7fffffff ){
- pC->useRandomRowid = 1;
- }else{
- v++;
- }
- }
- }
- if( v<0x7fffffff ){
- pC->nextRowidValid = 1;
- pC->nextRowid = v+1;
- }else{
- pC->nextRowidValid = 0;
- }
- }
- if( pC->useRandomRowid ){
- v = db->priorNewRowid;
- cnt = 0;
- do{
- if( v==0 || cnt>2 ){
- sqliteRandomness(sizeof(v), &v);
- if( cnt<5 ) v &= 0xffffff;
- }else{
- unsigned char r;
- sqliteRandomness(1, &r);
- v += r + 1;
- }
- if( v==0 ) continue;
- x = intToKey(v);
- rx = sqliteBtreeMoveto(pC->pCursor, &x, sizeof(int), &res);
- cnt++;
- }while( cnt<1000 && rx==STQLITE_OK && res==0 );
- db->priorNewRowid = v;
- if( rx==STQLITE_OK && res==0 ){
- rc = STQLITE_FULL;
- goto abort_due_to_error;
- }
- }
- pC->recnoIsValid = 0;
- pC->deferredMoveto = 0;
- }
- pTos++;
- pTos->i = v;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: PutIntKey P1 P2 *
-**
-** Write an entry into the table of cursor P1. A new entry is
-** created if it doesn't already exist or the data for an existing
-** entry is overwritten. The data is the value on the top of the
-** stack. The key is the next value down on the stack. The key must
-** be an integer. The stack is popped twice by this instruction.
-**
-** If the OPFLAG_NCHANGE flag of P2 is set, then the row change count is
-** incremented (otherwise not). If the OPFLAG_CSCHANGE flag is set,
-** then the current statement change count is incremented (otherwise not).
-** If the OPFLAG_LASTROWID flag of P2 is set, then rowid is
-** stored for subsequent return by the sqlite_last_insert_rowid() function
-** (otherwise it's unmodified).
-*/
-/* Opcode: PutStrKey P1 * *
-**
-** Write an entry into the table of cursor P1. A new entry is
-** created if it doesn't already exist or the data for an existing
-** entry is overwritten. The data is the value on the top of the
-** stack. The key is the next value down on the stack. The key must
-** be a string. The stack is popped twice by this instruction.
-**
-** P1 may not be a pseudo-table opened using the OpenPseudo opcode.
-*/
-case OP_PutIntKey:
-case OP_PutStrKey: {
- Mem *pNos = &pTos[-1];
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Cursor *pC;
- assert( pNos>=p->aStack );
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- if( ((pC = &p->aCsr[i])->pCursor!=0 || pC->pseudoTable) ){
- char *zKey;
- int nKey, iKey;
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_PutStrKey ){
- Stringify(pNos);
- nKey = pNos->n;
- zKey = pNos->z;
- }else{
- assert( pNos->flags & MEM_Int );
- nKey = sizeof(int);
- iKey = intToKey(pNos->i);
- zKey = (char*)&iKey;
- if( pOp->p2 & OPFLAG_NCHANGE ) db->nChange++;
- if( pOp->p2 & OPFLAG_LASTROWID ) db->lastRowid = pNos->i;
- if( pOp->p2 & OPFLAG_CSCHANGE ) db->csChange++;
- if( pC->nextRowidValid && pTos->i>=pC->nextRowid ){
- pC->nextRowidValid = 0;
- }
- }
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Null ){
- pTos->z = 0;
- pTos->n = 0;
- }else{
- assert( pTos->flags & MEM_Str );
- }
- if( pC->pseudoTable ){
- /* PutStrKey does not work for pseudo-tables.
- ** The following assert makes sure we are not trying to use
- ** PutStrKey on a pseudo-table
- */
- assert( pOp->opcode==OP_PutIntKey );
- sqliteFree(pC->pData);
- pC->iKey = iKey;
- pC->nData = pTos->n;
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- pC->pData = pTos->z;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }else{
- pC->pData = sqliteMallocRaw( pC->nData );
- if( pC->pData ){
- memcpy(pC->pData, pTos->z, pC->nData);
- }
- }
- pC->nullRow = 0;
- }else{
- rc = sqliteBtreeInsert(pC->pCursor, zKey, nKey, pTos->z, pTos->n);
- }
- pC->recnoIsValid = 0;
- pC->deferredMoveto = 0;
- }
- popStack(&pTos, 2);
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Delete P1 P2 *
-**
-** Delete the record at which the P1 cursor is currently pointing.
-**
-** The cursor will be left pointing at either the next or the previous
-** record in the table. If it is left pointing at the next record, then
-** the next Next instruction will be a no-op. Hence it is OK to delete
-** a record from within an Next loop.
-**
-** If the OPFLAG_NCHANGE flag of P2 is set, then the row change count is
-** incremented (otherwise not). If OPFLAG_CSCHANGE flag is set,
-** then the current statement change count is incremented (otherwise not).
-**
-** If P1 is a pseudo-table, then this instruction is a no-op.
-*/
-case OP_Delete: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Cursor *pC;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- pC = &p->aCsr[i];
- if( pC->pCursor!=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeCursorMoveto(pC);
- rc = sqliteBtreeDelete(pC->pCursor);
- pC->nextRowidValid = 0;
- }
- if( pOp->p2 & OPFLAG_NCHANGE ) db->nChange++;
- if( pOp->p2 & OPFLAG_CSCHANGE ) db->csChange++;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SetCounts * * *
-**
-** Called at end of statement. Updates lsChange (last statement change count)
-** and resets csChange (current statement change count) to 0.
-*/
-case OP_SetCounts: {
- db->lsChange=db->csChange;
- db->csChange=0;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: KeyAsData P1 P2 *
-**
-** Turn the key-as-data mode for cursor P1 either on (if P2==1) or
-** off (if P2==0). In key-as-data mode, the OP_Column opcode pulls
-** data off of the key rather than the data. This is used for
-** processing compound selects.
-*/
-case OP_KeyAsData: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- p->aCsr[i].keyAsData = pOp->p2;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: RowData P1 * *
-**
-** Push onto the stack the complete row data for cursor P1.
-** There is no interpretation of the data. It is just copied
-** onto the stack exactly as it is found in the database file.
-**
-** If the cursor is not pointing to a valid row, a NULL is pushed
-** onto the stack.
-*/
-/* Opcode: RowKey P1 * *
-**
-** Push onto the stack the complete row key for cursor P1.
-** There is no interpretation of the key. It is just copied
-** onto the stack exactly as it is found in the database file.
-**
-** If the cursor is not pointing to a valid row, a NULL is pushed
-** onto the stack.
-*/
-case OP_RowKey:
-case OP_RowData: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Cursor *pC;
- int n;
-
- pTos++;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- pC = &p->aCsr[i];
- if( pC->nullRow ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }else if( pC->pCursor!=0 ){
- BtCursor *pCrsr = pC->pCursor;
- sqliteVdbeCursorMoveto(pC);
- if( pC->nullRow ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- break;
- }else if( pC->keyAsData || pOp->opcode==OP_RowKey ){
- sqliteBtreeKeySize(pCrsr, &n);
- }else{
- sqliteBtreeDataSize(pCrsr, &n);
- }
- pTos->n = n;
- if( n<=NBFS ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Short;
- pTos->z = pTos->zShort;
- }else{
- char *z = sqliteMallocRaw( n );
- if( z==0 ) goto no_mem;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Dyn;
- pTos->z = z;
- }
- if( pC->keyAsData || pOp->opcode==OP_RowKey ){
- sqliteBtreeKey(pCrsr, 0, n, pTos->z);
- }else{
- sqliteBtreeData(pCrsr, 0, n, pTos->z);
- }
- }else if( pC->pseudoTable ){
- pTos->n = pC->nData;
- pTos->z = pC->pData;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str|MEM_Ephem;
- }else{
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Column P1 P2 *
-**
-** Interpret the data that cursor P1 points to as
-** a structure built using the MakeRecord instruction.
-** (See the MakeRecord opcode for additional information about
-** the format of the data.)
-** Push onto the stack the value of the P2-th column contained
-** in the data.
-**
-** If the KeyAsData opcode has previously executed on this cursor,
-** then the field might be extracted from the key rather than the
-** data.
-**
-** If P1 is negative, then the record is stored on the stack rather
-** than in a table. For P1==-1, the top of the stack is used.
-** For P1==-2, the next on the stack is used. And so forth. The
-** value pushed is always just a pointer into the record which is
-** stored further down on the stack. The column value is not copied.
-*/
-case OP_Column: {
- int amt, offset, end, payloadSize;
- int i = pOp->p1;
- int p2 = pOp->p2;
- Cursor *pC;
- char *zRec;
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
- int idxWidth;
- unsigned char aHdr[10];
-
- assert( i<p->nCursor );
- pTos++;
- if( i<0 ){
- assert( &pTos[i]>=p->aStack );
- assert( pTos[i].flags & MEM_Str );
- zRec = pTos[i].z;
- payloadSize = pTos[i].n;
- }else if( (pC = &p->aCsr[i])->pCursor!=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeCursorMoveto(pC);
- zRec = 0;
- pCrsr = pC->pCursor;
- if( pC->nullRow ){
- payloadSize = 0;
- }else if( pC->keyAsData ){
- sqliteBtreeKeySize(pCrsr, &payloadSize);
- }else{
- sqliteBtreeDataSize(pCrsr, &payloadSize);
- }
- }else if( pC->pseudoTable ){
- payloadSize = pC->nData;
- zRec = pC->pData;
- assert( payloadSize==0 || zRec!=0 );
- }else{
- payloadSize = 0;
- }
-
- /* Figure out how many bytes in the column data and where the column
- ** data begins.
- */
- if( payloadSize==0 ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- break;
- }else if( payloadSize<256 ){
- idxWidth = 1;
- }else if( payloadSize<65536 ){
- idxWidth = 2;
- }else{
- idxWidth = 3;
- }
-
- /* Figure out where the requested column is stored and how big it is.
- */
- if( payloadSize < idxWidth*(p2+1) ){
- rc = STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- goto abort_due_to_error;
- }
- if( zRec ){
- memcpy(aHdr, &zRec[idxWidth*p2], idxWidth*2);
- }else if( pC->keyAsData ){
- sqliteBtreeKey(pCrsr, idxWidth*p2, idxWidth*2, (char*)aHdr);
- }else{
- sqliteBtreeData(pCrsr, idxWidth*p2, idxWidth*2, (char*)aHdr);
- }
- offset = aHdr[0];
- end = aHdr[idxWidth];
- if( idxWidth>1 ){
- offset |= aHdr[1]<<8;
- end |= aHdr[idxWidth+1]<<8;
- if( idxWidth>2 ){
- offset |= aHdr[2]<<16;
- end |= aHdr[idxWidth+2]<<16;
- }
- }
- amt = end - offset;
- if( amt<0 || offset<0 || end>payloadSize ){
- rc = STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- goto abort_due_to_error;
- }
-
- /* amt and offset now hold the offset to the start of data and the
- ** amount of data. Go get the data and put it on the stack.
- */
- pTos->n = amt;
- if( amt==0 ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }else if( zRec ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Ephem;
- pTos->z = &zRec[offset];
- }else{
- if( amt<=NBFS ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Short;
- pTos->z = pTos->zShort;
- }else{
- char *z = sqliteMallocRaw( amt );
- if( z==0 ) goto no_mem;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Dyn;
- pTos->z = z;
- }
- if( pC->keyAsData ){
- sqliteBtreeKey(pCrsr, offset, amt, pTos->z);
- }else{
- sqliteBtreeData(pCrsr, offset, amt, pTos->z);
- }
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Recno P1 * *
-**
-** Push onto the stack an integer which is the first 4 bytes of the
-** the key to the current entry in a sequential scan of the database
-** file P1. The sequential scan should have been started using the
-** Next opcode.
-*/
-case OP_Recno: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Cursor *pC;
- int v;
-
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- pC = &p->aCsr[i];
- sqliteVdbeCursorMoveto(pC);
- pTos++;
- if( pC->recnoIsValid ){
- v = pC->lastRecno;
- }else if( pC->pseudoTable ){
- v = keyToInt(pC->iKey);
- }else if( pC->nullRow || pC->pCursor==0 ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- break;
- }else{
- assert( pC->pCursor!=0 );
- sqliteBtreeKey(pC->pCursor, 0, sizeof(u32), (char*)&v);
- v = keyToInt(v);
- }
- pTos->i = v;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: FullKey P1 * *
-**
-** Extract the complete key from the record that cursor P1 is currently
-** pointing to and push the key onto the stack as a string.
-**
-** Compare this opcode to Recno. The Recno opcode extracts the first
-** 4 bytes of the key and pushes those bytes onto the stack as an
-** integer. This instruction pushes the entire key as a string.
-**
-** This opcode may not be used on a pseudo-table.
-*/
-case OP_FullKey: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
-
- assert( p->aCsr[i].keyAsData );
- assert( !p->aCsr[i].pseudoTable );
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- pTos++;
- if( (pCrsr = p->aCsr[i].pCursor)!=0 ){
- int amt;
- char *z;
-
- sqliteVdbeCursorMoveto(&p->aCsr[i]);
- sqliteBtreeKeySize(pCrsr, &amt);
- if( amt<=0 ){
- rc = STQLITE_CORRUPT;
- goto abort_due_to_error;
- }
- if( amt>NBFS ){
- z = sqliteMallocRaw( amt );
- if( z==0 ) goto no_mem;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Dyn;
- }else{
- z = pTos->zShort;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Short;
- }
- sqliteBtreeKey(pCrsr, 0, amt, z);
- pTos->z = z;
- pTos->n = amt;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: NullRow P1 * *
-**
-** Move the cursor P1 to a null row. Any OP_Column operations
-** that occur while the cursor is on the null row will always push
-** a NULL onto the stack.
-*/
-case OP_NullRow: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
-
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- p->aCsr[i].nullRow = 1;
- p->aCsr[i].recnoIsValid = 0;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Last P1 P2 *
-**
-** The next use of the Recno or Column or Next instruction for P1
-** will refer to the last entry in the database table or index.
-** If the table or index is empty and P2>0, then jump immediately to P2.
-** If P2 is 0 or if the table or index is not empty, fall through
-** to the following instruction.
-*/
-case OP_Last: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Cursor *pC;
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
-
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- pC = &p->aCsr[i];
- if( (pCrsr = pC->pCursor)!=0 ){
- int res;
- rc = sqliteBtreeLast(pCrsr, &res);
- pC->nullRow = res;
- pC->deferredMoveto = 0;
- if( res && pOp->p2>0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- }else{
- pC->nullRow = 0;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Rewind P1 P2 *
-**
-** The next use of the Recno or Column or Next instruction for P1
-** will refer to the first entry in the database table or index.
-** If the table or index is empty and P2>0, then jump immediately to P2.
-** If P2 is 0 or if the table or index is not empty, fall through
-** to the following instruction.
-*/
-case OP_Rewind: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Cursor *pC;
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
-
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- pC = &p->aCsr[i];
- if( (pCrsr = pC->pCursor)!=0 ){
- int res;
- rc = sqliteBtreeFirst(pCrsr, &res);
- pC->atFirst = res==0;
- pC->nullRow = res;
- pC->deferredMoveto = 0;
- if( res && pOp->p2>0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- }else{
- pC->nullRow = 0;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Next P1 P2 *
-**
-** Advance cursor P1 so that it points to the next key/data pair in its
-** table or index. If there are no more key/value pairs then fall through
-** to the following instruction. But if the cursor advance was successful,
-** jump immediately to P2.
-**
-** See also: Prev
-*/
-/* Opcode: Prev P1 P2 *
-**
-** Back up cursor P1 so that it points to the previous key/data pair in its
-** table or index. If there is no previous key/value pairs then fall through
-** to the following instruction. But if the cursor backup was successful,
-** jump immediately to P2.
-*/
-case OP_Prev:
-case OP_Next: {
- Cursor *pC;
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
-
- CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPT;
- assert( pOp->p1>=0 && pOp->p1<p->nCursor );
- pC = &p->aCsr[pOp->p1];
- if( (pCrsr = pC->pCursor)!=0 ){
- int res;
- if( pC->nullRow ){
- res = 1;
- }else{
- assert( pC->deferredMoveto==0 );
- rc = pOp->opcode==OP_Next ? sqliteBtreeNext(pCrsr, &res) :
- sqliteBtreePrevious(pCrsr, &res);
- pC->nullRow = res;
- }
- if( res==0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- sqlite_search_count++;
- }
- }else{
- pC->nullRow = 1;
- }
- pC->recnoIsValid = 0;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: IdxPut P1 P2 P3
-**
-** The top of the stack holds a SQL index key made using the
-** MakeIdxKey instruction. This opcode writes that key into the
-** index P1. Data for the entry is nil.
-**
-** If P2==1, then the key must be unique. If the key is not unique,
-** the program aborts with a STQLITE_CONSTRAINT error and the database
-** is rolled back. If P3 is not null, then it becomes part of the
-** error message returned with the STQLITE_CONSTRAINT.
-*/
-case OP_IdxPut: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- assert( pTos->flags & MEM_Str );
- if( (pCrsr = p->aCsr[i].pCursor)!=0 ){
- int nKey = pTos->n;
- const char *zKey = pTos->z;
- if( pOp->p2 ){
- int res, n;
- assert( nKey >= 4 );
- rc = sqliteBtreeMoveto(pCrsr, zKey, nKey-4, &res);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ) goto abort_due_to_error;
- while( res!=0 ){
- int c;
- sqliteBtreeKeySize(pCrsr, &n);
- if( n==nKey
- && sqliteBtreeKeyCompare(pCrsr, zKey, nKey-4, 4, &c)==STQLITE_OK
- && c==0
- ){
- rc = STQLITE_CONSTRAINT;
- if( pOp->p3 && pOp->p3[0] ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, pOp->p3, (char*)0);
- }
- goto abort_due_to_error;
- }
- if( res<0 ){
- sqliteBtreeNext(pCrsr, &res);
- res = +1;
- }else{
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- rc = sqliteBtreeInsert(pCrsr, zKey, nKey, "", 0);
- assert( p->aCsr[i].deferredMoveto==0 );
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: IdxDelete P1 * *
-**
-** The top of the stack is an index key built using the MakeIdxKey opcode.
-** This opcode removes that entry from the index.
-*/
-case OP_IdxDelete: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- assert( pTos->flags & MEM_Str );
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- if( (pCrsr = p->aCsr[i].pCursor)!=0 ){
- int rx, res;
- rx = sqliteBtreeMoveto(pCrsr, pTos->z, pTos->n, &res);
- if( rx==STQLITE_OK && res==0 ){
- rc = sqliteBtreeDelete(pCrsr);
- }
- assert( p->aCsr[i].deferredMoveto==0 );
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: IdxRecno P1 * *
-**
-** Push onto the stack an integer which is the last 4 bytes of the
-** the key to the current entry in index P1. These 4 bytes should
-** be the record number of the table entry to which this index entry
-** points.
-**
-** See also: Recno, MakeIdxKey.
-*/
-case OP_IdxRecno: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
-
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- pTos++;
- if( (pCrsr = p->aCsr[i].pCursor)!=0 ){
- int v;
- int sz;
- assert( p->aCsr[i].deferredMoveto==0 );
- sqliteBtreeKeySize(pCrsr, &sz);
- if( sz<sizeof(u32) ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }else{
- sqliteBtreeKey(pCrsr, sz - sizeof(u32), sizeof(u32), (char*)&v);
- v = keyToInt(v);
- pTos->i = v;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- }
- }else{
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: IdxGT P1 P2 *
-**
-** Compare the top of the stack against the key on the index entry that
-** cursor P1 is currently pointing to. Ignore the last 4 bytes of the
-** index entry. If the index entry is greater than the top of the stack
-** then jump to P2. Otherwise fall through to the next instruction.
-** In either case, the stack is popped once.
-*/
-/* Opcode: IdxGE P1 P2 *
-**
-** Compare the top of the stack against the key on the index entry that
-** cursor P1 is currently pointing to. Ignore the last 4 bytes of the
-** index entry. If the index entry is greater than or equal to
-** the top of the stack
-** then jump to P2. Otherwise fall through to the next instruction.
-** In either case, the stack is popped once.
-*/
-/* Opcode: IdxLT P1 P2 *
-**
-** Compare the top of the stack against the key on the index entry that
-** cursor P1 is currently pointing to. Ignore the last 4 bytes of the
-** index entry. If the index entry is less than the top of the stack
-** then jump to P2. Otherwise fall through to the next instruction.
-** In either case, the stack is popped once.
-*/
-case OP_IdxLT:
-case OP_IdxGT:
-case OP_IdxGE: {
- int i= pOp->p1;
- BtCursor *pCrsr;
-
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nCursor );
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- if( (pCrsr = p->aCsr[i].pCursor)!=0 ){
- int res, rc;
-
- Stringify(pTos);
- assert( p->aCsr[i].deferredMoveto==0 );
- rc = sqliteBtreeKeyCompare(pCrsr, pTos->z, pTos->n, 4, &res);
- if( rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- break;
- }
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_IdxLT ){
- res = -res;
- }else if( pOp->opcode==OP_IdxGE ){
- res++;
- }
- if( res>0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1 ;
- }
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: IdxIsNull P1 P2 *
-**
-** The top of the stack contains an index entry such as might be generated
-** by the MakeIdxKey opcode. This routine looks at the first P1 fields of
-** that key. If any of the first P1 fields are NULL, then a jump is made
-** to address P2. Otherwise we fall straight through.
-**
-** The index entry is always popped from the stack.
-*/
-case OP_IdxIsNull: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- int k, n;
- const char *z;
-
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- assert( pTos->flags & MEM_Str );
- z = pTos->z;
- n = pTos->n;
- for(k=0; k<n && i>0; i--){
- if( z[k]=='a' ){
- pc = pOp->p2-1;
- break;
- }
- while( k<n && z[k] ){ k++; }
- k++;
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Destroy P1 P2 *
-**
-** Delete an entire database table or index whose root page in the database
-** file is given by P1.
-**
-** The table being destroyed is in the main database file if P2==0. If
-** P2==1 then the table to be clear is in the auxiliary database file
-** that is used to store tables create using CREATE TEMPORARY TABLE.
-**
-** See also: Clear
-*/
-case OP_Destroy: {
- rc = sqliteBtreeDropTable(db->aDb[pOp->p2].pBt, pOp->p1);
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Clear P1 P2 *
-**
-** Delete all contents of the database table or index whose root page
-** in the database file is given by P1. But, unlike Destroy, do not
-** remove the table or index from the database file.
-**
-** The table being clear is in the main database file if P2==0. If
-** P2==1 then the table to be clear is in the auxiliary database file
-** that is used to store tables create using CREATE TEMPORARY TABLE.
-**
-** See also: Destroy
-*/
-case OP_Clear: {
- rc = sqliteBtreeClearTable(db->aDb[pOp->p2].pBt, pOp->p1);
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: CreateTable * P2 P3
-**
-** Allocate a new table in the main database file if P2==0 or in the
-** auxiliary database file if P2==1. Push the page number
-** for the root page of the new table onto the stack.
-**
-** The root page number is also written to a memory location that P3
-** points to. This is the mechanism is used to write the root page
-** number into the parser's internal data structures that describe the
-** new table.
-**
-** The difference between a table and an index is this: A table must
-** have a 4-byte integer key and can have arbitrary data. An index
-** has an arbitrary key but no data.
-**
-** See also: CreateIndex
-*/
-/* Opcode: CreateIndex * P2 P3
-**
-** Allocate a new index in the main database file if P2==0 or in the
-** auxiliary database file if P2==1. Push the page number of the
-** root page of the new index onto the stack.
-**
-** See documentation on OP_CreateTable for additional information.
-*/
-case OP_CreateIndex:
-case OP_CreateTable: {
- int pgno;
- assert( pOp->p3!=0 && pOp->p3type==P3_POINTER );
- assert( pOp->p2>=0 && pOp->p2<db->nDb );
- assert( db->aDb[pOp->p2].pBt!=0 );
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_CreateTable ){
- rc = sqliteBtreeCreateTable(db->aDb[pOp->p2].pBt, &pgno);
- }else{
- rc = sqliteBtreeCreateIndex(db->aDb[pOp->p2].pBt, &pgno);
- }
- pTos++;
- if( rc==STQLITE_OK ){
- pTos->i = pgno;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- *(u32*)pOp->p3 = pgno;
- pOp->p3 = 0;
- }else{
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: IntegrityCk P1 P2 *
-**
-** Do an analysis of the currently open database. Push onto the
-** stack the text of an error message describing any problems.
-** If there are no errors, push a "ok" onto the stack.
-**
-** P1 is the index of a set that contains the root page numbers
-** for all tables and indices in the main database file. The set
-** is cleared by this opcode. In other words, after this opcode
-** has executed, the set will be empty.
-**
-** If P2 is not zero, the check is done on the auxiliary database
-** file, not the main database file.
-**
-** This opcode is used for testing purposes only.
-*/
-case OP_IntegrityCk: {
- int nRoot;
- int *aRoot;
- int iSet = pOp->p1;
- Set *pSet;
- int j;
- HashElem *i;
- char *z;
-
- assert( iSet>=0 && iSet<p->nSet );
- pTos++;
- pSet = &p->aSet[iSet];
- nRoot = sqliteHashCount(&pSet->hash);
- aRoot = sqliteMallocRaw( sizeof(int)*(nRoot+1) );
- if( aRoot==0 ) goto no_mem;
- for(j=0, i=sqliteHashFirst(&pSet->hash); i; i=sqliteHashNext(i), j++){
- toInt((char*)sqliteHashKey(i), &aRoot[j]);
- }
- aRoot[j] = 0;
- sqliteHashClear(&pSet->hash);
- pSet->prev = 0;
- z = sqliteBtreeIntegrityCheck(db->aDb[pOp->p2].pBt, aRoot, nRoot);
- if( z==0 || z[0]==0 ){
- if( z ) sqliteFree(z);
- pTos->z = "ok";
- pTos->n = 3;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Static;
- }else{
- pTos->z = z;
- pTos->n = strlen(z) + 1;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Dyn;
- }
- sqliteFree(aRoot);
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: ListWrite * * *
-**
-** Write the integer on the top of the stack
-** into the temporary storage list.
-*/
-case OP_ListWrite: {
- Keylist *pKeylist;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- pKeylist = p->pList;
- if( pKeylist==0 || pKeylist->nUsed>=pKeylist->nKey ){
- pKeylist = sqliteMallocRaw( sizeof(Keylist)+999*sizeof(pKeylist->aKey[0]) );
- if( pKeylist==0 ) goto no_mem;
- pKeylist->nKey = 1000;
- pKeylist->nRead = 0;
- pKeylist->nUsed = 0;
- pKeylist->pNext = p->pList;
- p->pList = pKeylist;
- }
- Integerify(pTos);
- pKeylist->aKey[pKeylist->nUsed++] = pTos->i;
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: ListRewind * * *
-**
-** Rewind the temporary buffer back to the beginning.
-*/
-case OP_ListRewind: {
- /* What this opcode codes, really, is reverse the order of the
- ** linked list of Keylist structures so that they are read out
- ** in the same order that they were read in. */
- Keylist *pRev, *pTop;
- pRev = 0;
- while( p->pList ){
- pTop = p->pList;
- p->pList = pTop->pNext;
- pTop->pNext = pRev;
- pRev = pTop;
- }
- p->pList = pRev;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: ListRead * P2 *
-**
-** Attempt to read an integer from the temporary storage buffer
-** and push it onto the stack. If the storage buffer is empty,
-** push nothing but instead jump to P2.
-*/
-case OP_ListRead: {
- Keylist *pKeylist;
- CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPT;
- pKeylist = p->pList;
- if( pKeylist!=0 ){
- assert( pKeylist->nRead>=0 );
- assert( pKeylist->nRead<pKeylist->nUsed );
- assert( pKeylist->nRead<pKeylist->nKey );
- pTos++;
- pTos->i = pKeylist->aKey[pKeylist->nRead++];
- pTos->flags = MEM_Int;
- if( pKeylist->nRead>=pKeylist->nUsed ){
- p->pList = pKeylist->pNext;
- sqliteFree(pKeylist);
- }
- }else{
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: ListReset * * *
-**
-** Reset the temporary storage buffer so that it holds nothing.
-*/
-case OP_ListReset: {
- if( p->pList ){
- sqliteVdbeKeylistFree(p->pList);
- p->pList = 0;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: ListPush * * *
-**
-** Save the current Vdbe list such that it can be restored by a ListPop
-** opcode. The list is empty after this is executed.
-*/
-case OP_ListPush: {
- p->keylistStackDepth++;
- assert(p->keylistStackDepth > 0);
- p->keylistStack = sqliteRealloc(p->keylistStack,
- sizeof(Keylist *) * p->keylistStackDepth);
- if( p->keylistStack==0 ) goto no_mem;
- p->keylistStack[p->keylistStackDepth - 1] = p->pList;
- p->pList = 0;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: ListPop * * *
-**
-** Restore the Vdbe list to the state it was in when ListPush was last
-** executed.
-*/
-case OP_ListPop: {
- assert(p->keylistStackDepth > 0);
- p->keylistStackDepth--;
- sqliteVdbeKeylistFree(p->pList);
- p->pList = p->keylistStack[p->keylistStackDepth];
- p->keylistStack[p->keylistStackDepth] = 0;
- if( p->keylistStackDepth == 0 ){
- sqliteFree(p->keylistStack);
- p->keylistStack = 0;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: ContextPush * * *
-**
-** Save the current Vdbe context such that it can be restored by a ContextPop
-** opcode. The context stores the last insert row id, the last statement change
-** count, and the current statement change count.
-*/
-case OP_ContextPush: {
- p->contextStackDepth++;
- assert(p->contextStackDepth > 0);
- p->contextStack = sqliteRealloc(p->contextStack,
- sizeof(Context) * p->contextStackDepth);
- if( p->contextStack==0 ) goto no_mem;
- p->contextStack[p->contextStackDepth - 1].lastRowid = p->db->lastRowid;
- p->contextStack[p->contextStackDepth - 1].lsChange = p->db->lsChange;
- p->contextStack[p->contextStackDepth - 1].csChange = p->db->csChange;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: ContextPop * * *
-**
-** Restore the Vdbe context to the state it was in when contextPush was last
-** executed. The context stores the last insert row id, the last statement
-** change count, and the current statement change count.
-*/
-case OP_ContextPop: {
- assert(p->contextStackDepth > 0);
- p->contextStackDepth--;
- p->db->lastRowid = p->contextStack[p->contextStackDepth].lastRowid;
- p->db->lsChange = p->contextStack[p->contextStackDepth].lsChange;
- p->db->csChange = p->contextStack[p->contextStackDepth].csChange;
- if( p->contextStackDepth == 0 ){
- sqliteFree(p->contextStack);
- p->contextStack = 0;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SortPut * * *
-**
-** The TOS is the key and the NOS is the data. Pop both from the stack
-** and put them on the sorter. The key and data should have been
-** made using SortMakeKey and SortMakeRec, respectively.
-*/
-case OP_SortPut: {
- Mem *pNos = &pTos[-1];
- Sorter *pSorter;
- assert( pNos>=p->aStack );
- if( Dynamicify(pTos) || Dynamicify(pNos) ) goto no_mem;
- pSorter = sqliteMallocRaw( sizeof(Sorter) );
- if( pSorter==0 ) goto no_mem;
- pSorter->pNext = p->pSort;
- p->pSort = pSorter;
- assert( pTos->flags & MEM_Dyn );
- pSorter->nKey = pTos->n;
- pSorter->zKey = pTos->z;
- assert( pNos->flags & MEM_Dyn );
- pSorter->nData = pNos->n;
- pSorter->pData = pNos->z;
- pTos -= 2;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SortMakeRec P1 * *
-**
-** The top P1 elements are the arguments to a callback. Form these
-** elements into a single data entry that can be stored on a sorter
-** using SortPut and later fed to a callback using SortCallback.
-*/
-case OP_SortMakeRec: {
- char *z;
- char **azArg;
- int nByte;
- int nField;
- int i;
- Mem *pRec;
-
- nField = pOp->p1;
- pRec = &pTos[1-nField];
- assert( pRec>=p->aStack );
- nByte = 0;
- for(i=0; i<nField; i++, pRec++){
- if( (pRec->flags & MEM_Null)==0 ){
- Stringify(pRec);
- nByte += pRec->n;
- }
- }
- nByte += sizeof(char*)*(nField+1);
- azArg = sqliteMallocRaw( nByte );
- if( azArg==0 ) goto no_mem;
- z = (char*)&azArg[nField+1];
- for(pRec=&pTos[1-nField], i=0; i<nField; i++, pRec++){
- if( pRec->flags & MEM_Null ){
- azArg[i] = 0;
- }else{
- azArg[i] = z;
- memcpy(z, pRec->z, pRec->n);
- z += pRec->n;
- }
- }
- popStack(&pTos, nField);
- pTos++;
- pTos->n = nByte;
- pTos->z = (char*)azArg;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Dyn;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SortMakeKey * * P3
-**
-** Convert the top few entries of the stack into a sort key. The
-** number of stack entries consumed is the number of characters in
-** the string P3. One character from P3 is prepended to each entry.
-** The first character of P3 is prepended to the element lowest in
-** the stack and the last character of P3 is prepended to the top of
-** the stack. All stack entries are separated by a \000 character
-** in the result. The whole key is terminated by two \000 characters
-** in a row.
-**
-** "N" is substituted in place of the P3 character for NULL values.
-**
-** See also the MakeKey and MakeIdxKey opcodes.
-*/
-case OP_SortMakeKey: {
- char *zNewKey;
- int nByte;
- int nField;
- int i, j, k;
- Mem *pRec;
-
- nField = strlen(pOp->p3);
- pRec = &pTos[1-nField];
- nByte = 1;
- for(i=0; i<nField; i++, pRec++){
- if( pRec->flags & MEM_Null ){
- nByte += 2;
- }else{
- Stringify(pRec);
- nByte += pRec->n+2;
- }
- }
- zNewKey = sqliteMallocRaw( nByte );
- if( zNewKey==0 ) goto no_mem;
- j = 0;
- k = 0;
- for(pRec=&pTos[1-nField], i=0; i<nField; i++, pRec++){
- if( pRec->flags & MEM_Null ){
- zNewKey[j++] = 'N';
- zNewKey[j++] = 0;
- k++;
- }else{
- zNewKey[j++] = pOp->p3[k++];
- memcpy(&zNewKey[j], pRec->z, pRec->n-1);
- j += pRec->n-1;
- zNewKey[j++] = 0;
- }
- }
- zNewKey[j] = 0;
- assert( j<nByte );
- popStack(&pTos, nField);
- pTos++;
- pTos->n = nByte;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str|MEM_Dyn;
- pTos->z = zNewKey;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Sort * * *
-**
-** Sort all elements on the sorter. The algorithm is a
-** mergesort.
-*/
-case OP_Sort: {
- int i;
- Sorter *pElem;
- Sorter *apSorter[NSORT];
- for(i=0; i<NSORT; i++){
- apSorter[i] = 0;
- }
- while( p->pSort ){
- pElem = p->pSort;
- p->pSort = pElem->pNext;
- pElem->pNext = 0;
- for(i=0; i<NSORT-1; i++){
- if( apSorter[i]==0 ){
- apSorter[i] = pElem;
- break;
- }else{
- pElem = Merge(apSorter[i], pElem);
- apSorter[i] = 0;
- }
- }
- if( i>=NSORT-1 ){
- apSorter[NSORT-1] = Merge(apSorter[NSORT-1],pElem);
- }
- }
- pElem = 0;
- for(i=0; i<NSORT; i++){
- pElem = Merge(apSorter[i], pElem);
- }
- p->pSort = pElem;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SortNext * P2 *
-**
-** Push the data for the topmost element in the sorter onto the
-** stack, then remove the element from the sorter. If the sorter
-** is empty, push nothing on the stack and instead jump immediately
-** to instruction P2.
-*/
-case OP_SortNext: {
- Sorter *pSorter = p->pSort;
- CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPT;
- if( pSorter!=0 ){
- p->pSort = pSorter->pNext;
- pTos++;
- pTos->z = pSorter->pData;
- pTos->n = pSorter->nData;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str|MEM_Dyn;
- sqliteFree(pSorter->zKey);
- sqliteFree(pSorter);
- }else{
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SortCallback P1 * *
-**
-** The top of the stack contains a callback record built using
-** the SortMakeRec operation with the same P1 value as this
-** instruction. Pop this record from the stack and invoke the
-** callback on it.
-*/
-case OP_SortCallback: {
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- assert( pTos->flags & MEM_Str );
- p->nCallback++;
- p->pc = pc+1;
- p->azResColumn = (char**)pTos->z;
- assert( p->nResColumn==pOp->p1 );
- p->popStack = 1;
- p->pTos = pTos;
- return STQLITE_ROW;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SortReset * * *
-**
-** Remove any elements that remain on the sorter.
-*/
-case OP_SortReset: {
- sqliteVdbeSorterReset(p);
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: FileOpen * * P3
-**
-** Open the file named by P3 for reading using the FileRead opcode.
-** If P3 is "stdin" then open standard input for reading.
-*/
-case OP_FileOpen: {
- assert( pOp->p3!=0 );
- if( p->pFile ){
- if( p->pFile!=stdin ) fclose(p->pFile);
- p->pFile = 0;
- }
- if( sqliteStrICmp(pOp->p3,"stdin")==0 ){
- p->pFile = stdin;
- }else{
- p->pFile = fopen(pOp->p3, "r");
- }
- if( p->pFile==0 ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg,"unable to open file: ", pOp->p3, (char*)0);
- rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: FileRead P1 P2 P3
-**
-** Read a single line of input from the open file (the file opened using
-** FileOpen). If we reach end-of-file, jump immediately to P2. If
-** we are able to get another line, split the line apart using P3 as
-** a delimiter. There should be P1 fields. If the input line contains
-** more than P1 fields, ignore the excess. If the input line contains
-** fewer than P1 fields, assume the remaining fields contain NULLs.
-**
-** Input ends if a line consists of just "\.". A field containing only
-** "\N" is a null field. The backslash \ character can be used be used
-** to escape newlines or the delimiter.
-*/
-case OP_FileRead: {
- int n, eol, nField, i, c, nDelim;
- char *zDelim, *z;
- CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPT;
- if( p->pFile==0 ) goto fileread_jump;
- nField = pOp->p1;
- if( nField<=0 ) goto fileread_jump;
- if( nField!=p->nField || p->azField==0 ){
- char **azField = sqliteRealloc(p->azField, sizeof(char*)*nField+1);
- if( azField==0 ){ goto no_mem; }
- p->azField = azField;
- p->nField = nField;
- }
- n = 0;
- eol = 0;
- while( eol==0 ){
- if( p->zLine==0 || n+200>p->nLineAlloc ){
- char *zLine;
- p->nLineAlloc = p->nLineAlloc*2 + 300;
- zLine = sqliteRealloc(p->zLine, p->nLineAlloc);
- if( zLine==0 ){
- p->nLineAlloc = 0;
- sqliteFree(p->zLine);
- p->zLine = 0;
- goto no_mem;
- }
- p->zLine = zLine;
- }
- if( vdbe_fgets(&p->zLine[n], p->nLineAlloc-n, p->pFile)==0 ){
- eol = 1;
- p->zLine[n] = 0;
- }else{
- int c;
- while( (c = p->zLine[n])!=0 ){
- if( c=='\\' ){
- if( p->zLine[n+1]==0 ) break;
- n += 2;
- }else if( c=='\n' ){
- p->zLine[n] = 0;
- eol = 1;
- break;
- }else{
- n++;
- }
- }
- }
- }
- if( n==0 ) goto fileread_jump;
- z = p->zLine;
- if( z[0]=='\\' && z[1]=='.' && z[2]==0 ){
- goto fileread_jump;
- }
- zDelim = pOp->p3;
- if( zDelim==0 ) zDelim = "\t";
- c = zDelim[0];
- nDelim = strlen(zDelim);
- p->azField[0] = z;
- for(i=1; *z!=0 && i<=nField; i++){
- int from, to;
- from = to = 0;
- if( z[0]=='\\' && z[1]=='N'
- && (z[2]==0 || strncmp(&z[2],zDelim,nDelim)==0) ){
- if( i<=nField ) p->azField[i-1] = 0;
- z += 2 + nDelim;
- if( i<nField ) p->azField[i] = z;
- continue;
- }
- while( z[from] ){
- if( z[from]=='\\' && z[from+1]!=0 ){
- int tx = z[from+1];
- switch( tx ){
- case 'b': tx = '\b'; break;
- case 'f': tx = '\f'; break;
- case 'n': tx = '\n'; break;
- case 'r': tx = '\r'; break;
- case 't': tx = '\t'; break;
- case 'v': tx = '\v'; break;
- default: break;
- }
- z[to++] = tx;
- from += 2;
- continue;
- }
- if( z[from]==c && strncmp(&z[from],zDelim,nDelim)==0 ) break;
- z[to++] = z[from++];
- }
- if( z[from] ){
- z[to] = 0;
- z += from + nDelim;
- if( i<nField ) p->azField[i] = z;
- }else{
- z[to] = 0;
- z = "";
- }
- }
- while( i<nField ){
- p->azField[i++] = 0;
- }
- break;
-
- /* If we reach end-of-file, or if anything goes wrong, jump here.
- ** This code will cause a jump to P2 */
-fileread_jump:
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: FileColumn P1 * *
-**
-** Push onto the stack the P1-th column of the most recently read line
-** from the input file.
-*/
-case OP_FileColumn: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- char *z;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nField );
- if( p->azField ){
- z = p->azField[i];
- }else{
- z = 0;
- }
- pTos++;
- if( z ){
- pTos->n = strlen(z) + 1;
- pTos->z = z;
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Ephem;
- }else{
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: MemStore P1 P2 *
-**
-** Write the top of the stack into memory location P1.
-** P1 should be a small integer since space is allocated
-** for all memory locations between 0 and P1 inclusive.
-**
-** After the data is stored in the memory location, the
-** stack is popped once if P2 is 1. If P2 is zero, then
-** the original data remains on the stack.
-*/
-case OP_MemStore: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Mem *pMem;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- if( i>=p->nMem ){
- int nOld = p->nMem;
- Mem *aMem;
- p->nMem = i + 5;
- aMem = sqliteRealloc(p->aMem, p->nMem*sizeof(p->aMem[0]));
- if( aMem==0 ) goto no_mem;
- if( aMem!=p->aMem ){
- int j;
- for(j=0; j<nOld; j++){
- if( aMem[j].flags & MEM_Short ){
- aMem[j].z = aMem[j].zShort;
- }
- }
- }
- p->aMem = aMem;
- if( nOld<p->nMem ){
- memset(&p->aMem[nOld], 0, sizeof(p->aMem[0])*(p->nMem-nOld));
- }
- }
- Deephemeralize(pTos);
- pMem = &p->aMem[i];
- Release(pMem);
- *pMem = *pTos;
- if( pMem->flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- if( pOp->p2 ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }else{
- pMem->z = sqliteMallocRaw( pMem->n );
- if( pMem->z==0 ) goto no_mem;
- memcpy(pMem->z, pTos->z, pMem->n);
- }
- }else if( pMem->flags & MEM_Short ){
- pMem->z = pMem->zShort;
- }
- if( pOp->p2 ){
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: MemLoad P1 * *
-**
-** Push a copy of the value in memory location P1 onto the stack.
-**
-** If the value is a string, then the value pushed is a pointer to
-** the string that is stored in the memory location. If the memory
-** location is subsequently changed (using OP_MemStore) then the
-** value pushed onto the stack will change too.
-*/
-case OP_MemLoad: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nMem );
- pTos++;
- memcpy(pTos, &p->aMem[i], sizeof(pTos[0])-NBFS);;
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Str ){
- pTos->flags |= MEM_Ephem;
- pTos->flags &= ~(MEM_Dyn|MEM_Static|MEM_Short);
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: MemIncr P1 P2 *
-**
-** Increment the integer valued memory cell P1 by 1. If P2 is not zero
-** and the result after the increment is greater than zero, then jump
-** to P2.
-**
-** This instruction throws an error if the memory cell is not initially
-** an integer.
-*/
-case OP_MemIncr: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- Mem *pMem;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->nMem );
- pMem = &p->aMem[i];
- assert( pMem->flags==MEM_Int );
- pMem->i++;
- if( pOp->p2>0 && pMem->i>0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: AggReset * P2 *
-**
-** Reset the aggregator so that it no longer contains any data.
-** Future aggregator elements will contain P2 values each.
-*/
-case OP_AggReset: {
- sqliteVdbeAggReset(&p->agg);
- p->agg.nMem = pOp->p2;
- p->agg.apFunc = sqliteMalloc( p->agg.nMem*sizeof(p->agg.apFunc[0]) );
- if( p->agg.apFunc==0 ) goto no_mem;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: AggInit * P2 P3
-**
-** Initialize the function parameters for an aggregate function.
-** The aggregate will operate out of aggregate column P2.
-** P3 is a pointer to the FuncDef structure for the function.
-*/
-case OP_AggInit: {
- int i = pOp->p2;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->agg.nMem );
- p->agg.apFunc[i] = (FuncDef*)pOp->p3;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: AggFunc * P2 P3
-**
-** Execute the step function for an aggregate. The
-** function has P2 arguments. P3 is a pointer to the FuncDef
-** structure that specifies the function.
-**
-** The top of the stack must be an integer which is the index of
-** the aggregate column that corresponds to this aggregate function.
-** Ideally, this index would be another parameter, but there are
-** no free parameters left. The integer is popped from the stack.
-*/
-case OP_AggFunc: {
- int n = pOp->p2;
- int i;
- Mem *pMem, *pRec;
- char **azArgv = p->zArgv;
- sqlite_func ctx;
-
- assert( n>=0 );
- assert( pTos->flags==MEM_Int );
- pRec = &pTos[-n];
- assert( pRec>=p->aStack );
- for(i=0; i<n; i++, pRec++){
- if( pRec->flags & MEM_Null ){
- azArgv[i] = 0;
- }else{
- Stringify(pRec);
- azArgv[i] = pRec->z;
- }
- }
- i = pTos->i;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->agg.nMem );
- ctx.pFunc = (FuncDef*)pOp->p3;
- pMem = &p->agg.pCurrent->aMem[i];
- ctx.s.z = pMem->zShort; /* Space used for small aggregate contexts */
- ctx.pAgg = pMem->z;
- ctx.cnt = ++pMem->i;
- ctx.isError = 0;
- ctx.isStep = 1;
- (ctx.pFunc->xStep)(&ctx, n, (const char**)azArgv);
- pMem->z = ctx.pAgg;
- pMem->flags = MEM_AggCtx;
- popStack(&pTos, n+1);
- if( ctx.isError ){
- rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: AggFocus * P2 *
-**
-** Pop the top of the stack and use that as an aggregator key. If
-** an aggregator with that same key already exists, then make the
-** aggregator the current aggregator and jump to P2. If no aggregator
-** with the given key exists, create one and make it current but
-** do not jump.
-**
-** The order of aggregator opcodes is important. The order is:
-** AggReset AggFocus AggNext. In other words, you must execute
-** AggReset first, then zero or more AggFocus operations, then
-** zero or more AggNext operations. You must not execute an AggFocus
-** in between an AggNext and an AggReset.
-*/
-case OP_AggFocus: {
- AggElem *pElem;
- char *zKey;
- int nKey;
-
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- Stringify(pTos);
- zKey = pTos->z;
- nKey = pTos->n;
- pElem = sqliteHashFind(&p->agg.hash, zKey, nKey);
- if( pElem ){
- p->agg.pCurrent = pElem;
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }else{
- AggInsert(&p->agg, zKey, nKey);
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto no_mem;
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: AggSet * P2 *
-**
-** Move the top of the stack into the P2-th field of the current
-** aggregate. String values are duplicated into new memory.
-*/
-case OP_AggSet: {
- AggElem *pFocus = AggInFocus(p->agg);
- Mem *pMem;
- int i = pOp->p2;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- if( pFocus==0 ) goto no_mem;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->agg.nMem );
- Deephemeralize(pTos);
- pMem = &pFocus->aMem[i];
- Release(pMem);
- *pMem = *pTos;
- if( pMem->flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- pTos->flags = MEM_Null;
- }else if( pMem->flags & MEM_Short ){
- pMem->z = pMem->zShort;
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: AggGet * P2 *
-**
-** Push a new entry onto the stack which is a copy of the P2-th field
-** of the current aggregate. Strings are not duplicated so
-** string values will be ephemeral.
-*/
-case OP_AggGet: {
- AggElem *pFocus = AggInFocus(p->agg);
- Mem *pMem;
- int i = pOp->p2;
- if( pFocus==0 ) goto no_mem;
- assert( i>=0 && i<p->agg.nMem );
- pTos++;
- pMem = &pFocus->aMem[i];
- *pTos = *pMem;
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Str ){
- pTos->flags &= ~(MEM_Dyn|MEM_Static|MEM_Short);
- pTos->flags |= MEM_Ephem;
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: AggNext * P2 *
-**
-** Make the next aggregate value the current aggregate. The prior
-** aggregate is deleted. If all aggregate values have been consumed,
-** jump to P2.
-**
-** The order of aggregator opcodes is important. The order is:
-** AggReset AggFocus AggNext. In other words, you must execute
-** AggReset first, then zero or more AggFocus operations, then
-** zero or more AggNext operations. You must not execute an AggFocus
-** in between an AggNext and an AggReset.
-*/
-case OP_AggNext: {
- CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPT;
- if( p->agg.pSearch==0 ){
- p->agg.pSearch = sqliteHashFirst(&p->agg.hash);
- }else{
- p->agg.pSearch = sqliteHashNext(p->agg.pSearch);
- }
- if( p->agg.pSearch==0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- } else {
- int i;
- sqlite_func ctx;
- Mem *aMem;
- p->agg.pCurrent = sqliteHashData(p->agg.pSearch);
- aMem = p->agg.pCurrent->aMem;
- for(i=0; i<p->agg.nMem; i++){
- int freeCtx;
- if( p->agg.apFunc[i]==0 ) continue;
- if( p->agg.apFunc[i]->xFinalize==0 ) continue;
- ctx.s.flags = MEM_Null;
- ctx.s.z = aMem[i].zShort;
- ctx.pAgg = (void*)aMem[i].z;
- freeCtx = aMem[i].z && aMem[i].z!=aMem[i].zShort;
- ctx.cnt = aMem[i].i;
- ctx.isStep = 0;
- ctx.pFunc = p->agg.apFunc[i];
- (*p->agg.apFunc[i]->xFinalize)(&ctx);
- if( freeCtx ){
- sqliteFree( aMem[i].z );
- }
- aMem[i] = ctx.s;
- if( aMem[i].flags & MEM_Short ){
- aMem[i].z = aMem[i].zShort;
- }
- }
- }
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SetInsert P1 * P3
-**
-** If Set P1 does not exist then create it. Then insert value
-** P3 into that set. If P3 is NULL, then insert the top of the
-** stack into the set.
-*/
-case OP_SetInsert: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- if( p->nSet<=i ){
- int k;
- Set *aSet = sqliteRealloc(p->aSet, (i+1)*sizeof(p->aSet[0]) );
- if( aSet==0 ) goto no_mem;
- p->aSet = aSet;
- for(k=p->nSet; k<=i; k++){
- sqliteHashInit(&p->aSet[k].hash, STQLITE_HASH_BINARY, 1);
- }
- p->nSet = i+1;
- }
- if( pOp->p3 ){
- sqliteHashInsert(&p->aSet[i].hash, pOp->p3, strlen(pOp->p3)+1, p);
- }else{
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- Stringify(pTos);
- sqliteHashInsert(&p->aSet[i].hash, pTos->z, pTos->n, p);
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- }
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) goto no_mem;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SetFound P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the stack once and compare the value popped off with the
-** contents of set P1. If the element popped exists in set P1,
-** then jump to P2. Otherwise fall through.
-*/
-case OP_SetFound: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- Stringify(pTos);
- if( i>=0 && i<p->nSet && sqliteHashFind(&p->aSet[i].hash, pTos->z, pTos->n)){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SetNotFound P1 P2 *
-**
-** Pop the stack once and compare the value popped off with the
-** contents of set P1. If the element popped does not exists in
-** set P1, then jump to P2. Otherwise fall through.
-*/
-case OP_SetNotFound: {
- int i = pOp->p1;
- assert( pTos>=p->aStack );
- Stringify(pTos);
- if( i<0 || i>=p->nSet ||
- sqliteHashFind(&p->aSet[i].hash, pTos->z, pTos->n)==0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- Release(pTos);
- pTos--;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: SetFirst P1 P2 *
-**
-** Read the first element from set P1 and push it onto the stack. If the
-** set is empty, push nothing and jump immediately to P2. This opcode is
-** used in combination with OP_SetNext to loop over all elements of a set.
-*/
-/* Opcode: SetNext P1 P2 *
-**
-** Read the next element from set P1 and push it onto the stack. If there
-** are no more elements in the set, do not do the push and fall through.
-** Otherwise, jump to P2 after pushing the next set element.
-*/
-case OP_SetFirst:
-case OP_SetNext: {
- Set *pSet;
- CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPT;
- if( pOp->p1<0 || pOp->p1>=p->nSet ){
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_SetFirst ) pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- break;
- }
- pSet = &p->aSet[pOp->p1];
- if( pOp->opcode==OP_SetFirst ){
- pSet->prev = sqliteHashFirst(&pSet->hash);
- if( pSet->prev==0 ){
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- break;
- }
- }else{
- assert( pSet->prev );
- pSet->prev = sqliteHashNext(pSet->prev);
- if( pSet->prev==0 ){
- break;
- }else{
- pc = pOp->p2 - 1;
- }
- }
- pTos++;
- pTos->z = sqliteHashKey(pSet->prev);
- pTos->n = sqliteHashKeysize(pSet->prev);
- pTos->flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Ephem;
- break;
-}
-
-/* Opcode: Vacuum * * *
-**
-** Vacuum the entire database. This opcode will cause other virtual
-** machines to be created and run. It may not be called from within
-** a transaction.
-*/
-case OP_Vacuum: {
- if( sqliteSafetyOff(db) ) goto abort_due_to_misuse;
- rc = sqliteRunVacuum(&p->zErrMsg, db);
- if( sqliteSafetyOn(db) ) goto abort_due_to_misuse;
- break;
-}
-
-/* An other opcode is illegal...
-*/
-default: {
- sqlite_snprintf(sizeof(zBuf),zBuf,"%d",pOp->opcode);
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, "unknown opcode ", zBuf, (char*)0);
- rc = STQLITE_INTERNAL;
- break;
-}
-
-/*****************************************************************************
-** The cases of the switch statement above this line should all be indented
-** by 6 spaces. But the left-most 6 spaces have been removed to improve the
-** readability. From this point on down, the normal indentation rules are
-** restored.
-*****************************************************************************/
- }
-
-#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE
- {
- long long elapse = hwtime() - start;
- pOp->cycles += elapse;
- pOp->cnt++;
-#if 0
- fprintf(stdout, "%10lld ", elapse);
- sqliteVdbePrintOp(stdout, origPc, &p->aOp[origPc]);
-#endif
- }
-#endif
-
- /* The following code adds nothing to the actual functionality
- ** of the program. It is only here for testing and debugging.
- ** On the other hand, it does burn CPU cycles every time through
- ** the evaluator loop. So we can leave it out when NDEBUG is defined.
- */
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- /* Sanity checking on the top element of the stack */
- if( pTos>=p->aStack ){
- assert( pTos->flags!=0 ); /* Must define some type */
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Str ){
- int x = pTos->flags & (MEM_Static|MEM_Dyn|MEM_Ephem|MEM_Short);
- assert( x!=0 ); /* Strings must define a string subtype */
- assert( (x & (x-1))==0 ); /* Only one string subtype can be defined */
- assert( pTos->z!=0 ); /* Strings must have a value */
- /* Mem.z points to Mem.zShort iff the subtype is MEM_Short */
- assert( (pTos->flags & MEM_Short)==0 || pTos->z==pTos->zShort );
- assert( (pTos->flags & MEM_Short)!=0 || pTos->z!=pTos->zShort );
- }else{
- /* Cannot define a string subtype for non-string objects */
- assert( (pTos->flags & (MEM_Static|MEM_Dyn|MEM_Ephem|MEM_Short))==0 );
- }
- /* MEM_Null excludes all other types */
- assert( pTos->flags==MEM_Null || (pTos->flags&MEM_Null)==0 );
- }
- if( pc<-1 || pc>=p->nOp ){
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, "jump destination out of range", (char*)0);
- rc = STQLITE_INTERNAL;
- }
- if( p->trace && pTos>=p->aStack ){
- int i;
- fprintf(p->trace, "Stack:");
- for(i=0; i>-5 && &pTos[i]>=p->aStack; i--){
- if( pTos[i].flags & MEM_Null ){
- fprintf(p->trace, " NULL");
- }else if( (pTos[i].flags & (MEM_Int|MEM_Str))==(MEM_Int|MEM_Str) ){
- fprintf(p->trace, " si:%d", pTos[i].i);
- }else if( pTos[i].flags & MEM_Int ){
- fprintf(p->trace, " i:%d", pTos[i].i);
- }else if( pTos[i].flags & MEM_Real ){
- fprintf(p->trace, " r:%g", pTos[i].r);
- }else if( pTos[i].flags & MEM_Str ){
- int j, k;
- char zBuf[100];
- zBuf[0] = ' ';
- if( pTos[i].flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- zBuf[1] = 'z';
- assert( (pTos[i].flags & (MEM_Static|MEM_Ephem))==0 );
- }else if( pTos[i].flags & MEM_Static ){
- zBuf[1] = 't';
- assert( (pTos[i].flags & (MEM_Dyn|MEM_Ephem))==0 );
- }else if( pTos[i].flags & MEM_Ephem ){
- zBuf[1] = 'e';
- assert( (pTos[i].flags & (MEM_Static|MEM_Dyn))==0 );
- }else{
- zBuf[1] = 's';
- }
- zBuf[2] = '[';
- k = 3;
- for(j=0; j<20 && j<pTos[i].n; j++){
- int c = pTos[i].z[j];
- if( c==0 && j==pTos[i].n-1 ) break;
- if( isprint(c) && !isspace(c) ){
- zBuf[k++] = c;
- }else{
- zBuf[k++] = '.';
- }
- }
- zBuf[k++] = ']';
- zBuf[k++] = 0;
- fprintf(p->trace, "%s", zBuf);
- }else{
- fprintf(p->trace, " ???");
- }
- }
- if( rc!=0 ) fprintf(p->trace," rc=%d",rc);
- fprintf(p->trace,"\n");
- }
-#endif
- } /* The end of the for(;;) loop the loops through opcodes */
-
- /* If we reach this point, it means that execution is finished.
- */
-vdbe_halt:
- if( rc ){
- p->rc = rc;
- rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_DONE;
- }
- p->magic = VDBE_MAGIC_HALT;
- p->pTos = pTos;
- return rc;
-
- /* Jump to here if a malloc() fails. It's hard to get a malloc()
- ** to fail on a modern VM computer, so this code is untested.
- */
-no_mem:
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, "out of memory", (char*)0);
- rc = STQLITE_NOMEM;
- goto vdbe_halt;
-
- /* Jump to here for an STQLITE_MISUSE error.
- */
-abort_due_to_misuse:
- rc = STQLITE_MISUSE;
- /* Fall thru into abort_due_to_error */
-
- /* Jump to here for any other kind of fatal error. The "rc" variable
- ** should hold the error number.
- */
-abort_due_to_error:
- if( p->zErrMsg==0 ){
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ) rc = STQLITE_NOMEM;
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(rc), (char*)0);
- }
- goto vdbe_halt;
-
- /* Jump to here if the sqlite_interrupt() API sets the interrupt
- ** flag.
- */
-abort_due_to_interrupt:
- assert( db->flags & STQLITE_Interrupt );
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_Interrupt;
- if( db->magic!=STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY ){
- rc = STQLITE_MISUSE;
- }else{
- rc = STQLITE_INTERRUPT;
- }
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(rc), (char*)0);
- goto vdbe_halt;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbe.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbe.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 0a3c622..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbe.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,112 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** Header file for the Virtual DataBase Engine (VDBE)
-**
-** This header defines the interface to the virtual database engine
-** or VDBE. The VDBE implements an abstract machine that runs a
-** simple program to access and modify the underlying database.
-**
-** $Id: vdbe.h,v 1.71 2004/02/22 20:05:02 drh Exp $
-*/
-#ifndef _STQLITE_VDBE_H_
-#define _STQLITE_VDBE_H_
-#include <stdio.h>
-
-/*
-** A single VDBE is an opaque structure named "Vdbe". Only routines
-** in the source file sqliteVdbe.c are allowed to see the insides
-** of this structure.
-*/
-typedef struct Vdbe Vdbe;
-
-/*
-** A single instruction of the virtual machine has an opcode
-** and as many as three operands. The instruction is recorded
-** as an instance of the following structure:
-*/
-struct VdbeOp {
- u8 opcode; /* What operation to perform */
- int p1; /* First operand */
- int p2; /* Second parameter (often the jump destination) */
- char *p3; /* Third parameter */
- int p3type; /* P3_STATIC, P3_DYNAMIC or P3_POINTER */
-#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE
- int cnt; /* Number of times this instruction was executed */
- long long cycles; /* Total time spend executing this instruction */
-#endif
-};
-typedef struct VdbeOp VdbeOp;
-
-/*
-** A smaller version of VdbeOp used for the VdbeAddOpList() function because
-** it takes up less space.
-*/
-struct VdbeOpList {
- u8 opcode; /* What operation to perform */
- signed char p1; /* First operand */
- short int p2; /* Second parameter (often the jump destination) */
- char *p3; /* Third parameter */
-};
-typedef struct VdbeOpList VdbeOpList;
-
-/*
-** Allowed values of VdbeOp.p3type
-*/
-#define P3_NOTUSED 0 /* The P3 parameter is not used */
-#define P3_DYNAMIC (-1) /* Pointer to a string obtained from sqliteMalloc() */
-#define P3_STATIC (-2) /* Pointer to a static string */
-#define P3_POINTER (-3) /* P3 is a pointer to some structure or object */
-
-/*
-** The following macro converts a relative address in the p2 field
-** of a VdbeOp structure into a negative number so that
-** sqliteVdbeAddOpList() knows that the address is relative. Calling
-** the macro again restores the address.
-*/
-#define ADDR(X) (-1-(X))
-
-/*
-** The makefile scans the vdbe.c source file and creates the "opcodes.h"
-** header file that defines a number for each opcode used by the VDBE.
-*/
-#include "opcodes.h"
-
-/*
-** Prototypes for the VDBE interface. See comments on the implementation
-** for a description of what each of these routines does.
-*/
-Vdbe *sqliteVdbeCreate(sqlite*);
-void sqliteVdbeCreateCallback(Vdbe*, int*);
-int sqliteVdbeAddOp(Vdbe*,int,int,int);
-int sqliteVdbeOp3(Vdbe*,int,int,int,const char *zP3,int);
-int sqliteVdbeCode(Vdbe*,...);
-int sqliteVdbeAddOpList(Vdbe*, int nOp, VdbeOpList const *aOp);
-void sqliteVdbeChangeP1(Vdbe*, int addr, int P1);
-void sqliteVdbeChangeP2(Vdbe*, int addr, int P2);
-void sqliteVdbeChangeP3(Vdbe*, int addr, const char *zP1, int N);
-void sqliteVdbeDequoteP3(Vdbe*, int addr);
-int sqliteVdbeFindOp(Vdbe*, int, int);
-VdbeOp *sqliteVdbeGetOp(Vdbe*, int);
-int sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(Vdbe*);
-void sqliteVdbeDelete(Vdbe*);
-void sqliteVdbeMakeReady(Vdbe*,int,int);
-int sqliteVdbeExec(Vdbe*);
-int sqliteVdbeList(Vdbe*);
-int sqliteVdbeFinalize(Vdbe*,char**);
-void sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(Vdbe*, int);
-int sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(Vdbe*);
-void sqliteVdbeTrace(Vdbe*,FILE*);
-void sqliteVdbeCompressSpace(Vdbe*,int);
-int sqliteVdbeReset(Vdbe*,char **);
-int sqliteVdbeSetVariables(Vdbe*,int,const char**);
-
-#endif
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbeInt.h b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbeInt.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 4c196d5..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbeInt.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,303 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2003 September 6
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This is the header file for information that is private to the
-** VDBE. This information used to all be at the top of the single
-** source code file "vdbe.c". When that file became too big (over
-** 6000 lines long) it was split up into several smaller files and
-** this header information was factored out.
-*/
-
-/*
-** When converting from the native format to the key format and back
-** again, in addition to changing the byte order we invert the high-order
-** bit of the most significant byte. This causes negative numbers to
-** sort before positive numbers in the memcmp() function.
-*/
-#define keyToInt(X) (sqliteVdbeByteSwap(X) ^ 0x80000000)
-#define intToKey(X) (sqliteVdbeByteSwap((X) ^ 0x80000000))
-
-/*
-** The makefile scans this source file and creates the following
-** array of string constants which are the names of all VDBE opcodes.
-** This array is defined in a separate source code file named opcode.c
-** which is automatically generated by the makefile.
-*/
-extern char *sqliteOpcodeNames[];
-
-/*
-** SQL is translated into a sequence of instructions to be
-** executed by a virtual machine. Each instruction is an instance
-** of the following structure.
-*/
-typedef struct VdbeOp Op;
-
-/*
-** Boolean values
-*/
-typedef unsigned char Bool;
-
-/*
-** A cursor is a pointer into a single BTree within a database file.
-** The cursor can seek to a BTree entry with a particular key, or
-** loop over all entries of the Btree. You can also insert new BTree
-** entries or retrieve the key or data from the entry that the cursor
-** is currently pointing to.
-**
-** Every cursor that the virtual machine has open is represented by an
-** instance of the following structure.
-**
-** If the Cursor.isTriggerRow flag is set it means that this cursor is
-** really a single row that represents the NEW or OLD pseudo-table of
-** a row trigger. The data for the row is stored in Cursor.pData and
-** the rowid is in Cursor.iKey.
-*/
-struct Cursor {
- BtCursor *pCursor; /* The cursor structure of the backend */
- int lastRecno; /* Last recno from a Next or NextIdx operation */
- int nextRowid; /* Next rowid returned by OP_NewRowid */
- Bool recnoIsValid; /* True if lastRecno is valid */
- Bool keyAsData; /* The OP_Column command works on key instead of data */
- Bool atFirst; /* True if pointing to first entry */
- Bool useRandomRowid; /* Generate new record numbers semi-randomly */
- Bool nullRow; /* True if pointing to a row with no data */
- Bool nextRowidValid; /* True if the nextRowid field is valid */
- Bool pseudoTable; /* This is a NEW or OLD pseudo-tables of a trigger */
- Bool deferredMoveto; /* A call to sqliteBtreeMoveto() is needed */
- int movetoTarget; /* Argument to the deferred sqliteBtreeMoveto() */
- Btree *pBt; /* Separate file holding temporary table */
- int nData; /* Number of bytes in pData */
- char *pData; /* Data for a NEW or OLD pseudo-table */
- int iKey; /* Key for the NEW or OLD pseudo-table row */
-};
-typedef struct Cursor Cursor;
-
-/*
-** A sorter builds a list of elements to be sorted. Each element of
-** the list is an instance of the following structure.
-*/
-typedef struct Sorter Sorter;
-struct Sorter {
- int nKey; /* Number of bytes in the key */
- char *zKey; /* The key by which we will sort */
- int nData; /* Number of bytes in the data */
- char *pData; /* The data associated with this key */
- Sorter *pNext; /* Next in the list */
-};
-
-/*
-** Number of buckets used for merge-sort.
-*/
-#define NSORT 30
-
-/*
-** Number of bytes of string storage space available to each stack
-** layer without having to malloc. NBFS is short for Number of Bytes
-** For Strings.
-*/
-#define NBFS 32
-
-/*
-** A single level of the stack or a single memory cell
-** is an instance of the following structure.
-*/
-struct Mem {
- int i; /* Integer value */
- int n; /* Number of characters in string value, including '\0' */
- int flags; /* Some combination of MEM_Null, MEM_Str, MEM_Dyn, etc. */
- double r; /* Real value */
- char *z; /* String value */
- char zShort[NBFS]; /* Space for short strings */
-};
-typedef struct Mem Mem;
-
-/*
-** Allowed values for Mem.flags
-*/
-#define MEM_Null 0x0001 /* Value is NULL */
-#define MEM_Str 0x0002 /* Value is a string */
-#define MEM_Int 0x0004 /* Value is an integer */
-#define MEM_Real 0x0008 /* Value is a real number */
-#define MEM_Dyn 0x0010 /* Need to call sqliteFree() on Mem.z */
-#define MEM_Static 0x0020 /* Mem.z points to a static string */
-#define MEM_Ephem 0x0040 /* Mem.z points to an ephemeral string */
-#define MEM_Short 0x0080 /* Mem.z points to Mem.zShort */
-
-/* The following MEM_ value appears only in AggElem.aMem.s.flag fields.
-** It indicates that the corresponding AggElem.aMem.z points to a
-** aggregate function context that needs to be finalized.
-*/
-#define MEM_AggCtx 0x0100 /* Mem.z points to an agg function context */
-
-/*
-** The "context" argument for a installable function. A pointer to an
-** instance of this structure is the first argument to the routines used
-** implement the SQL functions.
-**
-** There is a typedef for this structure in sqlite.h. So all routines,
-** even the public interface to STQLite, can use a pointer to this structure.
-** But this file is the only place where the internal details of this
-** structure are known.
-**
-** This structure is defined inside of vdbe.c because it uses substructures
-** (Mem) which are only defined there.
-*/
-struct sqlite_func {
- FuncDef *pFunc; /* Pointer to function information. MUST BE FIRST */
- Mem s; /* The return value is stored here */
- void *pAgg; /* Aggregate context */
- u8 isError; /* Set to true for an error */
- u8 isStep; /* Current in the step function */
- int cnt; /* Number of times that the step function has been called */
-};
-
-/*
-** An Agg structure describes an Aggregator. Each Agg consists of
-** zero or more Aggregator elements (AggElem). Each AggElem contains
-** a key and one or more values. The values are used in processing
-** aggregate functions in a SELECT. The key is used to implement
-** the GROUP BY clause of a select.
-*/
-typedef struct Agg Agg;
-typedef struct AggElem AggElem;
-struct Agg {
- int nMem; /* Number of values stored in each AggElem */
- AggElem *pCurrent; /* The AggElem currently in focus */
- HashElem *pSearch; /* The hash element for pCurrent */
- Hash hash; /* Hash table of all aggregate elements */
- FuncDef **apFunc; /* Information about aggregate functions */
-};
-struct AggElem {
- char *zKey; /* The key to this AggElem */
- int nKey; /* Number of bytes in the key, including '\0' at end */
- Mem aMem[1]; /* The values for this AggElem */
-};
-
-/*
-** A Set structure is used for quick testing to see if a value
-** is part of a small set. Sets are used to implement code like
-** this:
-** x.y IN ('hi','hoo','hum')
-*/
-typedef struct Set Set;
-struct Set {
- Hash hash; /* A set is just a hash table */
- HashElem *prev; /* Previously accessed hash elemen */
-};
-
-/*
-** A Keylist is a bunch of keys into a table. The keylist can
-** grow without bound. The keylist stores the ROWIDs of database
-** records that need to be deleted or updated.
-*/
-typedef struct Keylist Keylist;
-struct Keylist {
- int nKey; /* Number of Q_SLOTS in aKey[] */
- int nUsed; /* Next unwritten slot in aKey[] */
- int nRead; /* Next unread slot in aKey[] */
- Keylist *pNext; /* Next block of keys */
- int aKey[1]; /* One or more keys. Extra space allocated as needed */
-};
-
-/*
-** A Context stores the last insert rowid, the last statement change count,
-** and the current statement change count (i.e. changes since last statement).
-** Elements of Context structure type make up the ContextStack, which is
-** updated by the ContextPush and ContextPop opcodes (used by triggers)
-*/
-typedef struct Context Context;
-struct Context {
- int lastRowid; /* Last insert rowid (from db->lastRowid) */
- int lsChange; /* Last statement change count (from db->lsChange) */
- int csChange; /* Current statement change count (from db->csChange) */
-};
-
-/*
-** An instance of the virtual machine. This structure contains the complete
-** state of the virtual machine.
-**
-** The "sqlite_vm" structure pointer that is returned by sqlite_compile()
-** is really a pointer to an instance of this structure.
-*/
-struct Vdbe {
- sqlite *db; /* The whole database */
- Vdbe *pPrev,*pNext; /* Linked list of VDBEs with the same Vdbe.db */
- FILE *trace; /* Write an execution trace here, if not NULL */
- int nOp; /* Number of instructions in the program */
- int nOpAlloc; /* Number of Q_SLOTS allocated for aOp[] */
- Op *aOp; /* Space to hold the virtual machine's program */
- int nLabel; /* Number of labels used */
- int nLabelAlloc; /* Number of Q_SLOTS allocated in aLabel[] */
- int *aLabel; /* Space to hold the labels */
- Mem *aStack; /* The operand stack, except string values */
- Mem *pTos; /* Top entry in the operand stack */
- char **zArgv; /* Text values used by the callback */
- char **azColName; /* Becomes the 4th parameter to callbacks */
- int nCursor; /* Number of Q_SLOTS in aCsr[] */
- Cursor *aCsr; /* One element of this array for each open cursor */
- Sorter *pSort; /* A linked list of objects to be sorted */
- FILE *pFile; /* At most one open file handler */
- int nField; /* Number of file fields */
- char **azField; /* Data for each file field */
- int nVar; /* Number of entries in azVariable[] */
- char **azVar; /* Values for the OP_Variable opcode */
- int *anVar; /* Length of each value in azVariable[] */
- u8 *abVar; /* TRUE if azVariable[i] needs to be sqliteFree()ed */
- char *zLine; /* A single line from the input file */
- int nLineAlloc; /* Number of spaces allocated for zLine */
- int magic; /* Magic number for sanity checking */
- int nMem; /* Number of memory locations currently allocated */
- Mem *aMem; /* The memory locations */
- Agg agg; /* Aggregate information */
- int nSet; /* Number of sets allocated */
- Set *aSet; /* An array of sets */
- int nCallback; /* Number of callbacks invoked so far */
- Keylist *pList; /* A list of ROWIDs */
- int keylistStackDepth; /* The size of the "keylist" stack */
- Keylist **keylistStack; /* The stack used by opcodes ListPush & ListPop */
- int contextStackDepth; /* The size of the "context" stack */
- Context *contextStack; /* Stack used by opcodes ContextPush & ContextPop*/
- int pc; /* The program counter */
- int rc; /* Value to return */
- unsigned uniqueCnt; /* Used by OP_MakeRecord when P2!=0 */
- int errorAction; /* Recovery action to do in case of an error */
- int undoTransOnError; /* If error, either ROLLBACK or COMMIT */
- int inTempTrans; /* True if temp database is transactioned */
- int returnStack[100]; /* Return address stack for OP_Gosub & OP_Return */
- int returnDepth; /* Next unused element in returnStack[] */
- int nResColumn; /* Number of columns in one row of the result set */
- char **azResColumn; /* Values for one row of result */
- int popStack; /* Pop the stack this much on entry to VdbeExec() */
- char *zErrMsg; /* Error message written here */
- u8 explain; /* True if EXPLAIN present on SQL command */
-};
-
-/*
-** The following are allowed values for Vdbe.magic
-*/
-#define VDBE_MAGIC_INIT 0x26bceaa5 /* Building a VDBE program */
-#define VDBE_MAGIC_RUN 0xbdf20da3 /* VDBE is ready to execute */
-#define VDBE_MAGIC_HALT 0x519c2973 /* VDBE has completed execution */
-#define VDBE_MAGIC_DEAD 0xb606c3c8 /* The VDBE has been deallocated */
-
-/*
-** Function prototypes
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeCleanupCursor(Cursor*);
-void sqliteVdbeSorterReset(Vdbe*);
-void sqliteVdbeAggReset(Agg*);
-void sqliteVdbeKeylistFree(Keylist*);
-void sqliteVdbePopStack(Vdbe*,int);
-int sqliteVdbeCursorMoveto(Cursor*);
-int sqliteVdbeByteSwap(int);
-#if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(VDBE_PROFILE)
-void sqliteVdbePrintOp(FILE*, int, Op*);
-#endif
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbeaux.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbeaux.c
deleted file mode 100644
index dc41841..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/vdbeaux.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1061 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2003 September 6
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This file contains code used for creating, destroying, and populating
-** a VDBE (or an "sqlite_vm" as it is known to the outside world.) Prior
-** to version 2.8.7, all this code was combined into the vdbe.c source file.
-** But that file was getting too big so this subroutines were split out.
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-#include "os.h"
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include "vdbeInt.h"
-
-
-/*
-** When debugging the code generator in a symbolic debugger, one can
-** set the sqlite_vdbe_addop_trace to 1 and all opcodes will be printed
-** as they are added to the instruction stream.
-*/
-#ifndef NDEBUG
-int sqlite_vdbe_addop_trace = 0;
-#endif
-
-
-/*
-** Create a new virtual database engine.
-*/
-Vdbe *sqliteVdbeCreate(sqlite *db){
- Vdbe *p;
- p = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(Vdbe) );
- if( p==0 ) return 0;
- p->db = db;
- if( db->pVdbe ){
- db->pVdbe->pPrev = p;
- }
- p->pNext = db->pVdbe;
- p->pPrev = 0;
- db->pVdbe = p;
- p->magic = VDBE_MAGIC_INIT;
- return p;
-}
-
-/*
-** Turn tracing on or off
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeTrace(Vdbe *p, FILE *trace){
- p->trace = trace;
-}
-
-/*
-** Add a new instruction to the list of instructions current in the
-** VDBE. Return the address of the new instruction.
-**
-** Parameters:
-**
-** p Pointer to the VDBE
-**
-** op The opcode for this instruction
-**
-** p1, p2 First two of the three possible operands.
-**
-** Use the sqliteVdbeResolveLabel() function to fix an address and
-** the sqliteVdbeChangeP3() function to change the value of the P3
-** operand.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeAddOp(Vdbe *p, int op, int p1, int p2){
- int i;
- VdbeOp *pOp;
-
- i = p->nOp;
- p->nOp++;
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- if( i>=p->nOpAlloc ){
- int oldSize = p->nOpAlloc;
- Op *aNew;
- p->nOpAlloc = p->nOpAlloc*2 + 100;
- aNew = sqliteRealloc(p->aOp, p->nOpAlloc*sizeof(Op));
- if( aNew==0 ){
- p->nOpAlloc = oldSize;
- return 0;
- }
- p->aOp = aNew;
- memset(&p->aOp[oldSize], 0, (p->nOpAlloc-oldSize)*sizeof(Op));
- }
- pOp = &p->aOp[i];
- pOp->opcode = op;
- pOp->p1 = p1;
- if( p2<0 && (-1-p2)<p->nLabel && p->aLabel[-1-p2]>=0 ){
- p2 = p->aLabel[-1-p2];
- }
- pOp->p2 = p2;
- pOp->p3 = 0;
- pOp->p3type = P3_NOTUSED;
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( sqlite_vdbe_addop_trace ) sqliteVdbePrintOp(0, i, &p->aOp[i]);
-#endif
- return i;
-}
-
-/*
-** Add an opcode that includes the p3 value.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeOp3(Vdbe *p, int op, int p1, int p2, const char *zP3, int p3type){
- int addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(p, op, p1, p2);
- sqliteVdbeChangeP3(p, addr, zP3, p3type);
- return addr;
-}
-
-/*
-** Add multiple opcodes. The list is terminated by an opcode of 0.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeCode(Vdbe *p, ...){
- int addr;
- va_list ap;
- int opcode, p1, p2;
- va_start(ap, p);
- addr = p->nOp;
- while( (opcode = va_arg(ap,int))!=0 ){
- p1 = va_arg(ap,int);
- p2 = va_arg(ap,int);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(p, opcode, p1, p2);
- }
- va_end(ap);
- return addr;
-}
-
-
-
-/*
-** Create a new symbolic label for an instruction that has yet to be
-** coded. The symbolic label is really just a negative number. The
-** label can be used as the P2 value of an operation. Later, when
-** the label is resolved to a specific address, the VDBE will scan
-** through its operation list and change all values of P2 which match
-** the label into the resolved address.
-**
-** The VDBE knows that a P2 value is a label because labels are
-** always negative and P2 values are suppose to be non-negative.
-** Hence, a negative P2 value is a label that has yet to be resolved.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(Vdbe *p){
- int i;
- i = p->nLabel++;
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- if( i>=p->nLabelAlloc ){
- int *aNew;
- p->nLabelAlloc = p->nLabelAlloc*2 + 10;
- aNew = sqliteRealloc( p->aLabel, p->nLabelAlloc*sizeof(p->aLabel[0]));
- if( aNew==0 ){
- sqliteFree(p->aLabel);
- }
- p->aLabel = aNew;
- }
- if( p->aLabel==0 ){
- p->nLabel = 0;
- p->nLabelAlloc = 0;
- return 0;
- }
- p->aLabel[i] = -1;
- return -1-i;
-}
-
-/*
-** Resolve label "x" to be the address of the next instruction to
-** be inserted. The parameter "x" must have been obtained from
-** a prior call to sqliteVdbeMakeLabel().
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(Vdbe *p, int x){
- int j;
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- if( x<0 && (-x)<=p->nLabel && p->aOp ){
- if( p->aLabel[-1-x]==p->nOp ) return;
- assert( p->aLabel[-1-x]<0 );
- p->aLabel[-1-x] = p->nOp;
- for(j=0; j<p->nOp; j++){
- if( p->aOp[j].p2==x ) p->aOp[j].p2 = p->nOp;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the address of the next instruction to be inserted.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(Vdbe *p){
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- return p->nOp;
-}
-
-/*
-** Add a whole list of operations to the operation stack. Return the
-** address of the first operation added.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeAddOpList(Vdbe *p, int nOp, VdbeOpList const *aOp){
- int addr;
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- if( p->nOp + nOp >= p->nOpAlloc ){
- int oldSize = p->nOpAlloc;
- Op *aNew;
- p->nOpAlloc = p->nOpAlloc*2 + nOp + 10;
- aNew = sqliteRealloc(p->aOp, p->nOpAlloc*sizeof(Op));
- if( aNew==0 ){
- p->nOpAlloc = oldSize;
- return 0;
- }
- p->aOp = aNew;
- memset(&p->aOp[oldSize], 0, (p->nOpAlloc-oldSize)*sizeof(Op));
- }
- addr = p->nOp;
- if( nOp>0 ){
- int i;
- VdbeOpList const *pIn = aOp;
- for(i=0; i<nOp; i++, pIn++){
- int p2 = pIn->p2;
- VdbeOp *pOut = &p->aOp[i+addr];
- pOut->opcode = pIn->opcode;
- pOut->p1 = pIn->p1;
- pOut->p2 = p2<0 ? addr + ADDR(p2) : p2;
- pOut->p3 = pIn->p3;
- pOut->p3type = pIn->p3 ? P3_STATIC : P3_NOTUSED;
-#ifndef NDEBUG
- if( sqlite_vdbe_addop_trace ){
- sqliteVdbePrintOp(0, i+addr, &p->aOp[i+addr]);
- }
-#endif
- }
- p->nOp += nOp;
- }
- return addr;
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the value of the P1 operand for a specific instruction.
-** This routine is useful when a large program is loaded from a
-** static array using sqliteVdbeAddOpList but we want to make a
-** few minor changes to the program.
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeChangeP1(Vdbe *p, int addr, int val){
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- if( p && addr>=0 && p->nOp>addr && p->aOp ){
- p->aOp[addr].p1 = val;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the value of the P2 operand for a specific instruction.
-** This routine is useful for setting a jump destination.
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeChangeP2(Vdbe *p, int addr, int val){
- assert( val>=0 );
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- if( p && addr>=0 && p->nOp>addr && p->aOp ){
- p->aOp[addr].p2 = val;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Change the value of the P3 operand for a specific instruction.
-** This routine is useful when a large program is loaded from a
-** static array using sqliteVdbeAddOpList but we want to make a
-** few minor changes to the program.
-**
-** If n>=0 then the P3 operand is dynamic, meaning that a copy of
-** the string is made into memory obtained from sqliteMalloc().
-** A value of n==0 means copy bytes of zP3 up to and including the
-** first null byte. If n>0 then copy n+1 bytes of zP3.
-**
-** If n==P3_STATIC it means that zP3 is a pointer to a constant static
-** string and we can just copy the pointer. n==P3_POINTER means zP3 is
-** a pointer to some object other than a string.
-**
-** If addr<0 then change P3 on the most recently inserted instruction.
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeChangeP3(Vdbe *p, int addr, const char *zP3, int n){
- Op *pOp;
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- if( p==0 || p->aOp==0 ) return;
- if( addr<0 || addr>=p->nOp ){
- addr = p->nOp - 1;
- if( addr<0 ) return;
- }
- pOp = &p->aOp[addr];
- if( pOp->p3 && pOp->p3type==P3_DYNAMIC ){
- sqliteFree(pOp->p3);
- pOp->p3 = 0;
- }
- if( zP3==0 ){
- pOp->p3 = 0;
- pOp->p3type = P3_NOTUSED;
- }else if( n<0 ){
- pOp->p3 = (char*)zP3;
- pOp->p3type = n;
- }else{
- sqliteSetNString(&pOp->p3, zP3, n, 0);
- pOp->p3type = P3_DYNAMIC;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** If the P3 operand to the specified instruction appears
-** to be a quoted string token, then this procedure removes
-** the quotes.
-**
-** The quoting operator can be either a grave ascent (ASCII 0x27)
-** or a double quote character (ASCII 0x22). Two quotes in a row
-** resolve to be a single actual quote character within the string.
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeDequoteP3(Vdbe *p, int addr){
- Op *pOp;
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- if( p->aOp==0 ) return;
- if( addr<0 || addr>=p->nOp ){
- addr = p->nOp - 1;
- if( addr<0 ) return;
- }
- pOp = &p->aOp[addr];
- if( pOp->p3==0 || pOp->p3[0]==0 ) return;
- if( pOp->p3type==P3_POINTER ) return;
- if( pOp->p3type!=P3_DYNAMIC ){
- pOp->p3 = sqliteStrDup(pOp->p3);
- pOp->p3type = P3_DYNAMIC;
- }
- sqliteDequote(pOp->p3);
-}
-
-/*
-** On the P3 argument of the given instruction, change all
-** strings of whitespace characters into a single space and
-** delete leading and trailing whitespace.
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeCompressSpace(Vdbe *p, int addr){
- unsigned char *z;
- int i, j;
- Op *pOp;
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- if( p->aOp==0 || addr<0 || addr>=p->nOp ) return;
- pOp = &p->aOp[addr];
- if( pOp->p3type==P3_POINTER ){
- return;
- }
- if( pOp->p3type!=P3_DYNAMIC ){
- pOp->p3 = sqliteStrDup(pOp->p3);
- pOp->p3type = P3_DYNAMIC;
- }
- z = (unsigned char*)pOp->p3;
- if( z==0 ) return;
- i = j = 0;
- while( isspace(z[i]) ){ i++; }
- while( z[i] ){
- if( isspace(z[i]) ){
- z[j++] = ' ';
- while( isspace(z[++i]) ){}
- }else{
- z[j++] = z[i++];
- }
- }
- while( j>0 && isspace(z[j-1]) ){ j--; }
- z[j] = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Search for the current program for the given opcode and P2
-** value. Return the address plus 1 if found and 0 if not found.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeFindOp(Vdbe *p, int op, int p2){
- int i;
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- for(i=0; i<p->nOp; i++){
- if( p->aOp[i].opcode==op && p->aOp[i].p2==p2 ) return i+1;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the opcode for a given address.
-*/
-VdbeOp *sqliteVdbeGetOp(Vdbe *p, int addr){
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
- assert( addr>=0 && addr<p->nOp );
- return &p->aOp[addr];
-}
-
-/*
-** The following group or routines are employed by installable functions
-** to return their results.
-**
-** The sqlite_set_result_string() routine can be used to return a string
-** value or to return a NULL. To return a NULL, pass in NULL for zResult.
-** A copy is made of the string before this routine returns so it is safe
-** to pass in an ephemeral string.
-**
-** sqlite_set_result_error() works like sqlite_set_result_string() except
-** that it Q_SIGNALS a fatal error. The string argument, if any, is the
-** error message. If the argument is NULL a generic substitute error message
-** is used.
-**
-** The sqlite_set_result_int() and sqlite_set_result_double() set the return
-** value of the user function to an integer or a double.
-**
-** These routines are defined here in vdbe.c because they depend on knowing
-** the internals of the sqlite_func structure which is only defined in
-** this source file.
-*/
-char *sqlite_set_result_string(sqlite_func *p, const char *zResult, int n){
- assert( !p->isStep );
- if( p->s.flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- sqliteFree(p->s.z);
- }
- if( zResult==0 ){
- p->s.flags = MEM_Null;
- n = 0;
- p->s.z = 0;
- p->s.n = 0;
- }else{
- if( n<0 ) n = strlen(zResult);
- if( n<NBFS-1 ){
- memcpy(p->s.zShort, zResult, n);
- p->s.zShort[n] = 0;
- p->s.flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Short;
- p->s.z = p->s.zShort;
- }else{
- p->s.z = sqliteMallocRaw( n+1 );
- if( p->s.z ){
- memcpy(p->s.z, zResult, n);
- p->s.z[n] = 0;
- }
- p->s.flags = MEM_Str | MEM_Dyn;
- }
- p->s.n = n+1;
- }
- return p->s.z;
-}
-void sqlite_set_result_int(sqlite_func *p, int iResult){
- assert( !p->isStep );
- if( p->s.flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- sqliteFree(p->s.z);
- }
- p->s.i = iResult;
- p->s.flags = MEM_Int;
-}
-void sqlite_set_result_double(sqlite_func *p, double rResult){
- assert( !p->isStep );
- if( p->s.flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- sqliteFree(p->s.z);
- }
- p->s.r = rResult;
- p->s.flags = MEM_Real;
-}
-void sqlite_set_result_error(sqlite_func *p, const char *zMsg, int n){
- assert( !p->isStep );
- sqlite_set_result_string(p, zMsg, n);
- p->isError = 1;
-}
-
-/*
-** Extract the user data from a sqlite_func structure and return a
-** pointer to it.
-*/
-void *sqlite_user_data(sqlite_func *p){
- assert( p && p->pFunc );
- return p->pFunc->pUserData;
-}
-
-/*
-** Allocate or return the aggregate context for a user function. A new
-** context is allocated on the first call. Subsequent calls return the
-** same context that was returned on prior calls.
-**
-** This routine is defined here in vdbe.c because it depends on knowing
-** the internals of the sqlite_func structure which is only defined in
-** this source file.
-*/
-void *sqlite_aggregate_context(sqlite_func *p, int nByte){
- assert( p && p->pFunc && p->pFunc->xStep );
- if( p->pAgg==0 ){
- if( nByte<=NBFS ){
- p->pAgg = (void*)p->s.z;
- memset(p->pAgg, 0, nByte);
- }else{
- p->pAgg = sqliteMalloc( nByte );
- }
- }
- return p->pAgg;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return the number of times the Step function of a aggregate has been
-** called.
-**
-** This routine is defined here in vdbe.c because it depends on knowing
-** the internals of the sqlite_func structure which is only defined in
-** this source file.
-*/
-int sqlite_aggregate_count(sqlite_func *p){
- assert( p && p->pFunc && p->pFunc->xStep );
- return p->cnt;
-}
-
-#if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(VDBE_PROFILE)
-/*
-** Print a single opcode. This routine is used for debugging only.
-*/
-void sqliteVdbePrintOp(FILE *pOut, int pc, Op *pOp){
- char *zP3;
- char zPtr[40];
- if( pOp->p3type==P3_POINTER ){
- sprintf(zPtr, "ptr(%#x)", (int)pOp->p3);
- zP3 = zPtr;
- }else{
- zP3 = pOp->p3;
- }
- if( pOut==0 ) pOut = stdout;
- fprintf(pOut,"%4d %-12s %4d %4d %s\n",
- pc, sqliteOpcodeNames[pOp->opcode], pOp->p1, pOp->p2, zP3 ? zP3 : "");
- fflush(pOut);
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-** Give a listing of the program in the virtual machine.
-**
-** The interface is the same as sqliteVdbeExec(). But instead of
-** running the code, it invokes the callback once for each instruction.
-** This feature is used to implement "EXPLAIN".
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeList(
- Vdbe *p /* The VDBE */
-){
- sqlite *db = p->db;
- int i;
- int rc = STQLITE_OK;
- static char *azColumnNames[] = {
- "addr", "opcode", "p1", "p2", "p3",
- "int", "text", "int", "int", "text",
- 0
- };
-
- assert( p->popStack==0 );
- assert( p->explain );
- p->azColName = azColumnNames;
- p->azResColumn = p->zArgv;
- for(i=0; i<5; i++) p->zArgv[i] = p->aStack[i].zShort;
- i = p->pc;
- if( i>=p->nOp ){
- p->rc = STQLITE_OK;
- rc = STQLITE_DONE;
- }else if( db->flags & STQLITE_Interrupt ){
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_Interrupt;
- if( db->magic!=STQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY ){
- p->rc = STQLITE_MISUSE;
- }else{
- p->rc = STQLITE_INTERRUPT;
- }
- rc = STQLITE_ERROR;
- sqliteSetString(&p->zErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(p->rc), (char*)0);
- }else{
- sprintf(p->zArgv[0],"%d",i);
- sprintf(p->zArgv[2],"%d", p->aOp[i].p1);
- sprintf(p->zArgv[3],"%d", p->aOp[i].p2);
- if( p->aOp[i].p3type==P3_POINTER ){
- sprintf(p->aStack[4].zShort, "ptr(%#x)", (int)p->aOp[i].p3);
- p->zArgv[4] = p->aStack[4].zShort;
- }else{
- p->zArgv[4] = p->aOp[i].p3;
- }
- p->zArgv[1] = sqliteOpcodeNames[p->aOp[i].opcode];
- p->pc = i+1;
- p->azResColumn = p->zArgv;
- p->nResColumn = 5;
- p->rc = STQLITE_OK;
- rc = STQLITE_ROW;
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Prepare a virtual machine for execution. This involves things such
-** as allocating stack space and initializing the program counter.
-** After the VDBE has be prepped, it can be executed by one or more
-** calls to sqliteVdbeExec().
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeMakeReady(
- Vdbe *p, /* The VDBE */
- int nVar, /* Number of '?' see in the SQL statement */
- int isExplain /* True if the EXPLAIN keywords is present */
-){
- int n;
-
- assert( p!=0 );
- assert( p->magic==VDBE_MAGIC_INIT );
-
- /* Add a HALT instruction to the very end of the program.
- */
- if( p->nOp==0 || (p->aOp && p->aOp[p->nOp-1].opcode!=OP_Halt) ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(p, OP_Halt, 0, 0);
- }
-
- /* No instruction ever pushes more than a single element onto the
- ** stack. And the stack never grows on successive executions of the
- ** same loop. So the total number of instructions is an upper bound
- ** on the maximum stack depth required.
- **
- ** Allocation all the stack space we will ever need.
- */
- if( p->aStack==0 ){
- p->nVar = nVar;
- assert( nVar>=0 );
- n = isExplain ? 10 : p->nOp;
- p->aStack = sqliteMalloc(
- n*(sizeof(p->aStack[0]) + 2*sizeof(char*)) /* aStack and zArgv */
- + p->nVar*(sizeof(char*)+sizeof(int)+1) /* azVar, anVar, abVar */
- );
- p->zArgv = (char**)&p->aStack[n];
- p->azColName = (char**)&p->zArgv[n];
- p->azVar = (char**)&p->azColName[n];
- p->anVar = (int*)&p->azVar[p->nVar];
- p->abVar = (u8*)&p->anVar[p->nVar];
- }
-
- sqliteHashInit(&p->agg.hash, STQLITE_HASH_BINARY, 0);
- p->agg.pSearch = 0;
-#ifdef MEMORY_DEBUG
- if( sqliteOsFileExists("vdbe_trace") ){
- p->trace = stdout;
- }
-#endif
- p->pTos = &p->aStack[-1];
- p->pc = 0;
- p->rc = STQLITE_OK;
- p->uniqueCnt = 0;
- p->returnDepth = 0;
- p->errorAction = OE_Abort;
- p->undoTransOnError = 0;
- p->popStack = 0;
- p->explain |= isExplain;
- p->magic = VDBE_MAGIC_RUN;
-#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE
- {
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<p->nOp; i++){
- p->aOp[i].cnt = 0;
- p->aOp[i].cycles = 0;
- }
- }
-#endif
-}
-
-
-/*
-** Remove any elements that remain on the sorter for the VDBE given.
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeSorterReset(Vdbe *p){
- while( p->pSort ){
- Sorter *pSorter = p->pSort;
- p->pSort = pSorter->pNext;
- sqliteFree(pSorter->zKey);
- sqliteFree(pSorter->pData);
- sqliteFree(pSorter);
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Reset an Agg structure. Delete all its contents.
-**
-** For installable aggregate functions, if the step function has been
-** called, make sure the finalizer function has also been called. The
-** finalizer might need to free memory that was allocated as part of its
-** private context. If the finalizer has not been called yet, call it
-** now.
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeAggReset(Agg *pAgg){
- int i;
- HashElem *p;
- for(p = sqliteHashFirst(&pAgg->hash); p; p = sqliteHashNext(p)){
- AggElem *pElem = sqliteHashData(p);
- assert( pAgg->apFunc!=0 );
- for(i=0; i<pAgg->nMem; i++){
- Mem *pMem = &pElem->aMem[i];
- if( pAgg->apFunc[i] && (pMem->flags & MEM_AggCtx)!=0 ){
- sqlite_func ctx;
- ctx.pFunc = pAgg->apFunc[i];
- ctx.s.flags = MEM_Null;
- ctx.pAgg = pMem->z;
- ctx.cnt = pMem->i;
- ctx.isStep = 0;
- ctx.isError = 0;
- (*pAgg->apFunc[i]->xFinalize)(&ctx);
- if( pMem->z!=0 && pMem->z!=pMem->zShort ){
- sqliteFree(pMem->z);
- }
- if( ctx.s.flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- sqliteFree(ctx.s.z);
- }
- }else if( pMem->flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- sqliteFree(pMem->z);
- }
- }
- sqliteFree(pElem);
- }
- sqliteHashClear(&pAgg->hash);
- sqliteFree(pAgg->apFunc);
- pAgg->apFunc = 0;
- pAgg->pCurrent = 0;
- pAgg->pSearch = 0;
- pAgg->nMem = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Delete a keylist
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeKeylistFree(Keylist *p){
- while( p ){
- Keylist *pNext = p->pNext;
- sqliteFree(p);
- p = pNext;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** Close a cursor and release all the resources that cursor happens
-** to hold.
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeCleanupCursor(Cursor *pCx){
- if( pCx->pCursor ){
- sqliteBtreeCloseCursor(pCx->pCursor);
- }
- if( pCx->pBt ){
- sqliteBtreeClose(pCx->pBt);
- }
- sqliteFree(pCx->pData);
- memset(pCx, 0, sizeof(Cursor));
-}
-
-/*
-** Close all cursors
-*/
-static void closeAllCursors(Vdbe *p){
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<p->nCursor; i++){
- sqliteVdbeCleanupCursor(&p->aCsr[i]);
- }
- sqliteFree(p->aCsr);
- p->aCsr = 0;
- p->nCursor = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Clean up the VM after execution.
-**
-** This routine will automatically close any cursors, lists, and/or
-** sorters that were left open. It also deletes the values of
-** variables in the azVariable[] array.
-*/
-static void Cleanup(Vdbe *p){
- int i;
- if( p->aStack ){
- Mem *pTos = p->pTos;
- while( pTos>=p->aStack ){
- if( pTos->flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- sqliteFree(pTos->z);
- }
- pTos--;
- }
- p->pTos = pTos;
- }
- closeAllCursors(p);
- if( p->aMem ){
- for(i=0; i<p->nMem; i++){
- if( p->aMem[i].flags & MEM_Dyn ){
- sqliteFree(p->aMem[i].z);
- }
- }
- }
- sqliteFree(p->aMem);
- p->aMem = 0;
- p->nMem = 0;
- if( p->pList ){
- sqliteVdbeKeylistFree(p->pList);
- p->pList = 0;
- }
- sqliteVdbeSorterReset(p);
- if( p->pFile ){
- if( p->pFile!=stdin ) fclose(p->pFile);
- p->pFile = 0;
- }
- if( p->azField ){
- sqliteFree(p->azField);
- p->azField = 0;
- }
- p->nField = 0;
- if( p->zLine ){
- sqliteFree(p->zLine);
- p->zLine = 0;
- }
- p->nLineAlloc = 0;
- sqliteVdbeAggReset(&p->agg);
- if( p->aSet ){
- for(i=0; i<p->nSet; i++){
- sqliteHashClear(&p->aSet[i].hash);
- }
- }
- sqliteFree(p->aSet);
- p->aSet = 0;
- p->nSet = 0;
- if( p->keylistStack ){
- int ii;
- for(ii = 0; ii < p->keylistStackDepth; ii++){
- sqliteVdbeKeylistFree(p->keylistStack[ii]);
- }
- sqliteFree(p->keylistStack);
- p->keylistStackDepth = 0;
- p->keylistStack = 0;
- }
- sqliteFree(p->contextStack);
- p->contextStack = 0;
- sqliteFree(p->zErrMsg);
- p->zErrMsg = 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Clean up a VDBE after execution but do not delete the VDBE just yet.
-** Write any error messages into *pzErrMsg. Return the result code.
-**
-** After this routine is run, the VDBE should be ready to be executed
-** again.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeReset(Vdbe *p, char **pzErrMsg){
- sqlite *db = p->db;
- int i;
-
- if( p->magic!=VDBE_MAGIC_RUN && p->magic!=VDBE_MAGIC_HALT ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(STQLITE_MISUSE), (char*)0);
- return STQLITE_MISUSE;
- }
- if( p->zErrMsg ){
- if( pzErrMsg && *pzErrMsg==0 ){
- *pzErrMsg = p->zErrMsg;
- }else{
- sqliteFree(p->zErrMsg);
- }
- p->zErrMsg = 0;
- }else if( p->rc ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(p->rc), (char*)0);
- }
- Cleanup(p);
- if( p->rc!=STQLITE_OK ){
- switch( p->errorAction ){
- case OE_Abort: {
- if( !p->undoTransOnError ){
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- if( db->aDb[i].pBt ){
- sqliteBtreeRollbackCkpt(db->aDb[i].pBt);
- }
- }
- break;
- }
- /* Fall through to ROLLBACK */
- }
- case OE_Rollback: {
- sqliteRollbackAll(db);
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_InTrans;
- db->onError = OE_Default;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- if( p->undoTransOnError ){
- sqliteRollbackAll(db);
- db->flags &= ~STQLITE_InTrans;
- db->onError = OE_Default;
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- sqliteRollbackInternalChanges(db);
- }
- for(i=0; i<db->nDb; i++){
- if( db->aDb[i].pBt && db->aDb[i].inTrans==2 ){
- sqliteBtreeCommitCkpt(db->aDb[i].pBt);
- db->aDb[i].inTrans = 1;
- }
- }
- assert( p->pTos<&p->aStack[p->pc] || sqlite_malloc_failed==1 );
-#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE
- {
- FILE *out = fopen("vdbe_profile.out", "a");
- if( out ){
- int i;
- fprintf(out, "---- ");
- for(i=0; i<p->nOp; i++){
- fprintf(out, "%02x", p->aOp[i].opcode);
- }
- fprintf(out, "\n");
- for(i=0; i<p->nOp; i++){
- fprintf(out, "%6d %10lld %8lld ",
- p->aOp[i].cnt,
- p->aOp[i].cycles,
- p->aOp[i].cnt>0 ? p->aOp[i].cycles/p->aOp[i].cnt : 0
- );
- sqliteVdbePrintOp(out, i, &p->aOp[i]);
- }
- fclose(out);
- }
- }
-#endif
- p->magic = VDBE_MAGIC_INIT;
- return p->rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Clean up and delete a VDBE after execution. Return an integer which is
-** the result code. Write any error message text into *pzErrMsg.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeFinalize(Vdbe *p, char **pzErrMsg){
- int rc;
- sqlite *db;
-
- if( p->magic!=VDBE_MAGIC_RUN && p->magic!=VDBE_MAGIC_HALT ){
- sqliteSetString(pzErrMsg, sqlite_error_string(STQLITE_MISUSE), (char*)0);
- return STQLITE_MISUSE;
- }
- db = p->db;
- rc = sqliteVdbeReset(p, pzErrMsg);
- sqliteVdbeDelete(p);
- if( db->want_to_close && db->pVdbe==0 ){
- sqlite_close(db);
- }
- if( rc==STQLITE_SCHEMA ){
- sqliteResetInternalSchema(db, 0);
- }
- return rc;
-}
-
-/*
-** Set the values of all variables. Variable $1 in the original SQL will
-** be the string azValue[0]. $2 will have the value azValue[1]. And
-** so forth. If a value is out of range (for example $3 when nValue==2)
-** then its value will be NULL.
-**
-** This routine overrides any prior call.
-*/
-int sqlite_bind(sqlite_vm *pVm, int i, const char *zVal, int len, int copy){
- Vdbe *p = (Vdbe*)pVm;
- if( p->magic!=VDBE_MAGIC_RUN || p->pc!=0 ){
- return STQLITE_MISUSE;
- }
- if( i<1 || i>p->nVar ){
- return STQLITE_RANGE;
- }
- i--;
- if( p->abVar[i] ){
- sqliteFree(p->azVar[i]);
- }
- if( zVal==0 ){
- copy = 0;
- len = 0;
- }
- if( len<0 ){
- len = strlen(zVal)+1;
- }
- if( copy ){
- p->azVar[i] = sqliteMalloc( len );
- if( p->azVar[i] ) memcpy(p->azVar[i], zVal, len);
- }else{
- p->azVar[i] = (char*)zVal;
- }
- p->abVar[i] = copy;
- p->anVar[i] = len;
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
-
-
-/*
-** Delete an entire VDBE.
-*/
-void sqliteVdbeDelete(Vdbe *p){
- int i;
- if( p==0 ) return;
- Cleanup(p);
- if( p->pPrev ){
- p->pPrev->pNext = p->pNext;
- }else{
- assert( p->db->pVdbe==p );
- p->db->pVdbe = p->pNext;
- }
- if( p->pNext ){
- p->pNext->pPrev = p->pPrev;
- }
- p->pPrev = p->pNext = 0;
- if( p->nOpAlloc==0 ){
- p->aOp = 0;
- p->nOp = 0;
- }
- for(i=0; i<p->nOp; i++){
- if( p->aOp[i].p3type==P3_DYNAMIC ){
- sqliteFree(p->aOp[i].p3);
- }
- }
- for(i=0; i<p->nVar; i++){
- if( p->abVar[i] ) sqliteFree(p->azVar[i]);
- }
- sqliteFree(p->aOp);
- sqliteFree(p->aLabel);
- sqliteFree(p->aStack);
- p->magic = VDBE_MAGIC_DEAD;
- sqliteFree(p);
-}
-
-/*
-** Convert an integer in between the native integer format and
-** the bigEndian format used as the record number for tables.
-**
-** The bigEndian format (most significant byte first) is used for
-** record numbers so that records will sort into the correct order
-** even though memcmp() is used to compare the keys. On machines
-** whose native integer format is little endian (ex: i486) the
-** order of bytes is reversed. On native big-endian machines
-** (ex: Alpha, Sparc, Motorola) the byte order is the same.
-**
-** This function is its own inverse. In other words
-**
-** X == byteSwap(byteSwap(X))
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeByteSwap(int x){
- union {
- char zBuf[sizeof(int)];
- int i;
- } ux;
- ux.zBuf[3] = x&0xff;
- ux.zBuf[2] = (x>>8)&0xff;
- ux.zBuf[1] = (x>>16)&0xff;
- ux.zBuf[0] = (x>>24)&0xff;
- return ux.i;
-}
-
-/*
-** If a MoveTo operation is pending on the given cursor, then do that
-** MoveTo now. Return an error code. If no MoveTo is pending, this
-** routine does nothing and returns STQLITE_OK.
-*/
-int sqliteVdbeCursorMoveto(Cursor *p){
- if( p->deferredMoveto ){
- int res;
- extern int sqlite_search_count;
- sqliteBtreeMoveto(p->pCursor, (char*)&p->movetoTarget, sizeof(int), &res);
- p->lastRecno = keyToInt(p->movetoTarget);
- p->recnoIsValid = res==0;
- if( res<0 ){
- sqliteBtreeNext(p->pCursor, &res);
- }
- sqlite_search_count++;
- p->deferredMoveto = 0;
- }
- return STQLITE_OK;
-}
diff --git a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/where.c b/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/where.c
deleted file mode 100644
index c849d1c..0000000
--- a/tqtinterface/qt4/src/3rdparty/sqlite/where.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1204 +0,0 @@
-/*
-** 2001 September 15
-**
-** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
-** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
-**
-** May you do good and not evil.
-** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
-** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
-**
-*************************************************************************
-** This module contains C code that generates VDBE code used to process
-** the WHERE clause of SQL statements.
-**
-** $Id: where.c,v 1.89 2004/02/22 20:05:02 drh Exp $
-*/
-#include "sqliteInt.h"
-
-/*
-** The query generator uses an array of instances of this structure to
-** help it analyze the subexpressions of the WHERE clause. Each WHERE
-** clause subexpression is separated from the others by an AND operator.
-*/
-typedef struct ExprInfo ExprInfo;
-struct ExprInfo {
- Expr *p; /* Pointer to the subexpression */
- u8 indexable; /* True if this subexprssion is usable by an index */
- short int idxLeft; /* p->pLeft is a column in this table number. -1 if
- ** p->pLeft is not the column of any table */
- short int idxRight; /* p->pRight is a column in this table number. -1 if
- ** p->pRight is not the column of any table */
- unsigned prereqLeft; /* Bitmask of tables referenced by p->pLeft */
- unsigned prereqRight; /* Bitmask of tables referenced by p->pRight */
- unsigned prereqAll; /* Bitmask of tables referenced by p */
-};
-
-/*
-** An instance of the following structure keeps track of a mapping
-** between VDBE cursor numbers and bitmasks. The VDBE cursor numbers
-** are small integers contained in SrcList_item.iCursor and Expr.iTable
-** fields. For any given WHERE clause, we want to track which cursors
-** are being used, so we assign a single bit in a 32-bit word to track
-** that cursor. Then a 32-bit integer is able to show the set of all
-** cursors being used.
-*/
-typedef struct ExprMaskSet ExprMaskSet;
-struct ExprMaskSet {
- int n; /* Number of assigned cursor values */
- int ix[32]; /* Cursor assigned to each bit */
-};
-
-/*
-** Determine the number of elements in an array.
-*/
-#define ARRAYSIZE(X) (sizeof(X)/sizeof(X[0]))
-
-/*
-** This routine is used to divide the WHERE expression into subexpressions
-** separated by the AND operator.
-**
-** aSlot[] is an array of subexpressions structures.
-** There are nSlot spaces left in this array. This routine attempts to
-** split pExpr into subexpressions and fills aSlot[] with those subexpressions.
-** The return value is the number of Q_SLOTS filled.
-*/
-static int exprSplit(int nSlot, ExprInfo *aSlot, Expr *pExpr){
- int cnt = 0;
- if( pExpr==0 || nSlot<1 ) return 0;
- if( nSlot==1 || pExpr->op!=TK_AND ){
- aSlot[0].p = pExpr;
- return 1;
- }
- if( pExpr->pLeft->op!=TK_AND ){
- aSlot[0].p = pExpr->pLeft;
- cnt = 1 + exprSplit(nSlot-1, &aSlot[1], pExpr->pRight);
- }else{
- cnt = exprSplit(nSlot, aSlot, pExpr->pLeft);
- cnt += exprSplit(nSlot-cnt, &aSlot[cnt], pExpr->pRight);
- }
- return cnt;
-}
-
-/*
-** Initialize an expression mask set
-*/
-#define initMaskSet(P) memset(P, 0, sizeof(*P))
-
-/*
-** Return the bitmask for the given cursor. Assign a new bitmask
-** if this is the first time the cursor has been seen.
-*/
-static int getMask(ExprMaskSet *pMaskSet, int iCursor){
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<pMaskSet->n; i++){
- if( pMaskSet->ix[i]==iCursor ) return 1<<i;
- }
- if( i==pMaskSet->n && i<ARRAYSIZE(pMaskSet->ix) ){
- pMaskSet->n++;
- pMaskSet->ix[i] = iCursor;
- return 1<<i;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-/*
-** Destroy an expression mask set
-*/
-#define freeMaskSet(P) /* NO-OP */
-
-/*
-** This routine walks (recursively) an expression tree and generates
-** a bitmask indicating which tables are used in that expression
-** tree.
-**
-** In order for this routine to work, the calling function must have
-** previously invoked sqliteExprResolveIds() on the expression. See
-** the header comment on that routine for additional information.
-** The sqliteExprResolveIds() routines looks for column names and
-** sets their opcodes to TK_COLUMN and their Expr.iTable fields to
-** the VDBE cursor number of the table.
-*/
-static int exprTableUsage(ExprMaskSet *pMaskSet, Expr *p){
- unsigned int mask = 0;
- if( p==0 ) return 0;
- if( p->op==TK_COLUMN ){
- return getMask(pMaskSet, p->iTable);
- }
- if( p->pRight ){
- mask = exprTableUsage(pMaskSet, p->pRight);
- }
- if( p->pLeft ){
- mask |= exprTableUsage(pMaskSet, p->pLeft);
- }
- if( p->pList ){
- int i;
- for(i=0; i<p->pList->nExpr; i++){
- mask |= exprTableUsage(pMaskSet, p->pList->a[i].pExpr);
- }
- }
- return mask;
-}
-
-/*
-** Return TRUE if the given operator is one of the operators that is
-** allowed for an indexable WHERE clause. The allowed operators are
-** "=", "<", ">", "<=", ">=", and "IN".
-*/
-static int allowedOp(int op){
- switch( op ){
- case TK_LT:
- case TK_LE:
- case TK_GT:
- case TK_GE:
- case TK_EQ:
- case TK_IN:
- return 1;
- default:
- return 0;
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** The input to this routine is an ExprInfo structure with only the
-** "p" field filled in. The job of this routine is to analyze the
-** subexpression and populate all the other fields of the ExprInfo
-** structure.
-*/
-static void exprAnalyze(ExprMaskSet *pMaskSet, ExprInfo *pInfo){
- Expr *pExpr = pInfo->p;
- pInfo->prereqLeft = exprTableUsage(pMaskSet, pExpr->pLeft);
- pInfo->prereqRight = exprTableUsage(pMaskSet, pExpr->pRight);
- pInfo->prereqAll = exprTableUsage(pMaskSet, pExpr);
- pInfo->indexable = 0;
- pInfo->idxLeft = -1;
- pInfo->idxRight = -1;
- if( allowedOp(pExpr->op) && (pInfo->prereqRight & pInfo->prereqLeft)==0 ){
- if( pExpr->pRight && pExpr->pRight->op==TK_COLUMN ){
- pInfo->idxRight = pExpr->pRight->iTable;
- pInfo->indexable = 1;
- }
- if( pExpr->pLeft->op==TK_COLUMN ){
- pInfo->idxLeft = pExpr->pLeft->iTable;
- pInfo->indexable = 1;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/*
-** pOrderBy is an ORDER BY clause from a SELECT statement. pTab is the
-** left-most table in the FROM clause of that same SELECT statement and
-** the table has a cursor number of "base".
-**
-** This routine attempts to find an index for pTab that generates the
-** correct record sequence for the given ORDER BY clause. The return value
-** is a pointer to an index that does the job. NULL is returned if the
-** table has no index that will generate the correct sort order.
-**
-** If there are two or more indices that generate the correct sort order
-** and pPreferredIdx is one of those indices, then return pPreferredIdx.
-**
-** nEqCol is the number of columns of pPreferredIdx that are used as
-** equality constraints. Any index returned must have exactly this same
-** set of columns. The ORDER BY clause only matches index columns beyond the
-** the first nEqCol columns.
-**
-** All terms of the ORDER BY clause must be either ASC or DESC. The
-** *pbRev value is set to 1 if the ORDER BY clause is all DESC and it is
-** set to 0 if the ORDER BY clause is all ASC.
-*/
-static Index *findSortingIndex(
- Table *pTab, /* The table to be sorted */
- int base, /* Cursor number for pTab */
- ExprList *pOrderBy, /* The ORDER BY clause */
- Index *pPreferredIdx, /* Use this index, if possible and not NULL */
- int nEqCol, /* Number of index columns used with == constraints */
- int *pbRev /* Set to 1 if ORDER BY is DESC */
-){
- int i, j;
- Index *pMatch;
- Index *pIdx;
- int sortOrder;
-
- assert( pOrderBy!=0 );
- assert( pOrderBy->nExpr>0 );
- sortOrder = pOrderBy->a[0].sortOrder & STQLITE_SO_DIRMASK;
- for(i=0; i<pOrderBy->nExpr; i++){
- Expr *p;
- if( (pOrderBy->a[i].sortOrder & STQLITE_SO_DIRMASK)!=sortOrder ){
- /* Indices can only be used if all ORDER BY terms are either
- ** DESC or ASC. Indices cannot be used on a mixture. */
- return 0;
- }
- if( (pOrderBy->a[i].sortOrder & STQLITE_SO_TYPEMASK)!=STQLITE_SO_UNK ){
- /* Do not sort by index if there is a COLLATE clause */
- return 0;
- }
- p = pOrderBy->a[i].pExpr;
- if( p->op!=TK_COLUMN || p->iTable!=base ){
- /* Can not use an index sort on anything that is not a column in the
- ** left-most table of the FROM clause */
- return 0;
- }
- }
-
- /* If we get this far, it means the ORDER BY clause consists only of
- ** ascending columns in the left-most table of the FROM clause. Now
- ** check for a matching index.
- */
- pMatch = 0;
- for(pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext){
- int nExpr = pOrderBy->nExpr;
- if( pIdx->nColumn < nEqCol || pIdx->nColumn < nExpr ) continue;
- for(i=j=0; i<nEqCol; i++){
- if( pPreferredIdx->aiColumn[i]!=pIdx->aiColumn[i] ) break;
- if( j<nExpr && pOrderBy->a[j].pExpr->iColumn==pIdx->aiColumn[i] ){ j++; }
- }
- if( i<nEqCol ) continue;
- for(i=0; i+j<nExpr; i++){
- if( pOrderBy->a[i+j].pExpr->iColumn!=pIdx->aiColumn[i+nEqCol] ) break;
- }
- if( i+j>=nExpr ){
- pMatch = pIdx;
- if( pIdx==pPreferredIdx ) break;
- }
- }
- if( pMatch && pbRev ){
- *pbRev = sortOrder==STQLITE_SO_DESC;
- }
- return pMatch;
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate the beginning of the loop used for WHERE clause processing.
-** The return value is a pointer to an (opaque) structure that contains
-** information needed to terminate the loop. Later, the calling routine
-** should invoke sqliteWhereEnd() with the return value of this function
-** in order to complete the WHERE clause processing.
-**
-** If an error occurs, this routine returns NULL.
-**
-** The basic idea is to do a nested loop, one loop for each table in
-** the FROM clause of a select. (INSERT and UPDATE statements are the
-** same as a SELECT with only a single table in the FROM clause.) For
-** example, if the SQL is this:
-**
-** SELECT * FROM t1, t2, t3 WHERE ...;
-**
-** Then the code generated is conceptually like the following:
-**
-** foreach row1 in t1 do \ Code generated
-** foreach row2 in t2 do |-- by sqliteWhereBegin()
-** foreach row3 in t3 do /
-** ...
-** end \ Code generated
-** end |-- by sqliteWhereEnd()
-** end /
-**
-** There are Btree cursors associated with each table. t1 uses cursor
-** number pTabList->a[0].iCursor. t2 uses the cursor pTabList->a[1].iCursor.
-** And so forth. This routine generates code to open those VDBE cursors
-** and sqliteWhereEnd() generates the code to close them.
-**
-** If the WHERE clause is empty, the foreach loops must each scan their
-** entire tables. Thus a three-way join is an O(N^3) operation. But if
-** the tables have indices and there are terms in the WHERE clause that
-** refer to those indices, a complete table scan can be avoided and the
-** code will run much faster. Most of the work of this routine is checking
-** to see if there are indices that can be used to speed up the loop.
-**
-** Terms of the WHERE clause are also used to limit which rows actually
-** make it to the "..." in the middle of the loop. After each "foreach",
-** terms of the WHERE clause that use only terms in that loop and outer
-** loops are evaluated and if false a jump is made around all subsequent
-** inner loops (or around the "..." if the test occurs within the inner-
-** most loop)
-**
-** OUTER JOINS
-**
-** An outer join of tables t1 and t2 is conceptally coded as follows:
-**
-** foreach row1 in t1 do
-** flag = 0
-** foreach row2 in t2 do
-** start:
-** ...
-** flag = 1
-** end
-** if flag==0 then
-** move the row2 cursor to a null row
-** goto start
-** fi
-** end
-**
-** ORDER BY CLAUSE PROCESSING
-**
-** *ppOrderBy is a pointer to the ORDER BY clause of a SELECT statement,
-** if there is one. If there is no ORDER BY clause or if this routine
-** is called from an UPDATE or DELETE statement, then ppOrderBy is NULL.
-**
-** If an index can be used so that the natural output order of the table
-** scan is correct for the ORDER BY clause, then that index is used and
-** *ppOrderBy is set to NULL. This is an optimization that prevents an
-** unnecessary sort of the result set if an index appropriate for the
-** ORDER BY clause already exists.
-**
-** If the where clause loops cannot be arranged to provide the correct
-** output order, then the *ppOrderBy is unchanged.
-*/
-WhereInfo *sqliteWhereBegin(
- Parse *pParse, /* The parser context */
- SrcList *pTabList, /* A list of all tables to be scanned */
- Expr *pWhere, /* The WHERE clause */
- int pushKey, /* If TRUE, leave the table key on the stack */
- ExprList **ppOrderBy /* An ORDER BY clause, or NULL */
-){
- int i; /* Loop counter */
- WhereInfo *pWInfo; /* Will become the return value of this function */
- Vdbe *v = pParse->pVdbe; /* The virtual database engine */
- int brk, cont = 0; /* Addresses used during code generation */
- int nExpr; /* Number of subexpressions in the WHERE clause */
- int loopMask; /* One bit set for each outer loop */
- int haveKey; /* True if KEY is on the stack */
- ExprMaskSet maskSet; /* The expression mask set */
- int iDirectEq[32]; /* Term of the form ROWID==X for the N-th table */
- int iDirectLt[32]; /* Term of the form ROWID<X or ROWID<=X */
- int iDirectGt[32]; /* Term of the form ROWID>X or ROWID>=X */
- ExprInfo aExpr[101]; /* The WHERE clause is divided into these expressions */
-
- /* pushKey is only allowed if there is a single table (as in an INSERT or
- ** UPDATE statement)
- */
- assert( pushKey==0 || pTabList->nSrc==1 );
-
- /* Split the WHERE clause into separate subexpressions where each
- ** subexpression is separated by an AND operator. If the aExpr[]
- ** array fills up, the last entry might point to an expression which
- ** contains additional unfactored AND operators.
- */
- initMaskSet(&maskSet);
- memset(aExpr, 0, sizeof(aExpr));
- nExpr = exprSplit(ARRAYSIZE(aExpr), aExpr, pWhere);
- if( nExpr==ARRAYSIZE(aExpr) ){
- sqliteErrorMsg(pParse, "WHERE clause too complex - no more "
- "than %d terms allowed", (int)ARRAYSIZE(aExpr)-1);
- return 0;
- }
-
- /* Allocate and initialize the WhereInfo structure that will become the
- ** return value.
- */
- pWInfo = sqliteMalloc( sizeof(WhereInfo) + pTabList->nSrc*sizeof(WhereLevel));
- if( sqlite_malloc_failed ){
- sqliteFree(pWInfo);
- return 0;
- }
- pWInfo->pParse = pParse;
- pWInfo->pTabList = pTabList;
- pWInfo->peakNTab = pWInfo->savedNTab = pParse->nTab;
- pWInfo->iBreak = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
-
- /* Special case: a WHERE clause that is constant. Evaluate the
- ** expression and either jump over all of the code or fall thru.
- */
- if( pWhere && (pTabList->nSrc==0 || sqliteExprIsConstant(pWhere)) ){
- sqliteExprIfFalse(pParse, pWhere, pWInfo->iBreak, 1);
- pWhere = 0;
- }
-
- /* Analyze all of the subexpressions.
- */
- for(i=0; i<nExpr; i++){
- exprAnalyze(&maskSet, &aExpr[i]);
-
- /* If we are executing a trigger body, remove all references to
- ** new.* and old.* tables from the prerequisite masks.
- */
- if( pParse->trigStack ){
- int x;
- if( (x = pParse->trigStack->newIdx) >= 0 ){
- int mask = ~getMask(&maskSet, x);
- aExpr[i].prereqRight &= mask;
- aExpr[i].prereqLeft &= mask;
- aExpr[i].prereqAll &= mask;
- }
- if( (x = pParse->trigStack->oldIdx) >= 0 ){
- int mask = ~getMask(&maskSet, x);
- aExpr[i].prereqRight &= mask;
- aExpr[i].prereqLeft &= mask;
- aExpr[i].prereqAll &= mask;
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* Figure out what index to use (if any) for each nested loop.
- ** Make pWInfo->a[i].pIdx point to the index to use for the i-th nested
- ** loop where i==0 is the outer loop and i==pTabList->nSrc-1 is the inner
- ** loop.
- **
- ** If terms exist that use the ROWID of any table, then set the
- ** iDirectEq[], iDirectLt[], or iDirectGt[] elements for that table
- ** to the index of the term containing the ROWID. We always prefer
- ** to use a ROWID which can directly access a table rather than an
- ** index which requires reading an index first to get the rowid then
- ** doing a second read of the actual database table.
- **
- ** Actually, if there are more than 32 tables in the join, only the
- ** first 32 tables are candidates for indices. This is (again) due
- ** to the limit of 32 bits in an integer bitmask.
- */
- loopMask = 0;
- for(i=0; i<pTabList->nSrc && i<ARRAYSIZE(iDirectEq); i++){
- int j;
- int iCur = pTabList->a[i].iCursor; /* The cursor for this table */
- int mask = getMask(&maskSet, iCur); /* Cursor mask for this table */
- Table *pTab = pTabList->a[i].pTab;
- Index *pIdx;
- Index *pBestIdx = 0;
- int bestScore = 0;
-
- /* Check to see if there is an expression that uses only the
- ** ROWID field of this table. For terms of the form ROWID==expr
- ** set iDirectEq[i] to the index of the term. For terms of the
- ** form ROWID<expr or ROWID<=expr set iDirectLt[i] to the term index.
- ** For terms like ROWID>expr or ROWID>=expr set iDirectGt[i].
- **
- ** (Added:) Treat ROWID IN expr like ROWID=expr.
- */
- pWInfo->a[i].iCur = -1;
- iDirectEq[i] = -1;
- iDirectLt[i] = -1;
- iDirectGt[i] = -1;
- for(j=0; j<nExpr; j++){
- if( aExpr[j].idxLeft==iCur && aExpr[j].p->pLeft->iColumn<0
- && (aExpr[j].prereqRight & loopMask)==aExpr[j].prereqRight ){
- switch( aExpr[j].p->op ){
- case TK_IN:
- case TK_EQ: iDirectEq[i] = j; break;
- case TK_LE:
- case TK_LT: iDirectLt[i] = j; break;
- case TK_GE:
- case TK_GT: iDirectGt[i] = j; break;
- }
- }
- if( aExpr[j].idxRight==iCur && aExpr[j].p->pRight->iColumn<0
- && (aExpr[j].prereqLeft & loopMask)==aExpr[j].prereqLeft ){
- switch( aExpr[j].p->op ){
- case TK_EQ: iDirectEq[i] = j; break;
- case TK_LE:
- case TK_LT: iDirectGt[i] = j; break;
- case TK_GE:
- case TK_GT: iDirectLt[i] = j; break;
- }
- }
- }
- if( iDirectEq[i]>=0 ){
- loopMask |= mask;
- pWInfo->a[i].pIdx = 0;
- continue;
- }
-
- /* Do a search for usable indices. Leave pBestIdx pointing to
- ** the "best" index. pBestIdx is left set to NULL if no indices
- ** are usable.
- **
- ** The best index is determined as follows. For each of the
- ** left-most terms that is fixed by an equality operator, add
- ** 8 to the score. The right-most term of the index may be
- ** constrained by an inequality. Add 1 if for an "x<..." constraint
- ** and add 2 for an "x>..." constraint. Chose the index that
- ** gives the best score.
- **
- ** This scoring system is designed so that the score can later be
- ** used to determine how the index is used. If the score&7 is 0
- ** then all constraints are equalities. If score&1 is not 0 then
- ** there is an inequality used as a termination key. (ex: "x<...")
- ** If score&2 is not 0 then there is an inequality used as the
- ** start key. (ex: "x>..."). A score or 4 is the special case
- ** of an IN operator constraint. (ex: "x IN ...").
- **
- ** The IN operator (as in "<expr> IN (...)") is treated the same as
- ** an equality comparison except that it can only be used on the
- ** left-most column of an index and other terms of the WHERE clause
- ** cannot be used in conjunction with the IN operator to help satisfy
- ** other columns of the index.
- */
- for(pIdx=pTab->pIndex; pIdx; pIdx=pIdx->pNext){
- int eqMask = 0; /* Index columns covered by an x=... term */
- int ltMask = 0; /* Index columns covered by an x<... term */
- int gtMask = 0; /* Index columns covered by an x>... term */
- int inMask = 0; /* Index columns covered by an x IN .. term */
- int nEq, m, score;
-
- if( pIdx->nColumn>32 ) continue; /* Ignore indices too many columns */
- for(j=0; j<nExpr; j++){
- if( aExpr[j].idxLeft==iCur
- && (aExpr[j].prereqRight & loopMask)==aExpr[j].prereqRight ){
- int iColumn = aExpr[j].p->pLeft->iColumn;
- int k;
- for(k=0; k<pIdx->nColumn; k++){
- if( pIdx->aiColumn[k]==iColumn ){
- switch( aExpr[j].p->op ){
- case TK_IN: {
- if( k==0 ) inMask |= 1;
- break;
- }
- case TK_EQ: {
- eqMask |= 1<<k;
- break;
- }
- case TK_LE:
- case TK_LT: {
- ltMask |= 1<<k;
- break;
- }
- case TK_GE:
- case TK_GT: {
- gtMask |= 1<<k;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- /* CANT_HAPPEN */
- assert( 0 );
- break;
- }
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- if( aExpr[j].idxRight==iCur
- && (aExpr[j].prereqLeft & loopMask)==aExpr[j].prereqLeft ){
- int iColumn = aExpr[j].p->pRight->iColumn;
- int k;
- for(k=0; k<pIdx->nColumn; k++){
- if( pIdx->aiColumn[k]==iColumn ){
- switch( aExpr[j].p->op ){
- case TK_EQ: {
- eqMask |= 1<<k;
- break;
- }
- case TK_LE:
- case TK_LT: {
- gtMask |= 1<<k;
- break;
- }
- case TK_GE:
- case TK_GT: {
- ltMask |= 1<<k;
- break;
- }
- default: {
- /* CANT_HAPPEN */
- assert( 0 );
- break;
- }
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* The following loop ends with nEq set to the number of columns
- ** on the left of the index with == constraints.
- */
- for(nEq=0; nEq<pIdx->nColumn; nEq++){
- m = (1<<(nEq+1))-1;
- if( (m & eqMask)!=m ) break;
- }
- score = nEq*8; /* Base score is 8 times number of == constraints */
- m = 1<<nEq;
- if( m & ltMask ) score++; /* Increase score for a < constraint */
- if( m & gtMask ) score+=2; /* Increase score for a > constraint */
- if( score==0 && inMask ) score = 4; /* Default score for IN constraint */
- if( score>bestScore ){
- pBestIdx = pIdx;
- bestScore = score;
- }
- }
- pWInfo->a[i].pIdx = pBestIdx;
- pWInfo->a[i].score = bestScore;
- pWInfo->a[i].bRev = 0;
- loopMask |= mask;
- if( pBestIdx ){
- pWInfo->a[i].iCur = pParse->nTab++;
- pWInfo->peakNTab = pParse->nTab;
- }
- }
-
- /* Check to see if the ORDER BY clause is or can be satisfied by the
- ** use of an index on the first table.
- */
- if( ppOrderBy && *ppOrderBy && pTabList->nSrc>0 ){
- Index *pSortIdx;
- Index *pIdx;
- Table *pTab;
- int bRev = 0;
-
- pTab = pTabList->a[0].pTab;
- pIdx = pWInfo->a[0].pIdx;
- if( pIdx && pWInfo->a[0].score==4 ){
- /* If there is already an IN index on the left-most table,
- ** it will not give the correct sort order.
- ** So, pretend that no suitable index is found.
- */
- pSortIdx = 0;
- }else if( iDirectEq[0]>=0 || iDirectLt[0]>=0 || iDirectGt[0]>=0 ){
- /* If the left-most column is accessed using its ROWID, then do
- ** not try to sort by index.
- */
- pSortIdx = 0;
- }else{
- int nEqCol = (pWInfo->a[0].score+4)/8;
- pSortIdx = findSortingIndex(pTab, pTabList->a[0].iCursor,
- *ppOrderBy, pIdx, nEqCol, &bRev);
- }
- if( pSortIdx && (pIdx==0 || pIdx==pSortIdx) ){
- if( pIdx==0 ){
- pWInfo->a[0].pIdx = pSortIdx;
- pWInfo->a[0].iCur = pParse->nTab++;
- pWInfo->peakNTab = pParse->nTab;
- }
- pWInfo->a[0].bRev = bRev;
- *ppOrderBy = 0;
- }
- }
-
- /* Open all tables in the pTabList and all indices used by those tables.
- */
- for(i=0; i<pTabList->nSrc; i++){
- Table *pTab;
- Index *pIx;
-
- pTab = pTabList->a[i].pTab;
- if( pTab->isTransient || pTab->pSelect ) continue;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pTab->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_OpenRead, pTabList->a[i].iCursor, pTab->tnum,
- pTab->zName, P3_STATIC);
- sqliteCodeVerifySchema(pParse, pTab->iDb);
- if( (pIx = pWInfo->a[i].pIdx)!=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, pIx->iDb, 0);
- sqliteVdbeOp3(v, OP_OpenRead, pWInfo->a[i].iCur, pIx->tnum, pIx->zName,0);
- }
- }
-
- /* Generate the code to do the search
- */
- loopMask = 0;
- for(i=0; i<pTabList->nSrc; i++){
- int j, k;
- int iCur = pTabList->a[i].iCursor;
- Index *pIdx;
- WhereLevel *pLevel = &pWInfo->a[i];
-
- /* If this is the right table of a LEFT OUTER JOIN, allocate and
- ** initialize a memory cell that records if this table matches any
- ** row of the left table of the join.
- */
- if( i>0 && (pTabList->a[i-1].jointype & JT_LEFT)!=0 ){
- if( !pParse->nMem ) pParse->nMem++;
- pLevel->iLeftJoin = pParse->nMem++;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_String, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, pLevel->iLeftJoin, 1);
- }
-
- pIdx = pLevel->pIdx;
- pLevel->inOp = OP_Noop;
- if( i<ARRAYSIZE(iDirectEq) && iDirectEq[i]>=0 ){
- /* Case 1: We can directly reference a single row using an
- ** equality comparison against the ROWID field. Or
- ** we reference multiple rows using a "rowid IN (...)"
- ** construct.
- */
- k = iDirectEq[i];
- assert( k<nExpr );
- assert( aExpr[k].p!=0 );
- assert( aExpr[k].idxLeft==iCur || aExpr[k].idxRight==iCur );
- brk = pLevel->brk = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- if( aExpr[k].idxLeft==iCur ){
- Expr *pX = aExpr[k].p;
- if( pX->op!=TK_IN ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, aExpr[k].p->pRight);
- }else if( pX->pList ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetFirst, pX->iTable, brk);
- pLevel->inOp = OP_SetNext;
- pLevel->inP1 = pX->iTable;
- pLevel->inP2 = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- }else{
- assert( pX->pSelect );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, pX->iTable, brk);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_KeyAsData, pX->iTable, 1);
- pLevel->inP2 = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_FullKey, pX->iTable, 0);
- pLevel->inOp = OP_Next;
- pLevel->inP1 = pX->iTable;
- }
- }else{
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, aExpr[k].p->pLeft);
- }
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- cont = pLevel->cont = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MustBeInt, 1, brk);
- haveKey = 0;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotExists, iCur, brk);
- pLevel->op = OP_Noop;
- }else if( pIdx!=0 && pLevel->score>0 && pLevel->score%4==0 ){
- /* Case 2: There is an index and all terms of the WHERE clause that
- ** refer to the index use the "==" or "IN" operators.
- */
- int start;
- int testOp;
- int nColumn = (pLevel->score+4)/8;
- brk = pLevel->brk = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- for(j=0; j<nColumn; j++){
- for(k=0; k<nExpr; k++){
- Expr *pX = aExpr[k].p;
- if( pX==0 ) continue;
- if( aExpr[k].idxLeft==iCur
- && (aExpr[k].prereqRight & loopMask)==aExpr[k].prereqRight
- && pX->pLeft->iColumn==pIdx->aiColumn[j]
- ){
- if( pX->op==TK_EQ ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pX->pRight);
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- break;
- }
- if( pX->op==TK_IN && nColumn==1 ){
- if( pX->pList ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_SetFirst, pX->iTable, brk);
- pLevel->inOp = OP_SetNext;
- pLevel->inP1 = pX->iTable;
- pLevel->inP2 = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- }else{
- assert( pX->pSelect );
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, pX->iTable, brk);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_KeyAsData, pX->iTable, 1);
- pLevel->inP2 = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_FullKey, pX->iTable, 0);
- pLevel->inOp = OP_Next;
- pLevel->inP1 = pX->iTable;
- }
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- break;
- }
- }
- if( aExpr[k].idxRight==iCur
- && aExpr[k].p->op==TK_EQ
- && (aExpr[k].prereqLeft & loopMask)==aExpr[k].prereqLeft
- && aExpr[k].p->pRight->iColumn==pIdx->aiColumn[j]
- ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, aExpr[k].p->pLeft);
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- pLevel->iMem = pParse->nMem++;
- cont = pLevel->cont = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, -nColumn, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, nColumn, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, brk);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeKey, nColumn, 0);
- sqliteAddIdxKeyType(v, pIdx);
- if( nColumn==pIdx->nColumn || pLevel->bRev ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, pLevel->iMem, 0);
- testOp = OP_IdxGT;
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IncrKey, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, pLevel->iMem, 1);
- testOp = OP_IdxGE;
- }
- if( pLevel->bRev ){
- /* Scan in reverse order */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IncrKey, 0, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveLt, pLevel->iCur, brk);
- start = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemLoad, pLevel->iMem, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IdxLT, pLevel->iCur, brk);
- pLevel->op = OP_Prev;
- }else{
- /* Scan in the forward order */
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, pLevel->iCur, brk);
- start = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemLoad, pLevel->iMem, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, testOp, pLevel->iCur, brk);
- pLevel->op = OP_Next;
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_RowKey, pLevel->iCur, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IdxIsNull, nColumn, cont);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IdxRecno, pLevel->iCur, 0);
- if( i==pTabList->nSrc-1 && pushKey ){
- haveKey = 1;
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, iCur, 0);
- haveKey = 0;
- }
- pLevel->p1 = pLevel->iCur;
- pLevel->p2 = start;
- }else if( i<ARRAYSIZE(iDirectLt) && (iDirectLt[i]>=0 || iDirectGt[i]>=0) ){
- /* Case 3: We have an inequality comparison against the ROWID field.
- */
- int testOp = OP_Noop;
- int start;
-
- brk = pLevel->brk = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- cont = pLevel->cont = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- if( iDirectGt[i]>=0 ){
- k = iDirectGt[i];
- assert( k<nExpr );
- assert( aExpr[k].p!=0 );
- assert( aExpr[k].idxLeft==iCur || aExpr[k].idxRight==iCur );
- if( aExpr[k].idxLeft==iCur ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, aExpr[k].p->pRight);
- }else{
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, aExpr[k].p->pLeft);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_ForceInt,
- aExpr[k].p->op==TK_LT || aExpr[k].p->op==TK_GT, brk);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, iCur, brk);
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, iCur, brk);
- }
- if( iDirectLt[i]>=0 ){
- k = iDirectLt[i];
- assert( k<nExpr );
- assert( aExpr[k].p!=0 );
- assert( aExpr[k].idxLeft==iCur || aExpr[k].idxRight==iCur );
- if( aExpr[k].idxLeft==iCur ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, aExpr[k].p->pRight);
- }else{
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, aExpr[k].p->pLeft);
- }
- /* sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MustBeInt, 0, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+1); */
- pLevel->iMem = pParse->nMem++;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, pLevel->iMem, 1);
- if( aExpr[k].p->op==TK_LT || aExpr[k].p->op==TK_GT ){
- testOp = OP_Ge;
- }else{
- testOp = OP_Gt;
- }
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- }
- start = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- pLevel->op = OP_Next;
- pLevel->p1 = iCur;
- pLevel->p2 = start;
- if( testOp!=OP_Noop ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Recno, iCur, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemLoad, pLevel->iMem, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, testOp, 0, brk);
- }
- haveKey = 0;
- }else if( pIdx==0 ){
- /* Case 4: There is no usable index. We must do a complete
- ** scan of the entire database table.
- */
- int start;
-
- brk = pLevel->brk = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- cont = pLevel->cont = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, iCur, brk);
- start = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- pLevel->op = OP_Next;
- pLevel->p1 = iCur;
- pLevel->p2 = start;
- haveKey = 0;
- }else{
- /* Case 5: The WHERE clause term that refers to the right-most
- ** column of the index is an inequality. For example, if
- ** the index is on (x,y,z) and the WHERE clause is of the
- ** form "x=5 AND y<10" then this case is used. Only the
- ** right-most column can be an inequality - the rest must
- ** use the "==" operator.
- **
- ** This case is also used when there are no WHERE clause
- ** constraints but an index is selected anyway, in order
- ** to force the output order to conform to an ORDER BY.
- */
- int score = pLevel->score;
- int nEqColumn = score/8;
- int start;
- int leFlag, geFlag;
- int testOp;
-
- /* Evaluate the equality constraints
- */
- for(j=0; j<nEqColumn; j++){
- for(k=0; k<nExpr; k++){
- if( aExpr[k].p==0 ) continue;
- if( aExpr[k].idxLeft==iCur
- && aExpr[k].p->op==TK_EQ
- && (aExpr[k].prereqRight & loopMask)==aExpr[k].prereqRight
- && aExpr[k].p->pLeft->iColumn==pIdx->aiColumn[j]
- ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, aExpr[k].p->pRight);
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- break;
- }
- if( aExpr[k].idxRight==iCur
- && aExpr[k].p->op==TK_EQ
- && (aExpr[k].prereqLeft & loopMask)==aExpr[k].prereqLeft
- && aExpr[k].p->pRight->iColumn==pIdx->aiColumn[j]
- ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, aExpr[k].p->pLeft);
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* Duplicate the equality term values because they will all be
- ** used twice: once to make the termination key and once to make the
- ** start key.
- */
- for(j=0; j<nEqColumn; j++){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Dup, nEqColumn-1, 0);
- }
-
- /* Labels for the beginning and end of the loop
- */
- cont = pLevel->cont = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
- brk = pLevel->brk = sqliteVdbeMakeLabel(v);
-
- /* Generate the termination key. This is the key value that
- ** will end the search. There is no termination key if there
- ** are no equality terms and no "X<..." term.
- **
- ** 2002-Dec-04: On a reverse-order scan, the so-called "termination"
- ** key computed here really ends up being the start key.
- */
- if( (score & 1)!=0 ){
- for(k=0; k<nExpr; k++){
- Expr *pExpr = aExpr[k].p;
- if( pExpr==0 ) continue;
- if( aExpr[k].idxLeft==iCur
- && (pExpr->op==TK_LT || pExpr->op==TK_LE)
- && (aExpr[k].prereqRight & loopMask)==aExpr[k].prereqRight
- && pExpr->pLeft->iColumn==pIdx->aiColumn[j]
- ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pRight);
- leFlag = pExpr->op==TK_LE;
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- break;
- }
- if( aExpr[k].idxRight==iCur
- && (pExpr->op==TK_GT || pExpr->op==TK_GE)
- && (aExpr[k].prereqLeft & loopMask)==aExpr[k].prereqLeft
- && pExpr->pRight->iColumn==pIdx->aiColumn[j]
- ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- leFlag = pExpr->op==TK_GE;
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- break;
- }
- }
- testOp = OP_IdxGE;
- }else{
- testOp = nEqColumn>0 ? OP_IdxGE : OP_Noop;
- leFlag = 1;
- }
- if( testOp!=OP_Noop ){
- int nCol = nEqColumn + (score & 1);
- pLevel->iMem = pParse->nMem++;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, -nCol, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, nCol, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, brk);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeKey, nCol, 0);
- sqliteAddIdxKeyType(v, pIdx);
- if( leFlag ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IncrKey, 0, 0);
- }
- if( pLevel->bRev ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveLt, pLevel->iCur, brk);
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, pLevel->iMem, 1);
- }
- }else if( pLevel->bRev ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Last, pLevel->iCur, brk);
- }
-
- /* Generate the start key. This is the key that defines the lower
- ** bound on the search. There is no start key if there are no
- ** equality terms and if there is no "X>..." term. In
- ** that case, generate a "Rewind" instruction in place of the
- ** start key search.
- **
- ** 2002-Dec-04: In the case of a reverse-order search, the so-called
- ** "start" key really ends up being used as the termination key.
- */
- if( (score & 2)!=0 ){
- for(k=0; k<nExpr; k++){
- Expr *pExpr = aExpr[k].p;
- if( pExpr==0 ) continue;
- if( aExpr[k].idxLeft==iCur
- && (pExpr->op==TK_GT || pExpr->op==TK_GE)
- && (aExpr[k].prereqRight & loopMask)==aExpr[k].prereqRight
- && pExpr->pLeft->iColumn==pIdx->aiColumn[j]
- ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pRight);
- geFlag = pExpr->op==TK_GE;
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- break;
- }
- if( aExpr[k].idxRight==iCur
- && (pExpr->op==TK_LT || pExpr->op==TK_LE)
- && (aExpr[k].prereqLeft & loopMask)==aExpr[k].prereqLeft
- && pExpr->pRight->iColumn==pIdx->aiColumn[j]
- ){
- sqliteExprCode(pParse, pExpr->pLeft);
- geFlag = pExpr->op==TK_LE;
- aExpr[k].p = 0;
- break;
- }
- }
- }else{
- geFlag = 1;
- }
- if( nEqColumn>0 || (score&2)!=0 ){
- int nCol = nEqColumn + ((score&2)!=0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, -nCol, sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v)+3);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Pop, nCol, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, brk);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MakeKey, nCol, 0);
- sqliteAddIdxKeyType(v, pIdx);
- if( !geFlag ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IncrKey, 0, 0);
- }
- if( pLevel->bRev ){
- pLevel->iMem = pParse->nMem++;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, pLevel->iMem, 1);
- testOp = OP_IdxLT;
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, pLevel->iCur, brk);
- }
- }else if( pLevel->bRev ){
- testOp = OP_Noop;
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Rewind, pLevel->iCur, brk);
- }
-
- /* Generate the the top of the loop. If there is a termination
- ** key we have to test for that key and abort at the top of the
- ** loop.
- */
- start = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- if( testOp!=OP_Noop ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemLoad, pLevel->iMem, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, testOp, pLevel->iCur, brk);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_RowKey, pLevel->iCur, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IdxIsNull, nEqColumn + (score & 1), cont);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_IdxRecno, pLevel->iCur, 0);
- if( i==pTabList->nSrc-1 && pushKey ){
- haveKey = 1;
- }else{
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, iCur, 0);
- haveKey = 0;
- }
-
- /* Record the instruction used to terminate the loop.
- */
- pLevel->op = pLevel->bRev ? OP_Prev : OP_Next;
- pLevel->p1 = pLevel->iCur;
- pLevel->p2 = start;
- }
- loopMask |= getMask(&maskSet, iCur);
-
- /* Insert code to test every subexpression that can be completely
- ** computed using the current set of tables.
- */
- for(j=0; j<nExpr; j++){
- if( aExpr[j].p==0 ) continue;
- if( (aExpr[j].prereqAll & loopMask)!=aExpr[j].prereqAll ) continue;
- if( pLevel->iLeftJoin && !ExprHasProperty(aExpr[j].p,EP_FromJoin) ){
- continue;
- }
- if( haveKey ){
- haveKey = 0;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, iCur, 0);
- }
- sqliteExprIfFalse(pParse, aExpr[j].p, cont, 1);
- aExpr[j].p = 0;
- }
- brk = cont;
-
- /* For a LEFT OUTER JOIN, generate code that will record the fact that
- ** at least one row of the right table has matched the left table.
- */
- if( pLevel->iLeftJoin ){
- pLevel->top = sqliteVdbeCurrentAddr(v);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Integer, 1, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemStore, pLevel->iLeftJoin, 1);
- for(j=0; j<nExpr; j++){
- if( aExpr[j].p==0 ) continue;
- if( (aExpr[j].prereqAll & loopMask)!=aExpr[j].prereqAll ) continue;
- if( haveKey ){
- /* Cannot happen. "haveKey" can only be true if pushKey is true
- ** an pushKey can only be true for DELETE and UPDATE and there are
- ** no outer joins with DELETE and UPDATE.
- */
- haveKey = 0;
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MoveTo, iCur, 0);
- }
- sqliteExprIfFalse(pParse, aExpr[j].p, cont, 1);
- aExpr[j].p = 0;
- }
- }
- }
- pWInfo->iContinue = cont;
- if( pushKey && !haveKey ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Recno, pTabList->a[0].iCursor, 0);
- }
- freeMaskSet(&maskSet);
- return pWInfo;
-}
-
-/*
-** Generate the end of the WHERE loop. See comments on
-** sqliteWhereBegin() for additional information.
-*/
-void sqliteWhereEnd(WhereInfo *pWInfo){
- Vdbe *v = pWInfo->pParse->pVdbe;
- int i;
- WhereLevel *pLevel;
- SrcList *pTabList = pWInfo->pTabList;
-
- for(i=pTabList->nSrc-1; i>=0; i--){
- pLevel = &pWInfo->a[i];
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, pLevel->cont);
- if( pLevel->op!=OP_Noop ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, pLevel->op, pLevel->p1, pLevel->p2);
- }
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, pLevel->brk);
- if( pLevel->inOp!=OP_Noop ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, pLevel->inOp, pLevel->inP1, pLevel->inP2);
- }
- if( pLevel->iLeftJoin ){
- int addr;
- addr = sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_MemLoad, pLevel->iLeftJoin, 0);
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NotNull, 1, addr+4 + (pLevel->iCur>=0));
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NullRow, pTabList->a[i].iCursor, 0);
- if( pLevel->iCur>=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_NullRow, pLevel->iCur, 0);
- }
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Goto, 0, pLevel->top);
- }
- }
- sqliteVdbeResolveLabel(v, pWInfo->iBreak);
- for(i=0; i<pTabList->nSrc; i++){
- Table *pTab = pTabList->a[i].pTab;
- assert( pTab!=0 );
- if( pTab->isTransient || pTab->pSelect ) continue;
- pLevel = &pWInfo->a[i];
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, pTabList->a[i].iCursor, 0);
- if( pLevel->pIdx!=0 ){
- sqliteVdbeAddOp(v, OP_Close, pLevel->iCur, 0);
- }
- }
-#if 0 /* Never reuse a cursor */
- if( pWInfo->pParse->nTab==pWInfo->peakNTab ){
- pWInfo->pParse->nTab = pWInfo->savedNTab;
- }
-#endif
- sqliteFree(pWInfo);
- return;
-}